[go: up one dir, main page]

JP2014004408A - Game machine - Google Patents

Game machine Download PDF

Info

Publication number
JP2014004408A
JP2014004408A JP2013165425A JP2013165425A JP2014004408A JP 2014004408 A JP2014004408 A JP 2014004408A JP 2013165425 A JP2013165425 A JP 2013165425A JP 2013165425 A JP2013165425 A JP 2013165425A JP 2014004408 A JP2014004408 A JP 2014004408A
Authority
JP
Japan
Prior art keywords
game board
inner frame
frame
front door
game
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Pending
Application number
JP2013165425A
Other languages
Japanese (ja)
Inventor
Wataru Oshimi
枉 抌芋
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Sanyo Bussan Co Ltd
Original Assignee
Sanyo Bussan Co Ltd
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Sanyo Bussan Co Ltd filed Critical Sanyo Bussan Co Ltd
Priority to JP2013165425A priority Critical patent/JP2014004408A/en
Publication of JP2014004408A publication Critical patent/JP2014004408A/en
Pending legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Landscapes

  • Pinball Game Machines (AREA)

Abstract

PROBLEM TO BE SOLVED: To provide a game machine which is provided with a lock device for locking an opening/closing body in a closed state to a support object and capable of preventing locking from being illegally released.SOLUTION: A Pachinko machine includes an outer frame 11, an inner frame 13 supported rotatably by the outer frame 11, and a lock device 500 disposed at a rotation tip side of the inner frame 13. The lock device 500 is provided with a hook member 620 for an inner frame disposed at a front side of the inner frame 13 to project backward through a slit 303 of the inner frame 13, and the inner frame 13 is locked in a closed state by engaging the hook member 620 for an inner frame with a hook reception member 350 of the outer frame 11. A hook part 625 of the hook member 620 for an inner frame is provided movably within a range including an engagement position and an engagement release position with/from the hook reception member 350, and the inner frame 13 has an opposite wall part 305 overlapping from the rotation tip side of the inner frame 13 with respect to an area where the hook part 625 passes through when moving from the engagement position to the engagement release position.

Description

本発明は、遊技機に関するものである。   The present invention relates to a gaming machine.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に固定されおいる支持察象䟋えば倖枠に察しお回動可胜に取り付けられた開閉䜓䟋えば遊技盀が搭茉されおなる遊技機本䜓を備えおいるものがある。メンテナンス等の際には開閉䜓を開攟するこずにより、同開閉䜓の背面偎等に蚭けられた各皮制埡装眮等ぞのアクセスが蚱容される構成ずなっおいるものが倚い。   Game machines such as pachinko machines have an opening / closing body (for example, a game board main body on which a game board is mounted) that is attached to a support target (for example, an outer frame) fixed to an island facility of the game hall. ). In many cases, the opening / closing body is opened during maintenance, thereby allowing access to various control devices and the like provided on the back side of the opening / closing body.

䞀般的にこのような開閉䜓を有する遊技機においおは、同開閉䜓を支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮を蚭けるこずにより、䞊蚘各皮制埡装眮等ぞの䞍正なアクセスが抑制されおいる䟋えば特蚱文献参照。斜錠装眮は、支持察象に蚭けられた鉀受け郚に察しお匕っ掛かる䜍眮ず匕っ掛からない䜍眮ずに移動可胜な鉀郚を有し、それら鉀郚ず鉀受け郚ずが匕っ掛かるこずにより開閉䜓が斜錠された状態ずなるずずもに、所定のキヌ操䜜等によっお鉀郚ず鉀受け郚ずの匕っ掛かりが解陀されるこずで開閉䜓の開攟が蚱容されるように構成されおいる。   In general, in gaming machines having such an opening / closing body, unauthorized access to the various control devices described above is provided by providing a locking device that locks the opening / closing body in a state where it is closed with respect to a support target. Is suppressed (for example, refer to Patent Document 1). The locking device has a hook part that can be moved to a position where it can be hooked with respect to the hook receiving part provided on the support target and a position where it is not caught, and the opening and closing body is locked by the hook part and hook receiving part being hooked. In addition, the opening and closing body is allowed to be opened by releasing the hook between the hook part and the hook receiving part by a predetermined key operation or the like.

特開−号公報JP 2004-024337 A

䞊述した斜錠装眮は開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配されるこずが倚く、そのように斜錠装眮の配眮を工倫するこずで、支持察象からの開閉䜓の浮き䞊がり等を奜適に抑制しおいる。しかしながら斜錠装眮を開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配する構成においおは、開閉䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制できる反面、以䞋の䞍郜合を生じやすくなるず想定される。すなわち、斜錠装眮が開閉䜓ず支持察象ずの隙間回動先端偎での隙間に近づけお配眮されるこずで、同隙間を通じた斜錠装眮ぞの䞍正アクセスが行われやすくなるず懞念される。より具䜓的には、䞊蚘隙間等から挿入した針金等の䞍正具を鉀郚に匕っ掛けお同鉀郚を移動させるこずにより開閉䜓の斜錠を解陀するずいった䞍正行為が行われやすくなるず懞念される。   In many cases, the locking device described above is arranged on the rotating distal end side of the opening / closing body, and by appropriately devising the arrangement of the locking device, lifting of the opening / closing body from the support target is suitably suppressed. However, in the configuration in which the locking device is arranged on the rotating distal end side of the opening / closing body, it is assumed that the floating of the opening / closing body can be preferably suppressed, but the following disadvantages are likely to occur. In other words, there is a concern that the locking device is arranged close to the gap between the opening / closing body and the support target (the gap at the rotation tip side), so that unauthorized access to the locking device through the gap is likely to be performed. More specifically, there is a concern that a fraudulent act such as unlocking the opening / closing body is likely to be performed by hooking a fraudulent tool such as a wire inserted from the gap or the like onto the collar and moving the collar.

なお、䞊蚘䞍郜合は、パチンコ機に限っお発生するものではなく、前面扉や本䜓枠などの開閉䜓を有する他のタむプの遊技機においおも同様に発生し埗る。   The inconvenience described above is not limited to pachinko machines, but may also occur in other types of gaming machines having opening / closing bodies such as a front door and a main body frame.

本発明は、䞊蚘䟋瀺した事情等に鑑みおなされたものであり、開閉䜓を支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮を備えた遊技機においお、斜錠が䞍正に解陀されるこずを抑制できる遊技機を提䟛するこずを目的ずするものである。   The present invention has been made in view of the above-described circumstances and the like, and in a gaming machine including a locking device that locks an opening / closing body in a closed state with respect to a support target, the locking is illegally released. It is an object to provide a gaming machine that can be suppressed.

本発明は、
支持察象によっお回動可胜に支持されおいる開閉䜓ず、
前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配されおいるずずもに、その開閉䜓に察しお同開閉䜓の前面偎から取り付けられ、圓該開閉䜓を前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘開閉䜓に圢成された貫通孔を通じお、遊技機埌方に突出し、同支持察象に蚭けられた鉀受け郚に匕っ掛かる匕っ掛かり䜍眮及び同鉀受け郚に匕っ掛からない匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮を含んだ範囲を移動可胜な鉀郚が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘開閉䜓には、前蚘貫通孔よりも前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配され、前蚘鉀郚が前蚘匕っ掛かり䜍眮から前蚘匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮に移動する堎合に通過する領域に察しお前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎から重なる壁郚が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘鉀受け郚には、前蚘開閉䜓が前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じられおいる堎合に、前蚘壁郚の少なくずも先端郚䜍が挿入される挿入郚が圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする。
The present invention
An opening / closing body rotatably supported by a support object;
The opening / closing body is disposed on the rotating front end side, and is attached to the opening / closing body from the front side of the opening / closing body, and locks the opening / closing body in an unopenable state in a closed state with respect to the support target. A locking device,
The locking device includes a hook position that protrudes to the rear of the gaming machine through a through-hole formed in the opening / closing body, and is hooked to a hook receiving portion provided in the support target, and a hook release position that is not hooked to the hook receiving portion. There is a buttocks that can move within the range,
The opening / closing body is disposed closer to the rotation tip side of the opening / closing body than the through hole, and the opening / closing body has a region that passes when the collar moves from the hook position to the hook release position. A wall that overlaps from the rotating tip side is provided,
The hook receiving portion is formed with an insertion portion into which at least a tip portion of the wall portion is inserted when the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the support target.

開閉䜓を支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮を備えた遊技機においお、斜錠が䞍正に解陀されるこずを抑制できる。   In the gaming machine provided with the locking device that locks the opening / closing body in a closed state with respect to the support target, it is possible to prevent the lock from being illegally released.

䞀実斜の圢態におけるパチンコ機を瀺す正面図である。It is a front view which shows the pachinko machine in one embodiment. パチンコ機の䞻芁な構成を展開しお瀺す斜芖図である。It is a perspective view which expands and shows the main structures of a pachinko machine. パチンコ機の䞻芁な構成を展開しお瀺す斜芖図である。It is a perspective view which expands and shows the main structures of a pachinko machine. パチンコ機の構成を瀺す背面図である。It is a rear view which shows the structure of a pachinko machine. 前扉枠の構成を瀺す背面図である。It is a rear view which shows the structure of a front door frame. 内枠の構成を瀺す正面図である。It is a front view which shows the structure of an inner frame. 遊技盀の構成を瀺す正面図である。It is a front view which shows the structure of a game board. 内枠の構成を瀺す背面図である。It is a rear view which shows the structure of an inner frame. 遊技盀の背面構成を瀺す斜芖図である。It is a perspective view which shows the back surface structure of a game board. 裏パックナニットの構成を瀺す正面図である。It is a front view which shows the structure of a back pack unit. 䞻芁な構成を分解しお瀺す内枠の正面斜芖図である。It is a front perspective view of the inner frame which decomposes | disassembles and shows main structures. 図の−線郚分断面図である。FIG. 7 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along line AA in FIG. 6. 図の−線郚分断面図である。FIG. 7 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along line B-B in FIG. 6. 遊技盀の着脱の流れを瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the flow of attachment or detachment of a game board. 遊技盀の着脱の流れを瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the flow of attachment or detachment of a game board. ロック装眮を内枠から取り倖した状態を瀺す分解斜芖図である。It is a disassembled perspective view which shows the state which removed the locking device from the inner frame. 図の―線郚分断面図である。It is CC sectional view taken on the line of FIG. 開攟された前扉枠ず遊技盀及び挿入郚ずの䜍眮関係を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the positional relationship of the open front door frame, the game board, and the insertion part. 〜は遊技盀の亀換の様子を抂略的に瀺す断面図であり、〜は遊技盀の亀換の様子を抂略的に瀺す正面斜芖図である。(A1)-(c1) is sectional drawing which shows the mode of replacement | exchange of a game board schematically, (a2)-(c2) is a front perspective view which shows the mode of replacement | exchange of a game board schematically. は遊技盀の亀換の様子を抂略的に瀺す断面図であり、は遊技盀の亀換の様子を抂略的に瀺す正面斜芖図である。(D1), (e1) is sectional drawing which shows the mode of replacement of a game board roughly, (d2), (e2) is a front perspective view which shows the mode of replacement of a game board roughly. 内枠からハンドルベヌスを取り倖した状態を瀺す分解斜芖図である。It is a disassembled perspective view which shows the state which removed the handle base from the inner frame. 斜錠装眮を内枠から取り倖した状態を瀺す斜芖図である。It is a perspective view which shows the state which removed the locking device from the inner frame. 斜錠装眮を埌方から芋た斜芖図である。It is the perspective view which looked at the locking device from back. 斜錠装眮を䞻芁構成郚品毎に分解しお瀺す分解斜芖図である。It is a disassembled perspective view which decomposes | disassembles and shows a locking device for every main component. 前扉枠の開閉途䞭状態を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the state in the middle of opening and closing of a front door frame. 䞡鉀郚材の䜍眮関係を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the positional relationship of both collar members. 操䜜キヌを時蚈回りに回動操䜜した状態を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the state which operated the operation key K clockwise. 操䜜キヌを反時蚈回りに回動操䜜した状態を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the state which operated the operation key K counterclockwise. 図の―線郚分断面図である。FIG. 5 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along line EE in FIG. 4. 倖枠の正面斜芖図である。It is a front perspective view of an outer frame. 図の―線郚分断面図である。FIG. 9 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along line FF in FIG. 8. カム郚材及びネゞず開口郚ずの関係を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the relationship between a cam member and a screw | thread, and an opening part. パチンコ機の電気的構成を瀺すブロック図である。It is a block diagram which shows the electric constitution of a pachinko machine. ロック装眮の倉圢䟋を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the modification of a locking device. 斜錠装眮の倉圢䟋を瀺す抂略図である。It is the schematic which shows the modification of a locking device.

以䞋、遊技機の䞀皮であるパチンコ遊技機以䞋、「パチンコ機」ずいうの䞀実斜の圢態を、図面に基づいお詳现に説明する。図はパチンコ機の正面図、図及び図はパチンコ機の䞻芁な構成を展開しお瀺す斜芖図、図はパチンコ機の背面図である。なお、図では䟿宜䞊パチンコ機の遊技領域内の構成を省略しおいる。   Hereinafter, an embodiment of a pachinko gaming machine (hereinafter referred to as “pachinko machine”), which is a type of gaming machine, will be described in detail with reference to the drawings. FIG. 1 is a front view of the pachinko machine 10, FIGS. 2 and 3 are perspective views showing the main configuration of the pachinko machine 10, and FIG. 4 is a rear view of the pachinko machine 10. FIG. In FIG. 2, the configuration in the game area of the pachinko machine 10 is omitted for convenience.

パチンコ機は、圓該パチンコ機の倖殻を圢成する倖枠ず、この倖枠に察しお前方に回動可胜に取り付けられた遊技機䞻郚ずを有する。倖枠は朚補の板材を四蟺に連結し構成されるものであっお矩圢枠状をなしおいる。パチンコ機は、倖枠を島蚭備に取り付け固定するこずにより、遊技ホヌルに蚭眮される。   The pachinko machine 10 includes an outer frame 11 that forms an outer shell of the pachinko machine 10, and a gaming machine main part 12 that is rotatably attached to the outer frame 11. The outer frame 11 is configured by connecting wooden plates to four sides and has a rectangular frame shape. The pachinko machine 10 is installed in the game hall by attaching and fixing the outer frame 11 to the island facility.

遊技機䞻郚は、ベヌス䜓ずしおの内枠ず、その内枠の前方に配眮される前扉枠ず、内枠の埌方に配眮される裏パックナニットずを備えおいる。遊技機䞻郚のうち内枠が倖枠に察しお回動可胜に支持されおいる。詳现には、パチンコ機の正面芖で巊偎を回動基端偎、右偎を回動先端偎ずしお内枠が前方ぞ回動可胜ずされおいる。   The gaming machine main part 12 includes an inner frame 13 as a base body, a front door frame 14 disposed in front of the inner frame 13, and a back pack unit 15 disposed behind the inner frame 13. . An inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12 is supported so as to be rotatable with respect to the outer frame 11. Specifically, the inner frame 13 can be rotated forward with the left side as the rotation base end side and the right side as the rotation front end side in the front view of the pachinko machine 10.

内枠には、図に瀺すように、前扉枠が回動可胜に支持されおおり、正面芖で巊偎を回動基端偎ずし右偎を回動先端偎ずしお前方ぞ回動可胜ずされおいる。たた、内枠には、図に瀺すように、裏パックナニットが回動可胜に支持されおおり、正面芖で巊偎を回動基端偎ずし右偎を回動先端偎ずしお埌方ぞ回動可胜ずされおいる。   As shown in FIG. 2, the front door frame 14 is rotatably supported on the inner frame 13, and can be rotated forward with the left side as a rotation base end side and the right side as a rotation front end side in a front view. It is said that. Further, as shown in FIG. 3, a backpack unit 15 is rotatably supported on the inner frame 13, and when viewed from the front, the left side is the rotation base end side and the right side is the rotation front end side. It is possible to move.

次に、前扉枠に぀いお説明する。なお、以䞋の説明では、図〜図を参照するずずもに、前扉枠の背面の構成に぀いおは図を参照する。図は、前扉枠の背面図である。   Next, the front door frame 14 will be described. In the following description, FIGS. 1 to 3 are referred to, and FIG. 5 is referred to for the configuration of the back surface of the front door frame 14. FIG. 5 is a rear view of the front door frame 14.

図に瀺すように前扉枠は内枠における前面偎のほが党域を芆うようにしお蚭けられおいる。前扉枠には埌述する遊技領域のほが党域を前方から芖認するこずができるようにした窓郚が圢成されおいる。窓郚は、略楕円圢状をなし、透明性を有するガラスが嵌め蟌たれおいる。   As shown in FIG. 2, the front door frame 14 is provided so as to cover almost the entire front side of the inner frame 13. A window portion 21 is formed on the front door frame 14 so that substantially the entire game area PE described later can be viewed from the front. The window portion 21 has a substantially oval shape and is fitted with a transparent glass 22.

より詳しくは、前扉枠は、窓郚を囲むようにしお蚭けられたガラスホルダを有しおいる。ガラスホルダは、前扉枠の背面から埌方に匵り出しおおり、窓郚の巊右の瞁郚に沿っお䞊䞋に延びる瞊ホルダ郚ずそれら䞡瞊ホルダ郚の䞋端郚を繋いで巊右に延びる暪ホルダ郚ずを有しおなる。各ホルダ郚〜には、前埌に䞊蚭された条の溝郚が圢成されおいる。瞊ホルダ郚の溝郚は䞊方及び互いに向き合う偎すなわち窓郚の䞭倮偎に開攟されおおり、暪ホルダ郚の溝郚は、䞊方に開攟されおいるずずもに、䞡瞊ホルダ郚の溝郚に察しお連なっおおり、それら各溝郚に察しおガラスが嵌たるこずで、遊技領域が内倖重に芆われた状態ずなっおいる。   More specifically, the front door frame 14 has a glass holder 27 provided so as to surround the window portion 21. The glass holder 27 protrudes rearward from the back surface of the front door frame 14, and extends vertically along the left and right edges of the window portion 21 and the lower end portions of both the vertical holder portions 27 a and 27 b. And a horizontal holder portion 27c extending left and right. Each holder part 27a-27c is formed with two groove parts arranged side by side. The groove portions of the vertical holder portions 27a and 27b are opened upward and on the sides facing each other (that is, the center side of the window portion 21), and the groove portions of the horizontal holder portion 27c are opened upward, and both the vertical holder portions 27a. 27b, and the glass region 22 is fitted into each of the groove portions, so that the game area PE is covered in two layers.

図に瀺すように窓郚の呚囲には、各皮ランプ等の発光手段が蚭けられおいる。䟋えば、窓郚の呚瞁に沿っお等の発光手段を内蔵した環状電食郚が蚭けられおいる。環状電食郚では、倧圓たり時や所定のリヌチ時等における遊技状態の倉化に応じお点灯や点滅が行われる。たた、環状電食郚の䞭倮であっおパチンコ機の最䞊郚には所定の゚ラヌ時に点灯する゚ラヌ衚瀺ランプ郚が蚭けられ、窓郚の巊右䞡偎には賞球払出䞭に点灯する賞球ランプ郚が蚭けられおいる。たた、䞭倮の゚ラヌ衚瀺ランプ郚に近接した䜍眮には、遊技状態に応じた効果音などが出力されるスピヌカ郚が蚭けられおいる。   As shown in FIG. 1, light emitting means such as various lamps are provided around the window portion 21. For example, an annular illumination part 23 incorporating a light emitting means such as an LED is provided along the periphery of the window part 21. In the annular illumination part 23, lighting or blinking is performed in accordance with a change in the gaming state at the time of a big hit or a predetermined reach. In addition, an error display lamp unit 24 is provided at the center of the annular illumination unit 23 and at the uppermost part of the pachinko machine 10 so as to be lit when a predetermined error occurs. A prize ball lamp unit 25 is provided. In addition, a speaker unit 26 is provided at a position close to the central error display lamp unit 24 to output a sound effect corresponding to the gaming state.

前扉枠における窓郚の䞋方には、手前偎ぞ膚出した䞊偎膚出郚ず䞋偎膚出郚ずが䞊䞋に䞊蚭されおいる。䞊偎膚出郚内偎には䞊方に開口した䞊皿が蚭けられおおり、䞋偎膚出郚内偎には同じく䞊方に開口した䞋皿が蚭けられおいる。䞊皿は、埌述する払出装眮より払い出された遊技球を䞀旊貯留し、䞀列に敎列させながら埌述する遊技球発射機構偎ぞ導くための機胜を有する。たた、䞋皿は、䞊皿内にお䜙剰ずなった遊技球を貯留する機胜を有する。   Below the window portion 21 in the front door frame 14, an upper bulging portion 31 and a lower bulging portion 32 that bulge to the near side are provided side by side. An upper pan 33 that opens upward is provided inside the upper bulging portion 31, and a lower pan 34 that also opens upward is provided inside the lower bulging portion 32. The upper plate 33 has a function of temporarily storing game balls paid out from a payout device described later and guiding them to the game ball launching mechanism described later while aligning them in a line. In addition, the lower tray 34 has a function of storing game balls that become surplus in the upper tray 33.

䞋偎膚出郚の右方には、手前偎ぞ突出するようにしお遊技球発射ハンドルが蚭けられおいる。遊技球発射ハンドルが操䜜されるこずにより、埌述する遊技球発射機構から遊技球が発射される。   A game ball launching handle 40 is provided on the right side of the lower bulging portion 32 so as to protrude toward the front side. By operating the game ball launch handle 40, a game ball is launched from a game ball launch mechanism described later.

前扉枠の背面には、図及び図に瀺すように、通路圢成ナニットが取り付けられおいる。通路圢成ナニットは、合成暹脂により成圢されおおり、䞊皿に通じる前扉偎䞊皿通路ず、䞋皿に通じる前扉偎䞋皿通路ずが圢成されおなる。通路圢成ナニットにおいお、その䞊偎隅郚には埌方に突出し䞊方に開攟された受口郚が圢成されおおり、圓該受口郚を仕切壁によっお巊右に仕切るこずで前扉偎䞊皿通路ず前扉偎䞋皿通路の入口郚分ずが圢成されおいる。前扉偎䞊皿通路及び前扉偎䞋皿通路は䞊流偎が埌述する遊技球分配郚に通じおおり、前扉偎䞊皿通路に入った遊技球は䞊皿に導かれ、前扉偎䞋皿通路に入った遊技球は䞋皿に導かれる。   As shown in FIGS. 2 and 5, a passage forming unit 50 is attached to the back surface of the front door frame 14. The passage forming unit 50 is formed of a synthetic resin, and includes a front door side upper tray passage 51 that leads to the upper tray 33 and a front door side lower tray passage 52 that leads to the lower tray 34. In the passage forming unit 50, a receiving portion 53 that protrudes rearward and opens upward is formed at an upper corner portion thereof, and the receiving portion 53 is divided into left and right portions by a partition wall 54, whereby the front door side upper plate is formed. A passage 51 and an entrance portion of the front door side lower dish passage 52 are formed. The upstream side of the front door side upper dish passage 51 and the front door side lower dish path 52 are connected to a game ball distributing section described later, and the game balls that have entered the front door side upper dish path 51 are guided to the upper plate 33, The game balls that have entered the door-side lower dish passage 52 are guided to the lower dish 34.

前扉枠の背面における回動基端偎図の右偎には、その䞊端郚及び䞋端郚に突起軞が蚭けられおいる。これら突起軞は内枠に察する組付機構を構成する。たた、前扉枠の背面における回動先端偎図の巊偎には、図に瀺すように、埌方に延びる鉀受け郚材が䞊䞋方向に耇数䞊蚭されおいる。これら鉀受け郚材は内枠に察する斜錠機構を構成する。なお、斜錠機構に関しおの詳现な説明は埌述する。   Protrusion shafts 61 and 62 are provided on the upper and lower ends of the rotation base end side (the right side in FIG. 5) on the back surface of the front door frame 14. These projecting shafts 61 and 62 constitute an assembly mechanism for the inner frame 13. Further, as shown in FIG. 2, a plurality of hook receiving members 63 extending rearward are arranged in parallel in the up-down direction side (left side in FIG. 5) on the back surface of the front door frame 14. These hook receiving members 63 constitute a locking mechanism for the inner frame 13. A detailed description of the locking mechanism will be described later.

次に、内枠に぀いお詳现に説明する。図は内枠の正面図である。なお、図においおは、図ず同様にパチンコ機の遊技領域内の構成を省略しおいる。   Next, the inner frame 13 will be described in detail. FIG. 6 is a front view of the inner frame 13. In FIG. 6, the configuration in the game area of the pachinko machine 10 is omitted as in FIG.

内枠は、倖圢が倖枠ずほが同䞀圢状をなす暹脂ベヌスを䞻䜓に構成されおいる。暹脂ベヌスの前面における回動基端偎図の巊偎には、その䞊端郚及び䞋端郚に支持金具が取り付けられおいる。図瀺は省略するが、支持金具には軞孔が圢成されおおり、それら軞孔に前扉枠の突起軞が挿入されるこずにより、内枠に察しお前扉枠が回動可胜に支持されおいる。   The inner frame 13 is mainly composed of a resin base 70 whose outer shape is substantially the same as that of the outer frame 11. Support metal fittings 71 and 72 are attached to the upper end portion and the lower end portion of the rotation base end side (left side in FIG. 6) on the front surface of the resin base 70. Although illustration is omitted, shaft holes are formed in the support fittings 71 and 72, and the projection shafts 61 and 62 of the front door frame 14 are inserted into these shaft holes, so that the front door with respect to the inner frame 13. The frame 14 is rotatably supported.

暹脂ベヌス前面の略䞭倮郚分には、遊技盀を収容する遊技盀収容郚が圢成されおいる。遊技盀収容郚は、暹脂ベヌスの背面偎埌方に凹み、遊技盀を収容する収容空間を区画しおおり、暹脂ベヌスに取り付けられた遊技盀がその収容空間に嵌たった状態ずなっおいる。本実斜の圢態においおは特に、遊技盀が暹脂ベヌスに察しお着脱可胜に取り付けられおおり、メンテナンス䜜業等の容易化が図られおいる。   A game board accommodating portion 75 for accommodating the game board 80 is formed at a substantially central portion of the front surface of the resin base 70. The game board accommodating portion 75 is recessed on the back side (rear) of the resin base 70 to define an accommodation space for accommodating the game board 80, and the game board 80 attached to the resin base 70 is fitted in the accommodation space. It is in the state. Particularly in the present embodiment, the game board 80 is detachably attached to the resin base 70, thereby facilitating maintenance work and the like.

遊技盀は、朚補の合板ず同合板における前偎の板面を芆うシヌト材ずを有しおなり、その前面が遊技盀収容郚の開攟郚分を通じお暹脂ベヌスの正面偎に露出しおいる。この露出しおいる郚䜍、すなわち遊技盀の前面には、遊技球が流䞋する遊技領域が圢成されおいる。以䞋、図に基づき遊技盀特に遊技領域に配された各皮構成に぀いお説明する。図は、遊技盀の正面図である。   The game board 80 includes a wooden plywood and a sheet material that covers a front plate surface of the plywood, and the front surface of the game board 80 is exposed to the front side of the resin base 70 through an open portion of the game board housing portion 75. . In the exposed portion, that is, the front surface of the game board 80, a game area PE in which game balls flow down is formed. Hereinafter, the game board 80 (particularly, various configurations arranged in the game area PE) will be described with reference to FIG. FIG. 7 is a front view of the game board 80.

遊技盀には、ルヌタ加工が斜されるこずによっお自身の厚さ方向前埌方向に貫通する倧小耇数の開口が圢成されおいる。各開口には、䞀般入賞口、可倉入賞装眮、䜜動口、スルヌゲヌト及び可倉衚瀺ナニット等がそれぞれ蚭けられおいる。䞀般入賞口、可倉入賞装眮及び䜜動口に遊技球が入るず、それら遊技球が埌述する怜知スむッチにより怜知され、その怜知結果に基づいお所定数の賞球の払い出しが実行される。その他に、遊技盀の最䞋郚にはアりト口が蚭けられおおり、各皮入賞口等に入らなかった遊技球はアりト口を通っお遊技領域から排出される。   The game board 80 is formed with a plurality of large and small openings penetrating in its own thickness direction (front-rear direction) by performing router processing. Each opening is provided with a general winning port 81, a variable winning device 82, operating ports 83a and 83b, a through gate 84, a variable display unit 85, and the like. When game balls enter the general winning port 81, the variable winning device 82, and the operation ports 83a and 83b, the game balls are detected by a detection switch described later, and a predetermined number of award balls are paid out based on the detection result. The In addition, an out port 86 is provided at the lowermost part of the game board 80, and game balls that have not entered various winning ports etc. are discharged from the game area PE through the out port 86.

たた、遊技盀には、遊技球の流䞋経路を適宜分散調敎等するために倚数の釘が怍蚭されおいるずずもに、颚車等の各皮郚材圹物が配蚭されおいる。これら釘や颚車等の各皮構成によっお、遊技球の流䞋経路が分化され、䞊述した䞀般入賞口等ぞの入賞が適床な確立で発生するように調敎されおいる。   In addition, in the game board 80, a number of nails 87 are implanted in order to disperse and adjust the flow path of the game ball as appropriate, and various members (functions) such as a windmill are arranged. The flow path of the game ball is differentiated by various configurations such as the nails 87 and the windmills, and adjusted so that the winning to the above-described general winning opening 81 and the like occurs with an appropriate establishment.

可倉入賞装眮は、通垞は遊技球が入賞できない又は入賞し難い閉状態になっおおり、倧圓たりの際に遊技球が入賞しやすい所定の開攟状態に切り換えられるようになっおいる。可倉入賞装眮の開攟態様ずしおは、所定時間䟋えば秒間の経過又は所定個数䟋えば個の入賞をラりンドずしお、同可倉入賞装眮の開攟が耇数ラりンド䟋えばラりンドを䞊限ずしお繰り返されるように蚭定されおいる。   The variable winning device 82 is normally in a closed state in which a game ball cannot be won or difficult to win, and is switched to a predetermined open state in which a game ball is easy to win in the case of a big hit. As a release mode of the variable winning device 82, a predetermined time (for example, 30 seconds) or a predetermined number (for example, 10) of winnings is regarded as one round, and the variable winning device 82 is opened by a plurality of rounds (for example, 15 rounds). It is set to be repeated as the upper limit.

可倉衚瀺ナニットは遊技盀の䞭倮䞊寄りに配眮されおおり、その䞋方に䜜動口が配眮されおいる。より詳しくは、䜜動口は、䜜動口を䞊偎、䜜動口を䞋偎ずしお䞊䞋に䞊蚭されおいる。可倉衚瀺ナニット及び䜜動口は、遊技性を叞る郚䜍であり遊技者の泚意が集たりやすい。それら可倉衚瀺ナニット及び䜜動口を遊技機䞭倮においお䞊䞋に䞊べお配眮するこずで䞡者間での芖線の移動量を抑え、遊技者の目に生じる負担の䜎枛に貢献しおいる。   The variable display unit 85 is disposed at the upper center of the game board 80, and the operation ports 83a and 83b are disposed below the variable display unit 85. More specifically, the operation ports 83a and 83b are arranged side by side with the operation port 83a on the upper side and the operation port 83b on the lower side. The variable display unit 85 and the operation ports 83a and 83b are portions that control game play, and the player's attention is likely to be gathered. By arranging the variable display unit 85 and the operation ports 83a and 83b side by side in the center of the gaming machine, the movement amount of the line of sight between the two is suppressed, which contributes to the reduction of the burden on the player's eyes.

可倉衚瀺ナニットは、䜜動口ぞの入賞をトリガずしお図柄を可倉衚瀺する図柄衚瀺装眮を備えおいる。図柄衚瀺装眮は、液晶ディスプレむ衚瀺画面を備えた液晶衚瀺装眮ずしお構成されおおり、埌述する衚瀺制埡装眮によりその衚瀺内容が制埡されおいる。具䜓的には、衚瀺画面においおは、䞊段䞭段及び䞋段に䞊べお図柄が衚瀺され、これらの図柄が巊右方向にスクロヌルされるようにしお倉動衚瀺される。そしお、倧圓たり発生時には、予め蚭定されおいる有効ラむン䞊に所定の組合せの図柄が停止衚瀺され、特別遊技状態ぞず移行される。なお、衚瀺画面における衚瀺態様を以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、巊䞭及び右に䞊べお図柄を衚瀺し、それら図柄を䞊䞋スクロヌルさせるようにしお倉動衚瀺させおもよい。   The variable display unit 85 includes a symbol display device 94 that variably displays symbols with a winning in the operation ports 83a and 83b as a trigger. The symbol display device 94 is configured as a liquid crystal display device including a liquid crystal display (display screen 94a), and the display content is controlled by a display control device described later. Specifically, on the display screen 94a, symbols are displayed side by side in the upper, middle, and lower levels, and these symbols are variably displayed as they are scrolled in the horizontal direction. When a big hit occurs, a predetermined combination of symbols is stopped and displayed on a preset active line, and a transition is made to a special gaming state. The display mode on the display screen 94a may be changed as follows. That is, the symbols may be displayed side by side on the left, middle, and right, and the symbols may be displayed in a variable manner by scrolling up and down.

たた、可倉衚瀺ナニットは、図柄衚瀺装眮を囲むようにしお圢成されたセンタヌフレヌムを備えおいる。センタヌフレヌムの䞊郚には、第特定ランプ郚及び第特定ランプ郚が蚭けられおいる。たた、センタヌフレヌムの䞊郚及び䞋郚にはそれぞれ保留ランプ郚が蚭けられおいる。䞋偎の保留ランプ郚は、図柄衚瀺装眮及び第特定ランプ郚に察応しおおり、遊技球が䜜動口を通過した回数は最倧回たで保留され保留ランプ郚の点灯によっおその保留個数が衚瀺されるようになっおいる。䞊偎の保留ランプ郚は、第特定ランプ郚に察応しおおり、遊技球がスルヌゲヌトを通過した回数は最倧回たで保留され保留ランプ郚の点灯によっおその保留個数が衚瀺されるようになっおいる。   The variable display unit 85 includes a center frame 95 formed so as to surround the symbol display device 94. A first specific lamp unit 96 and a second specific lamp unit 97 are provided on the center frame 95. Reservation lamp portions 98 and 99 are provided at the upper and lower portions of the center frame 95, respectively. The lower holding lamp unit 98 corresponds to the symbol display device 94 and the first specific lamp unit 96, and the number of times that the game ball has passed through the operation port 83 is held up to four times, and the holding lamp unit 98 is turned on. The number of reserved items is displayed. The upper holding lamp unit 99 corresponds to the second specific lamp unit 97, and the number of times that the game ball has passed through the through gate 84 is held up to four times, and the number of holdings is displayed by lighting the holding lamp unit 99. It has become so.

再び図を甚いお説明すれば、暹脂ベヌスにおける遊技盀収容郚の䞋方には、遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜に基づいお遊技領域ぞ遊技球を発射する遊技球発射機構が蚭けられおいる。より詳しくは、暹脂ベヌスにおいお遊技盀収容郚の䞋方には遊技球発射機構を蚭眮する発射機構蚭眮郚が圢成されおいる。この発射機構蚭眮郚に蚭眮された遊技球発射機構は、内枠の回動先端寄りに䜍眮しおいる。遊技球発射機構は、所定の発射埅機䜍眮に配眮された遊技球を打ち出す゜レノむドず、同゜レノむドによっお打ち出された遊技球の発射方向を芏定する発射レヌルず、䞊蚘発射埅機䜍眮に遊技球を䟛絊する球送り機構ず、それら各皮構成〜が装着されおいるベヌスプレヌトずを䞻芁な構成ずしお備えおおり、同ベヌスプレヌトが暹脂ベヌスに察しおネゞ止めされるこずで内枠に察しお䞀䜓化されおいる。   Referring again to FIG. 6, a game ball launching mechanism 110 that launches a game ball to the game area PE based on the operation of the game ball launch handle 40 is provided below the game board housing portion 75 in the resin base 70. It has been. More specifically, in the resin base 70, a launching mechanism installation portion 79 for installing the game ball launching mechanism 110 is formed below the game board housing portion 75. The game ball launching mechanism 110 installed in the launching mechanism installation unit 79 is located near the rotational tip of the inner frame 13. The game ball launching mechanism 110 includes a solenoid 111 that launches a game ball placed at a predetermined launch standby position, a launch rail 112 that defines the launch direction of the game ball launched by the solenoid 111, and a game at the launch standby position. A ball feeding mechanism 113 for supplying a sphere and a base plate 114 on which the various configurations 111 to 113 are mounted are provided as main components, and the base plate 114 is screwed to the resin base 70 to be internally It is integrated with the frame 13.

遊技球発射機構詳しくは゜レノむドは、埌述する電源・発射制埡装眮に察しお電気的に接続されおいる。その電源・発射制埡装眮からの電気的な信号の出力に基づいお゜レノむドの出力軞が䌞瞮方向、すなわち発射レヌルのレヌル方向に移動し、発射埅機䜍眮に眮かれた遊技球が遊技領域、詳しくは遊技盀に装着された誘導レヌルに向けお打ち出される。   The game ball launching mechanism 110 (specifically, the solenoid 111) is electrically connected to a power source / launch control device to be described later. The output shaft of the solenoid 111 moves in the expansion / contraction direction, that is, the rail direction of the launch rail 112 based on the output of the electrical signal from the power source / launch control device, and the game ball placed in the launch standby position is played in the game area PE. Specifically, it is launched toward the guide rail 100 mounted on the game board 80.

誘導レヌルは、埌述する遊技領域区画郚材ず共に遊技領域を同遊技領域の倖圢が略円圢状ずなるように区画しおいる。たた、誘導レヌルは、遊技球の盎埄よりも若干倧きな隙間を隔おお察峙するように配眮された内レヌル及び倖レヌルからなり、それら䞡レヌルによっお挟たれた領域によっお遊技球の誘導通路が圢成されおいる。誘導通路は、発射レヌルの先端偎内枠の回動先端偎に開攟された入口郚分ず、遊技領域の䞊郚に䜍眮する出口郚分ずを有しおいる。゜レノむドの動䜜に基づいお発射された遊技球は、発射レヌル→誘導レヌル入口郚分→出口郚分の順に移動するこずにより遊技領域に導かれる。なお、遊技盀においお出口郚分の先偎、詳しくは内レヌルの先端付近には、遊技領域に到達した遊技球の同誘導通路内ぞの逆戻りを防止する逆戻り防止郚材が取り付けられおおり、先んじお遊技領域に至った遊技球によっお埌続する遊技球の打ち出しが劚げられるこずを抑制しおいる。   The guide rail 100 partitions the game area PE together with a game area partition member 480 described later so that the outer shape of the game area PE is substantially circular. In addition, the guide rail 100 includes an inner rail 101 and an outer rail 102 that are arranged so as to face each other with a gap slightly larger than the diameter of the game ball, and the game ball is defined by a region sandwiched between the two rails 101 and 102. The guide passage 103 is formed. The guide passage 103 has an inlet portion 104 that is open to the distal end side of the firing rail 112 (the rotational distal end side of the inner frame 13), and an outlet portion 105 that is located above the game area PE. The game ball fired based on the operation of the solenoid 111 is guided to the game area PE by moving in the order of the firing rail 112 → the guide rail 100 (the entrance portion 104 → the exit portion 105). In the game board 80, a reversal prevention member 106 for preventing the reversal of the game ball reaching the game area PE into the guide passage 103 is attached to the front side of the exit portion 105, specifically near the tip of the inner rail 101. Thus, it is possible to prevent the subsequent launch of the game ball from being hindered by the game ball that has reached the game area PE first.

誘導レヌルを構成しおいる各レヌルは、遊技領域の略䞭倮郚分を䞭心ずする円匧状をなしおいる。このため、誘導通路を通過する遊技球は、自身に発生する遠心力により倖レヌルに沿っお、すなわち倖レヌルに接觊したたた移動摺動又は転動しやすくなっおいる。   Each of the rails 101 and 102 constituting the guide rail 100 has an arc shape centered at a substantially central portion of the game area PE. For this reason, the game ball passing through the guide passage 103 is likely to move (slide or roll) along the outer rail 102, that is, in contact with the outer rail 102 due to the centrifugal force generated by itself.

誘導レヌルは、遊技球発射ハンドルが遊技球を遊技領域に到達させるこずができる皋床に操䜜された堎合に、すなわち遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜量が第の芏定量を超えた堎合に、発射レヌルから打ち出された遊技球が圓該誘導レヌルの入口郚分、詳しくは倖レヌルにおいお発射レヌルの延長䞊に䜍眮する特定郚䜍に着地するように圢成されおいる。   The guide rail 100 is operated when the game ball launch handle 40 is operated to such an extent that the game ball can reach the game area PE, that is, when the operation amount of the game ball launch handle 40 exceeds the first specified amount. In addition, the game ball launched from the launch rail 112 is formed so as to land on the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100, specifically the specific portion SP located on the extension of the launch rail 112 in the outer rail 102.

倖レヌルは、その特定郚䜍における接線の向きが発射レヌルのレヌル方向ず略同䞀ずなるように圢成されおいる。発射された遊技球の移動方向ず、特定郚䜍の接線方向を揃えるこずにより、遊技球の着地によっお生じる衝撃を䜎枛するずずもに同遊技球の跳ね返りを抑え、誘導レヌルによるそれら遊技球の円滑な誘導を可胜ずしおいる。   The outer rail 102 is formed so that the direction of the tangent TL at the specific portion SP is substantially the same as the rail direction of the firing rail 112. By aligning the direction of movement of the launched game balls and the direction of the tangent TL of the specific part SP, the impact caused by the landing of the game balls is reduced and the rebound of the game balls is suppressed. Is possible.

なお、倖レヌルは、圓該倖レヌルを遊技盀に察しお固定する固定手段ずしお耇数の固定ピンを備えおいる。固定ピンは倖レヌルに沿っお配蚭されおおり、それら固定ピンの間に䞊蚘特定郚䜍が蚭定されおいる。これにより、特定郚䜍での倖レヌルの若干の撓み倉圢匟性倉圢を蚱容し、同特定郚䜍に遊技球が着地した際の衝撃を䜎枛するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   The outer rail 102 includes a plurality of fixing pins 102 a as fixing means for fixing the outer rail 102 to the game board 80. The fixed pin 102a is disposed along the outer rail 102, and the specific portion SP is set between the fixed pins 102a. As a result, it is possible to allow slight deformation (elastic deformation) of the outer rail 102 at the specific part SP, and to reduce the impact when the game ball lands on the specific part SP.

図に瀺すように、誘導レヌル及び発射レヌルは、同誘導レヌルの入口郚分ず発射レヌルの先端郚分ずが遊技盀の䞋端瞁を挟んで斜めに察峙するように配眮されおいる。぀たり、それら䞡レヌルは、同誘導レヌルの入口郚分詳しくは特定郚䜍ず発射レヌルの先端郚分ずが遊技盀の䞋端瞁近傍にお巊右にずれるようにしお配眮されおいる。これにより䞡レヌルを遊技盀の䞋端瞁に近づけ぀぀、誘導レヌルの入口郚分ず発射レヌルずの間には所定間隔の隙間を圢成しおいる。   As shown in FIG. 6, the guide rail 100 and the launch rail 112 are arranged such that the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 and the tip portion of the launch rail 112 face each other diagonally across the lower edge of the game board 80. ing. That is, both the rails 100 and 112 are arranged such that the entrance portion 104 (specifically, the specific portion SP) of the guide rail 100 and the tip portion of the firing rail 112 are shifted to the left and right in the vicinity of the lower end edge of the game board 80. Has been. Thus, a gap of a predetermined interval is formed between the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 and the firing rail 112 while bringing both rails 100 and 112 close to the lower end edge of the game board 80.

このようにしお圢成された隙間よりも䞋偎にはファヌル球通路が配蚭されおいる。ファヌル球通路は前扉枠の通路圢成ナニットに䞀䜓成圢されおいる。仮に遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球が遊技領域たで至らずファヌル球ずしお誘導通路内を逆戻りする堎合には、それらファヌル球が䞊蚘隙間を介しおファヌル球通路内に入るこずずなる。ファヌル球通路は前扉偎䞋皿通路に通じおおり、ファヌル球通路に入った遊技球は図に瀺した䞋皿に排出される。これにより、ファヌル球ず次に発射される遊技球ずの干枉が抑制される。   A foul ball passage 55 is disposed below the gap formed in this way. The foul ball passage 55 is integrally formed with the passage formation unit 50 of the front door frame 14. If the game balls launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 do not reach the game area PE and return as foul balls in the guide passage 103, the foul balls enter the foul ball passage 55 through the gap. It becomes. The foul ball passage 55 communicates with the front door side lower tray passage 52, and the game balls that have entered the foul ball passage 55 are discharged to the lower tray 34 shown in FIG. This suppresses interference between the foul ball and the next game ball to be launched.

暹脂ベヌスにおいお発射レヌルの巊方には、暹脂ベヌスを前埌方向に貫通させお通路圢成郚が蚭けられおいる。通路圢成郚には本䜓偎䞊皿通路ず本䜓偎䞋皿通路ずを有しおなり、それら本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路の䞊流偎は、埌述する遊技球分配郚に通じおいる。たた、通路圢成郚の䞋方には前扉枠に取り付けられた通路圢成ナニットの受口郚が入り蟌んでおり、本䜓偎䞊皿通路の䞋方には前扉偎䞊皿通路が配眮され、本䜓偎䞋皿通路の䞋方には前扉偎䞊皿通路が配眮されおいる図参照。   A passage forming portion 121 is provided on the left side of the firing rail 112 in the resin base 70 so as to penetrate the resin base 70 in the front-rear direction. The passage forming part 121 has a main body side upper dish path and a main body side lower dish path, and the upstream side of the main body side upper dish path and the main body side lower dish path leads to a game ball distributing part to be described later. Yes. A receiving portion 53 of a passage forming unit 50 attached to the front door frame 14 is inserted below the passage forming portion 121, and a front door side upper plate passage 51 is disposed below the main body side upper plate passage. A front door side upper dish path 51 is arranged below the main body side lower dish path (see FIG. 5).

暹脂ベヌスにおいお通路圢成郚の䞋方には、本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路からの遊技球の流出を芏制するシャッタが蚭けられおいる。シャッタは、䞡通路の出口郚分を狭め遊技球の流出を阻止する阻止䜍眮ず、遊技球の流出を蚱容する蚱容䜍眮ずの䞡䜍眮に切り替え可胜な状態で暹脂ベヌスによっお支持されおいる。たた、暹脂ベヌスにはシャッタを阻止䜍眮に向けお付勢する付勢郚材が取り付けられおおり、前扉枠を内枠に察しお開いた状態では付勢郚材の付勢力によっおシャッタ、が阻止䜍眮に留たる構成ずなっおいる。これにより、本䜓偎䞊皿通路又は本䜓偎䞋皿通路に遊技球が貯留されおいる状態で前扉枠を開攟した堎合に、その貯留球がこがれ萜ちおしたうずいった䞍郜合が回避されおいる。これに察し、前扉枠を閉じた状態では、前扉枠の通路圢成ナニットに蚭けられた受口郚により䞊蚘付勢力に抗しおシャッタが蚱容䜍眮に抌し戻される。この状態では、本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び前扉偎䞊皿通路ず、本䜓偎䞋皿通路及び前扉偎䞋皿通路ずがそれぞれ連通し、遊技球の移動が蚱容されるこずずなる。   In the resin base 70, a shutter 124 that restricts the outflow of game balls from the main body side upper dish path and the main body side lower dish path is provided below the passage forming portion 121. The shutters 124 and 125 are supported by the resin base 70 in a state where the shutters 124 and 125 can be switched between a blocking position where the outlet portions of both passages are narrowed to prevent the gaming ball from flowing out and an allowable position where the gaming ball is allowed to flow out. Yes. Further, a biasing member that biases the shutters 124 and 125 toward the blocking position is attached to the resin base 70. When the front door frame 14 is opened with respect to the inner frame 13, the biasing force of the biasing member is provided. Thus, the shutters 124 and 125 remain in the blocking position. Thereby, when the front door frame 14 is opened in a state where the game balls are stored in the main body side upper tray passage or the main body side lower tray passage, the disadvantage that the stored balls spill out is avoided. On the other hand, when the front door frame 14 is closed, the shutters 124 and 125 are pushed back to the permissible position against the urging force by the receiving portion 53 provided in the passage forming unit 50 of the front door frame 14. In this state, the main body side upper dish passage and the front door side upper dish path 51 communicate with the main body side lower dish path and the front door side lower dish path 52, respectively, and the movement of the game ball is allowed.

次に、図に基づき内枠暹脂ベヌス及び遊技盀の背面構成に぀いお説明する。図は内枠の背面図である。   Next, the back configuration of the inner frame 13 (the resin base 70 and the game board 80) will be described with reference to FIG. FIG. 8 is a rear view of the inner frame 13.

暹脂ベヌスの背面における回動基端偎図の右偎には、軞受け金具が取り付けられおいる。軞受け金具には、䞊䞋に離間させお軞受け郚が圢成されおおり、これら軞受け郚により内枠に察しお裏パックナニットが回動可胜に取り付けられおいる。たた、暹脂ベヌスの背面には、裏パックナニットを内枠に固定するための固定レバヌが耇数蚭けられおいる。   A bearing fitting 132 is attached to the rotation base end side (the right side in FIG. 8) on the back surface of the resin base 70. A bearing portion 133 is formed on the bearing bracket 132 so as to be separated from each other in the vertical direction, and the back pack unit 15 is rotatably attached to the inner frame 13 by these bearing portions 133. A plurality of fixing levers 134 for fixing the back pack unit 15 to the inner frame 13 are provided on the back surface of the resin base 70.

暹脂ベヌスにおける遊技盀収容郚の底郚分埌述する察向板郚には暹脂ベヌスの厚さ方向に貫通し同暹脂ベヌスの背面偎に開攟された䞭倮開口が圢成されおおり、その䞭倮開口が遊技盀収容郚に収容された遊技盀によっお内枠の正面偎から芆われおいる。遊技盀の背面には制埡装眮等の各皮構成が搭茉されおおり、それら各皮構成は䞭倮開口を通じお内枠の背偎に露出した状態ずなっおいる。ここで、図に基づき遊技盀の背面の構成に぀いお詳现に説明する。図は遊技盀を埌方から芋た斜芖図である。   A central opening 76 that penetrates in the thickness direction of the resin base 70 and opens to the back side of the resin base 70 is formed in the bottom portion (opposing plate portion 251 described later) of the game board housing portion 75 in the resin base 70. The central opening 76 is covered from the front side of the inner frame 13 by the game board 80 housed in the game board housing part 75. Various components such as a control device are mounted on the back of the game board 80, and these various components are exposed to the back side of the inner frame 13 through the central opening 76. Here, the configuration of the back surface of the game board 80 will be described in detail with reference to FIG. FIG. 9 is a perspective view of the game board 80 as viewed from the rear.

遊技盀の背面には、可倉衚瀺ナニットを遊技盀に察しお搭茉する合成暹脂補の台座郚材が固定されおいる。台座郚材は、遊技盀偎に開攟された略箱状をなしおおり遊技盀の背面のほが党域を芆っおいる。台座郚材の䞀郚は暹脂ベヌスの䞭倮開口を通じお同暹脂ベヌスの背面偎に突出しおおり、その突出した郚分に察しお䞊述した図柄衚瀺装眮ず、その図柄衚瀺装眮を駆動するための衚瀺制埡装眮ずが取り付けられおいる。これら図柄衚瀺装眮及び衚瀺制埡装眮は前埌方向暹脂ベヌスの厚さ方向に図柄衚瀺装眮が前偎䞔぀衚瀺制埡装眮が埌偎ずなるように重ねお配眮されおいる。さらに、遊技盀には、衚瀺制埡装眮の埌方に䜍眮するようにしお音声ランプ制埡装眮ナニットが搭茉されおいる。音声ランプ制埡装眮ナニットは、音声ランプ制埡装眮ず、取付台ずを具備する構成ずなっおおり、取付台䞊に音声ランプ制埡装眮が装着されおいる。   On the back of the game board 80, a base member 141 made of synthetic resin for mounting the variable display unit 85 on the game board 80 is fixed. The pedestal member 141 has a substantially box shape opened to the game board 80 side, and covers almost the entire rear surface of the game board 80. A part of the base member 141 protrudes to the back side of the resin base 70 through the central opening 76 of the resin base 70, and the symbol display device 94 described above and the symbol display device 94 are driven with respect to the protruding portion. And a display control device for mounting. The symbol display device 94 and the display control device are arranged so that the symbol display device is on the front side and the display control device is on the rear side in the front-rear direction (thickness direction of the resin base 70). Furthermore, the game board 80 is equipped with an audio lamp control device unit 142 so as to be positioned behind the display control device. The sound lamp control device unit 142 includes a sound lamp control device 143 and a mounting table 144, and the sound lamp control device 143 is mounted on the mounting table 144.

音声ランプ制埡装眮は、埌述する䞻制埡装眮からの指瀺に埓い音声やランプ衚瀺、及び衚瀺制埡装眮の制埡を叞る音声ランプ制埡基板を具備しおおり、音声ランプ制埡基板が透明暹脂材料等よりなる基板ボックスに収容されお構成されおいる。   The sound lamp control device 143 includes a sound lamp control board that controls sound, lamp display, and display control device in accordance with instructions from a main control device to be described later, and the sound lamp control board is made of a transparent resin material or the like. It is configured to be accommodated in a substrate box 145.

音声ランプ制埡装眮ナニットの䞋方には、台座郚材を埌方から芆うようにしお䞻制埡装眮ナニットが蚭けられおいる。䞻制埡装眮ナニットは、遊技盀の背面に固定された合成暹脂補の取付台ず、その取付台に搭茉された䞻制埡装眮ずを有しおいる。䞻制埡装眮は、遊技の䞻たる制埡を叞る機胜䞻制埡回路ず、電源を監芖する機胜停電監芖回路ずを有する䞻制埡基板を具備しおおり、圓該䞻制埡基板が透明暹脂材料等よりなる基板ボックスに収容されお構成されおいる。   A main controller unit 160 is provided below the sound lamp controller unit 142 so as to cover the base member 141 from behind. The main controller unit 160 includes a synthetic resin mounting base 161 fixed to the back of the game board 80 and a main control unit 162 mounted on the mounting base 161. The main controller 162 includes a main control board having a function (main control circuit) that controls the main control of the game and a function (power failure monitoring circuit) that monitors the power source, and the main control board is made of a transparent resin material. It is configured to be accommodated in a substrate box 163 made of, for example.

基板ボックスは、略盎方䜓圢状のボックスベヌス衚ケヌス䜓ずこのボックスベヌスの開口郚を芆うボックスカバヌ裏ケヌス䜓ずを備えおいる。これらボックスベヌスずボックスカバヌずは封印手段ずしおのボックス封印郚によっお開封䞍胜に連結され、これにより基板ボックスが封印されおいる。ボックス封印郚は、基板ボックスの短蟺郚に耇数蚭けられ、そのうち少なくずも぀が甚いられお封印凊理が行われる。   The board box 163 includes a substantially rectangular parallelepiped box base (front case body) and a box cover (back case body) that covers an opening of the box base. The box base and the box cover are connected so as not to be unsealed by a box sealing portion 164 as sealing means, whereby the substrate box 163 is sealed. A plurality of box sealing portions 164 are provided on the short side portion of the substrate box 163, and at least one of them is used for sealing processing.

ボックス封印郚はボックスベヌスずボックスカバヌずを開封䞍胜に結合する構成であれば任意の構成が適甚できるが、ボックス封印郚を構成する係止孔郚に係止ピンを挿入するこずでボックスベヌスずボックスカバヌずが開封䞍胜に結合されるようになっおいる。ボックス封印郚による封印凊理は、その封印埌の䞍正な開封を防止し、たた䞇䞀䞍正開封が行われおもそのような事態を早期に䞔぀容易に発芋可胜ずするものであっお、䞀旊開封した埌でも再床封印凊理を行うこず自䜓は可胜である。すなわち、耇数のボックス封印郚のうち、少なくずも぀の係止孔郚に係止ピンを挿入するこずにより封印凊理が行われる。そしお、収容した䞻制埡基板の䞍具合発生の際や䞻制埡基板の怜査の際など基板ボックスを開封する堎合には、係止ピンが挿入されたボックス封印郚ず基板ボックス本䜓ずの連結郚分を切断する。これにより、基板ボックスのボックスベヌスずボックスカバヌずが分離され、内郚の䞻制埡基板を取り出すこずができる。その埌、再床封印凊理する堎合は他の係止孔郚に係止ピンを挿入する。基板ボックスの開封を行った旚の履歎を圓該基板ボックスに残しおおけば、基板ボックスを芋るこずで䞍正な開封が行われた旚が容易に発芋できる。   Any configuration can be applied to the box sealing portion 164 as long as the box base and the box cover are coupled so as not to be opened. However, by inserting a locking pin into the locking hole that forms the box sealing portion 164, the box sealing portion 164 can be applied. The base and the box cover are coupled so as not to be opened. The sealing process by the box sealing unit 164 prevents unauthorized opening after the sealing, and makes it possible to detect such a situation early and easily even if the unauthorized opening is performed. Even after opening, the sealing process can be performed again. That is, the sealing process is performed by inserting a locking pin into at least one locking hole portion among the plurality of box sealing portions 164. When the substrate box 163 is opened, such as when a failure occurs in the accommodated main control board or when the main control board is inspected, a connecting portion between the box sealing portion into which the locking pin is inserted and the substrate box 163 main body. Disconnect. As a result, the box base and the box cover of the substrate box 163 are separated, and the internal main control substrate can be taken out. Thereafter, when the sealing process is performed again, a locking pin is inserted into another locking hole. If the history of opening the substrate box 163 is left in the substrate box 163, it can be easily found that the unauthorized opening has been performed by looking at the substrate box 163.

基板ボックスず取付台ずは台座封印郚によっお開封䞍胜に連結されおいる。詳しくは、台座封印郚は、ボックス封印郚ず同様に係止孔郚及び係止ピンを有しおおり、係止孔郚に察しお係止ピンが挿入されるこずで基板ボックスず取付台ずが分離䞍胜に結合されるようになっおいる。これにより、基板ボックスの䞍正な取り倖しが行われた堎合に、その事実を把握しやすくなっおいる。   The board box 163 and the mounting base 161 are connected by a base seal part 165 so that they cannot be opened. Specifically, the pedestal sealing portion 165 has a locking hole portion and a locking pin similarly to the box sealing portion 164, and the locking pin is inserted into the locking hole portion so that the board box 163 and The mounting base 161 is coupled so as not to be separable. This makes it easier to grasp the fact that the substrate box 163 has been illegally removed.

台座郚材においお遊技盀の背面ず察向しおいる郚分には、前蚘䞀般入賞口可倉入賞装眮䞊䜜動口䞋䜜動口の遊技盀開口郚に察応し䞔぀䞋流偎でカ所に集合する回収通路が圢成されおいる。これにより、䞀般入賞口等に入賞した遊技球は䜕れも回収通路を介しお遊技盀の䞋方に集合する構成ずなっおいる。぀たり、台座郚材には各皮入賞口に入賞した遊技球を回収する機胜が付䞎されおいる。   The portion of the pedestal member 141 that faces the back of the game board 80 corresponds to the game board openings of the general winning port 81, variable winning device 82, upper operating port 83a, and lower operating port 83b, and on the downstream side. A collection passage that collects in one place is formed. Thereby, all the game balls won in the general winning opening 81 and the like are gathered below the game board 80 through the collection passage. That is, the pedestal member 141 is provided with a function of collecting game balls won in various winning openings.

遊技盀の䞋方には埌述する排出通路が配されおおり、回収通路によっお遊技盀の䞋方に集合した遊技球は排出通路内に導出される。なお、アりト口に぀いおも同様に排出通路に通じおおり、䜕れの入賞口にも入賞しなかった遊技球はアりト口を介しお排出通路内に導出される。   A discharge passage, which will be described later, is arranged below the game board 80, and the game balls gathered below the game board 80 by the collection passage are led out into the discharge passage. Similarly, the out port 86 leads to the discharge passage, and the game balls that have not won any winning port are led out into the discharge passage through the out port 86.

たた、䞊蚘回収通路には、遊技盀衚偎の䞀般入賞口に入賞した遊技球を怜知する入賞口スむッチず、可倉入賞装眮に入賞した遊技球を怜知するカりントスむッチず、䜜動口に入った遊技球を怜知する䜜動口スむッチずが装着されおおり、それら各皮スむッチによっお入賞怜知機構が構成されおいる。曎に、台座郚材においお可倉衚瀺ナニットの巊右䞡偎には、スルヌゲヌトを通過する遊技球を怜知するゲヌトスむッチが蚭けられおいる。これら各皮スむッチは䞻制埡装眮に察しお電気的に接続されおおり、各スむッチによる怜知情報が同䞻制埡装眮に出力される構成ずなっおいる。   Further, in the collection passage, a winning port switch for detecting a game ball won in the general winning port 81 on the front side of the game board 80, a count switch for detecting a game ball won in the variable winning device 82, and an operation port 83a, An operating port switch for detecting a game ball entering 83b is mounted, and a winning detection mechanism is constituted by these various switches. Furthermore, gate switches for detecting game balls passing through the through gate 84 are provided on the left and right sides of the variable display unit 85 in the base member 141. These various switches are electrically connected to the main control device 162, and the detection information by each switch is output to the main control device 162.

次に、図及び図に基づき裏パックナニットに぀いお説明する。図は裏パックナニットの正面図である。   Next, the back pack unit 15 will be described with reference to FIGS. FIG. 10 is a front view of the back pack unit 15.

図に瀺すように、裏パックナニットは、裏パックを備えおおり、圓該裏パックに察しお、払出機構郚、排出通路盀図参照、及び制埡装眮集合ナニットが取り付けられおいる。裏パックは透明性を有する合成暹脂により成圢されおおり、払出機構郚などが取り付けられるベヌス郚ず、パチンコ機埌方に突出し略盎方䜓圢状をなす保護カバヌ郚ずを有する。保護カバヌ郚は巊右偎面及び䞊面が閉鎖され䞔぀䞋面のみが開攟された圢状をなし、少なくずも可倉衚瀺ナニットを囲むのに十分な倧きさを有する。   As shown in FIG. 10, the back pack unit 15 includes a back pack 201, and with respect to the back pack 201, a payout mechanism unit 202, a discharge passage board 203 (see FIG. 3), and a control device assembly unit 204. Is attached. The back pack 201 is formed of a synthetic resin having transparency, and includes a base portion 211 to which the payout mechanism portion 202 and the like are attached, and a protective cover portion 212 that protrudes rearward from the pachinko machine 10 and has a substantially rectangular parallelepiped shape. The protective cover portion 212 has a shape in which left and right side surfaces and an upper surface are closed and only a lower surface is opened, and has a size sufficient to surround at least the variable display unit 85.

ベヌス郚には、その右䞊郚に倖郚端子板図瀺略が蚭けられおいる。倖郚端子板には各皮の出力端子が蚭けられおおり、これらの出力端子を通じお遊技ホヌル偎の管理制埡装眮に察しお各皮信号が出力される。たた、ベヌス郚にはパチンコ機埌方からみお右端郚に䞊䞋䞀察の掛止ピンが蚭けられおおり、掛止ピンを内枠に蚭けられた前蚘軞受け郚に挿通させるこずで、裏パックナニットが内枠に察しお回動可胜に支持されおいる。ベヌス郚には、内枠に蚭けられた固定レバヌが挿通される耇数の挿通郚が圢成されおおり、固定レバヌが挿通郚に挿通された状態におベヌス郚に埌方から圓接するこずにより内枠に察しお裏パックナニットが固定されおいる。   The base part 211 is provided with an external terminal board (not shown) at the upper right part thereof. Various output terminals are provided on the external terminal plate, and various signals are output to the management control device on the game hall side through these output terminals. Further, the base portion 211 is provided with a pair of upper and lower latch pins 214 at the right end when viewed from the rear of the pachinko machine 10, and the latch pins 214 are inserted through the bearing portions 133 provided on the inner frame 13. The back pack unit 15 is supported so as to be rotatable with respect to the inner frame 13. The base portion 211 is formed with a plurality of insertion portions 215 through which the fixing levers 134 provided in the inner frame 13 are inserted, and the base portion 211 is rearward of the base portion 211 in a state where the fixing levers 134 are inserted through the insertion portions 215. The back pack unit 15 is fixed to the inner frame 13 by contact with the inner frame 13.

ベヌス郚には、保護カバヌ郚を迂回するようにしお払出機構郚が配蚭されおいる。すなわち、裏パックの最䞊郚には䞊方に開口したタンクが蚭けられおおり、タンクには遊技ホヌルの島蚭備から䟛絊される遊技球が逐次補絊される。タンクの䞋方には、䞋流偎に向けお緩やかに傟斜するタンクレヌルが連結され、タンクレヌルの䞋流偎には䞊䞋方向に延びるケヌスレヌルが連結されおいる。ケヌスレヌルの最䞋流郚には払出装眮が蚭けられおいる。払出装眮より払い出された遊技球は、圓該払出装眮の䞋流偎に蚭けられた図瀺しない払出通路を通じお、裏パックのベヌス郚に蚭けられた遊技球分配郚に䟛絊される。   In the base portion 211, a payout mechanism portion 202 is disposed so as to bypass the protective cover portion 212. That is, a tank 221 opened upward is provided at the uppermost portion of the back pack 201, and the game balls supplied from the island facilities of the game hall are sequentially replenished to the tank 221. A tank rail 222 that is gently inclined toward the downstream side is connected to the lower side of the tank 221, and a case rail 223 that extends in the vertical direction is connected to the downstream side of the tank rail 222. A payout device 224 is provided at the most downstream portion of the case rail 223. The game balls paid out from the payout device 224 are supplied to the game ball distribution unit 225 provided in the base portion 211 of the back pack 201 through a payout passage (not shown) provided on the downstream side of the payout device 224.

遊技球分配郚は、払出装眮より払い出された遊技球を䞊皿、䞋皿又は埌述する排出通路の䜕れかに振り分けるための機胜を有し、内偎の開口郚が䞊述した本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び前扉偎䞊皿通路を介しお䞊皿に通じ、倖偎の開口郚が本䜓偎䞋皿通路及び前扉偎䞋皿通路を介しお䞋皿に通じるように圢成されおいる。   The game ball distribution unit 225 has a function of distributing the game balls paid out from the payout device 224 to any one of the upper plate 33, the lower plate 34, and a discharge passage described later, and the inner opening 226 has been described above. It communicates with the upper plate 33 through the main body side upper plate passage and the front door side upper plate passage 51, and the outer opening 227 communicates with the lower plate 34 through the main body side lower plate passage and the front door side lower plate passage 52. Is formed.

図及び図を䜵甚しお説明すればベヌス郚の䞋端郚には、圓該䞋端郚を前埌に挟むようにしお排出通路盀及び制埡装眮集合ナニットが取り付けられおいる。排出通路盀には、制埡装眮集合ナニットず察向する面に埌方に開攟された排出通路が圢成されおおり、圓該排出通路の開攟郚は制埡装眮集合ナニットによっお塞がれおいる。排出通路は、遊技ホヌルの島蚭備等ぞ遊技球を排出するように圢成されおおり、䞊述した回収通路等から排出通路に導出された遊技球は圓該排出通路を通るこずでパチンコ機倖郚に排出される。   3 and 10, the discharge passage board 203 and the control device collective unit 204 are attached to the lower end portion of the base portion 211 so as to sandwich the lower end portion in the front-rear direction. The discharge passage board 203 is formed with a discharge passage 231 opened rearward on the surface facing the control device assembly unit 204, and the open portion of the discharge passage 231 is blocked by the control device assembly unit 204. . The discharge passage 231 is formed so as to discharge game balls to an island facility or the like of the game hall, and the game balls led out to the discharge passage 231 from the above-described recovery passages and the like pass through the discharge passage 231 so that the pachinko machine 10 discharged outside.

図に瀺すように、制埡装眮集合ナニットは、暪長圢状をなす取付台を有し、取付台に払出制埡装眮ず電源・発射制埡装眮ずが搭茉されおいる。これら払出制埡装眮ず電源・発射制埡装眮ずは、払出制埡装眮がパチンコ機埌方ずなるように前埌に重ねお配眮されおいる。   As shown in FIG. 10, the control device assembly unit 204 has a horizontally long mounting base 241, and a payout control device 242 and a power supply / launch control device 243 are mounted on the mounting base 241. The payout control device 242 and the power supply / launch control device 243 are arranged so as to overlap each other so that the payout control device 242 is behind the pachinko machine 10.

払出制埡装眮においおは基板ボックス内に払出装眮を制埡する払出制埡基板が収容されおおり、圓該払出制埡基板に蚭けられた状態埩垰スむッチが基板ボックス倖に突出しおいる。䟋えば、払出装眮における球詰たり等、払出゚ラヌの発生時においお状態埩垰スむッチが抌されるず、球詰たりの解消が図られるようになっおいる。   In the payout control device 242, a payout control board for controlling the payout device 224 is accommodated in the board box 244, and a state return switch 245 provided on the payout control board projects out of the board box 244. For example, when the state return switch 245 is pressed when a payout error occurs, such as a ball jam in the payout device 224, the ball jam is eliminated.

電源・発射制埡装眮は、基板ボックス内に電源・発射制埡基板が収容されおおり、圓該基板により、各皮制埡装眮等で芁する所定の電源が生成されお出力され、さらに遊技者による遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜に䌎う遊技球の打ち出しの制埡が行われる。たた、電源・発射制埡装眮には消去スむッチが蚭けられおいる。本パチンコ機は各皮デヌタの蚘憶保持機胜を有しおおり、䞇䞀停電が発生した際でも停電時の状態を保持し、停電からの埩垰の際には停電時の状態に埩垰できるようになっおいる。したがっお、䟋えば遊技ホヌルの営業終了の堎合のように通垞手順で電源を遮断するず遮断前の状態が蚘憶保持されるが、消去スむッチを抌しながら電源を投入するず、デヌタが初期化されるようになっおいる。   The power source / launch control device 243 includes a power source / launch control board housed in the board box 246, and a predetermined power source required for various control devices and the like is generated and output by the board. Control of the launch of the game ball accompanying the operation of the firing handle 40 is performed. Further, the power supply / launch control device 243 is provided with a RAM erase switch 247. This pachinko machine 10 has a function to store and store various data so that even if a power failure occurs, it maintains the state at the time of the power failure, and when it recovers from the power failure, it can be restored to the state at the time of the power failure. It has become. Therefore, for example, when the power supply is turned off in the normal procedure, as in the case of the game hall being closed, the state before the interruption is stored and held, but when the power is turned on while the RAM erase switch 247 is held down, the RAM data is initialized. It is like that.

遊技盀の取付構造
本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技盀の取付構造具䜓的には同遊技盀の䜍眮決め構造決め及び固定構造に関しお特城的な構成を備えおいる。以䞋、図に加え図図を甚いお遊技盀の取付構造に぀いお詳しく説明する。図は䞻芁な構成を分解しお瀺す内枠の正面斜芖図、図は図の−線郚分断面図である。
(Mounting structure of game board 80)
In the present embodiment, a characteristic structure is provided regarding the mounting structure of the game board 80 (specifically, the positioning structure determination and fixing structure of the game board 80). Hereinafter, the mounting structure of the game board 80 will be described in detail with reference to FIGS. 11 and 12 in addition to FIG. FIG. 11 is a front perspective view of the inner frame 13 showing an exploded main structure, and FIG. 12 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along line AA of FIG.

既に説明したように、遊技盀は、内枠の遊技盀収容郚に察しお同内枠の正面偎から嵌たっおいる図参照。図に瀺すように、遊技盀収容郚は、遊技盀の背面に察向する平板状の察向板郚ず、同察向板郚から起立し遊技盀の呚瞁に沿っお延びる呚壁郚ずによっお構成されおいる。察向板郚は、その略䞭倮に䞊述した䞭倮開口が圢成されおおり、内枠の正面芖においお略矩枠状をなしおいる。呚壁郚は、遊技盀における䞊䞋巊右の各端面に察しお個々に察向する䞊偎壁郚䞋偎壁郚巊偎壁郚右偎壁郚が連なっおなり、党䜓ずしお遊技盀を囲む環状をなしおいる。なお、呚壁郚は䞭倮開口を囲むようにしお圢成されおいるずも蚀える。   As already described, the game board 80 is fitted to the game board housing portion 75 of the inner frame 13 from the front side of the inner frame 13 (see FIG. 6). As shown in FIG. 11, the game board housing part 75 includes a flat counter plate part 251 that faces the back of the game board 80, and a peripheral wall part that stands up from the counter plate part 251 and extends along the periphery of the game board 80. 261. The counter plate portion 251 is formed with the above-described central opening 76 at substantially the center thereof, and has a substantially rectangular frame shape when the inner frame 13 is viewed from the front. The peripheral wall portion 261 is composed of an upper side wall portion 262, a lower side wall portion 263, a left side wall portion 264, and a right side wall portion 265 that are individually opposed to the upper, lower, left and right end surfaces of the gaming board 80, and the gaming board 80 as a whole. It has a ring shape surrounding it. It can be said that the peripheral wall portion 261 is formed so as to surround the central opening 76.

察向板郚においお前扉枠の回動基端偎ずなる郚䜍、詳しくは巊偎壁郚の根元呚蟺には、遊技盀を察向板郚から離れる偎内枠の正面偎に向けお付勢する付勢郚材ずしおの板バネが同遊技盀の瞁郚に添っお䞊䞋に䞊蚭されおいる。板バネは、遊技盀の䞊端寄り及び䞋端寄りにそれぞれ配眮されおおり、遊技盀に察する付勢力が同遊技盀の䞊端偎及び䞋端偎にお同等ずなるように蚭定されおいる。これにより、䞊蚘付勢力が遊技盀の䞊端及び䞋端のいずれか䞀方に偏よっお䜜甚し、遊技盀が傟きやすくなるこず抑制しおいる。   The part of the counter plate 251 that is the rotation base end side of the front door frame 14, specifically, the vicinity of the base of the left wall 264, is the side away from the counter plate 251 (the front side of the inner frame 13). A leaf spring 270 as an urging member for urging the game board is arranged in parallel vertically along the edge of the game board 80. The leaf springs 270 are arranged near the upper end and the lower end of the game board 80, respectively, and are set so that the urging force against the game board 80 is equal on the upper end side and the lower end side of the game board 80. Thus, the biasing force acts on one of the upper end and the lower end of the game board 80 in a biased manner, thereby suppressing the game board 80 from being easily tilted.

図に瀺すように、板バネは、察向板郚に察する取付郚ずしおのベヌス板郚ず、遊技盀の背面を抌す抌圧郚ずを有し、それら䞡者が折曲郚を介しお連なるように長板状の鋌板を折り返しお圢成されおいる。抌圧郚が折曲郚を基端ずしお撓み倉圢するこずにより、䞊述した付勢力が発揮される。   As shown in FIG. 12, the leaf spring 270 has a base plate portion 271 as an attachment portion with respect to the opposing plate portion 251 and a pressing portion 272 that pushes the back surface of the game board 80, and both of them have a bent portion 273. The long plate-shaped steel plates are folded back so as to be continuous with each other. When the pressing portion 272 is bent and deformed with the bent portion 273 as the base end, the urging force described above is exhibited.

察向板郚の前面には、内枠の背面偎に凹む板バネ蚭眮郚が圢成されおいる。板バネは、ベヌス板郚が板バネ蚭眮郚に嵌たった状態にお同板バネ蚭眮郚にネゞ止めされるこずで内枠に察しお固定されおいる。板バネ蚭眮郚の深さ寞法は、ベヌス板郚の板厚寞法よりも倧きく蚭定されおおり、ベヌス板郚ず折曲郚ずが圓該板バネ蚭眮郚内に埋没しおいる。抌圧郚は、遊技盀偎に凞ずなる湟曲状をなし、その頂郚遊技盀に圓接する郚䜍が板バネ蚭眮郚から遊技盀偎に突出した状態ずなっおいる。このように頂郚を突出させおおくこずにより抌圧機胜が確保されおいる。   A plate spring installation portion 252 that is recessed toward the back side of the inner frame 13 is formed on the front surface of the counter plate portion 251. The leaf spring 270 is fixed to the inner frame 13 by being screwed to the leaf spring installation portion 252 with the base plate portion 271 fitted in the leaf spring installation portion 252. The depth dimension of the plate spring installation part 252 is set to be larger than the plate thickness dimension of the base plate part 271, and the base plate part 271 and the bent part 273 are buried in the plate spring installation part 252. . The pressing portion 272 has a curved shape that protrudes toward the game board 80, and a top portion 272 a (a portion that contacts the game board 80) protrudes from the leaf spring installation portion 252 toward the game board 80. Thus, the pressing function is ensured by protruding the top portion 272a.

なお、抌圧郚の先端郚分は、自由端ずなっおおり、遊技盀を付勢しおいない自然状態においおは同自由端が板バネ蚭眮郚から突出する構成を採甚しおいるが、これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、板バネを、抌圧郚の自由端が板バネ蚭眮郚内に垞時没するように構成しおもよい。これにより、遊技盀を着脱する際の同遊技盀ず板バネの自由端ずの匕っ掛かりを抑制できる。   In addition, although the front-end | tip part of the press part 272 becomes a free end and the structure which the same free end protrudes from the leaf | plate spring installation part 252 is employ | adopted in the natural state which is not energizing the game board 80, You may change this as follows. That is, the leaf spring 270 may be configured such that the free end of the pressing portion 272 is always immersed in the leaf spring installation portion 252. As a result, the game board 80 and the free end of the leaf spring 270 can be prevented from being caught when the game board 80 is attached and detached.

たた、板バネは、折曲郚が巊偎壁郚ず察峙するように、すなわち抌圧郚の自由端よりも固定端のほうが巊偎壁郚に察しお近くなるように配眮されおいる。このように配眮された状態では、ベヌス板郚が、少なくずも巊偎壁郚の根元郚分に近い䜍眮にお板バネ蚭眮郚の底面に圓接しおいる。遊技盀の付勢に䌎っお同遊技盀から受ける反力が抌圧郚→折曲郚→ベヌス板郚を介しお察向板郚に䌝播した堎合に、察向板郚に巊偎壁郚の根元を基端ずする撓み倉圢が生じるこずを抑制しおいる。぀たり、遊技盀からの反力を呚壁郚の根元付近で受けるこずで察向板郚の撓み倉圢を抑え、板バネの付勢機胜を発揮させやすくしおいる。   The leaf spring 270 is disposed so that the bent portion 273 faces the left wall portion 264, that is, the fixed end is closer to the left wall portion 264 than the free end of the pressing portion 272. . In such a state, the base plate portion 271 is in contact with the bottom surface of the leaf spring installation portion 252 at least at a position close to the root portion of the left side wall portion 264. When the reaction force received from the gaming board 80 with the urging of the gaming board 80 propagates to the opposing plate part 251 via the pressing part 272 → the bent part 273 → the base plate part 271, the left side of the opposing board part 251 Occurrence of bending deformation with the base of the wall 264 as the base end is suppressed. That is, by receiving the reaction force from the game board 80 near the base of the peripheral wall portion 261, the deformation of the opposing plate portion 251 is suppressed, and the urging function of the plate spring 270 is easily exhibited.

内枠には、板バネによる付勢方向の先偎から遊技盀の前面に察しお圓接するこずで同遊技盀の同付勢方向ぞの倉䜍を抑えるストッパが蚭けられおいる。ストッパは、呚壁郚の巊偎壁郚に䞀䜓成圢されおおり、同巊偎壁郚の内壁面から遊技盀収容郚内に匵り出しおいる。   The inner frame 13 is provided with a stopper 267 that suppresses the displacement of the game board 80 in the biasing direction by contacting the front surface of the game board 80 from the front side in the biasing direction of the leaf spring 270. . The stopper 267 is integrally formed with the left wall portion 264 of the peripheral wall portion 261, and projects from the inner wall surface of the left wall portion 264 into the game board housing portion 75.

ストッパず察向板郚ずの間隔寞法は、遊技盀の厚み寞法よりも若干倧きく、具䜓的にはそれら䞡寞法の差が板バネ蚭眮郚からの板バネ詳しくは頂郚の突出量よりも小さくなる皋床に蚭定されおいる。このため、板バネに抌されストッパによっお前埌䜍眮が芏定された遊技盀は、察向板郚に察しお僅かに浮いた状態ずなる。すなわち、遊技盀ず察向板郚ずの間に隙間が圢成される。これは、蚱容できる遊技盀の厚さ寞法の範囲を拡匵するための工倫である。   The distance between the stopper 267 and the opposing plate 251 is slightly larger than the thickness of the game board 80. Specifically, the difference between the two is the leaf spring 270 from the leaf spring installation portion 252 (specifically, the top portion 272a). Is set to be smaller than the amount of protrusion. For this reason, the game board 80 which is pushed by the leaf spring 270 and whose front and rear positions are defined by the stopper 267 is slightly lifted with respect to the opposing plate portion 251. That is, a gap is formed between the game board 80 and the opposing plate portion 251. This is a device for extending the range of the allowable thickness dimension of the game board 80.

ストッパは、内枠の正面芖においお板バネを挟んだ䞊䞋䞡偎に぀ず぀配眮されおいる。より詳しくは、䞀察のストッパの略䞭倮に板バネが配眮されおいる。ストッパ及び板バネの䜍眮を䞊述の劂く芏定するこずで、板バネによっお抌された遊技盀に察しお䞡ストッパのうち䞀方を支点ずした䞊䞋方向ぞの回転モヌメントが生じるこずを抑制しおいる。これにより、板バネにより遊技盀を付勢する構成においお同遊技盀における䞊䞋䞡端の䜍眮ずれを抑え、圓該遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を高めやすくしおいる。たた、䞀察のストッパず板バネずによっお遊技盀の䜍眮決め機胜が発揮される点に着目すれば、それら䞀察のストッパ及び板バネによっお遊技盀の䜍眮決め機構が構成され、同䜍眮決め機構が遊技盀の䞀蟺に沿っお耇数配眮されるこずで、䜍眮決め機胜の向䞊が図られおいるずも蚀える。   Two stoppers 267 are arranged on both upper and lower sides of the leaf spring 270 in front view of the inner frame 13. More specifically, a leaf spring 270 is disposed at the approximate center of the pair of stoppers 267. By defining the positions of the stopper 267 and the leaf spring 270 as described above, a rotational moment in the vertical direction with one of the stoppers 267 as a fulcrum is generated with respect to the game board 80 pushed by the leaf spring 270. Suppressed. Accordingly, in the configuration in which the game board 80 is biased by the plate spring 270, the positional deviation between the upper and lower ends of the game board 80 is suppressed, and the position accuracy of the game board 80 is easily improved. If attention is paid to the fact that the positioning function of the game board 80 is exhibited by the pair of stoppers 267 and the leaf springs 270, the positioning mechanism of the game board 80 is constituted by the pair of stoppers 267 and the leaf springs 270. It can be said that the positioning function is improved by arranging a plurality of mechanisms along one side of the game board 80.

䜍眮決め機構詳しくはストッパの配眮に関しお補足すれば、これら䜍眮決め機構は䞊蚘誘導レヌルにおいお遊技盀の回動基端偎に凞ずなっおいる郚分の䞊方及び䞋方に配眮されおいる。これにより、遊技盀の前面に察しお圓接するストッパず、遊技盀の前面にお遊技領域を区画する誘導レヌルずを遊技盀の前面偎にお奜適に共存させるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   If it supplements regarding arrangement | positioning of the positioning mechanism (specifically stopper 267), these positioning mechanisms are arrange | positioned in the said guide rail 100 above and below the part which protrudes in the rotation base end side of the game board 80. FIG. Accordingly, the stopper 267 that comes into contact with the front surface of the game board 80 and the guide rail 100 that partitions the game area PE on the front surface of the game board 80 can preferably coexist on the front side of the game board 80. It has become.

再び図を参照しお説明すれば、内枠には、巊偎壁郚の先端瞁に沿っお長尺状のプレヌト郚材が配蚭されおいる。プレヌト郚材は、内枠の䞊偎枠郚及び䞋偎枠郚の䞡枠郚に跚っお延びおおり、同プレヌト郚材の䞡端郚分が巊偎枠郚に察しお固定ネゞ止めされおいるずずもに、同プレヌト郚材の䞭間郚分が䞊述したストッパに察しお固定ネゞ止めされおいる。これにより、内枠においお倖枠や前扉枠に連結されおいる郚分を補匷し、曎には䞊述した付勢力等によるストッパの倉圢を抑制しおいる。   Referring to FIG. 11 again, the inner frame 13 is provided with a long plate member 268 along the leading edge of the left side wall portion 264. The plate member 268 extends over both the upper frame portion 13a and the lower frame portion 13b of the inner frame 13, and both end portions of the plate member 268 are fixed (screwed) to the left frame portion 13c. In addition, an intermediate portion of the plate member 268 is fixed (screwed) to the stopper 267 described above. Thereby, the part connected to the outer frame 11 and the front door frame 14 in the inner frame 13 is reinforced, and further, the deformation of the stopper 267 due to the urging force described above is suppressed.

以䞊詳述した板バネず同板バネの䞊䞋に配された䞀察のストッパずによっお、遊技盀の䞀偎郚を挿入可胜な挿入郚が構築されおいる図参照。挿入郚は、前扉枠の回動基端偎に配されおいるずずもに、内枠の回動先端偎からの遊技盀の挿入を蚱容すべく同内枠の回動先端偎に開攟されおいる。   An insertion portion 280 into which one side portion of the game board 80 can be inserted is constructed by the plate spring 270 described in detail above and the pair of stoppers 267 arranged above and below the plate spring 270 (see FIG. 12). The insertion portion 280 is arranged on the rotation base end side of the front door frame 14 and the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13 to allow insertion of the game board 80 from the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13. It is open to.

特に、板バネは、抌圧郚の頂郚、すなわち遊技盀に察しお圓接する郚䜍がストッパよりも前扉枠が支持されおいる偎から離れるように配されおいる。぀たり、抌圧郚の頂郚ずストッパずの距離寞法は、抌圧郚の頂郚ずストッパずの前埌方向での間隔寞法よりも倧きく蚭定されおいる。これにより、遊技盀を挿入郚に察しお内枠の斜め前方から挿入可胜ずしおいる。たた、既に説明したように、ストッパず察向板郚ずの隙間寞法は、遊技盀の厚さ寞法よりも倧きく蚭定されおいる。これにより、䞊述の劂く斜め前方から挿入された遊技盀を、同挿入郚を基端ずしお回動可胜ずしおいる。なお、ストッパの先端郚においお遊技盀ず察向しおいる郚䜍には面取りが斜されおおり、挿入郚の入口郚分が拡匵されおいる。これにより、䞊蚘距離寞法を倧きくし、遊技盀挿入時のストッパず遊技盀ずの぀かえが抑制されおいる。なお、図においおは、板バネの自然状態非圧瞮状態を点鎖線で瀺しおいる。   In particular, the leaf spring 270 is arranged such that the top portion 272a of the pressing portion 272, that is, the portion that comes into contact with the game board 80 is separated from the side on which the front door frame 14 is supported rather than the stopper 267. That is, the distance dimension D1 between the top part 272a of the pressing part 272 and the stopper 267 is set larger than the distance dimension D2 between the top part 272a of the pressing part 272 and the stopper 267 in the front-rear direction. Thereby, the game board 80 can be inserted into the insertion portion 280 from an oblique front of the inner frame 13. Further, as already described, the gap dimension between the stopper 267 and the opposing plate portion 251 is set to be larger than the thickness dimension of the game board 80. As a result, the game board 80 inserted obliquely from the front as described above can be rotated with the insertion portion 280 as the base end. The portion of the stopper 267 that faces the game board 80 is chamfered at the tip, and the entrance of the insertion portion 280 is expanded. Thus, the distance dimension D1 is increased, and the holding of the stopper 267 and the game board 80 when the game board is inserted is suppressed. In FIG. 12, the natural state (non-compressed state) of the leaf spring 270 is indicated by a two-dot chain line.

再び図を甚いお説明すれば、挿入郚ストッパ矀の䞋方、詳しくは内枠においお巊偎壁郚ず䞋偎壁郚ずが亀わる䜍眮には、挿入郚に挿入された遊技盀を仮眮き可胜な仮眮き郚が蚭けられおいる。仮眮き郚は、内枠においお前扉枠を支持しおいる郚分詳しくは䞋偎枠郚から䞊方に隆起しおおり、内枠における䞋偎枠郚ず同内枠における巊偎枠郚ずの䞡者に繋がっおいる。   Referring again to FIG. 11, the insertion portion 280 is inserted into the insertion portion 280 below the insertion portion 280 (the stopper 267 group), specifically, at the position where the left side wall portion 264 and the lower side wall portion 263 intersect in the inner frame 13. A temporary placement unit 290 capable of temporarily placing the game board 80 is provided. The temporary placement portion 290 protrudes upward from a portion of the inner frame 13 that supports the front door frame 14 (specifically, the lower frame portion 13b), and the inner frame is the same as the lower frame portion 13b of the inner frame 13. 13 to the left side frame 13c.

仮眮き郚の䞊端郚分は、遊技盀収容郚の䞋偎壁郚よりも䞊偎に䜍眮しおいるずずもに、遊技盀の䞋端郚に察しお察向する平面状をなしおいる。䞀方、遊技盀における回動基端偎の䞋隅郚にはこの仮眮き郚に察応した䞋偎切欠き郚が圢成されおいる図参照。遊技盀を挿入郚に挿入し回動開始する初期段階では、この仮眮き郚に察しお遊技盀の䞋偎切欠き郚が仮眮き䞀時的に茉眮されるこずで同遊技盀の重量の少なくずも䞀郚が䞡枠郚によっお支えられるこずずなる。これにより、䜜業負担を枛らし、遊技盀の回動操䜜の容易化を図っおいる。   The upper end portion of the temporary placement portion 290 is positioned above the lower side wall portion 263 of the game board housing portion 75 and has a planar shape facing the lower end portion of the game board 80. On the other hand, a lower notch 88 corresponding to the temporary placement portion 290 is formed in the lower corner portion of the rotation base end side of the game board 80 (see FIG. 6). At the initial stage of inserting the game board 80 into the insertion part 280 and starting to rotate, the lower notch 88 of the game board 80 is temporarily placed (temporarily placed) on the temporary placement part 290. At least a part of the weight of the game board 80 is supported by both the frame portions 13b and 13c. This reduces the work load and facilitates the turning operation of the game board 80.

図に瀺すように遊技盀が装着完了䜍眮に配眮されおいる状態では、遊技盀の䞋端郚が䞋偎壁郚の䞊面に茉り、䞊述した仮眮き郚ず䞋偎切欠き郚ずの間には僅かな隙間が生じおいる。遊技盀は、䞋偎壁郚䞊に茉るこずずで、同䞋偎壁郚によっお支えられ、その䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されるこずずなる。このように、茉眮された遊技盀を䞋偎から支える点に着目すれば、䞋偎壁郚を「茉眮郚」又は「支持郚」ず称するこずも可胜である。   As shown in FIG. 6, in the state where the game board 80 is arranged at the mounting completion position, the lower end portion of the game board 80 rests on the upper surface of the lower side wall part 263, and the temporary placement part 290 and the lower notch part 88 described above. There is a slight gap between them. The game board 80 is supported by the lower side wall part 263 by being placed on the lower side wall part 263, and the vertical position thereof is defined. In this way, if attention is paid to the point that the placed game board 80 is supported from the lower side, the lower side wall portion 263 can also be referred to as a “placement portion 263” or a “support portion 263”.

䞋偎壁郚の前端郚分には、遊技盀装着時に同遊技盀を䞋偎壁郚の䞊面に案内する案内郚が圢成されおいる図参照。案内郚は、遊技盀回動時に圓該遊技盀の䞋端瞁が圓接し埗る䜍眮に配され、内枠の正面偎に向けお䞋り傟斜しおいる。遊技盀を仮眮き郚に茉せた状態から装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させるず、その途䞭段階にお遊技盀の䞋端郚が案内郚に圓り、同遊技盀が案内郚の傟斜に沿っお抌し䞊げられる。これにより䞋偎切欠き郚が仮眮き郚から離間するずずもに遊技盀の䞋端郚が䞋偎壁郚䞊に茉った状態ずなり、遊技盀の重量負荷が仮眮き郚から䞋偎壁郚に移るこずずなる。   A guide portion 269 that guides the game board 80 to the upper surface of the lower wall portion 263 when the game board is mounted is formed at the front end portion of the lower wall portion 263 (see FIG. 11). The guide portion 269 is disposed at a position where the lower edge of the game board 80 can abut when the game board is rotated, and is inclined downward toward the front side of the inner frame 13. When the game board 80 is rotated from the state placed on the temporary placement part 290 toward the mounting completion position, the lower end part of the game board 80 hits the guide part 269 in the middle of the game board 80, and the game board 80 becomes the guide part 269. Pushed up along the slope. As a result, the lower notch 88 is separated from the temporary placement portion 290 and the lower end portion of the game board 80 is placed on the lower wall portion 263, and the weight load of the game board 80 is reduced from the temporary placement portion 290 to the lower wall portion. 263.

䞋偎壁郚は、遊技球発射機構ず遊技盀ずの間に䜍眮しおおり、遊技球発射機構に近い䜍眮にお遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定される。既に説明したように、誘導レヌルの入口郚分ず遊技球発射機構ずの䞡者は䞋偎壁郚に添っお配されおいる。これにより、遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球の誘導レヌルにおける着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑えやすくなっおいる。   The lower wall portion 263 is located between the game ball launching mechanism 110 and the game board 80, and the vertical position of the game board 80 is defined at a position close to the game ball launching mechanism 110. As already described, both the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 and the game ball launching mechanism 110 are arranged along the lower wall portion 263. This makes it easy to suppress variations in the landing position of the game balls launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 on the guide rail 100.

図に瀺すように、察向板郚においお䞋偎壁郚の䞊方には、遊技盀の巊右䜍眮を芏定する䜍眮決め突起が蚭けられおいる。䜍眮決め突起は、䞋偎壁郚の付け根郚分の近傍に配され、察向板郚の前面から遊技盀偎に起立しおいる。この䜍眮決め突起が、遊技盀に圢成された貫通孔図参照に挿通されるこずで、遊技盀の巊右方向ぞの移動が阻止される。   As shown in FIG. 11, positioning protrusions 259 that define the left and right positions of the game board 80 are provided above the lower side wall portion 263 in the opposing plate portion 251. The positioning protrusion 259 is disposed in the vicinity of the base portion of the lower side wall portion 263, and stands on the game board 80 side from the front surface of the opposing plate portion 251. The positioning protrusion 259 is inserted into a through hole 91 (see FIG. 6) formed in the game board 80, thereby preventing the game board 80 from moving in the left-right direction.

ここで、䜍眮決め突起の配眮に぀いお補足する。䜍眮決め突起は察向板郚に䞀䜓成圢されおいる。察向板郚は、耇数の平板郚が連なっおなり、それら平板郚のうち誘導レヌルの入口郚分に最も近いものは呚壁郚のコヌナ郚に連なっおいる。この平板郚に䜍眮決め突起が配眮されおいる。すなわち、呚壁郚を構成する䞋偎壁郚及び巊偎壁郚に連なる平板郚に䜍眮決め突起が配眮されおいる。このように、隣り合う耇数の壁郚に察しお連なっおいる平板郚においおは、同平板郚に察しお負荷が加わった堎合の倉圢を抑え、の壁郚に連なっおいる堎合ず比范しお圓該平板郚の倉䜍量を小さくするこずができる。特に、誘導レヌルの入口郚分に察しお最寄ずなるコヌナ郚に連なる平板郚に䜍眮決め突起を配眮するこずで、䞊述した倉䜍量を奜適に䜎枛し、䜍眮決め突起の䜍眮粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   Here, it supplements about arrangement | positioning of the positioning protrusion 259. FIG. The positioning protrusion 259 is integrally formed with the counter plate portion 251. The counter plate portion 251 includes a plurality of flat plate portions, and the flat plate portion that is closest to the inlet portion 104 of the guide rail 100 is connected to the corner portion of the peripheral wall portion 261. A positioning projection 259 is disposed on the flat plate portion. That is, the positioning protrusion 259 is disposed on the flat plate portion that is continuous with the lower wall portion 263 and the left wall portion 264 that constitute the peripheral wall portion 261. In this way, in the flat plate portion connected to a plurality of adjacent wall portions, the deformation when a load is applied to the flat plate portion is suppressed, as compared with the case where it is connected to one wall portion. The amount of displacement of the flat plate portion can be reduced. In particular, by arranging the positioning protrusion 259 on the flat plate portion connected to the corner portion closest to the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100, the above-described displacement amount is suitably reduced, and the positional accuracy of the positioning protrusion 259 is improved. Can contribute.

遊技盀に圢成された貫通孔は、䜍眮決め突起の巊右䜍眮のばら぀きを抑え぀぀䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きを蚱容可胜ずなるように圢成されおいる。具䜓的には、䜍眮決め突起が円柱状をなしおいるのに察しお、貫通孔は䞊䞋方向に拡がる長孔状をなしおいる。これにより、䜍眮決め突起に遊技盀の自重が加わるこずを回避しやすくし、同䜍眮決め突起による巊右䜍眮の䜍眮粟床の䜎䞋を抑制しおいる。   The through hole 91 formed in the game board 80 is formed so as to allow the variation in the vertical position while suppressing the variation in the horizontal position of the positioning protrusion 259. Specifically, the positioning protrusion 259 has a columnar shape, whereas the through hole 91 has a long hole shape extending in the vertical direction. Thereby, it is easy to avoid the weight of the game board 80 from being applied to the positioning protrusion 259, and the deterioration of the position accuracy of the left and right positions by the positioning protrusion 259 is suppressed.

図に瀺すように、これら䜍眮決め突起及び貫通孔は、誘導レヌルの入口郚分埌方ずなる䜍眮、具䜓的には遊技盀の正面芖にお倖レヌルの背埌に重なる䜍眮に配されおいる。より詳しくは、䜍眮決め突起及び貫通孔は、遊技盀の正面芖にお倖レヌルにおける䞊蚘特定郚䜍ず前埌に重なる䜍眮に配されおいる。このように、特定郚䜍に近い䜍眮にお遊技盀の巊右䜍眮を芏定するこずにより、倖レヌルの䜍眮ばら぀き、ひいおは遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑えやすくしおいる。   As shown in FIG. 6, the positioning protrusion 259 and the through hole 91 are located at a position behind the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100, specifically at a position overlapping the back of the outer rail 102 in the front view of the game board 80. It is arranged. More specifically, the positioning protrusions 259 and the through holes 91 are arranged at positions that overlap the specific part SP in the outer rail 102 in the front and rear directions when the game board 80 is viewed from the front. In this way, by defining the left and right positions of the game board 80 at positions close to the specific part SP, it is easy to suppress the variation in the position of the outer rail 102 and the variation in the landing position of the game ball.

図図の−線郚分断面図に瀺すように、䜍眮決め突起の起立量は、貫通孔の深さ寞法よりも小さく蚭定されおおり、貫通孔の䞭間䜍眮に䜍眮決め突起の先端が䜍眮しおいる。これは、内枠により遊技盀を回動可胜に支持する構成においお、貫通孔ず䜍眮決め突起ずの合わせを奜適なものずするための工倫である。   As shown in FIG. 13 (partial sectional view taken along line BB in FIG. 6), the standing protrusion 259 is set to be smaller than the depth dimension of the through hole 91 and is positioned at an intermediate position of the through hole 91. The tip of the protrusion 259 is located. This is a device for making the alignment of the through hole 91 and the positioning projection 259 suitable in the configuration in which the game board 80 is rotatably supported by the inner frame 13.

貫通孔においお䜍眮決め突起が届いおいない郚分には、倖レヌルを支持するレヌル支持郚材が取り付けられおいる。぀たり、貫通孔における凡そ前偎半分は遊技盀の䜍眮決め甚の領域、同貫通孔における凡そ埌偎半分はレヌル支持郚材の取付甚の領域ずしお掻甚されおいる。   A rail support member 107 that supports the outer rail 102 is attached to a portion of the through hole 91 where the positioning projection 259 has not reached. That is, the front half of the through hole 91 is used as a region for positioning the game board 80, and the rear half of the through hole 91 is used as a region for mounting the rail support member 107.

レヌル支持郚材は、貫通孔に嵌合する嵌合郚ず、倖レヌルの倖面に察しお圓接する圓接郚ずを有し、それら嵌合郚及び圓接郚が合成暹脂材料によっお䞀䜓成圢されおなる。遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球が倖レヌル詳しくは特定郚䜍に着地した際には、遊技球の着地によっお生じる衝撃の䞀郚をレヌル支持郚材及び遊技盀に分散するこずができ、倖レヌルを保護するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   The rail support member 107 includes a fitting portion 108 that fits into the through hole 91 and a contact portion 109 that comes into contact with the outer surface of the outer rail 102, and the fitting portion 108 and the contact portion 109 are combined. It is integrally formed of a resin material. When the game ball launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 lands on the outer rail 102 (specifically, the specific portion SP), a part of the impact generated by the landing of the game ball is distributed to the rail support member 107 and the game board 80. The outer rail 102 can be protected.

たた、レヌル支持郚材は、䞊蚘固定ピンの間に配眮されおいる。同レヌル支持郚材を倖レヌルに察しおレヌル支持郚材を圓接させおおくこずにより、遊技球の着地に䌎う倖レヌルの振動を抑制するこずができる。なお、䞊述の劂く貫通孔は長孔状をなしおおり、嵌合郚はその倖圢が同貫通孔の内圢に合わせお圢成されおいる。これにより、レヌル支持郚材が䞊述した遊技球衝突時の衝撃等により回動䜍眮ずれするこずを回避し぀぀、遊技盀に察しお䞊蚘衝撃を分散させやすくしおいる。たた、そのようにレヌル支持郚材の䜍眮ずれを生じにくくするこずで、䞊蚘保護機胜の䜎䞋が抑えられおいる。   The rail support member 107 is disposed between the fixed pins 102a. By causing the rail support member 107 to contact the outer rail 102, the vibration of the outer rail 102 due to the landing of the game ball can be suppressed. As described above, the through hole 91 has a long hole shape, and the fitting portion 108 is formed so that its outer shape matches the inner shape of the through hole 91. This makes it easy to disperse the impact on the game board 80 while avoiding the rail support member 107 from rotating (displacement) due to the impact or the like at the time of the game ball collision described above. Moreover, the deterioration of the protective function is suppressed by making it difficult for the rail support member 107 to be displaced.

以䞊詳述したように貫通孔を遊技盀の䜍眮決めず、レヌル支持郚材の取り付けに掻甚するこずで、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床のみならず、レヌル支持郚材の䜍眮粟床及び倖レヌルの䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図っおいる。これにより、倖レヌルにおける特定郚䜍ぞの遊技球の着地粟床を向䞊させるこずを可胜ずしおいる。   As described above in detail, the through hole 91 is used for positioning the game board 80 and mounting the rail support member 107, so that not only the position accuracy of the game board 80 but also the position accuracy of the rail support member 107 and the outer rail 102 are obtained. The position accuracy is improved. Thereby, the landing accuracy of the game ball on the specific part SP in the outer rail 102 can be improved.

たた、察向板郚からの䜍眮決め突起の起立量は、同察向板郚からの䞋偎壁郚の起立量よりも小さく蚭定されおいる。これは䜍眮決め突起を保護するための工倫である。ここで、図及び図に基づき遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮する際の遊技盀ず䜍眮決め突起ずの䜍眮関係に぀いお、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮ず絡めお説明する。図及び図は遊技盀の着脱の流れを瀺す抂略図であり、遊技盀を装着する際には、図→図→図→図の順に䜜業が行われる。   Further, the rising amount of the positioning protrusion 259 from the counter plate portion 251 is set smaller than the rising amount of the lower side wall portion 263 from the counter plate portion 251. This is a device for protecting the positioning protrusion 259. Here, the positional relationship between the game board 80 and the positioning protrusion 259 when the game board 80 is arranged at the mounting completion position will be described based on FIGS. 14 and 15 in conjunction with the vertical position of the game board 80. 14 and 15 are schematic views showing the flow of attaching and detaching the game board. When the game board 80 is mounted, FIG. 14 (a) → FIG. 14 (b) → FIG. 15 (c) → FIG. The operations are performed in the order of d).

図に瀺すように、遊技盀の䞀偎郚を挿入郚に挿入し、同遊技盀詳しくは䞋偎切欠き郚を仮眮き郚に茉せた状態においおは、遊技盀が回動基端偎にお䞋方から支えられるこずずなる。これにより、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮の倧たかなばら぀きが抑えられる。䜆し、この堎合、支えられおいるのは遊技盀の回動基端偎の䞀偎郚のみであり、同遊技盀の回動先端偎においおは回動基端偎ず比范しお遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きが生じやすいず想定される。   As shown in FIG. 14A, in a state where one side portion of the game board 80 is inserted into the insertion portion 280 and the game board 80 (specifically, the lower cutout portion 88) is placed on the temporary placement portion 290. The game board 80 is supported from below on the rotation base end side. Thereby, the rough dispersion | variation in the up-and-down position of the game board 80 is suppressed. However, in this case, only one side of the rotation base end side of the game board 80 is supported, and the game board 80 is compared with the rotation base end side at the rotation front end side of the game board 80. It is assumed that 80 vertical positions are likely to vary.

遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させるず、遊技盀の䞋端郚が遊技盀収容郚の䞋偎壁郚の案内郚に圓接する。この状態から遊技盀を曎に回動させるず、同遊技盀が案内郚に沿っお僅かに持ち䞊げられ、遊技盀詳しくは䞋偎切欠き郚が仮眮き郚から離間する。これにより、遊技盀は、仮眮き郚に茉った状態から䞋偎壁郚に茉った状態に移行され、䞊䞋䜍眮の䜍眮決めがなされる。このように遊技盀が䞋偎壁郚に茉った状態から回動されるず、その回動操䜜に応じお䞋偎壁郚ず遊技盀ずの接觊範囲が同遊技盀の回動先端偎に向けお拡がるこずずなる。この接觊範囲の拡がりに䌎っお遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀き、特に回動先端偎での䜍眮ばら぀きが抑制される。   When the game board 80 is rotated toward the mounting completion position, the lower end portion of the game board 80 comes into contact with the guide portion 269 of the lower wall portion 263 of the game board housing portion 75. When the game board 80 is further rotated from this state, the game board 80 is slightly lifted along the guide part 269, and the game board 80 (specifically, the lower notch part 88) is separated from the temporary placement part 290. . As a result, the gaming board 80 is shifted from the state of being placed on the temporary placement part 290 to the state of being placed on the lower side wall part 263, and the vertical position is determined. When the game board 80 is rotated from the state where it is placed on the lower wall part 263 in this way, the contact range CE between the lower wall part 263 and the game board 80 corresponds to the rotation of the game board 80 according to the turning operation. It will spread toward the tip side. Along with the expansion of the contact range CE, variations in the vertical position of the game board 80, in particular, positional variations on the rotating tip side are suppressed.

遊技盀が所定の䜍眮たで回動されるず、遊技盀の貫通孔に察しお内枠の䜍眮決め突起が入り始めるが、この時点では䜍眮決め突起に察しお挿入郚ずは反察偎ずなる䜍眮にたで接觊範囲が拡がるこずずなる。぀たり、巊右の䜍眮決めがなされる前に、䜍眮決め突起の巊右䞡偎にお遊技盀の䞊䞋ばら぀きが抑えられる。より詳しくは、接觊範囲が遊技盀の党重量を支えるこずのできる範囲たで拡がり、䜜業者の負担が軜枛される。これにより、䜜業ばら぀きに起因した䞍郜合、すなわち䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔の䞊方や䞋方に衝突し䜍眮決めがうたく行われなくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくしおいる。   When the game board 80 is rotated to a predetermined position, the positioning protrusion 259 of the inner frame 13 starts to enter the through hole 91 of the game board 80. At this time, the insertion portion 280 is defined with respect to the positioning protrusion 259. The contact range CE is expanded to a position on the opposite side. That is, the vertical variation of the game board 80 is suppressed on both the left and right sides of the positioning protrusion 259 before the left and right positioning is performed. More specifically, the contact range CE extends to a range where the entire weight of the game board 80 can be supported, and the burden on the operator is reduced. This makes it difficult to cause inconveniences due to work variations, that is, the positioning protrusions 259 collide above or below the through-holes 91 and positioning is not performed well.

曎には、遊技盀はその回動䞭心䜍眮が固定されおいるのではない。぀たり、遊技盀の回動に応じお、その回動䞭心䜍眮を挿入郚内で倉䜍させるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。具䜓的には、遊技盀を挿入郚に挿入した状態では、遊技盀が板バネ詳しくは抌圧郚に察しおその頂郚よりも折曲郚偎に寄った䜍眮で圓接する。この状態から遊技盀が回動されるこずで、䞊蚘圓接䜍眮が埐々に頂郚に向けお移動する。このように遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させる過皋で遊技盀ず抌圧郚ずの圓接䜍眮が埐々に前方に移るこずで、同遊技盀の回動䞭心䜍眮が倉䜍する。   Furthermore, the rotation center position of the game board 80 is not fixed. That is, according to the rotation of the game board 80, the rotation center position can be displaced within the insertion portion 280. Specifically, in a state where the game board 80 is inserted into the insertion part 280, the game board 80 is located closer to the bent part 273 side than the top part 272a with respect to the leaf spring 270 (specifically, the pressing part 272). Abut. By rotating the game board 80 from this state, the contact position gradually moves toward the top 272a. In this manner, the contact position between the game board 80 and the pressing portion 272 gradually moves forward in the process of turning the game board 80 toward the mounting completion position, so that the rotation center position of the game board 80 is displaced. To do.

遊技盀を回動させるこずで装着完了䜍眮に配眮する構成においおは、䜍眮決め突起の起立方向ず、遊技盀の移動方向ずが必ずしも䞀臎するわけではない。これは、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊ず、装着完了䜍眮ぞの円滑な移動ずの䞡立を困難なものずする芁因ずなり埗る。䟋えば、䜍眮決め突起の起立方向を遊技盀の回動軌跡に合わせお曲げるこずも可胜ではあるが、この堎合、䜍眮決め粟床を向䞊させるこずが難しくなる。   In the configuration in which the game board 80 is rotated and disposed at the mounting completion position, the standing direction of the positioning protrusion 259 and the movement direction of the game board 80 do not necessarily coincide with each other. This can be a factor that makes it difficult to achieve both improvement in positioning accuracy and smooth movement to the mounting completion position. For example, it is possible to bend the rising direction of the positioning protrusion 259 in accordance with the turning trajectory of the game board 80, but in this case, it is difficult to improve the positioning accuracy.

この点、回動䞭心䜍眮の倉䜍特に前埌方向での倉䜍を蚱容するこずで貫通孔ず䜍眮決め突起ずの匕っ掛かりを抑制し、貫通孔ぞの䜍眮決め突起の入り蟌みの円滑化を促進しおいる。なお、䜍眮決め突起の先端郚分は先现り状をなしおおり、圓該䜍眮決め突起ず貫通孔ずの匕っ掛かりが奜適に回避されおいる。   In this regard, by allowing displacement of the rotation center position (particularly displacement in the front-rear direction), the catch between the through hole 91 and the positioning projection 259 is suppressed, and the positioning projection 259 can smoothly enter the through hole 91. Promoting. Note that the distal end portion of the positioning projection 259 is tapered, and the catch between the positioning projection 259 and the through hole 91 is preferably avoided.

遊技盀の固定構造
図に瀺すように、䜍眮決め突起ず同䞀察象、すなわち内枠の察向板郚には、遊技盀収容郚からの遊技盀の取り倖しを䞍可ずするロック状態ず、同遊技盀の取り倖しを蚱容するアンロック状態ずに切替可胜なロック装眮が耇数蚭けられおいる。ロック装眮には、内枠においお前蚘挿入郚ずは反察偎、すなわち右偎壁郚寄りに配眮されおいるものず、挿入郚偎、詳しくは䞊蚘䜍眮決め突起の近傍に配眮されおいるものずがある。これら各ロック装眮においおは、基本構成が共通ずなっおおり、同ロック装眮に付随する構成のみが若干異なっおいる。そこで、先ず図及び図に基づきロック装眮の基本構成に぀いお説明し、埌に個々のロック装眮に付随する構成の差異に぀いお説明する。図はロック装眮を内枠から取り倖した状態を瀺す分解斜芖図、図は図の―線郚分断面図である。なお、図では䟿宜䞊、ロック装眮の䞀郚の構成埌述する操䜜レバヌに぀いおはパチンコ機の偎方から芋た状態で衚瀺しおいる。
(Fixed structure of game board 80)
As shown in FIG. 11, the same object as the positioning protrusion 259, that is, the opposing plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13, has a locked state in which it is impossible to remove the game board 80 from the game board housing part 75, and the game board 80. There are provided a plurality of lock devices 400 that can be switched to an unlocked state that allows removal of the locks. The locking device 400 is arranged on the inner frame 13 on the side opposite to the insertion portion 280, that is, on the right side wall portion 265, and on the insertion portion 280 side, specifically in the vicinity of the positioning protrusion 259. There is something that is. Each of the lock devices 400 has a common basic configuration, and only the configuration associated with the lock device 400 is slightly different. First, the basic configuration of the locking device 400 will be described with reference to FIGS. 16 and 17, and the difference in configuration associated with each locking device 400 will be described later. 16 is an exploded perspective view showing a state where the locking device 400 is detached from the inner frame 13, and FIG. 17 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along the line CC of FIG. In FIG. 17, for the sake of convenience, a part of the configuration of the locking device (an operation lever 440 described later) is shown as viewed from the side of the pachinko machine 10.

図に瀺すように、内枠の察向板郚には、ロック装眮が蚭眮されるロック装眮蚭眮郚が蚭けられおいる。ロック装眮蚭眮郚は、内枠の背面偎に窪む段付きの筒状をなしおいる図参照。より具䜓的には、ロック装眮蚭眮郚は、内枠の正面偎から背面偎に段階的に絞られた぀の筒郚〜によっお構成されおいる。以䞋䟿宜䞊、正面偎の筒郚を「正面偎筒郚」、背面偎の筒郚を「背面偎筒郚」、それら正面偎筒郚及び背面偎筒郚を繋ぐ筒郚を「䞭間筒郚」ずしお区別する。   As shown in FIG. 16, the counter plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13 is provided with a lock device installation portion 253 where the lock device 400 is installed. The locking device installation portion 253 has a stepped cylindrical shape that is recessed on the back side of the inner frame 13 (see FIG. 17). More specifically, the lock device installation portion 253 is configured by three cylindrical portions 254 to 256 that are gradually narrowed from the front side to the back side of the inner frame 13. Hereinafter, for the sake of convenience, the front side cylinder part 254 is referred to as “front side cylinder part 254”, the rear side cylinder part 256 is referred to as “rear side cylinder part 256”, and the front side cylinder part 254 and the rear side cylinder part 256 are connected to each other. Are distinguished as “intermediate tube portion 255”.

図に瀺すように、ロック装眮蚭眮郚には軞䜓が挿通されおいる。軞䜓は、その倖埄が背面偎筒郚の内埄ず同等になるように圢成されおおり、同背面偎筒郚に嵌たるこずでロック装眮蚭眮郚の䞭心軞線方向以倖の方向ぞの移動が芏制されおいる。   As shown in FIG. 17, the shaft 410 is inserted through the lock device installation portion 253. The shaft body 410 is formed so that the outer diameter thereof is equal to the inner diameter of the rear surface side cylindrical portion 256, and the shaft body 410 is fitted in the rear surface side cylindrical portion 256 so as to have a direction other than the central axis direction of the lock device installation portion 253. Movement to is restricted.

軞䜓は、その䞡端がロック装眮蚭眮郚から突出するようにしお配眮されおおり、内枠の背面偎に突出しおいる䞀端には背面偎筒郚の端面に察しお内枠の背面偎から圓接するフランゞが圢成されおいる。このフランゞが背面偎筒郚の端面に圓接するこずにより軞䜓の前埌䜍眮が芏定されおいる。   The shaft body 410 is arranged so that both ends thereof protrude from the lock device installation portion 253, and the inner frame 13 is opposed to the end surface of the rear side cylinder portion 256 at one end protruding to the rear side of the inner frame 13. A flange 411 that abuts from the back side is formed. The front and rear positions of the shaft body 410 are defined by the flange 411 coming into contact with the end surface of the rear side cylinder portion 256.

軞䜓には、遊技盀を背面偎から抌すプッシャず、そのプッシャを遊技盀の背面偎に向けお付勢する付勢郚材ずしおのコむルバネずが組み付けられおいる。詳しくは、プッシャが軞䜓の䞭心軞線方向に延びる角筒状をなすずずもに、コむルバネが螺旋状に圢成されおおり、それらプッシャ及びコむルバネの内郚に軞䜓が挿通されおいる図参照。   The shaft body 410 is assembled with a pusher 420 that pushes the game board 80 from the back side, and a coil spring 430 as an urging member that urges the pusher 420 toward the back side of the game board 80. Specifically, the pusher 420 has a rectangular tube shape extending in the central axis direction of the shaft body 410, and the coil spring 430 is formed in a spiral shape, and the shaft body 410 is inserted into the pusher 420 and the coil spring 430. (See FIG. 16).

プッシャは、軞䜓の䞭心軞線方向にスラむド移動可胜な状態で正面偎筒郚に嵌め蟌たれおいる。正面偎筒郚の内呚面はプッシャの倖呚面に合臎する角圢状をなしおおり、軞䜓を䞭心ずした同プッシャの回動が阻止されおいる。なお、正面偎筒郚の内呚には、ロック装眮蚭眮郚の䞭心軞線方向に延びる突条郚が圢成されおおり、プッシャの倖呚には同突条郚が嵌たるキヌ溝が圢成されおいる。これら突条郚ずキヌ溝ずが嵌合するこずにより、プッシャの取付䜍眮が芏定されおいる。   The pusher 420 is fitted into the front side tubular portion 254 so as to be slidable in the direction of the central axis of the shaft body 410. The inner peripheral surface of the front side cylinder portion 254 has an angular shape that matches the outer peripheral surface of the pusher 420, and the rotation of the pusher 420 around the shaft body 410 is prevented. A protrusion 257 extending in the central axis direction of the lock device installation part 253 is formed on the inner periphery of the front side cylinder 254, and a key groove into which the protrusion 257 is fitted on the outer periphery of the pusher 420. 421 is formed. The fitting position of the pusher 420 is defined by the fitting of the protruding portion 257 and the key groove 421.

正面偎筒郚に嵌め蟌たれたプッシャず䞭間筒郚ずによっお、䞊蚘コむルバネの収容空間が区画されおいる。䞭間筒郚ず背面偎筒郚ずの境界郚䜍には、プッシャの背面に察向する段差郚が圢成されおおり、コむルバネが段差郚ずプッシャずによっお挟たれお垞時圧瞮された状態ずなっおいる。より詳しくは、コむルバネの䞡端偎には軞䜓に挿通された䞀察のワッシャが配されおおり、それらワッシャがプッシャ及び段差郚に察する取付座面ずしお機胜しおいる。なお、䞡ワッシャを省略し、コむルバネがプッシャず段差郚ずを盎接抌す構成ずするこずも可胜である。   A housing space for the coil spring 430 is defined by the pusher 420 and the intermediate cylinder part 255 that are fitted into the front side cylinder part 254. A step portion 258 facing the back surface of the pusher 420 is formed at a boundary portion between the intermediate tube portion 255 and the back side tube portion 256, and the coil spring 430 is sandwiched between the step portion 258 and the pusher 420 and is always compressed. It is in the state. More specifically, a pair of washers 431 and 432 inserted through the shaft body 410 are disposed on both ends of the coil spring 430, and these washers 431 and 432 function as mounting seat surfaces for the pusher 420 and the stepped portion 258. Yes. It is also possible to omit both washers 431 and 432 and to have a configuration in which the coil spring 430 directly pushes the pusher 420 and the stepped portion 258.

プッシャの厚さ寞法軞線方向の長さ寞法は、正面偎筒郚の深さ寞法よりも小さくなるように蚭定されおおり、ロック装眮蚭眮郚からの突出が抑えられ圓該プッシャの前面が察向板郚の前面に察しお面䞀になる埅機䜍眮ず、ロック装眮蚭眮郚から突出しお遊技盀を前方ぞ倉䜍させる䜜甚䜍眮ずに切替可胜ずなっおいる。以䞋、プッシャの䜍眮の切替を実珟する構成に぀いお説明する。   The thickness dimension (the length dimension in the axial direction) of the pusher 420 is set to be smaller than the depth dimension of the front side cylinder portion 254, and the protrusion from the lock device installation portion 253 is suppressed and the pusher 420 is suppressed. Can be switched between a standby position where the front surface of the game board is flush with the front surface of the opposing plate portion 251 and an operation position where the game board 80 is displaced forward by protruding from the lock device installation portion 253. Hereinafter, a configuration for realizing switching of the position of the pusher 420 will be described.

軞䜓の先端郚フランゞずは反察偎の端郚はプッシャを通っおその前方に突出しおおり、その突出しおいる先端郚には特定の操䜜に基づいおプッシャの䜍眮を切り替える操䜜レバヌが固定されおいる。操䜜レバヌは、軞䜓の䞭心軞線を䞭心ずした回動が蚱容されおおり、軞䜓が嵌め蟌たれおいる円筒状の基郚ず、同基郚におけるプッシャずは反察偎の端郚から圓該基郚の攟射方向䞡偎に突出しおいる操䜜郚ずを有し、党䜓ずしお略字状をなしおいる。   The tip of the shaft 410 (the end opposite to the flange 411) protrudes forward through the pusher 420, and the position of the pusher 420 is switched to the protruding tip based on a specific operation. An operation lever 440 is fixed. The operation lever 440 is allowed to rotate around the central axis of the shaft 410, and has a cylindrical base 441 in which the shaft 410 is fitted, and an end of the base 441 opposite to the pusher 420. And an operation portion 446 that protrudes on both sides of the base portion 441 in the radial direction, and has a substantially T-shape as a whole.

プッシャにおいお基郚の端面ず察向しおいる郚分には同基郚偎に起立する突起が蚭けられおいる。䞀方、基郚の端面には、回動䞭心軞線ず盎亀する方向すなわち回動䞭心軞線の攟射方向に広がる平面状をなすずずもに、プッシャの突起が圓接した状態で停留可胜な䞀察の停留郚が圢成されおいる。それら各停留郚は、プッシャの前端面からの距離が盞違しおおり、軞䜓の呚方向に離しお配眮されおいる。以䞋、䟿宜䞊プッシャの前端面からの距離が倧きい䞀方を「第停留郚」、同第停留郚よりも前蚘距離が小さい他方を「第停留郚」ず称する。   A protrusion 422 erected on the side of the base 441 is provided on a portion of the pusher 420 facing the end surface of the base 441. On the other hand, the end surface of the base portion 441 has a planar shape extending in a direction orthogonal to the rotation center axis line (that is, a radial direction of the rotation center axis line), and can be stopped in a state where the protrusion 422 of the pusher 420 is in contact. The stopping portions 442 and 443 are formed. These stop portions 442 and 443 have different distances from the front end surface of the pusher 420 and are arranged apart from each other in the circumferential direction of the shaft body 410. Hereinafter, for the sake of convenience, one having a larger distance from the front end surface of the pusher 420 will be referred to as a “first stopping portion 442”, and the other having a smaller distance than the first stopping portion 442 will be referred to as a “second stopping portion 443”.

たた、基郚の端面にはそれら第停留郚及び第停留郚を繋ぐ連結郚が圢成されおいる。連結郚は、第停留郚から第停留郚に向けお䞋る曲面状をなしおいる。プッシャの突起が連結郚を蟿るこずで、各停留郚での停留状態の切り替えが蚱容される。なお、連結郚が第停留郚から第停留郚向けお傟斜する平面状をなす構成ずするこずも可胜である。   In addition, a connecting portion 444 that connects the first stopping portion 442 and the second stopping portion 443 is formed on the end surface of the base portion 441. The connecting portion 444 has a curved surface shape that descends from the second stopping portion 443 toward the first stopping portion 442. When the protrusion 422 of the pusher 420 follows the connecting portion 444, switching of the stopping state at each of the stopping portions 442 and 443 is allowed. Note that the connecting portion 444 may have a planar shape that is inclined from the second stopping portion 443 toward the first stopping portion 442.

突起、停留郚及び連結郚は、プッシャの䜍眮を切り替える切替手段を構成しおおり、ロック装眮にはこれら各皮構成を組ずする切替手段が耇数本実斜の圢態においおは぀蚭けられおいる。それら切替手段は、軞䜓の呚方向においお等間隔ずなるよう䞊べお配眮されおいる。これにより、コむルバネの付勢力によっお操䜜レバヌを歪たせるような応力が生じるこずを抑制しおいる。なお、突起、停留郚及び連結郚の配蚭察象を入れ替えるこずも可胜である。すなわち、プッシャに停留郚及び連結郚に盞圓する構成を配蚭し、基郚に突起に盞圓する構成を配蚭しおもよい。   The protrusions 422, the stopping portions 442 and 443, and the connecting portion 444 constitute a switching unit that switches the position of the pusher 420, and the lock device 400 includes a plurality of switching units that have one of these various configurations (this embodiment). 3) are provided. These switching means are arranged side by side at equal intervals in the circumferential direction of the shaft body 410. Thereby, it is suppressed that the stress which distorts the operation lever 440 with the urging | biasing force of the coil spring 430 arises. Note that it is also possible to change the arrangement target of the protrusion 422, the stopping portions 442 and 443, and the connecting portion 444. In other words, the pusher 420 may be provided with a configuration corresponding to the retaining portions 442 and 443 and the connecting portion 444, and the base 441 may be provided with a configuration corresponding to the protrusion 422.

たた、ロック装眮は、操䜜レバヌの回動操䜜量を制限する制限手段を備えおいる図参照。制限手段は、基郚の倖呚面から突出する突出郚ず、プッシャに圢成され、突出郚が嵌たる溝郚ずによっお構成されおいる。溝郚は䞭心軞線を䞭心ずする円匧状をなしおおり、これら溝郚及び突出郚によっお操䜜レバヌを切り替える際の回動操䜜量が制限されおいる本実斜の圢態においおは°以䞋ずなるように制限されおいる。これにより、䞊述した各切替手段が盞互に干枉するこずを回避し、耇数組みの切替手段を共存させやすくしおいる。   Further, the locking device 400 includes a limiting unit that limits the amount of rotation of the operation lever 440 (see FIG. 16). The restricting means is configured by a protruding portion 445 protruding from the outer peripheral surface of the base portion 441 and a groove portion 423 formed in the pusher 420 and into which the protruding portion 445 is fitted. The groove portion 423 has an arc shape centered on the central axis, and the amount of rotation operation when the operation lever 440 is switched is limited by the groove portion 423 and the protruding portion 445 (90 ° or less in this embodiment). To be limited). This avoids the above-described switching means from interfering with each other, and makes it easy for a plurality of sets of switching means to coexist.

ロック装眮がアンロック状態である堎合には、プッシャの各突起が各第停留郚に圓接するこずにより、ロック装眮蚭眮郚からのプッシャの突出が抑えられる。この堎合、第停留郚がコむルバネによる付勢方向ず盎亀しおいるため、操䜜レバヌはアンロック䜍眮で保持された状態ずなる。操䜜レバヌがアンロック䜍眮に保持された状態では、操䜜郚が氎平方向暪方向を向いおいる。   When the locking device 400 is in the unlocked state, the protrusions 422 of the pusher 420 abut on the second stopping portions 443, thereby preventing the pusher 420 from protruding from the locking device installation portion 253. In this case, since the 2nd stop part 443 is orthogonal to the urging | biasing direction by the coil spring 430, the operation lever 440 will be in the state hold | maintained in the unlocked position. In a state where the operation lever 440 is held at the unlock position, the operation unit 446 faces in the horizontal direction (lateral direction).

ロック装眮をロック状態に切り替える堎合には、操䜜レバヌを時蚈回りに回動させ、操䜜郚を瞊向きにするこずで、各突起が第停留郚から連結郚を経由しお第停留郚に移る。これにより、プッシャがロック装眮蚭眮郚から突出し、遊技盀を背面偎から抌す状態ずなる。この堎合、第停留郚がコむルバネによる付勢方向ず盎亀しおいるため、操䜜レバヌはロック䜍眮で保持された状態ずなる。操䜜レバヌがロック䜍眮で保持された状態では操䜜郚が氎平方向ず鉛盎方向ずの䞭間を向くように傟いおいる。   When the lock device 400 is switched to the locked state, the operation lever 440 is rotated clockwise and the operation portion 446 is turned vertically, so that each protrusion 422 passes from the second stop portion 443 via the connection portion 444. To the first stop 442. As a result, the pusher 420 protrudes from the lock device installation portion 253 and pushes the game board 80 from the back side. In this case, since the 1st stop part 442 is orthogonal to the urging | biasing direction by the coil spring 430, the operation lever 440 will be in the state hold | maintained in the lock position. In a state where the operation lever 440 is held at the lock position, the operation unit 446 is inclined so as to face the middle between the horizontal direction and the vertical direction.

遊技盀には操䜜郚に察応する挿通郚が圢成されおおり、操䜜郚が同挿通郚を通じお遊技盀の前面よりも前方に匵り出しおいる。より具䜓的には、挿通郚は、遊技盀の厚さ方向に貫通しおいるずずもに、遊技盀の回動基端偎から回動先端偎、詳しくは氎平方向に延びおおり、ロック装眮がアンロック状態にある堎合には操䜜郚の通過を蚱容し、ロック装眮がロック状態である堎合には操䜜郚の通過を阻止するように圢成されおいる。このため、ロック装眮がロック状態にある堎合には、操䜜郚においお遊技盀の前面ず察向する郚分が同遊技盀に察しお圓接し、䞊述したコむルバネの付勢力による遊技盀の移動が阻止される。぀たり、操䜜郚は遊技盀の移動を阻止するストッパ郚ずしおの機胜を䜵せ有しおいる。   An insertion portion 92 corresponding to the operation portion 446 is formed in the game board 80, and the operation portion 446 protrudes forward from the front surface of the game board 80 through the insertion portion 92. More specifically, the insertion portion 92 penetrates in the thickness direction of the game board 80, and extends from the rotation base end side of the game board 80 to the rotation front end side, more specifically in the horizontal direction. When the device 400 is in the unlocked state, the passage of the operation unit 446 is allowed, and when the lock device 400 is in the locked state, the passage of the operation unit 446 is prevented. For this reason, when the locking device 400 is in the locked state, a portion of the operation unit 446 facing the front surface of the game board 80 abuts against the game board 80, and the game board 80 due to the biasing force of the coil spring 430 described above. Movement is prevented. That is, the operation unit 446 also has a function as a stopper unit that prevents the game board 80 from moving.

以䞊詳述したように、ロック装眮によっお遊技盀の前埌䜍眮が芏定される点に着目すれば、圓該ロック装眮には䞊蚘板バネ及びストッパず同様に䜍眮決め機胜が付䞎され、同ロック装眮によっお䜍眮決め機構が構成されおいるずいえる。   As described in detail above, if attention is paid to the fact that the front and rear positions of the game board 80 are defined by the locking device 400, the locking device 400 is provided with a positioning function in the same manner as the leaf spring 270 and the stopper 267. It can be said that the locking device 400 constitutes a positioning mechanism.

ここで、図及び図に基づきロック装眮及び䞊蚘䜍眮決め突起の関係に぀いお説明する。   Here, the relationship between the locking device 400 and the positioning protrusion 259 will be described with reference to FIGS. 14 and 15.

図に瀺すように、ロック装眮は、操䜜郚の前端郚が䜍眮決め突起の先端よりも前方に䜍眮するように配眮されおいる。このため、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させる堎合には、先ずロック装眮の操䜜郚が遊技盀の挿通郚に入り図参照、その埌、䜍眮決め突起が遊技盀の貫通孔に入るこずずなる図参照。より詳しくは、操䜜郚の少なくずも䞀郚が挿通郚に嵌たっおいる状態にお、䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に入るこずずなる。挿通郚の内圢は操䜜郚の倖圢よりも僅かに倧きく圢成されおおり、挿通郚内での操䜜郚の移動ばら぀きが制限される。぀たり、操䜜郚が挿通郚内に入るこずで、遊技盀の組み付けばら぀き䟋えば巊右方向での䜍眮ばら぀きが抑えられるこずずなる。このように、遊技盀の䜍眮ばら぀きが抑えられた状態にお、䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に入る構成ずするこずで、䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に䞊手く嵌たらないずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくしおいる。   As shown in FIG. 14A, the locking device 400 is arranged such that the front end portion of the operation portion 446 is positioned forward of the tip end of the positioning protrusion 259. For this reason, when the game board 80 is rotated toward the mounting completion position, the operation unit 446 of the lock device 400 first enters the insertion part 92 of the game board 80 (see FIG. 14B), and then positioning is performed. The protrusion 259 enters the through hole 91 of the game board 80 (see FIG. 15C). More specifically, the positioning protrusion 259 enters the through hole 91 in a state where at least a part of the operation portion 446 is fitted in the insertion portion 92. The inner shape of the insertion portion 92 is formed to be slightly larger than the outer shape of the operation portion 446, and movement variation of the operation portion 446 within the insertion portion 92 is limited. That is, when the operation unit 446 enters the insertion unit 92, assembly variation of the game board 80 (for example, position variation in the left-right direction) is suppressed. As described above, with the configuration in which the positioning protrusion 259 enters the through hole 91 in a state in which the position variation of the game board 80 is suppressed, there arises a disadvantage that the positioning protrusion 259 does not fit into the through hole 91 well. It is difficult.

特に、本実斜の圢態においおは、䜍眮決め突起の巊右䞡偎にロック装眮が配眮されおいる。぀たり、䜍眮決め突起が぀のロック装眮右偎のロック装眮及び巊偎のロック装眮の間に配されおいる。各ロック装眮に察応する挿通郚は、巊偎の挿通郚が遊技盀の回動基端偎に開攟され、右偎の挿通郚が遊技盀の回動先端偎に開攟されおおり、その開攟されおいる方向以倖の方向ぞのロック装眮の䜍眮ずれを抑える構成ずなっおいる。このように各ロック装眮に䜍眮ずれ抑制機胜を分䞎するこずにより、䞀方のロック装眮に負担が集䞭するこずを抑制しおいる。   In particular, in the present embodiment, the locking device 400 is disposed on both the left and right sides of the positioning protrusion 259. That is, the positioning protrusion 259 is disposed between the two lock devices 400 (the right lock device 400R and the left lock device 400L). The insertion portions 92R and 92L corresponding to the respective locking devices 400R and 400L have the left insertion portion 92L opened to the rotation base end side of the game board 80 and the right insertion portion 92R to the rotation distal end side of the game board 80. The lock device 400R, 400L is restrained from being displaced in a direction other than the opened direction. In this way, by providing the lock devices 400R and 400L with the positional deviation suppression function, it is possible to prevent the load from being concentrated on one of the lock devices 400.

特に、巊偎のロック装眮に察応する挿通郚に぀いおは、遊技盀の䞋偎切欠き郚偎に連なるずずもに、遊技盀の回動基端偎に開攟されおいる。   In particular, the insertion portion 92L corresponding to the lock device 400L on the left side is connected to the lower notch portion 88 side of the game board 80 and is open to the rotation base end side of the game board 80.

ロック装眮が誘導レヌルの入口郚分を挟んだ巊右䞡偎に配眮されおいる構成においおは、䞡ロック装眮のうち入口郚分よりも遊技盀の回動基端偎に䜍眮する䞀方によっお挿入郚ぞの遊技盀の挿入が劚げられやすくなるこずが懞念される。入口郚分を遊技盀の幅方向における略䞭倮に配眮しおいるこずで、そのような䞍郜合が顕著になるず想定される。   In the configuration in which the locking device 400 is arranged on both the left and right sides of the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100, one of the both locking devices 400 located closer to the rotation base end side of the game board 80 than the entrance portion 104 is. There is a concern that the insertion of the game board 80 into the insertion portion 280 is likely to be hindered. It is assumed that such an inconvenience becomes conspicuous by arranging the entrance portion 104 at substantially the center in the width direction of the game board 80.

たた、本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路が各皿よりも䞊䜍に䜍眮するこずにより遊技球を同皿ぞ誘導する際にそれら遊技球の自重を利甚しお同遊技球を移動させるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。しかしながら、遊技領域が拡匵されおいる本実斜の圢態においおは、このような遊技領域の拡匵によっお本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路の配眮が制限されやすくなっおいる。これは、各皿ぞの遊技球の誘導を難しくする芁因ずなり埗る。   Further, since the main body side upper dish passage and the main body side lower dish path are positioned higher than the respective dishes 33 and 34, the game balls are guided to the same dishes 33 and 34 by using their own weights. It is possible to move the game ball. However, in the present embodiment in which the game area PE is expanded, the arrangement of the main body side upper dish passage and the main body side lower dish path is easily restricted by such expansion of the game area PE. This can be a factor that makes it difficult to guide the game balls to the respective dishes 33 and 34.

この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技盀に䞋偎切欠き郚を圢成するこずで、䞊蚘本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路ず遊技盀ずの共存が可胜ずなっおいる。぀たり、遊技領域を拡匵し぀぀本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路の䜍眮を各皿よりも䞊䜍に配眮するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。曎に、䞊述の劂くこの䞋偎切欠き郚に連なるようにしお挿通郚を圢成し、その挿通郚を遊技盀の回動基端偎に開攟させるこずで、挿入郚に遊技盀を挿入する際のロック装眮ず挿通郚ずの干枉を回避するこずができる。これにより、本䜓偎䞊皿通路及び本䜓偎䞋皿通路の配眮ず遊技領域の拡匵ずを奜適に実珟し、曎には䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊ず遊技盀の挿入䜜業の容易化ずを奜適に䞡立しおいる。   In this regard, in the present embodiment, by forming the lower cutout portion 88 in the game board 80, the main body side upper dish passage and the main body side lower dish path and the game board 80 can coexist. Yes. That is, it is possible to arrange the positions of the main body side upper dish passage and the main body side lower dish path higher than the respective dishes 33 and 34 while expanding the game area PE. Further, as described above, the insertion portion 92L is formed so as to be continuous with the lower cutout portion 88, and the insertion portion 92L is opened to the rotation base end side of the game board 80, so that the insertion portion 280 has the game board. Interference between the locking device 400L and the insertion portion 92L when inserting 80 can be avoided. Thereby, the arrangement of the main body side upper dish passage and the main body side lower dish passage and the expansion of the game area PE are preferably realized, and furthermore, both the improvement of the positioning accuracy and the ease of the insertion operation of the game board 80 are preferably realized. doing.

遊技盀の把持構造
たた、本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技盀の把持構造に぀いお特城的な構成を有しおいる。以䞋、図及び図に基づき遊技盀に蚭けられた各皮構成に぀いお補足し、その埌、遊技盀の把持構造に぀いお説明する。
(Grip structure of game board 80)
In the present embodiment, the gripping structure of the game board 80 has a characteristic configuration. Hereinafter, supplementing various configurations provided in the game board 80 based on FIG. 6 and FIG. 7, the grip structure of the game board 80 will be described.

図に瀺すように、遊技盀の誘導レヌルは遊技盀の回動先端偎に開攟された匧状をなしおいる。遊技盀の前面には、その開攟郚䜍を塞ぎ誘導レヌルず共に遊技領域を区画するブロック状の遊技領域区画郚材が蚭けられおいる。蚀い換えれば、誘導レヌルず遊技領域区画郚材ずは、前者が遊技盀の回動基端偎、埌者が遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮されるこずで䞡者䜵せお環状をなしおおり、それら誘導レヌル及び遊技領域区画郚材によっお区画された領域により遊技領域が構成されおいる。なお、遊技領域区画郚材は、遊技盀の前面から匵り出しおおり、その前面郚がガラスに察しお僅かな隙間詳しくは遊技球の盎埄寞法以䞋の隙間を隔おお察峙しおいる。これにより、遊技球が遊技領域区画郚材を乗り越えお遊技領域倖に流出するこずを回避しおいる。   As shown in FIG. 7, the guide rail 100 of the game board 80 has an arc shape that is open to the rotating front end side of the game board 80. On the front surface of the game board 80, a block-shaped game area partition member 480 is provided that closes the open portion and partitions the game area PE together with the guide rail 100. In other words, the guide rail 100 and the game area partition member 480 are arranged in a ring shape by arranging the former on the rotation base end side of the game board 80 and the latter on the rotation front end side of the game board 80. The game area PE is configured by the areas partitioned by the guide rail 100 and the game area partition member 480. The game area partition member 480 protrudes from the front surface of the game board 80, and the front surface portion of the game area partition member 480 faces the glass 22 with a slight gap (specifically, a gap smaller than the diameter dimension of the game ball). . Thereby, it is avoided that the game ball gets over the game area partition member 480 and flows out of the game area PE.

遊技領域区画郚材は、遊技盀の回動先端偎の端郚巊端郚に沿っお配眮されおおり、遊技盀の䞊端郚から䞋端郚に跚っお䞊䞋に延びおいる。遊技領域区画郚材においお倖レヌルの先端に隣接する郚䜍、詳しくは遊技領域の内偎に䜍眮する壁面には、倖レヌルに沿っお移動飛翔する遊技球が衝突するこずにより同遊技球を遊技領域の䞭倮偎ぞ跳ね返す返しゎムが装着されおいる。   The game area partitioning member 480 is disposed along the end portion (left end portion) on the rotation tip side of the game board 80 and extends vertically from the upper end portion to the lower end portion of the game board 80. A game ball moving along the outer rail 102 collides with a portion adjacent to the tip of the outer rail 102 in the game area partition member 480, specifically, a wall surface located inside the game area PE, thereby causing the same game. A return rubber 490 that rebounds the ball toward the center of the game area PE is attached.

遊技球発射ハンドルが操䜜されるず、遊技球が遊技球発射機構の発射レヌルに沿っお誘導レヌルの入口郚分に向けお発射される。遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜量が第の芏定量を䞊回った堎合には、遊技球が倖レヌルに沿っお移動し、可倉衚瀺ナニット図参照の䞊方を通過する。そしお、同遊技球は、倖レヌルから圓該倖レヌルのレヌル方向先偎に向けお飛び出し、返しゎムに衝突する。この衝突に基づいお返しゎムが圧瞮され䟋えば匟性倉圢し、返しゎムに加わった衝突荷重の䞀郚が遊技領域区画郚材に䌝わるこずずなる。以䞊の過皋を経るこずにより、遊技球発射機構によっお遊技球に付䞎された勢いを匱め、返しゎムよりも䞋流偎に配された釘等の各皮構成を保護しおいる。   When the game ball launch handle 40 is operated, a game ball is launched along the launch rail 112 of the game ball launch mechanism 110 toward the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100. When the operation amount of the game ball launch handle 40 exceeds the second specified amount, the game ball moves along the outer rail 102 and passes above the variable display unit 85 (see FIG. 7). Then, the game ball jumps out from the outer rail 102 toward the front side in the rail direction of the outer rail 102 and collides with the return rubber 490. Based on this collision, the return rubber 490 is compressed (for example, elastically deformed), and a part of the collision load applied to the return rubber 490 is transmitted to the game area partition member 480. Through the above process, the momentum imparted to the game ball by the game ball launching mechanism 110 is weakened, and various components such as the nail 87 disposed on the downstream side of the return rubber 490 are protected.

図に瀺すように、遊技領域区画郚材は、遊技盀に察しお耇数箇所でネゞ止めされおいる。それらネゞの少なくずも぀は返しゎムの近傍、具䜓的には遊技球の衝突方向においお返しゎムよりも先偎ずなる䜍眮に配されおいる。これにより、䞊蚘衝突荷重を遊技盀に察しお分散させやすくし、遊技球の繰り返しの衝突に察する耐久性の向䞊が図られおいる。   As shown in FIG. 7, the game area partition member 480 is screwed to the game board 80 at a plurality of locations. At least one of these screws 491 is arranged in the vicinity of the return rubber 490, specifically, at a position ahead of the return rubber 490 in the collision direction of the game ball. As a result, the collision load can be easily distributed to the game board 80, and the durability against repeated collision of game balls is improved.

たた、遊技領域区画郚材は、䞊述したロック装眮を遊技盀の回動基端偎から迂回するようにしお遊技盀の䞋端瞁に至っおおり、同遊技領域区画郚材の䞋郚、詳しくは誘導レヌルの右偎開攟郚分よりも䞋偎ずなる郚䜍には、誘導レヌルの内レヌルに遊技領域倖偎から察向する察向郚が圢成されおいる。察向郚は、内レヌルにおいお遊技盀のアりト口ず内レヌルの䞋偎の開攟端ずの間ずなる郚䜍に察しお䞋偎から若干の隙間を隔おお察向しおいる。すなわち、内レヌルず遊技領域区画郚材ずが内倖に重なっおいる。   Further, the game area partition member 480 reaches the lower end edge of the game board 80 so as to bypass the above-described locking device 400R from the rotation base end side of the game board 80, and the lower part of the game area partition member 480 is described in detail. In the part below the right open part of the guide rail 100, a facing part 485 is formed opposite to the inner rail 101 of the guide rail 100 from the outside of the game area PE. The facing portion 485 faces a portion of the inner rail 101 between the out port 86 of the game board 80 and the lower open end of the inner rail 101 with a slight gap from the lower side. That is, the inner rail 101 and the game area partition member 480 overlap with each other.

既に説明したように、遊技領域に達した遊技球の䞀郚は、同遊技領域を流䞋する過皋で䞀般入賞口等の入球口に入るが、それら入球口に入らなかった遊技球に぀いおは内レヌルによっお排出口ずしおのアりト口に導かれる。より具䜓的には、内レヌルは、䞋方に凞ずなる円匧状をなしおおり、その䞋端郚にアりト口が配眮されおいる。このため、入球口に入らなかった遊技球は、内レヌルに衝突した埌、内レヌルに沿っお遊技領域の最䞋郚に誘導される。   As already explained, some of the game balls that have reached the game area PE enter the entrance holes such as the general winning opening 81 in the process of flowing down the game area PE, but the games that have not entered the entrance area The sphere is guided to the out port 86 as a discharge port by the inner rail 101. More specifically, the inner rail 101 has an arc shape that protrudes downward, and an out port 86 is disposed at the lower end thereof. For this reason, the game ball that has not entered the entrance is collided with the inner rail 101 and then guided to the lowermost part of the game area PE along the inner rail 101.

内レヌルに぀いおは、遊技盀偎の開攟端及びその呚蟺での固定匷床が同内レヌルにおける他の郚䜍ず比べお䜎くなりやすい。このため、遊技球の衝突による衝撃の圱響が同内レヌルの開攟端及びその呚蟺では倧きくなりやすいず想定される。仮に、内レヌルが倉圢等した堎合には、アりト口ぞ向けおの遊技球の円滑な誘導が劚げられるず懞念される。この点、本実斜の圢態では、内レヌルが䞋方に抌される等した堎合に遊技領域区画郚材の察向郚に圓たるこずで、同内レヌルの倉圢や䜍眮ずれ等が抑制されるこずずなる。故に、遊技領域区画郚材によっお内レヌルを保護するこずができ、䞊蚘䞍郜合を奜適に払拭できる。蚀い換えれば、遊技領域区画郚材には、内レヌルのバックアップ機胜が付䞎されおいる。   As for the inner rail 101, the fixing strength at the open end on the game board 80 side and the periphery thereof tends to be lower than the other portions of the inner rail 101. For this reason, it is assumed that the impact due to the collision of the game balls is likely to increase at the open end of the inner rail 101 and its surroundings. If the inner rail 101 is deformed or the like, there is a concern that smooth guidance of the game ball toward the out port 86 is hindered. In this regard, in the present embodiment, when the inner rail 101 is pushed downward or the like, it hits the facing portion 485 of the game area partitioning member 480, so that deformation or positional deviation of the inner rail 101 is suppressed. Become. Therefore, the inner rail 101 can be protected by the game area partition member 480, and the above inconvenience can be suitably wiped off. In other words, the game area partition member 480 is provided with a backup function of the inner rail 101.

たた、遊技領域区画郚材においお察向郚を挟んで内レヌルずは反察偎ずなる郚䜍には、各パチンコ機毎に固有ずなる識別情報補造番号等が付䞎された蚌玙ず同蚌玙を収容する透明なケヌス郚材ずからなる識別ナニットが蚭けられおおり、遊技領域区画郚材には識別ナニットを収容するナニット収容郚が圢成されおいる。このナニット収容郚に識別ナニットが嵌たった状態で固定されるこずで、䞡者が䞀䜓化されおいる。   Further, in the game area partition member 480, the part opposite to the inner rail 101 across the facing portion 485 is the same as the stamp 492 to which identification information (manufacturing number and the like) unique to each pachinko machine is given. An identification unit 494 comprising a transparent case member 493 for accommodating the certificate paper 492 is provided, and the game area partitioning member 480 is formed with a unit accommodating portion 486 for accommodating the identification unit 494. The identification unit 494 is fixed in a state of being fitted in the unit housing portion 486, so that both are integrated.

識別ナニットはナニット収容郚に察しお埌方から嵌め蟌たれおおり、同ナニット収容郚に圢成された開口を介しおその䞀郚がパチンコ機の前方に露出した状態ずなっおいる。この開口を介しお䞊蚘蚌玙に付䞎された識別情報を芖認可胜ずなっおいる。぀たり、識別ナニットを遊技領域区画郚材から取り倖すこずなく蚌玙の識別情報を確認するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   The identification unit 494 is fitted into the unit housing portion 486 from the rear, and a part thereof is exposed to the front of the pachinko machine 10 through an opening formed in the unit housing portion 486. The identification information given to the certificate paper 492 can be visually recognized through this opening. That is, it is possible to confirm the identification information of the certificate stamp 492 without removing the identification unit 494 from the game area partition member 480.

遊技領域区画郚材が察向郚を有する構成を採甚した堎合には、遊技領域区画郚材における察向郚呚りでの匷床を向䞊させるこずで䞊述した誘導レヌルのバックアップ機胜を向䞊するこずができる。このような匷床の向䞊を実珟するには、遊技領域区画郚材を倧型化するこずが぀の手法ずしお考えられる。この点、識別ナニットを収容するナニット収容郚を遊技領域区画郚材に蚭け、それらナニット収容郚ず察向郚ずを䜵存させるこずで、遊技領域区画郚材の占有スペヌスを有効利甚しおいる。぀たり、遊技領域区画郚材の匷床向䞊ず識別手段の蚭眮領域の確保すなわちスペヌスの有効利甚を可胜ずし、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟しおいる。   When the game area partition member 480 adopts a configuration having the facing portion 485, the strength of the game area partition member 480 around the facing portion 485 can be improved to improve the above-described guide rail backup function. . In order to realize such an improvement in strength, it is conceivable as one method to increase the size of the game area partition member 480. In this regard, a unit accommodating portion 486 that accommodates the identification unit 494 is provided in the gaming area partition member 480, and by making the unit accommodating portion 486 and the opposing portion 485 coexist, the occupied space of the gaming area partition member 480 can be effectively used. ing. That is, it is possible to improve the strength of the game area partition member 480 and to secure the area for installing the identification means (that is, to effectively use the space), thereby realizing a practically preferable configuration.

たた、遊技領域区画郚材に぀いおは遊技盀からの着脱を特に必芁ずしない郚品であるため、その取り付けを匷固にするこずが可胜である。この遊技領域区画郚材によっお識別ナニットの取り倖しを阻止するこずで、識別ナニットの䞍正な取り倖し等を抑制し防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。䟋えば、識別ナニットを遊技領域区画郚材ずは別の郚材を甚いお遊技盀に装着する構成ず比范しお、遊技盀の前面偎のスペヌスを有効利甚できる。遊技盀の前面には遊技領域が圢成され、遊技領域倖の領域が限られおいる点を考慮すれば、遊技領域区画郚材に識別ナニット甚のナニット収容郚を蚭けるこずによる技術的貢献床は倧きいず考えられる。   Further, since the game area partition member 480 is a part that does not particularly require attachment / detachment from the game board 80, the attachment can be strengthened. By preventing the identification unit 494 from being removed by the game area partition member 480, unauthorized removal of the identification unit 494 can be suppressed and contribution to improvement of crime prevention can be achieved. For example, the space on the front side of the game board 80 can be effectively used as compared with a configuration in which the identification unit 494 is mounted on the game board 80 using a member different from the game area partition member 480. In consideration of the fact that the game area PE is formed on the front surface of the game board 80 and the area outside the game area PE is limited, the game area partition member 480 is provided with a unit accommodating portion 486 for the identification unit 494. Technical contribution is considered large.

遊技領域区画郚材には、ホヌル管理者等の䜜業者が遊技盀を移動させる堎合等に把持可胜な䞀察の把持郚が蚭けられおいる。䞡把持郚は、䞀方以䞋、䟿宜䞊「第把持郚」ず称するが他方以䞋、䟿宜䞊「第把持郚」ず称するよりも䞊方䞔぀遊技盀の回動先端寄りずなるように配されおいる。   The game area partition member 480 is provided with a pair of grip portions 481 and 482 that can be gripped when an operator such as a hall manager moves the game board 80. One of the gripping portions 481 and 482 (hereinafter referred to as “first gripping portion 481” for convenience) is higher than the other (hereinafter referred to as “second gripping portion 482” for convenience) and the rotation tip of the game board 80 It is arranged to be close.

第把持郚は、遊技領域区画郚材の䞊端郚、具䜓的には遊技領域区画郚材においお返しゎムが装着されおいる壁面ずは反察偎の壁面に圢成されおいる。より詳しくは、第把持郚は、䞊蚘ネゞを挟んで返しゎムず反察偎ずなる䜍眮に圢成されおいる。第把持郚が把持された際には、遊技盀の自重による負荷が第把持郚遊技領域区画郚材に加わりやすくなる。このように負荷が加わりやすい郚分においおは、それに耐え埗る匷床が必芁になり埗る。この点、元来匷床の確保が求められる郚分、すなわち返しゎムが蚭けられおいる郚分の呚蟺に第把持郚を蚭け、匷床を確保すべき箇所を集玄するこずで、匷床確保のために必芁な領域の拡がりを抑えおいる。これにより、遊技領域区画郚材の倧型化等によっお遊技領域が圧迫されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   The first grip 481 is formed on the upper end of the game area partition member 480, specifically, on the wall surface on the opposite side of the game area partition member 480 from the wall surface on which the return rubber 490 is mounted. More specifically, the first grip 481 is formed at a position on the opposite side of the return rubber 490 across the screw 491. When the first grip 481 is gripped, a load due to the weight of the game board 80 is easily applied to the first grip 481 (the game area partition member 480). In such a portion where a load is likely to be applied, a strength that can withstand the load may be required. In this regard, the first gripping portion 481 is provided around the portion where the strength is originally required to be secured, that is, the portion where the return rubber 490 is provided, and the locations where the strength should be secured are gathered to secure the strength. The expansion of the necessary area is suppressed. Thereby, it is possible to make it difficult for the inconvenience that the game area PE is compressed due to an increase in the size of the game area partition member 480 or the like.

たた、第把持郚は、遊技領域区画郚材における倖偎の壁面から遊技盀の回動基端偎すなわち前扉枠の回動基端偎に凹むずずもに、遊技盀の回動先端偎すなわち䞊蚘挿入郚に察する遊技盀の挿入方向手前偎に開口されおいる。その開口郚分に察しお遊技盀の回動先端偎から指を挿入するこずにより、第把持郚を把持するこずができる。   The first grip 481 is recessed from the outer wall surface of the game area partition member 480 toward the rotation base end side of the game board 80 (that is, the rotation base end side of the front door frame 14). It is opened on the moving tip side (that is, the front side in the insertion direction of the game board 80 with respect to the insertion portion 280). The first gripping portion 481 can be gripped by inserting a finger into the opening portion from the rotation tip side of the game board 80.

第把持郚の開口郚分は、遊技盀の回動先端偎の瞁郚よりも内偎回動基端偎ずなるように奥たった䜍眮に配されおいる。これにより、第把持郚を把持しおいる手が右偎壁郚に匕っ掛かるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくし、同第把持郚を利甚しやすくしおいる。   The opening portion of the first grip portion 481 is disposed at a position that is recessed so as to be on the inner side (rotation base end side) of the edge portion on the rotation distal end side of the game board 80. This makes it difficult for the hand holding the first holding part 481 to be caught on the right side wall part 265 and makes it easier to use the first holding part 481.

第把持郚は、第把持郚よりも䞋偎、詳しくは遊技領域区画郚材の䞋端郚に添っお、䞔぀第把持郚よりも遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮されおいる。より詳しくは、第把持郚は、䞊蚘察向郚を挟んで内レヌルずは反察偎、䞔぀誘導レヌルの入口郚分ず右偎のロック装眮ずの間に配眮されおいる。このように、第把持郚をロック装眮よりも遊技盀の回動基端偎、すなわち遊技盀の䞭倮寄りに配眮するこずで、遊技盀を把持した際の安定性向䞊に貢献しおいる。   The second grip portion 482 is below the first grip portion 481, specifically, along the lower end portion of the game area partition member 480, and on the rotation base end side of the game board 80 relative to the first grip portion 481. Placed in position. More specifically, the second gripping portion 482 is disposed on the opposite side to the inner rail 101 with the facing portion 485 interposed therebetween, and between the inlet portion 104 of the guide rail 100 and the right side locking device 400R. As described above, the second gripping portion 482 is disposed closer to the rotation base end side of the game board 80 than the lock device 400R, that is, closer to the center of the game board 80, thereby improving stability when the game board 80 is gripped. Contributing.

たた、遊技領域区画郚材を固定するネゞの少なくずも぀は、察向郚ず第把持郚ずの間に配眮されおいる。これにより、内レヌルのバックアップ機胜を向䞊ず、把持匷床の向䞊ずに貢献しおいる。   Further, at least one of the screws 491 for fixing the game area partition member 480 is disposed between the facing portion 485 and the second grip portion 482. This contributes to improving the backup function of the inner rail 101 and improving the grip strength.

第把持郚は、遊技領域区画郚材における䞋偎の壁面からパチンコ機の䞊方に凹むずずもに、パチンコ機の䞋方に開口されおいる。その開口郚分に察しお䞋方から指を挿入するこずにより、第把持郚を把持するこずができる。   The second grip 482 is recessed above the pachinko machine 10 from the lower wall surface of the game area partition member 480 and is opened below the pachinko machine 10. The second grip 482 can be gripped by inserting a finger into the opening from below.

第把持郚の開口郚分は、遊技盀の䞋端瞁よりも䞊偎ずなるように奥たった䜍眮に配されおいる。これにより、第把持郚を把持しおいる手が䞋偎壁郚に匕っ掛かるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくし、同第把持郚を利甚しやすくしおいる。   The opening portion of the second grip portion 482 is disposed at a position that is deeper than the lower end edge of the game board 80. This makes it difficult for the hand holding the second holding part 482 to be caught on the lower side wall part 263 and makes it easier to use the second holding part 482.

ここで、遊技盀を内枠に察しお着脱する際の䜜業に぀いお説明を補足する。   Here, a supplementary explanation will be given for the work when the game board 80 is attached to and detached from the inner frame 13.

遊技盀を内枠に察しお装着する際には、遊技盀の正面偎から䞡把持郚を掎み、同遊技盀を持ち䞊げた状態で保持する。この際、図に瀺すように遊技盀の第把持郚に䞀方の手指を挿入するずずもに第把持郚に他方の手指を挿入する。このように、第把持郚を右手で、第把持郚を巊手で保持するこずにより䞡の腕の亀差が回避された状態で遊技盀を保持するこずができ、腕に察する負担を軜枛しやくなっおいる。そしお、遊技盀を保持した状態から内枠に装着する際には、遊技盀の重量を巊手で支え぀぀、右手で遊技盀を挿入郚に向けお抌し蟌み、遊技盀の䞋偎切欠き郚を内枠の仮眮き郚に茉せるこずにより遊技盀の装着準備が敎うこずずなる。このように、䞡手の圹割分担を可胜ずするこずにより、遊技盀の装着䜜業の円滑化に貢献しおいる。   When the game board 80 is mounted on the inner frame 13, the grips 481 and 482 are grasped from the front side of the game board 80 and the game board 80 is held in a lifted state. At this time, as shown in FIG. 7, one hand RH (finger) is inserted into the first grip portion 481 of the game board 80 and the other hand LH (finger) is inserted into the second grip portion 482. Thus, by holding the first gripping portion 481 with the right hand RH and the second gripping portion 482 with the left hand LH, the game board 80 can be held in a state where the crossing of both arms is avoided, It is easier to reduce the burden. When the game board 80 is held and attached to the inner frame 13, the weight of the game board 80 is supported by the left hand LH, and the game board 80 is pushed toward the insertion portion 280 with the right hand RH. By placing the lower cutout portion 88 on the temporary placement portion 290 of the inner frame 13, preparation for mounting the game board 80 is completed. In this manner, by allowing the roles of both hands to be shared, the game board 80 can be mounted smoothly.

遊技盀を仮眮きした状態から回動させる際には、䞡把持郚が遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮されおいるので、同遊技盀を容易に回動させるこずができる。぀たり、把持郚が遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮されおいる堎合ず比范しお、手ず前扉枠ずの干枉を回避しやすくし、䜜業スペヌスの確保の容易化に貢献しおいる。   When the game board 80 is turned from the temporarily placed state, the gripping parts 481 and 482 are arranged on the turning front end side of the game board 80, so that the game board 80 can be easily turned. it can. That is, compared with the case where the gripping portion is arranged on the rotation base end side of the game board 80, it is easier to avoid interference between the hand and the front door frame 14 and contribute to facilitating the securing of the work space. ing.

遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に抌し蟌む際には、各把持郚の開口郚分が遊技盀収容郚の呚壁郚よりも内偎に離れおいるため、指ず呚壁郚ずが匕っ掛かりにくくなっおいる。これにより、配眮途䞭段階にお把持郚から指を匕き抜いお遊技盀の持ち替えを行うずいった予備的動䜜を䞍芁ずし、遊技盀の装着䜜業の簡玠化に貢献しおいる。   When the game board 80 is pushed into the mounting completion position, the opening portions of the respective gripping portions 481 and 482 are separated from the peripheral wall portion 261 of the game board accommodating portion 75 so that the fingers and the peripheral wall portion 261 are not easily caught. It has become. This eliminates the need for a preliminary operation of pulling out a finger from the gripping portions 481 and 482 and changing the game board 80 in the middle of the arrangement, thereby contributing to simplification of the mounting work of the game board 80.

䞀方、遊技盀を内枠から取り倖す際には、遊技盀の第把持郚に右手の指を挿入するずずもに第把持郚に巊手の指を挿入する。把持郚の開口郚分は呚壁郚から離しお蚭けられおいるため、指が呚壁郚に匕っ掛かっお把持郚を把持できなくなるずいった䞍郜合を回避しやすくなっおいる。   On the other hand, when removing the game board 80 from the inner frame 13, the right finger is inserted into the first grip 481 of the game board 80 and the left finger is inserted into the second grip 482. Since the opening portions of the grip portions 481 and 482 are provided apart from the peripheral wall portion 261, it is easy to avoid the inconvenience that the finger is caught on the peripheral wall portion 261 and the grip portions 481 and 482 cannot be gripped.

既に説明したように遊技盀を着脱する際には、内枠の正面偎から䜜業が行われる。この際、蚀うたでも無く前扉枠が開攟された状態で䜜業が行われる。ここで、開攟された前扉枠ず遊技盀及び挿入郚ずの䜍眮関係に぀いお図を甚いお説明を補足する。図は、開攟された前扉枠ず遊技盀及び挿入郚ずの䜍眮関係を瀺す抂略図である。   As described above, when the game board 80 is attached and detached, the work is performed from the front side of the inner frame 13. At this time, it goes without saying that the operation is performed in a state where the front door frame 14 is opened. Here, the positional relationship between the opened front door frame 14, the game board 80 and the insertion portion 280 will be supplemented with reference to FIG. 18. FIG. 18 is a schematic diagram showing the positional relationship between the opened front door frame 14, the game board 80, and the insertion portion 280.

図に瀺すように、前扉枠は内枠に蚭けられた䞊蚘支持金具によっお回動可胜に軞支されおおり、この軞支された郚分回動䞭心軞線を䞭心ずしお開閉される構成ずなっおいる。支持金具には前扉枠の最倧開攟䜍眮を芏定する芏定郚が圢成されおいる。前扉枠が開攟され、芏定郚に察しお圓たった堎合には、それ以䞊の開攟が䞍可ずなる。本実斜の圢態においおは、前扉枠の最倧開攟量が凡そ°に蚭定されおいる。これは、パチンコ機がホヌル等の島蚭備に蚭眮された状態にお前扉枠が開攟された堎合に、隣接しお蚭けられた他の遊技機等に察しお同前扉枠が干枉しないように、たた隣接する遊技機での遊技を劚げないようにするための工倫である。なお、前扉枠の最倧開攟量は°に限定されるものではない。少なくずも遊技盀の取り倖しが蚱容される範囲であれば任意に蚭定しおよい。   As shown in FIG. 18, the front door frame 14 is pivotally supported by the support brackets 71 and 72 provided on the inner frame 13 so that the pivoted portion (rotation center axis CL) is supported. It is configured to open and close as the center. The support fitting 72 is formed with a defining portion 73 that defines the maximum opening position of the front door frame 14. When the front door frame 14 is opened and hits against the defining portion 73, further opening is impossible. In the present embodiment, the maximum opening amount of the front door frame 14 is set to about 100 °. This is because, when the front door frame 14 is opened in a state where the pachinko machine 10 is installed in an island facility such as a hall, the front door frame 14 is compared to other adjacent gaming machines and the like. This is a contrivance for preventing interference with a game machine adjacent thereto. The maximum opening amount of the front door frame 14 is not limited to 100 °. As long as at least the removal of the game board 80 is allowed, it may be set arbitrarily.

前扉枠の回動䞭心軞線は、同前扉枠の前郚に䜍眮しおおり、前扉枠を閉じた状態にお内枠の内偎に圓該前扉枠が嵌たり蟌むように既定されおいる。これにより、前扉枠ず内枠ずの境界郚䜍を介しお䞍正具が挿入されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくし、防犯機胜の匷化を図っおいる。   The rotation center axis CL of the front door frame 14 is located at the front portion of the front door frame 14, and the front door frame 14 is fitted inside the inner frame 13 with the front door frame 14 closed. It is default to be included. As a result, the inconvenience that an unauthorized tool is inserted through the boundary portion between the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 is less likely to occur, and the crime prevention function is enhanced.

この回動䞭心軞線の埌方に䞊蚘挿入郚が配眮されおいる。前扉枠は所定の厚さを有しおいるため、䞊述の劂く最倧開攟䜍眮たで開攟された堎合であっおもその背面の䞀郚が挿入郚よりも右偎前扉枠を支持しおいる偎ずは反察偎に匵り出した状態ずなる。挿入郚は、その匵出郚分よりも奥たった䜍眮に存圚しおいるものの、遊技盀を出し入れする際に圓該遊技盀の通過する軌道ず前扉枠及び内枠ずの干枉が回避されるようにしおその挿入口がパチンコ機の斜め前方に開攟されおいる。このように、挿入郚の挿入口を斜め前方に向けるこずで、遊技盀挿入時に前扉枠の匵出郚分及び内枠ず遊技盀ずが干枉するこずを抑制しおいる。特に、前扉枠の匵出郚分ずの干枉を回避するこずにより、遊技盀詳しくは遊技領域の倧きさ察する制限を受けにくくするこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   The insertion portion 280 is disposed behind the rotation center axis CL. Since the front door frame 14 has a predetermined thickness, even when the front door frame 14 is opened to the maximum open position as described above, a part of the rear surface thereof is on the right side of the insertion portion 280 (supports the front door frame 14). It is in a state of overhanging on the side opposite to the side where it is running. Although the insertion portion 280 exists at a position deeper than the overhanging portion, when the game board 80 is put in and out, the path PL through which the game board 80 passes and the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 interfere with each other. The insertion port is opened obliquely forward of the pachinko machine 10 so as to avoid this. As described above, the insertion opening of the insertion portion 280 is directed obliquely forward, thereby suppressing the overhanging portion of the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 and the game board 80 from interfering when the game board is inserted. In particular, by avoiding interference with the overhanging portion of the front door frame 14, it is possible to make it difficult to receive restrictions on the size of the game board 80 (specifically, the game area PE).

配線簡玠化
曎に、本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成を採甚するのに䜵せお、前扉枠ず内枠ずを電気的に接続するための構成を簡略化しおいる。そこで以䞋、図及び図に基づき前扉枠ず内枠ずを電気的に接続するための構成に぀いお説明する。
(Simplified wiring)
Further, in the present embodiment, in addition to adopting a configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the front side of the inner frame 13, the configuration for electrically connecting the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 is simplified. It has become. Therefore, a configuration for electrically connecting the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 will be described below with reference to FIGS. 2 and 3.

既に説明したように、前扉枠にはランプ郚〜やスピヌカ郚等の各皮衚瀺機噚が搭茉されおいる。これら衚瀺機噚を甚いるこずにより、遊技に関する各皮挔出や、遊技状況の報知等が実効される。ランプ郚等の衚瀺機噚は、遊技盀の背面に搭茉された音声ランプ制埡装眮ず電気的に接続されおおり、その衚瀺態様が同音声ランプ制埡装眮によっお制埡されおいる。   As already described, various display devices such as the lamp units 23 to 25 and the speaker unit 26 are mounted on the front door frame 14. By using these display devices, various effects relating to the game, notification of the game situation, and the like are effective. Display devices such as the lamp unit 23 are electrically connected to an audio lamp control device 143 mounted on the back of the game board 80, and the display mode is controlled by the audio lamp control device 143.

より詳しくは、ランプ郚等に接続されたハヌネスは、前扉枠の内郚におたずめられ、前扉枠における回動基端偎の䞊郚に圢成されたハヌネス甚開口郚を介しお内枠偎に延出しおいる図参照。遊技盀における回動基端偎の䞊隅郚には遊技盀の回動先端偎及びパチンコ機の䞋方に凹む䞊偎切欠き郚が圢成されおいる。   More specifically, the harness H connected to the lamp portion 23 and the like is gathered inside the front door frame 14 and via a harness opening 36 formed in the upper portion of the front door frame 14 on the rotation base end side. Extending toward the inner frame 13 (see FIG. 2). An upper notch 89 is formed in the upper corner portion of the game board 80 at the rotation base end side and is recessed on the rotation tip side of the game board 80 and below the pachinko machine 10.

䞊偎切欠き郚は、遊技盀の正面芖においお少なくずもその䞀郚が遊技盀収容郚の䞭倮開口に察しお重なる倧きさを有しおいる図参照。それら䞊偎切欠き郚及び䞭倮開口によっおハヌネスの通過経路が構成され、ハヌネスがそれら䞊偎切欠き郚及び䞭倮開口を介しお遊技盀の背面偎に延びおいる。   The upper notch 89 has a size such that at least a part of the upper notch 89 overlaps the central opening 76 of the game board accommodating part 75 in the front view of the game board 80 (see FIG. 6). The upper notch 89 and the central opening 76 form a passage for the harness H, and the harness H extends to the back side of the game board 80 via the upper notch 89 and the central opening 76.

䞊偎切欠き郚には、遊技盀収容郚の䞊偎壁郚に察向するずずもに略氎平に延びるハヌネス支持郚が圢成されおおり、遊技盀の背面偎に延出するハヌネスが同ハヌネス支持郚に茉った状態ずなっおいる。   The upper notch 89 is formed with a harness support portion 89a that faces the upper side wall portion 262 of the game board housing portion 75 and extends substantially horizontally, and the harness H that extends to the back side of the game board 80 is the same. It is in a state of being placed on the harness support portion 89a.

ハヌネスにおいおランプ郚等に接続されおいる偎ずは反察偎の端郚には、ハヌネス偎コネクタが取り付けられおいる。このハヌネス偎コネクタに察応しお音声ランプ制埡装眮には制埡装眮偎コネクタが蚭けられおいる。ハヌネス偎コネクタが制埡装眮偎コネクタに接続されるこずにより、䞊蚘ランプ郚等ず音声ランプ制埡装眮ずが電気的に接続された状態ずなっおいる。   A harness-side connector C1 is attached to the end of the harness H opposite to the side connected to the lamp portion 23 and the like. Corresponding to the harness side connector C1, the sound lamp control device 143 is provided with a control device side connector C2. By connecting the harness side connector C1 to the control device side connector C2, the lamp portion 23 and the sound lamp control device 143 are electrically connected.

制埡装眮偎コネクタは、遊技盀の埌方に開口しおおり、ハヌネス偎コネクタの着脱方向が遊技盀の厚さ方向ず同䞀ずなるように芏定されおいる。これにより遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮から回動するこずで生じる空間を䜜業空間ずしお掻甚しやすくしおいる。なお、これらコネクタ着脱方向は任意であり、䟋えば遊技盀の幅方向ず同䞀方向ずするこずも可胜である。この堎合、制埡装眮偎コネクタを遊技盀の回動先端偎に開口させ、ハヌネス偎コネクタの着脱を同遊技盀の回動先端偎から行いやすくなるように工倫するずよい。これにより、䞊述した䜜業空間を䞀局奜適に掻甚できる。   The control device side connector C2 is opened to the rear of the game board 80, and the attachment / detachment direction of the harness side connector C1 is defined to be the same as the thickness direction of the game board 80. This makes it easy to utilize the space generated by rotating the game board 80 from the mounting completion position as a work space. These connector attaching / detaching directions are arbitrary, and can be the same direction as the width direction of the game board 80, for example. In this case, it is preferable that the control device side connector C2 is opened to the turning front end side of the game board 80 so that the harness side connector C1 can be easily attached and detached from the turning front end side of the game board 80. Thereby, the work space mentioned above can be utilized more suitably.

本実斜の圢態においおは、䞊偎切欠き郚詳しくはハヌネス支持郚は、䞊蚘ハヌネス甚開口郚よりも䞋偎に䜍眮し、制埡装眮偎コネクタは䞊偎切欠き郚詳しくはハヌネス支持郚よりも䞋偎に䜍眮しおいる。これにより、ハヌネスの取り回し経路を短瞮し、぀たりハヌネスの前長を短くし、匛み等の発生の回避に貢献しおいる。   In the present embodiment, the upper notch portion 89 (specifically, the harness support portion 89a) is positioned below the harness opening 36, and the control device side connector C2 is connected to the upper notch portion 89 (specifically, in detail). It is located below the harness support 89a). Thereby, the routing route of the harness H is shortened, that is, the front length of the harness H is shortened, which contributes to avoiding the occurrence of slack.

遊技盀の亀換䜜業の流れ
以䞊詳述した電気的な接続に関する構成を螏たえお、図及び図に基づき遊技盀亀換時の䜜業の流れに぀いお説明する。図〜及び図のは遊技盀の亀換の様子を抂略的に瀺す断面図であり、図〜及び図のは遊技盀の亀換の様子を抂略的に瀺す正面斜芖図である。遊技盀を取り倖す際には、図→図→図→図→図の順に䜜業が行われる。
(Flow of game board 80 replacement work)
Based on the configuration related to the electrical connection described in detail above, the flow of work at the time of game board replacement will be described based on FIG. 19 and FIG. 19 (a1) to (c1) and (d1) and (e1) in FIG. 20 are cross-sectional views schematically showing a state of replacement of the game board 80, and FIGS. 19 (a2) to (c2) and FIG. (D2) and (e2) are front perspective views schematically showing how the gaming board 80 is replaced. When the game board 80 is removed, work is performed in the order of FIG. 19A → FIG. 19B → FIG. 19C → FIG. 19D → FIG.

遊技盀を取り倖す際には、先ず前扉枠の内枠に察する斜錠を解陀し、同前扉枠を開攟する。この際、図に瀺すように、前扉枠を最倧開攟䜍眮たで回動させおおくこずで、内枠の正面偎にお遊技盀取倖甚の䜜業スペヌスを確保しやすくできる。   When removing the game board 80, first, the locking of the front door frame 14 to the inner frame 13 is released, and the front door frame 14 is opened. At this time, as shown in FIG. 19 (a), it is easy to secure a work space for removing the game board 80 on the front side of the inner frame 13 by rotating the front door frame 14 to the maximum open position. it can.

次に、図に瀺すように、遊技盀を閉䜍眮にお固定しおいるロック装眮がアンロック状態ずなるように操䜜レバヌを操䜜する。ロック装眮が党おアンロック状態に切り替えられるず、内枠の挿入郚を基端ずした遊技盀の回動が蚱容された状態ずなる。   Next, as shown in FIG. 19B, the operation lever 440 is operated so that the locking device 400 that fixes the game board 80 in the closed position is unlocked. When all the locking devices 400 are switched to the unlocked state, the game board 80 is allowed to rotate with the insertion portion 280 of the inner frame 13 as the base end.

図に瀺した状態から遊技盀をパチンコ機の手前偎に回動するこずで、遊技盀の背面に搭茉された音声ランプ制埡装眮が内枠の正面偎に移動される図参照。この状態では、遊技盀の回動先端郚ず内枠ずの間から音声ランプ制埡装眮ぞのアクセスが可胜ずなる。   By rotating the game board 80 toward the front side of the pachinko machine 10 from the state shown in FIG. 19 (b), the sound lamp control device 143 mounted on the back of the game board 80 moves to the front side of the inner frame 13. (See FIG. 19C). In this state, the audio lamp control device 143 can be accessed from between the rotating front end of the game board 80 and the inner frame 13.

その埌、音声ランプ制埡装眮のコネクタずハヌネスのコネクタずの接続を解陀するこずで、図に瀺すように、遊技盀の挿入郚からの匕き出しが蚱容された状態ずなる。そしお、遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の回動先端偎右偎に匕き出すこずにより、遊技盀の取り倖しが完了する図参照。なお、このように遊技盀内枠から取り倖すこずで、ハヌネスが遊技盀のハヌネス支持郚から脱萜し、前扉枠のハヌネス甚開口郚から垂れ䞋がった状態ずなる。   Thereafter, the connection between the connector C2 of the sound lamp control device 143 and the connector C1 of the harness H is released, and as shown in FIG. 20 (d), the drawer from the insertion portion 280 of the game board 80 is permitted. It becomes. Then, by pulling out the game board 80 to the rotation tip side (right side) of the game board 80, the removal of the game board 80 is completed (see FIG. 20 (e)). In addition, by removing from the inner frame 13 of the game board 80 in this way, the harness H is dropped from the harness support part 89a of the game board 80 and is hung from the harness opening 36 of the front door frame 14.

次に、遊技盀を装着する際の䜜業の流れに぀いお説明する。遊技盀を装着する際には、図→図→図→図→図の順に䜜業が行われる。   Next, a work flow when the game board 80 is mounted will be described. When the game board 80 is mounted, work is performed in the order of FIG. 20 (e) → FIG. 20 (d) → FIG. 19 (c) → FIG. 19 (b) → FIG.

内枠に察しお遊技盀を装着する際には、先ず前扉枠を開攟し、挿入郚に察する遊技盀の挿入軌道を確保する図参照。このように、遊技盀の挿入軌道が確保された埌、遊技盀を挿入郚に挿入するずずもに仮眮き郚に茉せる。この状態では図に瀺すように遊技盀の䞊偎切欠き郚の開攟郚分が遊技盀収容郚によっお芆われおいないため、同䞊偎切欠き郚に察しおパチンコ機の䞊方からアクセス可胜である。この状態にお、前扉枠から垂れ䞋がったハヌネスを遊技盀のハヌネス支持郚に茉せ、コネクタを遊技盀の背面偎に配眮する。なお、ハヌネスをハヌネス支持郚に茉せおおくこずにより、遊技盀を回動させた際のハヌネスの噛み蟌み等を回避されやすくなる。   When the game board 80 is mounted on the inner frame 13, the front door frame 14 is first opened, and the insertion track PL of the game board 80 with respect to the insertion portion 280 is secured (see FIG. 20E). Thus, after the insertion track PL of the game board 80 is secured, the game board 80 is inserted into the insertion part 280 and placed on the temporary placement part 290. In this state, as shown in FIG. 20 (d), since the open portion of the upper notch 89 of the game board 80 is not covered by the game board housing part 75, the pachinko machine 10 Accessible from above. In this state, the harness H hanging from the front door frame 14 is placed on the harness support part 89a of the game board 80, and the connector C1 is disposed on the back side of the game board 80. Note that, by placing the harness H on the harness support portion 89a, it is easy to avoid biting of the harness H when the game board 80 is rotated.

その埌、図に瀺すように、ハヌネスのコネクタず音声ランプ制埡装眮のコネクタずを接続する。これにより、前扉枠のランプ郚等ず音声ランプ制埡装眮ずが電気的に繋がった状態ずなる。   After that, as shown in FIG. 19C, the connector C1 of the harness H and the connector C2 of the sound lamp control device 143 are connected. Thereby, the lamp portion 24 and the like of the front door frame 14 and the sound lamp control device 143 are electrically connected.

ハヌネスの接続を終えた埌は、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に回動させる。この際、䜜業ミス等により、ハヌネスがハヌネス支持郚䞊ではなく、遊技盀の䞊端郚に茉っおいる堎合も想定される。本実斜の圢態においおは、ハヌネス甚開口郚は、遊技盀の回動䞭心挿入郚ずずれた䜍眮、䞔぀䞊䞋方向及び巊右方向においおハヌネス甚開口郚及び制埡装眮偎コネクタの䞭間ずなる䜍眮に配されおいる。曎には、ハヌネスの党長には䜙裕代がほずんど付䞎されおいない。このため、ハヌネスは、遊技盀の回動に䌎っお埐々に匕っ匵られ、ハヌネス支持郚偎に移動するこずずなる。これにより、仮に䞊蚘䜜業ミスが発生した堎合であっおもハヌネスをハヌネス支持郚偎に導きやすくし、同䜜業ミスによるハヌネスの噛み蟌みを抑制可胜ずなっおいる。   After the connection of the harness H is completed, the game board 80 is rotated to the mounting completion position. At this time, it is also assumed that the harness H is placed on the upper end portion of the game board 80 instead of on the harness support portion 89a due to a work mistake or the like. In the present embodiment, the harness opening 36 is located at a position deviated from the center of rotation (insertion portion 280) of the game board 80, and the harness opening 36 and the control device side connector C2 in the vertical and horizontal directions. It is arranged in the middle position. Further, the margin of the harness H is hardly given to the entire length of the harness H. For this reason, the harness H is gradually pulled with the rotation of the game board 80, and moves to the harness support portion 89a side. Thereby, even if the operation mistake occurs, the harness H can be easily guided to the harness support portion 89a side, and the biting of the harness H due to the operation error can be suppressed.

図に瀺すように、遊技盀が装着完了䜍眮に配眮された埌は、ロック装眮の操䜜レバヌを切替操䜜するこずで、遊技盀がロック状態ずなる図参照。なお、本実斜の圢態におけるロック装眮は遊技盀をその背面が内枠の察向板郚から浮いた状態で固定するものであり、仮に遊技盀の背面ず内枠の察向板郚ずの間にハヌネスが挟たった堎合であっおも断線等の䞍郜合が生じにくくなっおいる。曎には遊技盀の䜍眮決めを䞋偎壁郚によっお行い、遊技盀の䞊端ず䞊偎壁郚ずの間に所定の隙間を圢成するこずで、遊技盀の䞊端ず䞊偎壁郚ずの間にハヌネスが挟たった堎合であっおも断線等の䞍郜合が生じにくくなっおいる。   As shown in FIG. 19B, after the game board 80 is arranged at the mounting completion position, the game board 80 is locked by switching the operation lever 440 of the lock device 400 (FIG. 19 ( a)). The locking device 400 in the present embodiment fixes the game board 80 in a state where the back surface of the game board 80 is lifted from the opposing plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13. Even when the harness H is sandwiched between the portion 251, inconveniences such as disconnection are less likely to occur. Further, the game board 80 is positioned by the lower wall portion 263, and a predetermined gap is formed between the upper end of the game board 80 and the upper wall portion 262, so that the upper end of the game board 80 and the upper wall portion 262 are separated. Even when the harness H is sandwiched between them, inconveniences such as disconnection are less likely to occur.

以䞊詳述した遊技盀の着脱䜜業は、前扉枠を開攟しおいるこずを前提ずしお行われるものであるが、前扉枠を開攟するこずで内枠の前面䟋えば遊技領域や遊技球発射機構が露出されるため、遊技盀の着脱のみならず、遊技球発射機構等のメンテナンスも行いやすくなっおいる。   The mounting and dismounting operation of the game board 80 described in detail above is performed on the assumption that the front door frame 14 is opened. However, by opening the front door frame 14, the front surface of the inner frame 13 (for example, the game area) Since the PE and the game ball launching mechanism 110) are exposed, not only can the game board 80 be attached and detached, but also the game ball launching mechanism 110 and the like can be easily maintained.

䜆し、本実斜の圢態における前扉枠は内枠の前面党域を芆っおいるものではなく、同前扉枠の開攟に際しおその䞀郚が芆われたたたずなる。このため、前扉枠の開攟によっお内枠の前面党域ぞのアクセスが蚱容されるわけではない。具䜓的には、図に瀺すように、内枠における右䞋の䞀区画、すなわち遊技球発射ハンドルが蚭けられおいる郚分には、内枠の回動先端偎の䞋隅郚を含んだ䞀郚を芆うようにしおハンドルベヌスが蚭けられおいる。ここで、図に基づきハンドルベヌスに぀いお説明する。図は、内枠からハンドルベヌスを取り倖した状態を瀺す分解斜芖図である。   However, the front door frame 14 in the present embodiment does not cover the entire front surface of the inner frame 13, and a part of the front door frame 14 remains covered when the front door frame 14 is opened. For this reason, access to the entire front surface of the inner frame 13 is not permitted by opening the front door frame 14. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 2, the lower right section of the inner frame 13, that is, the portion where the game ball launching handle 40 is provided, includes the lower corner portion of the inner frame 13 on the rotation tip side. A handle base 41 is provided so as to cover the part. Here, the handle base 41 will be described with reference to FIG. FIG. 21 is an exploded perspective view showing a state where the handle base 41 is detached from the inner frame 13.

ハンドルベヌスは、前扉枠ず䜵せお内枠の党域を芆っおおり、その前面偎に遊技球発射ハンドルが固定されるこずで同遊技球発射ハンドルず䞀䜓化されおいる。ハンドルベヌスの呚瞁には内枠に察する取付郚が突蚭されおいる。取付郚は前扉枠の背偎に䜍眮しおおり、圓該取付郚が内枠に察しおネゞ止めされるこずで、それらネゞぞのアクセスが前扉枠によっお劚げられる構成ずなっおいる。   The handle base 41 covers the entire area of the inner frame 13 together with the front door frame 14, and is integrated with the game ball launching handle 40 by fixing the game ball launching handle 40 to the front side thereof. At the periphery of the handle base 41, a mounting portion 42 for the inner frame 13 is projected. The attachment portion 42 is located on the back side of the front door frame 14, and the attachment portion 42 is screwed to the inner frame 13, thereby preventing access to the screws 45 by the front door frame 14. It has become.

たた、ハンドルベヌスは、前扉枠ずは独立しお固定されおいるため、同前扉枠が開攟された堎合であっおも、自身の固定䜍眮に留たる構成ずなっおいる。故に、䞊蚘ネゞを取り陀くためには先ず前扉枠を開攟する必芁があり、ハンドルベヌスの䞍正な取り倖しを困難なものずしおいる。なお、ハンドルベヌスの固定手段ずしおネゞ以倖の構成、䟋えば係止ピンや係止爪等を甚いるこずも可胜であるが、このような倉曎を行った堎合であっおもやはり、固定手段を前扉枠の背埌に配眮するこずが奜たしい。   Further, since the handle base 41 is fixed independently of the front door frame 14, the handle base 41 is configured to remain in its own fixed position even when the front door frame 14 is opened. Therefore, in order to remove the screw 45, it is necessary to first open the front door frame 14, which makes unauthorized removal of the handle base 41 difficult. It is possible to use a structure other than the screw 45 as the fixing means of the handle base 41, for example, a locking pin or a locking claw, but even if such a change is made, the fixing means is still used. It is preferable to arrange behind the front door frame 14.

たた、ハンドルベヌスは、パチンコ機における斜錠装眮の䞀郚を芆っおおり、ハンドルベヌスにおいお遊技球発射ハンドルよりも䞊偎ずなる郚䜍には、同斜錠装眮の操䜜手段詳しくは埌述するシリンダ錠をパチンコ機の正面偎に露出させる挿通孔が圢成されおいる。   Further, the handle base 41 covers a part of the locking device 500 in the pachinko machine 10, and an operating means (specifically, the locking device 500) is provided at a position above the game ball launching handle 40 in the handle base 41. An insertion hole 43 for exposing a cylinder lock 520, which will be described later, to the front side of the pachinko machine 10 is formed.

本実斜の圢態においおは、前扉枠を内枠に察しお開攟䞍胜な状態で斜錠する斜錠機構ず、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお開攟䞍胜な状態で斜錠する斜錠機構ずが䞀の斜錠装眮によっお具珟化されおおり、䞊蚘操䜜手段を操䜜するこずで、前扉枠及び遊技機䞻郚内枠を個別に解錠可胜ずなっおいる。   In the present embodiment, a locking mechanism for locking the front door frame 14 with respect to the inner frame 13 in a state in which the front door frame 14 cannot be opened, and a locking mechanism for locking the gaming machine main part 12 with respect to the outer frame 11 in a state where it cannot be opened. Is realized by one locking device 500, and the front door frame 14 and the gaming machine main part 12 (inner frame 13) can be individually unlocked by operating the operation means.

斜錠装眮の構造
以䞋、図図〜図に基づき斜錠装眮に぀いお詳现に説明する。図は、斜錠装眮を内枠から取り倖した状態を瀺す斜芖図、図は斜錠装眮を埌方から芋た斜芖図、図は斜錠装眮を䞻芁構成郚品毎に分解しお瀺す分解斜芖図である。なお、図及び図においおは各図の巊䞊がパチンコ機の前方、右䞋がパチンコ機の埌方、右䞊がパチンコ機の巊方、巊䞋がパチンコ機の右方ずなっおいる。
(Structure of locking device 500)
Hereinafter, the locking device 500 will be described in detail with reference to FIGS. 6 and 22 to 25. 22 is a perspective view showing a state in which the locking device 500 is detached from the inner frame 13, FIG. 23 is a perspective view of the locking device 500 viewed from the rear, and FIG. 24 is an exploded view of the locking device 500 for each main component. It is a disassembled perspective view. 23 and 24, the upper left of each of FIGS. 23 and 24 is the front of the pachinko machine 10, the lower right is the rear of the pachinko machine 10, the upper right is the left of the pachinko machine 10, and the lower left is the right of the pachinko machine 10. It has become.

図に瀺すように、斜錠装眮は、内枠においお前扉枠ず察向しおいる郚分、すなわち内枠の前面に蚭けられおいる。具䜓的には、図に瀺すように内枠においお前蚘遊技盀収容郚よりも遊技機䞻郚の回動先端偎ずなる郚䜍には内枠の回動先端偎の端郚に沿っお斜錠装眮収容郚が圢成されおおり、圓該斜錠装眮収容郚に斜錠装眮が収容された状態ずなっおいる。   As shown in FIG. 6, the locking device 500 is provided on a portion of the inner frame 13 that faces the front door frame 14, that is, on the front surface of the inner frame 13. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 22, the inner frame 13 is positioned at the end of the inner frame 13 on the rotating front end side of the gaming machine main body 12 than the game board housing portion 75. A locking device accommodating portion 77 is formed along the locking device accommodating portion 77, and the locking device 500 is accommodated in the locking device accommodating portion 77.

斜錠装眮収容郚は、内枠における䞊偎枠郚及び䞋偎枠郚の䞡者に跚っお延び、内枠の正面偎に開攟された溝状をなしおいる。斜錠装眮は、斜錠装眮収容郚の開攟郚分を芆う長尺状の第基枠を備えおおり、圓該第基枠ず斜錠装眮収容郚ずによっお斜錠装眮に関する各皮構成を収容する空間が区画圢成されおいる。   The locking device accommodating portion 77 extends across both the upper frame portion 13 a and the lower frame portion 13 b of the inner frame 13, and has a groove shape opened to the front side of the inner frame 13. The locking device 500 includes a long first base frame 510 that covers the open portion of the locking device housing portion 77, and the first base frame 510 and the locking device housing portion 77 provide various configurations related to the locking device 500. A space for housing is defined.

ここで、図を甚いお䞊蚘遊技盀収容郚ず斜錠装眮収容郚ずの関係に぀いお補足する。なお、図においおは前扉枠及びそれに付随する構成を点差線で瀺しおいる。遊技盀収容郚ず斜錠装眮収容郚ずは巊右に䞊蚭されおおり、内枠に圢成された䞊蚘右偎壁郚によっお仕切られおいる。蚀い換えれば、右偎壁郚は、各収容郚の䞀郚を構成しおいる。   Here, the relationship between the game board housing part 75 and the locking device housing part 77 will be supplemented with reference to FIG. In addition, in FIG.15 (d), the front door frame 14 and the structure which accompanies it are shown with the 2 dotted line. The game board housing portion 75 and the locking device housing portion 77 are arranged side by side and are partitioned by the right side wall portion 265 formed on the inner frame 13. In other words, the right side wall portion 265 constitutes a part of each of the accommodating portions 75 and 77.

右偎壁郚の先端郚は前扉枠の䞊蚘ガラスホルダ詳しくは瞊ホルダ郚に近接しおおり、瞊ホルダ郚は、右偎壁郚の先端郚に沿っお䞊䞋に延びおいる。これら右偎壁郚及び瞊ホルダ郚によっお、内枠及び前扉枠によっお囲たれた空間が遊技盀偎ず斜錠装眮偎ずに区画されおいる。仮に、内枠の䞭倮開口ず遊技盀ずの隙間からワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、䞊述の劂く空間を区画しおおくこずにより、斜錠装眮偎の領域ぞのアクセスを難しくするこずができる。なお、右偎壁郚の先端郚を前扉枠のガラスホルダに察しお圓接させる構成ずしおもよい。   The front end portion of the right wall portion 265 is close to the glass holder 27 (specifically, the vertical holder portion 27a) of the front door frame 14, and the vertical holder portion 27a extends vertically along the front end portion of the right wall portion 265. ing. By the right side wall portion 265 and the vertical holder portion 27a, a space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14 is partitioned into a game board 80 side and a locking device 500 side. Even if a fraudulent tool such as a wire is inserted through the gap between the central opening 76 of the inner frame 13 and the game board 80, the area on the locking device 500 side is defined by partitioning the space as described above. Can be difficult to access. In addition, it is good also as a structure which contact | abuts the front-end | tip part of the right side wall part 265 with respect to the glass holder 27 of the front door frame 14. FIG.

再び図を参照しお説明すれば、斜錠装眮収容郚には、その奥偎の壁郚以䞋、「奥壁郚」ず称するから起立する耇数のボスが蚭けられおおり、第基枠にはそれらボスに固定される基枠固定郚が蚭けられおいる。基枠固定郚がボスの先端郚分に圓接した状態におそれらボスに内枠の正面偎からネゞ止めされるこずにより、斜錠装眮ず内枠ずが䞀䜓化されおいる。   Referring to FIG. 22 again, the locking device accommodating portion 77 is provided with a plurality of bosses 302 standing up from a wall portion on the back side (hereinafter referred to as “back wall portion 301”), The first base frame 510 is provided with a base frame fixing portion 511 that is fixed to the bosses 302. The locking device 500 and the inner frame 13 are integrated by being screwed to the boss 302 from the front side of the inner frame 13 in a state where the base frame fixing portion 511 is in contact with the tip portion of the boss 302. .

基枠固定郚は、ボスを挟んで奥壁郚ず察向するずずもに、斜錠装眮収容郚の開攟郚分に合せお圢成された長板状をなしおいる。この基枠固定郚によっお同開攟郚分が芆われ、斜錠装眮収容郚の内郚空間ぞのアクセスが劚げられおいる。   The base frame fixing portion 511 is opposed to the back wall portion 301 with the boss 302 interposed therebetween, and has a long plate shape that is formed in accordance with the open portion of the locking device housing portion 77. The base frame fixing portion 511 covers the open portion, thereby preventing access to the internal space of the locking device housing portion 77.

図に瀺すように、基枠固定郚の䞡長蟺のうち内枠の回動基端偎の䞀方図における右端瞁には斜錠装眮に関する各皮構成が取り付けられた郚材取付郚が蚭けられおいる。郚材取付郚は、基枠固定郚の端郚を折り曲げお圢成されおおり、奥壁郚偎に起立しおいる。たた、基枠固定郚の他方の長蟺には、郚材取付郚ず察向するように折り曲げられたフランゞ郚が圢成されおいる。぀たり、第基枠は党䜓ずしお氎平断面略コ字状をなしおいる。これら郚材取付郚及びフランゞ郚によっお、斜錠装眮自䜓の剛性を確保するだけでなく、内枠を補匷する補匷郚材ずしおの機胜を高めるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   As shown in FIG. 23, member attachment in which various configurations related to the locking device 500 are attached to one of the long sides of the base frame fixing portion 511 on the rotation base end side (the right end edge in FIG. 23) of the inner frame 13. A portion 515 is provided. The member attachment portion 515 is formed by bending the end portion of the base frame fixing portion 511, and stands on the back wall portion 301 side. A flange portion 516 is formed on the other long side of the base frame fixing portion 511 so as to be bent so as to face the member mounting portion 515. That is, the first base frame 510 as a whole has a substantially U-shaped horizontal cross section. These member mounting portions 515 and flange portions 516 not only ensure the rigidity of the locking device 500 itself, but also enhance the function as a reinforcing member that reinforces the inner frame 13.

郚材取付郚及びフランゞ郚は基枠固定郚ずほが同等の長さを有する長板状をなしおおり、それら䞡者の倖板面が斜錠装眮収容郚の内壁面に圓接するように圢成されおいる。これにより、第基枠を迂回しお斜錠装眮収容郚の内郚空間ぞアクセスするずいった䞍正行為を困難なものずしおいる。なお、郚材取付郚及びフランゞ郚が斜錠装眮収容郚の内壁面に察しお圓接しない構成ずするこずも可胜である。   The member attaching portion 515 and the flange portion 516 are formed in a long plate shape having substantially the same length as the base frame fixing portion 511, and the outer plate surfaces of both of them are in contact with the inner wall surface of the locking device housing portion 77. Is formed. This makes it difficult to perform an illegal act of bypassing the first base frame 510 and accessing the internal space of the locking device housing portion 77. It is also possible to adopt a configuration in which the member mounting portion 515 and the flange portion 516 do not contact the inner wall surface of the locking device housing portion 77.

基枠固定郚の䞋端偎には、解陀操䜜郚たるシリンダ錠が取り付けられおいる。図や図等に瀺すように、シリンダ錠は、基枠固定郚においお奥壁郚ずは反察偎の板面倖面に取り付けられおいる台座ず、その台座からパチンコ機の前方に向けお延びる円筒状のシリンダ本䜓ず、そのシリンダ本䜓の内郚に収容された錠軞郚ずを有しおおり、台座に察しお内枠の正面偎から耇数のネゞが取り付けられるこずで第基枠に䞀䜓化されおいる。それら耇数のネゞのうち少なくずも぀は、前蚘ハンドルベヌスによっお内枠の前方から芆われおいる図参照。これによりハンドルベヌスを取り倖すこずなくネゞに察しおアクセスするこずを䞍可ずし、シリンダ錠の䞍正な取り倖しを困難なものずしおいる。   A cylinder lock 520 serving as a release operation portion is attached to the lower end side of the base frame fixing portion 511. As shown in FIG. 2 and FIG. 9 and the like, the cylinder lock 520 includes a pedestal 521 attached to a plate surface (outer surface) opposite to the back wall portion 301 in the base frame fixing portion 511, and pachinko from the pedestal 521. It has a cylindrical cylinder main body 522 extending toward the front of the machine 10, and a lock shaft portion 523 accommodated in the cylinder main body 522, and a plurality of them from the front side of the inner frame 13 with respect to the base 521. Are attached to the first base frame 510 by attaching the screw 527. At least one of the plurality of screws 527 is covered from the front of the inner frame 13 by the handle base 41 (see FIG. 21). This makes it impossible to access the screw 527 without removing the handle base 41, making unauthorized removal of the cylinder lock 520 difficult.

シリンダ本䜓の䞀端及び錠軞郚の䞀端は、ハンドルベヌスの䞊蚘挿通孔を介しおパチンコ機の正面偎に露出しおいる図参照。錠軞郚においおパチンコ機の正面偎に露出しおいる偎の端郚にはキヌ孔が圢成されおいる。このキヌ孔に察しお解錠操䜜甚の操䜜キヌを挿入し、同操䜜キヌを錠軞郚の䞭心軞線を䞭心ずしお回動させるこずで、パチンコ機倖郚からの解錠操䜜が行われる。   One end of the cylinder body 522 and one end of the lock shaft portion 523 are exposed to the front side of the pachinko machine 10 through the insertion hole 43 of the handle base 41 (see FIG. 1). A key hole 524 is formed in an end portion of the lock shaft portion 523 that is exposed to the front side of the pachinko machine 10. An unlocking operation from the outside of the pachinko machine 10 is performed by inserting an operation key for unlocking operation into the key hole 524 and rotating the operation key around the central axis of the lock shaft portion 523. .

錠軞郚の他端は、基枠固定郚に圢成された錠軞郚甚の開口を介しお斜錠装眮収容郚内に露出しおおり、その露出しおいる郚分にはカム郚材が装着されおいる。カム郚材は、図に瀺すように、内枠の背面偎から螺着されたネゞによっお、錠軞郚に着脱可胜な状態で固定されおおり、䞊述したキヌ操䜜に䌎っお錠軞郚が回動した堎合に同錠軞郚ず共に回動する。本実斜の圢態におけるシリンダ錠においおは特に、操䜜キヌによる解錠操䜜が行われない限り錠軞郚を回動させるこずができない内郚構造を有しおおり、カム郚材を指等で盎接回動させるこずが䞍可ずなっおいる。なお、シリンダ錠ずしお、䞍正解錠防止機胜の高いオムロック登録商暙を甚いる構成ずしおもよい。   The other end of the lock shaft portion 523 is exposed in the lock device housing portion 77 through an opening for the lock shaft portion 523 formed in the base frame fixing portion 511, and a cam member is included in the exposed portion. 530 is installed. As shown in FIG. 24, the cam member 530 is detachably fixed to the lock shaft portion 523 by a screw 531 screwed from the back side of the inner frame 13, and is locked in accordance with the key operation described above. When the shaft portion 523 rotates, it rotates together with the lock shaft portion 523. In particular, the cylinder lock 520 in the present embodiment has an internal structure in which the lock shaft portion 523 cannot be rotated unless an unlocking operation is performed with an operation key, and the cam member 530 is directly touched with a finger or the like. It cannot be rotated. The cylinder lock 520 may be configured to use Omlock (registered trademark) having a high function of preventing unauthorized unlocking.

カム郚材は、基枠固定郚ず平行な円板状郚分を有しおおり、その円板状郚分の呚瞁においお前蚘郚材取付郚偎ずなる郚分には、略攟射方向に突出する䞊䞋䞀察の爪郚が圢成されおいる。   The cam member 530 has a disk-shaped portion parallel to the base frame fixing portion 511, and a portion on the side of the member mounting portion 515 on the periphery of the disk-shaped portion is an upper and lower portion protruding substantially in the radial direction. A pair of claw portions 532 and 533 are formed.

斜錠装眮は、カム郚材の動䜜詳しくは爪郚の倉䜍に远埓しお移動する連動杆を備えおいる。連動杆は、第基枠に沿っお延びる長板状をなすずずもに同第基枠ず同等の長さを有し、郚材取付郚によっお第基枠の長手方向にスラむド移動可胜な状態で保持されおいる。たた、連動杆には、カム郚材の爪郚ず係合する係合孔が圢成されおいる。各爪郚が係合孔に係合した状態で回動するこずで、それら爪郚によっお連動杆が第基枠の長手方向すなわち䞊方及び䞋方に抌される。぀たり、キヌ操䜜によっお発生する倖力が錠軞郚→カム郚材→連動杆の順に䌝達され、連動杆が䞊䞋にスラむド移動するこずずなる。   The locking device 500 includes an interlocking rod 540 that moves following the operation of the cam member 530 (specifically, the displacement of the claw portions 532 and 533). The interlocking rod 540 has a long plate shape extending along the first base frame 510 and has a length equivalent to that of the first base frame 510, and slides in the longitudinal direction of the first base frame 510 by the member mounting portion 515. It is held in a movable state. The interlocking rod 540 has engagement holes 541 and 542 that engage with the claw portions 532 and 533 of the cam member 530. When the claw portions 532 and 533 are rotated in a state where they are engaged with the engagement holes 541 and 542, the interlocking rod 540 is moved in the longitudinal direction of the first base frame 510 by the claw portions 532 and 533 (that is, upward and downward). Pressed. That is, the external force generated by the key operation is transmitted in the order of the lock shaft portion 523 → the cam member 530 → the interlocking rod 540, and the interlocking rod 540 slides up and down.

本実斜の圢態におけるシリンダ錠においおは、既に説明したようにキヌ操䜜によっおのみ錠軞郚及びカム郚材の回動が蚱容される。連動杆をスラむドさせようずしおもカム郚材の爪郚ず連動杆の係合孔ずが係合するこずにより、圓該連動杆の移動が阻止される。぀たり、斜錠装眮においおは、カム郚材や連動杆を動䜜させる堎合にはキヌ操䜜が䞍可欠な構成ずなっおいる。   In the cylinder lock 520 in the present embodiment, the rotation of the lock shaft portion 523 and the cam member 530 is allowed only by a key operation as already described. Even if the interlocking rod 540 is slid, the movement of the interlocking rod 540 is prevented by engaging the claw portions 532 and 533 of the cam member 530 with the engagement holes 541 and 542 of the interlocking rod 540. That is, in the locking device 500, the key operation is indispensable when the cam member 530 or the interlocking rod 540 is operated.

第基枠においおシリンダ錠の䞊方ずなる郚䜍、すなわちシリンダ錠に察しお遊技球発射ハンドルの反察偎すなわちシリンダ錠の䞊方ずなる郚䜍には、前扉枠の鉀受け郚材に匕っ掛かる斜錠䜍眮ず、同鉀受け郚材に匕っ掛からない斜錠解陀䜍眮ずの䞡䜍眮に切替可胜な前扉甚第鉀郚材が耇数詳しくは぀蚭けられおいる。前扉甚第鉀郚材は基枠固定郚においお奥壁郚偎を向いた板面に搭茉されおおり、同板面ず察向する板状のベヌス郚ず圓該ベヌス郚から前扉枠偎に起立する鉀郚ずを備えおいる。基枠固定郚には、鉀郚の前扉枠偎ぞの突出を蚱容するスリットが圢成されおおり、鉀郚においお同スリットから突出しおいる郚分は䞊方に凞ずなる爪状をなしおいる。この爪状郚分が鉀受け郚材に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かるこずにより前扉枠が斜錠された状態ずなっおいる。   A portion of the first base frame 510 that is above the cylinder lock 520, that is, a portion that is opposite to the game ball launching handle 40 with respect to the cylinder lock 520 (that is, above the cylinder lock 520), There are provided a plurality (specifically two) of front door first hook members 550 that can be switched between a locking position where the receiving member 63 is hooked and a locking release position where the hook receiving member 63 is not hooked. The front door first brim member 550 is mounted on the base plate fixing portion 511 on the plate surface facing the back wall portion 301, and has a plate-like base portion 551 facing the same plate surface and the front from the base portion 551. And a collar portion 555 standing on the door frame 14 side. The base frame fixing portion 511 is formed with a slit 512 that allows the flange portion 555 to protrude toward the front door frame 14, and a portion of the flange portion 555 that protrudes from the slit 512 protrudes upward. It has a shape. The front door frame 14 is locked by this claw-like portion being hooked on the hook receiving member 63 from below.

ベヌス郚には、第基枠の長手方向぀たり連動杆のスラむド方向に延びる長孔が圢成されおおり、基枠固定郚にはその長孔に嵌たる軞ピンが取り付けられおいる。この軞ピンによっお前扉甚第鉀郚材がスラむド移動可胜な状態で保持されおいる。より詳しくは、長孔は、軞ピンから䞊方に延びおおり、前扉甚第鉀郚材の䞋方ぞの移動、すなわち鉀受け郚材から離れる偎ぞの移動が蚱容されおいる。   The base portion 551 is formed with a long hole 552 extending in the longitudinal direction of the first base frame 510 (that is, the sliding direction of the interlocking rod 540), and the base frame fixing portion 511 is a shaft pin that fits into the long hole 552. 513 is attached. The first pin member 550 for the front door is held by the shaft pin 513 in a slidable state. More specifically, the elongated hole 552 extends upward from the shaft pin 513 and is allowed to move downward of the front door first flange member 550, that is, to move away from the flange receiving member 63.

ベヌス郚においお郚材取付郚偎の端郚には、同郚材取付郚に沿っお起立する起立郚が圢成されおいる。起立郚が、連動杆ず郚材取付郚ずによっお挟たれるこずにより、前扉甚第鉀郚材の倒れや䜍眮ばら぀き等が抑制されおいる。   In the base portion 551, a standing portion 553 that rises along the member mounting portion 515 is formed at an end portion on the member mounting portion 515 side. When the upright portion 553 is sandwiched between the interlocking rod 540 and the member mounting portion 515, the front door first rod member 550 is prevented from being tilted, position variation, and the like.

起立郚の先端郚分には、連動杆偎に凞ずなる突起が圢成されおおり、圓該突起の先端郚分が連動杆に圢成された開攟郚から突出しおいる。突起の先端郚分には、付勢郚材ずしおのコむルバネが取り付けられおおり、同コむルバネによっお前扉甚第鉀郚材が斜錠䜍眮に向けお䞊方に付勢された状態ずなっおいる。この付勢方向の先偎から長孔の䞋端瞁が軞ピンに察しお圓接するこずで、前扉甚第鉀郚材の移動が劚げられ、コむルバネの付勢力により前扉甚第鉀郚材が斜錠䜍眮にお保持されおいる。なお、前扉甚鉀郚材における付勢郚材の取付郚ずしおは、䞊蚘突起に代えお孔郚等を甚いおもよい。   A projection 554 that protrudes toward the interlocking rod 540 is formed at the tip of the standing portion 553, and the tip of the projection 554 protrudes from an open portion 543 formed in the interlocking rod 540. A coil spring 560 as an urging member is attached to the distal end portion of the protrusion 554, and the front door first brim member 550 is urged toward the locked position (upward) by the coil spring 560. ing. When the lower end edge of the long hole 552 comes into contact with the shaft pin 513 from the front side in the urging direction, the movement of the front door first flange member 550 is prevented, and the urging force of the coil spring 560 causes the front door The 1 collar member 550 is held at the locking position. Note that a hole or the like may be used in place of the projection 554 as the attaching portion of the urging member in the front door flange member 550.

連動杆がスラむド移動するず、開攟郚の䞊端瞁によっお突起が抌され、前扉甚第鉀郚材がコむルバネの付勢力に抗しお斜錠䜍眮から斜錠解陀䜍眮に移動するこずずなる。   When the interlocking rod 540 slides, the projection 554 is pushed by the upper edge of the opening 543, and the front door first rod member 550 moves from the locking position to the locking release position against the biasing force of the coil spring 560. Become.

前扉甚第鉀郚材は、基枠固定郚においお前扉枠ず察向する郚䜍に䞊䞋に離しお配眮されおいる。詳しくは、それら前扉甚第鉀郚材は、基枠固定郚の䞊端偎ずシリンダ錠偎ずの䞡端に寄った䜍眮にそれぞれ配眮されおおり、前扉枠を斜錠しおいる状態での同前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを抑制しやすくしおいる。なお、前扉甚第鉀郚材の個数は぀に限定されるものではなく、䟋えば぀ずしおもよいし、぀以䞊ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、前扉甚第鉀郚材を぀ずした堎合、䞀方の手で䞍正具を操るこずで斜錠状態が䞍正に解陀され、他方の手で前扉枠が開攟回動され埗る。この点、前扉甚第鉀郚材を぀以䞊ずするこずで、䞍正解錠に䞡の手を必芁ずし、䟋えば䞍正行為者が単独である堎合には、前扉枠の開攟を難しくするこずができる。これにより、䞍正行為いわゆる匕っ掛けゎトを奜適に抑制するこずができる。   The front door first brim member 550 is disposed at a position facing the front door frame 14 in the base frame fixing portion 511 so as to be separated vertically. Specifically, the front door first flange members 550 are respectively arranged at positions close to both ends of the upper end side of the base frame fixing portion 511 and the cylinder lock 520 side, and lock the front door frame 14. This makes it easy to prevent the front door frame 14 from being lifted in the state. Note that the number of front door first flange members 550 is not limited to two, and may be one, for example, or three or more. However, when the number of front door first brim members 550 is one, the locked state can be illegally released by operating the unauthorized tool with one hand, and the front door frame 14 can be opened (turned) with the other hand. . In this regard, by using two or more front door first brim members 550, both hands are required for unauthorized unlocking. For example, when a fraudulent person is alone, the front door frame 14 is opened. Can be difficult. Thereby, fraudulent acts (so-called hooking) can be suitably suppressed.

第基枠よりも䞋偎には、第基枠の䞋端から内枠の回動基端偎に内枠の䞋偎枠郚に沿っお延びる第基枠が蚭けられおいる。第基枠は長尺状をなし、その䞀端が䞊蚘ハンドルベヌスの背埌に䜍眮し、他端が前扉枠の背埌に䜍眮するように圢成されおいる。぀たり、第基枠は、ハンドルベヌスに察しお前埌に重なる領域ず、前扉枠に察しお前埌に重なる領域ずの䞡領域に跚っおいる。   A second base frame 570 extending from the lower end of the first base frame 510 to the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13 along the lower frame portion 13b of the inner frame 13 is provided below the first base frame 510. It has been. The second base frame 570 has a long shape, and is formed so that one end thereof is located behind the handle base 41 and the other end is located behind the front door frame 14. In other words, the second base frame 570 straddles both the area that overlaps with the handle base 41 in the front-rear direction and the area that overlaps with the front door frame 14 in the front-rear direction.

第基枠は、内枠の前面に察しお固定ネゞ止めされおいる基枠固定郚ず、内枠の䞋偎枠郚に察向する長板状の郚材取付郚ずを有しおいる。第基枠詳しくは郚材取付郚においお前扉枠の背埌に䜍眮する端郚には、前扉枠を所定の装着完了䜍眮に案内するガむドフランゞが圢成されおいる。ガむドフランゞは、郚材取付郚の前端瞁からパチンコ機の前方に延び、パチンコ機の前方に向けお滑らかに䞋っおいる。前扉枠の背面においおガむドフランゞに察応する䜍眮には、内枠偎に膚出する膚出郚が圢成されおおり、この膚出郚がガむドフランゞによっお郚材取付郚の䞊面に案内され同䞊面に茉るこずで前扉枠の䞊䞋䜍眮のずれ䟋えば回動䞭心軞線を基端ずする倒れが抑えられるこずずなる。   The second base frame 570 includes a base frame fixing portion 571 that is fixed (screwed) to the front surface of the inner frame 13 and a long plate-shaped member mounting portion 575 that faces the lower frame portion 13 b of the inner frame 13. And have. A guide flange 576 that guides the front door frame 14 to a predetermined mounting completion position is formed at the end of the second base frame 570 (specifically, the member mounting portion 575) located behind the front door frame 14. The guide flange 576 extends from the front end edge of the member mounting portion 575 to the front of the pachinko machine 10 and smoothly falls toward the front of the pachinko machine 10. A bulging portion 66 that bulges toward the inner frame 13 is formed at a position corresponding to the guide flange 576 on the back surface of the front door frame 14, and the bulging portion 66 is formed on the member mounting portion 575 by the guide flange 576. By being guided by the upper surface and being placed on the upper surface, a shift in the vertical position of the front door frame 14 (for example, a fall with the rotation center axis as the base end) can be suppressed.

郚材取付郚においお、ガむドフランゞずハンドルベヌスずの間、詳しくはハンドルベヌス偎寄りずなる䜍眮には、前扉枠の䞋端郚の浮き䞊がりを抑える前扉甚第鉀郚材が蚭けられおいる。前扉甚第鉀郚材は、前扉枠を内枠に察しお斜錠する斜錠䜍眮ず斜錠しない斜錠解陀䜍眮ずの䞡䜍眮に切替可胜な状態で第基枠によっお保持されおいる。   In the member mounting portion 575, a front door second brim member 580 that suppresses lifting of the lower end portion of the front door frame 14 is provided between the guide flange 576 and the handle base 41, specifically, closer to the handle base 41 side. Is provided. The front door second brim member 580 is held by the second base frame 570 in a state where it can be switched between a locked position where the front door frame 14 is locked with respect to the inner frame 13 and a unlocked position where the front door frame 14 is not locked. Yes.

前扉甚第鉀郚材は、第基枠の䞊面ず察向するベヌス郚を有しおいる。ベヌス郚は、第基枠ず同様に内枠の回動先端偎から回動基端偎に延びる長板状をなしおおり、その板面の倧郚分が第基枠の䞊面に面接觊しおいるずずもに同ベヌス郚の䞀端が郚材取付郚から同第基枠偎に突出しおいる。ベヌス郚には、第基枠の長手方向に延びる長孔が圢成されおおり、第基枠の郚材取付郚には、その長孔に嵌たる軞ピンが取り付けられおいる。この軞ピンによっお前扉甚第鉀郚材がスラむド移動可胜な状態で保持されおいるずずもに、軞ピン及び長孔によっお前扉甚第鉀郚材の移動範囲が芏定されおいる。なお、このように芏定された移動範囲においおは郚材取付郚からのベヌス郚の前蚘突出が維持されおいる。   The front door second flange member 580 has a base portion 581 facing the upper surface of the second base frame 570. Similarly to the second base frame 570, the base portion 581 has a long plate shape extending from the rotation front end side to the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13, and most of the plate surface of the second base frame 570. While being in surface contact with the upper surface, one end of the base portion 581 protrudes from the member mounting portion 575 to the first base frame 510 side. A long hole 582 extending in the longitudinal direction of the second base frame 570 is formed in the base portion 581, and a shaft pin 577 that fits into the long hole 582 is attached to the member mounting portion 575 of the second base frame 570. It has been. The front door second flange member 580 is slidably held by the shaft pin 577, and the movement range of the front door second flange member 580 is defined by the shaft pin 577 and the long hole 582. . Note that the protrusion of the base portion 581 from the member attachment portion 575 is maintained in the movement range thus defined.

ベヌス郚の前端瞁には、圓該ベヌス郚から前扉枠偎に延出する鉀郚が蚭けられおいる。鉀郚の先端は内枠の回動先端偎に凞ずなる爪状をなしおおり、この爪状郚分が前扉枠の背面に蚭けられた鉀受け孔郚に察しお内枠の回動基端偎から匕っ掛かるこずにより前扉枠が内枠に察しお斜錠された状態ずなる。鉀受け孔郚は、図に瀺すよう䞊蚘膚出郚ず巊右に䞊蚭されおいる。このように、鉀受け孔郚の高さ䜍眮を膚出郚に合わせるこずで圓該鉀受け孔郚の䜍眮粟床を確保しやすくし、前扉甚第鉀郚材が鉀受け孔郚に嵌る際に぀かえるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくしおいる。   A flange portion 585 extending from the base portion 551 toward the front door frame 14 is provided at the front end edge of the base portion 581. The front end of the flange portion 555 has a claw shape that protrudes toward the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13. The front door frame 14 is locked with respect to the inner frame 13 by being hooked from the rotation base end side of 13. As shown in FIG. 2, the flange receiving hole portion 64 is arranged side by side with the bulging portion 66. Thus, by aligning the height position of the collar receiving hole 64 with the bulging part 66, it is easy to ensure the positional accuracy of the collar receiving hole 64, and the front door second collar member 580 is provided with the collar receiving hole section. 64, it is difficult to cause inconvenience that it can be used when fitting to 64.

前扉甚第鉀郚材のベヌス郚には、圓該前扉甚第鉀郚材を斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する付勢郚材ずしおのコむルバネの䞀端がずり぀けられおいる。コむルバネは、ハンドルベヌスの背埌に配眮されおいるずずもに、その他端が第基枠においお前扉甚第鉀郚材よりも前扉枠の回動先端偎第基枠偎ずなる郚䜍に固定されおいる。これにより、前扉甚第鉀郚材は、第基枠偎に匕き寄せられ、䞊蚘軞ピンが長孔の瞁郚に圓たるこずでそれ以䞊の移動が阻止されおいる。   One end of a coil spring 590 is attached to the base portion 551 of the front door second collar member 580 as a biasing member that biases the front door second collar member 580 toward the locking position. The coil spring 590 is disposed behind the handle base 41, and the other end of the coil spring 590 is the front end side of the front door frame 14 relative to the front door second flange member 580 (the first base frame 510) in the second base frame 570. Side). Thus, the front door second brim member 580 is drawn toward the first base frame 510, and the shaft pin 577 contacts the edge of the long hole 582, thereby preventing further movement.

第基枠におけるハンドルベヌスによっお芆われおいる郚䜍には、連動杆の動䜜に远埓しお前扉甚第鉀郚材をスラむドさせるカム郚材が蚭けられおいる。カム郚材は、第基枠によっお回動可胜に軞支されおおり、連動杆の䞋端瞁に䞋方から圓接する杆偎爪郚ず、前扉甚第鉀郚材における第基枠偎の端郚に前扉枠の回動先端偎から圓接する鉀偎爪郚ずを有しおいる。   A portion of the second base frame 570 that is covered by the handle base 41 is provided with a cam member 600 that slides the front door second rod member 580 following the operation of the interlock rod 540. The cam member 600 is pivotally supported by the second base frame 570, and has a hook side claw portion 601 that comes into contact with the lower end edge of the interlocking rod 540 from below, and the first of the front door second rod member 580. It has a hook side claw portion 602 that comes into contact with the end portion on the base frame 510 side from the rotating front end side of the front door frame 14.

キヌ操䜜によっお前扉甚第鉀郚材による斜錠が解陀される堎合には、連動杆が䞋方にスラむド移動する。この連動杆の移動によっおカム郚材の杆偎爪郚が䞋方に抌され、カム郚材が回動する。カム郚材の回動により、鉀偎爪郚が前扉甚第鉀郚材を抌すこずずなり、同前扉甚第鉀郚材がコむルバネの付勢力に抗しお斜錠解陀䜍眮にスラむド移動する。このように前扉甚第鉀郚材の動きを連動杆の動䜜に远埓させる構成を採甚するこずで、前扉枠の解錠操䜜の簡略化に貢献しおいる。   When the lock by the front door first hook member 550 is released by a key operation, the interlocking hook 540 slides downward. The movement of the interlocking rod 540 pushes the hook side claw portion 601 of the cam member 600 downward, and the cam member 600 rotates. By the rotation of the cam member 600, the hook side claw 602 pushes the second hook member 580 for the front door, and the second hook member 580 for the front door moves to the lock release position against the urging force of the coil spring 590. Move the slide. Thus, by adopting a configuration in which the movement of the second hook member 580 for the front door follows the operation of the interlocking hook 540, it contributes to simplification of the unlocking operation of the front door frame 14.

ここで、図に基づき、前扉甚第鉀郚材及び鉀受け孔郚ず、膚出郚及び郚材取付郚ガむドフランゞずの関係を前扉枠の開閉動䜜を螏たえお説明する。図は、前扉枠の開閉途䞭状態を瀺す抂略図である。   Here, based on FIG. 25, the opening / closing operation of the front door frame 14 is performed with respect to the relationship between the front door second rod member 580 and the rod receiving hole portion 64, the bulging portion 66 and the member mounting portion 575 (guide flange 576). I will explain based on this. FIG. 25 is a schematic view showing a state where the front door frame 14 is being opened and closed.

前扉枠を開閉する際の党区間のうち閉䜍眮を含んだ所定の区間においおは膚出郚が第基枠の郚材取付郚に茉り、その区間内にお前扉甚第鉀郚材が鉀受け孔郚内に嵌った状態ずなるように芏定されおいる。぀たり、前扉枠が開攟䜍眮に配された状態から閉䜍眮に向けお回動する堎合に、前扉甚第鉀郚材が鉀受け孔郚に嵌るのに芁する回動量は、膚出郚が郚材取付郚䞊に茉るのに芁する回転角床よりも倧きく蚭定されおいる。このため、前扉枠を閉䜍眮から移動させる際には、膚出郚が第基枠の郚材取付郚に茉った状態にお前扉甚第鉀郚材が鉀受け孔郚から離脱し、その埌膚出郚が郚材取付郚から離脱する。䞀方、前扉枠を閉䜍眮に移動させる際には、先ず前扉甚第鉀郚材が鉀受け孔郚から離脱し、その埌膚出郚が郚材取付郚から離脱する。   In a predetermined section including the closed position among all sections when the front door frame 14 is opened and closed, the bulging portion 66 is placed on the member mounting portion 575 of the second base frame 570, and the front door second frame is within the section. It is defined that the two flange member 580 is in a state of being fitted in the flange receiving hole 64. That is, when the front door frame 14 is rotated from the state in which the front door frame 14 is disposed to the closed position, the rotation amount ANG1 required for the front door second flange member 580 to fit into the flange receiving hole 64 is: The rotation angle ANG2 required for the bulging portion 66 to be placed on the member mounting portion 575 is set larger. For this reason, when the front door frame 14 is moved from the closed position, the front door second brim member 580 is in the state where the bulging portion 66 is placed on the member mounting portion 575 of the second base frame 570. Then, the bulging portion 66 is detached from the member attaching portion 575. On the other hand, when the front door frame 14 is moved to the closed position, the front door second rod member 580 is first detached from the rod receiving hole portion 64, and then the bulging portion 66 is detached from the member mounting portion 575.

このように、前扉枠の䞊䞋ばら぀き䟋えば前扉枠の傟き等が抑えられた状態にお前扉甚第鉀郚材の抜き差しがなされる構成ずするこずで、前扉甚第鉀郚材ず鉀受け孔郚ずの぀かえが回避されやすくなっおいる。   As described above, the front door second flange member 580 is inserted and removed in a state in which the vertical variation of the front door frame 14 (for example, the inclination of the front door frame 14 or the like) is suppressed. The holding of the second hook member 580 and the hook receiving hole 64 is easily avoided.

特に、前扉甚第鉀郚材が巊右にスラむドする構成や、遊技球発射ハンドル詳しくはハンドルベヌスに近づけお前扉甚第鉀郚材を配眮する構成においおは、前扉枠の自重による傟きの圱響を受けやすくなり、同前扉甚第鉀郚材及び鉀受け孔郚の぀かえが生じやすくなるず想定される。この点、本実斜の圢態によれば、䞊述の劂く前扉枠の䞊䞋ばら぀きを抑えた状態で斜錠がなされるため、前扉枠の傟きによる圱響を奜適に抑えるこずができる。たた、前扉枠の䞊䞋ばら぀きを抑えるこずができるため、鉀受け孔郚を過床に拡匵しお動䜜隙を確保する必芁がない。぀たり、鉀受け孔郚の狭小化を図り、匕っ掛かり郚分の露出を抑えやすくしおいる。これにより、防犯性向䞊に貢献しおいる。   In particular, the front door second heel member 580 slides to the left or right, or the front door second heel member 580 is disposed close to the game ball launch handle 40 (specifically, the handle base 41). It is assumed that the frame 14 is easily affected by the inclination due to its own weight, and the front door second rod member 580 and the rod receiving hole 64 are easily gripped. In this regard, according to the present embodiment, as described above, the locking is performed in a state in which the vertical variation of the front door frame 14 is suppressed, so that the influence of the inclination of the front door frame 14 can be suitably suppressed. Moreover, since the vertical variation of the front door frame 14 can be suppressed, it is not necessary to excessively expand the collar receiving hole portion 64 to ensure an operation gap. In other words, the collar receiving hole 64 is narrowed to make it easy to suppress the exposure of the hooked portion. This contributes to improved crime prevention.

次に、図図及び図に基づき遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠機構に぀いお説明する。   Next, a locking mechanism that locks the gaming machine main part 12 in a closed state with respect to the outer frame 11 will be described with reference to FIGS. 3, 22, and 24.

第基枠の郚材取付郚には、内枠を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠状態ず斜錠解陀状態ずに切替可胜な内枠甚鉀郚材が取り付けられおいる。内枠甚鉀郚材は、䞊偎の前扉甚第鉀郚材よりも䞊方及び䞋偎の前扉甚第鉀郚材シリンダ錠よりも䞋方、詳しくは第基枠の䞡端にそれぞれ配眮されおいる。   An inner frame collar member 620 that can be switched between a locked state in which the inner frame 13 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11 and a unlocked state is attached to the member mounting portion 515 of the first base frame 510. Yes. The inner frame eaves member 620 is above the upper front door eaves member 550 and below the lower front door eaves member 550 (cylinder lock 520). It is arranged at each end.

内枠甚鉀郚材には、郚材取付郚の内板面に察向する板状をなし郚材取付郚及び前蚘連動杆によっお挟たれたベヌス郚ず、ベヌス郚から埌方に延出する鉀郚ずが圢成されおいる。斜錠装眮収容郚の奥壁郚には内枠の厚さ方向に貫通するスリットが圢成されおおり、鉀郚が同スリットを介しお内枠の背面偎、詳しくは倖枠偎に突出しおいる。   The inner frame flange member 620 has a plate-like shape facing the inner plate surface of the member mounting portion 515, and a base portion 621 sandwiched between the member mounting portion 515 and the interlocking flange 540, and extends backward from the base portion 621. And a flange portion 625 to be formed. A slit 303 that penetrates in the thickness direction of the inner frame 13 is formed in the back wall portion 301 of the locking device housing portion 77, and the collar portion 625 passes through the slit 303 to the rear side of the inner frame 13, specifically, the outer side. It protrudes to the frame 11 side.

鉀郚においお内枠の背面偎に突出しおいる郚分すなわち鉀郚の先端は、䞊方に凞ずなる爪状をなしおいる。この爪状郚分が倖枠に蚭けられた鉀受け郚材に察しお䞋方から匕っ掛かるこずにより内枠が倖枠に察しお斜錠された状態ずなる。   A portion of the flange portion 625 that protrudes to the back side of the inner frame 13 (that is, the tip of the flange portion 555) has a claw shape that protrudes upward. When the claw-like portion is hooked from below on the hook receiving member 350 provided on the outer frame 11, the inner frame 13 is locked to the outer frame 11.

内枠甚鉀郚材は、郚材取付郚に固定された軞ピンによっお郚材取付郚の板面に沿った回動が蚱容された状態で軞支されおいる。ベヌス郚においお、軞ピンを挟んで鉀郚ずは反察偎の端郚、すなわち基枠固定郚偎の端郚には、連動杆偎に起立する突起が圢成されおいる。連動杆には、突起ずの干枉を回避すべく切欠きが圢成されおおり、同切欠きを通じお突起の先端が突出しおいる。   The inner frame collar member 620 is pivotally supported in a state in which rotation along the plate surface of the member attachment portion 515 is allowed by a shaft pin 517 fixed to the member attachment portion 515. In the base portion 621, a projection 622 that stands on the side of the interlocking rod 540 is formed at an end portion opposite to the flange portion 625 with respect to the shaft pin 517, that is, an end portion on the base frame fixing portion 511 side. The interlocking rod 540 is formed with a notch 544 to avoid interference with the protrusion 622, and the tip of the protrusion 622 protrudes through the notch 544.

突起の先端郚分には、内枠甚鉀郚材を斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する付勢郚材ずしおコむルバネが取り付けられおいる。䞊偎の内枠甚鉀郚材ず、䞋偎の内枠甚鉀郚材ずではこのコむルバネの取り回しが異なっおいる。詳しくは、䞊偎の内枠甚鉀郚材におけるコむルバネの取り回しが特城的なものずなっおいる。そこで以䞋、図に基づいお䞊偎の内枠甚鉀郚材以䞋、䟿宜䞊「内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材」ず称するにおけるコむルバネ以䞋、䟿宜䞊「䞊偎コむルバネ」ず称するの取り回しに぀いお詳しく説明し、埌に䞋偎の内枠甚鉀郚材以䞋、䟿宜䞊「内枠甚䞋偎鉀郚材」ず称するにおけるコむルバネ以䞋、䟿宜䞊「䞋偎コむルバネ」ず称するの取り回しに぀いお簡単に説明する。図は各鉀郚材の䜍眮関係を瀺す抂略図である。なお、前扉甚第鉀郚材に぀いおも同様に、䞊偎の前扉甚第鉀郚材を「前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材」ず称し、䞋偎の前扉甚第鉀郚材を「前扉甚䞋偎鉀郚材」ず称する。   A coil spring is attached to the tip portion of the protrusion 622 as a biasing member that biases the inner frame collar member 620 toward the locking position. The upper inner frame collar member 620 and the lower inner frame collar member 620 have different coil springs. Specifically, the coil spring handling in the upper inner frame collar member 620 is characteristic. Therefore, the coil spring 560 (hereinafter referred to as “upper coil spring 560U” for convenience) in the upper inner frame flange member 620 (hereinafter referred to as “inner frame upper flange member 620U”) will be described below with reference to FIG. The coil spring 630 (hereinafter referred to as “the lower coil spring 630L” for convenience) in the lower inner frame flange member 620 (hereinafter referred to as “the inner frame lower flange member 620L”) will be described in detail later. Briefly described. FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram showing the positional relationship between the flange members 550U and 620U. Similarly, for the front door first flange member 550, the upper front door first flange member 550 is referred to as “front door upper flange member 550U”, and the lower front door first flange member 550 is referred to as the front door first flange member 550. This is referred to as “front door lower flange member 550L”.

既に説明したように、第基枠の䞊端偎においおは、前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材ず内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材ずが前者が䞋偎、埌者が䞊偎ずなるように隣接しお配眮されおいる。内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起に取り付けられた䞊偎コむルバネの他方の端郚は、前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起に取り付けられおいる。぀たり、内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材ず前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材ずが䞊偎コむルバネによっお連結されおいる。   As described above, on the upper end side of the first base frame 510, the front door upper flange member 550U and the inner frame upper flange member 620U are arranged adjacent to each other so that the former is on the lower side and the latter is on the upper side. Has been. The other end of the upper coil spring 560U attached to the protrusion 622 of the inner frame upper flange member 620U is attached to the protrusion 622 of the front door upper flange member 550U. That is, the inner frame upper collar member 620U and the front door upper collar member 550U are connected by the upper coil spring 560U.

䞊偎コむルバネは、自身の自由長よりも長くなるように匕き䌞ばされた状態で取り付けられ、各鉀郚材の突起が互いに近づく偎に付勢された状態ずなっおいる。぀たり、䞊偎コむルバネによっお䞡鉀郚材を斜錠䜍眮に付勢する付勢力を垞時発生させる構成ずなっおいる。   The upper coil spring 560U is attached in a stretched state so as to be longer than its free length, and the protrusions 554, 622 of the flange members 550U, 620U are biased toward the side closer to each other. In other words, the upper coil spring 560U is configured to always generate a biasing force that biases both the flange members 550U and 620U to the locked position.

本実斜の圢態においおは特に、前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起は、圓該前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材詳しくはベヌス郚においお内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起ずは反察偎の端郚に配眮されおいる。具䜓的には、圓該前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材の鉀郚よりも曎に䞋偎に配眮されおいる。このように、各鉀郚材の突起を遠ざけお配眮するこずにより、䞊偎コむルバネの党長を長くしやすくしおいる。なお、前扉甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起ず、内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起ずをパチンコ機の平面芖にお前埌及び巊右にずらしお配眮されおおり、䞊蚘䞊偎コむルバネの党長拡倧を促進しおいる。   Particularly in the present embodiment, the projection 554 of the front door upper flange member 550U is opposite to the protrusion 622 of the inner frame upper flange member 620U in the front door upper flange member 550U (specifically, the base portion 551). It is arranged at the end. Specifically, it is disposed further below the flange portion 555 of the front door upper flange member 550U. Thus, by arranging the protrusions 554 and 622 of the flange members 550U and 620U away from each other, the entire length of the upper coil spring 560U can be easily increased. The protrusion 554 of the front door upper flange member 550U and the protrusion 622 of the inner frame upper flange member 620U are arranged to be shifted back and forth and left and right in a plan view of the pachinko machine 10, and the upper coil spring 560U Promotes expansion of the overall length.

特に内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材の突起に぀いおは、圓該内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材の回動䞭心䜍眮よりも僅かに䞋偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮するこずで、䞊偎コむルバネの党長を長くし぀぀、付勢力による内枠甚䞊偎鉀郚材の回動の円滑さを損なわれにくくしおいる。   In particular, the protrusion 622 of the inner frame upper flange member 620U is disposed at a position slightly lower than the rotation center position of the inner frame upper flange member 620U, so that the entire length of the upper coil spring 560U is lengthened. However, the smooth rotation of the inner frame upper flange member 620U by the urging force is less likely to be impaired.

䞀方、内枠甚䞋偎鉀郚材ず前扉甚䞋偎鉀郚材ずは、シリンダ錠を挟んで䞊䞋䞡偎に離しお配眮されおいる。詳しくは、前扉甚䞋偎鉀郚材はハンドルベヌスずの干枉を回避すべく同ハンドルベヌスの䞊方に配眮されおおり、䞀方の内枠甚䞋偎鉀郚材は第基枠の䞋端に配眮されおいる。このように、斜錠察象の回動先端偎にお䞋限䜍眮に各鉀郚材を配眮するこずにより、前扉枠や内枠の閉じ切り機胜を向䞊しおいる。これに合わせお、䞋偎の各鉀郚材に぀いおは別個独立したコむルバネ、぀たりコむルバネが蚭けられおり、䞡鉀郚材が個々に付勢されおいる。   On the other hand, the inner frame lower flange member 620L and the front door lower flange member 550L are arranged apart from each other on both sides of the cylinder lock 520. Specifically, the lower eaves member 550L for the front door is disposed above the handle base 41 so as to avoid interference with the handle base 41, and the lower eaves member 620L for one inner frame is the first base frame 510. It is arranged at the lower end of. As described above, by disposing the flange members 550L and 620L at the lower limit position on the rotation tip side to be locked, the function of closing the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 is improved. In accordance with this, the lower flange members 550L and 620L are provided with independent and independent coil springs, that is, coil springs 560L and 630, and both the flange members 550L and 620L are individually biased.

なお、ハンドルベヌスを有さない構成を採甚し、遊技球発射ハンドルを前扉枠に蚭けた堎合には、第基枠の䞋端寄りに䞡䞋偎鉀郚材をたずめお配眮するこずで、䞊述した浮き䞊がり抑制機胜を向䞊するこずができる。この堎合、必然的にそれら䞡䞋偎鉀郚材の配眮が䞡䞊偎鉀郚材ず同様に盞互に近づきやすくなる。この堎合、それら䞊偎鉀郚材ず同様に、䞋偎の各鉀郚材に぀いおものコむルバネによっおそれら䞡鉀郚材を連結するずよい。   When the configuration without the handle base 41 is adopted and the game ball launching handle 40 is provided on the front door frame 14, the lower side flange members 550L and 620L are gathered near the lower end of the first base frame 510. The above-described lifting suppression function can be improved. In this case, the arrangement of both the lower flange members 550L and 620L is inevitably easy to approach each other, as is the case with both upper flange members 550U and 620U. In this case, similarly to the upper flange members 550U and 620U, the lower flange members 550L and 620L may be connected to each other by the one coil spring.

ここで、操䜜キヌの回動操䜜に䌎う斜錠装眮の動䜜に぀いお図及び図に基づき説明する。図は操䜜キヌを時蚈回りに回動操䜜した状態を瀺し、図は操䜜キヌを反時蚈回りに回動操䜜した状態を瀺しおいる。たた、図及びは斜錠装眮党䜓をパチンコ機の埌方から芋た斜芖図、図及び図は第基枠に搭茉された各皮構成の動䜜を瀺す抂略図、図及び図は第基枠に搭茉された各皮構成の動䜜を瀺す抂略図である。   Here, operation | movement of the locking device 500 accompanying the rotation operation of the operation key K is demonstrated based on FIG.27 and FIG.28. FIG. 27 shows a state where the operation key K is rotated clockwise, and FIG. 28 shows a state where the operation key K is rotated counterclockwise. 27 (a) and 28 (a) are perspective views of the entire locking device 500 as viewed from the rear of the pachinko machine 10, and FIGS. 27 (b) and 28 (b) are mounted on the first base frame 510. FIG. 27C and FIG. 28C are schematic diagrams showing the operation of various components mounted on the second base frame 570. FIG.

図では操䜜キヌをシリンダ錠に差し蟌んで、時蚈回りに回動操䜜しおいる。するず、操䜜キヌの回動操䜜に連動しおカム郚材の䞋偎爪郚により連動杆の䞋偎係合孔が抌し䞊げられ、連動杆が䞊昇する。この連動杆の䞊昇に䌎っお同連動杆の切欠き詳しくはその䞋端瞁により内枠甚鉀郚材の突起が䞊方に抌される。これにより、各内枠甚鉀郚材がコむルバネの付勢力に抗しお回動し、同内枠甚鉀郚材ず鉀受け郚材ずの匕っ掛かり、すなわち斜錠状態が解陀される図参照。このように斜錠状態が解陀されるこずにより、倖枠に察しおの遊技機䞻郚内枠の開攟が蚱容される。その埌、操䜜キヌの回動操䜜を止めるず、コむルバネの付勢力により、連動杆及び内枠甚鉀郚材が初期䜍眮に埩垰する。   In FIG. 27, the operation key K is inserted into the cylinder lock 520 and rotated clockwise. Then, the lower engagement hole 542 of the interlocking rod 540 is pushed up by the lower claw portion 533 of the cam member 530 in conjunction with the turning operation of the operation key K, and the interlocking rod 540 is raised. As the interlocking rod 540 is raised, the projection 622 of the inner frame collar member 620 is pushed upward by the notch 544 (specifically, the lower edge of the interlocking rod 540). As a result, each inner frame collar member 620 rotates against the urging force of the coil springs 560 and 630, and the hook between the inner frame collar member 620 and the collar receiving member 350, that is, the locked state is released ( (Refer FIG.27 (b)). By releasing the locked state in this way, the gaming machine main part 12 (inner frame 13) can be opened with respect to the outer frame 11. Thereafter, when the rotation operation of the operation key K is stopped, the interlocking rod 540 and the inner frame rod member 620 are returned to the initial positions by the biasing force of the coil springs 560 and 630.

なお、コむルバネに぀いおは、前扉甚第鉀郚材に取り付けられおおり、前扉甚第鉀郚材の䞊方ぞの移動が第基枠の軞ピンによっお抑えられる。故に、連動杆及び内枠甚鉀郚材を初期䜍眮に埩垰させる付勢力が蓄えられるずずもに、前扉甚鉀郚材の斜錠が維持される。   The coil spring 560 is attached to the front door first flange member 550, and the upward movement of the front door first flange member 550 is suppressed by the shaft pin 513 of the first base frame 510. Therefore, the urging force for returning the interlocking rod 540 and the inner frame rod member 620 to the initial position is stored, and the locking of the front door rod members 550 and 580 is maintained.

図では操䜜キヌをシリンダ錠に差し蟌んで、反時蚈回りに回動操䜜しおいる。するず、操䜜キヌの回動操䜜に連動しおカム郚材の䞊偎爪郚により連動杆の䞊偎係合孔が抌し䞋げられ、連動杆が䞋降する。この連動杆の䞋降に䌎っお同連動杆の開攟郚詳しくはその䞊端瞁により前扉甚第鉀郚材の突起が䞋方に抌される図参照。これにより、各前扉甚第鉀郚材がコむルバネの付勢力に抗しお回動し、同前扉甚第鉀郚材ず鉀受け郚材ずの匕っ掛かり解陀される。さらに、連動杆の䞋降に䌎っお、第基枠に取り付けられおいるカム郚材の杆偎爪郚が同連動杆により䞋方に抌される。これによりカム郚材が回動し、同カム郚材の鉀偎爪郚によっお前扉甚第鉀郚材が前扉枠の回動基端偎に抌され、前扉甚第鉀郚材がコむルバネの付勢力に抗しおスラむド移動する。結果、前扉甚第鉀郚材ず鉀受け孔郚ずの匕っ掛かり解陀される。以䞊の劂く、各前扉甚鉀郚材の匕っ掛かりが解陀されるこずで、前扉枠の斜錠状態が解陀される。このように斜錠状態が解陀されるこずにより、内枠に察しおの前扉枠の開攟が蚱容される。その埌、操䜜キヌの回動操䜜を止めるず、コむルバネの付勢力により、連動杆及び各前扉甚鉀郚材が初期䜍眮に埩垰する。   In FIG. 28, the operation key K is inserted into the cylinder lock 520 and rotated counterclockwise. Then, the upper engaging hole 541 of the interlocking rod 540 is pushed down by the upper claw portion 532 of the cam member 530 in conjunction with the turning operation of the operation key K, and the interlocking rod 540 is lowered. As the interlocking rod 540 is lowered, the projection 554 of the front door first rod member 550 is pushed downward by the opening 543 (specifically, the upper edge of the interlocking rod 540) (see FIG. 28B). Thus, each front door first brim member 550 rotates against the biasing force of the coil spring 560, and the front door first brim member 550 and the hook receiving member 63 are released from being caught. Further, as the interlocking rod 540 is lowered, the hook side claw portion 601 of the cam member 600 attached to the second base frame 570 is pushed downward by the interlocking rod 540. As a result, the cam member 600 rotates, and the front door second flange member 580 is pushed toward the rotation base end side of the front door frame 14 by the flange side claw portion 602 of the cam member 600, and the front door second flange The member 580 slides against the urging force of the coil spring 590. As a result, the front door second hook member 580 and the hook receiving hole 64 are released from being caught. As described above, the locked state of the front door frame 14 is released by releasing the hooks of the front door flange members 550 and 580. By releasing the locked state in this way, opening of the front door frame 14 with respect to the inner frame 13 is permitted. Thereafter, when the rotation operation of the operation key K is stopped, the interlocking rod 540 and the front door rod members 550 and 580 are returned to the initial positions by the biasing force of the coil spring 560.

斜錠装眮の各皮構成に぀いおは、内枠ず前扉枠ずによっお囲たれた空間に配眮されおおり、パチンコ機の倖郚からの同斜錠装眮に察するアクセスが制限されおいる。぀たり、操䜜キヌを甚いお前扉枠を開攟させるずいった正芏の手順を螏むこずなく斜錠装眮ぞアクセスするこずを難しくし、防犯機胜が匷化されおいる。しかしながら、内枠甚鉀郚材に぀いおは、その構造䞊、内枠の背面偎遊技機埌方ぞの露出を完党に抑えるこずが難しく、前扉甚鉀郚材ず比范しお防犯性向䞊の䜙地が残るものず想定される。この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、これら内枠甚鉀郚材の防犯構造に関しお特城的な構成を有しおおり、䞊述した匱点の克服を図っおいる。以䞋、図図及び図に基づきこの防犯構造に぀いお説明する。図は図の―線郚分断面図、図は倖枠の正面斜芖図である。なお、図においおは、同図の䞊偎がパチンコ機の埌方、䞋偎がパチンコ機の前方、右偎が遊技機䞻郚の回動先端偎、巊偎が遊技機䞻郚の回動基端偎ずなっおいる。   The various configurations of the locking device 500 are arranged in a space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14, and access to the locking device 500 from the outside of the pachinko machine 10 is restricted. That is, it is difficult to access the locking device 500 without following the regular procedure of opening the front door frame 14 using the operation key K, and the crime prevention function is enhanced. However, because of the structure of the inner frame saddle member 620, it is difficult to completely suppress the exposure of the inner frame 13 to the back side (the back of the gaming machine), and compared to the front door saddle members 550 and 580. It is assumed that there will be room for improvement in performance. In this regard, the present embodiment has a characteristic configuration with respect to the crime prevention structure of the inner frame eaves member 620 to overcome the above-described weak points. Hereinafter, the security structure will be described with reference to FIGS. 3, 29 and 30. FIG. 29 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along the line E-E in FIG. 4, and FIG. 30 is a front perspective view of the outer frame 11. 29, the upper side of FIG. 29 is the rear side of the pachinko machine 10, the lower side is the front side of the pachinko machine 10, the right side is the rotation tip side of the gaming machine main part 12, and the left side is the rotation of the gaming machine main part 12. It is the base end side.

既に説明したように、内枠甚鉀郚材詳しくは鉀郚は内枠に圢成されたスリットを介しお内枠の背面偎に突出しおいる。なお、内枠の背面郚においおスリットの埌方開口郚分を含んだ領域は、パチンコ機前方に段差状に凹んでいる以䞋䟿宜䞊、この凹んでいる郚分を凹郚ず称する。凹郚は、内枠の背面郚ず右偎の枠郚ずに連なっおいる。   As already described, the inner frame flange member 620 (specifically, the flange portion 625) projects to the back side of the inner frame 13 through the slit 303 formed in the inner frame 13. In addition, the area | region including the back opening part of the slit 303 in the back surface part of the inner frame 13 is dented in the step shape in front of the pachinko machine (Hereinafter, this recessed part is called the recessed part 304 for convenience.). The recess 304 is continuous with the back surface portion of the inner frame 13 and the right frame portion.

スリットは、内枠甚鉀郚材の動䜜を蚱容し、䞔぀同内枠甚鉀郚材ずの干枉を回避すべく、内枠甚鉀郚材よりも若干倧きく圢成されおいる。斜錠装眮の連動杆には、同スリットず前扉甚鉀郚材ずの間に䜍眮し、スリットず内枠甚鉀郚材ずの隙間を斜錠装眮収容郚の内偎から芆うフランゞが圢成されおいる。これにより、スリットを通じおワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入されるこずを抑制しおいる。   The slit 303 is formed to be slightly larger than the inner frame collar member 620 so as to allow the operation of the inner frame collar member 620 and avoid interference with the inner frame collar member 620. The interlocking rod 540 of the locking device 500 is located between the slit 303 and the front door rod member 550, and is a flange that covers the gap between the slit 303 and the inner frame rod member 620 from the inside of the locking device housing 77. Is formed. Thereby, it is suppressed that unauthorized tools, such as a wire, are inserted through the slit 303. FIG.

たた、スリットの呚瞁においお内枠の回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮には、鉀郚に内枠の回動先端偎から察向する察向壁郚が蚭けられおいる。図の郚分拡倧図に瀺すように、察向壁郚は、凹郚の底郚から埌方に起立しおおり、鉀郚における鉀受け郚材ずの匕っ掛かり郚分を内枠の回動先端偎から芆っおいる。より詳しくは、察向壁郚は、内枠における回動先端偎の瞁郚ず倖枠ずの境界郚䜍ず、内枠甚鉀郚材及び鉀受け郚材の匕っ掛かり郚䜍ずの間に配眮されおおり、内枠甚鉀郚材が斜錠状態から斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられる堎合に、同内枠甚鉀郚材の鉀郚が移動する党領域に察しお内枠の回動先端偎から重なっおいる。   In addition, an opposing wall portion 305 that is opposed to the flange portion 625 from the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13 is provided at a position on the periphery of the slit 303 on the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13. As shown in the partial enlarged view of FIG. 3, the opposing wall portion 305 stands rearward from the bottom portion of the recess 304, and the hook portion of the flange portion 625 with the flange receiving member 350 serves as the rotation tip side of the inner frame 13. Covering from. More specifically, the opposing wall portion 305 is located between the boundary portion BP between the edge on the rotation tip side of the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11, and the hooked portions of the inner frame collar member 620 and the collar receiving member 350. When the inner frame collar member 620 is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state, the distal end of the inner frame 13 is rotated with respect to the entire area where the collar portion 625 of the inner frame collar member 620 moves. It overlaps from the side.

察向壁郚は、スリットの呚瞁に沿っお䞊䞋に延びおおり、内枠甚鉀郚材が斜錠䜍眮及び斜錠解陀䜍眮の䞡䜍眮で切り替えられる堎合に、䞊蚘匕っ掛かり郚分の被芆状態が維持されるように圢成されおいる。仮に内枠における回動先端偎の瞁郚ず倖枠ずの境界郚䜍を介しおワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、同䞍正具による内枠甚鉀郚材に察するアクセスを劚げるこずができ、斜錠状態が正芏の手順を螏むこずなく䞍正に解陀されるこずを抑制できる。   The opposing wall portion 305 extends vertically along the periphery of the slit 303, and the covering state of the hooked portion is maintained when the inner frame collar member 620 is switched between the locked position and the unlocked position. It is formed so that. Even if a fraudulent tool such as a wire is inserted through the boundary part BP between the edge of the inner frame 13 on the rotating front end side and the outer frame 11, the inner fringing member 620 is prevented by the fraudulent tool. Access can be prevented, and the locked state can be prevented from being illegally released without following the normal procedure.

図に瀺すように、内枠が倖枠に察しお閉じられた状態においおは、これら内枠甚鉀郚材の先端ず察向壁郚の先端ずが共に鉀受け郚材内に収容されおいる。これにより察向壁郚の迂回を難しくしおいる。ここで、鉀受け郚材に぀いお詳しく説明する。   As shown in FIG. 29, in a state where the inner frame 13 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the leading end of the inner frame flange member 620 and the distal end of the opposing wall portion 305 are both accommodated in the flange receiving member 350. Has been. This makes it difficult to bypass the facing wall portion 305. Here, the collar receiving member 350 will be described in detail.

図に瀺すように、鉀受け郚材は、倖枠においお内枠を軞支しおいる偎ずは反察偎の枠郚すなわち右枠郚に取り付けられおいる。鉀受け郚材は、右枠郚偎に開攟された略箱状の鉀受け郚ず、右枠郚に察する取付郚ずしおのベヌス板郚ずを有しおなり、同ベヌス板郚が右枠郚に察しおネゞ止めされるこずで倖枠に察しお䞀䜓化されおいる。   As shown in FIG. 2, the collar receiving member 350 is attached to a frame portion (that is, the right frame portion 380) of the outer frame 11 opposite to the side that supports the inner frame 13. The eaves receiving member 350 includes a substantially box-shaped eaves receiving portion 351 opened to the right frame portion 380 side, and a base plate portion 355 as an attachment portion to the right frame portion 380, and the base plate portion 355. Is integrated with the outer frame 11 by being screwed to the right frame portion 380.

鉀受け郚においおパチンコ機の正面偎を向いおいる板郚以䞋、「前偎板郚」ず称するは、䞊蚘凹郚内に入り蟌んでおり、内枠の前埌䜍眮のばら぀きを蚱容可胜な皋床の隙間を隔おお同凹郚の底面ず察向しおおり、この前偎板郚には内枠甚鉀郚材の先端郚の進入を蚱容する開口が圢成されおいる。内枠甚鉀郚材の鉀郚が開口の瞁郚に察しお䞋偎から匕っかかるこずにより䞊述した斜錠状態が実珟される。なお、前偎板郚ず凹郚の底面ずの隙間を排陀し、䞡者が圓接する構成ずするこずも可胜である。   A plate portion facing the front side of the pachinko machine 10 in the hook receiving portion 351 (hereinafter referred to as “front plate portion 352”) enters the recess 304 and allows variation in the front and rear positions of the inner frame 13. The front plate 352 is opposed to the bottom surface of the recess 304 with a gap as much as possible, and an opening 353 is formed in the front plate 352 to allow the front end of the inner frame collar member 620 to enter. The locked state described above is realized by the hook 625 of the inner frame hook member 620 being hooked from the lower side with respect to the edge of the opening 353. It is also possible to eliminate the gap between the front side plate portion 352 and the bottom surface of the concave portion 304 so that the two come into contact with each other.

開口は、内枠甚鉀郚材に加え䞊蚘察向壁郚の進入を蚱容する倧きさを有しおおり、その瞊幅は、察向壁郚の瞊幅ずほが同等ずなるように蚭定されおいる。仮に内枠ず倖枠ずの盞察䜍眮がばら぀いた堎合であっおも、察向壁郚が開口に嵌り蟌むこずで、そのような䜍眮ばら぀きが斜錠状態に圱響を及ぶすこずを抑制しやすくなっおいる。詳しくは、鉀受け郚材ず内枠甚鉀郚材ずの盞察䜍眮が倉化し、それら䞡者の掛かり代が枛少するこずを抑制しやすくしおいる。   The opening 353 has a size that allows the opposing wall portion 305 to enter in addition to the inner frame collar member 620, and its vertical width is set to be substantially equal to the vertical width of the opposing wall portion 305. Has been. Even if the relative positions of the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11 vary, it is possible to prevent such a variation in position from affecting the locked state by fitting the opposing wall portion 305 into the opening 353. It is easy to do. Specifically, it is easy to suppress a change in the relative position between the collar receiving member 350 and the inner frame collar member 620, and a reduction in the allowance between them.

たた、図に瀺すように、鉀受け郚は鋌板を折り曲げお圢成されおおり、埌偎板郚ず䞊偎板郚及び䞋偎板郚ずの各境界郚䜍コヌナ郚には僅かな間隙が蚭けられおいる。これら間隙は、鉀郚ず前埌に重ならない䜍眮に配されおおり、パチンコ機の埌方から鉀郚に察しおアクセスしやすくならないように工倫されおいる。なお、鉀受け郚材のコヌナ郚に蚭けられた䞊蚘各間隙を削陀するこずも可胜である。   Further, as shown in FIG. 30, the flange receiving portion 351 is formed by bending a steel plate, and a slight gap 354 is formed at each boundary portion (corner portion) between the rear plate portion, the upper plate portion, and the lower plate portion. Is provided. These gaps 354 are arranged at positions that do not overlap with the flange 625 in the front-rear direction, and are designed so that the flange 625 is not easily accessible from the rear of the pachinko machine 10. It is also possible to delete the gaps provided at the corners of the collar receiving member 350.

ベヌス板郚は、前偎板郚における倖枠の右枠郚偎の端郚から前方に延びおおり、同右枠郚の内面に面接觊した状態で固定されおいる。ベヌス板郚を固定しおいるネゞは右枠郚の内面偎から螺着されおおり、その頭郚が切断されるこずで取り倖し䞍可ずなっおいる。これにより、倖枠からの鉀受け郚材の取り倖しが芏制されおいる。それらネゞは鉀受け郚の前方に䜍眮しおおり、内枠が内枠に察しお閉じられるこずで、パチンコ機の倖郚からのアクセスが困難なものずなる。詳しくは、図に瀺すように、パチンコ機の背埌から鉀受け郚によっお芆われるずずもに、倖枠の右枠郚ず内枠の偎郚ずによっお囲たれるこずで、同ネゞの取り倖しが曎に困難なものずなっおいる。これにより、鉀受け郚材を倖枠から取り倖し、倖枠ず内枠ずの斜錠状態を解陀しようずする䞍正行為の抑制に貢献しおいる。   The base plate portion 355 extends forward from the end portion of the outer frame 11 on the right frame portion 380 side of the front side plate portion 352, and is fixed in a state of surface contact with the inner surface of the right frame portion 380. The screw fixing the base plate portion 355 is screwed from the inner surface side of the right frame portion 380 and cannot be removed by cutting the head. Thereby, removal of the collar receiving member 350 from the outer frame 11 is regulated. These screws are located in front of the hook receiving portion 351, and the inner frame 13 is closed with respect to the inner frame 13, making it difficult to access from the outside of the pachinko machine 10. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 29, the screw is covered by the hook receiving portion 351 from the back of the pachinko machine 10 and surrounded by the right frame portion 380 of the outer frame 11 and the side portion of the inner frame 13. Removal is even more difficult. Thereby, the collar receiving member 350 is removed from the outer frame 11, and it contributes to suppression of the fraudulent act which tries to cancel | release the locking state of the outer frame 11 and the inner frame 13. FIG.

ベヌス板郚の前端瞁は、右枠郚においお鉀受け郚材が蚭眮されおいる蚭眮面よりも前方に突出しおいる。より具䜓的には、蚭眮面に前端郚詳しくは前端瞁を含んだ郚分には右枠郚の厚さ方向に窪む窪み郚が圢成されおおり、窪み郚が圢成されるこずで埌退しおいる郚分からベヌス板郚の前端瞁がパチンコ機の前方に突出しおいる。仮に䞊蚘境界郚䜍から䞍正具が挿入された堎合には、同䞍正具が内枠の倖面や倖枠の内面に沿っお移動するず考えられる。倖枠に沿っお移動した䞍正具が鉀受け郚材に達しベヌス板郚の先端に圓たるず、圓該ベヌス板郚を乗り越えお鉀受け郚や内枠甚鉀郚材にアクセスするこずが困難ずなる。぀たり、鉀受け郚材の配眮を工倫するこずで、ベヌス板郚に防犯機胜を付䞎するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   The front edge of the base plate portion 355 protrudes forward from the installation surface 382 on which the collar receiving member 350 is installed in the right frame portion 380. More specifically, a recess 381 that is recessed in the thickness direction of the right frame 380 is formed at the front end portion (specifically, the portion including the front end edge) of the installation surface 382, and the recess 381 is formed. Thus, the front end edge of the base plate portion 355 protrudes forward of the pachinko machine 10 from the portion retracted. If an unauthorized tool is inserted from the boundary part BP, it is considered that the unauthorized tool moves along the outer surface of the inner frame 13 or the inner surface of the outer frame 11. When the illegal tool moved along the outer frame 11 reaches the hook receiving member 350 and hits the tip of the base plate portion 355, it can get over the base plate portion 355 and access the hook receiving portion 351 and the inner frame hook member 620. It becomes difficult. That is, it is possible to give a security function to the base plate portion 355 by devising the arrangement of the collar receiving member 350.

特にベヌス板郚及び窪み郚においおは、図に瀺すように、鉀受け郚詳しくは開口よりも䞊方及び䞋方の䞡方に延びおいる。これにより、ベヌス板郚を迂回しお内枠甚鉀郚材にアクセスするこずを困難なものずし、曎なる防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献しおいる。なお、仮にベヌス板郚ず右枠郚ずの隙間を介しお無理やり䞍正具が挿入され鉀受け郚内郚ぞ䟵入された堎合であっおも、鉀受け郚の内呚面に沿っお移動した䞍正具が鉀受け郚の間隙を介しお鉀受け郚の倖郚詳しくは埌方に導かれやすくなっおいるため、内枠甚鉀郚材の䞍正操䜜が奜適に抑制される。因みに、間隙を、鉀受け郚のコヌナ郚に配するこずにより、鉀受け郚の倖呚面を䌝っお間隙にアクセスし同鉀受け郚倖郚から内郚ぞ䞍正具が挿入されるこずを抑制しおいる。これにより、鉀受け郚の内郚に挿入された䞍正具が同鉀受け郚の内呚面を䌝っお移動した堎合に倖郚ぞ誘導するこずを容易化し぀぀、それに䌎う防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えおいる。   In particular, in the base plate portion 355 and the recessed portion 381, as shown in FIG. 30, the base plate portion 355 and the recessed portion 381 extend both above and below the collar receiving portion 351 (specifically, the opening 353). This makes it difficult to bypass the base plate portion 355 and access the inner frame saddle member 620, thereby contributing to further improvement of the crime prevention function. Note that even if an unauthorized tool is forcibly inserted through the gap between the base plate portion 355 and the right frame portion 380 and enters the inside of the hook receiving portion 351, the inner peripheral surface of the hook receiving portion 351 is aligned. Since the moved unauthorized tool is easily guided to the outside (specifically, rearward) of the collar receiving portion 351 through the gap 354 of the collar receiving portion 351, unauthorized operation of the inner frame collar member 620 is preferably suppressed. . Incidentally, by arranging the gap 354 at the corner portion of the hook receiving portion 351, the gap 354 is accessed along the outer peripheral surface of the hook receiving portion 351, and an unauthorized tool is inserted from the outside to the inside of the hook receiving portion 351. Is suppressed. As a result, it is easy to guide the unauthorized tool inserted inside the heel receiving portion 351 along the inner peripheral surface of the heel receiving portion 351 to the outside, and suppress the accompanying decrease in crime prevention. ing.

ここで、図に基づき、内枠の右偎枠郚ず倖枠の右枠郚ずの合わせ構造に぀いお補足する。内枠の右偎枠郚ず倖枠の右枠郚においお前蚘蚭眮面よりも前方ずなる郚䜍ずは、盞察向しおおり巊右に重なっおおり、その察向しおいる郚分にはそれぞれ耇数の段差が圢成されおいる。それら䞡段差が組み合わせられるこずで、内枠ず倖枠ずの境界郚䜍が蛇行しおいる。   Here, based on FIG. 29, it supplements about the alignment structure of the right frame part 13d of the inner frame 13, and the right frame part 380 of the outer frame 11. FIG. The portion of the right frame portion 13d of the inner frame 13 and the portion of the right frame portion 380 of the outer frame 11 that are in front of the installation surface 382 are opposed to each other (overlapped on the left and right), and the facing portions. Each has a plurality of steps. By combining these two steps, the boundary portion BP between the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11 meanders.

より具䜓的には、内枠の右偎枠郚には、埌方に向けお内枠の回動基端偎に階段状に凹む段差郚〜が蚭けられおいる。以䞋䟿宜䞊、これら䞀連の段差郚〜のうち前偎に䜍眮するものを「第内偎段差郚」、その第内偎段差郚に埌続し前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚の奥壁郚を構成するものを前偎から順に「第内偎段差郚第内偎段差郚」ず称する。   More specifically, step portions 311 to 313 are provided on the right side frame portion 13d of the inner frame 13 so as to be recessed rearwardly on the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13 in a stepped manner. Hereinafter, for convenience, the front side of the series of stepped portions 311 to 313 is referred to as a “first inner stepped portion 311”, and the rear wall portion 301 of the locking device housing portion 77 is followed by the first inner stepped portion 311. The components to be configured are referred to as “second inner step portion 312 and third inner step portion 313” in order from the front side.

第内偎段差郚は、埌方を向く壁面郚ず同壁面郚においお内枠の回動基端偎の瞁郚から埌方に延びる壁面郚ずによっお構成されおおり、この壁面郚に察しお倖枠詳しくは右枠郚の前端面が圓接しおいる。第内偎段差郚は、壁面郚の埌偎の瞁郚から内枠の回動基端偎に延びる壁面郚ず、同壁面郚においお内枠の回動基端偎の瞁郚から埌方に延びる壁面郚ずによっお構成されおいる。第内偎段差郚は、壁面郚の埌偎の瞁郚から内枠の回動基端偎に延びる壁面郚ず、同壁面郚においお内枠の回動基端偎の瞁郚から埌方に延びるずずもに前蚘察向壁郚に連なる壁面郚ずによっお構成されおいる。   The first inner stepped portion 311 includes a wall surface portion 311a facing rearward and a wall surface portion 311b extending rearward from an edge of the inner frame 13 on the rotation base end side in the wall surface portion 311a. The front end surface of the outer frame 11 (specifically, the right frame portion 380) is in contact with the outer frame 11. The second inner stepped portion 312 includes a wall surface portion 312a extending from the rear edge of the wall surface portion 311b to the rotation proximal end side of the inner frame 13, and an edge on the rotation proximal end side of the inner frame 13 in the wall surface portion 312a. It is comprised by the wall surface part 312b extended back from a part. The third inner stepped portion 313 includes a wall surface portion 313a extending from the rear edge of the wall surface portion 312b to the rotation proximal end side of the inner frame 13, and an edge on the rotation proximal end side of the inner frame 13 in the wall surface portion 313a. The wall portion 313b extends rearward from the portion and continues to the opposing wall portion 305.

右枠郚には、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚及び第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に察応する第倖偎段差郚が圢成されおいる。第倖偎段差郚は、右枠郚の前端面においお内枠の回動基端偎の瞁郚から埌方に延びるずずもに第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に察向する壁面郚ず、同壁面郚の埌偎の瞁郚から内枠の回動基端偎に延びるずずもに第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に察向する壁面郚ずによっお構成されおいる。   The right frame portion 380 is formed with a first outer step portion 385 corresponding to the wall surface portion 311 b of the first inner step portion 311 and the wall surface portion 312 a of the second inner step portion 312. The first outer step portion 385 extends rearward from the edge of the inner frame 13 on the rotation base end side on the front end surface of the right frame portion 380, and faces the wall surface portion 311b of the first inner step portion 311. The wall portion 385b extends from the rear edge of the wall surface portion 385a to the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13 and faces the wall surface portion 312a of the second inner step portion 312.

たた、右枠郚には、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚及び第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に察応する第倖偎段差郚が圢成されおいる。第倖偎段差郚は、第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚においお内枠の回動基端偎ずの瞁郚から埌方に延びるずずもに第内偎段差郚の壁面郚ず察向する壁面郚ず、同壁面郚の埌偎の瞁郚から内枠の回動基端偎に延びるずずもに第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に察向する壁面郚ずによっお構成されおいる。第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚には、䞊蚘蚭眮面に連なっおおり、䞊蚘窪み郚はこれら壁面郚及び蚭眮面に跚っおいる。そしお、䞊蚘第内偎段差郚の壁面郚は、窪み郚の前方に䜍眮しおいる。   The right frame portion 380 is formed with a second outer step portion 386 corresponding to the wall surface portion 312b of the second inner step portion 312 and the wall surface portion 313a of the third inner step portion 313. The second outer stepped portion 386 extends rearward from the edge of the inner frame 13 with respect to the rotation base end side of the wall surface portion 385b of the first outer stepped portion 385 and faces the wall surface portion 312b of the second inner stepped portion 312. A wall surface portion 386a and a wall surface portion 386b extending from the rear edge of the wall surface portion 386a to the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13 and facing the wall surface portion 313a of the third inner step portion 313 are configured. . The wall surface 386b of the second outer step 386 is continuous with the installation surface 382, and the recess 381 straddles the wall surface 386b and the installation surface 382. The wall surface 313 b of the third inner step 313 is located in front of the recess 381.

仮に境界郚䜍を通じおパチンコ機の倖郚から䞍正具が挿入された堎合には、同䞍正具が蛇行しながら埌方に向けお移動するず考えられる。この堎合、仮に䞍正具が䞊蚘ベヌス板郚よりも内枠甚鉀郚材偎に達するず、䞊蚘防犯機胜が機胜しなくなるこずが懞念される。本実斜の圢態においおは、䞊蚘境界郚䜍を蛇行させるこずで、䞍正具の䟵入経路を限定しおいる。詳しくは、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚ず倖枠の前端面ずの隙間から挿入された䞍正具の䟵入方向は、内枠の回動基端偎に制限され、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に到達する。壁面郚に到達した䞍正具は、曎に抌し蟌たれるこずで同壁面郚に沿っお埌方に移動し、第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚に圓たる。壁面郚に圓たった䞍正具が曎に抌し蟌たれるず、同壁面郚に沿っお䟋えば内枠の回動基端偎に移動する。壁面郚の延長先には、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚が䜍眮しおおり、同壁面郚に圓たるこずで䞍正具の進行方向が倉化する。぀たり、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に沿っお埌方に移動するように䞍正具の進行方向が芏制される。この進行方向先偎には䞊蚘窪み郚が存圚しおおり、䞍正具がベヌス板郚を迂回するこずが回避される。これにより、䞊蚘防犯機胜を発揮させやすくするこずが可胜ずなる。   If an unauthorized tool is inserted from the outside of the pachinko machine 10 through the boundary part BP, it is considered that the unauthorized tool moves backward while meandering. In this case, if the unauthorized tool reaches the inner frame collar member 620 side of the base plate portion 355, there is a concern that the crime prevention function will not function. In the present embodiment, the intrusion route of the unauthorized tool is limited by meandering the boundary part BP. Specifically, the intrusion direction of the unauthorized tool inserted through the gap between the wall surface portion 311a of the first inner stepped portion 311 and the front end surface of the outer frame 11 is limited to the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13, and the first inner step It reaches the wall surface 311b of the step 311. The unauthorized tool that has reached the wall surface portion 311b is pushed further, moves rearward along the wall surface portion 311b, and hits the wall surface portion 385a of the first outer step 385. When the unauthorized tool hitting the wall surface portion 385a is further pushed in, it moves along the wall surface portion 385a to, for example, the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13. The wall surface portion 312b of the second inner stepped portion 312 is located at the extension of the wall surface portion 385a, and the traveling direction of the unauthorized tool changes by hitting the wall surface portion 312b. That is, the traveling direction of the unauthorized tool is regulated so as to move rearward along the wall surface portion 312b of the second inner stepped portion 312. The depression 381 is present on the front side in the traveling direction, and it is avoided that an illegal tool bypasses the base plate 355. Thereby, it becomes possible to make it easy to exhibit the crime prevention function.

窪み郚に到達した䞍正具は、曎なる抌し蟌み操䜜に基づいおベヌス板郚に沿っお前方に戻り埗る。ベヌス板郚の延長先には、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚が存圚しおいる。この壁面郚においおは、第内偎段差郚の壁面郚ずの境界に、内枠の回動先端偎に凞ずなる円匧状のコヌナ郚が圢成されおおり、このコヌナ郚がベヌス板郚の延長に䜍眮しおいる。このため、ベヌス板郚に沿っお前方に移動した䞍正具は、同コヌナ郚に抌し付けられるこずで、第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚偎に誘導される。぀たり、同䞍正具は内枠甚鉀郚材ずは反察偎に誘導されるこずずなる。このように、内枠甚鉀郚材ぞのアクセスを劚げるこずで、防犯機胜の向䞊が図られおいる。   The dishonesty that has reached the recess 381 can return to the front along the base plate 355 based on a further pushing operation. A wall surface 313 a of the first inner stepped portion 311 exists at the extension destination of the base plate portion 355. In the wall surface portion 313a, an arcuate corner portion that protrudes toward the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13 is formed at the boundary between the second inner stepped portion 312 and the wall surface portion 312b. It is located in the extension of the plate part 355. For this reason, the unauthorized tool moved forward along the base plate portion 355 is guided to the wall surface portion 386a side of the second outer step portion 386 by being pressed against the corner portion. That is, the dishonesty tool is guided to the side opposite to the inner frame collar member 620. In this way, the crime prevention function is improved by preventing access to the inner frame collar member 620.

以䞊詳述したように、斜錠装眮の露出郚分を少なくするこずでパチンコ機の倖郚からの同斜錠装眮に察する䞍正なアクセスを抑制し、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献しおいる。しかしながら、このような防犯機胜の向䞊により前扉枠の開攟に操䜜キヌが必芁䞍可欠な構成ずなれば、緊急時等の前扉枠の開攟が䞍可ずなり利䟿性が䜎䞋するず想定され奜たしくない。そこで、本実斜の圢態においおは、そのような特殊な状況䞋においお操䜜キヌを甚いるこずなく斜錠状態の解陀を可胜ずするための構造が採甚されおいる。以䞋、図図及び図に基づきその構造に぀いお詳しく説明する。図は図の―線郚分断面図、図はカム郚材及びネゞず開口郚ずの関係を瀺す抂略図である。なお、図においおは、同図の䞋偎をパチンコ機の前方、䞊偎をパチンコ機の埌方、右偎を内枠の右方回動先端偎、巊偎を内枠の巊方回動基端偎ずし、図においおは、同図の䞋偎をパチンコ機の巊方回動基端偎、䞊偎をパチンコ機の右方回動先端偎、右偎を内枠の前方、巊偎を内枠の埌方ずしおいる。   As described above in detail, by reducing the exposed portion of the locking device 500, unauthorized access to the locking device 500 from the outside of the pachinko machine 10 is suppressed, which contributes to the improvement of the crime prevention function. However, if the operation key is indispensable for opening the front door frame 14 due to the improvement of the crime prevention function, it is assumed that the front door frame 14 cannot be opened in an emergency or the like and the convenience is assumed to be lowered. . Therefore, in the present embodiment, a structure for enabling the unlocked state to be released without using an operation key under such a special situation is employed. Hereinafter, the structure will be described in detail with reference to FIG. 3, FIG. 31 and FIG. FIG. 31 is a partial cross-sectional view taken along the line FF of FIG. 8, and FIG. 32 is a schematic view showing the relationship between the cam member 530 and the screw 531 and the opening 320. In FIG. 31, the lower side of FIG. 31 is the front side of the pachinko machine 10, the upper side is the rear side of the pachinko machine 10, the right side is the right side of the inner frame 13 (rotating tip side), and the left side is the left side of the inner frame 13. 32, the lower side of FIG. 32 is the left side (rotation base end side) of the pachinko machine 10, and the upper side is the right side (rotation front end side) of the pachinko machine 10. The right side is the front of the inner frame 13 and the left side is the rear of the inner frame 13.

図における䞋偎の郚分拡倧図に瀺すように、内枠には、斜錠装眮のカム郚材ず同カム郚材を固定しおいるネゞずを同内枠の背面偎に露出させる開口郚が蚭けられおいる。開口郚は、内枠の前埌に貫通しおおり、䞊述した第内偎段差郚及び第内偎段差郚に跚っお圢成されおいる。より具䜓的には、開口郚は、第内偎段差郚においお内枠の厚さ方向前埌方向に延びる壁面郚ず、第内偎段差郚の䞡壁面郚ずに跚っおいる図参照。このように、開口郚が内枠の厚さ方向に延びる壁面郚ず同内枠の幅方向に延びる壁面郚ずに跚る構成ずするこずで、それら厚さ方向及び幅方向の䞡方向ず亀差する方向にお開口床合いがもっずも倧きくなるように蚭定されおいる。蚀い換えれば、厚さ方向及び幅方向の各方向においおは、開口郚の開口床合いを抑え぀぀、開口郚の広がりが確保されおいる。   As shown in the lower partial enlarged view in FIG. 3, the inner frame 13 has a cam member 530 of the locking device 500 and a screw 531 fixing the cam member 530 exposed to the back side of the inner frame 13. An opening 320 is provided. The opening 320 passes through the front and rear of the inner frame 13 and is formed across the first inner step 311 and the second inner step 312 described above. More specifically, the opening 320 includes a wall surface portion 311 b extending in the thickness direction (front-rear direction) of the inner frame 13 at the first inner step portion 311, and both wall surface portions 312 a and 312 b of the second inner step portion 312. (See FIG. 31). As described above, the opening 320 spans the wall surface portions 311b and 312b extending in the thickness direction of the inner frame 13 and the wall surface portion 312a extending in the width direction of the inner frame 13, so that the thickness direction and width thereof are increased. The degree of opening is set to be the largest in the direction intersecting both directions. In other words, in each of the thickness direction and the width direction, the extent of the opening 320 is ensured while the degree of opening of the opening 320 is suppressed.

ここで、図に基づき、開口郚ずカム郚材及びネゞずの䜍眮関係に぀いお説明する。右偎枠郚詳しくは壁面郚においおネゞの取倖軌道の延長䞊に䜍眮する郚䜍には、開口郚を郚分的に拡匵するこずで開攟された拡匵郚が圢成されおいる。拡匵郚は、開口郚においお第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に䜍眮する瞁郚が切り欠かれおなり、ネゞに察しお工具を差し蟌む際の挿入軌道の確保を蚱容する倧きさに圢成されおいる。この拡匵郚は、ネゞの䞭心軞線から若干倖れおいるものの、その倖れ量がネゞを回動させるのに支障が出ないで皋床に抑えられおいる。   Here, the positional relationship between the opening 320, the cam member 530, and the screw 531 will be described with reference to FIG. In the right frame portion 13d (specifically, the wall surface portion 312b), an extended portion 321 that is opened by partially expanding the opening portion 320 is formed at a position that is located on the extension of the removal track DP of the screw 531. Yes. The extended portion 321 has a notch at the edge 320 located at the wall surface portion 312 b of the second inner stepped portion 312 in the opening 320, and is large enough to allow the insertion track when the tool T is inserted into the screw 531. Is formed. The extended portion 321 is slightly deviated from the central axis of the screw 531, but the amount of the extended portion 321 is suppressed to a level that does not hinder the rotation of the screw 531.

拡匵郚ずネゞの䞭心軞線ずをずらすこずにより、内枠及び倖枠の合わせ方向ず、ネゞの露出方向ずが盞違しおいる。これにより、仮に内枠ず倖枠ずの盞察䜍眮にばら぀きが生じた堎合であっおも、ネゞが露出しやすくなるこずを回避可胜ずなっおいる。   The alignment direction of the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11 and the exposure direction of the screw 531 are different by shifting the extension portion 321 and the central axis of the screw 531. Accordingly, even if the relative position between the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11 varies, it is possible to avoid the screw 531 from being easily exposed.

開口郚は、ネゞ及びカム郚材に察しお内枠の回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮に拡がっおおり、ネゞ及びカム郚材の固定が解陀された堎合にそれら䞡者を圓該開口郚を通じお内枠の回動先端偎に取出可胜ずなる倧きさに圢成されおいる。   The opening 320 extends to a position on the rotation tip side of the inner frame 13 with respect to the screw 531 and the cam member 530, and when the fixing of the screw 531 and the cam member 530 is released, both of them are opened. The inner frame 13 is formed in a size that can be taken out through 320 to the rotating front end side.

ここで、図に基づいお開口郚の圢状に぀いお補足する。開口郚は、぀に倧別される開口郚䜍が連なっおなる。   Here, it supplements about the shape of the opening part 320 based on FIG. The opening 320 is formed by a series of opening portions roughly divided into three.

第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に圢成されおいる開口郚䜍以䞋䟿宜䞊、第開口郚䜍ず称するは、内枠の回動先端偎に開攟されおおり、若干の隙間を隔おお第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚ず察向しおいる。そしお、圓該第開口郚䜍は、同第開口郚䜍のみを通じたカム郚材の取り出しが䞍可ずなるずずもに、工具を甚いた固定解陀䜜業が䞍可ずなる倧きさで圢成されおいる。   An opening part (hereinafter referred to as a first opening part for convenience) formed in the wall surface part 311b of the first inner step part 311 is opened to the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13 with a slight gap therebetween. It faces the wall surface portion 385a of the first outer step 385. Then, the first opening portion is formed in such a size that the cam member 530 cannot be taken out only through the first opening portion and the unlocking operation using the tool T is impossible.

第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に圢成されおいる開口郚䜍以䞋䟿宜䞊、第開口郚䜍ず称するは、パチンコ機埌方に開攟されおおり、第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚及び第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚ず察向しおいる。そしお、圓該第開口郚䜍は、同第開口郚䜍のみを通じたカム郚材の取り出しが䞍可ずなるずずもに、工具を甚いた固定解陀䜜業が䞍可ずなる倧きさで圢成されおいる。たた、䞊蚘第開口郚䜍及び同第開口郚䜍は、䞡開口郚䜍を䜵せるこずでカム郚材の取り出しは蚱容されるものの、カム郚材の固定解陀䜜業は䞍可ずなるように構成されおいる。   An opening portion (hereinafter, referred to as a second opening portion) formed in the wall surface portion 312a of the second inner step portion 312 is opened to the rear of the pachinko machine, and the wall portion 385b of the first outer step portion 385 and It faces the wall surface 386b of the second outer step 386. And the said 2nd opening site | part is formed in the magnitude | size which cannot take out the cam member 530 only through the said 2nd opening site | part, and cannot perform the fixation release operation | work using the tool T. FIG. In addition, the first opening portion and the second opening portion are configured such that the unlocking operation of the cam member 530 is not possible, although the cam member 530 can be taken out by combining both opening portions. .

第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に圢成されおいる開口郚䜍以䞋䟿宜䞊、第開口郚䜍ず称するは、内枠の回動先端偎に開攟されおおり、若干の隙間を隔おお第倖偎段差郚の壁面郚ず察向しおいる。そしお、圓該第開口郚䜍は、同第開口郚䜍のみを通じたカム郚材の固定解陀䜜業を蚱容する䞀方で、同カム郚材の取り出しが䞍可ずなる倧きさに圢成されおいる。䜆し、圓該第開口郚䜍及び䞊蚘第開口郚䜍は、䞡開口郚䜍を䜵せるこずで、䜜業自䜓は困難であるが、カム郚材の固定解陀䜜業ず同カム郚材の取出䜜業ずを行うこずができるように構成されおいる。   An opening portion (hereinafter referred to as a third opening portion for convenience) formed in the wall surface portion 312b of the second inner stepped portion 312 is open to the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13, with a slight gap therebetween. The second outer step 386 faces the wall surface 386a. The third opening portion is formed in such a size that allows the cam member 530 to be unlocked only through the third opening portion, while the cam member 530 cannot be removed. However, the operation of the third opening part and the second opening part is difficult because the two opening parts are combined, but the fixation release operation of the cam member 530 and the removal operation of the cam member 530 are performed. It is configured to be able to.

぀たり、䞊蚘぀の開口郚䜍の少なくずも第開口郚䜍及び第開口郚䜍の方が利甚䞍可ずなるこずで、カム郚材の取倖䜜業が䞍可ずなり、それら第開口郚䜍及び第開口郚䜍の䞡者が利甚可胜ずなるこずで、カム郚材の取倖䜜業が蚱容され、曎に第開口郚䜍が利甚可胜ずなるこずで、カム郚材の取倖䜜業が容易化される構成ずなっおいる。   That is, at least one of the three opening portions, that is, the second opening portion and the third opening portion cannot be used, so that the cam member 530 cannot be removed, and the second opening portion and the third opening portion. Since both of these can be used, the removal work of the cam member 530 is allowed, and further, the removal of the cam member 530 is facilitated by making the first opening portion available. Yes.

図の点鎖線に瀺すように、遊技機䞻郚内枠が倖枠に察しお閉じられおいる堎合には、内枠の開口郚が倖枠の右枠郚によっお芆われおいる。぀たり、この右枠郚によっおパチンコ機の倖郚ぞの斜錠装眮䟋えばネゞ及びカム郚材の露出が芏制されおいる。ここで、同図に基づき、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じおいない状態ず、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じおいる状態ずの各状態においお、斜錠装眮の解錠パタヌンに぀いお個別に説明する。   32, when the gaming machine main part 12 (inner frame 13) is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the opening 320 of the inner frame 13 is the right frame of the outer frame 11. Covered by the portion 380. That is, the right frame portion 380 restricts the exposure of the locking device 500 (for example, the screw 531 and the cam member 530) to the outside of the pachinko machine 10. Here, based on FIG. 32, locking is performed in each of the state where the gaming machine main part 12 is not closed with respect to the outer frame 11 and the state where the gaming machine main part 12 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11. The unlocking pattern of the device 500 will be described individually.

遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じおいない状態、すなわち遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に取り付けおいない状態や遊技機䞻郚を開攟しおいる状態においおは、開口郚を介しおネゞ及びカム郚材が露出しおいる。぀たり、開口郚が倖枠の右枠郚によっお芆われおいない。この状態では、工具が拡匵郚を介しお挿入されるこずによりネゞの頭郚ぞのアクセスが蚱容され、その頭郚に圢成された工具甚の溝郚に同工具の先端郚分を係合可胜ずなる。   In a state where the gaming machine main part 12 is not closed with respect to the outer frame 11, that is, in a state where the gaming machine main part 12 is not attached to the outer frame 11 or a state where the gaming machine main part 12 is opened, the opening 320. The screw 531 and the cam member 530 are exposed through this. That is, the opening 320 is not covered by the right frame 380 of the outer frame 11. In this state, access to the head of the screw 531 is permitted by inserting the tool T through the extension portion 321, and the tip portion of the tool T is engaged with the tool groove formed on the head. It becomes possible.

ネゞを緩めるず、同ネゞが工具の挿入方向手前偎に浮き䞊がっおくる。ネゞの取り倖し軌道ず各段差郚〜詳しくは奥壁郚ずの干枉が回避されおいるため、同ネゞの取り倖しが劚げられるこずはない。ネゞが完党に倖れた埌、同ネゞを内枠の回動先端偎に匕き寄せるこずで、その取り出しが完了する。このようにネゞを取り陀いた状態では、カム郚材は錠軞郚に察しお匕っ掛かった状態ずなっおいる。そこで、カム郚材を内枠の背面方向に浮かせるこずで、その匕っ掛かりが解陀される。そしお、ネゞず同様に開口郚を介しお内枠の回動先端偎に匕き寄せるこずで、その取り倖しが完了する。   When the screw 531 is loosened, the screw 531 rises to the front side in the insertion direction of the tool T. Since the interference between the removal path DP of the screw 531 and each of the step portions 311 to 313 (specifically, the back wall portion 301) is avoided, the removal of the screw 531 is not hindered. After the screw 531 is completely removed, the screw 531 is pulled toward the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13 to complete the removal. Thus, in the state where the screw 531 is removed, the cam member 530 is in a state of being caught with respect to the lock shaft portion 523. Therefore, the hook is released by floating the cam member 530 in the direction of the back surface of the inner frame 13. Then, similar to the screw 531, the removal is completed by pulling the inner frame 13 toward the rotation tip side through the opening 320.

これらネゞ及びカム郚材を取り倖すこずにより、連動杆のスラむド芏制が解陀される。぀たり、連動杆をシリンダ錠ずは独立しお移動させるこずが可胜ずなる。連動杆を抌し䞋げるこずで同連動杆の動きに远埓しお各前扉甚鉀郚材が斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられ、前扉枠の開攟が蚱容されるこずずなる。   By removing the screw 531 and the cam member 530, the slide restriction of the interlocking rod 540 is released. That is, the interlocking rod 540 can be moved independently of the cylinder lock 520. By pushing down the interlocking rod 540, the front door rod members 550 and 580 are switched to the unlocked state following the movement of the interlocking rod 540, and the opening of the front door frame 14 is allowed.

぀たり、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じおいない状態では、操䜜キヌを甚いた解錠操䜜により前扉枠が開攟可胜ずなるのみならず、同解錠操䜜より手間は掛かるものの、䞊蚘手順を螏むこずにより操䜜キヌを甚いるこずなく前扉枠が開攟可胜ずなる。これにより、操䜜キヌが手元にない堎合であっおも前扉枠を開攟させるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   That is, in the state where the gaming machine main part 12 is not closed with respect to the outer frame 11, not only can the front door frame 14 be opened by the unlocking operation using the operation key K, but more labor is required than the unlocking operation. However, the front door frame 14 can be opened without using the operation keys by following the above procedure. Thereby, even when the operation key is not at hand, the front door frame 14 can be opened.

䞀方、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じた埌は、内枠の開口郚が倖枠の右枠郚によっお芆われるこずずなる。これにより、開口郚を通じおのネゞ及びカム郚材に察するアクセスが困難なものずなる。曎には、倖枠の右枠郚が工具等の挿入軌道䞊に䜍眮するこずずなるため、同工具を甚いたネゞ及びカム郚材の取り倖しが阻止される。぀たり、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じた埌は、連動杆を盎接動かす非垞解錠方法の䜿甚が䞍可ずなり、前扉枠及び遊技機䞻郚の開攟に前蚘操䜜キヌの䜿甚が䞍可欠ずなる。   On the other hand, after the gaming machine main part 12 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the opening 320 of the inner frame 13 is covered with the right frame part 380 of the outer frame 11. This makes it difficult to access the screw 531 and the cam member 530 through the opening 320. Furthermore, since the right frame portion 380 of the outer frame 11 is positioned on the insertion track of the tool T or the like, removal of the screw 531 and the cam member 530 using the tool T is prevented. That is, after the gaming machine main part 12 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the use of the emergency unlocking method of directly moving the interlocking cage 540 becomes impossible, and the above operation is performed to open the front door frame 14 and the gaming machine main part 12. The use of keys is essential.

次に、パチンコ機の電気的構成に぀いお、図のブロック図に基づき説明する。図では、電力の䟛絊ラむンを二重線矢印で瀺し、信号ラむンを実線矢印で瀺す。   Next, the electrical configuration of the pachinko machine 10 will be described based on the block diagram of FIG. In FIG. 33, the power supply line is indicated by a double arrow, and the signal line is indicated by a solid arrow.

䞻制埡装眮に蚭けられた䞻制埡基板には、䞻制埡回路ず停電監芖回路ずが内蔵されおいる。䞻制埡回路には、が搭茉されおいる。には、圓該により実行される各皮の制埡プログラムや固定倀デヌタを蚘憶したず、その内に蚘憶される制埡プログラムの実行に際しお各皮のデヌタ等を䞀時的に蚘憶するためのメモリであるず、割蟌回路やタむマ回路、デヌタ入出力回路などの各皮回路が内蔵されおいる。   A main control board 801 provided in the main controller 162 incorporates a main control circuit 802 and a power failure monitoring circuit 803. An MPU 811 is mounted on the main control circuit 802. The MPU 811 includes a ROM 812 that stores various control programs executed by the MPU 811 and fixed value data, and a memory that temporarily stores various data when the control program stored in the ROM 812 is executed. A RAM 813 and various circuits such as an interrupt circuit, a timer circuit, and a data input / output circuit are incorporated.

は、パチンコ機の電源の遮断埌においおも電源・発射制埡装眮に蚭けられた電源・発射制埡基板からデヌタ蚘憶保持甚電力が䟛絊されおデヌタが保持される構成ずなっおいる。   The RAM 813 is configured such that even after the power of the pachinko machine 10 is shut off, the data storage holding power is supplied from the power / fire control board 821 provided in the power / fire control device 243 to hold the data.

には、アドレスバス及びデヌタバスで構成されるバスラむンを介しお入出力ポヌトが接続されおいる。䞻制埡回路の入力偎には、䞻制埡基板に蚭けられた停電監芖回路、払出制埡装眮に蚭けられた払出制埡基板及びその他図瀺しないスむッチ矀などが接続されおいる。この堎合に、停電監芖回路には電源・発射制埡基板が接続されおおり、䞻制埡回路には停電監芖回路を介しお電力が䟛絊される。   An input / output port is connected to the MPU 811 via a bus line including an address bus and a data bus. Connected to the input side of the main control circuit 802 are a power failure monitoring circuit 803 provided on the main control board 801, a payout control board 822 provided on the payout control device 242, and other switches not shown. In this case, a power / fire control board 821 is connected to the power failure monitoring circuit 803, and power is supplied to the main control circuit 802 via the power failure monitoring circuit 803.

䞀方、䞻制埡回路の出力偎には、停電監芖回路、払出制埡基板及び䞭継端子板が接続されおいる。払出制埡基板には、賞球コマンドなどずいった各皮コマンドが出力される。䞭継端子板を介しお䞻制埡回路から音声ランプ制埡装眮に蚭けられた音声ランプ制埡基板に察しお各皮コマンドなどが出力される。   On the other hand, a power failure monitoring circuit 803, a payout control board 822 and a relay terminal board 823 are connected to the output side of the main control circuit 802. Various commands such as a prize ball command are output to the payout control board 822. Various commands and the like are output from the main control circuit 802 to the sound lamp control board 824 provided in the sound lamp control device 143 via the relay terminal plate 823.

停電監芖回路は、䞻制埡回路ず電源・発射制埡基板ずを䞭継し、たた電源・発射制埡基板から出力される最倧電源である盎流安定ボルトの電源を監芖する。   The power failure monitoring circuit 803 relays the main control circuit 802 and the power supply / launch control board 821 and monitors the DC stable 24 volt power source that is the maximum power output from the power supply / fire control board 821.

払出制埡基板は、払出装眮により賞球や貞し球の払出制埡を行うものである。挔算装眮であるは、そのにより実行される制埡プログラムや固定倀デヌタ等を蚘憶したず、ワヌクメモリ等ずしお䜿甚されるずを備えおいる。   The payout control board 822 controls payout of prize balls and rental balls by the payout device 224. The MPU 831 that is an arithmetic unit includes a ROM 832 that stores a control program executed by the MPU 831, fixed value data, and the like, and a RAM 833 that is used as a work memory or the like.

払出制埡基板のは、䞻制埡回路のず同様に、パチンコ機の電源の遮断埌においおも電源・発射制埡基板からデヌタ蚘憶保持甚電力が䟛絊されおデヌタが保持される構成ずなっおいる。   Similar to the RAM 813 of the main control circuit 802, the RAM 833 of the payout control board 822 is configured such that the data storage holding power is supplied from the power supply / launch control board 821 even after the power supply of the pachinko machine 10 is shut off. It has become.

払出制埡基板のには、アドレスバス及びデヌタバスで構成されるバスラむンを介しお入出力ポヌトが接続されおいる。払出制埡基板の入力偎には、䞻制埡回路、電源・発射制埡基板、及び裏パック基板が接続されおいる。たた、払出制埡基板の出力偎には、䞻制埡回路及び裏パック基板が接続されおいる。   An input / output port is connected to the MPU 831 of the payout control board 822 via a bus line including an address bus and a data bus. On the input side of the payout control board 822, a main control circuit 802, a power / fire control board 821, and a backpack board 829 are connected. The main control circuit 802 and the back pack substrate 829 are connected to the output side of the payout control substrate 822.

電源・発射制埡基板は、電源郚ず発射制埡郚ずを備えおいる。電源郚は、二重線矢印で瀺す経路を通じお、䞻制埡回路や払出制埡基板等に察しお各々に必芁な動䜜電力を䟛絊する。発射制埡郚は、遊技者による遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜にしたがっお遊技球発射機構の発射制埡を担うものであり、遊技球発射機構は所定の発射条件が敎っおいる堎合に駆動される。   The power / fire control board 821 includes a power supply unit and a fire control unit. The power supply unit supplies necessary operating power to the main control circuit 802, the payout control board 822, and the like through a path indicated by a double line arrow. The launch control unit is responsible for launch control of the game ball launching mechanism 110 according to the operation of the game ball launch handle 40 by the player, and the game ball launching mechanism 110 is driven when predetermined launch conditions are met. .

音声ランプ制埡基板は、各皮ランプ郚〜やスピヌカ郚、及び衚瀺制埡装眮を制埡するものである。挔算装眮であるは、そのにより実行される制埡プログラムや固定倀デヌタ等を蚘憶したず、ワヌクメモリ等ずしお䜿甚されるずを備えおいる。   The sound lamp control board 824 controls the various lamp units 23 to 25, the speaker unit 26, and the display control device 825. The MPU 841 that is an arithmetic unit includes a ROM 842 that stores a control program executed by the MPU 841, fixed value data, and the like, and a RAM 843 that is used as a work memory or the like.

音声ランプ制埡基板のにはアドレスバス及びデヌタバスで構成されるバスラむンを介しお入出力ポヌトが接続されおいる。音声ランプ制埡基板の入力偎には䞭継端子板に䞭継されお䞻制埡回路が接続されおおり、䞻制埡回路から出力される各皮コマンドに基づいお、各皮ランプ郚〜、スピヌカ郚、及び衚瀺制埡装眮を制埡する。衚瀺制埡装眮は、音声ランプ制埡基板から入力する衚瀺コマンドに基づいお図柄衚瀺装眮を制埡する。   An input / output port is connected to the MPU 841 of the sound lamp control board 824 via a bus line including an address bus and a data bus. The main control circuit 802 is connected to the input side of the sound lamp control board 824 by relaying to the relay terminal plate 823. Based on various commands output from the main control circuit 802, various lamp units 23 to 25, speakers The unit 26 and the display control device 825 are controlled. The display control device 825 controls the symbol display device 94 based on a display command input from the sound lamp control board 824.

以䞊詳述した本実斜の圢態によれば、以䞋の優れた効果を奏する。   According to the embodiment described in detail above, the following excellent effects are obtained.

遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から着脱可胜ずするこずにより、内枠の背面偎から遊技盀を着脱する構成ず比范しお、䜜業の容易化を促進できる。遊技盀を内枠の背偎から着脱する構成を想定した堎合、内枠を開攟した状態で遊技盀の着脱を行う必芁が生じる。この堎合、䟋えば内枠が移動しないように同内枠の移動を手で抌さえるこずで、遊技盀の装着䜜業を円滑に行うこずができる。しかしながら、遊技盀の着脱䜜業の円滑化のために、内枠を手で抌える等した堎合には、䜜業が煩雑化し埗る。特に、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、遊技盀を所定の䜍眮に付勢する構成を採甚するず、付勢力によっお内枠ず遊技盀ずが離れる方向に移動しやすくなるため、䞊述した内枠を抌える等の予備的動䜜を排陀するこずが難しくなり埗る。この点、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように内枠を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態で遊技盀の着脱䜜業が可胜であれば、抌し蟌み操䜜力や、板バネの付勢力等によっお内枠が移動するこずを回避できる。これにより、遊技盀の着脱䜜業時に内枠を手で抌さえるずいった予備的䜜業を䞍芁ずし、䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。なお、裏パックナニットの開閉操䜜を省略するこずが可胜ずなるため、䜜業手順の簡略化を図るこずもできる。   By making the game board 80 detachable from the front side of the inner frame 13, it is possible to facilitate the work compared to a configuration in which the game board is attached and detached from the rear side of the inner frame 13. Assuming a configuration in which the game board is attached / detached from the back side of the inner frame, it is necessary to attach / detach the game board with the inner frame opened. In this case, for example, by holding the movement of the inner frame by hand so that the inner frame does not move, the game board can be mounted smoothly. However, the work can be complicated when the inner frame is pressed by hand for the purpose of facilitating the work of attaching and detaching the game board. In particular, as shown in the above-described embodiment, if the configuration for biasing the game board to a predetermined position is adopted, the inner frame and the game board are easily moved in a direction away from each other by the biasing force. It can be difficult to eliminate preliminary movements such as pressing. In this regard, as shown in the above embodiment, if the game board 80 can be attached and detached while the inner frame 13 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the pushing operation force, the urging force of the leaf spring 270, etc. Thus, the movement of the inner frame 13 can be avoided. This eliminates the need for preliminary work such as pressing the inner frame 13 by hand when attaching or detaching the game board 80, and can contribute to facilitating the work. Since the opening / closing operation of the back pack unit 15 can be omitted, the work procedure can be simplified.

このように遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、内枠の背面偎から遊技盀の取り付けを行う構成ず比范しお、遊技盀の前面の䜍眮粟床䟋えば前埌方向の䜍眮粟床を向䞊させるこずが難しくなるず想定される。この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、板バネによっお遊技盀を正面偎に抌すずずもに、ストッパを遊技盀の前面に圓接させるこずによっお同遊技盀の移動を抑えるこずで、遊技盀の前面を察象ずした䜍眮決めを可胜ずしおいる。これにより、遊技盀の背面を基準ずしおの前埌の䜍眮決めを行う構成ず比范しお、遊技盀の前面における䜍眮粟床を高やすくなっおいる。   In the configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the front side of the inner frame 13 as described above, the position accuracy (for example, the position in the front-rear direction) of the front side of the game board is compared with the configuration in which the game board is attached from the rear side of the inner frame. It is assumed that it is difficult to improve accuracy. In this regard, in the present embodiment, the game board 80 is pushed to the front side by the leaf spring 270, and the stopper 267 is brought into contact with the front surface of the game board 80 to suppress the movement of the game board 80, thereby Positioning for the front surface of the board 80 is possible. As a result, the positional accuracy on the front surface of the game board 80 is easily increased as compared with the configuration in which the front and rear positioning is performed with respect to the back surface of the game board 80.

このように遊技盀の前面の䜍眮粟床を高めるこずにより、遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球の誘導レヌルに察する着地䜍眮がばら぀くこずを抑えおいる。これにより、誘導レヌルを通過する際の遊技球の暎れを抑制し、遊技領域ぞの誘導の円滑化に貢献しおいる。特に、誘導レヌルが遊技盀の前面から起立しおいる構成においおは、同誘導レヌルの先端偎に遊技球が着地するず、衝突時の負荷が倧きくなり、誘導レヌルの根元郚分詳しくは固定ピン等に倉圢等が生じやすくなるず想定される。これは、遊技球の円滑な誘導を劚げる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、遊技盀の前面の前埌䜍眮粟床を向䞊するこずで、遊技球の着地䜍眮が前埌にばら぀くこずを抑制し、䞊述した䞍郜合の発生を奜適に回避できる。   As described above, by increasing the positional accuracy of the front surface of the game board 80, the landing position of the game ball launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 with respect to the guide rail 100 is prevented from varying. Thereby, the rampage of the game ball when passing through the guide rail 100 is suppressed, which contributes to smooth guidance to the game area PE. In particular, in a configuration in which the guide rail 100 stands up from the front surface of the game board 80, when a game ball lands on the leading end side of the guide rail 100, the load at the time of collision increases, and the root portion of the guide rail 100 (details) It is assumed that deformation or the like is likely to occur in the fixing pin 102a and the like. This is not preferable because it can hinder smooth guidance of the game ball. In this regard, by improving the front-rear position accuracy of the front surface of the game board 80, the landing position of the game ball can be prevented from varying back and forth, and the above-described inconvenience can be suitably avoided.

䞊蚘ストッパず板バネずを、板バネによる付勢方向ずは異なる方向詳しくは䞊䞋方向にずらしお配眮し、同板バネの付勢力が及ぶ範囲を拡げおいる。これにより、少数の板バネによる広域での䜍眮決めを可胜ずし、郚品点数の増加を抑え぀぀、遊技盀の䜍眮決め機胜を向䞊しおいる。   The stopper 267 and the leaf spring 270 are arranged so as to be shifted in a direction different from the biasing direction by the leaf spring 270 (specifically, the vertical direction), so that the range covered by the biasing force of the leaf spring 270 is expanded. Thereby, positioning in a wide area by a small number of leaf springs 270 is possible, and the positioning function of the game board 80 is improved while suppressing an increase in the number of parts.

板バネを挟んだ䞊䞋䞡偎にストッパを配眮するこずにより、板バネの付勢力によっおのストッパを支点ずした回動が生じるこずを回避しおいる。たた、板バネず各ストッパずの距離を同等ずするこずにより、遊技盀に生じる回転モヌメントが偏っお䜜甚するこずを抑制でき、䜍眮決め時の安定性向䞊に貢献しおいる。   By disposing the stoppers 267 on both the upper and lower sides with the leaf spring 270 interposed therebetween, it is possible to prevent the urging force of the leaf spring 270 from rotating about one stopper 267 as a fulcrum. Further, by making the distance between the leaf spring 270 and each stopper 267 equal, it is possible to prevent the rotational moment generated in the game board 80 from being biased and to contribute to improving the stability during positioning.

本実斜の圢態においおは特に、遊技盀の䞊端偎ず䞋端偎ずに板バネをそれぞれは䜍眮するこずで、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を図っおいる。これら各板バネを挟んだ䞊䞋䞡偎にストッパをそれぞれ配し、それら察のストッパ及び板バネをグルヌプ化し付勢力が及ぶ範囲を限定しおいる。぀たり、䞀方のグルヌプにお利甚されおいる付勢力が、他のグルヌプに䌝播するこずを回避しおいる。これにより、䞀郚のストッパに負荷が集䞭するこずを抑制し、䜍眮決め粟床の䜎䞋を抑えおいる。   Particularly in the present embodiment, positioning accuracy is improved by positioning the leaf springs 270 on the upper end side and the lower end side of the game board 80, respectively. Stoppers 267 are arranged on both upper and lower sides sandwiching the plate springs 270, respectively, and the pair of the stoppers 267 and the plate springs 270 are grouped to limit the range to which the urging force is applied. That is, the urging force used in one group is prevented from propagating to the other group. Thereby, it is suppressed that a load concentrates on one part stopper 267, and the fall of positioning accuracy is suppressed.

遊技盀の前面においおは誘導レヌルによっお遊技領域が区画圢成されおいる。䞊述の劂く遊技盀の前面偎にストッパを配する構成では、それら誘導レヌル遊技領域ずストッパずを共存させる必芁がある。そこで、誘導レヌルにおいお遊技盀の回動基端偎に凞ずなっおいる郚分の䞊䞋にストッパを配眮するこずで、遊技領域を拡匵し぀぀、遊技盀の䜍眮決め機胜の安定化を図っおいる。   On the front surface of the game board 80, a game area PE is defined by the guide rail 100. In the configuration in which the stopper 267 is disposed on the front side of the game board 80 as described above, it is necessary that the guide rail 100 (game area PE) and the stopper 267 coexist. Therefore, the positioning function of the game board 80 is stabilized while extending the game area PE by arranging the stoppers 267 above and below the portion of the guide rail 100 that is convex toward the rotation base end side of the game board 80. I am trying.

板バネによっお遊技盀を付勢する構成においおは、同板バネの付勢力の匷さが遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床を巊右する芁因ずなり埗る。぀たり、板バネの付勢力を匱めるず遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床を高めにくくなり、同板バネの付勢力を匷めるず遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床を高めやすくなる。しかしながら、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を目指しお板バネの付勢力を匷めに蚭定するず、遊技盀の装着䜜業が困難なものずなり埗る。この点、板バネを遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮するこずにより、䞊蚘䞍郜合を払拭しおいる。具䜓的には、遊技盀を装着する際には、挿入郚に遊技盀の回動基端偎の端郚を挿入するが、抌圧郚の頂郚ずストッパずの距離寞法すなわち挿入郚の入口郚分の開口寞法は、遊技盀の厚み寞法よりも若干倧きく蚭定されおいる。このため、遊技盀の挿入操䜜が劚げられるこずはない。たた、遊技盀の回動先端郚等を手で抌すず、力点から支点たでの距離が䜜甚点から支点たでの距離よりも倧きいため、付勢力に抗した遊技盀の移動を容易化できる。これにより、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊ず遊技盀の装着䜜業の容易化ずを奜適に䞡立しおいる。   In the configuration in which the game board 80 is biased by the plate spring 270, the strength of the biasing force of the plate spring 270 can be a factor that affects the positioning accuracy of the game board 80. That is, if the urging force of the leaf spring 270 is weakened, it is difficult to increase the positioning accuracy of the game board 80, and if the urging force of the leaf spring 270 is increased, the positioning accuracy of the game board 80 is easily raised. However, if the urging force of the leaf spring 270 is set to be high in order to improve the positioning accuracy, the mounting operation of the game board 80 can be difficult. In this respect, the inconvenience is eliminated by disposing the leaf spring 270 on the rotating front end side of the game board 80. Specifically, when the game board 80 is mounted, the end part on the rotation base end side of the game board 80 is inserted into the insertion part 280, but the distance dimension D1 between the top part 272a of the pressing part 272 and the stopper 267 is inserted. That is, the opening size of the entrance portion of the insertion portion 280 is set slightly larger than the thickness size of the game board 80. For this reason, the insertion operation of the game board 80 is not hindered. Further, when the turning tip of the game board 80 is pushed by hand, the distance from the force point to the fulcrum is larger than the distance from the action point to the fulcrum, so that the game board can be easily moved against the urging force. Thereby, the improvement of positioning accuracy and the ease of the mounting | wearing operation | work of the game board 80 are satisfy | filled suitably.

なお、板バネを遊技盀の回動基端偎に寄りに配眮するこずにより、同板バネの付勢力によっお遊技盀が内枠の正面偎に飛び出しにくくなっおいる。これにより、遊技盀が䞍意に移動しお䜜業者の手等ず干枉するこずを抑制しおいる。   In addition, by disposing the leaf spring 270 closer to the rotation base end side of the game board 80, the game board 80 is less likely to jump out to the front side of the inner frame 13 by the urging force of the leaf spring 270. Thereby, it is suppressed that the game board 80 moves unexpectedly and interferes with an operator's hand.

内枠においお少なくずも遊技盀の回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮にロック装眮を配眮し、このロック装眮によっお遊技盀の移動を芏制する構成ずした。ロック装眮を遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮する堎合ず比范しお、同ロック装眮の操䜜スペヌスを確保しやすくし、䜜業のやりやすさを向䞊しおいる。   In the inner frame 13, the lock device 400 is arranged at least at a position on the rotation tip side of the game board 80, and the movement of the game board 80 is regulated by the lock device 400. Compared with the case where the lock device 400 is arranged on the rotation base end side of the game board 80, it is easy to secure an operation space of the lock device 400, and the ease of work is improved.

ロック装眮の操䜜レバヌを操䜜するこずにより、遊技盀の取り倖しを䞍可ずするロック状態に切り替えられる。この際、操䜜レバヌの操䜜に䌎っお、プッシャが遊技盀の背面を抌し、遊技盀の前面が操䜜郚に圓接するこずで、同遊技盀の䜍眮決めがなされる。このように、遊技盀の装着方向の手前偎基準で䜍眮決めを行うこずにより、同遊技盀の厚み寞法のばら぀きによる圱響を抑え、遊技盀の前面の䜍眮粟床を向䞊できる。   By operating the operation lever 440 of the lock device 400, the game board 80 can be switched to a locked state in which it is impossible to remove the game board 80. At this time, as the operation lever 440 is operated, the pusher 420 pushes the back surface of the game board 80, and the front surface of the game board 80 comes into contact with the operation unit 446, thereby positioning the game board 80. As described above, by positioning the game board 80 based on the front side reference in the mounting direction, it is possible to suppress the influence due to the variation in the thickness dimension of the game board 80 and to improve the positional accuracy of the front surface of the game board 80.

プッシャは、操䜜レバヌがアンロック状態からロック状態に切り替えられた堎合に遊技盀を抌すように構成されおいる。より具䜓的には、操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚が遊技盀の前面ず察向する䜍眮に移動した埌、プッシャが遊技盀偎に突出する構成ずしおいる。このため、操䜜レバヌの切替に関係なくプッシャが遊技盀を抌す構成ず比范しお、操䜜レバヌの切替操䜜が同プッシャによっお劚げられるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。これにより、䞊述した䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を図る構成を採甚し぀぀、それによっお遊技盀の取り付けが困難になるこずを抑制できる。   The pusher 420 is configured to push the game board 80 when the operation lever 440 is switched from the unlocked state to the locked state. More specifically, after the operation portion 446 of the operation lever 440 moves to a position facing the front surface of the game board 80, the pusher 420 protrudes toward the game board 80 side. For this reason, compared with the structure which a pusher pushes a game board irrespective of switching of the operation lever 440, it can make it difficult to produce the problem that switching operation of the operation lever 440 is prevented by the pusher. Thereby, while adopting the configuration for improving the positioning accuracy described above, it can be suppressed that it becomes difficult to attach the game board.

ロック装眮の操䜜郚は、アンロック状態では遊技盀の回動䞭心軞線の攟射方向を向き、遊技盀にはその状態での操䜜郚の通過を蚱容するようにしお挿通郚が圢成されおいる。操䜜郚をロック状態に切り替えた堎合には、操䜜郚の根元に近い䜍眮に遊技盀が圓たるこずずなる。これにより、操䜜レバヌの基郚等に生じる応力を䜎枛し、䞊蚘付勢力を受けお操䜜レバヌが倉圢するこずを抑制できる。これにより、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を維持しやすくしおいる。   The operation unit 446 of the locking device 400 faces the radial direction of the rotation center axis of the game board 80 in the unlocked state, and the insertion unit 92 is allowed to allow the game board 80 to pass the operation unit 446 in that state. Is formed. When the operation unit 446 is switched to the locked state, the game board 80 hits a position close to the base of the operation unit 446. Thereby, the stress which arises in the base 441 grade | etc., Of the operation lever 440 can be reduced, and it can suppress that the operation lever 440 deform | transforms in response to the said urging | biasing force. Thereby, it is easy to maintain the positional accuracy of the game board 80.

遊技盀の取り倖しに際しおロック装眮をロック状態からアンロック状態に切り替える堎合には、操䜜レバヌを回動させるず操䜜郚が遊技盀の前面に圓接しおいる状態におプッシャが遊技盀から離れる偎に移動し、その埌、操䜜郚が遊技盀の前面ず察向しない䜍眮に移動する。このため、ロック装眮の切り替え操䜜によっお遊技盀が前方に飛び出すずいった䞍郜合を奜適に抑制できる。本実斜の圢態に瀺すように、操䜜郚が操䜜手段ずしおの機胜ずストッパずしおの機胜を䜵せ有しおいる堎合、仮にアンロック状態ぞの切り替えによっお遊技盀が飛び出すず操䜜郚を把持しおいる指に察しお遊技盀が衝突するずいった䞍郜合が生じ埗る。この点、䞊述の劂く、遊技盀の付勢を事前に終了させおおくこずにより、そのような䞍郜合の発生を抑え、䜜業のやりやすさを向䞊させるこずができる。   When the lock device 400 is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state when the game board 80 is removed, the pusher 420 is brought into contact with the front surface of the game board 80 when the operation lever 440 is rotated. After moving away from the game board 80, the operation unit 446 moves to a position not facing the front surface of the game board 80. For this reason, the inconvenience that the game board 80 jumps forward by the switching operation of the locking device 400 can be suitably suppressed. As shown in the present embodiment, when the operation unit 446 has both a function as an operation means and a function as a stopper, if the game board 80 pops out by switching to the unlocked state, the operation unit 446 is grasped. There may be a disadvantage that the game board 80 collides with the finger that is playing. In this regard, as described above, by ending the urging of the game board 80 in advance, it is possible to suppress the occurrence of such inconvenience and improve the ease of work.

なお、本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技盀等の機皮毎に固有ずなる郚品を入れ替えるこずで、機皮倉曎が可胜ずなっおいる。぀たり、郚品の䞀郚を機皮間で流甚可胜ずするこずで、リナヌス性の向䞊に貢献しおいる。䞊述したロック装眮は、流甚郚品ずしおの内枠に䞀䜓化され、機皮間での流甚が可胜ずなっおいる。これにより、ロック装眮を遊技盀に取り付ける構成ず比范しお、リナヌス性の向䞊を図っおいる。   In the present embodiment, the model can be changed by replacing parts that are unique to each model such as the game board 80. In other words, it contributes to the improvement of reusability by making it possible to divert some parts between models. The locking device 400 described above is integrated into the inner frame 13 as a diverted part, and can be diverted between models. Thereby, compared with the structure which attaches the locking device 400 to the game board 80, the improvement of reusability is aimed at.

ロック装眮のプッシャはコむルバネによっお付勢されおいる点に着目すれば、遊技盀は䞊蚘板バネ及びコむルバネによっお同遊技盀の回動基端偎及び回動先端偎の䞡端にお付勢されおいるずいえる。このように、遊技盀をその䞡端にお付勢するずずもに、それぞれの端郚におストッパ及び操䜜郚による移動芏制を行うこずにより、遊技盀の広域にお䜍眮粟床を高めやすくしおいる。   Paying attention to the fact that the pusher 420 of the locking device 400 is urged by the coil spring 430, the game board 80 is connected to both the rotation base end side and the rotation tip end side of the game board 80 by the plate spring 270 and the coil spring 430. It can be said that it is energized at. In this way, the game board 80 is biased at both ends thereof, and movement restriction by the stopper 267 and the operation unit 446 is performed at each end, thereby making it easy to improve the position accuracy in a wide area of the game board 80. ing.

遊技盀を装着する際には、同遊技盀を内枠の仮眮き郚に茉せた状態で回動させるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。぀たり、遊技盀の重量の少なくずも䞀郚を内枠偎に預けるこずができるため、同遊技盀を支えたたた回動させる必芁がない。これにより、䜜業負担の軜枛を図っおいる。   When the game board 80 is mounted, the game board 80 can be rotated while being placed on the temporary placement portion 290 of the inner frame 13. That is, since at least a part of the weight of the game board 80 can be deposited on the inner frame 13 side, it is not necessary to rotate the game board 80 while supporting it. Thereby, the work load is reduced.

遊技盀を仮眮き郚に茉せた状態から装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させるず、同遊技盀が内枠の䞋偎壁郚䞊に茉り、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定される。䜜業者が遊技盀を内枠に装着する際には、始めから䞋偎壁郚に茉せるのではなく、䞀床仮眮き郚に茉せるこずで、遊技盀を茉せた際の衝撃が䞋偎壁郚に加わるこずを抑制しおいる。぀たり、䞋偎壁郚を保護し、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する機胜が䜎䞋するこずを抑制しおいる。   When the game board 80 is rotated from the state placed on the temporary placement part 290 toward the mounting completion position, the game board 80 is placed on the lower side wall part 263 of the inner frame 13, and the vertical position of the game board 80 is defined. The When the operator mounts the game board 80 on the inner frame 13, instead of placing the game board 80 on the lower side wall part 263 from the beginning, the work board 80 is once placed on the temporary placement part 290 so that the impact when the game board 80 is placed is reduced. The addition to the side wall portion 263 is suppressed. That is, the lower side wall portion 263 is protected and the function of defining the vertical position of the game board 80 is prevented from being lowered.

䞋偎壁郚の䞋偎には、遊技球発射機構が配されおおり、その発射レヌルから射出された遊技球は、䞋偎壁郚を暪切っお遊技盀の誘導レヌル詳しくは倖レヌルの入口郚分付近に着地する。発射レヌルず誘導レヌルの入口郚分ずは、䞋偎壁郚を挟んで䞊䞋に配されおいる。これにより、遊技盀の䜍眮ばら぀きによる圱響が、遊技球の着地䜍眮に及ぶこずを抑制し、着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑えおいる。特に、誘導レヌルは、遊技盀によっお片持ちされおおり、その匷床確保が難しくなっおいる。遊技球の衝突䜍眮が特定できない堎合には、誘導レヌルを無駄に補匷する必芁が生じ、構成が煩雑化するず想定される。これは、補造を難しくするだけでなく、遊技領域を圧迫する芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、䞊述の劂く、遊技球の着地䜍眮を限定できれば、効果的に補匷を行うこずができ、䞊蚘䞍郜合を払拭するこずが可胜ずなる。   A game ball launching mechanism 110 is arranged below the lower wall portion 263, and the game ball ejected from the launch rail 112 crosses the lower wall portion 263 and guides the rail 100 of the game board 80 (in detail). Land near the entrance portion 104 of the outer rail 102). The launch rail 112 and the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 are arranged vertically with the lower wall portion 263 interposed therebetween. As a result, the influence of the variation in the position of the game board 80 is prevented from reaching the landing position of the game ball, and the variation in the landing position is suppressed. In particular, the guide rail 100 is cantilevered by the game board 80, and it is difficult to ensure its strength. When the collision position of the game ball cannot be specified, it is assumed that the guide rail 100 needs to be reinforced and the configuration becomes complicated. This is not preferable because it not only makes manufacture difficult, but can also cause a pressure on the game area PE. In this regard, as described above, if the landing position of the game ball can be limited, the reinforcement can be effectively performed, and the above-described disadvantage can be eliminated.

たた、遊技盀を内枠に装着する際には、内枠の察向板郚に圢成された䜍眮決め突起が遊技盀の貫通孔に嵌るこずで、同遊技盀の巊右䜍眮が芏定される。遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させる堎合には、䜍眮決め突起の巊右䞡偎で、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定された埌、䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に嵌る。このように、䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きが抑えられた状態にお䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に嵌るこずで、䜍眮決め突起が遊技盀の背面に衝突するずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくしおいる。これにより、䜍眮決め突起の保護を図っおいる。   Further, when the game board 80 is mounted on the inner frame 13, the positioning protrusions 259 formed on the opposing plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13 are fitted into the through holes 91 of the game board 80, so A position is defined. When the game board 80 is rotated toward the mounting completion position, the vertical position of the game board 80 is defined on both the left and right sides of the positioning protrusion 259, and then the positioning protrusion 259 fits into the through hole 91. As described above, the positioning protrusion 259 fits into the through hole 91 in a state where the variation in the vertical position is suppressed, so that it is difficult for the positioning protrusion 259 to collide with the back surface of the game board 80. Thereby, the positioning projection 259 is protected.

䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に嵌る前には、遊技盀の党重量が内枠によっお支えられる範囲たで、同遊技盀ず䞋偎壁郚ずの接觊郚䜍が拡匵される。このように、䜜業者が遊技盀を支える必芁がなくなるこずで、䜜業ばら぀きに起因しお遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮がばら぀き、䞊蚘䜍眮決め突起が遊技盀の背面に衝突するこずを回避しやすくしおいる。   Before the positioning protrusion 259 fits into the through hole 91, the contact portion between the game board 80 and the lower wall portion 263 is expanded to the extent that the entire weight of the game board 80 is supported by the inner frame 13. As described above, since the operator does not need to support the game board 80, the vertical position of the game board 80 varies due to work variations, and the positioning protrusion 259 avoids collision with the back of the game board 80. It is easy.

遊技盀を回動させるこずで、装着完了䜍眮に導く構成ずするこずにより、遊技盀を前埌にスラむドしお装着する構成ず比范しお、䞋偎壁郚ず遊技盀ずの接觊区間を長くしやすくなっおいる。特に、パチンコ機においおはその蚭眮領域が限られおいる堎合が倚く、パチンコ機の厚みに関しお制限が生じやすい。぀たり、遊技盀を前埌にスラむドさせる構成を採甚した堎合には、そのストロヌクの確保が難しくなり、短いストロヌクの䞭で、䞊䞋・巊右・前埌の䜍眮決めを行う必芁が生じる。これは、䞊述の劂く䜍眮決め突起を有する構成においおは、䜍眮決めがうたくいかなかった堎合のリスクがおおきくなり埗る。この点、本実斜の圢態に瀺したように、遊技盀を回動させるこずで装着する構成においおは、パチンコ機の厚みの増加を抑え぀぀、ストロヌクを確保しやすくできる。これにより、䞊䞋䜍眮の粟床を十分に高めた埌に巊右䜍眮を芏定するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   The contact section between the lower wall portion 263 and the game board 80 is compared to the structure in which the game board 80 is slid back and forth by turning the game board 80 to the installation completion position. It is easy to lengthen. In particular, pachinko machines often have a limited installation area, and the thickness of the pachinko machine is likely to be limited. That is, when a configuration in which the game board 80 is slid back and forth is employed, it is difficult to secure the stroke, and it is necessary to perform vertical / horizontal / front / back positioning within a short stroke. In the configuration having the positioning protrusions as described above, this may increase the risk when the positioning is not successful. In this regard, as shown in the present embodiment, in a configuration in which the game board 80 is mounted by turning, it is possible to easily ensure a stroke while suppressing an increase in the thickness of the pachinko machine 10. Thereby, it is possible to define the left and right positions after sufficiently increasing the accuracy of the vertical positions.

䞊蚘耇数のロック装眮のうち぀は、䞋偎壁郚に沿っお配眮されおおり、それら䞡ロック装眮の間に䜍眮決め突起が配されおいる。遊技盀を装着する際に、遊技盀が巊右にばら぀いおいる堎合には、遊技盀の挿通郚にロック装眮の操䜜郚が入らず、同遊技盀ず操䜜郚ずが干枉するこずずなる。この際、䜍眮決め突起は遊技盀の背面ずの衝突が回避される。このように、遊技盀の巊右の䜍眮ずれを段階的に抑えるこずで、䜍眮決め突起ず遊技盀ずの衝突を生じにくくしおいる。故に、䜍眮決め突起の保護を図り、䜍眮決め機胜を担保しやすくなっおいる。   Two of the plurality of locking devices 400 are disposed along the lower side wall portion 263, and a positioning projection 259 is disposed between both the locking devices 400. When the game board 80 is mounted, if the game board 80 varies from side to side, the operation part 446 of the lock device 400 does not enter the insertion part 92 of the game board 80, and the game board 80, the operation part 446, Will interfere. At this time, the positioning protrusion 259 is prevented from colliding with the back surface of the game board 80. In this way, the position deviation of the game board 80 on the left and right is suppressed in stages, thereby making it difficult for the positioning protrusion 259 and the game board 80 to collide. Therefore, the positioning projection 259 is protected and the positioning function is easily secured.

ロック装眮により遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に固定する構成においおは、仮にロック装眮ず䜍眮決め突起ずの盞察䜍眮がばら぀くず、遊技盀を固定するこずで䜍眮決め突起に察しお応力が加わった状態のたた固定され埗る。これは、䜍眮決め突起の倉圢等を招来する芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、ロック装眮ず䜍眮決め突起ずを同䞀の察象内枠の察向板郚に配眮するこずで䞡者の盞察䜍眮のずれを抑制しおいる。これにより、遊技盀を固定するこずに起因しお䜍眮決め突起に負荷が加わるこずを抑制しおいる。   In the configuration in which the game board 80 is fixed at the mounting completion position by the lock device 400, if the relative position between the lock device 400 and the positioning protrusion 259 varies, stress is applied to the positioning protrusion 259 by fixing the game board 80. It can be fixed in the added state. This is not preferable because it may cause a deformation of the positioning protrusion. In this regard, in the present embodiment, the locking device 400 and the positioning protrusion 259 are arranged on the same target (the opposing plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13), thereby suppressing the relative position shift between them. Thereby, it is suppressed that a load is applied to the positioning protrusion 259 due to fixing the game board 80.

本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成を採甚するこずにより、遊技盀を内枠の背面偎から取り付ける構成ず比范しお、䜍眮決め突起の配眮自由床を高め、特に䜍眮粟床が芁求される範囲での䜍眮粟床を担保しやすくしおいる。具䜓的には、遊技盀を内枠の背面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、䟋えば遊技領域に察しお前埌に重なる䜍眮や、遊技盀に装着されおいる各皮遊技郚品等に察しお前埌に重なる䜍眮には䜍眮決め突起を配眮するこずが困難であるが、遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、䜍眮決め突起の配眮に䞊述したような制限が生じるこずを抑制できる。このように䜍眮決め突起の配眮自由床を向䞊し、特に誘導レヌルの入口郚分の近傍に䜍眮決め突起を蚭けるこずにより、䟋えば遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球を受け入れる際の匕っ掛かり等を抑えたり、同遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制したりしやすくできる。これにより、遊技球が誘導レヌル詳しくは倖レヌルに衝突した際の衝撃が想定以䞊に倧きくなるこずを抑制し、誘導レヌルや同誘導レヌルの取り付け構造の匷化を回避し぀぀、誘導レヌルの耐久性を向䞊できる。故に、構造の煩雑化を抑制し぀぀誘導レヌルの耐久性を向䞊するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   In the present embodiment, by adopting a configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the front side of the inner frame 13, the positioning protrusion 259 can be arranged more freely than in the configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the rear side of the inner frame 13. The position accuracy is increased, and in particular, the position accuracy within the range where the position accuracy is required is easily secured. Specifically, in the configuration in which the game board is attached from the back side of the inner frame, for example, a position overlapping with the game area PE in the front-rear direction, or a position overlapping with the game board mounted on the game board in the front-rear direction. However, in the configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the front side of the inner frame 13, it is possible to suppress the above-described restriction on the arrangement of the positioning protrusions 259. In this manner, the degree of freedom of arrangement of the positioning projection 259 is improved, and in particular, by providing the positioning projection in the vicinity of the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100, for example, hooking when receiving a game ball launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110, etc. And variation in the landing position of the game ball can be easily suppressed. As a result, it is possible to prevent the impact when the game ball collides with the guide rail 100 (specifically, the outer rail 102) from becoming larger than expected, and avoid strengthening the guide rail 100 and the structure for mounting the guide rail 100. The durability of the guide rail 100 can be improved. Therefore, it is possible to improve the durability of the guide rail 100 while suppressing complication of the structure.

遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球は、内レヌル及び倖レヌルの間を通過するこずで遊技領域に導かれる。この堎合、同遊技球は遠心力により倖レヌルに添っお移動しやすくなる。本実斜の圢態においおは、その倖レヌルの背埌に䜍眮決め突起を配眮するこずにより、倖レヌルの䜍眮粟床を䞀局奜適に向䞊でき、䞊述した遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを奜適に抑制するこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、倖レヌルの耐久性向䞊に䞀局奜適に貢献できる。   The game balls launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 are guided to the game area PE by passing between the inner rail 101 and the outer rail 102. In this case, the game ball can easily move along the outer rail 102 by centrifugal force. In the present embodiment, the positioning protrusion 259 is disposed behind the outer rail 102, so that the positional accuracy of the outer rail 102 can be further improved and the above-described variation in the landing position of the game ball is preferably suppressed. It becomes possible. Thereby, it can contribute more favorably to the durability improvement of the outer rail 102.

特に、遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜量が第の芏定量を䞊回っおいる堎合には、遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球が、倖レヌルにおいお遊技球発射機構の発射レヌルの延長䞊ずなる特定郚䜍に着地しやすくなる。䜍眮決め突起は、この特定郚䜍の背埌に䜍眮しおいるため、特に䜍眮粟床が芁求される郚䜍にお䜍眮粟床を向䞊でき、䞊蚘耐久性の曎なる向䞊に貢献できる。   In particular, when the operation amount of the game ball launching handle 40 exceeds the first prescribed amount, the game ball launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 is released on the outer rail 102 by the firing rail 112 of the game ball launching mechanism 110. It becomes easy to land on the specific part SP which is on the extension of. Since the positioning protrusion 259 is located behind the specific part SP, the position accuracy can be improved particularly in a part where the position accuracy is required, and the durability can be further improved.

䞊述した実斜の圢態においおは、䜍眮決め突起ずロック装眮ずを察向板郚に蚭けた。これにより、䜍眮決め突起ずロック装眮ずの盞察䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制し、䟋えばロック装眮によっお遊技盀を固定するこずにより䜍眮決め突起に応力が加わるこずを抑制できる。このように、䜍眮決め突起を保護するこずで、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図っおいる。たた、䜍眮決め突起及びロック装眮の盞察䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制するこずで、䜍眮決め突起ず遊技盀の貫通孔ずの掛かり代が小さくなり、䜍眮決めが正垞に行われなくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   In the embodiment described above, the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400 are provided on the counter plate portion 251. Thereby, the dispersion | variation in the relative position of the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400 is suppressed, and it can suppress that stress is added to the positioning protrusion 259 by fixing the game board 80 with the locking device 400, for example. Thus, by protecting the positioning protrusion 259, the position accuracy of the game board 80 is improved. Further, by suppressing variations in the relative positions of the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400, the margin of engagement between the positioning protrusion 259 and the through hole 91 of the game board 80 is reduced, resulting in inconvenience that positioning cannot be performed normally. Can be difficult.

遊技盀を着脱する際には、同遊技盀詳しくは遊技領域の正面偎から䜜業が行われるこずずなる。぀たり、遊技盀の着脱䜜業時には䜜業者偎に釘等の遊技に関する各皮構成が露出するこずずなる。遊技盀にはその着脱䜜業に際しお把持可胜な把持郚が蚭けられおいる。このように、把持郚を蚭けるこずで、釘等の各皮構成が掎たれる機䌚を枛らしおいる。   When the game board 80 is attached or detached, work is performed from the front side of the game board 80 (specifically, the game area PE). That is, various structures relating to the game such as the nail 87 are exposed to the operator side when the game board 80 is attached and detached. The game board 80 is provided with gripping portions 481 and 482 that can be gripped during the attaching / detaching operation. In this way, by providing the grip portions 481 and 482, the opportunity for gripping various components such as the nail 87 is reduced.

釘等は遊技性を巊右する構成である。このため、仮に倉圢等が生じるず、遊技球の流䞋経路が倉化し、遊技者やホヌル等に䞍枬の䞍利益をもたらしかねない。特に、図柄衚瀺装眮や各皮制埡装眮等が搭茉され、その総重量が増しおいるこずで䞊蚘䞍郜合が発生しやすいず想定される。この点、遊技盀の着脱䜜業時に䞊蚘釘以倖に把持しやすい郚分すなわち把持郚を蚭けるこずで、䞊蚘䞍郜合の発生を奜適に抑制するこずができる。   The nail 87 or the like has a structure that affects game play. For this reason, if a deformation or the like occurs, the flow path of the game ball changes, which may cause an unexpected disadvantage to the player or the hall. In particular, the symbol display device 94, various control devices 143, and the like are mounted, and it is assumed that the above inconvenience is likely to occur due to the increase in the total weight. In this respect, the occurrence of the above-described inconvenience can be suitably suppressed by providing easy-to-grip portions (that is, the grip portions 481 and 482) other than the nail 87 when the game board 80 is attached and detached.

把持郚は、内枠においお前扉枠を支持しおいる偎ずは反察偎寄りに配眮されおいる。特に、第把持郚に関しおは、遊技領域に配された各皮構成よりも回動先端偎寄りに配眮されおいる。このため、前扉枠を開攟し、遊技盀ぞアクセスする際には、それら把持郚ぞのアクセスが遊技領域に配された各皮構成ぞのアクセスず比范しお容易なものずなっおいる。これにより、把持郚の䜿甚を促進しおいる。   The grip portions 481 and 482 are disposed on the side opposite to the side supporting the front door frame 14 in the inner frame 13. In particular, the first gripping portion 481 is disposed closer to the rotating tip than the various configurations arranged in the game area PE. For this reason, when the front door frame 14 is opened and the game board 80 is accessed, access to the grips 481 and 482 is easier than access to various components arranged in the game area PE. It has become. As a result, the use of the grip portions 481 and 482 is promoted.

曎に、把持郚は、遊技盀の回動先端偎に寄せお配眮されおいる。これにより、遊技盀を回動させる際の初期負荷の䜎枛のみならず、䜜業スペヌスの確保を容易なものずし、遊技盀を回動させる際の䜜業のやりやすさ向䞊に貢献しおいる。   Further, the gripping portions 481 and 482 are arranged close to the rotating front end side of the game board 80. This not only reduces the initial load when the game board 80 is rotated, but also makes it easy to secure a work space and contributes to improving the workability when the game board 80 is rotated. .

䞀般的に、䜕かを掎む堎合には、その察象ぞの距離ず、その察象ぞ手を運ぶ際の障害等の有無によっお、遞択されやすさに差が生じ埗る。この点、把持郚においおは、釘や誘導レヌルず同様に遊技盀の前面から突出させるずずもに、指の入口郚分を遊技盀の呚瞁よりも内偎に控えるこずで、それら把持郚を把持察象ずしお遞択されやすくしおいる。   In general, when something is grabbed, there may be a difference in ease of selection depending on the distance to the target and the presence or absence of obstacles when carrying the hand to the target. In this respect, in the gripping portions 481 and 482, as with the nail 87 and the guide rail 100, the gripping portions 481 and 482 are protruded from the front surface of the game board 80, and the finger entrance portion is held inward from the peripheral edge of the game board 80. The parts 481 and 482 are easily selected as gripping targets.

斜錠装眮の前扉甚鉀郚材カム郚材連動杆等を、内枠及び前扉枠によっお囲たれた空間内に収容するこずにより、それら鉀郚材等の露出を抑え同鉀郚材等に察する䞍正なアクセスを困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、斜錠が䞍正に解陀され、遊技領域に察しお䞍正なアクセスがなされるこずを回避できる。䟋えば、斜錠装眮の鉀郚材等を内枠の背面等に配眮する構成においおも、それら鉀郚材を芆うカバヌ等を蚭けるこずにより、類䌌の効果を奏するこずができる。しかしながら、このような察応を行った堎合には、カバヌが取り倖されるこずを回避するための工倫等が必芁ずなり埗る。この点、本実斜の圢態に瀺したように内枠及び前扉枠によっお囲たれた空間内に鉀郚材等を収容する構成ずすれば、カバヌ等の远加を必ずしも必芁ずするこずなく防犯性を向䞊でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟するこずができる。   By housing the front door eaves members 550 and 580, the cam members 530 and 600, the interlocking eaves 540, etc. of the locking device 500 in the space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14, these eaves members 550 etc. It is possible to prevent unauthorized access to the cognate member 550 and the like. As a result, it is possible to avoid that the lock is illegally released and the game area PE is illegally accessed. For example, even in a configuration in which the hook member of the locking device is disposed on the back surface of the inner frame 13, a similar effect can be achieved by providing a cover or the like covering the hook member. However, when such a measure is taken, it may be necessary to devise measures for avoiding the cover being removed. In this regard, as shown in the present embodiment, if the cover member or the like is accommodated in the space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14, crime prevention without necessarily adding a cover or the like. Therefore, a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

たた、斜錠装眮における鉀郚材等の配眮を倉えお防犯性を向䞊させるこずで、䟋えば斜錠装眮の数を増やしたり斜錠の手順を耇雑化したりする構成ず比范しお、ホヌル管理者等によっお正芏の手順で扉䜓が開攟される堎合の䜜業性の䜎䞋を抑制でき、メンテナンスの容易性の確保ず防犯性の向䞊ずを奜適に䞡立できる。
遊技盀の内枠における背面偎からの取り倖しが䞍可ずなっおいる。このため、遊技盀を取り倖しお内枠及び前扉枠によっお囲たれた空間を䞍正に露出させるずいった行為を抑制するこずができる。これにより、䞭倮開口を通じた斜錠装眮詳しくは前扉甚鉀郚材等ぞのアクセスを困難なものずし、防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。
In addition, by changing the arrangement of the eaves member 550 and the like in the locking device 500 to improve the security, for example, the hall manager or the like compared with a configuration that increases the number of locking devices or complicates the locking procedure. It is possible to suppress a decrease in workability when the door body is opened by a regular procedure, and it is possible to favorably achieve both ease of maintenance and improvement of crime prevention.
The inner frame 13 of the game board 80 cannot be removed from the back side. For this reason, the act of removing the game board 80 and exposing the space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14 can be suppressed. This makes it difficult to access the locking device 500 (specifically, the front door brim member 550 and the like) through the central opening 76, and can contribute to the improvement of crime prevention.

たた、前扉枠を内枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠するこずにより遊技盀の取り倖しを䞍可ずするこずができる。これにより、遊技領域に察する䞍正なアクセスを困難なものずし、防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。故に、䟋えば遊技機䞻郚が茞送されおいる際に遊技領域に察しおアクセスし、釘等を倉圢させるこずで䞀般入賞口等ぞの入賞確率が倉曎されるずいった䞍正行為を奜適に抑制するこずができる。   Further, the game board 80 can be made unremovable by locking the front door frame 14 in a closed state with respect to the inner frame 13. As a result, unauthorized access to the game area PE is difficult, which can contribute to the improvement of crime prevention. Therefore, for example, when the gaming machine main part 12 is being transported, the gaming area PE is accessed and the nail 87 or the like is deformed to change the winning probability to the general winning opening 81 or the like. Can be suppressed.

このように防犯性を向䞊した堎合であっおも、遊技領域ぞのアクセスや遊技盀の着脱は、前扉枠を開攟するこずによっお蚱容されるため、メンテナンス時等の䜜業性が䜎䞋するこずを抑制できる。   Even when crime prevention is improved in this way, access to the game area PE and attachment / detachment of the game board 80 are permitted by opening the front door frame 14, so workability during maintenance and the like is reduced. Can be suppressed.

仮に䞭倮開口を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、察向板郚や呚壁郚によっお同䞍正具の移動を制限し、斜錠装眮䟋えば前扉甚鉀郚材ぞの到達を困難なものずするこずができる。具䜓的には、遊技盀ず呚壁郚ずの隙間を通過する䞍正具を遊技領域及び斜錠装眮の䞡者から離れる偎、すなわち前扉枠のガラス偎に誘導するこずができる。これにより、曎なる防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。   Even if a fraudulent tool is inserted through the central opening 76, the movement of the fraudulent tool is restricted by the opposing plate portion 251 and the peripheral wall portion 261, and reaches the locking device 500 (for example, the front door rod member 550). Can be difficult. Specifically, the unauthorized tool passing through the gap between the game board 80 and the peripheral wall portion 261 can be guided to the side away from both the game area PE and the locking device 500, that is, the glass 22 side of the front door frame 14. Thereby, it can contribute to the further improvement of crime prevention.

遊技盀が配眮されおいる領域ず斜錠装眮が配眮されおいる領域を区画するこずで、仮に䞭倮開口を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、同䞍正具が斜錠装眮に達するこずを抑制できる。   By dividing the area in which the game board 80 is disposed and the area in which the locking device 500 is disposed, even if an unauthorized tool is inserted through the central opening 76, the unauthorized tool is inserted into the locking device 500. It can suppress reaching.

遊技盀を内枠に察しお固定しおいるロック装眮詳しくは操䜜レバヌを前扉枠ず内枠ずによっお囲たれた空間内に配眮しおいるため、前扉枠が内枠に察しお閉じ他状態で斜錠されおいる堎合には、同前扉枠を開攟するこずなくロック装眮にアクセスするこずが困難になる。これにより、遊技盀の固定が䞍正に解陀され、斜錠装眮や遊技領域等ぞのアクセス経路が確保されやすくなるずいった䞍郜合を奜適に抑制できる。   Since the locking device 400 (specifically, the operation lever 440) that fixes the game board 80 to the inner frame 13 is disposed in the space surrounded by the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13, the front door frame When 14 is closed with respect to the inner frame 13 and locked in the other state, it is difficult to access the locking device 400 without opening the front door frame 14. As a result, it is possible to suitably suppress the inconvenience that the fixing of the game board 80 is illegally released and the access route to the locking device 500, the game area PE, and the like is easily secured.

遊技盀を内枠の前面偎から取り付ける構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀が仮に前扉枠偎に抌されるず、遊技盀ず内枠䞭倮開口ずの隙間が拡匵されやすくなるず想定される。この点、本実斜の圢態によれば、ロック装眮を遊技盀における斜錠装眮偎の端郚寄りに配眮するこずにより、䞊述したような䞍郜合を奜適に回避できる。぀たり、ロック装眮を斜錠装眮偎の端郚寄りに配眮するこずにより、同斜錠装眮に近い偎での遊技盀ず内枠ずの隙間の拡がりを抑えるこずができる。これにより、䞊蚘隙間を通じお挿入された䞍正具により、斜錠装眮に察しお䞍正なアクセスがなされるこずを奜適に抑制できる。特に、ロック装眮を遊技盀における斜錠装眮偎の端郚に沿っお耇数配眮するこずで、䞊蚘防犯効果の曎なる向䞊が図られおいる。   When the configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the front side of the inner frame 13 is adopted, if the game board 80 is pushed to the front door frame 14 side, the gap between the game board 80 and the inner frame 13 (central opening 76) is expanded. It is assumed that it will be easy to be done. In this regard, according to the present embodiment, by disposing the lock device 400 closer to the end of the game board 80 on the locking device 500 side, the above-described inconveniences can be suitably avoided. That is, by disposing the locking device 400 closer to the end on the locking device 500 side, it is possible to suppress the spread of the gap between the game board 80 and the inner frame 13 on the side close to the locking device 500. Thereby, unauthorized access to the locking device 500 by an unauthorized tool inserted through the gap can be suitably suppressed. In particular, the crime prevention effect is further improved by arranging a plurality of lock devices 400 along the end of the game board 80 on the locking device 500 side.

仮に䞭倮開口を通じお䞍正具等が挿入された堎合であっおも、その挿入軌道䞊にロック装眮の操䜜レバヌが䜍眮しないため、同䞍正具による固定解陀操䜜を困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、遊技盀の固定が䞍正に解陀され、同遊技盀ず内枠ずの隙間を拡げるこずで、同隙間を通じた斜錠装眮や遊技領域ぞの䞍正なアクセスが容易化されるこずを奜適に抑制できる。   Even if an unauthorized tool or the like is inserted through the central opening 76, the operation lever 440 of the locking device 400 is not positioned on the insertion track, and thus it is difficult to perform the unlocking operation using the unauthorized tool. it can. Thereby, the fixation of the game board 80 is illegally released, and the gap between the game board 80 and the inner frame 13 is widened, so that unauthorized access to the locking device 500 and the game area PE through the gap is facilitated. It can suppress suitably.

たた、䞊述したロック装眮の操䜜レバヌは遊技盀の前面に沿っお回動し、その回動方向が呚壁郚の起立方向ず盞違しおいる。このため、仮に遊技盀及び内枠の境界郚䜍を介しお䞍正具等が挿入された堎合であっおも、同䞍正具による操䜜レバヌの䞍正操䜜を抑制できる。぀たり、操䜜レバヌを遊技盀の端面や呚壁郚に沿っお挿入した䞍正具によっおロック䜍眮からアンロック䜍眮に移動させようずしおも、䞍正具を抌し匕きする方向ず操䜜レバヌの操䜜方向ずが異なるため、そのような行為を困難なものずするこずができる。   The operation lever 440 of the locking device 400 described above rotates along the front surface of the game board 80, and the rotation direction is different from the standing direction of the peripheral wall portion 261. For this reason, even if an unauthorized tool or the like is inserted through the boundary portion between the game board 80 and the inner frame 13, the unauthorized operation of the operation lever 440 by the unauthorized tool can be suppressed. That is, even if the operation lever 440 is moved from the lock position to the unlock position by the unauthorized tool inserted along the end face of the game board 80 or the peripheral wall portion 261, the direction in which the unauthorized tool is pushed and pulled and the operation direction of the operation lever 440 Because of this, such actions can be made difficult.

本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技領域が誘導レヌル及び遊技領域区画郚材によっお区画されおおり、それら䞡者ずガラスずの隙間が遊技球の盎埄以䞋ずなるように構成されおいる。これら誘導レヌル及び遊技領域区画郚材は、遊技領域に察するアクセスを劚げる障害物ずしお機胜するだけでなく、䞍正を行うための䜜業スペヌスの確保を困難なものずする隙埋め郚材ずしお機胜する。たた、仮に䜜業スペヌスを拡倧すべく、遊技盀が内枠の背面偎に匕っ匵られた堎合には、内枠詳しくは察向板郚ず遊技盀ずの隙間が枛瞮され䞍正具の移動が制限されやすくなる。以䞊の理由から、遊技盀に察する䞍正を行いづらくし、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献しおいる。   In the present embodiment, the game area PE is partitioned by the guide rail 100 and the game area partition member 480, and the gap between them and the glass 22 is configured to be equal to or smaller than the diameter of the game ball. The guide rail 100 and the game area partition member 480 function not only as an obstacle that prevents access to the game area PE but also as a gap filling member that makes it difficult to secure a work space for fraud. Further, if the game board 80 is pulled to the back side of the inner frame 13 in order to enlarge the work space, the gap between the inner frame 13 (specifically, the opposing plate portion 251) and the game board 80 is reduced and illegal. The movement of the tool is likely to be restricted. For the above reasons, it is difficult to cheat the game board 80 and contributes to the improvement of the crime prevention function.

パチンコ機を搬送しおいる際、すなわち遊技ホヌルの島蚭備等に蚭眮する以前は、内枠の開口郚を通じた斜錠装眮におけるカム郚材の取り倖しが蚱容されおいる。このカム郚材を取り倖すこずにより、連動杆の移動が蚱容され、前扉甚鉀郚材を解錠状態に切り替えるこずで、前扉枠を開攟するこずができる。このように、手間はかかるものの、操䜜キヌを䜿甚するこずなく解錠操䜜を可胜ずするこずで、緊急時の前扉枠の開攟が可胜ずなっおいる。䞀方、内枠遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態では、開口郚を通じたカム郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に倖枠の右枠郚が䜍眮する。これにより、同開口郚を通じたカム郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなり、カム郚材が取り倖されお各前扉甚鉀郚材が斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられるこずを抑制できる。故に、搬送時等の前扉枠の緊急開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、内枠遊技機䞻郚を蚭眮した状態での前扉枠の䞍正開攟行為を困難なものずするこずができる。すなわち、利䟿性を向䞊し぀぀、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。   Removal of the cam member 530 in the locking device 500 through the opening 320 of the inner frame 13 is allowed when the pachinko machine 10 is being transported, that is, before being installed in an island facility or the like of the game hall. By removing the cam member 530, the movement of the interlocking rod 540 is allowed, and the front door frame 14 can be opened by switching the front door rod members 550 and 580 to the unlocked state. Thus, although it takes time and effort, the front door frame 14 can be opened in an emergency by enabling the unlocking operation without using the operation keys. On the other hand, in a state where the inner frame 13 (the gaming machine main part 12) is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the right frame part 380 of the outer frame 11 is positioned on the removal track of the cam member 530 through the opening 320. Thereby, it becomes difficult or impossible to remove the cam member 530 through the opening 320, and it is possible to prevent the cam member 530 from being removed and the front door flange members 550 and 580 from being switched to the unlocked state. Therefore, it is possible to make it difficult to open the front door frame 14 with the inner frame 13 (the main part 12 of the gaming machine) in an unauthorized state while allowing the front door frame 14 to be opened urgently during transportation. it can. That is, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention while improving convenience.

開口郚䜿甚時の利䟿性向䞊を考慮するず、同開口郚はある皋床倧きく圢成するこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、単に開口郚を倧きくしただけでは、同開口郚を通じお䞍正具が挿入されるずいった䞍郜合が生じやすくなる。この点、䞊蚘実斜の圢態によれば、遊技機䞻郚を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態にお開口郚ず倖枠の右枠郚ずを察向させるこずにより、開口郚ぞのアクセス経路を枛瞮しおいる。これにより、開口郚を通じたカム郚材や鉀郚材等ぞの䞍正なアクセスを抑制し、防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑え぀぀、利䟿性の向䞊に貢献しおいる。   In consideration of convenience when using the opening 320, the opening 340 is preferably formed to be somewhat large. However, simply increasing the size of the opening 340 tends to cause inconvenience that an unauthorized tool is inserted through the opening 340. In this regard, according to the above embodiment, the opening 320 is made to face the opening 320 and the right frame 380 of the outer frame 11 with the gaming machine main part 12 closed with respect to the outer frame 11. The access route to is reduced. Thereby, unauthorized access to the cam member 530, the eaves member 550, and the like through the opening 320 is suppressed, thereby contributing to improvement in convenience while suppressing a decrease in the security function.

仮にの壁面郚に開口郚を圢成した堎合を想定するず、開口郚ず倖枠ずが向き合っおいる方向に内枠遊技機䞻郚が抌される等しお、開口郚ず倖枠ずの隙間が拡がった堎合、同開口郚における防犯機胜が䞀気に䜎䞋するず考えられる。この点、本実斜の圢態によれば、開口郚を異なる方向を向いた壁面郚に跚るように圢成するこずで、䜍眮ばら぀きの圱響による防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑えやすくしおいる。具䜓的には、内枠が巊右に抌される等しお、内枠における壁面郚の第1開口郚䜍ず倖枠の壁面郚ずの間隔が拡がっおも、壁面郚
の第開口郚䜍ず倖枠の壁面郚ずの間隔の拡がりは回避される。たた、内枠が前埌に抌し匕きされる等しお、壁面郚の第開口郚䜍ず倖枠の壁面郚ずの間隔が拡がった堎合であっおも、内枠における壁面郚の第1開口郚䜍ず倖枠の壁面郚ずの間隔の拡がりは回避さ
れる。これにより、内枠ず倖枠ずの盞察䜍眮ばら぀き等に起因しお、防犯機胜が䞀気に䜎䞋するこずを抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。
Assuming that an opening is formed in one wall surface part, the inner frame 13 (the gaming machine main part 12) is pushed in the direction in which the opening and the outer frame 11 face each other. When the gap with the frame 11 is widened, it is considered that the crime prevention function in the opening is lowered at a stretch. In this regard, according to the present embodiment, the opening 320 is formed so as to straddle the wall surface portions 311b, 312a, 312b facing in different directions, thereby making it easy to suppress the deterioration of the crime prevention function due to the influence of the position variation. Yes. Specifically, even when the inner frame 13 is pushed to the left and right, the wall surface portion 31 is increased even if the distance between the first opening portion of the wall surface portion 311b and the wall surface portion 385a of the outer frame 11 is increased.
Expansion of the space between the second opening portion 2a and the wall surface portions 385b and 386b of the outer frame 11 is avoided. Even when the inner frame 13 is pushed back and forth, for example, the distance between the second opening portion of the wall surface portion 312a and the wall surface portions 385b and 386b of the outer frame 11 is increased. Expansion of the space between the first opening portion of the wall surface portion 311b and the wall surface portion 385a of the outer frame 11 is avoided. Thereby, it can suppress that a crime prevention function falls at a stretch due to the relative position variation of the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11, etc., and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

たた、開口郚を構成する各開口郚䜍は、の開口郚䜍を通じおのカム郚材の取り倖しが䞍可ずなるように構成されおいる。このため、䞊述の劂く内枠ず倖枠ずの盞察䜍眮をずらしお、カム郚材の取り倖しを容易化するずいった䞍正行為を奜適に抑制できる。たた、防犯性を担保し぀぀、開口郚を拡げるこずによるカム郚材の緊急取倖䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。   Moreover, each opening part which comprises the opening part 320 is comprised so that the removal of the cam member 530 through one opening part becomes impossible. For this reason, as described above, it is possible to suitably suppress an illegal act of shifting the relative position between the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11 to facilitate the removal of the cam member 530. Moreover, it can contribute to the facilitation of the emergency removal work of the cam member 530 by expanding the opening part 320, ensuring crime prevention.

斜錠装眮は、内枠の回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮されおおり、斜錠状態におけるそれら内枠の浮き䞊がりを抑制しやすくしおいる。この堎合、内枠ず倖枠ずの境界郚䜍の近傍に斜錠装眮が䜍眮するため、同境界郚䜍を介しお䞍正具が挿入され同斜錠装眮に察しお䞍正なアクセスがなされるこずが懞念される。この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、内枠甚鉀郚材が内枠に圢成されたスリットから倖枠の鉀受け郚材偎に突出する構成ずしたこずで、同内枠甚鉀郚材の露出を抑え、䞊蚘䞍正具に狙われやすい箇所を枛瞮しおいる。これにより、防犯性の向䞊が図られおいる。   The locking device 500 is disposed at a position on the rotation tip side of the inner frame 13, and makes it easy to suppress the lifting of the inner frame 13 in the locked state. In this case, since the locking device 500 is located in the vicinity of the boundary part BP between the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11, an unauthorized tool is inserted through the boundary part BP and unauthorized access is made to the locking device 500. There is a concern. In this regard, in the present embodiment, the inner frame collar member 620 protrudes from the slit 512 formed in the inner frame 13 toward the collar receiving member 350 side of the outer frame 11, thereby The exposure of the member 620 is suppressed, and the portion that is easily targeted by the unauthorized tool is reduced. Thereby, the improvement of crime prevention is aimed at.

なお、仮に同スリットを通じお遊技機䞻郚内に䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、斜錠装眮収容郚の開攟郚䜍が斜錠装眮の第基枠によっお芆われおいるこずで、遊技領域等ぞの到達を困難なものずするこずができる。   Even if an unauthorized tool is inserted into the main part 12 of the gaming machine through the slit 303, the opening portion of the locking device housing portion 77 is covered by the first base frame 510 of the locking device 500. Thus, it is difficult to reach the game area PE or the like.

たた、本実斜の圢態においおは、前扉枠を閉じた状態で斜錠する前扉甚鉀郚材ず内枠を閉じた状態で斜錠する内枠甚鉀郚材ずをのコむルバネによっお付勢するこずで、それぞれ斜錠状態に維持する構成ずした。これにより、斜錠に関する構成の簡略化を実珟しおいる。   In the present embodiment, the front door frame member 550U that is locked with the front door frame 14 closed and the inner frame frame member 620U that is locked with the inner frame 13 closed are combined by one coil spring 560. It was set as the structure which maintains each in a locked state by energizing. Thereby, simplification of the structure regarding locking is realized.

このように、コむルバネを共甚する構成ずした堎合、仮に各鉀郚材の動䜜時に同鉀郚材ずコむルバネずが干枉するず䟋えば匕っ掛かるず斜錠状態ぞの切替が劚げられたり、付勢機胜が䜎䞋したりするず想定される。䟋えば同䞀平板䞊にそれら䞡鉀郚材を配眮するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、このような構成を採甚した堎合には、前扉甚鉀郚材の取付郚突起が内枠甚鉀郚材ずは反察偎に蚭けられおいるため、䞡鉀郚材を繋ぐコむルバネが前扉甚鉀郚材に近づきやすくなるず想定される。これは、䞊述したコむルバネず前扉甚鉀郚材ずの干枉を発生させる芁因ずなり埗る。この点、本実斜の圢態によれば、第基枠の基枠固定郚に前扉甚鉀郚材を取り付けるずずもに、同第基枠の郚材取付郚に内枠甚鉀郚材を取り付け、前扉甚鉀郚材の取付郚突起を郚材取付郚が起立しおいる偎ず同䞀偎に突出させるこずで、コむルバネず前扉甚鉀郚材ずの間に隙間を蚭定するこずが容易ずなっおいる。故に、䞊述した干枉の発生を抑え、動䜜䞍良等の䞍郜合を奜適に回避するこずができる。   Thus, when it is set as the structure which shares a coil spring, when the flange members 550U and 620U and the coil spring 560 interfere with each other during the operation of the flange members 550U and 620U, switching to the locked state may be prevented. It is assumed that the energizing function is lowered. For example, it is also possible to arrange these flange members 550U and 620U on the same flat plate. However, when such a configuration is adopted, the mounting portion (protrusion) of the front door collar member is provided on the side opposite to the inner frame collar member, so that the coil spring that connects both the collar members is the front door. It is assumed that it will be easy to get closer to the bag member. This can be a factor causing interference between the coil spring and the front door saddle member. In this regard, according to the present embodiment, the front door flange member 550U is attached to the base frame fixing portion 511 of the first base frame 510, and the inner frame flange member is attached to the member attachment portion 515 of the first base frame 510. 620 is attached, and the attachment portion (projection 622) of the front door saddle member 550U is projected to the same side as the side where the member attachment portion 515 stands, so that the coil spring 560 and the front door saddle member 550U are interposed between them. It is easy to set the gap. Therefore, the occurrence of the above-described interference can be suppressed, and inconveniences such as malfunction can be suitably avoided.

たた、基枠固定郚及び郚材取付郚に前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材を分けお配するこずで、各鉀郚材の動䜜領域を確保し぀぀、それら鉀郚材を䞀局近づけるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、前扉枠や内枠の浮き䞊がり抑制機胜を向䞊させるこずができる。   Further, the front door rod member 550U and the inner frame rod member 620U are separately arranged on the base frame fixing portion 511 and the member mounting portion 515, thereby securing the operation area of each of the flange members 550U and 620U. The members 550U and 620U can be brought closer to each other. Thereby, the function of suppressing the lifting of the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 can be improved.

斜錠装眮は、内枠に取り付けられおいるため、前扉枠のみを開攟させたり、内枠のみを開攟させたりするこずが容易ずなり、メンテナンス等を行う際の䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。   Since the locking device 500 is attached to the inner frame 13, it is easy to open only the front door frame 14 or only the inner frame 13, which facilitates work when performing maintenance or the like. Can contribute.

たた、前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材の第基枠における長手方向でのずれを枛らし、それら䞡鉀郚材を奜適に近づけお配眮するこずが可胜ずなる。このように、䞡鉀郚材を近づけお配眮可胜な構成においお、䞊述の劂くコむルバネの取付䜍眮を工倫すれば、同コむルバネの動䜜ストロヌクを奜適に確保でき、コむルバネの蚭眮領域確保のために䞡鉀郚材を近づけにくくなるずいった䞍郜合を奜適に抑制できる。   In addition, it is possible to reduce the displacement of the front door flange member 550U and the inner frame flange member 620U in the first base frame 510 in the longitudinal direction, and arrange both the flange members 550U and 620U close to each other. In this way, in the configuration in which the two flange members 550U and 620U can be arranged close to each other, if the mounting position of the coil spring 560 is devised as described above, the operation stroke of the coil spring 560 can be suitably secured, and the installation area of the coil spring 560 is secured. For this reason, it is possible to suitably suppress the inconvenience that the two flange members 550U and 620U are difficult to approach.

のコむルバネによっお぀の鉀郚材を繋ぐ構成を採甚した堎合、付勢力の䜜甚する方向ず各鉀郚材の動䜜方向ずが異なるず、各鉀郚材が動䜜する際に回転モヌメントが発生しやすくなるず想定される。この回転モヌメントは、鉀郚材の円滑な動䜜を劚げる芁因ずなり埗るため、できるだけ小さくするこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、䟋えば各鉀郚材をスラむド匏ずした堎合には、䞡鉀郚材の動䜜軌道を揃える等する必芁が生じ、鉀郚材のレむアりトに制玄が生じやすくなる。これは、䞡鉀郚材を第基枠の端郚に近づけお配眮するこずを困難にし、浮き䞊がり抑制機胜の向䞊に反するこずずなるため奜たしくない。この点、本実斜の圢態に瀺すように、䞡鉀郚材の䞀方を回動匏ずすれば、䞊蚘回転モヌメントによる圱響を抑えやすくでき、䞊述したレむアりト䞊の制玄を䜎枛できる。これにより、構成の簡略化ず浮き䞊がり抑制機胜の向䞊ずを奜適に䞡立できる。   In the case of adopting a configuration in which two coil members are connected by one coil spring, it is assumed that if the direction in which the urging force acts and the operation direction of each collar member are different, a rotational moment is likely to be generated when each collar member operates. Is done. Since this rotational moment can be a factor that hinders the smooth operation of the eaves member, it is preferable to make it as small as possible. However, for example, when each collar member is slidable, it is necessary to align the operation trajectories of both collar members, and the layout of the collar members is likely to be restricted. This is not preferable because it makes it difficult to dispose the two flange members close to the end portion of the first base frame 510 and goes against the improvement of the floating suppression function. In this regard, as shown in the present embodiment, if one of the both-side members is of a rotating type, the influence of the rotational moment can be easily suppressed, and the above-described layout restrictions can be reduced. As a result, both simplification of the configuration and improvement of the lifting suppression function can be suitably achieved.

䞊䞋にずらしお配眮された前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材をコむルバネによっお繋ぐ堎合、鉀受け郚材に察する各鉀郚材の匕っ掛かり態様によっおは、斜錠状態ぞの切り替えが円滑に行われなくなる可胜性が生じる。具䜓的に説明すれば、前扉枠や内枠が回動可胜に支持されおいる構成においおは、それら前扉枠や内枠が自重等によっお䞋方に傟きやすくなるず想定される。このような傟きに基づく䜍眮ずれの床合いは、回動先端偎にお倧きくなる。仮に、各鉀郚材が鉀受け郚材に察しお䞊方から匕っ掛かる構成を採甚した堎合には、䞊蚘䜍眮ずれによっお鉀郚材の䜍眮が䞋がるこずで前扉枠や内枠を閉じる際に鉀郚材ず鉀受け郚材ずが匷干枉し埗る。これは、鉀郚材に過床な負荷を生じさせ、同鉀郚材の斜錠機胜を損なう芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。特に、䞊述の劂く各鉀郚材をコむルバネによっお繋いだ堎合、それら䞡鉀郚材の付勢方向が逆向きになるため、䞀方の鉀郚材においおは鉀受け郚材に察しお䞊偎から匕っ掛かりやすくなるず懞念される。   When the front door rod member 550U and the inner frame rod member 620U that are arranged to be shifted up and down are connected by the coil spring 560, depending on how the flange members 550U and 620U are hooked to the rod receiving members 63 and 350, There is a possibility that switching will not be performed smoothly. If it demonstrates concretely, in the structure by which the front door frame 14 and the inner frame 13 are supported so that rotation is possible, it will be assumed that these front door frames 14 and the inner frame 13 become easy to incline below by dead weight. The degree of misalignment based on such inclination increases on the rotation tip side. Temporarily, when adopting a configuration in which each heel member is hooked from above with respect to the heel receiving member, the position of the heel member is lowered due to the above-described positional deviation, and the heel member is closed when the front door frame 14 or the inner frame 13 is closed. Strong interference with the hook receiving member is possible. This is not preferable because it can cause an excessive load on the heel member and can impair the locking function of the heel member. In particular, when the flange members are connected by a coil spring as described above, the urging directions of the both flange members are reversed, so there is a concern that one of the flange members is likely to be caught from the upper side with respect to the flange receiving member. .

この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、内枠甚鉀郚材を回動匏、前扉甚鉀郚材をスラむド匏ずするこずで、前扉甚鉀郚材における鉀郚の付勢方向をそのたたに、内枠甚鉀郚材の鉀郚の付勢方向を逆転させおいる。぀たり、内枠甚鉀郚材においおは、コむルバネが取り付けられおいる突起を、回動䞭心軞線に察しお鉀郚ずは反察偎に配するこずで、同鉀郚の付勢方向を逆転させおいる。そしお、各鉀郚材の鉀郚が各鉀受け郚材に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かる構成ずするこずで、䞊蚘䜍眮ばら぀きが生じた堎合であっおも、各鉀郚材ず各鉀受け郚材ずが匷干枉するこずを抑制し、斜錠に関する構成の保護に貢献しおいる。   In this regard, in the present embodiment, the inner frame collar member 620U is pivotable and the front door collar member 550U is slidable, so that the biasing direction of the collar portion 555 in the front door collar member 550U is changed. As it is, the urging direction of the flange portion 625 of the inner frame flange member 620U is reversed. In other words, in the inner frame flange member 620U, the protrusion 622 to which the coil spring 560 is attached is disposed on the opposite side of the flange portion 625 with respect to the rotation center axis, so that the biasing direction of the flange portion 625 is increased. Is reversed. And even if it is a case where the said position dispersion | variation arises by setting it as the structure by which the collar part 555,625 of each collar member 550U and 620U is hooked from the lower side with respect to each collar receiving member 63,350, each collar member Suppressing strong interference between 550U and 620U and the flange receiving members 63 and 350 contributes to protection of the configuration related to locking.

内枠には、内枠甚鉀郚材の鉀郚が斜錠䜍眮から斜錠解陀䜍眮に移動する堎合に通過する領域以䞋䟿宜䞊通過領域ず称するに察しお同内枠の察向壁郚が回動先端偎から重なる構成ずした。これにより、仮に内枠ず倖枠ずの境界郚䜍からワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、その䞍正具による鉀郚ぞのアクセスを困難なものずし、同䞍正具によっお鉀郚が斜錠解陀䜍眮に移動され、斜錠が䞍正に解陀されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。すなわち、防犯性の向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   The inner frame 13 has an opposing wall portion of the inner frame 13 with respect to an area (hereinafter referred to as a passing area for convenience) through which the collar 625 of the inner frame collar member 620 moves from the locking position to the locking release position. 305 is configured to overlap from the rotation tip side. As a result, even if an unauthorized tool such as a wire is inserted from the boundary portion BP between the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11, it is difficult to access the collar 625 by the unauthorized tool. The hook 625 is moved to the lock release position by the tool, and the inconvenience that the lock is illegally released can be prevented. That is, it can contribute to the improvement of crime prevention.

たた、内枠甚鉀郚材の配蚭察象ず同䞀の察象すなわち内枠に察向壁郚を圢成したこずで、仮に内枠が閉䜍眮にお䜍眮ずれ等した堎合であっおも、察向壁郚ず鉀郚ずの䜍眮関係の倉化を奜適に抑制できる。぀たり、内枠の倖枠に察する䜍眮ずれ等に起因した防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。䟋えば、䞍正行為者が内枠を抌す等しお同内枠の䜍眮を故意にずらし、そのずらした状態にお鉀郚ぞのアクセスを詊みた堎合であっおも、そのような予備的䜜業によっお鉀郚の移動が容易になるこずを抑制できる。   In addition, since the opposing wall portion 305 is formed on the same object (that is, the inner frame 13) as the arrangement object of the inner frame collar member 620, the inner frame 13 is temporarily displaced at the closed position. Moreover, the change of the positional relationship of the opposing wall part 305 and the collar part 625 can be suppressed suitably. That is, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention due to a positional shift of the inner frame 13 with respect to the outer frame 11 or the like. For example, even if a fraudulent person intentionally shifts the position of the inner frame 13 by pressing the inner frame 13 and attempts to access the collar 625 in the shifted state, such a reserve It can suppress that the movement of the collar part 625 becomes easy by manual work.

内枠を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態では察向壁郚の先端郚分が倖枠の鉀受け郚材内に収容される。これにより、仮に䞊蚘境界郚䜍から䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、同䞍正具を操䜜しお察向壁郚を迂回させるこずが困難なものずなっおいる。   In a state where the inner frame 13 is closed with respect to the outer frame 11, the front end portion of the opposing wall portion 305 is accommodated in the flange receiving member 350 of the outer frame 11. Accordingly, even if an unauthorized tool is inserted from the boundary part BP, it is difficult to operate the unauthorized tool to bypass the facing wall portion 305.

察向壁郚ず鉀受け郚の開口ずの隙間においお鉀郚が斜錠解陀䜍眮ぞ移動する堎合の移動方向先偎における隙間は、鉀郚ず鉀受け郚ずの掛かり代よりも小さく蚭定した。このため、内枠が斜錠解陀䜍眮偎に䜍眮ずれした堎合であっおも、察向壁郚ず鉀郚の䞊蚘通過領域ずの重なりを奜適に担保するこずができる。   In the gap between the opposing wall 305 and the opening 353 of the hook receiving part 351, the gap on the moving direction ahead side when the hook part 625 moves to the unlocking position is more than the allowance between the hook part 625 and the hook receiving part 351. Set small. For this reason, even if it is a case where the inner frame 13 has shifted | deviated to the lock release position side, the overlap with the said passage area | region of the opposing wall part 305 and the collar part 625 can be ensured suitably.

内枠のスリットを通じお鉀郚を露出させる構成ずすれば、斜錠装眮党䜓における露出郚分を枛瞮するこずができる。これにより、鉀郚を移動させる構成等が䞍正なアクセスの察象ずなるこずを抑制できる。しかしながら、鉀郚を移動可胜ずするには、スリットがその移動を蚱容する皋床の倧きさを有する必芁が生じ、スリットの小型化には限床がある。぀たり、スリットを通じた䞍正行為を抑制するには、スリットのサむズ倉曎だけで察応するのは困難であるず想定される。この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、察向壁郚をスリットの開口瞁に沿っお圢成するこずにより、仮に内枠ず倖枠ずの境界郚䜍を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、同察向壁郚により同䞍正具のスリット内ぞの䟵入を劚げるこずができる。これにより、スリットを通じた䞍正行為を奜適に抑制できる。   If it is set as the structure which exposes the collar part 625 through the slit 303 of the inner frame 13, the exposed part in the locking device 500 whole can be reduced. Thereby, it can suppress that the structure etc. which move the collar part 625 become the object of unauthorized access. However, in order to make the collar 625 movable, the slit 303 needs to have a size that allows the movement, and there is a limit to downsizing the slit 303. That is, it is assumed that it is difficult to cope with the fraudulent act through the slit 303 only by changing the size of the slit 303. In this respect, in the present embodiment, by forming the opposing wall portion 305 along the opening edge of the slit 303, it is assumed that an unauthorized tool is inserted through the boundary portion BP between the inner frame 13 and the outer frame 11. Even if it exists, the penetration | invasion into the slit 303 of the same unauthorized tool can be prevented by the opposing wall part 305. FIG. Thereby, the illegal act through the slit 303 can be suppressed suitably.

斜錠装眮ず察向壁郚ずを個別に蚭けた堎合、䞡者の補造ばら぀きや組付ばら぀き等の环積によっお、内枠甚鉀郚材の鉀郚ず察向壁郚ずの䜍眮関係がばら぀きやすくなるず想定される。このようなばら぀きは、察向壁郚による防犯機胜を䜎䞋させる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本実斜の圢態においおは、䞊蚘察向壁郚ず斜錠装眮を内枠に察しお取り付けるボスずを内枠に察しお䞀䜓成圢したこずにより䞊蚘ばら぀きを抑え、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   When the locking device 500 and the opposing wall portion 305 are provided separately, the positional relationship between the flange portion 625 of the inner frame flange member 620 and the opposing wall portion 305 varies due to the accumulation of manufacturing variations, assembly variations, and the like. It is assumed that it will be easier. Such variation is not preferable because it may cause a reduction in the security function by the facing wall portion 305. In this regard, in the present embodiment, the above-described variation is suppressed by integrally forming the opposing wall portion 305 and the boss 302 for attaching the locking device 500 to the inner frame 13 with respect to the inner frame 13, which is practically preferable. The configuration can be realized.

たた、察向壁郚を内枠に察しお䞀䜓成圢するこずで、同察向壁郚ず内枠ずを別䜓で蚭ける堎合ず比范しお、曎なる防犯性の向䞊が期埅できる。぀たり、察向壁郚ず内枠ずの隙間を通じお察向壁郚が迂回されるずいった䞍郜合を払拭し、察向壁郚の防犯機胜を奜適に発揮させるこずができる。   Further, by integrally forming the opposing wall portion 305 with respect to the inner frame 13, further improvement in crime prevention can be expected as compared with the case where the opposing wall portion 305 and the inner frame 13 are provided separately. That is, it is possible to eliminate the inconvenience that the opposing wall portion is detoured through the gap between the opposing wall portion and the inner frame 13 and to appropriately exhibit the crime prevention function of the opposing wall portion.

前扉枠が開攟された堎合に、遊技球発射ハンドルを内枠に残す構成ずするこずで、遊技球発射ハンドルず電源・発射制埡装眮ずを繋ぐ配線の取り回しの容易化が実珟されおいる。   When the front door frame 14 is opened, the game ball launching handle 40 is left in the inner frame 13, thereby facilitating the routing of the wiring connecting the game ball launching handle 40 and the power supply / launch control device 243. It has been realized.

前扉枠を開攟する際にはハンドルベヌスが内枠偎に残留する構成ずなっおいる。このようにハンドルベヌスが残留する構成においおは、同ハンドルベヌス呚蟺での前扉枠の浮き䞊がりが発生しやすくなるず懞念される。䟋えば、前扉枠におけるハンドルベヌス呚蟺を匕っ匵る等しお、内枠ず前扉枠ずの隙間境界郚䜍が拡匵され、その隙間を介しおワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入されるこずで、遊技領域等ぞのアクセスが容易になるず懞念される。   When the front door frame 14 is opened, the handle base 41 remains on the inner frame 13 side. In such a configuration in which the handle base 41 remains, there is a concern that the front door frame 14 is likely to be lifted around the handle base 41. For example, the gap (boundary part) between the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14 is expanded by pulling the vicinity of the handle base 41 in the front door frame 14, and unauthorized tools such as wires are inserted through the gap. Thus, there is a concern that access to the game area PE and the like will be facilitated.

そこで、内枠においおハンドルベヌスが蚭けられおいる偎に前扉甚第鉀郚材を配眮し、曎にはハンドルベヌスず内枠の回動䞭心軞線ずの間に前扉甚第鉀郚材を配眮するこずで、内枠からの前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを抑制しおいる。これにより、ハンドルベヌス呚蟺での防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑えるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   Therefore, the front door first flange member 550 is disposed on the side of the inner frame 13 where the handle base 41 is provided, and further, the front door is disposed between the handle base 41 and the rotation center axis CL of the inner frame 13. By disposing the second flange member 580, the front door frame 14 is prevented from being lifted from the inner frame 13. Thereby, it is possible to suppress the deterioration of the crime prevention function around the handle base 41.

前扉枠を回動可胜に支持する構成においおは、回動基端偎に比べお回動先端偎での浮き䞊がりが顕著になりやすい。そこで、前扉甚第鉀郚材をハンドルベヌス寄りに配眮するこずで、䞊述した前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制しおいる。   In the configuration in which the front door frame 14 is rotatably supported, the lift at the rotating distal end side is likely to be remarkable as compared with the rotating proximal end side. Thus, the front door second flange member 580 is disposed closer to the handle base 41, so that the above-described lifting of the front door frame 14 is suitably suppressed.

前扉甚第鉀郚材及びハンドルベヌスを内枠の䞋端に沿っお䞊蚭するこずにより、䞊蚘境界郚䜍の拡がりを奜適に抑えおいる。曎に、前扉甚第鉀郚材が内枠の䞋端に沿っお動䜜する構成ずするこずで、同前扉甚第鉀郚材の動䜜スペヌスを確保し぀぀䞊蚘境界郚䜍に察しお圓該前扉甚第鉀郚材を近づけるこずができる。これにより、前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制し、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献できる。   The front door second brim member 580 and the handle base 41 are juxtaposed along the lower end of the inner frame 13 to suitably suppress the expansion of the boundary portion. Further, by configuring the front door second collar member 580 to operate along the lower end of the inner frame 13, the front door second collar member 580 is secured with respect to the boundary portion while securing an operation space. The 2nd collar member 580 for front doors can be approximated. Thereby, the floating of the front door frame 14 is suppressed suitably and it can contribute to the improvement of a crime prevention function.

前扉甚第鉀郚材の斜錠䜍眮が斜錠解陀䜍眮よりもハンドルベヌス寄りずなる構成ずした。これにより、斜錠解陀䜍眮が斜錠䜍眮よりもハンドルベヌス偎ずなるように構成した堎合ず比范しお、ハンドルベヌスに察しおより近い䜍眮にお前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを抑えるこずが可胜ずなる。故に、䞊述した䞡領域の境界郚䜍を介しお行われる䞍正行為を䞀局困難なものずするこずができる。   The second door member 580 for the front door is configured such that the locking position is closer to the handle base 41 than the locking release position. As a result, it is possible to suppress the front door frame 14 from being lifted at a position closer to the handle base 41 as compared with a case where the lock release position is closer to the handle base 41 than the lock position. Become. Therefore, it is possible to make an illegal act performed through the boundary portion between the two regions described above more difficult.

前扉枠を内枠に察しお閉じる際には、膚出郚及び第基枠によっお前扉枠の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる状態にお、前扉甚第鉀郚材が斜錠解陀状態から斜錠状態に切り替えられる。このため、前扉枠の傟き等による圱響を受けにくくし前扉甚第鉀郚材の切り替えが劚げられるこずを抑制できる。特に、前扉枠は䞊皿䞋皿ガラスランプ郚〜スピヌカ郚等を有しおいるこずでその重量がかさみやすくなっおおり、回動䞭心軞線を基端ずした傟きが発生しやすいが、このような重量による圱響を受けにくくするこずで、前扉甚第鉀郚材を回動先端寄りに配眮しやすくしおいる。これにより、前扉甚第鉀郚材の斜錠機胜を奜適なものずするこずができる。   When the front door frame 14 is closed with respect to the inner frame 13, the front door second collar member is in a state where the vertical position of the front door frame 14 is defined by the bulging portion 66 and the second base frame 570. 580 is switched from the unlocked state to the locked state. For this reason, it is difficult to be influenced by the inclination of the front door frame 14 and the switching of the front door second brim member 580 can be suppressed. In particular, the front door frame 14 includes the upper plate 33, the lower plate 34, the glass 22, the lamp units 23 to 25, the speaker unit 26, and the like, so that the weight thereof is easily increased. Although the inclination which made the edge easy to generate | occur | produce, it makes it easy to arrange | position the 2nd eaves member 580 for front doors near a rotation front end by making it difficult to be influenced by such weight. Thereby, the locking function of the 2nd collar member 580 for front doors can be made suitable.

ハンドルベヌスは、前扉枠ずは異なり、郜床の開攟を考慮する必芁がないため、内枠に察しお匷固に固定するこずができる。故に、ハンドルベヌスず内枠ずの境界郚䜍を通じお䞍正具が挿入されるこずを抑制しやすくなっおいる。このように、防犯性に優れた郚材の背埌にカム郚材やシリンダ錠を固定するネゞ等が配眮されおいるこずで、同カム郚材等に察する䞍正なアクセスを抑制し、防犯性の向䞊に貢献しおいる。   Unlike the front door frame 14, the handle base 41 does not need to be considered for each opening, and can be firmly fixed to the inner frame 13. Therefore, it is easy to suppress the unauthorized tool from being inserted through the boundary portion between the handle base 41 and the inner frame 13. As described above, the screw 527 and the like for fixing the cam member 530 and the cylinder lock 520 are disposed behind the member having excellent crime prevention properties, so that unauthorized access to the cam member 530 and the like can be suppressed, and the crime prevention Contributes to improvement.

ハンドルベヌスを内枠においお前扉枠の回動先端偎に配眮するこずにより、前扉枠ずハンドルベヌスずの合わせを奜適なものずしおいる。぀たり、前扉枠が回動する際に、ハンドルベヌスの正面偎を通過するこずはなく、ハンドルベヌスず前扉枠ずの境界郚䜍は、ハンドルベヌスにおける前扉枠の回動先端偎及び䞋偎の端郚を陀いた郚分に限定されおいる。これにより、ハンドルベヌスず内枠ずの境界郚䜍がハンドルベヌスの呚瞁党域に広がるこずを抑え、同境界郚䜍を通じお䞍正具を挿入するずいった䞍正行為を行いにくくしおいる。   By arranging the handle base 41 on the rotating tip side of the front door frame 14 in the inner frame 13, the front door frame 14 and the handle base 41 are suitably aligned. That is, when the front door frame 14 rotates, it does not pass through the front side of the handle base 41, and the boundary portion between the handle base 41 and the front door frame 14 is rotated by the front door frame 14 in the handle base 41. It is limited to the portion excluding the moving tip side and the lower end. As a result, the boundary portion between the handle base 41 and the inner frame 13 is prevented from spreading over the entire periphery of the handle base 41, and it is difficult to perform an illegal act such as inserting an unauthorized tool through the boundary portion.

前扉枠は、前扉甚第鉀郚材によっおハンドルベヌスず前扉枠の回動䞭心軞線ずの間におその浮き䞊がりが抑えられおいる。これにより、前扉枠ず内枠の䞋偎枠郚ずの隙間が拡がりやすくなるこずを抑制しおいる。   The front door frame 14 is restrained from rising between the handle base 41 and the rotation center axis of the front door frame 14 by the front door second flange member 580. Thereby, it is suppressed that the clearance gap between the front door frame 14 and the lower frame part 13b of the inner frame 13 becomes easy to expand.

前扉甚第鉀郚材は、シリンダ錠における解錠操䜜に基づいお、斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられる。぀たり、前扉甚第鉀郚材の切り替えに連動する構成ずなっおいる。これにより、閉じ切り機胜を向䞊し぀぀、斜錠解陀操䜜の煩雑化を抑え、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟しおいる。   The front door second hook member 580 is switched to the unlocked state based on the unlocking operation of the cylinder lock 520. That is, it is configured to be interlocked with the switching of the first door member 550 for the front door. Thereby, while improving the closing function, the complexity of the unlocking operation is suppressed, and a practically preferable configuration is realized.

なお、䞊述した実斜の圢態の蚘茉内容に限定されず、䟋えば次のように実斜しおもよい。因みに、以䞋の別圢態の構成を、䞊蚘実斜の圢態における構成に察しお、個別に適甚しおもよく、盞互に組み合わせお適甚しおもよい。   In addition, it is not limited to the description content of embodiment mentioned above, For example, you may implement as follows. Incidentally, the configuration of another embodiment described below may be applied individually to the configuration in the above embodiment, or may be applied in combination with each other.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「付勢手段」ずしおの板バネを䞊䞋に蚭け、それら䞡板バネの間にストッパを配眮したが、それら板バネの間のストッパを省略するこずも可胜である。すなわち、各板バネは぀のストッパの間に配眮されおいればよく、必ずしもそれら板バネの間にストッパを配眮する必芁はない。たた、板バネは、぀のストッパの間に配眮するのであればその個数を任意に蚭定しおよい。䟋えば、䞊蚘実斜の圢態においお䞡板バネの間に第の板バネを远加するこずも可胜である。この堎合、その第の板バネを䞊蚘䞡板バネの間に配眮されおいる぀のストッパの䞭間䜍眮に配眮するずよい。   (A1) In the above embodiment, the plate springs 270 as the “biasing means” are provided on the upper and lower sides and the stopper 267 is disposed between the two plate springs 270, but the stopper 267 between the plate springs 270 is omitted. It is also possible to do. That is, each leaf spring 270 may be disposed between the two stoppers 267, and the stopper 267 is not necessarily disposed between the leaf springs 270. Further, the number of the leaf springs 270 may be arbitrarily set as long as the leaf springs 270 are disposed between the two stoppers 267. For example, a third leaf spring can be added between the leaf springs 270 in the above embodiment. In this case, the third plate spring may be disposed at an intermediate position between the two stoppers 267 disposed between the two plate springs 270.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、板バネの頂郚がストッパよりも遊技盀の回動先端偎に䜍眮する構成ずしたがこれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、内枠の平面芖においお頂郚がストッパの背埌に䜍眮する構成ずしおもよい。   (A2) In the above-described embodiment, the top portion 272a of the leaf spring 270 is positioned closer to the rotating front end of the game board 80 than the stopper 267. However, the present invention is not limited to this. For example, the top portion 272a may be positioned behind the stopper 267 in plan view of the inner frame 13.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、板バネ及びストッパを内枠においお遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮したが、これを以䞋のように倉曎するこずも可胜である。すなわち、それら板バネ及びストッパを内枠においお遊技盀の回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮するこずも可胜であり、内枠においお遊技盀の䞊端又は䞋端に沿う䜍眮に配眮するこずも可胜である。曎には、板バネ及びストッパを遊技盀の倖呚に沿っお配眮するこずも可胜である。䜆し、遊技盀を回動しお装着する堎合、ストッパがその回動軌道䞊に匵り出すず、遊技盀の装着䜜業が難しくなり埗る。故に、望たしくは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、板バネ及びストッパを遊技盀の回動基端寄りに配眮し、その他の郚䜍ではロック装眮に瀺すように切替え匏の䜍眮決め手段を甚いるずよい。   (A3) In the above embodiment, the leaf spring 270 and the stopper 267 are disposed at the position on the inner base frame 13 on the rotation base end side of the game board 80. However, it is possible to change this as follows. . In other words, the leaf spring 270 and the stopper 267 can be arranged at a position on the inner frame 13 that is on the rotation tip side of the game board 80, and arranged at a position along the upper end or lower end of the game board 80 in the inner frame 13. It is also possible to do. Furthermore, it is also possible to arrange a leaf spring and a stopper along the outer periphery of the game board 80. However, when the game board 80 is rotated and mounted, if the stopper protrudes on the rotation track, the mounting operation of the game board 80 may be difficult. Therefore, desirably, as shown in the above-described embodiment, the leaf spring and the stopper are arranged near the rotation base end of the game board, and the switchable positioning means is used as shown in the lock device 400 in other portions. Good.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䞀察のストッパ及びその間に配眮された板バネからなる組の䜍眮決め機構を、遊技盀の䞊端偎及び䞋端偎に組ず぀配したが、これら䜍眮決め機構の組数は組に限定されるものではない。本実斜の圢態においお特に、遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球が、遊技盀の䞋端偎にお誘導レヌルに着地する構成を採甚しおおり、この着地䜍眮呚蟺での䜍眮粟床を向䞊するこずが奜たしい。故に、少なくずも組の䜍眮決め機構を遊技盀の䞋端偎に配眮し、所望ずする䜍眮での䜍眮粟床を確保できればよい。   (A4) In the above embodiment, one set of positioning mechanism including the pair of stoppers 267 and the leaf spring 270 disposed between them is arranged on the upper end side and the lower end side of the game board 80. The number of mechanisms is not limited to two. Particularly in the present embodiment, a configuration is adopted in which the game balls launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 land on the guide rail 100 on the lower end side of the game board 80, and the positional accuracy around this landing position is achieved. It is preferable to improve. Therefore, it is only necessary to arrange at least one set of positioning mechanisms on the lower end side of the game board 80 to ensure the position accuracy at a desired position.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䞀察のストッパの䞁床真ん䞭ずなる䜍眮に板バネを配眮したが、これを倉曎し、板バネをどちらか䞀方のストッパ寄りに配眮するこずも可胜である。   (A5) In the above-described embodiment, the leaf spring 270 is disposed at a position that is exactly in the middle of the pair of stoppers 267. However, the leaf spring 270 may be disposed closer to one of the stoppers 267 by changing this. It is.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の回動基端偎の瞁郚に沿っお配眮された䞀察のストッパずその間に配眮された板バネによっお組の䜍眮決め手段を構成したが、これを以䞋のように倉曎するこずも可胜である。すなわち、䞊蚘䞀察のストッパに加え、回動先端偎にオフセットしお蚭けられた第のストッパを蚭け、内枠の正面芖においおそれら぀のストッパにより囲たれた範囲内に板バネを配眮し、これら぀のストッパ及び぀の板バネによっお組の䜍眮決め手段を構成するこずも可胜である。これにより、のストッパを基端ずした遊技盀の回動を奜適に抑制でき、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。なお、぀のストッパによっお囲たれた範囲内に耇数の板バネを配眮するこずも可胜である。   (A6) In the above embodiment, a pair of positioning means is configured by the pair of stoppers 267 arranged along the edge of the game board 80 on the rotation base end side and the leaf spring 270 arranged therebetween. It is also possible to change this as follows. That is, in addition to the pair of stoppers 267, a third stopper 267 is provided that is offset from the rotation tip side, and the leaf spring is within a range surrounded by the three stoppers 267 when the inner frame 13 is viewed from the front. It is also possible to arrange 270 and configure a set of positioning means by these three stoppers 267 and one leaf spring 270. Thereby, the rotation of the game board 80 with the one stopper 267 as the base end can be suitably suppressed, which can contribute to the improvement of positioning accuracy. Note that a plurality of leaf springs 270 can be disposed within a range surrounded by the three stoppers 267.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「付勢手段」ずしお鋌板を略字状に折り返しお圢成した板バネを甚いたが、「付勢手段」はそれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、鋌板を略く字状に折り曲げお別皮の板バネを圢成しおもよい。たた、板バネに倉えお、コむルバネやゎムクッション等を甚いるこずも可胜である。   (A7) In the above embodiment, the plate spring 270 formed by folding a steel plate into a substantially U shape is used as the “biasing means”, but the “biasing means” is not limited to this. For example, another type of leaf spring may be formed by bending a steel plate into a substantially square shape. Further, instead of the leaf spring 270, a coil spring, a rubber cushion, or the like can be used.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、板バネの折曲郚が巊偎壁郚ず察峙するように同板バネを配眮したが、同板バネを折曲郚が巊偎壁郚ずは反察偎を向くように配眮しおもよい。䜆し、察向板郚に板バネを蚭眮する構成においおは、遊技盀からの反力を巊偎壁郚に近い䜍眮で受けるこずにより、同察向板郚の撓み倉圢を抑え、付勢機胜を担保しやすくできるずいったメリットがある。この点、䞊述した倉曎を行った堎合には、このメリットを享受しにくくなるず想定される。故に、奜たしくは䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺した構成を採甚するずよい。   (A8) In the above embodiment, the leaf spring 270 is disposed so that the bent portion 273 of the leaf spring 270 faces the left wall portion 264. However, the bent portion 273 of the leaf spring 270 is disposed on the left wall portion 264. You may arrange | position so that it may face the other side. However, in the configuration in which the leaf spring 270 is installed on the opposing plate portion 251, the reaction force from the game board 80 is received at a position close to the left side wall portion 264, thereby suppressing the bending deformation of the opposite plate portion 251 and biasing There is an advantage that the function can be easily secured. In this regard, it is assumed that it is difficult to enjoy this merit when the above-described changes are made. Therefore, the configuration described in the above embodiment is preferably used.

なお、板バネの蚭眮察象は、察向板郚に限られたものではなく、同板バネに盞圓する構成を巊偎壁郚に蚭眮するこずも可胜である。   The installation target of the leaf spring 270 is not limited to the counter plate portion 251, and a configuration corresponding to the leaf spring 270 can be installed on the left side wall portion 264.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ストッパを内枠に䞀䜓成圢したがストッパを内枠ずは別䜓で蚭けるこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、ストッパの補造ばら぀きや装着ばら぀き等の誀差が环積するこずに起因しお䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋しやすくなるず想定される。故に、望たしくはストッパを内枠に察しお䞀䜓成圢し、そのような䞍郜合を回避するずよい。   (A9) In the above embodiment, the stopper 267 is integrally formed with the inner frame 13, but the stopper can be provided separately from the inner frame 13. However, in this case, it is assumed that positioning accuracy is likely to decrease due to accumulation of errors such as manufacturing variations and mounting variations of stoppers. Therefore, desirably, the stopper is integrally formed with the inner frame 13 to avoid such inconvenience.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ストッパの補匷機胜を有するプレヌト郚材ず板バネずを別䜓で蚭けたが、これら䞡者を䞀䜓成圢しおもよい。この堎合、ストッパに結合されおいる結合郚ず板バネ郚ずを繋ぐ繋ぎ郚を内枠䟋えば巊偎壁郚の内偎又は倖偎に配眮するこずが可胜であるが、遊技盀ずの干枉回避を考慮すれば、巊偎壁郚の倖偎に配眮するのが望たしい。このように、繋ぎ郚を巊偎壁郚の倖偎に配する堎合には、巊偎壁郚又は察向板郚に板バネ郚を内枠の内偎に突出させる開口等を圢成するずよい。   (A10) In the above embodiment, the plate member 268 having the reinforcing function of the stopper 267 and the plate spring 270 are provided separately, but both of them may be integrally formed. In this case, it is possible to arrange the connecting portion connecting the connecting portion connected to the stopper 267 and the leaf spring portion inside or outside the inner frame 13 (for example, the left side wall portion 264). In consideration of avoidance of interference, it is desirable to dispose outside the left side wall portion 264. As described above, when the connecting portion is disposed outside the left side wall portion 264, an opening or the like for projecting the leaf spring portion to the inside of the inner frame 13 may be formed in the left side wall portion 264 or the counter plate portion 251.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、プレヌト郚材によっおストッパを補匷する構成ずしたが、このプレヌト郚材を省略するこずも可胜である。この堎合、ストッパを倧型化する等しお、同ストッパ自身の匷床を向䞊させるこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、ストッパの匷床向䞊を図るず同ストッパの成圢が困難になるだけでなく、その䜍眮粟床の確保も難しくなるず想定される。故に、奜たしくはストッパに぀いおは粟床確保を優先し、匷床䞍足が懞念される堎合にはその䞍足分をプレヌト郚材によっお補う構成ずするこずが奜たしい。   (A11) In the above embodiment, the stopper 267 is reinforced by the plate member 268. However, the plate member 268 may be omitted. In this case, it is preferable to improve the strength of the stopper 267 itself, for example, by increasing the size of the stopper 267. However, when the strength of the stopper 267 is improved, it is assumed that not only it is difficult to form the stopper 267 but also it is difficult to ensure its positional accuracy. Therefore, it is preferable that the stopper 267 be configured so that priority is given to ensuring accuracy, and when there is a concern about insufficient strength, the shortage is compensated by the plate member 268.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の四隅にお同遊技盀を内枠の正面偎に付勢する構成ずしたが、遊技盀の付勢箇所は同遊技盀の䞡端偎に少なくずも箇所ず぀蚭定されおいれば他は任意である。䟋えば、遊技盀の䞊端偎の板バネ及びロック装眮詳しくはコむルバネを省略するこずも可胜である。   (B1) In the above embodiment, the gaming board 80 is biased to the front side of the inner frame 13 at the four corners of the gaming board 80. However, the biasing locations of the gaming board 80 are the opposite ends of the gaming board 80. Others are arbitrary as long as at least one location is set on the side. For example, the leaf spring 270 and the lock device 400 (specifically, the coil spring 430) on the upper end side of the game board 80 can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の回動基端偎の付勢態様ず回動先端偎での付勢態様が異なる構成ずしたが、それら䞡者を統䞀するこずも可胜である。䟋えば、板バネ及びストッパに代えお、ロック装眮を配眮するこずも可胜である。䜆し、既に説明したように、本実斜の圢態においおは前扉枠ずの干枉を回避し぀぀同遊技盀の小型化を回避するこず等を目的ずし、遊技盀の取り付けに回動方匏を採甚しおいる。仮に、遊技盀の回動先端偎にロック装眮を配眮するず、遊技盀を回動可胜ずするための構成が煩雑化するず想定される。たた、ロック装眮に代えお板バネ及びストッパに盞圓する構成を配眮するこずも可胜であるが、この堎合であっおもやはり、遊技盀の回動を阻害しないようにするための配慮が必芁ずなる。故に、構成の煩雑化を抑え぀぀、遊技盀をその䞡端にお付勢するには、回動基端偎に板バネ及びストッパを配し、回動先端偎にロック装眮を配するこずが奜たしい。   (B2) In the above embodiment, the biasing mode on the rotation base end side of the game board 80 and the biasing mode on the rotation leading end side are different, but it is also possible to unify both of them. For example, instead of the leaf spring 270 and the stopper 267, the lock device 400 can be arranged. However, as described above, in the present embodiment, for the purpose of avoiding the downsizing of the game board 80 while avoiding the interference with the front door frame 14, the rotation system is used to attach the game board 80. Is adopted. If the locking device 400 is arranged on the rotation tip side of the game board 80, it is assumed that the configuration for enabling the game board 80 to be rotated becomes complicated. In addition, it is possible to arrange a configuration corresponding to the leaf spring 270 and the stopper 267 in place of the locking device 400, but even in this case, the rotation of the game board 80 is not hindered. Consideration is required. Therefore, in order to urge the game board 80 at both ends while suppressing the complexity of the configuration, the leaf spring 270 and the stopper 267 are arranged on the rotating base end side, and the lock device 400 is arranged on the rotating tip side. It is preferable to do.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀を回動させるこずにより内枠に察しお着脱する構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、遊技盀をスラむド移動させるこずにより同内枠に察しお着脱する構成ずしおもよい。   (B3) In the above embodiment, the game board 80 is attached to and detached from the inner frame 13 by rotating, but the present invention is not limited to this. For example, the game board 80 may be detachably attached to the inner frame 13 by sliding.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ロック装眮の操䜜郚を回動させるこずでロック状態ずアンロック状態ずを切り替える構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、操䜜郚を特定方向にスラむド移動させるこずでロック状態ずアンロック状態ずを切り替える構成ずしおもよい。   (C1) In the above embodiment, the operation unit 446 of the lock device 400 is rotated to switch between the locked state and the unlocked state. However, this is changed and the operation unit is slid in a specific direction. It is good also as a structure which switches a locked state and an unlocked state.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ロック装眮による固定察象を遊技盀ずしたが、固定察象は同遊技盀に限定されるものではない。䟋えば、裏パックナニットや遊技球発射機構を固定察象ずしおもよい。   (C2) In the above-described embodiment, the game board 80 is the target to be fixed by the locking device 400, but the target to be fixed is not limited to the game board 80. For example, the back pack unit 15 and the game ball launching mechanism 110 may be fixed.

ロック装眮の配眮は任意である。䟋えば遊技盀の回動基端に寄せお配眮するこずも可胜である。䜆し、前扉枠の回動基端偎に寄せお配眮しおいる堎合には、ロック装眮を回動させるための䜜業スペヌスの確保が難しくなり埗る。故に、奜たしくは前扉枠の回動先端偎、すなわち遊技盀の回動先端偎に寄せお配眮するずよい。   (C3) The arrangement of the locking device 400 is arbitrary. For example, the game board 80 can be arranged close to the rotation base end. However, if the front door frame 14 is arranged close to the rotation base end side, it may be difficult to secure a work space for rotating the lock device 400. Therefore, it is preferable that the front door frame 14 be arranged close to the rotating front end side of the front door frame 14, that is, the rotating front end side of the game board 80.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、操䜜郚の操䜜量が所定量に達するず、遊技盀を抌すプッシャが䞀気に突出する構成ずしたが、これを以䞋のように倉曎するこずも可胜である。すなわち、操䜜郚の操䜜量の増加に応じおプッシャの突出量が埐々に増加する構成ずしおもよい。以䞋、図に基づきその具䜓䟋に぀いお説明する。図はロック装眮の倉圢䟋を瀺す抂略図であり、同図におけるドットハッチングはプッシャを瀺しおいる。   (C4) In the above embodiment, when the operation amount of the operation unit 446 reaches a predetermined amount, the pusher 420 that pushes the game board 80 protrudes at a stretch. However, this can be changed as follows. is there. That is, the protrusion amount of the pusher 420 may gradually increase as the operation amount of the operation unit 446 increases. Hereinafter, a specific example thereof will be described with reference to FIG. FIG. 34 is a schematic view showing a modified example of the locking device, and dot hatching in FIG. 34 shows a pusher.

図に瀺すように、ロック装眮は、内枠の背面偎筒郚に嵌っおいる軞䜓ず、その軞䜓に挿通されたプッシャず、同軞䜓の先端郚に固定された操䜜レバヌずを有しおいる。軞䜓においお操䜜レバヌずは反察偎の端郚には、背面偎筒郚の埌端面に圓接するフランゞが圢成されおおり、内枠の背面にはそのフランゞを背面偎筒郚の埌端面ずの間に挟み蟌むようにしおストッパ郚材が固定されおいる。このストッパ郚材及び背面偎筒郚の埌端面によっお軞䜓の自身の軞線方向ぞの移動が阻止されおいる。   As shown in FIG. 34, the locking device 850 is fixed to the shaft body 851 fitted to the back surface side cylindrical portion 861 of the inner frame 13, the pusher 852 inserted through the shaft body 851, and the distal end portion of the coaxial body 851. The operation lever 853 is provided. A flange 854 is formed at the end of the shaft body 851 opposite to the operation lever 853 so as to come into contact with the rear end surface of the rear tube portion 861, and the flange 854 is attached to the rear surface of the inner frame 13. A stopper member 858 is fixed so as to be sandwiched between the rear end surface of the portion 861. The stopper member 858 and the rear end surface of the rear surface side cylindrical portion 861 prevent the shaft body 851 from moving in the axial direction.

軞䜓においおプッシャが挿通されおいる郚分には、所定の範囲に亘っおネゞ山が圢成されおいる。䞀方、プッシャの内呚面には、このネゞ山に察応するネゞ溝が圢成されおいる。プッシャは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態ず同様に、その倖呚が倚角状をなしおおり、内枠の前偎筒郚に回動が芏制された状態で嵌っおいる。   A thread is formed in a portion of the shaft body 851 where the pusher 852 is inserted over a predetermined range. On the other hand, a thread groove corresponding to this thread is formed on the inner peripheral surface of the pusher 852. Similar to the above embodiment, the pusher 852 has a polygonal outer periphery, and is fitted to the front cylindrical portion 862 of the inner frame 13 in a state in which the rotation is restricted.

操䜜レバヌを所定の方向に回動させるず、それに䜵せお軞䜓が回動する。この際、軞䜓のネゞ山ずプッシャのネゞ溝ずが噛み合うこずで、プッシャが軞䜓の軞線方向に移動する。具䜓的には、操䜜レバヌを時蚈回りに回動させるこずにより遊技盀偎に移動しすなわち前偎筒郚から突出し、同操䜜レバヌを反時蚈回りに回動させるこずにより遊技盀から離れる偎に移動するすなわち前偎筒郚内に没入する。   When the operation lever 853 is rotated in a predetermined direction, the shaft body 851 is rotated accordingly. At this time, the screw thread of the shaft body 851 and the thread groove of the pusher 852 mesh with each other, so that the pusher 852 moves in the axial direction of the shaft body 851. Specifically, the operation lever 853 is moved to the game board 80 side by rotating clockwise (that is, protrudes from the front cylinder portion 862), and the operation lever 853 is rotated counterclockwise to play the game board. It moves to the side away from 80 (that is, it is immersed in the front side cylinder part 862).

遊技盀を内枠に察しお取り付ける際には、操䜜レバヌを時蚈回りに回動させるこずで、同遊技盀が操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚偎に抌される。これにより、遊技盀の前面が操䜜郚に圓接し、操䜜レバヌの曎なる回動操䜜が䞍可ずなるずずもに、同遊技盀の前埌䜍眮が芏定される。   When attaching the game board 80 to the inner frame 13, the game board 80 is pushed toward the operation portion 855 of the operation lever 853 by rotating the operation lever 853 clockwise. As a result, the front surface of the game board 80 comes into contact with the operation unit 855, and further turning operation of the operation lever 853 becomes impossible, and the front and rear positions of the game board 80 are defined.

なお、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したコむルバネず同等の構成を远加するこずも可胜である。この堎合、コむルバネの付勢力によっお、プッシャの遊技盀からの離れ、すなわち緩みを抑制し、䜍眮決め状態を奜適に維持するこずができる。   In addition, it is also possible to add the structure equivalent to the coil spring 430 shown in the said embodiment. In this case, the biasing force of the coil spring 430 can suppress the separation of the pusher 852 from the game board 80, that is, loosening, and can favorably maintain the positioning state.

たた、䞊蚘構成に远加しお、前扉枠等に操䜜郚の移動を阻止する阻止手段を蚭けるこずも可胜である。これにより、䜍眮決め状態が意図せず解陀されるこずを抑制しやすくできる。䟋えば、阻止手段ずしお前扉枠に操䜜郚ず嵌合する嵌合凹郚等を蚭けるずよい。操䜜郚の回動を防止するこずで、䜍眮決め機胜の䜎䞋を抑制するこずもできる。   In addition to the above configuration, it is also possible to provide a blocking means for blocking the movement of the operation unit 855 on the front door frame 14 or the like. As a result, it is possible to easily prevent the positioning state from being unintentionally released. For example, a fitting recess or the like that fits the operating portion 855 may be provided on the front door frame 14 as a blocking means. By preventing the operation unit 855 from rotating, it is possible to suppress a decrease in the positioning function.

䜆し、遊技盀の䜍眮をその前面を基準ずしお芏定する構成においおは、各遊技盀の厚みの差によっお操䜜郚の回動䜍眮が盞違し埗る。機皮倉曎等で遊技盀の厚みが倉わった際に操䜜郚ず遊技盀ずの係り代を確保できなくなる可胜性がある。曎には、䞊蚘嵌合凹郚等を远加しおも䞊蚘阻止機胜を正垞に発揮させるこずが困難になり埗る。故に、奜たしくは䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、遊技盀の厚み差に圱響されるこずなく操䜜郚のロック䜍眮が同䞀ずなる構成を採甚するずよい。   However, in the configuration in which the position of the game board 80 is defined with reference to the front surface thereof, the rotation position of the operation unit 855 can be different depending on the thickness difference of each game board 80. When the thickness of the game board changes due to a model change or the like, there is a possibility that it is not possible to secure the allowance between the operation unit 855 and the game board 80. Furthermore, even if the fitting recess is added, it may be difficult to cause the blocking function to be exhibited normally. Therefore, it is preferable to adopt a configuration in which the lock position of the operation unit 855 is the same without being affected by the thickness difference of the game board 80 as shown in the above embodiment.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、操䜜郚がアンロック䜍眮から遊技盀の前面に察しお圓接する䜍眮たで回動した堎合に、プッシャが遊技盀を抌す構成ずしたが、これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、操䜜郚がアンロック䜍眮から遊技盀の前面に察しお圓接する䜍眮たで回動する前の時点で、プッシャが遊技盀を抌す構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合には、操䜜郚の操䜜がプッシャに抌された遊技盀によっお劚げられやすくなるず想定される。これは、ロック装眮の切替操䜜をやりにくくする芁因ずなり埗る。この点、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺すように、操䜜郚が遊技盀によっお邪魔されない䜍眮たで回動した埌、プッシャが遊技盀を抌す構成ずすれば、確かに操䜜郚ず遊技盀ずの間に摩擊は生じるものの、操䜜郚が遊技盀詳しくは挿通郚の内面に぀かえるずいった䞍郜合を回避するこずができる。   (C5) In the above embodiment, the pusher 420 pushes the game board 80 when the operation unit 446 rotates from the unlock position to the position where the operation part 446 contacts the front surface of the game board 80. You may change as follows. In other words, the pusher 420 may push the game board 80 before the operation unit 446 rotates from the unlock position to a position where the operation part 446 contacts the front surface of the game board 80. However, when such a change is made, it is assumed that the operation of the operation unit 446 is likely to be hindered by the game board 80 pushed by the pusher 420. This can be a factor that makes it difficult to perform the switching operation of the lock device 400. In this regard, as shown in the above embodiment, if the pusher 420 pushes the game board 80 after the operation part 446 has been rotated to a position where it is not obstructed by the game board 80, the operation part 446 and the game board are surely configured. Although friction occurs between the control unit 80 and the control unit 80, it is possible to avoid the inconvenience that the operation unit 446 can be used by the game board 80 (specifically, the inner surface of the insertion unit 92).

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、操䜜レバヌの停留郚、及び連結郚ずプッシャの突起ずによっおプッシャの䜍眮芏制を実珟し、構成の簡略化を図った。しかしながら、この構成では、プッシャを抌すコむルバネの付勢力によっお操䜜郚は、䜜業者が意図しおいない方向に移動する可胜性がある。これに察しお、䟋えば別のリンク郚材等を介するこずで操䜜郚に加わった操䜜力をプッシャに䌝えるずずもにコむルバネの付勢力が操䜜郚に䌝播するこずを抑制可胜な構成を採甚しおもよい。この堎合、構造は耇雑化するものの、操䜜のやりやすさを向䞊させるこずができる。䜆し、ロック装眮を配眮できるスペヌスが限られおおり、同スペヌスの増倧が遊技盀の配眮領域の瞮小を招来し埗る点に着目すれば、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺した構成のほうが実甚䞊奜たしい構成であるず考えられる。   (C6) In the above embodiment, the position restriction of the pusher 420 is realized by the stopping portions 442 and 443 and the connecting portion 444 of the operation lever 440 and the protrusion 422 of the pusher 420, thereby simplifying the configuration. However, in this configuration, the operation unit 446 may move in a direction not intended by the operator due to the biasing force of the coil spring 430 that presses the pusher 420. On the other hand, for example, an operation force applied to the operation unit via another link member or the like may be transmitted to the pusher, and a configuration capable of suppressing the urging force of the coil spring 430 from propagating to the operation unit may be employed. . In this case, although the structure is complicated, the ease of operation can be improved. However, in view of the fact that the space in which the lock device 400 can be placed is limited and the increase in the space can lead to a reduction in the placement area of the game board 80, the configuration shown in the above embodiment is more practical. A preferred configuration is considered.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ロック装眮がアンロック状態である堎合に、操䜜郚の長手方向ず、遊技盀の回動䞭心軞線に盎亀する方向ずが䞀臎する構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、操䜜郚の長手方向ず、遊技盀の回動䞭心軞線に盎亀する方向ずが盞違する構成ずしおもよい。䜆しこの堎合、遊技盀が回動する構成であるが故に、挿通郚における操䜜郚の通過隙を倧きく蚭定する必芁が生じる。これは、操䜜郚においお遊技盀に圓接する郚䜍を操䜜レバヌの基郚から遠ざける芁因ずなる。すなわち、遊技盀ずの掛かり代を枛少させるずずもに操䜜レバヌに加わる応力を増倧させる芁因ずなり埗る。故に、望たしくは、アンロック状態においおは操䜜郚の長手方向を遊技盀の回動䞭心軞線に盎亀する方向に揃えるずよい。   (C7) In the above embodiment, when the locking device 400 is in the unlocked state, the longitudinal direction of the operation unit 446 and the direction orthogonal to the rotation center axis of the game board 80 are the same. It is not limited to this. For example, the longitudinal direction of the operation unit 446 may be different from the direction orthogonal to the rotation center axis of the game board 80. However, in this case, since the game board 80 is configured to rotate, it is necessary to set a large passage gap of the operation unit 446 in the insertion unit 92. This is a factor that keeps the portion of the operation unit 446 that contacts the game board 80 away from the base 441 of the operation lever 440. That is, it is possible to reduce the allowance for the game board 80 and increase the stress applied to the operation lever 440. Therefore, desirably, in the unlocked state, the longitudinal direction of the operation unit 446 may be aligned with the direction orthogonal to the rotation center axis of the game board 80.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚が基郚の䞭心軞線を䞭心ずしお察称圢状をなす構成ずしたが、必ずしもそのように察称圢状を成す必芁はなく、䞭心軞線を挟んだ䞡偎で圢状が異なっおいおもよい。   (C8) In the above-described embodiment, the operation portion 446 of the operation lever 440 is configured to be symmetric with respect to the central axis of the base portion 441. However, it is not always necessary to form such a symmetric shape, and the central axis is sandwiched. However, the shape may be different on both sides.

たた、操䜜郚が基郚を挟んだ䞊䞋䞡偎にお遊技盀の前面ず圓接する構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、基郚の䞊䞋䞡偎のうち䞀方で遊技盀の前面ず圓接する構成ずするこずも可胜である。䟋えば操䜜レバヌを字状から字状に倉圢し、遊技盀の前面に察する圓接箇所を枛らすこずも可胜である。   In addition, the operation unit 446 is configured to contact the front surface of the game board 80 on both the upper and lower sides with the base portion 441 interposed therebetween. A configuration is also possible. For example, the operating lever 440 can be deformed from a T-shape to an L-shape, and the number of contact points with the front surface of the game board 80 can be reduced.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、各操䜜レバヌが同䞀圢状をなす䞀方で遊技盀の挿通郚はそれぞれ異なる圢状をなす構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、各操䜜レバヌず同様に各挿通郚の圢状を統䞀しおもよい。   (C9) In the above embodiment, the operation levers 440 have the same shape, while the insertion portions 92 of the game board 80 have different shapes. However, this is changed and the operation levers 440 are similar to each other. The shape of each insertion portion 92 may be unified.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、操䜜レバヌの回動範囲を凡そ°に制限し、その範囲内でロック状態ずアンロック状態ずが切り替えられる構成ずしたが、操䜜レバヌの回動範囲はこれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば°ずしおもよいし°ずしおもよい。   (C10) In the above embodiment, the rotation range of the operation lever 440 is limited to about 90 °, and the lock state and the unlock state can be switched within the range. Is not limited to this. For example, it may be 180 ° or 360 °.

たた、アンロック状態から時蚈回りに回動させるこずでロック状態に切り替えられ、ロック状態から反時蚈回りに回動させるこずでアンロック状態に切り替えられる構成ずしたが、これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、同䞀方向ぞの回動操䜜によりロック状態ずアンロック状態ずの切り替えがなされる構成ずしおもよい。䟋えば、時蚈回りに°回動させる毎にロック状態ずアンロック状態ずが切り替わる構成ずするこずも可胜である。これにより、に瀺した遊技盀ず操䜜郚ずの掛かり代を確保しやすくできる。   In addition, it is configured to be switched to the locked state by rotating clockwise from the unlocked state, and switched to the unlocked state by rotating counterclockwise from the locked state, but this has been changed as follows: May be. That is, it is good also as a structure by which switching with a locked state and an unlocked state is made | formed by rotation operation to the same direction. For example, it is possible to adopt a configuration in which the locked state and the unlocked state are switched every time it is rotated 180 ° clockwise. This makes it easy to secure the allowance between the game board 80 and the operation unit 446 shown in (c7).

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、コむルバネによっおプッシャを遊技盀偎に付勢する構成ずしたが、コむルバネに代えお板バネ等の別皮のバネ郚材を甚いおもよいし、ゎム等の匟性郚材を甚いおもよい。   (C11) In the above embodiment, the pusher 420 is urged toward the game board 80 by the coil spring 430. However, instead of the coil spring 430, another type of spring member such as a leaf spring may be used, rubber or the like. The elastic member may be used.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ロック装眮の操䜜レバヌを内枠及び前扉枠によっお挟たれた領域内に収容する構成ずしたが、操䜜レバヌが同領域から露出する構成ずしおもよい。䜆し、この堎合、遊技盀の䞍正な取り倖しが容易になり、防犯機胜が䜎䞋する可胜性がある。故に、防犯機胜の向䞊を配慮するならば、操䜜レバヌをパチンコ機の倖郚からのアクセスが䞍可又は困難な䜍眮に配眮するこずが望たしい。   (C12) In the above embodiment, the operation lever 440 of the locking device 400 is housed in the region sandwiched between the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14, but the operation lever 440 is exposed from the region. Also good. However, in this case, unauthorized removal of the game board 80 is facilitated, and the crime prevention function may be reduced. Therefore, if the improvement of the crime prevention function is taken into consideration, it is desirable to dispose the operation lever 440 at a position where access from the outside of the pachinko machine 10 is impossible or difficult.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の第把持郚及び第把持郚をの遊技領域区画郚材に配蚭したが、それら把持郚の配蚭察象を異なるものずするこずも可胜である。䟋えば、遊技領域区画郚材を぀蚭け、それら遊技領域区画郚材の䞀方に第把持郚を蚭け、他方に第把持郚を蚭けおもよい。   (D1) In the above embodiment, the first gripping portion 481 and the second gripping portion 482 of the game board 80 are disposed in one game area partition member 480, but the objects to be disposed of these gripping portions 481, 482 are different. It is also possible. For example, two game area partition members may be provided, and one of the game area partition members may be provided with a first grip portion, and the other may be provided with a second grip portion.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、把持郚を遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮したが、把持郚の䜍眮はそれに限定されるものではなく、䟋えば回動基端偎に配眮するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、䞊蚘実斜の圢態にお瀺したように、遊技盀の回動基端ず、前扉枠の回動基端ずが同䞀偎ずなっおいる堎合、前扉枠によっお把持郚ぞのアクセスが劚げられやすくなるず想定される。これでは、把持郚を掻甚しにくくなり、結果ずしお遊技領域内の各皮構成が掎たれやすくなるず懞念される。故に、望たしくは、把持郚を遊技領域よりも回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮に配された遊技機郚品䟋えば遊技領域区画郚材に配するずよい。   (D2) In the above embodiment, the gripping portions 481 and 482 are arranged on the rotating front end side of the game board 80. However, the positions of the gripping portions 481 and 482 are not limited thereto. It is also possible to arrange them. However, as shown in the above embodiment, when the rotation base end of the game board 80 and the rotation base end of the front door frame 14 are on the same side, the front door frame 14 moves to the gripping portion. It is assumed that access to the site is likely to be hindered. This makes it difficult to use the grip portions 481 and 482, and as a result, there is a concern that various configurations in the game area PE are easily gripped. Therefore, desirably, the gripping portion may be disposed on a gaming machine component (for example, the gaming area partition member 480) disposed at a position closer to the rotation tip side than the gaming area PE.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、第把持郚を遊技領域区画郚材においお遊技盀の回動先端偎を向いた壁郚に蚭けたが、同第把持郚の䜍眮は任意である。䟋えば、遊技領域区画郚材においお䞋偎を向いた壁郚に第把持郚ず䞊べお配するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、䞡把持郚を䞊蚭するず、仮に把持郚を぀蚭けたずしおも遊技盀を把持した際の安定性を向䞊させるこずが困難であるず想定される。故に、望たしくは各把持郚を異なる方向を向いた壁郚に配するずよい。   (D3) In the above embodiment, the first gripping portion 481 is provided on the wall portion of the game area partition member 480 facing the turning front side of the game board 80, but the position of the first gripping portion 481 is arbitrary. is there. For example, it is also possible to arrange the game area partition member 480 side by side with the second grip portion 482 on a wall portion facing downward. However, if both gripping portions 481 and 482 are arranged side by side, it is assumed that it is difficult to improve the stability when the game board 80 is gripped even if two gripping portions are provided. Therefore, it is desirable to arrange each gripping part on a wall part facing in a different direction.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、各把持郚の開攟郚分が、遊技盀の呚瞁よりも内偎に䜍眮する構成ずしたが必ずしもこれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、各把持郚の開攟郚分が遊技盀の呚瞁よりも倖偎に䜍眮する構成ずするこずも可胜である。しかしながら、この堎合、把持郚を把持する際の䜜業スペヌス詳しくは指を把持郚に差し蟌むスペヌスの確保が難しくなり埗る。具䜓的には、遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、同遊技盀の正面偎には圓該遊技盀を着脱するための軌道が確保されおいる。この軌道䞊に把持郚を把持するための䜜業スペヌスを確保するこずにより呚蟺郚品ず指ずの干枉を奜適に回避できるが、䞊述の劂く把持郚の開攟郚分が遊技盀の倖偎に䜍眮しおいる堎合、䜜業スペヌスを別途圢成する必芁が生じる。これは、遊技盀の呚蟺郚品や呚蟺構造ずの共存を難しくする芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。故に、望たしくは、把持郚の開攟郚分は遊技盀の呚瞁よりも内偎に配するずよい。   (D4) In the above embodiment, the open portions of the grip portions 481 and 482 are positioned on the inner side of the periphery of the game board 80, but the present invention is not necessarily limited thereto. For example, it is possible to adopt a configuration in which the open portions of the gripping portions 481 and 482 are positioned outside the peripheral edge of the game board 80. However, in this case, it may be difficult to ensure a work space for gripping the grip portion (specifically, a space for inserting a finger into the grip portion). Specifically, in a configuration in which the game board 80 is attached from the front side of the inner frame 13, a track for attaching and detaching the game board 80 is secured on the front side of the game board 80. By securing a work space for gripping the grip portion on the track, it is possible to preferably avoid interference between peripheral parts and fingers. However, as described above, the open portion of the grip portion is located outside the game board 80. If so, it is necessary to form a work space separately. This is not preferable because it can be a factor that makes it difficult to coexist with peripheral components and peripheral structure of the game board 80. Therefore, it is desirable that the open portions of the grip portions 481 and 482 be disposed inside the peripheral edge of the game board 80.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、把持郚を凹状ずしそれら把持郚ぞの指の挿入を可胜ずするずしたが、把持郚の圢状はこれに限定されるものではなく任意である。䟋えば、把持郚を遊技盀の正面偎に突出する突起状ずし、それら把持郚を指で摘めるようにしおもよい。   (D5) In the above embodiment, the gripping portions 481 and 482 are concave and the fingers can be inserted into the gripping portions 481 and 482. However, the shape of the gripping portion is not limited to this and is arbitrary. is there. For example, the gripping portions may be protrusions that protrude to the front side of the game board 80, and the gripping portions may be picked up with fingers.

第把持郚及び第把持郚のうちいずれか䞀方を省略するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、このように把持郚を぀だけに限定するず、以䞋の䞍郜合が生じ埗る。぀たり、遊技盀には可倉衚瀺ナニット等の各皮構成が搭茉されおいるこずでその総重量が嵩んでいるため、遊技盀を片手のみで保持するのは効率的でなく、遊技盀を内枠から取り倖した際に、把持郚を掎んでいないほうの手で遊技盀の他の郚䜍が把持されやすくなるず想定される。この堎合、仮に釘等の遊技性に関わる構成が把持されるず、遊技性に倉化が生じ埗るため奜たしくない。故に、把持郚は、䞡の手に察応すべく぀蚭けるずよい。   (D6) Either one of the first gripping portion 481 and the second gripping portion 482 may be omitted. However, if the number of grips is limited to one, the following inconvenience may occur. In other words, since the game board 80 is mounted with various components such as the variable display unit 85 and the total weight thereof is increased, it is not efficient to hold the game board 80 with only one hand. When it is removed from the inner frame 13, it is assumed that the other part of the game board 80 is easily gripped by the hand not gripping the grip portion. In this case, if a configuration related to game play such as the nail 87 is gripped, it is not preferable because the game play may change. Therefore, it is preferable to provide two gripping portions so as to correspond to both hands.

第把持郚を返しゎムに察する遊技球の移動経路の延長䞊に配するこずも可胜である。この堎合、同延長䞊にネゞを配するずよい。なお、遊技領域区画郚材の固定手段ずしお、ネゞ以倖の構成又は手段を甚いるこずも可胜である。䟋えば、係止ピンや接着剀等を甚いおもよい。   (D7) It is also possible to arrange the first grip portion 481 on an extension of the moving path of the game ball with respect to the return rubber 490. In this case, a screw 491 may be disposed on the extension. It should be noted that a configuration or means other than the screw 491 can be used as a fixing means for the game area partition member 480. For example, a locking pin or an adhesive may be used.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技領域区画郚材が返しゎムを有する構成ずしたが、同返しゎムを省略するこずも可胜である。   (D8) In the above embodiment, the game area partitioning member 480 has the rubber return 490. However, the rubber return 490 can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、第把持郚を第把持郚よりも䞊方䞔぀遊技盀の回動先端偎ずなるように配眮したが、これら各把持郚の配眮は任意である。たた、各把持郚の凹み方向に぀いおも任意である。   (D9) In the above embodiment, the first gripping portion 481 is disposed above the second gripping portion 482 and on the rotating front end side of the game board 80. However, these gripping portions 481, 482 are arranged as follows. Is optional. Further, the direction of depression of each gripping portion 481, 482 is also arbitrary.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技領域区画郚材に内レヌルに察向する察向郚を蚭けたが、同様の構成を倖レヌルに適甚するこずも可胜である。   (D10) In the above embodiment, the game area partition member 480 is provided with the facing portion 485 that faces the inner rail 101. However, the same configuration can be applied to the outer rail 102.

たた、察向郚やナニット収容郚を省略するこずも可胜であるが、第把持郚の匷床確保のためには、遊技領域区画郚材を小型化するこずは困難であるず想定される。この点、遊技領域区画郚材の第把持郚の呚蟺に、察向郚やナニット収容郚を配すれば、遊技盀の前面での限られたスペヌスを有効に掻甚し、遊技領域ずの共存を奜適なものずするこずができる。   Although it is possible to omit the facing portion 485 and the unit accommodating portion 486, it is assumed that it is difficult to downsize the game area partition member 480 in order to ensure the strength of the second grip portion 482. The In this regard, if the opposing portion 485 and the unit accommodating portion 486 are arranged around the second grip portion 482 of the game area partition member 480, the limited space on the front surface of the game board 80 can be effectively utilized, and the game area Coexistence with PE can be made suitable.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、右偎ロック装眮よりも遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に第把持郚を配眮したが、䞡者の䜍眮を入れ替えるこずも可胜である。しかしながら、ロック装眮は䜍眮決め機胜向䞊の芳点から遊技盀の端寄りに配眮するこずが奜たしく、第把持郚は遊技盀を支えおいる状態での安定性向䞊の芳点から遊技盀の䞭倮寄りに配眮するこずが奜たしい。この点、䞊蚘倉曎を行うず、第把持郚及び右偎ロック装眮の各機胜が䜎䞋し埗る。故に、望たしくは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、第把持郚よりもロック装眮を回動先端偎に寄せお配眮するずよい。   (D11) In the above embodiment, the second grip portion 482 is disposed at a position closer to the rotation base end side of the game board 80 than the right side lock device 400R. However, both positions can be interchanged. However, the locking device 400 is preferably disposed near the end of the game board 80 from the viewpoint of improving the positioning function, and the second gripping portion 482 is provided from the viewpoint of improving stability in a state where the game board 80 is supported. It is preferable to arrange near the center. In this regard, if the above change is made, the functions of the second gripping portion 482 and the right side locking device 400R may be deteriorated. Therefore, desirably, as shown in the above-described embodiment, the lock device 400 may be disposed closer to the rotation tip side than the second grip portion 482.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「平板郚」ずしおの察向板郚が環状詳しくは矩圢枠状をなす構成ずしたが、察向板郚は遊技盀の背面に察向する平板状をなしおいればよく、その倖圢は必ずしも環状でなくおもよい。䟋えば、「平板郚」を内枠の巊偎枠郚及び右偎枠郚に跚っお延びる長板状に圢成しおもよい。   (E1) In the above embodiment, the opposing plate portion 251 as the “flat plate portion” has a ring shape (specifically, a rectangular frame shape), but the opposing plate portion has a flat plate shape facing the back of the game board 80. The outer shape is not necessarily circular. For example, the “flat plate portion” may be formed in a long plate shape extending across the left frame portion 13 c and the right frame portion 13 d of the inner frame 13.

たた、察向板郚に補匷や郚材取付等を目的ずしたリブや凹み等の凹凞を有する構成ずしたが、それら凹凞等を有さない構成ずするこずも可胜である。   In addition, although the opposing plate portion 251 has a configuration having irregularities such as ribs and dents for the purpose of reinforcement and member attachment, it is also possible to have a configuration without such irregularities.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向板郚ず呚壁郚によっお遊技盀収容郚を構成したが、同遊技盀収容郚は必須ではない。少なくずも察向板郚に盞圓する構成を有しおいればよく、呚壁郚を省略するこずも可胜である。   (E2) In the above embodiment, the game board housing portion 75 is configured by the opposing plate portion 251 and the peripheral wall portion 261, but the game board housing portion 75 is not essential. It is only necessary to have a configuration corresponding to at least the counter plate portion 251, and the peripheral wall portion 261 can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀を固定する巊右のロック装眮の間に同遊技盀の巊右䜍眮を芏定する䜍眮決め突起を配眮したが、ロック装眮及び䜍眮決め突起の䜍眮関係は任意であり、぀のロック装眮の間に䜍眮決め突起を配眮する必芁はない。たた、䜍眮決め突起を巊偎のロック装眮に寄せお配眮したが、同䜍眮決め突起を右偎のロック装眮に寄せお配眮するこずも可胜である。   (E3) In the above embodiment, the positioning protrusions 259 that define the left and right positions of the game board 80 are disposed between the left and right lock apparatuses 400R and 400L that fix the game board 80. The positional relationship of the protrusion 259 is arbitrary, and it is not necessary to arrange the positioning protrusion 259 between the two locking devices 400R and 400L. Further, although the positioning protrusion 259 is disposed close to the left lock device 400L, the positioning protrusion 259 may be disposed close to the right lock device 400R.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮する過皋で、先ずロック装眮の操䜜郚が遊技盀の挿通郚に入り、その埌、䜍眮決め突起が遊技盀の貫通孔に入る構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に入った埌、操䜜郚が挿通郚に入る構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、遊技盀の巊右䜍眮が倧きくばら぀いた状態にお䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔には入ろうずするため、同䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に嵌らず遊技盀の背面等に衝突するこずが懞念される。これは、䜍眮決め突起を倉圢させ、䜍眮決め粟床の䜎䞋を招く芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。故に、望たしくは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、先ず操䜜郚及び挿通郚によっお遊技盀の倧たかな䜍眮ずれを抑え、ある皋床䜍眮決めの目凊が立った状態にお䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に入る構成ずするずよい。   (E4) In the above embodiment, in the process of placing the game board 80 in the mounting completion position, the operation unit 446 of the locking device 400 first enters the insertion part 92 of the game board 80, and then the positioning protrusion 259 is inserted into the game board 80. However, it is also possible to change the configuration so that the operation portion 446 enters the insertion portion 92 after the positioning protrusion 259 enters the through hole 91. However, in this case, since the positioning protrusion 259 tries to enter the through hole 91 in a state where the left and right positions of the game board 80 are largely dispersed, the positioning protrusion 259 does not fit into the through hole 91 and the back surface of the game board 80, etc. There is a concern about the collision. This is not preferable because it may cause the positioning protrusion 259 to be deformed and cause a decrease in positioning accuracy. Therefore, preferably, as shown in the above-described embodiment, first, the positioning protrusion 259 penetrates in a state where the rough positioning of the game board 80 is suppressed by the operation portion 446 and the insertion portion 92 and the positioning target stands to some extent. A configuration that enters the hole 91 is preferable.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䜍眮決め突起が円柱状をなす構成ずしたが、同䜍眮決め突起を角柱状ずするこずも可胜である。たた、䜍眮決め突起の先端郚分を瞮埄したが、これを省略するこずも可胜である。   (E5) In the above-described embodiment, the positioning protrusion 259 has a cylindrical shape. However, the positioning protrusion can also have a prismatic shape. Further, although the diameter of the tip portion of the positioning protrusion 259 is reduced, this can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向板郚を構成する平板郚のうち、呚壁郚のコヌナ郚のうち誘導レヌルの入口郚分から最寄ずなるコヌナ郚に連なる平板郚に䜍眮決め突起及びロック装眮を配蚭したが、それら䜍眮決め突起及びロック装眮を他の平板郚に配蚭するこずも可胜である。   (E6) In the above embodiment, among the flat plate portions constituting the counter plate portion 251, the positioning protrusions on the flat plate portion that is connected to the corner portion closest to the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 among the corner portions of the peripheral wall portion 261. 259 and the locking device 400 are disposed, but the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400 may be disposed on another flat plate portion.

たた、察向板郚を構成する平板郚のうち、前扉枠を支持する支持金具が取り付けられおいる巊偎枠郚に連なる平板郚に䜍眮決め突起及びロック装眮を配蚭したが、それら䜍眮決め突起及びロック装眮を他の平板郚に配蚭するこずも可胜である。   In addition, the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400 are arranged on the flat plate portion that is connected to the left side frame portion 13c to which the support fittings 71 and 72 that support the front door frame 14 are attached among the flat plate portions that constitute the counter plate portion 251. However, the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400 can be disposed on another flat plate portion.

曎には、䜍眮決め突起及びロック装眮を配蚭された平板郚が、呚壁郚を構成する壁郚〜のうち耇数の壁郚に連なる構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。䟋えば同平板郚がの壁郚にのみ連なる構成ずするこずも可胜である。   Further, the flat plate portion on which the positioning protrusion 259 and the locking device 400 are disposed is configured to be continuous with the plurality of wall portions 263 and 264 among the wall portions 262 to 265 constituting the peripheral wall portion 261, but is not limited thereto. It is not something. For example, the flat plate portion can be connected to only one wall portion.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の巊右䜍眮を芏定する䜍眮決め突起を同遊技盀の倖レヌルの背埌に配眮したが、これを倉曎し、䜍眮決め突起をパチンコ機の正面芖においお倖レヌルよりも内偎又は同倖レヌルよりも倖偎に配眮するこずも可胜である。䜆し、このように䜍眮決め突起の配眮を倉曎する堎合であっおも、特定郚䜍になるべく近づけお配眮するこずが奜たしい。   (F1) In the above embodiment, the positioning protrusions 259 that define the left and right positions of the game board 80 are arranged behind the outer rail 102 of the game board 80. However, this is changed, and the positioning protrusions 259 are arranged on the pachinko machine 10. It is also possible to arrange the inner side of the outer rail 102 or the outer side of the outer rail 102 in a front view. However, even when the arrangement of the positioning protrusions 259 is changed as described above, it is preferable to arrange them as close as possible to the specific part SP.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、誘導レヌルの入口郚分を遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配したが、同入口郚分を遊技盀の䞊端寄りに配するこずも可胜である。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合には、入口郚分ず遊技球発射機構ずの間隔が拡がるこずで、遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きが倧きくなるず想定される。この堎合、入口郚分の近傍にお䜍眮決め突起によっお䜍眮ばら぀きを抑えたずしおも、遊技球の発射ばら぀きが支配的ずなり、䜍眮決め突起による着地䜍眮の安定化機胜の恩恵を十分に享受できなくなるず懞念される。故に、望たしくは、誘導レヌルの入口郚分を遊技盀の䞋端、すなわち遊技球発射機構に近づけおは䜍眮するずよい。   (F2) In the above embodiment, the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 is arranged near the lower end of the game board 80, but the entrance portion 104 can be arranged near the upper end of the game board 80. However, when such a change is made, it is assumed that the variation in the landing position of the game ball is increased by increasing the interval between the entrance portion 104 and the game ball launching mechanism 110. In this case, even if the position variation is suppressed by the positioning protrusion in the vicinity of the entrance portion 104, the variation in the launch of the game ball becomes dominant, and there is a concern that the benefits of the landing position stabilization function by the positioning protrusion cannot be fully enjoyed. Is done. Therefore, it is desirable that the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 be positioned close to the lower end of the game board 80, that is, the game ball launching mechanism 110.

たた、誘導レヌルの入口郚分を遊技盀の䞭倮付近に配したが、䟋えば入口郚分を遊技盀の回動基端偎の端郚に寄せお配するこずも可胜である。この堎合、遊技球発射機構に぀いおも同䞀偎に寄せお配眮するずよい。   In addition, although the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 is arranged near the center of the game board 80, for example, the entrance portion 104 can be arranged near the end of the game board 80 on the rotation base end side. In this case, the game ball launching mechanism 110 may be arranged close to the same side.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球が、遊技盀の䞋端瞁すなわち内枠の䞋偎壁郚を斜めに暪切る構成ずした。蚀い換えれば、誘導レヌルの入口郚分ず遊技球発射機構における発射レヌルの先端郚分ずが、䞋偎壁郚を挟んで斜めに察峙する構成ずした。これを倉曎し、誘導レヌルの入口郚分ず遊技球発射機構における発射レヌルの先端郚分ずを䞋偎壁郚を挟んで䞊䞋に配眮し、遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球が、遊技盀の䞋端瞁すなわち内枠の䞋偎壁郚を瞊に暪切る構成ずしおもよい。䜆し、この堎合には、遊技球が内レヌル偎に逞れる可胜性が生じ、遊技球の着地䜍眮を特定するのが困難なものずなり埗る。故に、望たしくは、遊技球の飛翔方向をわずかにでも倖レヌル偎に傟けるのがよい。   (F3) In the above embodiment, the game ball launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 is configured to obliquely cross the lower end edge of the game board 80, that is, the lower wall portion 263 of the inner frame 13. In other words, the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 and the tip end portion of the launch rail 112 in the game ball launch mechanism 110 face each other with the lower wall portion 263 interposed therebetween. By changing this, the entrance portion 104 of the guide rail 100 and the tip portion of the launch rail 112 in the game ball launching mechanism 110 are arranged vertically with the lower wall portion 263 interposed therebetween, and the game ball launched from the game ball launching mechanism 110 However, a configuration may be adopted in which the lower end edge of the game board 80, that is, the lower wall portion 263 of the inner frame 13 is vertically traversed. However, in this case, there is a possibility that the game ball is displaced to the inner rail 101 side, and it may be difficult to specify the landing position of the game ball. Therefore, it is desirable to tilt the flight direction of the game ball toward the outer rail 102 even slightly.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、倖レヌルが円匧状をなし、同倖レヌルの特定郚䜍における接線が発射レヌルのレヌル方向ず同䞀方向ずするこずにより、遊技球着地時の衝撃を和らげるずずもに、倖レヌルに沿った円滑な誘導を可胜ずした。これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、倖レヌル党䜓を円匧状にするのではなく、䞊蚘特定郚䜍を含んだ䞀郚が発射レヌルのレヌル方向ず同䞀方向に延びる構成ずしおもよい。これにより、䞊蚘実斜の圢態ず同様の効果が埗られる。   (F4) In the above embodiment, the outer rail 102 has an arc shape, and the tangent TL at the specific portion SP of the outer rail 102 has the same direction as the rail direction of the launch rail 112, so that the impact at the time of landing on the game ball And smooth guidance along the outer rail 102 was made possible. You may change this as follows. That is, instead of making the entire outer rail arc-shaped, a part including the specific portion SP may extend in the same direction as the rail direction of the firing rail 112. Thereby, the same effect as the above-described embodiment can be obtained.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䜍眮決め突起が挿通される貫通孔にレヌル支持郚材を取り付けたが、このレヌル支持郚材を省略するこずも可胜である。たた、貫通孔以倖の孔等を甚いおレヌル支持郚材を取り付けるこずも可胜である。   (F5) In the above embodiment, the rail support member 107 is attached to the through hole 91 through which the positioning protrusion 259 is inserted. However, the rail support member 107 can be omitted. It is also possible to attach the rail support member 107 using a hole other than the through hole 91 or the like.

遊技盀の厚さ方向に貫通しおいる貫通孔に代えお、遊技盀の厚さ方向に貫通しおいない穎郚又は凹郚を甚いるこずも可胜である。曎には、貫通孔が䞊䞋に拡匵された長孔状をなし、䜍眮決め突起の䞊䞋方向ぞの移動を蚱容する構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。䟋えば貫通孔の内圢を䜍眮決め突起の倖圢に合わせお圢成し、それら貫通孔及び䜍眮決め突起に䞊䞋方向の䜍眮決め機胜を付䞎するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、このような倉曎を行った堎合、䜍眮決め突起に生じる負担が倧きくなり、同䜍眮決め突起の倉圢等を生じやすくなるず想定される。これは、䜍眮決め機胜の䜎䞋を招く芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。故に、望たしくは、貫通孔を、遊技盀の䞊䞋の䜍眮ばら぀きを蚱容する隙間が䜍眮決め突起ずの間に生じるように圢成するずよい。   (F6) Instead of the through hole 91 penetrating in the thickness direction of the game board 80, it is also possible to use a hole or a recess that does not penetrate in the thickness direction of the game board 80. Furthermore, although the through hole has a long hole shape that is expanded vertically, and the positioning protrusion 259 is allowed to move in the vertical direction, the present invention is not limited to this. For example, the inner shape of the through hole 91 can be formed in accordance with the outer shape of the positioning protrusion 259, and a vertical positioning function can be given to the through hole 91 and the positioning protrusion 259. However, when such a change is made, it is assumed that the burden generated on the positioning protrusion 259 increases, and the positioning protrusion 259 is likely to be deformed. This is not preferable because it may cause a decrease in positioning function. Therefore, it is desirable that the through hole 91 is formed so that a gap that allows variation in the vertical position of the game board 80 is formed between the through hole 91 and the positioning protrusion 259.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、内枠に䜍眮決め突起を蚭けるずずもに遊技盀に同䜍眮決め突起が挿通される貫通孔を蚭けたが、これら䜍眮決め突起及び貫通孔を入れ替えるこずも可胜である。すなわち、内枠に貫通孔を蚭けるずずもに遊技盀に同貫通孔に挿通される䜍眮決め突起を蚭けるこずも可胜である。   (F7) In the above embodiment, the positioning protrusion 259 is provided on the inner frame 13 and the through hole 91 through which the positioning protrusion 259 is inserted is provided in the game board 80. However, the positioning protrusion 259 and the through hole 91 are replaced. Is also possible. That is, it is possible to provide a through hole in the inner frame 13 and provide a positioning projection inserted into the through hole in the game board 80.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、誘導レヌルを内レヌル及び倖レヌルによっお構成したが、必ずしもそれら䞡レヌルを必須ずするものではない。少なくずも倖レヌルに盞圓するレヌルを有しおいればよい。たた、内レヌル及び倖レヌルを別䜓で蚭ける必芁はなく、䞡者を䞀䜓的に蚭けるこず䟋えば䞀䜓成圢するこずも可胜である。   (F8) In the above-described embodiment, the guide rail 100 is configured by the inner rail 101 and the outer rail 102. However, both the rails are not necessarily required. It is only necessary to have a rail corresponding to at least the outer rail 102. Moreover, it is not necessary to provide the inner rail 101 and the outer rail 102 as separate bodies, and it is also possible to provide both of them integrally (for example, integrally molding).

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜量が第芏定量以䞊ずなった堎合に、遊技球が倖レヌルの特定郚䜍に着地する構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、操䜜量が第芏定量以䞊ずなった堎合に、遊技球が倖レヌルの特定郚䜍に着地する構成ずするこずも可胜である。遊技球発射ハンドルの操䜜量が増せば、遊技球の発射速床も増加する。遊技球の発射速床が、返しゎムに到達するレベルたで高たるず、倖レヌルに着地した際の衝撃も倧きくなるず想定される。少なくずも、このような高い発射速床で打ち出された遊技球の衝突䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制するこずで、倖レヌルの耐久性向䞊に貢献しやすくできる。   (F9) In the above embodiment, the game ball is configured to land on the specific part SP of the outer rail 102 when the operation amount of the game ball launching handle 40 is equal to or greater than the first specified amount. However, it is also possible to adopt a configuration in which the game ball lands on the specific part SP of the outer rail 102 when the operation amount becomes equal to or greater than the second specified amount. If the amount of operation of the game ball launch handle 40 increases, the launch speed of the game ball also increases. It is assumed that the impact at the time of landing on the outer rail 102 increases as the launching speed of the game ball increases to a level that reaches the return rubber 490. At least, it is possible to easily contribute to improving the durability of the outer rail 102 by suppressing the variation in the collision position of the game balls launched at such a high firing speed.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䜍眮決め突起が内枠の察向板郚から垞時突出する構成ずしたが、同䜍眮決め突起を可動匏ずし、䜍眮決め䜍眮ず非䜍眮決め䜍眮ずに切り替え可胜ずしおもよい。具板的には、䜍眮決め突起を察向板郚に察しお出没自圚ずしおもよい。   (F10) In the above embodiment, the positioning protrusion 259 always protrudes from the opposing plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13. However, the positioning protrusion may be movable so that it can be switched between a positioning position and a non-positioning position. Good. As a material plate, the positioning projection may be freely movable in and out of the counter plate portion.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「茉眮郚」ずしおの䞋偎壁郚が平板状をなす構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。「茉眮郚」は少なくずも遊技盀の䞋端面ず察峙し、同遊技盀を䞋偎から支えるこずで、圓該遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きを抑えるこずができるものであればよい。䟋えば、「茉眮郚」を面状ではなく、線状又は点状ずするこずも可胜である。   (G1) In the above-described embodiment, the lower wall portion 263 serving as the “mounting portion” has a flat plate shape. However, the present invention is not limited to this. The “mounting unit” may be any one that can confront at least the lower end surface of the game board 80 and support the game board 80 from the lower side to suppress variation in the vertical position of the game board 80. For example, the “mounting portion” may be a line or a dot instead of a plane.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䞋偎壁郚が遊技盀の䞋端面党域に察しお圓接する構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、遊技盀の䞋端面のうち巊右䞡偎の䞀郚に察しお圓接する構成ずしおもよい。少なくずも、それら圓接箇所が遊技盀の巊右ぞの傟きを抑えるこずができる皋床の間隔で蚭定されおいれば、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する機胜は担保される。   (G2) In the above embodiment, the lower wall portion 263 is in contact with the entire lower end surface of the game board 80. However, the lower wall portion 263 is changed to a part of the left and right sides of the lower end surface of the game board 80. It is good also as a structure which contact | abuts. As long as at least the contact points are set at such an interval that the inclination of the game board 80 to the left and right can be suppressed, the function of defining the vertical position of the game board 80 is secured.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀が䞋偎壁郚に茉っお䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定された埌、䜍眮決め突起によっお巊右䜍眮が芏定される構成ずしたが、この䜍眮決めの順序を逆にしおもよい。たた、䞊䞋䜍眮の芏定ず巊右䜍眮の芏定ずが同時に行われる構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、䞋偎壁郚ず比べお䜍眮決め突起の匷床を確保するこずは困難であるず想定される。このように、匷床の劣る䜍眮決め突起にお先に䜍眮決めを行った堎合には、遊技盀の重量が䜍眮決め突起に加わる等しお、䜍眮決め突起の倉圢等が発生しやすくなるず懞念される。これは、䜍眮決め粟床の䜎䞋を招く芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。故に、望たしくは、遊技盀を装着する過皋においおは、先ず䞋偎壁郚による䞊䞋䜍眮の芏定を可胜ずするずよい。   (G3) In the above embodiment, after the game board 80 is placed on the lower wall portion 263 and the vertical position is defined, the left and right positions are defined by the positioning protrusions 259. However, the positioning order is reversed. May be. It is also possible to adopt a configuration in which the definition of the vertical position and the definition of the left and right positions are performed simultaneously. However, it is assumed that it is difficult to ensure the strength of the positioning protrusion 259 as compared with the lower side wall portion 263. As described above, there is a concern that when the positioning projection 259 with low strength is first positioned, the weight of the game board 80 is added to the positioning projection 259 and the positioning projection 259 is likely to be deformed. The This is not preferable because it can cause a decrease in positioning accuracy. Therefore, preferably, in the process of mounting the game board 80, it is preferable to first define the vertical position by the lower wall portion 263.

特に、䞊蚘実斜の圢態においおは、内枠に仮眮き郚を圢成し、遊技盀の装着初期段階にお遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きを抑え、遊技盀を回動させるこずで同遊技盀が䞋偎壁郚䞊に案内されお曎に䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きが抑えられる構成ずした。そしお、遊技盀が䞋偎壁郚に茉った状態で䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に挿通される構成ずした。぀たり、䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されるよりも先に、䜍眮決め突起が貫通孔に挿通されるこずを抑制した。しかしながら、この仮眮き郚に関しおは必須の構成ではなく、省略するこずも可胜である。   In particular, in the above-described embodiment, the temporary placement portion 290 is formed in the inner frame 13, the variation in the vertical position of the game board 80 is suppressed at the initial stage of mounting the game board 80, and the game board 80 is rotated. The gaming board 80 is guided on the lower wall portion 263 to further suppress variation in the vertical position. The positioning protrusion 259 is inserted into the through hole 91 in a state where the game board 80 is placed on the lower wall portion 263. That is, the positioning protrusion 259 is prevented from being inserted into the through hole 91 before the vertical position is defined. However, the temporary placement unit 290 is not an essential configuration and can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、茉眮郚ずしおの䞋偎壁郚が略平面状をなす構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、前埌に延びる突起によっお遊技盀を支える構成ずしおもよい。   (G4) In the above-described embodiment, the lower wall portion 263 serving as the placement portion is configured to be substantially planar, but the present invention is not limited to this. For example, the game board 80 may be supported by protrusions extending in the front-rear direction.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の回動䞭心を倉䜍可胜な構成ずしたが、同遊技盀の回動䞭心を固定する構成ずしおもよい。䟋えば、内枠によっお遊技盀を回動可胜に軞支するずよい。特に、遊技盀の䞊䞋方向ぞの移動を蚱容した状態で軞支し、䞋偎壁郚による䜍眮決めがなされた埌の軞郚ぞの負担を軜枛するずよい。   (G5) In the above embodiment, the rotation center of the game board 80 can be displaced. However, the rotation center of the game board 80 may be fixed. For example, the game board 80 may be pivotally supported by the inner frame 13. In particular, the game board 80 may be pivotally supported in a state in which the game board 80 is allowed to move in the vertical direction, and the burden on the shaft portion after the positioning by the lower wall portion 263 is reduced.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䜍眮決め突起を䞋偎壁郚偎に寄せお配眮したが、䜍眮決め突起を䞊偎壁郚偎に寄せお配眮するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮の䜍眮決め粟床が䞋偎壁郚近傍で最も高くなる䟋えば遊技盀が巊右に傟いた堎合のばら぀きは䞋偎壁郚近傍で最も小さくなるこずを想定すれば、䜍眮決め突起は䞋偎壁郚偎に寄せお配眮するこずが望たしい。   (G6) In the above-described embodiment, the positioning protrusion 259 is arranged close to the lower wall portion 263 side. However, the positioning protrusion 259 can be arranged close to the upper wall portion 262 side. However, assuming that the positioning accuracy of the vertical position of the game board 80 is the highest near the lower wall 263 (for example, the variation when the game board 80 is tilted to the left and right is the smallest near the lower wall 263). The positioning protrusion 259 is desirably arranged close to the lower wall portion 263 side.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮を「遊技機本䜓」ずしおの内枠に取り付けたが、これを倉曎し、「扉䜓」ずしおの前扉枠に取り付けおもよい。   (H1) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 is attached to the inner frame 13 as the “game machine main body”, but this may be changed and attached to the front door frame 14 as the “door body”.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮を前扉枠の回動先端偎に配眮したが、斜錠装眮の䜍眮を任意に倉曎しおもよい。䟋えば、斜錠装眮を前扉枠の䞊端及び䞋端に沿っお配眮するこずも可胜である。なお、前扉枠は必ずしも回動可胜に蚭ける必芁はなく、スラむド移動可胜に蚭けおもよい。   (H2) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 is arranged on the rotating front end side of the front door frame 14, but the position of the locking device may be arbitrarily changed. For example, the locking device can be disposed along the upper and lower ends of the front door frame 14. The front door frame 14 is not necessarily provided so as to be rotatable, and may be provided so as to be slidable.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮が前扉枠を内枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠するずずもに、内枠を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。斜錠装眮は、少なくずも前扉枠を閉じた状態で斜錠する機胜を有しおいればよく、内枠を閉じた状態で斜錠する機胜を省略するこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、内枠を倖枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮を別途蚭けるこずが奜たしい。たた、斜錠装眮に、裏パックナニットを内枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する機胜を付䞎するこずも可胜である。   (H3) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 locks the front door frame 14 with the inner frame 13 closed, and locks the inner frame 13 with the outer frame 11 closed. However, the present invention is not limited to this. The locking device 500 only needs to have a function of locking with at least the front door frame 14 closed, and the function of locking with the inner frame 13 closed may be omitted. However, in this case, it is preferable to separately provide a locking device that locks the inner frame 13 with the outer frame 11 closed. Moreover, it is also possible to provide the locking device 500 with a function of locking the back pack unit 15 with the inner frame 13 closed.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠及びハンドルベヌスによっお内枠の前面を芆うずずもに、そのハンドルベヌスに遊技球発射ハンドルを装着する構成ずしたが、このハンドルベヌスを省略し、前扉枠に遊技球発射ハンドルを装着するこずも可胜である。   (H4) In the above embodiment, the front door frame 14 and the handle base 41 cover the front surface of the inner frame 13, and the handle base 41 is mounted with the game ball launch handle 40. It is also possible to omit the game ball launch handle 40 from the front door frame 14.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠及びハンドルベヌスの䞡者によっお斜錠装眮を芆う構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、前扉枠によっおのみ斜錠装眮を芆う構成ずしおもよい。   (H5) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 is covered with both the front door frame 14 and the handle base 41. However, the locking device 500 may be changed to cover the locking device 500 only with the front door frame 14. .

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、内枠に斜錠装眮収容郚を圢成し、その前方開攟郚分を斜錠装眮における「ベヌス郚材」ずしおの第基枠によっお芆う構成ずしたが、必ずしも第基枠によっお芆う必芁はない。䟋えば、その開攟郚分をカバヌ郚材等によっお芆う構成ずしおもよいし、同開攟郚分を芆わない構成ずするこずも可胜である。仮に、開攟郚分を芆わない堎合であっおも、斜錠装眮が内枠及び前扉枠によっお芆われおいるため、埓来の構成斜錠装眮を内枠の背面に搭茉する構成ず比范すれば、少なからず防犯機胜を向䞊させるこずができる。   (H6) In the above embodiment, the locking device accommodating portion 77 is formed in the inner frame 13, and the front open portion thereof is covered by the first base frame 510 as the “base member” in the locking device 500. It is not necessary to cover with the first base frame 510. For example, the open portion may be covered with a cover member or the like, or the open portion may not be covered. Even if the open portion is not covered, since the locking device 500 is covered by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14, the conventional configuration (configuration in which the locking device is mounted on the back surface of the inner frame 13) and If compared, the crime prevention function can be improved.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から着脱する構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、遊技盀を内枠の背面偎から着脱する構成ずしおもよい。䜆し、このような倉曎を行う堎合には、䜵せお以䞋の倉曎を行うこずが奜たしい。前扉枠を開攟するこずにより、遊技盀を内枠に察しお固定するロック装眮の解陀操䜜が可胜ずなるように倉曎する。䟋えば、ロック装眮の操䜜郚を内枠の正面偎に配眮したり、内枠が倖枠に察しお開攟されおいない堎合にロック装眮の切り替え操䜜を阻止する阻止手段を前扉枠に蚭けたりするずよい。これにより、遊技盀が取り倖され、釘等の遊技郚品に察しお容易にアクセスされるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   (H7) In the above embodiment, the game board 80 is attached and detached from the front side of the inner frame 13, but this may be changed and the game board may be attached and detached from the rear side of the inner frame. However, when making such a change, it is preferable to make the following changes together. By opening the front door frame, the lock is changed so that the lock device for fixing the game board to the inner frame can be released. For example, the front door frame is provided with blocking means for disposing the operation portion of the locking device on the front side of the inner frame or blocking the switching operation of the locking device when the inner frame 13 is not open to the outer frame 11. Or better. As a result, it is possible to make it difficult for the inconvenience that the game board is removed and the game parts such as the nail 87 are easily accessed.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀を内枠の正面偎から着脱する構成ずしたが、これず同じ思想を内枠に搭茉されおいる他の遊技機郚品に適甚するこずも可胜である。䟋えば本実斜の圢態においおは、遊技球発射機構が内枠に圢成された貫通孔等を介しお内枠の背面偎に蚭けられた制埡装眮ず接続されおいるが、その取り倖しを内枠の正面偎から行う構成ずするこずで、遊技球発射機構が取り陀かれ、䞊蚘貫通孔を介しお䞍正が行われやすくなるずいった䞍郜合を奜適に抑制できる。   (H8) In the above embodiment, the gaming board 80 is configured to be attached and detached from the front side of the inner frame 13, but the same idea can be applied to other gaming machine parts mounted on the inner frame. It is. For example, in the present embodiment, the game ball launching mechanism 110 is connected to a control device provided on the back side of the inner frame through a through hole or the like formed in the inner frame 13. By adopting a configuration that is performed from the front side of 13, the game ball launching mechanism 110 is removed, and inconvenience that fraud is likely to be performed through the through hole can be suitably suppressed.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀収容郚詳しくは呚壁郚及び挿入郚によっお遊技盀の着脱軌道を特定し、前扉枠を閉じた状態では、この軌道䞊に同前扉枠が存圚するこずで、遊技盀の取り倖しを䞍可ずしたが、これら遊技盀収容郚及び挿入郚を省略するこずも可胜である。   (H9) In the above embodiment, the mounting / dismounting track of the game board 80 is specified by the game board housing part 75 (specifically, the peripheral wall part 261) and the insertion part 280, and when the front door frame 14 is closed, The presence of the front door frame 14 makes it impossible to remove the game board 80, but the game board housing part 75 and the insertion part 280 can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠が内枠に察しお閉じた状態では、「区画手段」ずしおの前扉枠のガラスホルダず内枠の右偎壁郚ずによっお、内枠及び前扉枠によっお囲たれた空間を遊技盀偎の領域ず斜錠装眮偎の領域ずに区画する構成ずしたが、必ずしもこれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、前扉枠の背面に内枠の前面に向けお延びる仕切郚を蚭けおもよいし、内枠の前面に前扉枠の背面に向けお延びる仕切郚を蚭けおもよい。   (H10) In the above embodiment, when the front door frame 14 is closed with respect to the inner frame 13, the glass holder 27 of the front door frame 14 as the “partitioning means” and the right side wall portion 265 of the inner frame 13 The space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14 is divided into a region on the game board 80 side and a region on the locking device 500 side, but is not necessarily limited thereto. For example, a partition portion that extends toward the front surface of the inner frame 13 may be provided on the back surface of the front door frame 14, or a partition portion that extends toward the back surface of the front door frame 14 may be provided on the front surface of the inner frame 13. .

曎には、内枠及び前扉枠によっお囲たれた空間を遊技盀偎の領域ず斜錠装眮偎の領域ずに区画する必芁は必ずしもなく、同空間を䞡領域に区画しない構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、䞊蚘実斜の圢態ず比范しお防犯機胜が䜎䞋しやすくなる。   Furthermore, the space surrounded by the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14 is not necessarily divided into a region on the game board 80 side and a region on the locking device 500 side, and the space is not divided into both regions. It is also possible. However, in this case, the crime prevention function is likely to be reduced as compared with the above embodiment.

前扉枠に、「固定手段」ずしおのロック装眮の操䜜郚の切り替えを阻止する阻止手段を蚭けるこずも可胜である。䟋えば、ロック状態に切り替えられた状態の操䜜郚が嵌る凹郚を圢成したり、操䜜郚がアンロック状態に切り替えられる堎合の回動方向先偎から同操䜜郚に察しお圓接するストッパを圢成したりするずよい。これにより、遊技盀の䞍正な取り倖しを抑制し、曎なる防犯機胜の匷化に貢献できる。   (H11) The front door frame 14 may be provided with blocking means for blocking the switching of the operation unit 446 of the locking device 400 as “fixing means”. For example, a recess that fits the operation unit 446 in the locked state is formed, or a stopper that contacts the operation unit 446 from the front side in the rotation direction when the operation unit 446 is switched to the unlocked state. It is good to form. As a result, unauthorized removal of the game board 80 can be suppressed and further security functions can be enhanced.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、各鉀郚材が斜錠装眮収容郚から突出する構成ずしたが、これら各鉀郚材が斜錠装眮収容郚から突出しない構成ずするこずも可胜である。以䞋、図に基づきその具䜓䟋に぀いお説明する。図は、斜錠装眮及びそれに付随する構成を瀺す抂略図である。   (H12) In the above embodiment, the hook members 550 and 620 protrude from the locking device housing portion 77. However, the hook members 550 and 620 may not protrude from the locking device housing portion 77. Is possible. A specific example will be described below with reference to FIG. FIG. 35 is a schematic view showing the locking device and the structure accompanying it.

図に瀺すように、前扉枠には、内枠偎に突出する鉀郚材が蚭けられおいる。斜錠装眮の第基枠においお前扉枠の背面ず察向しおいる前板郚には鉀郚材が挿通される挿通孔が圢成されおいる。前板郚の背面偎には鉀郚材に察応する前扉甚鉀受け郚材が蚭けられおいる。前扉甚鉀受け郚材には孔郚が圢成されおおり、この孔郚に察しお鉀郚材が匕っ掛かるこずで前扉枠が斜錠された状態ずなる。   As shown in FIG. 35, the front door frame 14 is provided with a flange member 871 that protrudes toward the inner frame 13 side. In the first base frame 891 of the locking device 890, an insertion hole 893 through which the flange member 871 is inserted is formed in the front plate portion 892 facing the back surface of the front door frame 14. A front door scissor receiving member 894 corresponding to the scissors member 871 is provided on the back side of the front plate portion 892. A hole 895 is formed in the front door scissor receiving member 894, and the front door frame 14 is locked by the hook member 871 being caught in the hole 895.

同様に、倖枠には、内枠偎に突出する鉀郚材が蚭けられおいる。斜錠装眮においお斜錠装眮収容郚の奥壁郚ず察向しおいる埌板郚には鉀郚材の通過を蚱容する挿通孔が圢成されおいる。埌板郚の前面偎には鉀郚材に察応する内枠甚鉀受け郚材が蚭けられおいる。内枠甚鉀受け郚材には孔郚が圢成されおおり、この孔郚に察しお鉀郚材が匕っ掛かるこずで内枠が倖枠に察しお斜錠された状態ずなる。   Similarly, the outer frame 11 is provided with a flange member 881 that protrudes toward the inner frame 13. In the locking device 890, an insertion hole 897 that allows passage of the flange member 881 is formed in the rear plate portion 896 that faces the back wall portion 301 of the locking device housing portion 77. An inner frame collar receiving member 898 corresponding to the collar member 881 is provided on the front side of the rear plate portion 896. A hole 899 is formed in the inner frame collar receiving member 898, and the inner frame 13 is locked to the outer frame 11 when the collar member 881 is caught in the hole 899.

以䞊詳述したように、前扉枠の鉀郚材が斜錠装眮収容郚内に入り蟌むこずで同斜錠装眮収容郚の内郚領域にお鉀郚材ず前扉甚鉀受け郚材ずが匕っ掛かる構成ずし、䞔぀倖枠の鉀郚材が斜錠装眮収容郚内に入り蟌むこずで同斜錠装眮収容郚の内郚領域にお鉀郚材ず内枠甚鉀受け郚材ずが匕っ掛かる構成ずするこずにより、斜錠装眮収容郚倖ぞの各鉀受け郚材の露出を抑え、同鉀受け郚材に察しおのパチンコ機倖郚からのアクセスを第基枠によっお劚げるこずができる。このような倉曎を行うこずで曎なる防犯性の向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   As described in detail above, when the collar member 871 of the front door frame 14 enters the locking device housing portion 77, the collar member 871 and the front door rod receiving member 894 are formed in the inner region of the locking device housing portion 77. A configuration in which the hook member 881 of the outer frame 11 enters the locking device housing portion 77 and the hook member 881 and the inner frame hook receiving member 898 are hooked in the inner region of the locking device housing portion 77. As a result, the exposure of the hook receiving members 894 and 898 to the outside of the locking device housing 77 is suppressed, and the first base frame 891 prevents access to the hook receiving members 894 and 898 from the outside of the pachinko machine. Can do. By making such changes, it is possible to contribute to further improvement of crime prevention.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、内枠のスリットを通じお内枠甚鉀郚材が同内枠の背面偎に露出し、それらスリットず内枠甚鉀郚材ずの隙間を連動杆のフランゞによっお斜錠装眮収容郚の内偎から芆う構成ずしたが、これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、連動杆以倖の郚材等によっお䞊蚘隙間を芆う構成ずしおもよい。特に、䞊蚘隙間を、内枠甚鉀郚材における鉀郚以倖の郚分で芆う構成ずすれば、同内枠甚鉀郚材が動䜜した堎合に、䞊蚘隙間を奜適に塞ぐこずができる。   (H13) In the above embodiment, the inner frame collar member 620 is exposed to the back side of the inner frame 13 through the slit 303 of the inner frame 13, and the gap between the slit 303 and the inner frame collar member 620 is coupled to the inner frame 13. Although it was set as the structure covered from the inner side of the locking device accommodating part 77 by the flange 545 of 540, you may change this as follows. In other words, the gap may be covered with a member other than the interlocking rod 540. In particular, if the gap is configured to be covered with a portion other than the collar portion of the inner frame collar member, the gap can be suitably closed when the inner frame collar member operates.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮の第基枠が郚材取付郚及びフランゞ郚を有する構成ずしたが、これら䞡者を省略するこずも可胜である。この堎合、郚材取付郚に取り付けられおいる各皮構成を基枠固定郚に取り付けるずよい。䜆し、䞊蚘実斜の圢態においおは、それら郚材取付郚及びフランゞ郚によっお斜錠装眮の着脱軌道を芏定しおいた。前扉枠が閉じられた状態では、同着脱軌道䞊に前扉枠が存圚するこずにより、同斜錠装眮の取り倖しを抑制しおいた。䞊述の劂く郚材取付郚及びフランゞ郚を省略する堎合、䟋えば、斜錠装眮収容郚の呚壁を前扉枠偎に延出させ、第基枠の取り倖し軌道を捻出するずよい。これにより、防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑制できる。   (H14) In the above embodiment, the first base frame 510 of the locking device 500 has the member mounting portion 515 and the flange portion 516, but both of them can be omitted. In this case, various configurations attached to the member attaching portion 515 may be attached to the base frame fixing portion 511. However, in the above-described embodiment, the attaching / detaching track of the locking device 500 is defined by the member attaching portion 515 and the flange portion 516. In the state where the front door frame 14 is closed, the front door frame 14 is present on the same attachment / detachment track, thereby suppressing the removal of the locking device 500. When the member attaching portion 515 and the flange portion 516 are omitted as described above, for example, the peripheral wall of the locking device housing portion 77 may be extended toward the front door frame 14 and the removal track of the first base frame 510 may be twisted. Thereby, the fall of a crime prevention function can be suppressed.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、内枠に斜錠装眮のカム郚材に察応する開口郚を圢成したが、この開口郚を省略するこずも可胜である。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合、操䜜キヌなしで前扉枠を開攟するこずが䞍可ずなり、利䟿性が䜎䞋し埗る。   (H15) In the above embodiment, the opening 320 corresponding to the cam member 600 of the locking device 500 is formed in the inner frame 13, but the opening 320 may be omitted. However, when such a change is made, it becomes impossible to open the front door frame 14 without an operation key, and convenience may be lowered.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、内枠の䞭倮開口を遊技盀によっお芆う構成ずしたが、遊技盀によっお塞ぐ構成ずするこずも可胜である。この堎合、遊技盀の背面を内枠の察向板郚に圓接させるこずで同遊技盀の前埌䜍眮の䜍眮決めを行うずよい。なお、䞭倮開口は必須の構成ではなく、これを省略するこずも可胜である。   (H16) In the above-described embodiment, the central opening 76 of the inner frame 13 is covered with the game board 80. However, the game board 80 may be closed. In this case, the front and back positions of the game board 80 may be positioned by bringing the back surface of the game board 80 into contact with the opposing plate portion 251 of the inner frame 13. Note that the central opening 76 is not an essential component and can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、挿入郚に遊技盀の䞀偎郚を挿入し、同遊技盀を回動させるこずで装着完了䜍眮に移動させる構成ずしたが、遊技盀を前埌にスラむド移動させるこずで装着完了䜍眮に移動させる構成ずしおもよい。このような倉曎を行う堎合、䟋えば挿入郚を省略し、遊技盀を遊技盀収容郚の呚壁郚によっお同遊技盀のスラむド方向を芏定するずよい。   (H17) In the above embodiment, one side portion of the game board 80 is inserted into the insertion part 280, and the game board 80 is moved to the mounting completion position by rotating the game board 80. It is good also as a structure which is moved to a mounting completion position by sliding it. When such a change is made, for example, the insertion part 280 may be omitted, and the sliding direction of the game board may be defined by the peripheral wall part of the game board housing part.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮が「ベヌス郚材」ずしおの第基枠にシリンダ錠連動杆前扉甚鉀郚材内枠甚鉀郚材を取り付ける構成ずしたが、同第基枠を省略し、内枠や前扉枠に察しお䞊蚘各皮構成を取り付ける構成ずするこずも可胜である。   (H18) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 attaches the cylinder lock 520, the interlocking rod 540, the front door rod member 550, and the inner frame rod member 620 to the first base frame 510 as the “base member”. However, it is possible to omit the first base frame 510 and attach the various configurations to the inner frame 13 and the front door frame 14.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮においお「第斜錠郚材」ずしおの前扉甚鉀郚材及び「第斜錠郚材」ずしおの内枠甚鉀郚材を斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する「付勢郚材」ずしおコむルバネを甚いたが、これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。コむルバネ匕っ匵りコむルバネに代えお圧瞮コむルバネや板バネ等を甚いるこずも可胜であり、同コむルバネに代えおゎム等の匟性郚材を甚いるこずも可胜である。   (I1) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 biases the front door rod member 550U as the “first locking member” and the inner frame rod member 630U as the “second locking member” toward the locking position. The coil spring 560U is used as the “biasing member” to be changed, but this may be changed as follows. A compression coil spring, a leaf spring, or the like can be used instead of the coil spring 560U (tensile coil spring), and an elastic member such as rubber can be used instead of the coil spring 560U.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚鉀郚材における突起を「第取付郚」ずし、内枠甚鉀郚材における突起を「第取付郚」ずしたが、これらを逆にするこずも可胜である。すなわち、内枠甚鉀郚材の突起を同内枠甚鉀郚材においお前扉甚鉀郚材ずは反察偎ずなる郚䜍に配蚭するこずも可胜である。特に、䞡鉀郚材においお各突起を盞手ずは反察偎にそれぞれ圢成するこずで、コむルバネの自由長の確保を曎に容易なものずするこずができる。   (I2) In the above embodiment, the protrusion 554 in the front door flange member 550U is referred to as a “first attachment portion”, and the protrusion 622 in the inner frame flange member 620 is referred to as a “second attachment portion”. It is also possible to make it. In other words, the protrusion of the inner frame collar member 620U can be disposed on the opposite side of the inner frame collar member 620U from the front door collar member 550U. In particular, by forming the protrusions 554 and 622 on the opposite sides of the flange members 550U and 620U, it is possible to further easily secure the free length of the coil spring 560U.

たた、内枠甚鉀郚材が前扉甚鉀郚材よりも䞊䜍ずなるように配眮したが、これら䞡鉀郚材を䞊䞋逆にするこずも可胜である。   Further, although the inner frame eaves member 620U is arranged to be higher than the front door eaves member 550U, both the eaves members 550U and 620U can be turned upside down.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「ベヌス郚材」ずしおの第基枠の䞊端偎に配眮された前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材をコむルバネで繋ぐ構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、第基枠の䞋端偎に配眮された前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材をコむルバネで繋ぐ構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、䞊蚘実斜の圢態においおは、遊技球発射ハンドルによっお前扉甚鉀郚材の配眮が限定されおいるため、敢えお内枠甚鉀郚材を前扉甚鉀郚材に寄せる必芁はない。   (I3) In the above embodiment, the front door flange member 550U and the inner frame flange member 620U arranged on the upper end side of the first base frame 510 as the “base member” are connected by the coil spring 560U. It is also possible to change this and adopt a configuration in which the front door flange member 550L and the inner frame flange member 620L arranged on the lower end side of the first base frame 510 are connected by a coil spring 560L. However, in the above embodiment, since the arrangement of the front door cage member 550 is limited by the game ball launch handle 40, it is not necessary to bring the inner frame cage member 620 to the front door cage member 550.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、各鉀郚材の突起を互いに近づく偎に付勢するこずで、それら各鉀郚材を斜錠䜍眮に維持する構成ずしたが、この付勢方向を逆にするこずも可胜である。すなわち、各鉀郚材の突起を互いに遠ざかる偎に付勢するこずで、それら各鉀郚材を斜錠䜍眮に維持する構成ずするこずも可胜である。しかしながら、このような倉曎を行った堎合には、䞡鉀郚材を近づけお配眮するこずが難しくなるず懞念される。故に、望たしくは䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺した構成を採甚するずよい。   (I4) In the above embodiment, the projections 554 and 622 of the flange members 550 and 620 are biased toward each other to maintain the flange members 550 and 620 in the locked position. It is also possible to reverse the biasing direction. That is, it is also possible to adopt a configuration in which the hook members 550 and 620 are maintained in the locked position by urging the protrusions 554 and 622 of the hook members 550 and 620 away from each other. However, when such a change is made, there is a concern that it will be difficult to arrange the two flange members 550 and 620 close to each other. Therefore, it is desirable to adopt the configuration shown in the above embodiment.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚鉀郚材の突起を起立郚に蚭けたが、同突起をベヌス郚に蚭けるこずも可胜である。   (I5) In the above-described embodiment, the protrusion 554 of the front door saddle member 550 is provided on the upright portion 553, but the protrusion can also be provided on the base portion 551.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材を第基枠の異なる郚䜍に配眮した。すなわち、前扉甚鉀郚材を第基枠の基枠固定郚に取り付けるずずもに、内枠甚鉀郚材を第基枠の郚材取付郚に取り付ける構成ずした。これを倉曎し、各鉀郚材を同䞀察象に取り付ける構成ずしおもよい。   (I6) In the above embodiment, the front door saddle member 550 and the inner frame saddle member 620 are arranged in different parts of the first base frame 510. That is, the front door cage member 550 is attached to the base frame fixing portion 511 of the first base frame 510, and the inner frame cage member 620 is attached to the member attachment portion 515 of the first base frame 510. It is good also as a structure which changes this and attaches each collar member 550,620 to the same object.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚鉀郚材をスラむド移動可胜に蚭けるずずもに、内枠甚鉀郚材を回動可胜に蚭けた。これら各鉀郚材の移動態様に぀いおは任意であり、䟋えば䞡鉀郚材をスラむド移動可胜ずしおもよいし、回動可胜ずしおもよい。   (I7) In the above embodiment, the front door flange member 550 is slidably provided, and the inner frame flange member 620 is rotatably provided. The movement mode of each of the flange members 550 and 620 is arbitrary. For example, both the flange members 550 and 620 may be slidable or rotatable.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮の䞋端偎に遊技球発射ハンドルを固定するハンドルベヌスを蚭け、このハンドルベヌスずの重なりを回避すべく前扉甚鉀郚材をハンドルベヌスの䞊方に配眮した。このハンドルベヌスを省略するこずも可胜であり、これに䜵せお前扉甚鉀郚材を斜錠装眮内枠の䞋端に寄せお配眮するこずで、前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを䞀局奜適に抑制できる。この堎合、前扉甚鉀郚材及び内枠甚鉀郚材の䜍眮が近づくず想定されるが、これら䞡鉀郚材のコむルバネの代わりにのコむルバネを甚いお䞡鉀郚材を付勢するこずで実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   (I8) In the above embodiment, the handle base 41 for fixing the game ball launching handle 40 is provided on the lower end side of the locking device 500, and the front door saddle member 550L is attached to the handle base to avoid overlapping with the handle base 41. 41 above. The handle base 41 can be omitted, and the front door frame member 550L is arranged close to the lower end of the locking device 500 (inner frame 13), thereby further raising the front door frame 14. It can suppress suitably. In this case, it is assumed that the positions of the front door brim member 550L and the inner frame brim member 620L are close to each other. A practically preferable configuration can be realized by energizing 550L and 620L.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮を内枠の正面偎に配眮したが、これを倉曎し、同斜錠装眮を内枠の背面偎に配眮するこずも可胜である。   (I9) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 is arranged on the front side of the inner frame 13, but it is also possible to change this and arrange the locking device on the back side of the inner frame 13.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、各鉀郚材が連動杆の動きずは独立した斜錠解陀䜍眮ぞの移動を蚱容する構成ずした。これを倉曎し、各鉀郚材が連動杆の動きに远埓するこずによっおのみ斜錠解陀䜍眮ぞの移動が蚱容される構成ずしおもよい。   (I10) In the above-described embodiment, the hook members 550 and 620 are configured to allow movement to the unlocking position independent of the movement of the interlocking hook 540. It is good also as a structure by which this is changed and the movement to a lock release position is accept | permitted only when each collar member 550,620 follows the motion of the interlocking collar 540. FIG.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮に鉀郚材を配するずずもに前扉枠及び倖枠に鉀受け郚材を配したが、これを倉曎し、斜錠装眮に鉀受け郚材を配するずずもに前扉枠及び倖枠に鉀郚材を配しおもよい。぀たり、「斜錠郚材」は、鉀郚材に限定されるものではなく鉀受け郚材ずしおもよい。なお、鉀郚材及び鉀受け郚材の䞡者を同等の関係ずみなせば、䟋えば斜錠装眮偎の斜錠郚材を斜錠装眮偎係止郚材、前扉枠及び倖枠偎の斜錠郚材を前扉偎係止郚材倖枠偎係止郚材ず称するこずも可胜である。   (I11) In the above embodiment, the hook members 550 and 620 are arranged on the locking device 500 and the hook receiving members 63 and 350 are arranged on the front door frame 14 and the outer frame 11, but this is changed to the locking device. A scissor receiving member may be disposed and a scissor member may be disposed on the front door frame 14 and the outer frame 11. That is, the “locking member” is not limited to the hook member, and may be a hook receiving member. If both the hook member and the hook receiving member are regarded as equivalent, for example, the locking member on the locking device side is the locking member on the locking device side, and the locking member on the front door frame and the outer frame side is the locking member on the front door side. The outer frame side locking member can also be called.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、各鉀郚材をのシリンダ錠を甚いお操䜜可胜ずしたが、各鉀郚材に個別に察応しおシリンダ錠を぀蚭け、それら各シリンダ錠を甚いお各鉀郚材を個々に操䜜可胜ずしおもよい。   (I12) In the above embodiment, each hook member 550, 620 can be operated using one cylinder lock 520. However, two cylinder locks are provided corresponding to each hook member 550, 620, and Each saddle member 550, 620 may be individually operable using each cylinder lock.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「開閉䜓」ずしおの内枠における「貫通孔」ずしおのスリットを介しお斜錠装眮の内枠甚鉀郚材が同内枠の背面偎に露出する構成ずし、そのスリットの呚瞁に沿っお「壁郚」ずしおの察向壁郚を圢成したが、同察向壁郚をスリットの呚瞁から離しお圢成するこずも可胜である。   (J1) In the above embodiment, the inner frame collar member 620 of the locking device 500 is exposed to the back side of the inner frame 13 through the slit 303 as the “through hole” in the inner frame 13 as the “opening / closing body”. Although the opposing wall portion 305 as a “wall portion” is formed along the periphery of the slit 303, the opposing wall portion 305 can be formed away from the periphery of the slit 303.

内枠甚鉀郚材は内枠の䞊端及び䞋端に寄せお配眮され、内枠の倖枠からの浮き䞊がりを抑えやすくしおいる。この堎合、䟋えば、䞊偎の鉀郚材に察応するスリットにおいおは、同スリットの䞊端瞁に沿うようにしお䞊蚘察向壁郚を延長するこずにより、内枠の䞊偎枠郚ず前扉枠ずの境界郚からの䞍正なアクセスを抑制しやすくできる。これず同様の倉曎を䞋偎の察向壁郚に適甚するこずも可胜である。   (J2) The inner frame collar member 620 is arranged close to the upper end and the lower end of the inner frame 13 to make it easy to suppress the floating of the inner frame 13 from the outer frame 11. In this case, for example, in the slit 303 corresponding to the upper flange member 620U, the opposing wall portion 305 is extended along the upper end edge of the slit 303, so that the upper frame portion 13a of the inner frame 13 and the front frame portion 620U Unauthorized access from the boundary with the door frame 14 can be easily suppressed. It is also possible to apply the same change to the lower facing wall portion 305.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向壁郚の起立量を内枠甚鉀郚材の匕っ掛かり郚分を芆える皋床に蚭定したが、これを倉曎し、内枠甚鉀郚材のスリットからの突出量ず同等に蚭定しおもよい。   (J3) In the above-described embodiment, the amount of standing of the facing wall 305 is set to an extent that covers the hooked portion of the inner frame collar member 620. However, this is changed and the slit 303 of the inner frame collar member 620 is changed. It may be set to be equal to the protruding amount of.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向壁郚の先端郚分が倖枠の鉀受け郚材に圢成された開口に入る構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、同開口に入らない構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、察向壁郚の迂回が容易になり、防犯機胜が䜎䞋するず懞念される。そこで、察向壁郚が開口に入らない構成を採甚する堎合には、同察向壁郚の先端を鉀受け郚材の前偎板郚に近接又は圓接させるずよい。これにより、防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。なお、実際にこのような倉曎を適甚する堎合には、察向壁郚の先端を前偎板郚に近接又は圓接させるこずが、装着䜍眮のばら぀き等により困難になりえる。そしお、このような䞍郜合を解消する堎合、構成が煩雑化しやすくなる。故に、奜たしくは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、察向壁郚の先端が開口内に入る構成を採甚するずよい。   (J4) In the above-described embodiment, the distal end portion of the facing wall portion 305 is configured to enter the opening 353 formed in the flange receiving member 350 of the outer frame 11. However, the present invention is not limited to this. For example, a configuration that does not enter the opening 353 is also possible. However, in this case, there is a concern that detouring of the facing wall portion 305 is facilitated and the security function is reduced. Therefore, when adopting a configuration in which the opposing wall portion 305 does not enter the opening 353, the front end of the opposing wall portion 305 may be brought close to or in contact with the front side plate portion 352 of the collar receiving member 350. Thereby, the fall of a crime prevention function can be suppressed. Note that when such a change is actually applied, it may be difficult to bring the front end of the facing wall portion 305 close to or in contact with the front plate portion 352 due to variations in the mounting position. And when such an inconvenience is eliminated, a structure becomes easy to become complicated. Therefore, it is preferable to adopt a configuration in which the tip of the opposing wall portion 305 enters the opening 353 as shown in the above embodiment.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向壁郚が内枠の回動先端偎から内枠甚鉀郚材の移動範囲党域に重なる構成ずしたが、必ずしもこれに限定されない。察向壁郚は、前蚘移動範囲の䞀郚に重なる構成ずするこずで、内枠甚鉀郚材の斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えを困難なものずするこずができる。   (J5) In the above embodiment, the opposing wall portion 305 is configured to overlap the entire moving range of the inner frame collar member 620 from the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13, but this is not necessarily limited thereto. By making the opposing wall portion overlap with a part of the moving range, it is difficult to switch the inner frame collar member 620 to the unlocked state.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向壁郚をスリットに察しお内枠甚鉀郚材の解陀方向䞋方に僅かにずらしお配眮したが、必ずしもこのようにずらしお配眮する必芁はない。たた、察向壁郚の瞊幅は、内枠甚鉀郚材をその移動範囲党域で芆うこずができるのであれば、スリットの瞊幅に合わせる必芁はない。䜆し、スリットに぀いおも䞍正具の䟵入経路ずしお狙われやすいず想定されるため、望たしくは、スリットに合わせお察向壁郚を圢成するずよい。   (J6) In the above embodiment, the opposing wall portion 305 is slightly shifted in the releasing direction (downward) of the inner frame collar member 620 with respect to the slit 303. However, it is not always necessary to shift the opposing wall portion 305 in this manner. Absent. Further, the vertical width of the facing wall portion 305 does not need to match the vertical width of the slit 303 as long as the inner frame flange member 620 can be covered over the entire moving range. However, since it is assumed that the slit 303 is also easily targeted as an intrusion route for unauthorized tools, it is desirable to form the opposing wall portion in accordance with the slit 303.

察向壁郚は、斜錠状態の内枠甚鉀郚材に察しお斜錠偎に延びおいる必芁はなく、少なくずも斜錠解陀䜍眮偎に延びおいればよい。これにより、内枠甚鉀郚材にワむダ等の䞍正具を匕っ掛けお斜錠解陀状態に切り替えるずいった行為を抑制するこずができる。   (J7) The opposing wall portion 305 does not need to extend to the locking side with respect to the locked inner frame collar member 620, and may extend to at least the locking release position side. Thereby, the act of hooking an improper tool such as a wire on the inner frame collar member 620 and switching to the unlocked state can be suppressed.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、察向壁郚の起立方向を、スリットからの内枠甚鉀郚材の突出方向ず同䞀ずしたが、必ずしもこれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、内枠甚鉀郚材の突出方向に察しお傟けるこずも可胜である。䜆し、このような倉曎を行う堎合であっおも、同察向壁郚においお内枠の回動先端偎を向いた面を前蚘突出方向ず平行又は内枠甚鉀郚材の先端偎にお同内枠甚鉀郚材から離れるように傟斜させるこずが奜たしい。   (J8) In the above-described embodiment, the rising direction of the opposing wall portion 305 is the same as the protruding direction of the inner frame flange member 620 from the slit 303, but the present invention is not necessarily limited thereto. For example, it is possible to incline with respect to the protruding direction of the inner frame collar member 620. However, even in the case where such a change is made, the surface facing the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13 in the opposite wall portion is parallel to the projecting direction or the front end side of the inner frame collar member 620 is the same. It is preferable to incline away from the inner frame collar member 620.

なお、察向壁郚においお内枠の回動先端偎を向いた面は曲面であっおもよい。   In addition, the surface which faced the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13 in an opposing wall part may be a curved surface.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「開口」ずしおの開口郚が遊技機偎方及び遊技機埌方に連続する構成ずしが、開口郚が遊技機偎方及び遊技機埌方いずれか䞀方を向く構成ずするこずも可胜である。蚀い換えれば、開口郚が盞互に異なる方向を向いた耇数の壁面郚に跚る構成ずした。これに限定されるものではく、耇数の壁面郚に跚らない構成ずするこずも可胜である。   (K1) In the above embodiment, the opening 320 as the “opening” is configured to be continuous to the side of the gaming machine and the rear of the gaming machine, but the opening is directed to either the side of the gaming machine or the rear of the gaming machine. It is also possible. In other words, the opening 320 is configured to straddle a plurality of wall surfaces 312a and 312b facing different directions. However, the present invention is not limited to this, and a configuration that does not straddle a plurality of wall surfaces is also possible.

䟋えば、開口郚をパチンコ機の埌方を向く壁面郚に圢成しおもよい。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合、「芏制郚䜍」ずしおのカム郚材やネゞの取り倖し䜜業が容易になる反面、倖枠によっお開口郚を芆うこずが難しくなり埗る。   For example, the opening may be formed on a wall surface facing the back of the pachinko machine 10. However, when such a change is made, it is easy to remove the cam member 530 and the screw 531 as the “regulatory part”, but it may be difficult to cover the opening 320 with the outer frame 11.

たた、開口郚を内枠の回動先端偎を向く壁面郚に圢成するこずも可胜である。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合、倖枠によっお開口郚を芆いやすくなる反面、ネゞの取り倖し䜜業が難しくなるず想定される。   It is also possible to form the opening in the wall surface portion facing the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13. However, when such a change is made, it is assumed that the outer frame 11 can easily cover the opening, but it is difficult to remove the screw 531.

故に、望たしくは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、開口郚をパチンコ機の埌方を向く壁面郚ず内枠の回動先端偎を向く壁面郚ずに跚るように圢成し、䜜業のやりやすさず防犯性の確保ずを䞡立するずよい。   Therefore, desirably, as shown in the above-described embodiment, the opening 320 is formed so as to straddle the wall surface portion 312a facing the back of the pachinko machine 10 and the wall surface portion 312b facing the rotation front end side of the inner frame 13. It is advisable to achieve both work ease and security.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、開口郚を介しおのカム郚材及びネゞの取り出しを蚱容する構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、それらカム郚材及びネゞの取り出しを䞍可ずする構成ずしおもよい。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合には、取り倖されたカム郚材及びネゞが斜錠装眮収容郚内に残留するこずで、それらカム郚材やネゞが匕っ掛かる等しお解錠操䜜が劚げられる可胜性が生じる。本実斜の圢態においおは、前扉甚鉀郚材をカム郚材よりも䞊偎に配眮しおいるため、カム郚材等ずの匕っ掛かりは回避されやすいが、前扉枠の解錠時に連動杆が䞋方に移動する構成であるため圓該連動杆ず斜錠装眮収容郚の䞋偎壁郚等ずの間にカム郚材等が挟たるずいった䞍郜合は十分発生し埗る。そこで、䞊蚘倉曎に䜵せお、前扉枠の解錠時の連動杆の動䜜方向を逆にする等の察策を講じるこずが望たしい。   (K2) In the above embodiment, the cam member 530 and the screw 531 are allowed to be taken out through the opening 320. However, the cam member 530 and the screw 531 cannot be taken out by changing this. It is good also as a structure. However, when such a change is made, the removed cam member 530 and the screw 531 remain in the locking device housing portion 77, so that the cam member 530 and the screw 531 are caught and the unlocking operation is performed. May be hindered. In the present embodiment, since the front door eaves members 550U and 550L are arranged above the cam member 530, it is easy to avoid catching with the cam member 530 and the like, but when the front door frame 14 is unlocked Since the interlocking rod 540 is configured to move downward, there can be a sufficient problem that the cam member 530 or the like is sandwiched between the interlocking rod 540 and the lower wall portion of the locking device housing portion 77 or the like. Therefore, it is desirable to take measures such as reversing the operation direction of the interlocking rod 540 when the front door frame 14 is unlocked in conjunction with the above change.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䞡前扉甚鉀郚材をカム郚材の䞊方に配眮したが、これら前扉甚鉀郚材の配眮を以䞋のように倉曎するこずも可胜である。䟋えば、䞡前扉甚鉀郚材をカム郚材の䞋方に配眮しおもよいし、前扉甚鉀郚材をカム郚材の䞊方、前扉甚鉀郚材をカム郚材の䞋方に配眮するこずも可胜である。特にカム郚材の䞀方偎にたずめお配眮するこずにより、カム郚材から遠い偎の前扉甚鉀郚材ぞの䞍正なアクセス開口郚を介しおの䞍正解錠をカム郚材から近い偎の他方の前扉甚鉀郚材によっお劚げるずいった防犯機胜の向䞊が芋蟌たれる。   (K3) In the above embodiment, the front door saddle members 550U and 550L are arranged above the cam member 530. However, the arrangement of the front door saddle members 550U and 550L can be changed as follows. It is. For example, the front door saddle members 550U and 550L may be arranged below the cam member 530, the front door saddle member 550U above the cam member 530, and the front door saddle member 550L below the cam member 530. It is also possible to arrange them. In particular, by arranging the cam member 530 together on one side, unauthorized access to the front door collar member 550 far from the cam member 530 (unauthorized unlocking via the opening 320) can be prevented from the cam member 530. The improvement of the crime prevention function such as blocking by the other front door gutter member 550 on the near side is expected.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、開口郚の特定郚分を郚分的に拡匵する拡匵郚を圢成し、ドラむバ等の工具を挿入する際の目安及びガむドずしお利甚可胜ずしたが、開口郚を党䜓的に拡匵し工具の挿入軌道が確保されるのであれば、拡匵郚を省略するこずもできる。   (K4) In the above embodiment, the extended portion 321 that partially expands a specific portion of the opening 320 is formed and can be used as a guide and a guide when inserting a tool such as a driver. If the tool is extended as a whole and the insertion path of the tool is secured, the extension part 321 can be omitted.

たた、䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ネゞの取り倖し䜜業を行うための拡匵郚を、カム郚材及びネゞを取り出しを蚱容する開口郚に察しお、䞀䜓的に蚭けたが、同拡匵郚に盞圓する構成䟋えば貫通孔や開口を開口郚ずは別個独立しお蚭けるこずも可胜である。   In the above embodiment, the extension 321 for removing the screw 531 is provided integrally with the opening 320 that allows the cam member 530 and the screw 531 to be removed. A configuration corresponding to 321 (for example, a through hole or an opening) can be provided independently of the opening 320.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、倖枠によっお開口郚を芆う構成ずしたが、同倖枠によっお開口郚を塞ぐ構成ずしおもよい。これにより、曎なる防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献できる。   (K5) In the above embodiment, the opening 320 is covered with the outer frame 11, but the opening 320 may be closed with the outer frame 11. This can contribute to further improvement of the crime prevention function.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮のカム郚材を固定する「固定具」ずしおネゞを甚いたが、このネゞに代えお、係止ピンやリング等の係止郚材を甚いるこずも可胜である。   (K6) In the above embodiment, the screw 531 is used as a “fixing tool” for fixing the cam member 530 of the locking device 500. However, instead of the screw 531, a locking member such as a locking pin or a C ring is used. It is also possible to use it.

たた、内枠を閉じるこずにより、倖枠又はそれに付随する構成が「固定具」の取り倖し軌道䞊䜍眮する構成ずしおもよい。特に、係止ピンやリング等の係止郚材によっおカム郚材を固定する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、シリンダ錠の軞線方向ず、固定具の取り倖し方向ずを亀差させ、具䜓的には取り倖し方向が内枠の回動先端偎を向くようにするこずが容易ずなる。これにより、本倉圢䟋を奜適に実珟できる。   Alternatively, the inner frame 13 may be closed so that the outer frame 11 or the configuration accompanying the outer frame 11 is positioned on the removal track of the “fixing tool”. In particular, in a combination with a configuration in which the cam member 530 is fixed by a locking member such as a locking pin or a C-ring, the axial direction of the cylinder lock 520 intersects the removal direction of the fixing tool, and specifically, the removal is performed. It becomes easy to make the direction face the rotation tip side of the inner frame 13. Thereby, this modification can be suitably realized.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、連動杆によっおカム郚材の動䜜を前扉甚鉀郚材に䌝達する構成ずしたが、この連動杆を省略し、カム郚材によっお前扉甚鉀郚材を盎接動䜜させる構成ずしおもよい。   (K7) In the above embodiment, the operation of the cam member 530 is transmitted to the front door rod member 550 by the interlocking rod 540, but the interlocking rod 540 is omitted, and the front door rod member is omitted by the cam member 530. It is good also as a structure which operates 550 directly.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「遊技機本䜓」ずしおの内枠の斜錠装眮が「第斜錠郚材」ずしおの前扉甚第鉀郚材を有するずずもに、前扉枠が鉀受け郚材を有する構成ずしたが、䞡者を入れ替えるこずも可胜である。すなわち、斜錠装眮が鉀受け郚材を有するずずもに、前扉枠が鉀郚材を有する構成ずするこずも可胜である。この堎合、鉀郚材が抌し蟌たれるこずで、鉀受け郚材が斜錠解陀状態から斜錠状態に切り替わる構成ずすればよい。   (L1) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 of the inner frame 13 as the “gaming machine body” has the front door second flange member 580 as the “second locking member”, and the front door frame 14 is Although the receiving member 63 is provided, both can be replaced. That is, the locking device 500 may have a hook receiving member, and the front door frame 14 may have a hook member. In this case, what is necessary is just to set it as the structure which a heel receiving member switches from a lock release state to a locked state by pushing in a heel member.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「第斜錠郚材」ずしおの前扉甚第鉀郚材が「第斜錠郚材」ずしおの前扉甚第鉀郚材の斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えず連動しお斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられる構成ずしたが、䞡鉀郚材を連動させる必芁はない。䟋えば、前扉甚第鉀郚材に察応するシリンダ錠を別途蚭け、解錠操䜜を個別に行う構成ずするこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、前扉枠の開攟䜜業が煩雑なものずなり、メンテナンス性の悪化を招来し埗る。故に、望たしくは、前扉甚第鉀郚材ず前扉甚第鉀郚材ずを連動させ、の解錠操䜜によっお、それら䞡鉀郚材が斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられる構成ずするずよい。   (L2) In the above embodiment, the front door second collar member 580 as the “second locking member” is switched to the unlocked state of the front door first collar member 550 as the “first locking member”. Although it is configured to be interlocked and switched to the unlocked state, it is not necessary to interlock the both flange members 550 and 580. For example, a cylinder lock 520 corresponding to the front door second rod member 580 may be separately provided, and the unlocking operation may be performed individually. However, in this case, the opening operation of the front door frame 14 becomes complicated, which may lead to deterioration in maintainability. Therefore, preferably, the first door member 550 for the front door and the second door member 580 for the front door are interlocked, and the two member members 550 and 580 are switched to the unlocked state by one unlocking operation. Good.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚第鉀郚材を「扉䜓」ずしおの前扉枠の回動先端偎に配眮したが、同前扉甚第鉀郚材を前扉枠の回動基端偎に配眮するこずも可胜である。   (L3) In the above embodiment, the front door second collar member 580 is arranged on the rotating front end side of the front door frame 14 as a “door body”, but the front door second collar member 580 is disposed on the front door. It is also possible to arrange the frame 14 on the rotation base end side.

たた、前扉甚第鉀郚材を「遊技甚操䜜郚」を構成するハンドルベヌス寄りに配眮したが、同前扉甚第鉀郚材を前扉枠の回動䞭心軞線寄りに配眮するこずも可胜である。   Further, the front door second rod member 580 is disposed near the handle base 41 constituting the “gaming operation unit”, but the front door second rod member 580 is disposed near the rotation center axis of the front door frame 14. It is also possible to arrange.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚第鉀郚材の斜錠䜍眮が前扉枠の回動先端偎ハンドルベヌス偎、斜錠解陀䜍眮が前扉枠の回動基端偎ずなるように構成したが、これら斜錠䜍眮ず、斜錠解陀䜍眮ずを逆にしおもよい。䜆し、ハンドルベヌスずの境界郚䜍付近での前扉枠の浮き䞊がりを抑えるには、斜錠䜍眮をハンドルベヌス寄りに蚭定するこずが望たしい。   (L4) In the above embodiment, the locking position of the front door second flange member 580 is the rotation distal end side (the handle base 41 side) of the front door frame 14, and the locking release position is the rotation proximal end of the front door frame 14. However, the lock position and the lock release position may be reversed. However, it is desirable to set the locking position closer to the handle base 41 in order to prevent the front door frame 14 from rising near the boundary with the handle base 41.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮詳しくは第基枠や前扉甚第鉀郚材を内枠の正面偎に配眮したが、これを倉曎し、内枠の背面偎に配眮するこずも可胜である。なお、斜錠装眮を内枠に蚭眮したが、前扉枠に蚭眮するこずも可胜である。   (L5) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 (specifically, the second base frame 570 and the second hook member 580 for the front door) is disposed on the front side of the inner frame 13. It is also possible to arrange on the back side of the. Although the locking device 500 is installed on the inner frame 13, it can also be installed on the front door frame 14.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚第鉀郚材においおは連動杆ずは独立した斜錠解陀䜍眮ぞの移動を蚱容する構成ずした。これを倉曎し、斜錠解陀䜍眮ぞの移動が必ず連動杆の動きに远埓する構成ずするこずも可胜である。   (L6) In the above embodiment, the front door second rod member 580 is configured to allow movement to the lock release position independent of the interlocking rod 540. It is also possible to change this so that the movement to the unlocking position always follows the movement of the interlocking rod 540.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠の鉀受け孔郚及び膚出郚を、前者が埌者よりもハンドルベヌスに近くなるように配眮したが、埌者が前者よりも同ハンドルベヌスに近くなるように配眮するこずも可胜である。   (L7) In the above embodiment, the collar receiving hole 64 and the bulging portion 66 of the front door frame 14 are arranged so that the former is closer to the handle base 41 than the latter, but the latter is the same handle as the former. It is also possible to arrange it close to the base 41.

たた、膚出郚を省略するこずも可胜である。   Further, the bulging portion 66 can be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、パチンコ機の正面芖においおハンドルベヌスを斜錠装眮ず重なる䜍眮に配眮したが、重ならない䜍眮に配眮するこずも可胜である。   (L8) In the above-described embodiment, the handle base 41 is disposed at a position overlapping the locking device 500 in the front view of the pachinko machine 10, but may be disposed at a position not overlapping.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ハンドルベヌスず前扉枠ずの境界がハンドルベヌスの呚瞁の䞀郚ずなるようにそれらハンドルベヌスず前扉枠ずを䜵存させたが、ハンドルベヌスの党呚に亘っお䞡者の境界が圢成されるようにハンドルベヌスず前扉枠ずを䜵存させるこずも可胜である。   (L9) In the above embodiment, the handle base 41 and the front door frame 14 coexist so that the boundary between the handle base 41 and the front door frame 14 becomes a part of the periphery of the handle base 41. The handle base 41 and the front door frame 14 can coexist so that the boundary between them is formed over the entire circumference of the base 41.

内枠によっおハンドルベヌスを開閉可胜に保持しおもよい。䟋えば、内枠においお前扉枠の回動先端偎ずなる端郚におハンドルベヌスを回動可胜に軞支するずよい。   (L10) The handle base 41 may be held by the inner frame 13 so that it can be opened and closed. For example, the handle base 41 may be pivotally supported at the end of the inner frame 13 on the front end side of the front door frame 14 so as to be rotatable.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚第鉀郚材を぀有する構成ずしたが、前扉甚第鉀郚材を耇数有する構成ずしおもよい。この堎合、第基枠の長手方向にそれら前扉甚第鉀郚材を䞊べお配眮するずずもに、連動杆ず同様の構成を远加するこずにより各前扉甚第鉀郚材を連動させるずよい。   (L12) In the above-described embodiment, the front door second flange member 580 is provided. However, a configuration having a plurality of front door second flange members 580 may be employed. In this case, the front door second collar members 580 are arranged side by side in the longitudinal direction of the second base frame 570, and each front door second collar member 580 is interlocked by adding the same configuration as the interlocking collar 540. It is good to let them.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉甚第鉀郚材が巊右にスラむドするこずで、斜錠状態ず斜錠解陀状態ずが切り替えられる構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、前扉甚第鉀郚材が䞊䞋にスラむドするこずで、斜錠状態ず斜錠解陀状態ずが切り替えられる構成ずしおもよい。たた、前扉甚第鉀郚材を、内枠甚鉀郚材ず同様に、回動するこずで斜錠状態ず斜錠解陀状態ずが切り替えられる構成ずするこずも可胜である。   (L13) In the above embodiment, the front door second collar member 580 slides to the left and right to switch between the locked state and the unlocked state. It is good also as a structure by which a locking state and a lock release state are switched by sliding a collar member up and down. Also, the front door second hook member 580 can be configured to be switched between the locked state and the unlocked state by rotating in the same manner as the inner frame hook member 620.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「支持枠」ずしおの倖枠に固定された鉀受け郚材のベヌス板郚を、右枠郚の蚭眮面に窪み郚を圢成するこずにより蚭眮面よりも前方に突出させたが、この窪み郚を省略し、鉀受け郚材党䜓を前出しするこずにより同ベヌス板郚を蚭眮面から突出させおもよい。   (M1) In the above embodiment, the base plate portion 355 of the collar receiving member 350 fixed to the outer frame 11 as the “support frame” is formed on the installation surface 382 of the right frame portion 380 by forming the recess 381. The base plate portion 355 may be protruded from the installation surface 382 by omitting the recessed portion 381 and projecting the entire hook receiving member 350 forward.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「壁面郚」ずしおのベヌス板郚が、鉀受け郚材を倖枠に取り付けるための取付郚ずしおの機胜を有する構成ずしたが、これを倉曎し、ベヌス板郚が取付郚ずしおの機胜を有さない構成ずするこずも可胜である。この堎合、鉀受け郚材に別途取付郚を蚭けるずよい。   (M2) In the above embodiment, the base plate portion 355 as the “wall surface portion” has a function as an attachment portion for attaching the collar receiving member 350 to the outer frame 11, but this is changed, The base plate portion 355 may be configured not to have a function as an attachment portion. In this case, it is preferable to provide a separate mounting portion for the collar receiving member 350.

䜆し、ベヌス板郚が、倖枠ず内枠ずの境界郚䜍から䞍正具が挿入された堎合に、同䞍正具が圓たるこずでそれ以䞊の䟵入を劚げる機胜を有しおいる点に着目すれば、ベヌス板郚を倖枠に固定するこずで、ベヌス板郚の倉圢を抑え防犯機胜の向䞊が期埅できる。故に、望たしくは、ベヌス板郚を倖枠に察しお固定する構成を採甚するこずで、同ベヌス板郚が取付機胜ず防犯機胜ずを䜵せ有する構成ずするずよい。   However, the base plate portion 355 has a function of preventing further intrusion when the unauthorized tool hits when an unauthorized tool is inserted from the boundary portion BP between the outer frame 11 and the inner frame 13. If the base plate portion 355 is fixed to the outer frame 11, the deformation of the base plate portion 355 can be suppressed and the security function can be improved. Therefore, it is preferable that the base plate portion 355 has a mounting function and a crime prevention function by adopting a configuration in which the base plate portion 355 is fixed to the outer frame 11.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ベヌス板郚が鉀受け郚材の開口の䞊端よりも曎に䞊方䞔぀同開口の䞋端よりも曎に䞋方に延びる構成ずしたが、これに限定されるものではない。ベヌス板郚は、少なくずも鉀受け郚材の匕っ掛かり郚分すなわち開口の䞊端瞁を境界郚䜍偎から芆っおいればよく、その瞊幅は任意である。䜆し、同ベヌス板郚の迂回や開口内ぞの䟵入を難しくし、防犯機胜を充実させる点に着目すれば、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺すように、ベヌス板郚を少なくずも開口よりも䞊方及び䞋方に延びる構成ずするこずが奜たしい。   (M3) In the above embodiment, the base plate portion 355 is configured to extend further upward than the upper end of the opening 353 of the flange receiving member 350 and further downward than the lower end of the opening 353. However, the present invention is not limited thereto. is not. The base plate portion 355 only needs to cover at least the hooked portion of the flange receiving member 350 (that is, the upper end edge of the opening 353) from the boundary portion BP side, and the vertical width is arbitrary. However, if it pays attention to the point which makes the detour of the base plate part 355 and the intrusion into the opening 353 and enhances the crime prevention function, the base plate part 355 is at least more than the opening 353 as shown in the above embodiment. It is preferable to have a configuration that extends upward and downward.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、ベヌス板郚を、内枠の第内偎段差郚の壁面郚よりも同内枠の回動基端偎ずなるように配眮したが、これを以䞋のように倉曎しおもよい。すなわち、ベヌス板郚及び壁面郚の巊右䜍眮を同䞀ずしおもよいし、ベヌス板郚が壁面郚よりも内枠の回動先端偎ずなるように配眮しおもよい。䜆し、このような倉曎を行った堎合には、仮に䞍正具が壁面郚に沿っお埌方に移動するず、ベヌス板郚が迂回されやすくなるず懞念されるため、防犯機胜向䞊の芳点から芋れば、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺した配眮が奜たしい。   (M4) In the above embodiment, the base plate portion 355 is disposed so as to be closer to the rotation base end side of the inner frame 13 than the wall surface portion 312b of the second inner stepped portion 312 of the inner frame 13. May be changed as follows. That is, the left and right positions of the base plate portion 355 and the wall surface portion 312b may be the same, or the base plate portion 355 may be disposed on the rotating front end side of the inner frame 13 relative to the wall surface portion 312b. However, if such a change is made, there is a concern that if the unauthorized tool moves rearward along the wall surface portion 312b, the base plate portion 355 is likely to be bypassed. From the viewpoint of improving the crime prevention function, The arrangement shown in the above embodiment is preferable.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、倖枠右枠郚の蚭眮面における前端瞁が倖枠ず内枠ずの境界郚䜍よりも埌方に䜍眮する構成ずしたが、蚭眮面の前端瞁が境界郚䜍よりも前方に䜍眮する構成ずしおもよい。䜆し、この堎合、仮に䞍正具の前方に移動し、ベヌス板郚の突出方向ず䞀臎した堎合、同ベヌス板郚の迂回が容易なものずなり埗る。これは、ベヌス板郚の防犯機胜を䜎䞋させる芁因ずなり埗る。故に、望たしくは、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺したように、蚭眮面の前端瞁が境界郚䜍よりも埌方ずなる構成を採甚するずよい。   (M5) In the above embodiment, the front edge of the installation surface 382 of the outer frame 11 (right frame part 380) is positioned behind the boundary part BP between the outer frame 11 and the inner frame 13, but the installation It is good also as a structure where the front-end edge of the surface 382 is located ahead of the boundary part BP. However, in this case, if it moves to the front of the unauthorized tool and coincides with the protruding direction of the base plate portion 355, detouring of the base plate portion 355 can be facilitated. This can be a factor that reduces the security function of the base plate portion 355. Therefore, desirably, as shown in the above embodiment, a configuration in which the front end edge of the installation surface 382 is behind the boundary part BP may be employed.

内枠に、埌方に突出しお倖枠の窪み郚に嵌る突起等を圢成するずよい。これにより、曎なる防犯機胜の匷化に貢献できる。   (M6) A projection or the like that protrudes rearward and fits into the recessed portion 381 of the outer frame 11 may be formed on the inner frame 13. This can contribute to further strengthening the crime prevention function.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、斜錠装眮を内枠の右偎枠郚に沿っお配眮したが、同斜錠装眮を内枠の䞊偎枠郚に沿っお配眮するこずも可胜である。この堎合、倖枠の鉀受け郚材を同倖枠の䞊枠郚に配眮するずずもに、窪み郚及び蚭眮面に盞圓する構成を同䞊枠郚に圢成するずよい。たた、斜錠装眮を内枠の䞋偎枠郚や巊偎枠郚に沿っお配眮するずずもに、それに䜵せお鉀受け郚材蚭眮面窪み郚の配眮を倖枠の䞋枠郚や巊枠郚に配するこずも可胜である。   (M7) In the above embodiment, the locking device 500 is disposed along the right frame portion 13d of the inner frame 13. However, the locking device 500 may be disposed along the upper frame portion 13a of the inner frame 13. is there. In this case, the hook receiving member 350 of the outer frame 11 may be disposed in the upper frame portion of the outer frame 11, and a configuration corresponding to the recessed portion 381 and the installation surface 382 may be formed in the upper frame portion. Further, the locking device 500 is arranged along the lower frame portion 13b and the left frame portion 13c of the inner frame 13, and the arrangement of the hook receiving member 350, the installation surface, and the recessed portion is arranged along with the lower frame portion of the outer frame 11. It can also be arranged in the left frame.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、内枠の右偎枠郚に耇数の段差郚〜を圢成するこずにより、䞍正具の䟵入を難しくするずずもに、仮に䟵入された堎合であっおもその䟵入経路が限定されやすくした。しかしながら、それら段差郚〜に぀いおは、必ずしも必芁な構成ではなく省略するこずも可胜である。䜆し、段差郚〜を省略する堎合には、倖枠の窪み郚の前方に䜍眮する第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に盞圓する構成を残すこずが望たしい。倖枠ず内枠ずの境界郚䜍から挿入された䞍正具は、内枠等の壁面に沿っお移動しやすく、その移動経路がそれら壁面によっお芏定されやすい。故に、䞊述の劂く第内偎段差郚の壁面郚に盞圓する構成を残すこずで、境界郚䜍から䟵入した䞍正具を窪み郚に誘導しやすくできる。これにより、鉀受け郚材のベヌス板郚の防犯機胜を発揮させやすくできる。   (M8) In the above embodiment, by forming the plurality of stepped portions 311 to 313 in the right side frame portion 13d of the inner frame 13, it is difficult for an unauthorized tool to enter, and even if it is temporarily intruded, The intrusion route was easily limited. However, these stepped portions 311 to 313 are not necessarily required and can be omitted. However, when the step portions 311 to 313 are omitted, it is desirable to leave a configuration corresponding to the wall surface portion 312b of the second inner step portion 312 located in front of the recess portion 381 of the outer frame 11. The unauthorized tool inserted from the boundary part BP between the outer frame 11 and the inner frame 13 easily moves along the wall surface of the inner frame 13 and the like, and the movement path is easily defined by these wall surfaces. Therefore, by leaving the configuration corresponding to the wall surface portion 312 b of the second inner stepped portion 312 as described above, it is possible to easily guide the unauthorized tool that has entered from the boundary portion BP to the recessed portion 381. Thereby, the crime prevention function of the base plate portion 355 of the collar receiving member 350 can be easily exhibited.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、鉀受け郚材を固定する固定手段ずしお、砎断ネゞを甚いたが、これら砎断ネゞを通垞のネゞ、釘及び係止ピン等で眮き換えるこずも可胜である。このように固定手段を倉曎する堎合であっおも、それら固定手段の取り付け䜍眮は、倖枠ず内枠によっお囲たれる又は芆われる領域内であるこずが望たしい。   (M9) In the above embodiment, the breaking screws are used as the fixing means for fixing the collar receiving member 350. However, these breaking screws can be replaced with ordinary screws, nails, locking pins, and the like. Even when the fixing means are changed in this way, it is desirable that the fixing position of the fixing means is within a region surrounded or covered by the outer frame 11 and the inner frame 13.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、鉀受け郚材の鉀受け郚においお各板郚の境界郚䜍に間隙を圢成したが、これら間隙を省略するこずも可胜である。   (M10) In the above embodiment, the gap 354 is formed at the boundary portion of each plate portion in the collar receiving portion 351 of the collar receiving member 350, but these gaps may be omitted.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、鋌板を折り曲げるこずで鉀受け郚材を圢成したが、同鉀受け郚材の材質は鋌板に限定されるものではなく、他の金属板を甚いおもよいし、合成暹脂を甚いおもよい。なお、合成暹脂材料を䜿甚する堎合には、鉀受け郚材の内郚が芖認困難又は䞍可ずなるように有色䞍透明のものを甚いるずよい。   (M11) In the above embodiment, the saddle receiving member 350 is formed by bending a steel plate. However, the material of the saddle receiving member 350 is not limited to a steel plate, and other metal plates may be used. A synthetic resin may be used. In addition, when using a synthetic resin material, it is good to use a colored opaque thing so that the inside of a collar receiving member may become difficult or impossible to visually recognize.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の䞊偎切欠き郚によっお「開攟郚」を構成したが、「開攟郚」を遊技盀の厚さ方向に貫通する貫通孔によっお構成するこずも可胜である。䜆し、貫通孔を採甚した堎合には、ハヌネスを挿通させる際の䜜業が煩雑なものずなり埗る。故に、望たしくは切欠きを採甚するずよい。   (N1) In the above embodiment, the “opening portion” is configured by the upper notch portion 89 of the game board 80, but the “opening portion” may be configured by a through-hole penetrating in the thickness direction of the game board 80. Is possible. However, when the through-hole is employed, the work for inserting the harness H can be complicated. Therefore, it is desirable to use a notch.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䞊偎切欠き郚を䞊偎及び回動䞭心偎に開攟したが、これを倉曎し、䞊偎切欠き郚が䞊偎及び回動䞭心偎のいずれか䞀方に開攟させおもよい。   (N2) In the above embodiment, the upper notch 89 is opened to the upper side and the rotation center side, but this is changed so that the upper notch is opened to either the upper side or the rotation center side. Also good.

たた、䞊偎切欠き郚は必ずしも䞊隅に圢成する必芁はなく、遊技盀の䞊端及び䞋端の䞭間䜍眮に配眮するこずも可胜である。   Further, the upper notch portion 89 is not necessarily formed at the upper corner, and can be disposed at an intermediate position between the upper end and the lower end of the game board 80.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、䞊偎切欠き郚にハヌネスを支持するハヌネス支持郚を蚭け、遊技盀の着脱䜜業䞭及び遊技盀を装着した埌は同ハヌネス支持郚によっおハヌネスを支持する構成ずしたが、ハヌネス偎コネクタず制埡装眮偎コネクタずを接続したり、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮したりするこずで、ハヌネスがハヌネス支持郚から離間する構成ずしおもよい。぀たり、ハヌネス支持郚によっお垞時ハヌネスを支持する必芁はない。   (N3) In the above embodiment, the upper notch portion 89 is provided with the harness support portion 89a for supporting the harness H, and the harness support portion 89a is used to attach and remove the harness while the game board 80 is attached and detached. Although it was set as the structure which supports H, the harness H separates from the harness support part 89a by connecting the harness side connector C1 and the control apparatus side connector C2, or arrange | positioning the game board 80 in the completion position of mounting | wearing. It is good also as a structure. That is, it is not necessary to always support the harness H by the harness support portion 89a.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、「開口郚」ずしおの䞭倮開口を蚭けたが、䞭倮開口ずは別にハヌネス甚の開口を蚭けおもよい。   (N4) In the embodiment described above, the central opening 76 as the “opening” is provided. However, a harness opening may be provided separately from the central opening 76.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、音声ランプ制埡装眮詳しくは制埡装眮偎コネクタよりも䞊䜍ずなる䜍眮に䞊偎切欠き郚を蚭け、その䞊偎切欠き郚よりも曎に䞊䜍ずなる䜍眮にハヌネス甚開口郚を蚭けたが、これら、各皮構成の䜍眮関係はこれに限定されるものではない。䟋えば、ハヌネス甚開口郚を䞊偎切欠き郚よりも䞋䜍ずなる䜍眮に蚭けおもよい。   (N5) In the above embodiment, the upper notch portion 89 is provided at a position higher than the sound lamp control device 143 (specifically, the control device side connector C2), and is further higher than the upper notch portion 89. Although the harness opening 36 is provided at the position, the positional relationship between these various components 36, 89, 143 is not limited to this. For example, the harness opening 36 may be provided at a position lower than the upper notch 89.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀の回動䞭心軞線ず前扉枠の回動䞭心軞線ずをずらすこずにより、遊技盀の装着完了䜍眮ぞの移動に䌎っお、ハヌネスの匛みが枛少する構成ずしたが、それら䞡䞭心軞線を䞀臎させるこずも可胜である。この倉圢䟋を採甚するこずで、ハヌネスの䜙裕代を曎に小さくするこずができる。故に、䜵せおハヌネスの党長を、䞊偎切欠き郚を経由するこずなく各コネクタの接続が䞍可ずなるように蚭定するずよい。これにより、䜜業ばら぀きによっおハヌネスが内枠前扉枠及び遊技盀の䞉者間にお挟たるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   (N6) In the above embodiment, by shifting the rotation center axis of the game board 80 and the rotation center axis of the front door frame 14, as the game board 80 moves to the mounting completion position, the harness H Although the slack is reduced, it is possible to make both the central axes coincide with each other. By adopting this modification, the margin of the harness H can be further reduced. Therefore, the total length of the harness H may be set so that the connectors C1 and C2 cannot be connected without going through the upper notch 89. Thereby, it is possible to reduce the inconvenience that the harness H is caught between the inner frame 13, the front door frame 14, and the game board 80 due to work variations.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠のハヌネス甚開口郚ず音声ランプ制埡装眮の制埡装眮偎コネクタず遊技盀の䞊端郚ずの䞉者を結んだ最短経路䞊に䞊偎切欠き郚を圢成したが、䞊偎切欠き郚をこの最短経路から倖れた䜍眮に圢成するこずも可胜である。䜆し、この堎合、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に向けお回動させるこずでハヌネスの匛みが枛少し、同ハヌネスが䞊偎切欠き郚偎に移動するずいった䜍眮合わせ機胜を享受するこずが難しくなるず想定される。   (N7) In the above embodiment, on the shortest path connecting the harness opening 36 of the front door frame 14, the control device-side connector C 2 of the sound lamp control device 143, and the upper end of the game board 80, Although the cutout portion 89 is formed, the upper cutout portion 89 can be formed at a position off the shortest path. However, in this case, by rotating the game board 80 toward the mounting completion position, the looseness of the harness H can be reduced, and the harness H can be moved to the upper notch 89 side to enjoy the alignment function. It will be difficult.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、遊技盀を回動させるこずにより装着完了䜍眮に配眮する構成ずしたが、同遊技盀をスラむドさせるこずで装着完了䜍眮に配眮する構成ずしおもよい。   (N8) In the above-described embodiment, the game board 80 is rotated and arranged at the installation completion position. However, the game board 80 may be arranged at the installation completion position by sliding.

たた、遊技盀の回動䞭心を前扉枠の回動基端偎ず同䞀偎に蚭定したが、遊技盀の回動䞭心を前扉枠の回動基端偎ずは反察偎に蚭定するこずも可胜である。   Further, the rotation center of the game board 80 is set on the same side as the rotation base end side of the front door frame 14, but the rotation center of the game board 80 is opposite to the rotation base end side of the front door frame 14. It is also possible to set to.

なお、前扉枠に぀いおは、内枠によっお回動可胜に支持される構成ずしたが、同内枠によっおスラむド移動可胜に支持される構成ずするこずも可胜である。   Note that the front door frame 14 is configured to be rotatably supported by the inner frame 13, but may be configured to be slidably supported by the inner frame 13.

䜆し、䞊蚘぀の倉圢䟋を採甚した堎合には、䞊蚘実斜の圢態に瀺した構成ず比范しおハヌネスの䜙裕代を増加させる必芁が生じる。このため、呚蟺郚品ずの干枉等による断線等の䞍具合を生じやすくなるず想定される。故に、ハヌネスの䜙剰撓み分を逃がすためのスペヌスの確保等を行うこずが奜たしい。   However, when the three modified examples are adopted, it is necessary to increase the margin of the harness H as compared with the configuration shown in the above embodiment. For this reason, it is assumed that problems such as disconnection due to interference with peripheral components are likely to occur. Therefore, it is preferable to secure a space for escaping the excessive deflection of the harness H.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠のハヌネス甚開口郚を同前扉枠の回動基端偎の端郚に寄せお蚭けたが、同ハヌネス甚開口郚の配眮は任意である。䟋えば、ハヌネス甚開口郚を同前扉枠の回動先端偎に蚭けるこずも可胜である。この堎合、ハヌネスを前扉枠の背面に沿っお回動基端偎に案内し、回動基端偎の端郚に寄った䜍眮で保持するクランプ等を蚭けるこずが奜たしい。   (N9) In the above embodiment, the harness opening 36 of the front door frame 14 is provided close to the end of the front door frame 14 on the rotation base end side. Is optional. For example, the harness opening 36 can be provided on the rotating front end side of the front door frame 14. In this case, it is preferable to provide a clamp or the like that guides the harness H along the rear surface of the front door frame 14 toward the rotation base end and holds the harness H at a position near the end of the rotation base end.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態では、前扉枠が「挔出装眮」ずしお環状電食郚及びスピヌカ郚を有する構成ずしたが、これら䞡者の䞀方を省略するこずも可胜である。たた、前扉枠が「挔出装眮」ずしお液晶ディスプレむ等の衚瀺装眮を有する構成ずしおもよい。   (N10) In the above-described embodiment, the front door frame 14 has the annular electric decoration part 23 and the speaker part 26 as the “production device”, but one of these can be omitted. The front door frame 14 may have a display device such as a liquid crystal display as the “production device”.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態ずは異なる他のタむプのパチンコ機等、䟋えば特別装眮の特定領域に遊技球が入るず電動圹物が所定回数開攟するパチンコ機や、特別装眮の特定領域に遊技球が入るず暩利が発生しお倧圓たりずなるパチンコ機、他の圹物を備えたパチンコ機、アレンゞボヌル機、雀球等の遊技機にも、本発明を適甚できる。   (O1) Other types of pachinko machines different from the above embodiment, for example, a pachinko machine in which an electric accessory is released a predetermined number of times when a game ball enters a specific area of a special device, or a game ball in a specific area of a special device The present invention can also be applied to a pachinko machine that generates a right if a player enters, a pachinko machine equipped with other objects, an arrangement ball machine, a sparrow ball, and other gaming machines.

たた、匟球匏でない遊技機、䟋えば、耇数皮の図柄が呚方向に付された耇数のリヌルを備え、メダルの投入及びスタヌトレバヌの操䜜によりリヌルの回転を開始し、ストップスむッチが操䜜されるか所定時間が経過するこずでリヌルが停止した埌に、衚瀺窓から芖認できる有効ラむン䞊に特定図柄又は特定図柄の組み合わせが成立しおいた堎合にはメダルの払い出し等ずいった特兞を遊技者に付䞎するスロットマシンにも本発明を適甚できる。   Also, a non-ball-type gaming machine, for example, a plurality of reels with a plurality of types of symbols attached in the circumferential direction, starts rotation of the reel by inserting a medal and operating a start lever, and a stop switch is operated. If a specific symbol or a combination of specific symbols is established on the effective line visible from the display window after the reel has stopped after a predetermined time has passed, a privilege such as paying out medals is given to the player The present invention can also be applied to a slot machine.

曎に、倖枠に開閉可胜に支持された遊技機本䜓に貯留郚及び取蟌装眮を備え、貯留郚に貯留されおいる所定数の遊技球が取蟌装眮により取り蟌たれた埌にスタヌトレバヌが操䜜されるこずによりリヌルの回転を開始する、パチンコ機ずスロットマシンずが融合された遊技機にも本発明を適甚できる。   Further, the gaming machine main body supported by the outer frame so as to be openable and closable is provided with a storage unit and a capture device, and the start lever is operated after a predetermined number of game balls stored in the storage unit are captured by the capture device. Thus, the present invention can also be applied to a gaming machine in which a pachinko machine and a slot machine are fused to start the rotation of the reel.

䞊蚘実斜の圢態から抜出される発明矀に぀いお
以䞋、䞊述した実斜の圢態から抜出される発明矀の特城に぀いお、必芁に応じお効果等を瀺し぀぀説明する。なお以䞋においおは、理解の容易のため、䞊蚘実斜の圢態においお察応する構成を括匧曞き等で適宜瀺すが、この括匧曞き等で瀺した具䜓的構成に限定されるものではない。
<Invention Group Extracted from the Embodiments>
Hereinafter, the features of the invention group extracted from the above-described embodiment will be described while showing effects and the like as necessary. In the following, for ease of understanding, the corresponding configuration in the above embodiment is appropriately shown in parentheses, but is not limited to the specific configuration shown in parentheses.

特城矀
特城遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を着脱可胜に支持する支持枠内枠ず
を備え、
前蚘支持枠に察しお前蚘遊技盀が遊技機前方から取り付けられおいる遊技機においお、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する耇数の圓接郚ストッパず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から抌すこずにより同遊技盀を遊技機前方に向けお付勢する付勢手段板バネず
を備え、
前蚘耇数の圓接郚は、前蚘付勢手段の付勢力によるの圓接郚を支点ずした前蚘遊技盀の回動を他の圓接郚によっお抑えるこずができる䜍眮にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature A group>
Feature A1. A game board (game board 80) in which a game area (game area PE) is formed;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for detachably supporting the game board;
In the gaming machine in which the gaming board is attached to the support frame from the front of the gaming machine,
A plurality of contact portions (stoppers 267) provided on the support frame and contacting the front surface of the game board;
Biasing means (plate spring 270) provided on the support frame and biasing the gaming board toward the front of the gaming machine by pushing the gaming board from the back side of the gaming board;
The plurality of abutting portions are respectively arranged at positions where rotation of the game board with one abutting portion by a biasing force of the biasing means as a fulcrum can be suppressed by another abutting portion. A gaming machine characterized by

特城によれば、遊技盀を支持枠の前方すなわち支持枠の正面偎から取り付け可胜ずするこずにより、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀の取り付けを行う堎合ず比范しお、䜜業の容易化を促進できる。このように遊技盀を支持枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀の取り付けを行う構成ず比范しお、遊技盀の前面の䜍眮粟床䟋えば前埌方向の䜍眮粟床を向䞊させるこずが難しくなるず想定されるが、本特城においおは、圓接郚及び付勢手段によっお遊技盀の前面を察象ずしお䜍眮決めを行うこずにより、同前面の䜍眮粟床を高めやすくしおいる。   According to the feature A1, the game board can be attached from the front of the support frame (that is, from the front side of the support frame), thereby making it easier to work compared to the case where the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame. Can be promoted. Thus, in the configuration in which the game board is attached from the front side of the support frame, the positional accuracy of the front side of the game board (for example, the positional accuracy in the front-rear direction) compared to the configuration in which the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame. However, in this feature, the position accuracy of the front surface of the game board is easily improved by positioning the front surface of the game board with the contact portion and the biasing means.

付勢手段によっお遊技盀を付勢する構成においおは、䟋えば遊技盀においお付勢手段によっお抌される䜍眮ず、圓接郚によっお止められる䜍眮ずをずらすこずにより、付勢手段の付勢力の及ぶ範囲を拡げやすくし、構成の煩雑化を抑え぀぀同遊技盀の䜍眮決め機胜を向䞊するこずができる。しかしながら、単にこのような構成を適甚した堎合には、遊技盀が圓接郚を支点ずしお回動しやすくなるず想定される。曎には、仮に遊技盀の回動が阻止されおいる堎合であっおも、同遊技盀に察しお回転モヌメントが䜜甚しやすい状態ずなり埗る。これらは、䜍眮決め時の安定性を䜎䞋させ、同遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を劚げる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。そこで、本特城においおは、耇数の圓接郚を、付勢手段の付勢力によるの圓接郚を支点ずした遊技盀の回動を他の圓接郚によっお抑えるこずができる䜍眮に配眮するこずで、䞊述した䞍郜合を払拭するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。これにより、遊技盀の取り付けを容易化し぀぀、同遊技盀の䜍眮粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   In the configuration in which the game board is urged by the urging means, for example, the range covered by the urging force of the urging means is shifted by shifting the position pressed by the urging means on the game board from the position stopped by the contact portion. The positioning function of the game board can be improved while facilitating expansion and suppressing complication of the configuration. However, when such a configuration is simply applied, it is assumed that the game board easily turns around the contact portion. Furthermore, even if the game board is prevented from rotating, a rotational moment can easily be applied to the game board. These are not preferable because they can reduce stability during positioning and hinder improvement in positioning accuracy of the game board. Therefore, in this feature, the plurality of abutting portions are arranged at positions where rotation of the game board with the one abutting portion by the urging force of the urging means as a fulcrum can be suppressed by other abutting portions. This makes it possible to eliminate the above-mentioned disadvantages. Thereby, it is possible to contribute to improvement of the positional accuracy of the game board while facilitating the mounting of the game board.

たた、圓接郚を耇数蚭けるこずで、䟋えば䞊述した耇数の圓接郚を包括するような倧型の圓接郚を蚭ける堎合ず比范しお、圓接郚の成圢の容易化及び同圓接郚による䜍眮決め粟床の確保の容易化に貢献できる。   In addition, by providing a plurality of contact portions, for example, compared to the case of providing a large contact portion including a plurality of contact portions described above, it is easier to form the contact portion and the contact portion. Can contribute to the ease of ensuring positioning accuracy.

特城前蚘耇数の圓接郚は特定方向に䞊べお配眮されおおり、
前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘特定方向においお、前蚘圓接郚矀の䞡端に配眮された぀よりも内偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A2. The plurality of contact portions are arranged in a specific direction,
The gaming machine according to A1, wherein the urging means is disposed at a position on the inner side of the two disposed at both ends of the contact portion group in the specific direction.

特城に瀺すように圓接郚矀の配眮方向特定方向においお䞡端に配眮された぀よりも内偎ずなる䜍眮に付勢手段を配眮する構成ずすれば、遊技盀の回動を奜適に抑制するこずができ、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   As shown in the feature A2, if the urging means is arranged at a position inside the two arranged at both ends in the arrangement direction (specific direction) of the contact portion group, the game board is preferably rotated. And can contribute to the improvement of positioning accuracy.

特城前蚘付勢手段を耇数有し、
前蚘圓接郚は、遊技機の正面芖においおそれら個々の付勢手段の䞡偎にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A3. A plurality of biasing means;
The gaming machine according to A1 or A2, wherein the abutting portions are arranged on both sides of the respective urging means in a front view of the gaming machine.

特城によれば、付勢手段を耇数蚭け、遊技盀を抌す䜍眮を増やすこずにより、䜍眮決めをしやすくできる反面、各付勢手段ず圓接郚ずの䜍眮関係によっおは、特定の圓接郚に加わる負荷が極端に倧きくなるこずが懞念される。これは圓接郚の倉圢等を促進させ遊技盀の各所における䜍眮決めの粟床にばら぀きが生じる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城においおは、遊技機の正面芖においおそれら付勢手段の䞡偎に圓接郚を各々配眮するこずにより、䞊蚘デメリットを抑え぀぀䞊蚘メリットを奜適に享受できる。これにより、遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床の曎なる向䞊に貢献しおいる。   According to the feature A3, by providing a plurality of urging means and increasing the position where the game board is pushed, positioning can be facilitated. However, depending on the positional relationship between each urging means and the abutting part, a specific abutting part There is a concern that the load applied to the battery becomes extremely large. This is not preferable because it can cause deformation of the abutting portion and the like, which can cause variations in positioning accuracy at various locations on the game board. In this regard, in this feature, by arranging the contact portions on both sides of the urging means in a front view of the gaming machine, the above advantages can be suitably enjoyed while suppressing the above demerits. This contributes to further improvement in the positioning accuracy of the game board.

特城前蚘付勢手段は、同付勢手段の䞡偎にある前蚘圓接郚のほが䞭倮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature A4. The gaming machine according to A3, wherein the urging means is disposed substantially at the center of the abutting portion on both sides of the urging means.

特城によれば、付勢手段の付勢力によっお各圓接郚に加わる負荷の差を小さくするこずができる。これにより、䟋えば䞀方の圓接郚が倉圢しやすくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくし、䜍眮決め粟床の䜎䞋を抑制しやすくできる。   According to the feature A4, the difference in load applied to each contact portion by the urging force of the urging means can be reduced. Thereby, for example, it is difficult to cause a problem that one of the contact portions is easily deformed, and it is possible to easily suppress a decrease in positioning accuracy.

なお、本特城に瀺す構成を「前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀においお圓該付勢手段によっお抌されおいる郚䜍から圓該付勢手段の䞡偎にある前蚘圓接郚のうち䞀方の圓接郚及び前蚘遊技盀が圓たっおいる郚䜍たでの距離ず、前蚘遊技盀においお圓該付勢手段によっお抌されおいる郚䜍から圓該付勢手段の䞡偎にある前蚘圓接郚のうち他方の圓接郚及び前蚘遊技盀が圓たっおいる郚䜍たでの距離ずがほが同等ずなる䜍眮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機」ず眮き換えるこずも可胜である。   Note that the configuration shown in this feature is “the urging means is one of the abutting portions on both sides of the urging means from a portion pressed by the urging means on the game board, and The distance to the part where the game board is hit and the other contact part of the contact parts on both sides of the biasing means from the part pressed by the biasing means on the game board and the game It is also possible to replace it with a “gaming machine according to A3, which is arranged at a position where the distance to the part where the board is hit is substantially equal.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに前蚘遊技盀よりも䞋偎に配眮され、遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘遊技球発射装眮は、遊技球の発射方向を芏定する発射レヌル発射レヌルを有し、
前蚘遊技盀の前面に取り付けられ、前蚘発射レヌルから発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に導く誘導レヌル誘導レヌルず、
前蚘支持枠の前面に蚭けられ、前蚘発射レヌルが蚭眮される蚭眮面発射機構蚭眮郚ず
を備え、
前蚘圓接郚ず前蚘蚭眮面ずが䞀䜓成圢されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A5. A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) that is provided on the support frame and disposed below the game board and launches a game ball,
The game ball launching device has a launch rail that defines the launch direction of the game ball (the launch rail 112),
A guide rail (guide rail 100) that is attached to the front surface of the game board and guides a game ball launched from the launch rail to the game area;
An installation surface provided on the front surface of the support frame, on which the firing rail is installed (launching mechanism installation unit 79),
The gaming machine according to any one of A1 to A4, wherein the contact portion and the installation surface are integrally formed.

特城等に瀺したように遊技盀の前面にお䜍眮決めを行う構成においおは、その䜍眮決め粟床が圓接郚、詳しくは圓接郚においお遊技盀が圓接する面以䞋䟿宜䞊、圓接面ず称するの䜍眮によっお巊右されるこずずなる。仮に、圓接面ず蚭眮面ずの䜍眮がばら぀くず、発射レヌル及び遊技盀の前面詳しくは誘導レヌルの前埌䜍眮がばら぀きやすくなる。これにより、誘導レヌルにおける遊技球の着地䜍眮がばら぀くず想定される。これは遊技球の円滑な誘導を劚げる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城に瀺すように、圓接郚及び蚭眮面を䞀䜓成圢するこずにより、圓接郚ず蚭眮面ずの䜍眮ばら぀きを抑えるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、䞊蚘䞍郜合を生じにくくし、遊技球の誘導を円滑なものずするこずができる。   In the configuration in which the positioning is performed on the front surface of the game board as shown in the feature A1 and the like, the positioning accuracy is the contact portion, more specifically, the surface on which the game board contacts the contact portion (hereinafter referred to as the contact surface for convenience). ) Will be affected by the position. If the positions of the contact surface and the installation surface vary, the front and rear positions of the launch rail and the front surface of the game board (specifically, the guide rail) are likely to vary. Thereby, it is assumed that the landing position of the game ball on the guide rail varies. This is not preferable because it can hinder smooth guidance of the game ball. In this regard, as shown in this feature, by integrally forming the contact portion and the installation surface, it is possible to suppress variation in position between the contact portion and the installation surface. Thereby, the inconvenience described above is hardly caused, and the game ball can be guided smoothly.

特城前蚘遊技領域は略円圢状をなしおおり、
前蚘遊技盀の前面に蚭けられ、遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球を同遊技領域に導く誘導レヌル誘導レヌルを備え、
前蚘誘導レヌルは、前蚘遊技領域の倖瞁においお前蚘遊技盀の䞀蟺偎ずなる郚䜍に沿っお延びおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技盀の䞀蟺偎に凞ずなる円匧状をなしおおり、
前蚘圓接郚は、前蚘誘導レヌルにおいお前蚘䞀蟺偎に凞ずなっおいる郚分の䞊方及び䞋方にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A6. The game area has a substantially circular shape,
A guidance rail (guidance rail 100) provided on the front surface of the game board for guiding the game ball launched from the game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) to the game area;
The guide rail extends along a portion that is on one side of the game board at an outer edge of the game area, and has an arc shape that is convex on one side of the game board,
The gaming machine according to any one of A1 to A5, wherein the contact portion is arranged above and below a portion of the guide rail that is convex toward the one side.

特城によれば、誘導レヌルにおいお遊技盀の䞀蟺偎に凞ずなっおいる郚䜍の䞊䞋に圓接郚を配眮するこずで、遊技領域ず圓接郚ずを遊技盀の前面偎にお奜適に共存させるこずが可胜ずなる。   According to the feature A6, the game area and the contact portion are preferably arranged on the front side of the game board by arranging the contact portions above and below the portion of the guide rail that protrudes on one side of the game board. It becomes possible to coexist.

なお、特城ずの組み合わせにおいおは特に、本特城における「遊技球発射装眮」「誘導レヌル」を特城における「遊技球発射装眮」及び「誘導レヌル」ず同䞀のものずしおもよい。   In particular, in combination with the feature A5, the “game ball launching device” and the “guidance rail” in this feature may be the same as the “game ball launching device” and the “guide rail” in the feature A5.

特城前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は前蚘遊技盀の䞀蟺に沿っお配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature A7. The gaming machine according to any one of A1 to A6, wherein the contact portion and the urging means are arranged along one side of the game board.

特城等に瀺したように、遊技盀の前面偎に遊技領域が圢成されおいる構成においお、曎に同遊技盀の前面に察応する圓接郚を有する構成ずした堎合、それら圓接郚の配眮によっお遊技領域の拡がりが制限されるこずは奜たしくない。この点、特城に瀺すように、圓接郚及び付勢手段を遊技盀の䞀蟺に沿っお配眮し、䜍眮決めに関する構成の占有領域の拡がりを抑える構成ずすれば、䞊蚘䞍郜合を抑制し、圓接郚ず遊技領域ずを奜適に共存させるこずが可胜ずなる。   As shown in the feature A1 and the like, in a configuration in which a game area is formed on the front side of the game board, when the configuration further includes a contact part corresponding to the front side of the game board, the arrangement of the contact parts It is not preferable that the expansion of the game area is limited by the above. In this regard, as shown in feature A7, if the abutting portion and the urging means are arranged along one side of the game board to suppress the expansion of the occupied area of the configuration related to the positioning, the above disadvantages are suppressed, It is possible to allow the contact portion and the game area to coexist suitably.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお回動可胜に支持され、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠を備え、
前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀においお前蚘支持枠により支持されおいる偎ず同䞀偎の䞀蟺に沿っお配眮されおおり、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘圓接郚ず前蚘付勢手段ずの間に挿入された状態にお、その挿入された郚分を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A8. A door body (front door frame 14) that is rotatably supported by the support frame and covers the game board from the front;
The contact portion and the biasing means are arranged along one side on the same side as the side supported by the support frame in the game board,
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the inserted portion in a state of being inserted between the contact portion and the biasing means. The gaming machine according to any one of A1 to A7, which is characterized in that:

特城に瀺すように支持枠に扉䜓が蚭けられおいる堎合には、扉䜓を開攟した状態で遊技盀を遊技機前方から真っ盎ぐ抌し蟌んで取り付けるのは難しくなり埗る。特に、遊技機が遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に蚭眮されおいる堎合には、扉䜓の回動基端偎においお遊技盀を取り付ける際の䜜業スペヌスの確保や取付軌道の確保が困難になりやすいず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、遊技盀を挿入郚に挿入した埌で、支持枠に察しお回動させるこずにより取付完了䜍眮に配眮するこずができるため、䞊述した䞍郜合を奜適に払拭するこずができる。   When the door frame is provided on the support frame as shown in feature A8, it may be difficult to push the game board straight from the front of the gaming machine with the door body open. In particular, when a gaming machine is installed in an island facility in a gaming hall, it is assumed that it is difficult to secure a work space and a mounting track when installing a game board on the rotating base end side of the door body. Is done. In this regard, according to the present feature, after the game board is inserted into the insertion portion, the game board can be arranged at the attachment completion position by rotating with respect to the support frame, so that the above-described inconveniences can be suitably eliminated. Can do.

このような構成においお、仮に遊技盀を所定の取り付け䜍眮に配眮した埌、圓接郚を遊技盀に圓接する䜍眮に移動させる等の別途操䜜が必芁である堎合には、䞊述の劂く䜜業スペヌスの確保が難しい等の理由から䜜業が煩雑化するず想定される。故に、遊技盀の回動基端偎においおは、別操䜜を必芁ずしない固定匏の圓接郚を採甚するこが奜たしい。これにより、遊技盀の取り付け䜜業の曎なる容易化が期埅できる。   In such a configuration, if a separate operation such as moving the contact portion to a position where it contacts the game board after the game board is placed at a predetermined mounting position is necessary, It is assumed that the work will be complicated because it is difficult to secure. Therefore, it is preferable to employ a fixed contact portion that does not require a separate operation on the rotation base end side of the game board. Thereby, further simplification of the game board mounting operation can be expected.

特城前蚘圓接郚は、前蚘付勢手段においお前蚘遊技盀の背面に圓接する郚䜍よりも前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature A9. The gaming machine according to A8, wherein the abutting portion is arranged at a position closer to a rotation base end side of the game board than a portion of the biasing means that abuts against a back surface of the game board. .

特城に瀺したように、圓接郚ず付勢手段ずの間に遊技盀を挿入する構成においおは、仮に遊技盀の挿入角床が小さくなるず同遊技盀が支持枠に察しおひっかかりやすくなるず懞念される。この点、本特城においおは、圓接郚が付勢手段においお遊技盀の背面に圓接する郚䜍よりも遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮されおいるこずで、挿入口を遊技機前偎に向けるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、䞊蚘挿入角床を倧きくでき挿入䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。   As shown in feature A8, in the configuration in which the game board is inserted between the abutting portion and the biasing means, if the insertion angle of the game board becomes small, the game board may be easily caught on the support frame. Is done. In this point, in this feature, the contact portion is arranged on the rotation base end side of the game board with respect to the portion of the biasing means that contacts the back surface of the game board, so that the insertion port faces the front side of the gaming machine. It becomes possible. Thereby, the said insertion angle can be enlarged and it can contribute to the simplification of insertion work.

たた、遊技盀を遊技機前方に付勢する構成を採甚した堎合、その付勢力をある皋床高めに蚭定するこずにより、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を図るこずができる。しかしながら、付勢力を匷めるず遊技盀の装着䜜業が難しくなり埗る。この点、本特城によれば、圓接郚ず付勢手段の圓接郚䜍ずをずらしお配眮するこずで、付勢力を倧きくした堎合にその付勢力が遊技盀を挿入する際の抵抗ずなるこずを抑制でき、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊ず挿入䜜業の容易化ず奜適に䞡立できる。   In addition, when a configuration in which the gaming board is urged forward of the gaming machine is employed, the positioning accuracy can be improved by setting the urging force to be somewhat high. However, if the urging force is increased, it is difficult to attach the game board. In this regard, according to this feature, the biasing force becomes a resistance when the game board is inserted when the biasing force is increased by disposing the abutting portion and the abutting portion of the biasing means. This can be suppressed, and it is possible to preferably achieve both improvement in positioning accuracy and ease of insertion work.

特城前蚘圓接郚は、前蚘支持枠に固定された第圓接郚であり、
前蚘付勢手段は、第付勢手段であり、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘第圓接郚よりも前蚘遊技盀取り付け時における圓該遊技盀の回動先端偎に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する状態ず、同遊技盀の前面に圓接しない状態ずに切替え可胜な第圓接郚ロック装眮の操䜜郚ず、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘第圓接郚ず同䞀偎に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から抌すこずにより同遊技盀を遊技機前方に向けお付勢する第付勢手段ロック装眮のプッシャ及びコむルバネず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A10. The contact portion is a first contact portion fixed to the support frame,
The biasing means is a first biasing means,
The support frame is provided on the rotating tip side of the game board when the game board is mounted with respect to the first contact part, and is in contact with the front surface of the game board and does not contact the front surface of the game board. A second contact portion (the operation portion 446 of the lock device 400) that can be switched to a state;
Second urging means (provided on the same side of the support frame as the second abutment portion) and urges the game board toward the front of the gaming machine by pushing the game board from the back side of the game board. A gaming machine according to A8 or A9, comprising a pusher 420 and a coil spring 430) of the locking device 400.

特城によれば、遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊が期埅できる。䟋えば、遊技盀の回動基端偎では固定匏の第圓接郚を採甚し、遊技盀の回動先端偎では可動匏の第圓接郚を採甚するこずで、遊技盀の前方の䜜業スペヌスを有効掻甚し遊技盀の着脱䜜業を容易化できる。   According to the feature A10, improvement in the positioning accuracy of the game board can be expected. For example, by adopting a fixed first contact portion on the rotation base end side of the game board and adopting a movable second contact portion on the rotation front end side of the game board, The work space can be used effectively to facilitate the mounting and dismounting of the game board.

特城前蚘第付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀が回動される過皋にお同遊技盀を付勢可胜に圢成されおおり、
前蚘第付勢手段は、前蚘第圓接郚の前蚘圓接しない状態から前蚘圓接する状態ぞの切替えに基づいお前蚘遊技盀を付勢するように構成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature A11. The first urging means is formed so as to be able to urge the game board in the process of turning the game board,
The second urging means is configured to urge the game board based on switching from the non-contact state to the contact state of the second contact portion. The gaming machine described in 1.

特城によれば、第付勢手段によっお回動䞭の遊技盀を付勢する構成ずするこずで遊技盀を回動させる際の操䜜ばら぀きを抑制でき、䟋えば遊技盀が支持枠に匕っ掛かっお回動操䜜が劚げられるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。たた、遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮した第付勢手段は、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮した埌、第圓接郚を䞊蚘圓接する状態ぞ切り替えるこずによっお、遊技盀を付勢するこずずなる。故に、第付勢手段の付勢力を匷め䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図ったずしおも、それにより遊技盀の装着䜜業が劚げられやすくなるこずは無い。぀たり、䜜業の容易化ず䜍眮決め粟床の䞡立に貢献できる。   According to the feature A11, it is possible to suppress variation in operation when the game board is rotated by urging the rotating game board by the first urging means. For example, the game board is caught by the support frame. It is possible to make it difficult for the inconvenience that the rotation operation is hindered. Further, the second biasing means disposed on the rotation tip side of the game board biases the game board by switching the second contact portion to the above-mentioned contact state after placing the game board at the mounting completion position. Will be. Therefore, even if the urging force of the second urging means is increased to improve the position accuracy, it does not easily hinder the game board mounting operation. That is, it is possible to contribute to both ease of work and positioning accuracy.

特城矀
特城遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を支持する支持枠内枠ず
を備え、
前蚘支持枠に察しお前蚘遊技盀が遊技機前方から取付可胜な遊技機においお、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚䟋えばストッパやロック装眮の操䜜郚ず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から抌すこずにより同遊技盀を遊技機前方に向けお付勢する付勢手段䟋えば板バネやコむルバネず
を備え、
前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘支持枠においお前蚘遊技盀の䞀端偎ずなる䜍眮及び同遊技盀の他端偎ずなる䜍眮にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature B group>
Feature B1. A game board (game board 80) in which a game area (game area PE) is formed;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for supporting the game board;
In the gaming machine in which the gaming board can be attached to the support frame from the front of the gaming machine,
A contact portion (for example, a stopper 267 or an operation portion 446 of the lock device 400) provided on the support frame and contacting the front surface of the game board;
Urging means (for example, a leaf spring 270 and a coil spring 430) provided on the support frame and urging the game board toward the front of the game machine by pushing the game board from the back side of the game board;
The gaming machine according to claim 1, wherein the abutting portion and the urging means are respectively disposed at a position on one end side of the game board and a position on the other end side of the game board in the support frame.

特城によれば、遊技盀を支持枠の前方すなわち前面偎から取付可胜ずするこずにより、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀の取り付けを行う堎合ず比范しお、同遊技盀の着脱䜜業の容易化を促進できる。䜆し、このように遊技盀を支持枠前方から取り付ける構成においおは、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀を取り付ける構成ず比范しお、遊技盀前面の遊技盀取付方向前埌方向における䜍眮粟床を向䞊させるのは難しくなるず想定される。   According to the feature B1, the game board can be attached from the front (ie, the front side) of the support frame, so that the game board can be attached and detached compared to the case where the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame. Can be facilitated. However, in the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the front of the support frame in this way, the positional accuracy in the game board mounting direction (front-rear direction) on the front of the game board is improved compared to the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the back side of the support frame. It is assumed that it will be difficult.

この点、本特城においおは、付勢手段によっお遊技機前方ぞ遊技盀を抌し、同遊技盀の移動を圓接郚によっお阻止するこずにより、同遊技盀の前埌䜍眮を芏定できる。特に、これら圓接郚及び付勢手段を遊技盀の䞡端偎に配眮するこずにより、䞊蚘付勢力によっお遊技盀が傟いたり回動したりするこずを抑制しやすくしおいる。これにより、遊技盀詳しくはその前面の䜍眮粟床向䞊に貢献できる。   In this respect, in this feature, the front and back positions of the game board can be defined by pushing the game board forward of the game machine by the urging means and preventing the movement of the game board by the contact portion. In particular, by disposing these contact portions and urging means on both ends of the game board, it is easy to suppress the game board from being tilted or rotated by the urging force. This can contribute to improving the positional accuracy of the game board (specifically, the front face thereof).

なお、本特城においおは、䞀端偎の付勢手段及び圓接郚を、同付勢手段の付勢力による圓該圓接郚を䞭心ずした遊技盀の回動を阻止可胜なずなるように配眮するこずが望たしい。䟋えば、同付勢手段の前方や同付勢手段の䞡偎等に圓接郚を配眮するずよい。たた、他端偎の付勢手段及び圓接郚に぀いおも同様に、同付勢手段の付勢力による圓該圓接郚を䞭心ずした遊技盀の回動を阻止可胜ずなるように配眮するこずが望たしい。   In this feature, the urging means and the abutting portion on one end side are arranged so as to prevent rotation of the game board around the abutting portion due to the urging force of the urging means. It is desirable. For example, the abutting portion may be disposed in front of the urging means or on both sides of the urging means. Similarly, the urging means and the abutting portion on the other end side may be arranged so as to prevent rotation of the game board around the abutting portion due to the urging force of the urging means. desirable.

特城前面に遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいるずずもに、背面に前蚘遊技領域を通過した遊技球を回収する回収通路台座郚材の回収通路が蚭けられおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を支持する支持枠内枠ず
を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘支持枠に察しお遊技機前方からの取り付けが蚱容されおいるずずもに、前蚘支持枠に圢成された開口を通じお前蚘回収通路が圓該支持枠の埌方に露出した状態で配眮されおいる遊技機においお、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚䟋えばストッパやロック装眮の操䜜郚ず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から抌すこずにより同遊技盀を遊技機前方に向けお付勢する付勢手段䟋えば板バネやコむルバネず
を備え、
前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘支持枠における前蚘開口を挟んだ䞡偎にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature B2. A game board (game board 80) in which a game area (game area PE) is formed on the front side and a collection path (collection path of the base member 141) for collecting game balls that have passed through the game area is provided on the back side. )When,
A support frame (inner frame 13) for supporting the game board;
The gaming board is allowed to be attached to the support frame from the front of the gaming machine, and is arranged in a state where the collection passage is exposed to the rear of the support frame through an opening formed in the support frame. Game machines
A contact portion (for example, a stopper 267 or an operation portion 446 of the lock device 400) provided on the support frame and contacting the front surface of the game board;
Urging means (for example, a leaf spring 270 and a coil spring 430) provided on the support frame and urging the game board toward the front of the game machine by pushing the game board from the back side of the game board;
The gaming machine, wherein the contact portion and the urging means are respectively disposed on both sides of the opening in the support frame.

特城によれば、遊技盀を支持枠の前方すなわち前面偎から取付可胜ずするこずにより、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀の取り付けを行う堎合ず比范しお、同遊技盀の取付䜜業の容易化を促進できる。䜆し、このように遊技盀を支持枠前方から取り付ける構成においおは、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀を取り付ける構成ず比范しお、遊技盀前面の遊技盀取付方向前埌方向における䜍眮粟床を向䞊させるのは難しくなるず想定される。   According to the feature B2, the game board can be attached from the front (ie, front side) of the support frame, so that the game board can be attached compared to the case where the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame. Can be facilitated. However, in the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the front of the support frame in this way, the positional accuracy in the game board mounting direction (front-rear direction) on the front of the game board is improved compared to the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the back side of the support frame. It is assumed that it will be difficult.

この点、本特城においおは、付勢手段によっお遊技機前方ぞ遊技盀を抌し、同遊技盀の移動を圓接郚によっお阻止するこずにより、同遊技盀の前埌䜍眮を芏定できる。特に、これら圓接郚及び付勢手段を開口を挟んだ䞡偎にそれぞれ配眮するこずにより、䞊蚘付勢力によっお遊技盀が傟いたり回動したりするこずを抑制でき、遊技盀詳しくはその前面の䜍眮粟床向䞊に貢献できる。   In this respect, in this feature, the front and back positions of the game board can be defined by pushing the game board forward of the game machine by the urging means and preventing the movement of the game board by the contact portion. In particular, by disposing these abutting portions and urging means on both sides of the opening, it is possible to prevent the game board from being tilted or rotated by the urging force, and the game board (specifically, the front surface thereof). Can contribute to improving the position accuracy of

なお、本特城においおは、開口の䞀方偎に䜍眮する付勢手段及び圓接郚を、同付勢手段の付勢力による圓該圓接郚を䞭心ずした遊技盀の回動を阻止可胜なずなるように配眮するこずが望たしい。䟋えば、同付勢手段の前方や同付勢手段の䞡偎等に圓接郚を配眮するずよい。たた、開口を挟んだ反察偎に䜍眮する付勢手段及び圓接郚に぀いおも同様に、同付勢手段の付勢力による圓該圓接郚を䞭心ずした遊技盀の回動を阻止可胜なずなるように配眮するこずが望たしい。   In this feature, the biasing means and the contact portion located on one side of the opening can be prevented from rotating the game board around the contact portion by the biasing force of the biasing means. It is desirable to arrange so that. For example, the abutting portion may be disposed in front of the urging means or on both sides of the urging means. Similarly, with respect to the biasing means and the abutting portion located on the opposite side across the opening, it is possible to prevent rotation of the game board around the abutting portion due to the biasing force of the biasing means. It is desirable to arrange so that.

特城前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀の呚瞁に沿っお配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature B3. The gaming machine according to B1 or B2, wherein the abutting portion and the biasing means are arranged along a peripheral edge of the game board.

特城に瀺すように圓接郚及び付勢手段を遊技盀の呚瞁に沿っお配眮するこずにより、広範囲にお遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を高めるこずが可胜ずなる。   By disposing the abutting portion and the biasing means along the periphery of the game board as shown in the feature B3, it is possible to improve the position accuracy of the game board in a wide range.

特に特城に瀺したように遊技盀の前面偎に遊技領域背面偎に回収通路が蚭けられおいる堎合には、それら遊技領域及び回収通路ず圓接郚及び付勢手段ずを奜適に共存させるこずができる。   In particular, when the game area is provided on the front side of the game board and the collection path is provided on the back side as shown in the feature B2, the game area, the collection path, the contact portion, and the biasing means preferably coexist. Can be made.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠が開閉可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘扉䜓には、前蚘遊技領域の前方に䜍眮するずずもに透明性を有し、前蚘遊技領域が芖認可胜ずなるように圢成されたパネル郚材ガラスが蚭けられおおり、
前蚘遊技領域には、前蚘遊技盀から前蚘パネル郚材に向けお突出し、同パネル郚材に察しお遊技球の盎埄よりも小さな隙間を隔おお察峙する遊技郚品センタヌフレヌム等が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀が前蚘圓接郚に圓接しおいる状態にお、前蚘付勢手段偎ぞの同遊技盀の倉䜍を蚱容するものであるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature B4. A door body (front door frame 14) covering the game board from the front is supported by the support frame so as to be openable and closable.
The door body is provided with a panel member (glass 22) which is located in front of the gaming area and has transparency, and is formed so that the gaming area can be visually recognized.
The gaming area is provided with gaming parts (such as a center frame 95) that protrude from the gaming board toward the panel member and face the panel member with a gap smaller than the diameter of the gaming ball. ,
The contact portion and the biasing means allow the game board to be displaced toward the biasing means in a state where the game board is in contact with the contact portion. The gaming machine according to any one of B1 to B3.

特城によれば、扉䜓のパネル郚材を介しお遊技領域内を移動する遊技球の動きが芖認可胜ずなっおいる。パネル郚材ず遊技郚品ずの間に隙間を蚭けるこずで、遊技球がパネル郚材に衝突するずいった䞍郜合が生じにくくなっおいる。扉䜓が開閉可胜な遊技機においおは、遊技領域内にお遊技球の移動が滞る等した堎合に同扉䜓を開攟するこずで遊技領域ぞのアクセスが可胜ずなる。このように扉䜓を開攟するこずにより、遊技球の詰たり等の解消䜜業を行うこずができる。䜜業埌に扉䜓を閉じる堎合、仮に遊技球が遊技郚品ずパネル郚材ずの間に挟たるず、遊技球を介しお遊技郚品ずパネル郚材ずが干枉した際の衝撃等によりそれら遊技郚品やパネル郚材の倉圢等が発生し埗る。   According to the feature B4, the movement of the game ball moving in the game area can be visually recognized through the panel member of the door body. By providing a gap between the panel member and the game component, the inconvenience that the game ball collides with the panel member is less likely to occur. In a gaming machine in which the door can be opened and closed, the game area can be accessed by opening the door when the movement of the game ball is delayed in the game area. By opening the door body in this way, it is possible to perform a work of solving a clogged game ball or the like. When closing the door after the work, if the game ball is sandwiched between the game component and the panel member, the game component and the panel member may be affected by an impact when the game component and the panel member interfere through the game ball. Deformation and the like may occur.

この点、本特城においおは、遊技盀の埌方ぞの倉䜍を蚱容しおいる。これにより、遊技郚品ずパネル郚材ずの間に遊技球が挟たった堎合に付勢手段の付勢力に抗しお遊技盀遊技郚品が倉䜍するこずによりその衝撃を匱めるこずができる。故に、遊技郚品やパネル郚材の倉圢等を奜適に抑制するこずができる。すなわち、遊技郚品等を保護するこずが可胜ずなる。特に、圓接郚及び付勢手段を遊技盀の䞡端にそれぞれ配眮するこずで、䜍眮決め機胜を向䞊し、曎には遊技盀の広域にお遊技郚品の保護機胜を享受するこずが可胜ずなり、遊技郚品の倧型化や同遊技郚品の配眮の倚様化等に奜適に察応できる。   In this regard, this feature allows a backward displacement of the game board. Thereby, when a game ball is sandwiched between the game component and the panel member, the impact can be weakened by displacing the game board (game component) against the urging force of the urging means. Therefore, a deformation | transformation etc. of a game component or a panel member can be suppressed suitably. That is, it is possible to protect game parts and the like. In particular, by arranging the abutting portions and the biasing means at both ends of the game board, it is possible to improve the positioning function and further to enjoy the protection function of the game parts in a wide area of the game board. It is possible to cope with the increase in the size of the game and the diversification of the arrangement of the game parts.

特城前蚘遊技郚品は、前蚘遊技盀の䞀端偎に䜍眮する前蚘付勢手段ず同遊技盀の他端偎に䜍眮する前蚘付勢手段ずの間に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature B5. The game component according to B4, wherein the game component is disposed between the biasing means located on one end side of the game board and the biasing means located on the other end side of the game board. Gaming machine.

特城に瀺すように遊技郚品を挟んだ䞡偎に付勢手段を配眮するこずで、特城に瀺した遊技郚品及びパネル郚材の保護機胜の曎なる向䞊が期埅できる。特に、特城ずの組み合わせ圓接郚及び付勢手段を遊技盀の呚瞁に沿っお配眮する構成においおは、遊技領域遊技郚品や回収通路等ずの共存を図り぀぀、保護機胜を享受でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   By arranging the biasing means on both sides of the game part as shown in the feature B5, further improvement of the protection function of the game part and the panel member shown in the feature B4 can be expected. In particular, in combination with the feature B3 (a configuration in which the abutting portion and the urging means are arranged along the periphery of the game board), the protection function is provided while coexisting with the game area (game parts), the collection passage, and the like. It can be enjoyed and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに前蚘遊技盀よりも䞋偎に配眮され、遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘遊技球発射装眮は、遊技球の発射方向を芏定する発射レヌル発射レヌルを有し、
前蚘遊技盀には、圓該遊技盀の前面から起立し、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に誘導する誘導レヌル誘導レヌルが蚭けられおおり、
前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚入口郚分は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配されおおり、
前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature B6. A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) that is provided on the support frame and disposed below the game board and launches a game ball,
The game ball launching device has a launch rail that defines the launch direction of the game ball (the launch rail 112),
The game board is provided with a guide rail (guide rail 100) that stands up from the front of the game board and guides the game ball launched from the game ball launcher to the game area,
The entrance portion (entrance portion 104) of the guide rail is arranged near the lower end of the game board,
The gaming machine according to any one of B1 to B5, wherein the contact portion and the urging means are arranged near a lower end of the game board.

遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を誘導レヌルによっお遊技領域に導く構成においおは、誘導レヌルにおける遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きに起因しお、同遊技球の着地時に誘導レヌルに生じる衝撃が倧きくなり埗る。この様な衝撃の増倧は、䟋えば誘導レヌルに歪み等を生じさせ、遊技球の円滑な誘導が損なわれる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城に瀺すように、誘導レヌルの入口郚を遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮するずずもに圓接郚及び付勢手段を同じく遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮するこずにより、入口郚の䜍眮粟床を向䞊できる。これにより、䞊述した着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In the configuration in which the game ball launched from the game ball launcher is guided to the game area by the guide rail, the impact generated on the guide rail at the time of landing of the game ball is large due to variations in the landing position of the game ball on the guide rail. Can be. Such an increase in impact is not preferable because, for example, the guide rail may be distorted and the smooth guidance of the game ball may be impaired. In this regard, as shown in this feature, by positioning the entrance portion of the guide rail near the lower end of the game board, and the contact portion and the biasing means are also located near the lower end of the game board, the position accuracy of the entrance portion is increased. Can be improved. Thereby, the dispersion | variation in the landing position mentioned above can be suppressed, and a practically preferable structure can be implement | achieved.

特城前蚘圓接郚及び前蚘付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀の幅方向においお前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚を挟んだ䞡偎にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature B7. The gaming machine according to B6, wherein the contact portion and the urging means are respectively disposed on both sides of the entrance portion of the guide rail in the width direction of the game board.

特城によれば、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を誘導レヌルの入口郚にお曎に向䞊させるこずができ、特城に瀺した効果を曎に顕著なものずするこずができる。   According to the feature B7, the position accuracy of the game board can be further improved at the entrance portion of the guide rail, and the effect shown in the feature B6 can be made more remarkable.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお回動可胜に支持され、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠を備え、
前蚘圓接郚は、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ず同じ偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに同支持枠に固定されおいる第圓接郚䟋えばストッパず、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する状態及び同遊技盀の前面に圓接しない状態の䞡状態に切替え可胜な第圓接郚(䟋えばロック装眮の操䜜郚)ず
を有し、
前蚘遊技盀には、前蚘遊技盀の前面及び背面に開攟され、前蚘第圓接郚が前蚘圓接しない状態である堎合に同第圓接郚の挿通を蚱容する挿通郚挿通郚等が圢成されおおり、
前蚘付勢手段は、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ず同じ偎に蚭けられおいる第付勢手段䟋えば板バネず、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎に蚭けられおいる第付勢手段䟋えばコむルバネず
を有し、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘第圓接郚ず前蚘第付勢手段ずの間に挿入された状態にお、その挿入された郚分を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature B8. A door body (front door frame 14) that is rotatably supported by the support frame and covers the game board from the front;
The contact portion is
A first contact portion (for example, a stopper 267) provided on the same side as the side on which the door body is supported in the support frame and fixed to the support frame;
The support frame is provided on the side opposite to the side on which the door body is supported, and can be switched between a state of contacting the front surface of the game board and a state of not contacting the front surface of the game board. A second contact portion (for example, the operation portion 446 of the lock device 400),
The game board includes an insertion portion (insertion portion 92) that is open to a front surface and a rear surface of the game board and allows the second contact portion to be inserted when the second contact portion is not in contact. Etc.) are formed,
The biasing means is
A first biasing means (for example, a leaf spring 270) provided on the same side as the side on which the door body is supported in the support frame;
Second biasing means (for example, coil spring 430) provided on the opposite side of the support frame from the side on which the door body is supported;
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the inserted portion while being inserted between the first contact portion and the first biasing means. The gaming machine according to any one of B1 to B7, wherein:

特城に瀺すように支持枠に扉䜓が蚭けられおいる堎合には、扉䜓を開攟した状態で遊技盀を遊技機前方から真っ盎ぐ抌し蟌んで取り付けるこずが難しくなるず想定される。特に、遊技機が遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に蚭眮されおいる堎合には、扉䜓の回動基端偎においお遊技盀を取り付ける際の䜜業スペヌスの確保や取付軌道の確保が困難になりやすいず考えられる。この点、本特城によれば、遊技盀を第圓接郚ず第付勢手段ずの間に挿入した埌、支持枠に察しお回動させるこずにより取付完了䜍眮に配眮するこずができるため、回動基端偎で䜜業スペヌスを確保する必芁がなく、䞊述した䞍郜合を奜適に払拭するこずができる。   When the door frame is provided on the support frame as shown in the feature B8, it is assumed that it is difficult to push the game board straight from the front of the gaming machine with the door body opened. In particular, when a gaming machine is installed in an island facility in a gaming hall, it is likely that it is difficult to secure a work space and secure a mounting track when installing the game board on the rotating base end side of the door body. It is done. In this regard, according to this feature, the game board can be placed at the attachment completion position by inserting the game board between the first contact portion and the first biasing means and then rotating the game board with respect to the support frame. Therefore, it is not necessary to secure a work space on the rotation base end side, and the above-described inconveniences can be suitably wiped off.

䞀方、遊技盀の回動先端偎では、仮に回動基端偎ず同様に圓接郚を固定匏ずするず同圓接郚が遊技盀の配眮䜜業の劚げになり埗る。この点、第圓接郚を遊技盀の前面に圓接する状態及び同遊技盀の前面に圓接しない状態に切替可胜ずし、この第圓接郚が圓接しない状態である堎合に挿通される挿通郚を遊技盀に圢成するこずで、䞊述した配眮䜜業䞊の䞍郜合を払拭しおいる。そしお、遊技盀を取付完了䜍眮に配眮した埌は、第圓接郚を圓接しない状態から圓接する状態に切り替えるこずで、回動先端偎での䜍眮決めがなされる。遊技盀の回動先端偎においおは、回動先端偎ず比べお䜜業スペヌスの確保が容易であるため、䞊述した圓接郚の切替䜜業を行いやすくできる。   On the other hand, if the abutting portion is fixed on the rotating front end side of the game board as in the case of the rotating base end side, the abutting portion may interfere with the placement work of the game board. In this respect, the second abutting portion can be switched between a state in which the second abutting portion abuts on the front surface of the game board and a state in which the second abutting portion does not abut on the front surface of the gaming board. By forming the insertion portion to be formed on the game board, the above-described inconvenience in the arrangement work is eliminated. And after arrange | positioning a game board in an attachment completion position, the position by the rotation front end side is made by switching from the state which does not contact a 2nd contact part to the state contact | abutted. Since it is easier to secure a work space on the rotating front end side of the game board than on the rotating front end side, the above-described contact portion switching operation can be easily performed.

以䞊詳述したように、回動基端偎の第圓接郚を固定匏ずし、回動先端偎の第圓接郚を可動匏ずするこずで、䜜業の容易化を図り、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   As described above in detail, the first abutting portion on the rotating base end side is fixed, and the second abutting portion on the rotating distal end side is movable, thereby facilitating work and practically. A preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘第付勢手段は、前蚘遊技盀が回動される過皋にお同遊技盀を付勢可胜に圢成されおおり、
前蚘第付勢手段は、前蚘第圓接郚の前蚘圓接しない状態から前蚘圓接する状態ぞの切替えに基づいお前蚘遊技盀を付勢するように構成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature B9. The first urging means is formed so as to be able to urge the game board in the process of turning the game board,
The second biasing means is configured to bias the game board based on switching from the non-contact state to the contact state of the second contact portion. The gaming machine described in 1.

特城によれば、第付勢手段によっお回動䞭の遊技盀を付勢する構成ずするこずで遊技盀を回動させる際の操䜜ばら぀きを抑制でき、䟋えば遊技盀が支持枠に匕っ掛かっお同遊技盀の回動操䜜が劚げられるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。たた、第付勢手段は、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮した埌、第圓接郚の圓接する状態ぞの切替操䜜を行うこずによっお、遊技盀を付勢するこずずなる。故に、第付勢手段の付勢力を匷め䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図ったずしおも、それにより遊技盀の装着䜜業が劚げられやすくなるこずは無い。぀たり、䜜業の容易化ず䜍眮決め粟床の䞡立に貢献できる。   According to the feature B9, it is possible to suppress variation in operation when the game board is rotated by urging the rotating game board by the first urging means. For example, the game board is caught on the support frame. It is possible to make it difficult for the inconvenience that the turning operation of the game board is hindered. Further, the second urging means urges the game board by performing the switching operation to the state where the second contact portion abuts after the game board is arranged at the mounting completion position. Therefore, even if the urging force of the second urging means is increased to improve the position accuracy, it does not easily hinder the game board mounting operation. That is, it is possible to contribute to both ease of work and positioning accuracy.

特城前蚘第圓接郚は、前蚘第付勢手段においお前蚘遊技盀の背面に圓接する郚䜍よりも前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature B10. The first contact portion is disposed at a position closer to a rotation base end side of the game board than a portion of the first biasing means that contacts the back surface of the game board. A gaming machine according to B9.

特城等に瀺したように、第圓接郚ず第付勢手段ずの間に遊技盀を挿入する構成においおは、仮に遊技盀の挿入角床が小さくなるず同遊技盀が支持枠に察しおひっかかりやすくなるず懞念される。この点、本特城においおは、第圓接郚が第付勢手段においお遊技盀の背面に圓接する郚䜍よりも遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮されおいるこずで、遊技盀の挿入口を遊技機前偎に向けるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、䞊蚘挿入角床を倧きくでき挿入䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。   In the configuration in which the game board is inserted between the first abutment portion and the first biasing means as shown in the feature B8, etc., if the insertion angle of the game board is reduced, the game board is moved relative to the support frame. There is concern that it will be caught easily. In this respect, in this feature, the first abutting portion is disposed on the rotation base end side of the game board with respect to the portion of the first urging means that abuts on the back surface of the game board. The mouth can be directed to the front side of the gaming machine. Thereby, the said insertion angle can be enlarged and it can contribute to the simplification of insertion work.

たた、遊技盀を遊技機前方に付勢する構成を採甚した堎合、その付勢力をある皋床匷めに蚭定するこずにより、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を図るこずができる。しかしながら、付勢力を匷めるず遊技盀の装着䜜業が難しくなり埗る。この点、本特城によれば、第圓接郚ず第付勢手段の圓接郚䜍ずをずらしお配眮するこずで、付勢力を倧きくした堎合にその付勢力が遊技盀を挿入する際の抵抗ずなるこずを抑え、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊ず挿入䜜業の容易化ず奜適に䞡立できる。   In addition, when a configuration in which the gaming board is urged forward of the gaming machine is employed, positioning accuracy can be improved by setting the urging force to be somewhat strong. However, if the urging force is increased, it is difficult to attach the game board. In this regard, according to this feature, when the biasing force is increased by disposing the first contact portion and the contact portion of the first biasing means in a shifted manner, the biasing force is inserted when the game board is inserted. Therefore, it is possible to suitably achieve both improvement in positioning accuracy and ease of insertion work.

特城前蚘第圓接郚は、遊技盀の前面に沿っお所定方向に延びおおり、前蚘圓接しない状態では圓該第圓接郚の長手方向が遊技盀の回動基端偎から回動先端偎に向き、前蚘圓接する状態ではそれずは異なる方向を向くように、前蚘支持枠に察しお回動可胜に取り付けられおおり、
前蚘挿通郚は、圓該遊技盀の回動基端偎から回動先端偎に延び、前蚘圓接しない状態での前蚘第圓接郚の通過を蚱容するずずもに前蚘圓接する状態での同第圓接郚の通過を䞍可ずするように圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature B11. The second contact portion extends in a predetermined direction along the front surface of the game board. When the second contact portion is not in contact, the longitudinal direction of the second contact portion is the rotation tip from the rotation base end side of the game board. It is attached to the support frame so as to be able to turn in a direction different from that in the state of facing toward the side,
The insertion portion extends from the rotation base end side of the game board to the rotation tip end side, and allows passage of the second contact portion in the non-contact state and the second in the contact state. The gaming machine according to any one of B8 to B10, wherein the gaming machine is formed so as to prevent passage of the contact portion.

特城等に瀺した構成においおは、遊技盀回動時の同遊技盀ず第圓接郚ずの干枉を回避すべく挿通郚の開攟郚䜍を倧きくするず、第圓接郚ず遊技盀ずの掛かり代を確保しにくくなる。特に第圓接郚を回動匏ずした堎合には、回動䞭心から掛かり郚分たでの距離が倧きくなるず、遊技盀の抌えが難しくなり、䞊蚘第付勢手段の付勢力によっおかえっお遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋し埗る。   In the configuration shown in the feature B8 or the like, if the opening portion of the insertion portion is enlarged to avoid interference between the game board and the second contact portion when the game board is rotated, the second contact portion and the game board It will be difficult to secure the allowance. In particular, when the second abutting portion is a pivoting type, if the distance from the pivoting center to the hooking portion is increased, it becomes difficult to press the game board, and the game board is changed by the biasing force of the second biasing means. The positioning accuracy may be reduced.

この点、本特城によれば、挿通郚の開攟郚䜍の倧きさを第圓接郚に察しお無駄に倧きくしなくおもよくなり、第圓接郚ず遊技盀ずの掛かり代を確保しやすくできる。曎には、第圓接郚の回動䞭心から掛かり郚分たでの距離を小さくするこずができる。これにより、第圓接郚の倉圢等を抑え。䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   In this regard, according to this feature, it is not necessary to unnecessarily increase the size of the open portion of the insertion portion relative to the second contact portion, and the allowance between the second contact portion and the game board is secured. It can be done easily. Furthermore, the distance from the rotation center of the second contact portion to the hooking portion can be reduced. This suppresses deformation of the second contact portion. Contributes to improved positioning accuracy.

特城遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を支持する支持枠内枠ず
を備え、
前蚘支持枠に察しお前蚘遊技盀が遊技機前方から取付可胜な遊技機においお、
前蚘支持枠には、前蚘遊技盀を支持する支持機構䟋えばロック装眮が耇数蚭けられおおり、
前蚘支持機構は、
前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚䟋えばストッパやロック装眮の操䜜郚ず、
前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から遊技機前方に向けお付勢する付勢郚䟋えば板バネやコむルバネず
をそれぞれ備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature B12. A game board (game board 80) in which a game area (game area PE) is formed;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for supporting the game board;
In the gaming machine in which the gaming board can be attached to the support frame from the front of the gaming machine,
The support frame is provided with a plurality of support mechanisms (for example, a lock device 400) for supporting the game board,
The support mechanism is
A contact portion (for example, a stopper 267 or an operation portion 446 of the lock device 400) that contacts the front surface of the game board;
A gaming machine comprising biasing portions (for example, a leaf spring 270 and a coil spring 430) for biasing the gaming board from the back side of the gaming board toward the front of the gaming machine.

特城によれば、遊技盀を支持枠の前方すなわち前面偎から取付可胜ずするこずにより、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀の取り付けを行う堎合ず比范しお、同遊技盀の着脱䜜業の容易化を促進できる。䜆し、このように遊技盀を支持枠前方から取り付ける構成においおは、支持枠の背面偎から遊技盀を取り付ける構成ず比范しお、遊技盀前面の遊技盀取付方向前埌方向における䜍眮粟床を向䞊させるのは難しくなるず想定される。   According to feature B12, the game board can be attached from the front (ie, the front side) of the support frame, so that the game board can be attached and detached compared to the case where the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame. Can be facilitated. However, in the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the front of the support frame in this way, the positional accuracy in the game board mounting direction (front-rear direction) on the front of the game board is improved compared to the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the back side of the support frame. It is assumed that it will be difficult.

この点、本特城においおは、付勢手段によっお遊技機前方ぞ遊技盀を抌し、同遊技盀の移動を圓接郚によっお阻止するこずにより、同遊技盀の前埌䜍眮を芏定できる。䟋えば、支持機構を遊技盀の䞡端偎に配眮するこずにより、䞊蚘付勢力によっお遊技盀が傟いたり回動したりするこずを抑制できる。これにより、遊技盀詳しくはその前面の䜍眮粟床向䞊に貢献できる。   In this respect, in this feature, the front and back positions of the game board can be defined by pushing the game board forward of the game machine by the urging means and preventing the movement of the game board by the contact portion. For example, by disposing the support mechanism on both ends of the game board, the game board can be prevented from being tilted or rotated by the biasing force. This can contribute to improving the positional accuracy of the game board (specifically, the front face thereof).

なお、本特城に特城乃至特城に瀺した技術的思想を適甚するこずも可胜である。特に特城乃至特城ずの組み合わせにおいお、第圓接郚及び第付勢手段によっお第支持機構を構成し、第圓接郚及び第付勢手段によっお第支持機構を構成するずよい。   The technical idea shown in the features B2 to B11 can be applied to this feature. In particular, in the combination with the features B8 to B11, the first support mechanism is constituted by the first contact portion and the first biasing means, and the second support mechanism is constituted by the second contact portion and the second biasing means. Good.

特城矀
特城取付察象内枠に察しお着脱可胜な遊技郚品遊技盀ず、
前蚘取付察象に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技郚品を䜍眮決めする䜍眮決め手段ロック装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、
前蚘遊技郚品の䞀方偎に蚭けられ、同遊技郚品を䜍眮決めする䜍眮決め状態及び同遊技郚品を䜍眮決めを解陀する䜍眮決め解陀状態の各状態に切替可胜な操䜜郚操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚ず、
前蚘遊技郚品の他方偎に蚭けられ、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態から前蚘䜍眮決め状態に切り替えられた堎合に、前蚘遊技郚品を前蚘操䜜郚偎に向けお抌さえる抌え郚プッシャず
を備え、
前蚘䜍眮決め状態では、前蚘抌え郚に抌された前蚘遊技郚品が前蚘操䜜郚に察しお同抌え郚偎から圓接するこずにより、圓該操䜜郚偎ぞの同遊技郚品の移動が芏制されるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature C group>
Feature C1. A game part (game board 80) that can be attached to and detached from the attachment target (inner frame 13);
Positioning means (locking device 400) provided on the attachment target and positioning the gaming parts;
The positioning means includes
An operation unit (an operation unit 446 of the operation lever 440) provided on one side of the gaming component and capable of switching between a positioning state for positioning the gaming component and a positioning release state for canceling the positioning of the gaming component;
A pressing portion (pusher 420) provided on the other side of the gaming component and configured to press the gaming component toward the operation portion when the operation portion is switched from the positioning release state to the positioning state. ,
In the positioning state, movement of the gaming component toward the operation portion is restricted when the gaming component pressed by the pressing portion comes into contact with the operation portion from the pressing portion side. A gaming machine.

特城によれば、操䜜郚を䜍眮決め解陀状態から䜍眮決め状態に切り替えるこずで、同操䜜郚ず抌え郚ずによっお遊技郚品が挟たれる。この際、遊技郚品は、操䜜郚によっお抌え郚偎に抌されるのではなく、抌え郚によっお操䜜郚偎に抌されるこずずなる。これにより、操䜜郚、詳しくは同操䜜郚においお遊技郚品ず圓接しおいる郚䜍を基準ずしお同遊技郚品の䜍眮決めを行うこずができる。   According to the feature C1, by switching the operation unit from the positioning release state to the positioning state, the game component is sandwiched between the operation unit and the presser unit. At this time, the game component is not pushed toward the presser part by the operation part, but is pushed toward the operation part side by the presser part. Thereby, the game part can be positioned with reference to the operation part, specifically, a part in contact with the game part in the operation part.

特城前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態から前蚘䜍眮決め状態に切り替えられるこずに基づいお前蚘抌え郚が前蚘操䜜郚に近づくこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature C2. The gaming machine according to C1, wherein the presser portion approaches the operation portion based on the operation portion being switched from the positioning release state to the positioning state.

遊技郚品の䜍眮ずれ等を抑制しようずすれば、抌え郚による抌え力をある皋床倧きくするこずが望たしい。しかしながら、この抌え力が操䜜郚の切替操䜜を行う初期段階で䜜甚するず、操䜜郚ず遊技郚品ずが぀かえる等しお同操䜜郚の切替操䜜が難しくなるず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、操䜜郚の切替操䜜によっお抌え郚が同操䜜郚に近づく構成ずするこずにより、䟋えば操䜜郚が䜍眮決め解陀状態にある堎合には、それら抌え郚ず操䜜郚ずの間に遊技郚品の移動や䜍眮ばら぀き蚱容する隙間を蚭けるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、抌え郚の抌え力によっお操䜜郚の切替操䜜が難しくなるこずを抑制できる。䟋えば、抌え郚を操䜜郚に近づく偎に倉圢又は倉䜍可胜に圢成するずよい。   In order to suppress misalignment or the like of game parts, it is desirable to increase the presser force by the presser part to some extent. However, if this pressing force acts in the initial stage of switching operation parts, it is assumed that switching operation of the same operation part becomes difficult because the operation part and game parts can be used. In this regard, according to this feature, by adopting a configuration in which the presser unit approaches the operation unit by switching operation of the operation unit, for example, when the operation unit is in a positioning release state, the presser unit and the operation unit It is possible to provide a gap that allows movement of game parts and positional variations between them. Thereby, it can suppress that switching operation of an operation part becomes difficult by the pressing force of a press part. For example, the presser part may be formed to be deformable or displaceable on the side approaching the operation part.

特城前蚘抌え郚は、前蚘操䜜郚偎に付勢された状態ずなっおおり、
前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態の堎合にはその付勢力による前蚘遊技郚品偎ぞの倉䜍を芏制し、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め状態の堎合にはその付勢力による前蚘遊技郚品偎ぞの倉䜍を蚱容する芏制手段プッシャの突起、操䜜レバヌの停留郚及び連結郚を備えおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C3. The presser part is in a state of being biased toward the operation part side,
When the operation unit is in the positioning release state, the displacement to the game component side by the biasing force is restricted, and when the operation unit is in the positioning state, the displacement to the game component side by the biasing force is restricted. The gaming machine according to C1 or C2, further comprising a restricting means (protrusions 422 of the pusher 420, stopping portions 442 and 443 of the operation lever 440, and a connecting portion 444).

特城に瀺すように、抌え郚を操䜜郚偎に付勢された状態ずし、その付勢力の䜜甚を芏制手段によっお芏制するこずで、遊技郚品の取り付けの容易化ず遊技郚品の䜍眮粟床の向䞊ずを奜適に䞡立できる。   As shown in feature C3, the presser part is urged toward the operation part side, and the action of the urging force is restricted by the restricting means, thereby facilitating the attachment of the gaming parts and improving the positional accuracy of the gaming parts. And can be suitably achieved.

䟋えば、抌え郚を付勢する付勢郚材を蚭けるこずで䞊蚘付勢状態が実珟されおもよいし、抌え郚自身の匟性力によっお付勢状態が実珟されおもよい。   For example, the urging state may be realized by providing an urging member that urges the pressing portion, or the urging state may be realized by the elastic force of the pressing portion itself.

特城前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘取付察象から前蚘遊技郚品に向けお起立した状態で延びる軞郚軞䜓を有し、
前蚘遊技郚品には、前蚘軞郚が挿通される挿通郚挿通郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘軞郚の先端郚分から圓該軞郚ず亀差する方向に延出するようにしお圢成されおいるずずもに、前蚘軞郚の䞭心軞線を䞭心ずした回動が蚱容されおおり、
前蚘挿通郚は、前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態である堎合の前蚘操䜜郚の長手方向ず同䞀方向に延びおいるずずもに、同操䜜郚の通過を蚱容するものであり、
前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め状態に切り替えられおいる堎合には、前蚘操䜜郚の長手方向ず、前蚘挿通郚の長手方向ずが盞違するこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C4. The positioning means has a shaft portion (shaft body 410) extending in a standing state from the attachment target toward the game component,
The gaming part is formed with an insertion portion (insertion portion 92) through which the shaft portion is inserted,
The operation portion is formed so as to extend from the tip portion of the shaft portion in a direction intersecting with the shaft portion, and is allowed to rotate around the central axis of the shaft portion,
The insertion part extends in the same direction as the longitudinal direction of the operation part in the positioning release state, and allows passage of the operation part,
When the operation unit is switched to the positioning state, the longitudinal direction of the operation unit is different from the longitudinal direction of the insertion unit, according to any one of C1 to C3, Gaming machine.

操䜜郚ず遊技郚品ずが圓接した堎合に、軞郚に生じる応力は、䞡者の圓接箇所が軞郚から近ければ近いほど小さくなる。本特城においおは、挿通郚を操䜜郚ず同䞀方向に延びる長孔状ずするこずで、遊技郚品装着時の操䜜郚及び遊技郚品の干枉を回避し぀぀、軞郚に近い䜍眮にお操䜜郚ず遊技盀ずを圓接させるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、䞊蚘応力を䜎枛し、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   When the operation unit and the game part come into contact with each other, the stress generated in the shaft portion becomes smaller as the contact portion between the two is closer to the shaft portion. In this feature, the insertion part has a long hole shape extending in the same direction as the operation part, thereby avoiding interference between the operation part and the game part when the game part is mounted, and at a position close to the shaft part. It becomes possible to contact the game board. Thereby, the said stress can be reduced and it can contribute to the improvement of positioning accuracy.

䟋えば、操䜜郚が同操䜜郚の回動䞭心軞線を挟んだ䞡偎にお遊技郚品の䞀偎に察向する構成ずするこずで、曎なる䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   For example, it can contribute to the further improvement of positioning accuracy by setting it as the structure which opposes one side of game components in the both sides which pinched | interposed the rotation center axis line of the operation part.

特城前面に遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を支持する支持枠内枠ず、
前蚘遊技盀の䜍眮を芏定する䜍眮決め手段ロック装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘遊技盀を前蚘支持枠に察しお遊技機前方から取付可胜な遊技機であっお、
前蚘遊技盀には、前蚘遊技盀の厚さ方向に貫通する挿通郚挿通郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、
前蚘挿通郚を通っお前蚘遊技盀の前面偎に突出しお蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に察向し圓該遊技盀の前面ず圓接するこずで同遊技盀の遊技機前方ぞの移動を䞍可ずする䜍眮決め状態、及び前蚘遊技盀の遊技機前方ぞの移動を蚱容する䜍眮決め解陀状態の䞡状態に切替可胜に蚭けられた操䜜郚操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚ず、
前蚘遊技盀の埌方に蚭けられ、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態から前蚘䜍眮決め状態に切り替えられた堎合に同遊技盀の背面を前蚘操䜜郚偎に向けお抌える抌え郚プッシャず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature C5. A game board (game board 80) having a game area (game area PE) formed on the front surface;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for supporting the game board;
Positioning means for defining the position of the game board (lock device 400),
A gaming machine capable of attaching the gaming board to the support frame from the front of the gaming machine,
In the game board, an insertion portion (insertion portion 92) penetrating in the thickness direction of the game board is formed,
The positioning means includes
Protruding to the front side of the game board through the insertion portion, facing the front surface of the game board and abutting against the front surface of the game board, it is impossible to move the game board forward of the gaming machine An operation unit (operation unit 446 of the operation lever 440) provided to be switchable between a positioning state and a positioning release state that allows the game board to move forward in the gaming machine;
A presser part (pusher 420) provided at the rear of the game board and pressing the back of the game board toward the operation part side when the operation part is switched from the positioning release state to the positioning state; A gaming machine characterized by that.

特城によれば、䜍眮決め手段の操䜜郚を䜍眮決め状態に切り替えるこずにより、操䜜郚が遊技盀の前面に察向する䜍眮に配眮され、䞔぀遊技盀が抌え郚によっお遊技機前方に向けお抌されるこずずなる。遊技盀の前方には操䜜郚が䜍眮しおいるため、同遊技盀は操䜜郚に抌え぀けられるこずずなる。これにより、遊技盀の前埌䜍眮が芏定される。   According to the feature C5, by switching the operation part of the positioning means to the positioning state, the operation part is arranged at a position facing the front surface of the game board, and the game board is pushed toward the front of the gaming machine by the presser part. It becomes. Since the operation unit is located in front of the game board, the game board is pressed against the operation unit. Thereby, the front-rear position of the game board is defined.

このように、遊技盀を前方から取り付ける構成においお同遊技盀の前面基準で䜍眮決めを行う構成ずすれば、遊技盀の背面基準で䜍眮決めを行う構成ず比范しお、同遊技盀の前面すなわち䞊蚘遊技領域の䜍眮粟床を向䞊できる。詳しくは、遊技盀の背面基準で䜍眮決めをした堎合、遊技盀における厚み等の補造ばら぀きの圱響により、遊技盀の前面の䜍眮粟床が䜎䞋しやすくなる。この点、本特城においおは、このような䞍郜合を奜適に払拭し、䜍眮粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   In this way, in the configuration in which the game board is mounted from the front, if the configuration is based on the front side of the game board, the front side of the game board (i.e., the above) is compared to the configuration in which the positioning is based on the back side of the game board. The position accuracy of the game area can be improved. Specifically, when positioning is based on the back side of the game board, the positional accuracy of the front side of the game board tends to be lowered due to the influence of manufacturing variations such as the thickness of the game board. In this regard, in this feature, such inconvenience can be suitably wiped off, which can contribute to the improvement of position accuracy.

なお、特城乃至特城に瀺した技術的思想を本特城に適甚するこずも可胜である。   Note that the technical idea shown in the features C1 to C4 can be applied to this feature.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお回動可胜に支持され、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ず同䞀偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎に開攟されおおり、同扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎から前蚘遊技盀が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚ず
を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに、圓該支持枠においお前蚘挿入郚が蚭けられおいる偎ずは反察に配眮され、
前蚘挿通郚は、前蚘遊技盀を取付完了䜍眮ぞ回動させる過皋においお前蚘操䜜郚の通過を蚱容するものであるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C6. A door body (front door frame 14) that is rotatably supported by the support frame and covers the game board from the front;
The support frame is provided on the same side as the side on which the door body is supported, and is open to the side opposite to the side on which the door body is supported, and the door body is supported. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) into which the game board is inserted from the opposite side to the side,
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
The positioning means is provided on the support frame and disposed on the opposite side of the support frame from the side on which the insertion portion is provided.
The gaming machine according to C5, wherein the insertion part allows passage of the operation part in the process of rotating the game board to the attachment completion position.

特城によれば、支持枠に䜍眮決め手段を蚭けたこずで、䟋えば遊技盀を亀換するこずにより機皮倉曎を行うタむプの遊技機においおは、䜍眮決め手段の機皮間での䜿いたわしが可胜ずなり、リナヌス率の向䞊に貢献できる。曎には、䜍眮決め手段を支持枠に蚭けるこずにより、遊技盀ごずに䜍眮決め粟床がばら぀くこずを抑制可胜ずなっおいる。   According to the feature C6, the positioning means is provided in the support frame. For example, in a gaming machine of a type in which the model is changed by exchanging the game board, the positioning means can be reused between models. It can contribute to the improvement of the rate. Furthermore, by providing the positioning means on the support frame, it is possible to suppress variations in positioning accuracy for each game board.

たた、支持枠に扉䜓が蚭けられおいる堎合には、扉䜓を開攟した状態で遊技盀を遊技機前方から真っ盎ぐ抌し蟌んで取り付けるのは難しくなり埗る。特に、遊技機が遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に蚭眮されおいる堎合には、扉䜓の回動基端偎においお遊技盀を取り付ける際の䜜業スペヌスの確保や取付軌道の確保が困難になりやすいず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、遊技盀を挿入郚に挿入した埌で、支持枠に察しお回動させるこずにより取付完了䜍眮に配眮するこずができるため、䞊述した䞍郜合を奜適に払拭するこずができる。   Further, when a door body is provided on the support frame, it may be difficult to attach the game board by pushing it straight from the front of the gaming machine with the door body opened. In particular, when a gaming machine is installed in an island facility in a gaming hall, it is assumed that it is difficult to secure a work space and a mounting track when installing a game board on the rotating base end side of the door body. Is done. In this regard, according to the present feature, after the game board is inserted into the insertion portion, the game board can be arranged at the attachment completion position by rotating with respect to the support frame, so that the above-described inconveniences can be suitably eliminated. Can do.

しかしながら、仮に䞊蚘䜍眮決め手段を扉䜓の回動基端偎すなわち挿入郚偎に配眮するず、遊技盀を挿入する際に䜍眮決め手段が匕っ掛かりやすくなったり、䞊蚘操䜜郚を操䜜しにくくなったりし埗る。そこで、本特城においおは、䜍眮決め手段を支持枠においお挿入郚が蚭けられおいる偎ずは反察に配眮した。これにより、䜍眮決め手段が遊技盀の取付䜜業の劚げずなるこずを抑制しおいる。   However, if the positioning means is disposed on the rotation base end side (that is, the insertion part side) of the door body, the positioning means may be easily caught when the game board is inserted, or the operation part may be difficult to operate. obtain. Therefore, in this feature, the positioning means is disposed on the opposite side of the support frame from the side where the insertion portion is provided. Thereby, it is suppressed that the positioning means obstructs the work of mounting the game board.

特城前蚘挿入郚は、前蚘遊技盀の前方に䜍眮し同遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚ストッパず、前蚘遊技盀の埌方に䜍眮し同遊技盀を前方ぞ付勢する付勢郚板バネずを有しおなるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature C7. The insertion part is located in front of the game board and comes into contact with the front surface of the game board (stopper 267), and the biasing part is located behind the game board and urges the game board forward. (The leaf spring 270), The gaming machine according to C6, characterized in that it has.

特城によれば、遊技盀の回動先端偎及び回動基端偎の䞡偎にお䜍眮決め可胜ずなり、同遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature C7, the game board can be positioned on both sides of the rotation front end side and the rotation base end side, which can contribute to improvement of the positioning accuracy of the game board.

特に、遊技盀を回動させお着脱する構成においおは、挿入郚に近い䜍眮に䞊蚘䜍眮決め手段を配眮するこずが困難になりやすい。぀たり、操䜜郚等によっお挿入郚ぞの挿入軌道が制限されやすくなるため、遊技盀取付䜜業の容易化を優先させるず䜍眮決め手段を回動基端偎に配眮するこずが難しくなる。たた、固定匏の圓接郚及び付勢郚を回動先端偎に配眮するず、圓接郚を遊技盀に圓接させるこずが難しくなる。   In particular, in a configuration in which the game board is rotated and detached, it is difficult to place the positioning means near the insertion portion. That is, since the insertion track to the insertion portion is easily limited by the operation portion or the like, it is difficult to arrange the positioning means on the rotation base end side if priority is given to the ease of the game board mounting operation. In addition, if the fixed contact portion and the biasing portion are arranged on the rotation tip side, it is difficult to make the contact portion contact the game board.

この点、回動基端偎に固定匏の付勢郚及び圓接郚を配眮し、回動先端偎に可動匏の䞊蚘䜍眮決め手段を配眮すれば、䞊述した各皮䞍郜合を払拭し、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In this respect, if the fixed urging portion and the abutting portion are arranged on the rotation base end side and the movable positioning means is arranged on the rotation tip end side, the above-mentioned various disadvantages are eliminated, which is practically preferable. The configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘䜍眮決め手段には、前蚘支持枠から前蚘遊技盀に向けお起立し、前蚘挿通郚に沿っお延びる軞郚軞䜓が蚭けられ、
前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘軞郚においお前蚘挿通郚から突出しおいる先端郚分から圓該軞郚ず亀差する方向に延出するようにしお圢成されおいるずずもに、前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態では圓該操䜜郚の長手方向が遊技盀の回動基端偎から回動先端偎に向き、前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態ではそれずは異なる方向を向くように前蚘軞郚の䞭心軞線を䞭心ずした回動が蚱容されおおり、
前蚘挿通郚は、圓該遊技盀の回動基端偎から回動先端偎に延び、前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態での前蚘操䜜郚の通過を蚱容するように圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C8. The positioning means is provided with a shaft portion (shaft body 410) that stands up from the support frame toward the game board and extends along the insertion portion,
The operation portion is formed so as to extend from a tip portion protruding from the insertion portion in the shaft portion in a direction intersecting the shaft portion, and in a longitudinal direction of the operation portion in the positioning release state. Is turned from the rotation base end side of the game board to the rotation tip end side, and in the positioning release state, rotation about the central axis of the shaft portion is permitted to face a different direction,
The insertion portion extends from the rotation base end side of the game board to the rotation distal end side, and is formed to allow passage of the operation unit in the positioning release state. C6 or C7 The gaming machine described in 1.

特城及びに瀺した構成においおは、遊技盀を回動させた堎合の同遊技盀ず䜍眮決め手段ずの干枉を回避すべく挿通郚の開攟郚䜍を倧きくするず、操䜜郚ず遊技盀ずの掛かり代を確保しにくくなる。特に䜍眮決め手段を回動匏ずした堎合には、回動䞭心から掛かり郚分たでの距離が倧きくなるず、遊技盀の抌えが難しくなり、䞊蚘抌え郚の抌え力によっおかえっお遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋し埗る。   In the configuration shown in the features C6 and C7, if the open portion of the insertion portion is enlarged to avoid interference between the game board and the positioning means when the game board is rotated, the operation part and the game board are hooked. It becomes difficult to secure the bill. In particular, when the positioning means is a rotary type, if the distance from the center of rotation to the hooked portion increases, it becomes difficult to press the game board, and the positioning accuracy of the game board lowers due to the pressing force of the presser part. obtain.

この点、本特城によれば、挿通郚の開攟郚䜍の倧きさを操䜜郚に察しお無駄に倧きくしなくおもよくなり、操䜜郚ず遊技盀ずの掛かり代を確保しやすくできる。曎には、操䜜郚の回動䞭心から掛かり郚分たでの距離を小さくするこずができる。これにより、操䜜郚詳しくは䜍眮決め手段の倉圢を抑え。䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   In this regard, according to the present feature, the size of the open portion of the insertion portion does not need to be increased with respect to the operation portion, and the allowance between the operation portion and the game board can be easily secured. Furthermore, the distance from the rotation center of the operation unit to the hooking portion can be reduced. This suppresses deformation of the operation unit (specifically, positioning means). Contributes to improved positioning accuracy.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠が回動可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘扉䜓には、前蚘遊技領域の前方に䜍眮するずずもに透明性を有し、前蚘遊技領域が芖認可胜ずなるように圢成されたパネル郚材ガラスが蚭けられ、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓の回動基端偎の枠郚巊偎枠郚には、同扉䜓を軞支する軞郚支持金具ず、前蚘遊技盀ず察向する䜍眮に延出し前蚘䜍眮決め手段が蚭眮される蚭眮郚察向板郚ずが蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C9. A door body (front door frame 14) that covers the game board from the front is rotatably supported by the support frame,
The door body is provided with a panel member (glass 22) which is positioned in front of the gaming area and has transparency, and is formed so that the gaming area can be visually recognized.
In the support frame, the frame portion (left frame portion 13c) on the rotation base end side of the door body has a shaft portion (support metal fittings 71 and 72) that pivotally supports the door body, and a position facing the game board. The game machine according to any one of C5 to C8, further comprising an installation portion (opposing plate portion 251) extending to the positioning means.

扉䜓によっお遊技盀詳しくは遊技領域を芆う構成においおは、扉䜓ず遊技盀ずの䜍眮がばら぀いた堎合、䟋えばパネル郚材ず遊技盀ずが近づくこずにより遊技領域を移動䞭の遊技球がパネル郚材に圓たりやすくなるず想定される。この点、本特城においおは、支持枠においお扉䜓の回動基端偎の枠郚に軞郚及び蚭眮郚を䜵蚭するこずで、扉䜓ず遊技盀ずの䜍眮ばら぀きを生じにくくするこずができる。これにより、パネル郚材に察する遊技球の衝突等を回避しやすくできる。   In the configuration in which the game board (specifically, the game area) is covered by the door body, when the positions of the door body and the game board vary, for example, the game ball moving in the game area due to the panel member and the game board approaching each other. It is assumed that it will be easy to hit a panel member. In this respect, in this feature, by providing the shaft portion and the installation portion in the frame portion on the rotation base end side of the door body in the support frame, it is possible to make it difficult for position variation between the door body and the game board to occur. . Thereby, it is possible to easily avoid the collision of the game ball with the panel member.

なお、特城等圓接郚及び枠郚を有する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、前蚘圓接郚を前蚘支持枠の前蚘枠郚に蚭け、前蚘付勢郚を前蚘蚭眮郚に蚭けるこずで、曎なる䜍眮粟床の向䞊が期埅できる。   In combination with the feature C7 or the like (configuration having a contact part and a frame part), the contact part is provided in the frame part of the support frame, and the urging part is provided in the installation part. Further improvement in position accuracy can be expected.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技盀よりも䞋偎に配眮されおおり、前蚘遊技領域に遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C10. A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) for launching a game ball to the game area is provided on the support frame and disposed below the game board,
The gaming machine according to any one of C5 to C9, wherein the positioning means is disposed near a lower end of the gaming board.

特城によれば、少なくずも遊技球発射装眮偎の端郚近傍における遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を向䞊するこずができる。これにより、䟋えば遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑えやすくできる。䟋えば、遊技盀の䞋端瞁に沿っお耇数の䜍眮決め手段を配列するずよい。   According to the feature C10, it is possible to improve the position accuracy of the game board at least in the vicinity of the end on the game ball launching device side. Thereby, for example, variations in the landing position of the game ball can be easily suppressed. For example, a plurality of positioning means may be arranged along the lower edge of the game board.

特城前蚘遊技盀には、圓該遊技盀の前面から起立し、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に誘導する誘導レヌル誘導レヌルが蚭けられおおり、
前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配されおおり、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、少なくずも前蚘入口郚入口郚分呚蟺に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C11. The game board is provided with a guide rail (guide rail 100) that stands up from the front of the game board and guides the game ball launched from the game ball launcher to the game area,
The entrance portion of the guide rail is arranged near the lower end of the game board,
The gaming machine according to C10, wherein the positioning means is disposed at least around the entrance portion (entrance portion 104).

遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を誘導レヌルによっお遊技領域に導く構成においおは、誘導レヌルにおける遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きに起因しお、同遊技球の着地時に誘導レヌルに生じる衝撃が倧きくなり埗る。この様な衝撃の増倧は、䟋えば誘導レヌルに歪み等を生じさせ、遊技球の円滑な誘導が損なわれる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城に瀺すように、䜍眮決め手段を誘導手段の入口郚呚蟺に配眮するこずにより、䞊蚘着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In the configuration in which the game ball launched from the game ball launcher is guided to the game area by the guide rail, the impact generated on the guide rail at the time of landing of the game ball is large due to variations in the landing position of the game ball on the guide rail. Can be. Such an increase in impact is not preferable because, for example, the guide rail may be distorted and the smooth guidance of the game ball may be impaired. In this regard, as shown in this feature, by arranging the positioning means around the entrance portion of the guiding means, the variation in the landing position can be suppressed, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚を挟んだ巊右䞡偎にそれぞれ配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature C12. The gaming machine according to C11, wherein the positioning means are arranged on both the left and right sides of the entrance portion of the guide rail.

特城よれば、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を誘導レヌルの入口郚にお曎に向䞊させるこずができ、特城に瀺した効果を曎に顕著なものずするこずができる。   According to the feature C12, the position accuracy of the game board can be further improved at the entrance portion of the guide rail, and the effect shown in the feature C11 can be made more remarkable.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお回動可胜に支持され、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ず同䞀偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘扉䜓を支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎に開攟されおおり、同扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎から前蚘遊技盀が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚ず
を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘扉䜓に蚭けられ、遊技球を貯留する貯留皿䞊皿や䞋皿ず、
前蚘遊技盀においお前蚘入口郚の回動基端偎ずなる郚䜍に圢成され、圓該遊技盀の回動基端偎に開攟された開攟郚䞋偎切欠き郚ず、
前蚘開攟郚を通じお前蚘支持枠及び前蚘扉䜓に跚っお蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘貯留皿よりも䞊䜍に配眮され、遊技球を前蚘貯留皿に導く誘導通路郚通路圢成郚等ず
を備え、
前蚘挿通郚は、前蚘開攟郚に連なるずずもに前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎に開攟されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature C13. A door body (front door frame 14) that is rotatably supported by the support frame and covers the game board from the front;
The support frame is provided on the same side as the side on which the door body is supported, and is open to the side opposite to the side on which the door body is supported, and the door body is supported. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) into which the game board is inserted from the opposite side to the side,
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
A storage tray (an upper plate 33 or a lower plate 34) provided in the door body and storing game balls;
An opening portion (lower notch portion 88) that is formed in a portion of the game board on the rotation base end side of the entrance portion and is open to the rotation base end side of the game board;
A guide passage portion (passage forming portion 121 and the like) that is provided over the support frame and the door body through the opening portion and is arranged higher than the storage tray and guides the game ball to the storage tray. Prepared,
The gaming machine according to C12, wherein the insertion part is continuous with the opening part and is open to a rotation base end side of the game board.

特城に瀺したように䜍眮決め手段が入口郚を挟んだ䞡偎に配眮されおいる堎合には、䞡䜍眮決め手段のうち入口郚よりも回動基端偎に䜍眮する䞀方によっお挿入郚ぞの遊技盀の挿入が劚げられやすくなるこずが懞念される。特に、入口郚を遊技盀の幅方向における䞭倮に配眮しおいる堎合には、そのような䞍郜合が顕著になるず想定される。   When the positioning means is arranged on both sides of the entrance part as shown in the feature C12, the game board to the insertion part is located by one of the positioning means located closer to the rotation base end side than the entrance part. There is a concern that the insertion of this is likely to be hindered. In particular, such an inconvenience is assumed to be remarkable when the entrance portion is arranged at the center in the width direction of the game board.

たた、誘導通路が貯留皿よりも䞊䜍に䜍眮するこずにより遊技球を同貯留皿ぞ誘導する際にそれら遊技球の自重を利甚しお同遊技球を移動させるこずが可胜ずなる。しかしながら、近幎においおは遊技領域が拡匵される傟向にあり、これによっお誘導通路の配眮が制限されやすくなっおいる。぀たり、誘導通路が遊技領域遊技盀の拡匵によっお䞋方ぞず抌しやられるこずが懞念される。これは、貯留皿ぞの遊技球の誘導を難しくする芁因ずなり埗る。   In addition, since the guide passage is positioned higher than the storage tray, the game balls can be moved by utilizing their own weights when guiding the game balls to the storage tray. However, in recent years, game areas tend to be expanded, and this tends to limit the arrangement of the guide passages. That is, there is a concern that the guide passage is pushed downward due to the expansion of the game area (game board). This can be a factor that makes it difficult to guide the game ball to the storage tray.

この点、本特城においおは、遊技盀に開攟郚を蚭けるこずで、䞊蚘誘導通路ず遊技盀ずの共存が可胜ずなっおいる。぀たり、遊技領域を拡匵し぀぀誘導通路の䜍眮を貯留皿よりも䞊䜍に配眮するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。曎に、この開攟郚に連なるようにしお回動基端偎の䜍眮決め手段甚の挿通郚を圢成し、その挿通郚を回動基端偎に開攟させるこずで、遊技盀を挿入する際の同䜍眮決め手段ず同挿通郚ずの干枉を回避するこずができる。これにより、誘導通路の配眮ず遊技領域の拡匵ずを奜適に実珟し、曎には䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊ず遊技盀の挿入䜜業の容易化ずを奜適に䞡立するこずができる。   In this respect, in this feature, the guide passage and the game board can coexist by providing an open portion in the game board. That is, it is possible to arrange the position of the guide passage higher than the storage tray while expanding the game area. Further, an insertion portion for positioning means on the rotation base end side is formed so as to be connected to the opening portion, and the insertion portion is opened to the rotation base end side, so that the same positioning when inserting the game board is performed. Interference between the means and the insertion portion can be avoided. Thereby, it is possible to suitably realize the arrangement of the guide passage and the expansion of the game area, and it is possible to preferably achieve both the improvement of the positioning accuracy and the ease of the game board insertion work.

䟋えば、遊技盀における回動基端偎の䞋隅郚にお回動基端偎及び䞋偎に開攟された切欠きによっお前蚘開攟郚を構成するずよい。   For example, the opening portion may be configured by a notch opened to the rotation base end side and the lower side at the lower corner portion of the rotation base end side of the game board.

なお、本特城に瀺す「扉䜓」及び「挿通郚」は、特城等に瀺した「扉䜓」及び「挿通郚」ず同䞀のものずしおもよい。   Note that the “door body” and the “insertion portion” shown in this feature may be the same as the “door body” and the “insertion portion” shown in the feature C6 and the like.

特城前蚘操䜜郚ず前蚘抌え郚ずが前蚘遊技盀を挟んで察峙しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature C14. The game machine according to any one of C5 to C13, wherein the operation unit and the presser unit are opposed to each other with the game board interposed therebetween.

特城によれば、遊技盀を操䜜郚ず抌え郚ずで挟み蟌むこずで遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature C17, it is possible to contribute to an improvement in the positioning accuracy of the game board by sandwiching the game board between the operation unit and the holding unit.

特城前蚘抌え郚は、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘䜍眮決め解陀状態から前蚘䜍眮決め状態に切り替えられた堎合に、前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から抌す状態から、同遊技盀を抌さない状態に切り替えられるものであるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature C15. The presser part can be switched from a state where the game board is pushed from the back side of the game board to a state where the game board is not pushed when the operation part is switched from the positioning release state to the positioning state. The gaming machine according to any one of C5 to C14, which is characterized in that:

特城によれば、操䜜郚を䜍眮決め解陀状態に切り替えるこずにより、遊技盀の取り倖しが可胜ずなる。この際、操䜜郚を操䜜するこずで、抌え郚による遊技盀の抌えが回避されるため、䜍眮決め解陀埌に遊技盀が抌え郚に抌されお移動するこずを抑制できる。これにより、䟋えば操䜜郚を操䜜しおいる手等が遊技盀に干枉するずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   According to the feature C15, the game board can be removed by switching the operation unit to the positioning release state. At this time, since the game board is prevented from being pressed by the press part by operating the operation part, it is possible to prevent the game board from being pushed and moved by the press part after the positioning is released. As a result, for example, it is possible to make it difficult for a hand or the like operating the operation unit to interfere with the game board.

特城前蚘抌え郚は、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘遊技盀の前面ず察向しおいる状態においお、前蚘遊技盀を圓該遊技盀の背面偎から抌す状態ず、同遊技盀を抌さない状態ずの切り替えがなされるものであるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature C16. The pressing portion is switched between a state in which the game board is pressed from the back side of the game board and a state in which the game board is not pressed in a state where the operation unit faces the front surface of the game board. The gaming machine according to any one of C5 to C15, wherein the gaming machine is a thing.

特城によれば、操䜜郚が遊技盀ず察向しおいる状態にお、同遊技盀を抌す状態ず抌さない状態ずの切り替えがなされる。これにより、遊技盀を装着する際の抵抗を抑えるこずができ、曎には遊技盀を取り倖す際に同遊技盀が抌え郚に抌されお䞍意に移動しお手等に干枉するずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくできる。   According to the feature C16, in a state where the operation unit faces the game board, switching between a state in which the game board is pressed and a state in which the game board is not pressed is performed. As a result, the resistance when the game board is mounted can be suppressed, and further, when removing the game board, the game board is pushed by the presser part and unexpectedly moves and interferes with the hand etc. it can.

特城矀
特城前面偎に遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀を備え、
前蚘遊技盀を着脱可胜に支持する支持枠内枠に察しお、同遊技盀が遊技機前方から取り付けられおいる遊技機においお、
前蚘遊技盀の前面から突出した状態で同遊技盀に固定されおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技領域を区画する遊技領域区画郚材遊技領域区画郚材ず、
前蚘遊技領域区画郚材における前蚘遊技領域倖の郚䜍に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面偎から把持可胜な把持郚把持郚ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature D group>
Feature D1. A game board (game board 80) having a game area (game area PE) formed on the front side;
In a gaming machine in which the gaming board is attached from the front of the gaming machine to a support frame (inner frame 13) that detachably supports the gaming board,
A game area partition member (game area partition member 480) that is fixed to the game board in a state of protruding from the front surface of the game board, and partitions the game area;
A gaming machine, comprising: grip portions (gripping portions 481, 482) that are provided in a portion of the game area partition member outside the game region and can be gripped from the front side of the game board.

遊技盀を支持枠前方から着脱する構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀の着脱を容易化できる反面、以䞋の䞍郜合が生じやすくなるず想定される。぀たり、遊技盀の遊技領域に配された釘や可倉衚瀺装眮等の各皮構成が䜜業者偎を向くこずで、遊技盀を支持枠の背面偎から着脱する構成ず比范しお、それら各皮構成が遊技盀着脱時の把持の察象ずしお遞択されやすくなる。遊技領域内の構成が把持されるこずは、遊技性の意図せぬ倉化等を招く芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。   When the configuration in which the game board is attached / detached from the front of the support frame is adopted, it is assumed that the following disadvantages are likely to occur, while the attachment / detachment of the game board can be facilitated. That is, various configurations such as nails and variable display devices arranged in the game area of the game board face the operator side, so that these various configurations are compared with the configuration in which the game board is detached from the back side of the support frame. It becomes easy to be selected as an object to be gripped when the game board is attached / detached. Holding the configuration in the game area is not preferable because it may cause an unintended change in game play.

この点、本特城によれば、装着時及び取倖時の䞡方にお把持可胜な郚䜍を遊技領域倖に蚭けるこずで遊技領域内に配眮されおいる釘等の各皮構成が把持の察象ずしお遞択される機䌚を枛らすこずができる。すなわち、遊技領域内に配眮された各皮構成が把持されるこずを抑制し、遊技盀の着脱䜜業に起因した遊技性の倉化等を抑えるこずができる。   In this regard, according to this feature, various components such as nails arranged in the game area are selected as objects to be gripped by providing a part that can be gripped both when mounted and removed outside the game area. Can reduce the chance of being played. In other words, it is possible to suppress gripping of various components arranged in the game area, and it is possible to suppress a change in gameability or the like due to the game board attaching / detaching operation.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の䞀偎郚が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀における回動先端偎に配されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D2. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) provided on the support frame and into which one side portion of the game board is inserted;
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
The gaming machine according to D1, wherein the gripping part is arranged on a rotating front end side of the gaming board.

遊技盀に察しお、単に把持郚を蚭けただけでは、䜜業者が同把持郚を積極的に掻甚しおもらえるずは限らない。この点、本特城によれば、把持郚を掻甚するこずによる遊技盀の装着䜜業の容易化を明らかなものずし、同把持郚を掻甚するこずによるメリットを曎に高めるこずで、䜜業者に察しお把持郚の掻甚を促がすこずができる。   Simply providing a gripping portion for the game board does not necessarily mean that an operator will actively use the gripping portion. In this regard, according to this feature, it becomes clear that the game board can be easily attached by utilizing the gripping portion, and the merit by utilizing the gripping portion is further enhanced, thereby The use of the gripping part can be promoted.

䟋えば、遊技盀を装着する際には床等に眮かれた遊技盀の把持郚を把持したたた同遊技盀を持ち䞊げお、支持枠の挿入郚に遊技盀を挿入する。把持郚は、遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮されおいるので、遊技盀の持ち替えを必芁ずするこずなく、遊技盀を容易に回動させるこずができる。このため、把持郚が、遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮されおいる堎合ず比范しお、遊技盀の回動䜜業が行いやすくなる。このように、把持郚の利甚によるメリットを高めるこずで、遊技領域内の各皮構成が把持される機䌚を䜎枛できる。   For example, when the game board is mounted, the game board is lifted while holding the holding part of the game board placed on the floor or the like, and the game board is inserted into the insertion part of the support frame. Since the grip portion is arranged on the rotation tip side of the game board, the game board can be easily rotated without requiring the game board to be changed. For this reason, compared with the case where the holding | gripping part is arrange | positioned at the rotation base end side of a game board, it becomes easy to perform the rotation operation | work of a game board. As described above, by increasing the merit of using the gripping portion, it is possible to reduce the chance that various configurations in the game area are gripped.

特城前蚘支持枠によっお回動可胜に支持され、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠を備え、
前蚘挿入郚は、前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ず同䞀偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに、同支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ずは反察偎に開攟されおおり、その開攟されおいる偎から前蚘遊技盀が挿入されるものであり、
前蚘把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀においお前蚘挿入郚に挿入される偎ずは反察偎に蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D3. A door body (front door frame 14) that is rotatably supported by the support frame and covers the game board from the front;
The insertion portion is provided on the same side of the support frame as the side on which the door body is supported, and is open on the opposite side of the support frame from the side on which the door body is supported. The game board is inserted from the opened side,
The gaming machine according to D2, wherein the grip portion is provided on the opposite side of the gaming board from the side inserted into the insertion portion.

扉䜓によっお遊技盀詳しくは遊技領域を遊技機前方から芆う構成においおは、遊技盀の着脱が同扉䜓によっお邪魔されるこずで、䜜業を行いづらくなるず想定される。このような構成に、特城を適甚するこずで、䞊蚘䞍郜合を払拭し実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In the configuration in which the game board (specifically, the game area) is covered from the front of the gaming machine by the door body, it is assumed that it is difficult to perform the operation because the door body is obstructed by the door body. By applying the feature D2 to such a configuration, it is possible to eliminate the above disadvantages and realize a practically preferable configuration.

具䜓的には、扉䜓の回動基端偎に蚭けられた挿入郚に察しお遊技盀を挿入し、同遊技盀を回動させるこずで装着䜜業が行われる。把持郚が遊技盀においお挿入郚に挿入される偎ずは反察偎すなわち遊技盀の回動先端偎に蚭けられおいるこずで、䜜業スペヌスの確保が容易なものずなる。䟋えば、遊技ホヌルの島蚭備等では、隣り合う遊技機等によっお扉䜓の回動範囲が制限を受けやすくなるが、このような堎合であっおも、扉䜓ずの干枉を回避し、䞊蚘䜜業スペヌスを容易に確保できる。   Specifically, the mounting operation is performed by inserting the game board into the insertion portion provided on the rotation base end side of the door body and rotating the game board. Since the grip portion is provided on the opposite side of the game board from the side where it is inserted into the insertion section (that is, the rotation front end side of the game board), it is easy to secure the work space. For example, in a game hall island facility, etc., the range of rotation of the door body is likely to be limited by adjacent gaming machines, etc., but even in such a case, interference with the door body is avoided and the above work is performed. Space can be secured easily.

たた、遊技盀の取倖䜜業時においおも同様に、扉䜓ずの干枉を回避し、遊技盀を移動させるための䜜業スペヌスを容易に確保できる。このように、遊技盀の着脱䜜業を容易化できる䜍眮に把持郚を配するこずで、同把持郚の掻甚を促進し、遊技領域内に配された各皮構成が把持される可胜性を枛らすこずができる。   Similarly, when the game board is removed, it is possible to avoid interference with the door and easily secure a work space for moving the game board. In this way, by arranging the gripping portion at a position where the game board can be easily attached and detached, the utilization of the gripping portion is promoted and the possibility that various configurations arranged in the game area are gripped is reduced. Can do.

特城前蚘遊技盀においお前蚘遊技領域区画郚材よりも同遊技盀の回動基端偎に蚭けられ、同遊技領域区画郚材ず共に前蚘遊技領域を区画し、遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構から発射された遊技球を同遊技領域に導く誘導レヌル誘導レヌルを備えおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature D4. The game board is provided on the rotation base end side of the game board with respect to the game area partition member, partitions the game area together with the game area partition member, and fires from a game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110). The gaming machine according to D2 or D3, further comprising a guide rail (guide rail 100) for guiding the played game ball to the game area.

特城によれば、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球は誘導レヌルに着地した埌、同誘導レヌルによっお遊技領域に導かれる。誘導レヌルにおいおは、遊技球の着地䜍眮や角床によっお同誘導レヌルによる遊技球の誘導態様が倉化する可胜性がある。぀たり、誘導レヌルの䜍眮がばら぀いお遊技球の着地䜍眮粟床が䜎䞋するこずで、それら遊技球の円滑な誘導が劚げられるおそれがある。そこで、本特城においおは、誘導レヌルず遊技領域区画郚材ずを別䜓で蚭けるこずにより、把持郚が把持された堎合に発生する負荷によっお誘導レヌルの䜍眮粟床が䜎䞋するこずを抑制可胜ずしおいる。たた、遊技盀を挿入郚に挿入した埌回動させる構成においお、誘導レヌルを遊技領域区画郚材よりも回動基端偎、すなわち遊技領域区画郚材を誘導レヌルよりも回動先端偎に配眮するこずで、遊技盀の回動䜜業の容易化に貢献しおいる。   According to the feature D4, the game ball launched from the game ball launching device is guided to the game area by the guide rail after landing on the guide rail. In the guide rail, the guidance mode of the game ball by the guide rail may change depending on the landing position and angle of the game ball. That is, since the position of the guide rail varies and the landing position accuracy of the game balls decreases, there is a risk that smooth guidance of the game balls may be hindered. Therefore, in this feature, by providing the guide rail and the game area partitioning member separately, it is possible to suppress a decrease in the positional accuracy of the guide rail due to a load generated when the grip portion is gripped. Further, in the configuration in which the game board is rotated after being inserted into the insertion portion, the guide rail is disposed on the pivot base end side with respect to the game area partition member, that is, the game area partition member is disposed on the pivot tip side with respect to the guide rail. Therefore, it contributes to the easy rotation of the game board.

誘導レヌルは、遊技領域内に配された各皮構成ず比范しお同等以䞊に把持察象ずしお遞択されやすいず想定されるが、䞊述した遊技球の着地䜍眮粟床向䞊の芳点から誘導レヌルが把持されるこずは奜たしくない。この点、特城扉䜓を有する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは特に、誘導レヌルず比范しお把持郚ぞのアクセスを容易化できる。蚀い換えれば、誘導レヌルが把持察象ずしお遞択される可胜性を䜎枛できる。これにより、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   The guide rail is assumed to be more easily selected as a gripping object than the various configurations arranged in the game area, but the guide rail is gripped from the viewpoint of improving the landing position accuracy of the game ball described above. That is not preferred. In this regard, in particular, in combination with the feature D3 (configuration having a door), access to the grip portion can be facilitated as compared with the guide rail. In other words, the possibility that the guide rail is selected as a gripping object can be reduced. Thereby, a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘把持郚は、個別に蚭けられた第把持郚第把持郚及び第把持郚第把持郚を有しおなり、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀においお前蚘挿入郚に挿入される偎ずは反察の端郚寄りに配眮されおおり、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀においお自身の回動基端偎から回動先端偎に延びる端郚寄りに配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D5. The grip part includes a first grip part (first grip part 481) and a second grip part (second grip part 482) provided individually,
The first gripping part is disposed near the end opposite to the side inserted into the insertion part in the game board,
The game according to any one of D2 to D4, wherein the second gripping portion is disposed near an end portion extending from the rotation base end side to the rotation front end side of the game board. Machine.

特城によれば、第把持郚及び第把持郚を個別に蚭けるこずで、遊技領域内に配された各皮構成が觊れられる機䌚を曎に䜎枛するこずができる。遊技盀は䟋えば䞊蚘各皮構成ずしお倚数の釘釘や衚瀺装眮可倉衚瀺ナニット等を備えおいるこずが倚く、その重量が嵩む傟向にある。このように重量が嵩んでいる堎合、仮に把持郚を぀だけ蚭定するず、䜜業者は遊技盀を支える際に把持郚を把持しおいる手ず反察の手で遊技盀の任意の箇所を把持するず想定される。この点、予め第把持郚及び第把持郚を蚭定しおおけば、そのような機䌚を枛らすこずができる。   According to the feature D5, by providing the first gripping part and the second gripping part individually, it is possible to further reduce the chance that the various components arranged in the game area can be touched. For example, game boards often include a large number of nails (nails 87), a display device (variable display unit 85), etc. as the above-mentioned various configurations, and the weight tends to increase. When the weight is increased in this way, if only one gripping part is set, the operator grips an arbitrary part of the game board with a hand opposite to the hand holding the grip part when supporting the game board. It is assumed. In this regard, if the first grip portion and the second grip portion are set in advance, such opportunities can be reduced.

特に、第把持郚を遊技盀においお挿入郚に挿入される偎ず反察の端郚寄りに配眮し、第把持郚を遊技盀においお自身の回動基端偎から回動先端偎に延びる端郚寄りに配眮するこずで、遊技盀の重みを支えやすくし぀぀、遊技盀を持った際に䞡手が亀差するこずを抑制できる。これにより、䜜業の容易化を目的ずしお遊技領域内の各皮構成が䜜業者によっお積極的に把持されるずいった可胜性を䜎くするこずができる。   In particular, the first gripping portion is disposed near the end opposite to the side inserted into the insertion portion in the game board, and the second gripping portion is an end extending from the rotation base end side to the rotation tip end side in the game board. Arranging closer to the part makes it easier to support the weight of the game board, while suppressing the crossing of both hands when holding the game board. Thereby, it is possible to reduce the possibility that various components in the game area are actively held by the worker for the purpose of facilitating the work.

特城前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞊端偎に配眮され、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端偎に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D6. The first grip portion is disposed on an upper end side of the game board,
The gaming machine according to D5, wherein the second gripping portion is disposed on a lower end side of the gaming board.

特城に瀺した構成を実珟するには、本特城に瀺すように第把持郚を遊技盀の䞊端偎、第把持郚を遊技盀の䞋端偎に配眮するずよい。これにより、遊技盀を把持しおいる腕が遊技領域の前方に䜍眮するこずを抑制し、遊技領域に配された各皮遊技郚品に察しお腕が圓たるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。たた、䞡把持郚を䞊䞋に離しお配眮するこずで、遊技盀を把持した際のバランス向䞊に貢献できる。   In order to realize the configuration shown in the feature D5, as shown in this feature, the first gripping portion may be disposed on the upper end side of the game board and the second gripping portion may be disposed on the lower end side of the game board. Thereby, it is possible to suppress the arm holding the game board from being positioned in front of the game area, and to reduce the inconvenience of the arm hitting various game components arranged in the game area. In addition, by disposing both gripping portions apart from each other, it is possible to contribute to improving the balance when the game board is gripped.

特城前蚘遊技領域区画郚材は、
圓該遊技領域区画郚材においお前蚘遊技領域偎を向いおいる郚分に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の誘導レヌル誘導レヌルに沿っお打ち出された遊技球が衝突した堎合にその衝突によっお発生する衝撃の䞀郚を吞収するずずもに、同遊技球を跳ね返す返し郚返しゎムを備え、
前蚘返し郚及び前蚘第把持郚は、同返し郚を前蚘遊技領域の内偎、同第把持郚を前蚘遊技領域の倖偎ずしお同遊技領域の内倖に䞊蚭されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D7. The game area partition member is
The game area partition member is provided in a portion facing the game area side, and when a game ball launched along the guide rail (guide rail 100) of the game board collides, the impact generated by the collision is reduced. A part that absorbs a part and bounces the game ball back (return rubber 490),
The return portion and the first gripping portion are arranged side by side inside and outside the game region with the return portion inside the game region and the first grip portion outside the game region. Or the game machine as described in D6.

遊技盀が持ち䞊げられた状態では同遊技盀の自重による負荷は、把持郚遊技領域区画郚材に集䞭しやすいず想定される。このように負荷が集䞭しやすい郚分においおは、それに耐え埗る匷床が必芁になる。この点、本特城によれば、返し郚ず第把持郚ずを遊技領域の内倖に䞊蚭するこずで、すなわち元来匷床の確保が求められる郚分返し郚が蚭けられおいる郚分に近づけお第把持郚を蚭けるこずで、匷床を確保すべき箇所を集玄し、匷床確保に必芁な領域の広がりを抑えるこずができる。これにより、遊技領域区画郚材によっお遊技領域が圧迫されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   In the state where the game board is lifted, it is assumed that the load due to the weight of the game board tends to concentrate on the gripping part (game area partition member). In such a portion where the load tends to concentrate, the strength that can withstand the load is required. In this regard, according to this feature, the return portion and the first gripping portion are arranged in parallel inside and outside the game area, that is, in a portion where securing of strength is originally required (a portion where the return portion is provided). By providing the first grip portions close to each other, it is possible to consolidate the places where the strength should be ensured and to suppress the spread of the area necessary for securing the strength. Accordingly, it is possible to make it difficult for the game area to be compressed by the game area partition member.

なお、特城等誘導レヌルを有する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、本特城に瀺した「誘導レヌル」を特城等の「誘導レヌル」ず同䞀のものずしおもよい。   In combination with the feature D4 or the like (configuration having a guide rail), the “guide rail” shown in this feature may be the same as the “guide rail” such as the feature D4.

因みに、本特城に瀺した技術的思想を特城乃至等に適甚するこずも可胜である。この堎合、本特城を倉曎し「前蚘遊技領域区画郚材は、圓該遊技領域区画郚材においお前蚘遊技領域偎を向いおいる郚分に蚭けられ、前蚘誘導レヌルに沿っお打ち出された遊技球が衝突した堎合にその衝突によっお発生する衝撃の䞀郚を吞収するずずもに、同遊技球を跳ね返す返し郚返しゎムを備え、前蚘返し郚及び前蚘把持郚は、同返し郚を前蚘遊技領域の内偎、同把持郚を前蚘遊技領域の倖偎ずしお前蚘遊技領域の内倖に䞊蚭されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機」ずするずよい。   Incidentally, the technical idea shown in this feature can be applied to the features D1 to D4 and the like. In this case, this feature is changed, and “the game area partition member is provided in a part of the game area partition member facing the game area side, and a game ball launched along the guide rail collides. And a part for returning the game ball to rebound (return rubber 490), and the return part and the gripping part have the same return part inside the game area. The gaming machine according to any one of D1 to D4, characterized in that a gripping portion is provided outside and inside the gaming area and arranged inside and outside the gaming area.

特城前蚘遊技盀に察しお前蚘遊技領域区画郚材を固定する第固定手段ネゞを備え、
前蚘第固定手段は、前蚘返し郚ず前蚘第把持郚ずの間に配されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D8. First fixing means (screw 491) for fixing the game area partition member to the game board,
The gaming machine according to D7, wherein the first fixing means is disposed between the return portion and the first gripping portion.

特城によれば、返し郚ず第把持郚ずの間に第固定手段を配するこずで、同第固定手段を返し郚の匷床確保甚及び第把持郚の匷床確保甚ずしお兌甚するこずができる。これにより、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   According to the feature D8, by arranging the first fixing means between the return portion and the first gripping portion, the first fixing means can be used for securing the strength of the return portion and securing the strength of the first gripping portion. can do. Thereby, a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘遊技盀に蚭けられた誘導レヌル誘導レヌルは、前蚘遊技領域を流䞋した遊技球を前蚘遊技盀に圢成された排出口アりト口に導くずずもに、その排出口よりも䞊偎にお前蚘遊技盀の回動先端偎に開攟されおおり、
前蚘遊技領域区画郚材は、前蚘誘導レヌルの開攟郚分を芆っおおり、
曎に、前蚘遊技領域区画郚材には、前蚘誘導レヌルにおける䞋偎の開攟端ず前蚘排出口ずの間にお、同誘導レヌルに䞋偎から察向する察向郚察向郚を有しおおり、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘察向郚に察しお前蚘誘導レヌルずは反察偎に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D9. The guide rail (guide rail 100) provided on the game board guides the game ball flowing down the game area to a discharge port (out port 86) formed in the game board, and above the discharge port. Open to the rotation tip side of the game board,
The game area partition member covers an open portion of the guide rail,
Furthermore, the game area partition member has a facing portion (facing portion 485) facing the same guide rail from below between the lower open end of the guide rail and the discharge port. ,
The gaming machine according to any one of D5 to D8, wherein the second gripping portion is disposed on the opposite side of the guide rail with respect to the facing portion.

特城によれば、遊技領域に達した遊技球の䞀郚は遊技領域を流䞋する過皋で䟋えば入球口䞀般入賞口等に入球するが、同入球口に入球しなかった遊技球に぀いおは誘導レヌルによっお排出口に導かれるこずずなる。この誘導レヌルに぀いおは、遊技盀の回動先端偎に開攟されおおり、その開攟端及びその呚蟺での匷床が同誘導レヌルにおける他の郚䜍ず比べお䜎くなりやすい。たた、遊技領域を流䞋した遊技球が衝突するこずで、誘導レヌルに負荷が加わりやすくなるず想定される。仮に、誘導レヌルが倉圢等した堎合には、遊技球の円滑な排出が劚げられるず懞念される。   According to the feature D9, part of the game balls that have reached the game area enter, for example, the entrance (such as the general winning opening 81) in the process of flowing down the game area, but do not enter the entrance area. The game balls are guided to the discharge port by the guide rail. About this guide rail, it is open | released at the rotation front end side of a game board, and the intensity | strength in the open end and its periphery tends to become low compared with the other site | part in the guide rail. In addition, it is assumed that a load is easily applied to the guide rail due to the collision of the game balls flowing down the game area. If the guide rail is deformed, there is a concern that the smooth discharge of the game ball will be hindered.

この点、本特城においおは、遊技領域区画郚材が誘導レヌルに察しお䞋偎から察向する察向郚を有しおいる。すなわち、遊技領域区画郚材の䞀郚察向郚が誘導レヌルず内倖に重なっおいる。䟋えば誘導レヌルが察向郚に圓接した堎合に同誘導レヌルの倉圢や䜍眮ずれ等を抑えるこずが可胜であり、誘導レヌルの誘導機胜をバックアップし、䞊述した䞍郜合を奜適に払拭できる。   In this regard, in this feature, the game area partition member has a facing portion that faces the guide rail from below. That is, a part (opposing portion) of the game area partition member overlaps with the guide rail inside and outside. For example, when the guide rail comes into contact with the facing portion, it is possible to suppress the deformation and displacement of the guide rail, and the guidance function of the guide rail can be backed up, and the above-described inconveniences can be suitably eliminated.

なお、特城等誘導レヌルを有する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、本特城に瀺した「誘導レヌル」を特城等の「誘導レヌル」ず同䞀のものずしおもよい。   In combination with the feature D4 or the like (configuration having a guide rail), the “guide rail” shown in this feature may be the same as the “guide rail” such as the feature D4.

特城前蚘遊技盀に察しお前蚘遊技領域区画郚材を固定する第固定手段ネゞを備え、
前蚘第固定手段は、前蚘察向郚ず前蚘第把持郚ずの間に配されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D10. A second fixing means (screw 491) for fixing the game area partition member to the game board;
The game machine according to D9, wherein the second fixing means is disposed between the facing portion and the second gripping portion.

特城によれば、察向郚ず第把持郚ずの間に第固定手段を配するこずで、同第固定手段を誘導レヌルのバックアップ甚及び第把持郚の匷床確保甚ずしお兌甚するこずができる。これにより、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   According to the feature D10, by disposing the second fixing means between the facing portion and the second gripping portion, the second fixing means can be used both for backup of the guide rail and for securing the strength of the second gripping portion. be able to. Thereby, a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城遊技機毎に固有ずなる識別情報が付䞎された識別手段蚌玙を備え、
前蚘遊技領域区画郚材は、前蚘識別手段を蚭眮する蚭眮郚ナニット収容郚を有し、
前蚘蚭眮郚は、前蚘察向郚に察しお前蚘誘導レヌルずは反察偎に配されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D11. Provided with identification means (certificate 492) to which identification information unique to each gaming machine is given,
The game area partition member has an installation part (unit accommodation part 486) for installing the identification means;
The gaming machine according to D9 or D10, wherein the installation portion is arranged on the opposite side of the guide rail with respect to the facing portion.

特城に瀺したように、遊技領域区画郚材が察向郚を有する構成を採甚した堎合には、遊技領域区画郚材における察向郚呚りでの匷床を向䞊させるこずで䞊述した誘導レヌルのバックアップ機胜を向䞊するこずができる。このような匷床の向䞊を実珟するには、遊技領域区画郚材を倧型化するこずが぀の手法ずしお考えられる。この点、識別手段甚の蚭眮郚を遊技領域区画郚材に蚭け、その蚭眮郚ず察向郚ずを䜵存させるこずで、遊技領域区画郚材の占有スペヌスを有効利甚できる。぀たり、遊技領域区画郚材の匷床向䞊ず識別手段の蚭眮郚確保すなわちスペヌスの有効利甚が可胜ずなり、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   As shown in the feature D9, when the configuration in which the game area partition member has the facing portion is adopted, the above-described guide rail backup function is improved by improving the strength around the facing portion of the game area partition member. can do. In order to realize such an improvement in strength, it is conceivable as one method to increase the size of the game area partition member. In this respect, by providing the game area partition member with an installation portion for identifying means and making the installation portion and the opposing portion coexist, the occupied space of the game area partition member can be effectively used. That is, it is possible to improve the strength of the game area partition member and secure the installation part of the identification means (that is, to effectively use the space), and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

なお、遊技領域区画郚材に぀いおは遊技盀からの着脱を特に必芁ずしない郚品であるため、その取り付けを匷固にしたり、装着した埌の取り倖しを䞍可ずしたりするこずも可胜である。この遊技領域区画郚材によっお識別手段の取り倖しを阻止するこずで、識別手段の䞍正な取り倖し等を抑制し防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。䟋えば、識別手段を遊技領域区画郚材ずは別の郚材を甚いお遊技盀に装着する構成ず比范しお、遊技盀の前面偎のスペヌスを有効利甚できる。遊技盀の前面には遊技領域が圢成され、遊技領域倖の領域が限られおいる点を考慮すれば、遊技領域区画郚材に識別手段甚の蚭眮郚を蚭けるこずによる技術的貢献床は倧きいず考えられる。   Note that the game area partition member is a part that does not particularly need to be attached to or detached from the game board, so that the attachment thereof can be strengthened, or the attachment after the attachment can be disabled. By preventing the identification means from being removed by this game area partitioning member, unauthorized removal of the identification means can be suppressed, thereby contributing to improvement of crime prevention. For example, the space on the front side of the game board can be effectively used as compared with a configuration in which the identification means is mounted on the game board using a member different from the game area partition member. Considering the fact that a game area is formed on the front surface of the game board and the area outside the game area is limited, it is said that the technical contribution by providing the setting means for the identification means on the game area partition member is large. Conceivable.

特城前蚘遊技盀の䞋方に蚭けられ、遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技盀の誘導レヌルによっお前蚘遊技領域に導く遊技機であっお、
前蚘遊技領域の倖に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技盀の回動先端偎の䞋偎隅郚に配眮され、前蚘遊技盀の前蚘支持枠からの取り倖しを芏制する芏制手段ロック装眮を備え、
前蚘遊技領域区画郚材は、前蚘遊技盀における回動先端偎の瞁郚に沿っお䞊䞋に延びるずずもに、その䞋偎の端郚が前蚘芏制手段を前蚘遊技領域偎から迂回しお前蚘遊技盀の䞋端郚に達しおおり、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技領域区画郚材においお前蚘芏制手段に察しお前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に配されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D12. A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) provided below the game board and launching a game ball;
A gaming machine that guides a game ball launched from the game ball launcher to the game area by a guide rail of the game board,
A restricting means (lock device 400) provided outside the game area and disposed at a lower corner of the rotation front side of the game board for restricting removal of the game board from the support frame. Prepared,
The game area partition member extends vertically along an edge on the rotation tip side of the game board, and a lower end of the game area partition member bypasses the restricting means from the game area side to lower the lower end of the game board Has reached the department,
In any one of D5 to D11, the second gripping portion is arranged at a position that is on a rotation base end side of the game board with respect to the restriction means in the game area partition member. The gaming machine described.

特城によれば、同遊技盀の回動基端偎の䞋偎隅郚に配眮された芏制手段によっお遊技盀の取り倖しを芏制するこずで、同遊技盀の䞋端偎での䜍眮ずれ等を奜適に抑制できる。これにより、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球の誘導レヌルにおける着地䜍眮のばら぀きを奜適に抑えるこずができる。   According to the feature D12, by controlling the removal of the game board by the restriction means arranged at the lower corner portion on the rotation base end side of the game board, it is preferable to shift the position on the lower end side of the game board. Can be suppressed. Thereby, the dispersion | variation in the landing position in the guide rail of the game ball launched from the game ball launching device can be suitably suppressed.

たた、遊技盀を回動させお装着する構成においおは、その回動先端偎での䜍眮ばら぀き等が回動基端偎に比べお顕著になるず想定される。故に、芏制手段を回動基端偎の端郚に寄せお配眮するこずが奜たしい。本特城においおは、第把持郚を芏制手段よりも回動基端偎に配眮するこずで、芏制手段の回動先端偎ぞ寄せやすくできる。たた、第把持郚に関しおは、遊技盀着脱時のアクセスの容易化を考慮すれば、遊技盀の呚瞁詳しくは䞋端瞁に寄せお配眮するこずが奜たしい。぀たり、芏制手段のみならず第把持郚に぀いおも、遊技盀の䞋端に寄せお配眮するこが奜たしい。この点、遊技領域区画郚材が芏制手段を迂回しお延びおいるこずで、第把持郚を遊技盀䞭倮に近づけるこずが可胜ずなるだけでなく、遊技盀の䞋端瞁に寄せお配眮するこずが可胜ずなっおいる。そしお、同第把持郚を芏制手段に察しお回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮に配眮するこずで、遊技盀を持ち䞊げおいる状態での安定性向䞊を図り、曎には遊技盀の䞋端偎に配眮するこずで第把持郚ぞのアクセス容易化を図っおいる。故に、第把持郚ず芏制手段ずを奜適に共存させるこずができる。   In addition, in the configuration in which the game board is rotated and mounted, it is assumed that the positional variation and the like on the rotation front end side becomes conspicuous as compared with the rotation base end side. Therefore, it is preferable that the restricting means is arranged close to the end portion on the rotation base end side. In this feature, the second gripping portion can be easily moved closer to the rotation distal end side of the restriction means by disposing the second grip portion on the rotation base end side than the restriction means. Further, the second gripping portion is preferably arranged close to the peripheral edge (specifically, the lower edge) of the game board in consideration of easy access when the game board is attached / detached. That is, it is preferable that not only the restricting means but also the second gripping portion is arranged close to the lower end of the game board. In this regard, since the game area partition member extends around the restricting means, it is possible not only to bring the second gripping portion closer to the center of the game board but also to place it close to the lower edge of the game board. Is possible. Then, by arranging the second gripping portion at a position on the rotation base end side with respect to the regulating means, stability is improved in a state where the game board is lifted, and further on the lower end side of the game board. Arrangement facilitates access to the second gripping portion. Therefore, the 2nd holding part and a regulation means can be made to coexist suitably.

特城前蚘遊技盀の䞋方に蚭けられ、遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技盀の誘導レヌルによっお前蚘遊技領域に導く遊技機であっお、
前蚘遊技領域倖に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技盀の回動先端偎に配眮され、前蚘遊技盀の前蚘支持枠からの取り倖しを芏制する芏制手段ロック装眮を備え、
前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚入口郚分及び前蚘芏制手段は、同入口郚が同芏制手段よりも前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎ずなるようにしお同遊技盀の䞋端瞁に沿っお䞊蚭されおおり、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘芏制手段ず前蚘入口郚ずの間に配されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D13. A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) provided below the game board and launching a game ball;
A gaming machine that guides a game ball launched from the game ball launcher to the game area by a guide rail of the game board,
A regulation means (lock device 400) that is provided outside the game area and is disposed on a rotating front end side of the game board and regulates removal of the game board from the support frame;
The guide rail entrance portion (entrance portion 104) and the restricting means are arranged along the lower edge of the game board so that the entrance portion is closer to the rotation base end side of the game board than the restricting means. Has been established,
The gaming machine according to any one of D5 to D11, wherein the second gripping portion is disposed between the restricting means and the inlet portion.

特城によれば、芏制手段及び誘導レヌルの入口郚を遊技盀の䞋端瞁に沿っお䞊蚭するこずで誘導レヌルの入口郚の䜍眮ばら぀きを抑制できる。これにより、誘導レヌルにおける遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀き抑制に貢献でき、遊技球の誘導の円滑化に貢献できる。   According to the feature D13, variation in the position of the entrance portion of the guide rail can be suppressed by arranging the restricting means and the entrance portion of the guide rail along the lower edge of the game board. As a result, it is possible to contribute to suppressing variation in the landing position of the game ball on the guide rail, and to contribute to smooth guidance of the game ball.

たた、第把持郚を芏制手段ず誘導レヌルの入口郚ずの間に配眮するこずで、遊技球発射装眮から誘導レヌルぞの遊技球の移動を蚱容し぀぀、遊技盀を持ち䞊げおいる際のバランス維持機胜ず遊技盀の䜍眮ずれ抑制機胜ずを奜適に向䞊させるこずができ、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   Further, by disposing the second gripping portion between the restricting means and the entrance portion of the guide rail, the game board is lifted while allowing the game ball to move from the game ball launching device to the guide rail. The balance maintaining function and the game board position shift suppressing function can be preferably improved, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘第把持郚及び前蚘第把持郚のうち䞀方は、前蚘遊技盀における回動先端偎に開攟され、同回動先端偎から回動基端偎に凹んでいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature D14. One of the first gripping portion and the second gripping portion is open to the rotating front end side of the game board and is recessed from the rotating front end side to the rotating base end side. The gaming machine according to any one of D13.

特城によれば、把持郚凹み郚分に指を差し蟌むこずにより、指の差し蟌み方向ず、挿入郚ぞの遊技盀の挿入方向が同䞀ずなる。これにより、遊技盀の差し蟌み䜜業を容易化できる。   According to the feature D14, by inserting a finger into the grip portion (dented portion), the insertion direction of the finger is the same as the insertion direction of the game board into the insertion portion. Thereby, the insertion operation of the game board can be facilitated.

たた、把持郚を突起等によっお構成し、遊技盀の着脱䜜業時には同突起を摘たんだり握ったりする構成ず比范するず、遊技盀の重量の支えやすさ及び回動させやすさの点で本特城に瀺す構成の方が優れおいるず考えられる。蚀い換えれば、突起等の構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀の着脱䜜業の過皋で、持ち替えの行われる可胜性が高くなるず想定される。曎には、遊技盀を着脱する過皋においおはただしも、遊技盀を茞送する過皋では、突起以倖の郚䜍が把持される可胜性が高たるず懞念される。以䞊の理由から、把持郚に察しお本特城に瀺す技術的思想を採甚するメリットは倧きいず考えられる。   In addition, compared to a configuration in which the gripping part is constituted by a protrusion, etc., and the protrusion is picked or gripped when attaching or detaching the game board, this feature is characterized in that the weight of the game board is easier to support and easier to rotate. It is considered that the configuration shown in FIG. In other words, when a structure such as a protrusion is adopted, it is assumed that the possibility of switching is increased in the process of attaching / detaching the game board. Furthermore, in the process of attaching and detaching the game board, there is a concern that in the process of transporting the game board, there is an increased possibility that parts other than the protrusions will be gripped. For the above reasons, it is considered that the merit of adopting the technical idea shown in the present feature for the grip portion is great.

特城前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀における回動先端偎に開攟され、同回動先端偎から回動基端偎に凹み、
前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋方に開攟され、䞊方に凹んでいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D15. The first gripping part is opened to a rotating front end side of the game board, and is recessed from the rotating front end side to a rotating base end side,
The gaming machine according to any one of D5 to D14, wherein the second gripping portion is opened below the gaming board and recessed upward.

特城によれば、特城に瀺した構成を奜適に実珟できる。具䜓的には、遊技盀に正察した状態で、同遊技盀の挿入方向先偎の手で䞋偎の第把持郚を把持し、反察偎の手で䞊偎の第把持郚を把持する。この状態で、遊技盀を支持枠に装着するならば、遊技盀の重量を第把持郚偎の手で支え぀぀、第把持郚偎の手で遊技盀を挿入郚に抌すこずにより、遊技盀の装着䜜業を円滑に行うこずができる。   According to the feature D15, the configuration shown in the feature D3 can be suitably realized. Specifically, in a state of facing the game board, the lower second gripping part is gripped by the hand in the insertion direction ahead of the game board, and the upper first gripping part is gripped by the opposite hand. . In this state, if the game board is mounted on the support frame, the game board is pushed by the hand on the first holding part side to the insertion part while supporting the weight of the game board with the hand on the second holding part side. The board can be installed smoothly.

特城前蚘第把持郚は、前蚘第把持郚よりも前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎に寄っおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature D16. The gaming machine according to any one of D5 to D15, wherein the second gripping part is closer to a rotation base end side of the game board than the first gripping part.

特城によれば、各把持郚を把持した堎合に、䞡の手が亀差するこずを抑制でき、遊技盀の持ちやすさ向䞊にも貢献できる。   According to the feature D16, when each grip part is gripped, it is possible to suppress the crossing of both hands, and it is possible to contribute to improving the ease of holding the game board.

遊技盀を支持枠から取り倖すず、䜜業者が遊技盀の重量を支える必芁が生じる。仮に遊技盀の挿入操䜜回転操䜜のみを考慮しお把持郚を配眮するず、遊技盀の重量を支えにくくなり埗る。これに察凊しお䜜業者が持ち替えを行った堎合は、持ちやすさを向䞊できる反面、䜜業効率は悪化するず想定される。特に、このような持ち替えが行われる堎合には、遊技領域内の構成が掎たれるずいった䞍郜合の発生頻床が高たるず懞念される。この点、本特城によれば、各把持郚の配眮を䞊述の劂く工倫するこずで、そのような䞍郜合を回避できる。   When the game board is removed from the support frame, an operator needs to support the weight of the game board. If the grip portion is disposed only in consideration of the insertion operation and rotation operation of the game board, it may be difficult to support the weight of the game board. When the worker changes the handle in response to this, it is possible to improve the ease of holding, but the work efficiency is expected to deteriorate. In particular, when such a change is performed, there is a concern that the frequency of occurrence of inconvenience such as grasping the configuration in the game area will increase. In this regard, according to this feature, such inconvenience can be avoided by devising the arrangement of the gripping portions as described above.

たた、第把持郚ず比べお、第把持郚は遊技盀の重量を支える圹割が倧きい郚分である。この第把持郚を第把持郚よりも回動基端偎䟋えば遊技盀の䞭倮寄りに配眮するこずで、遊技盀を支えやすい構成を実珟できる。   Further, the second grip portion is a portion that plays a larger role in supporting the weight of the game board than the first grip portion. By disposing the second grip portion closer to the rotation base end side than the first grip portion (for example, near the center of the game board), it is possible to realize a configuration that can easily support the game board.

特城前蚘支持枠には、前蚘遊技盀の背面に察向するベヌス郚察向板郚ず、そのベヌス郚から前方に起立する起立壁郚呚壁郚ずによっお区画されおなる遊技盀収容郚遊技盀収容郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘把持郚は、前蚘遊技盀収容郚に前蚘遊技盀が収容された状態にお、前蚘遊技盀収容郚から突出しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D17. The support frame is divided into a base part (opposing plate part 251) facing the back of the game board and a standing wall part (peripheral wall part 261) standing forward from the base part. (Game board accommodating part 75) is formed,
The gaming machine according to any one of D1 to D16, wherein the grip portion protrudes from the game board housing portion in a state where the game board is housed in the game board housing portion.

特城によれば、遊技盀を取り倖す際に支持枠によっお把持郚ぞのアクセスが劚げられるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。たた、遊技盀を装着する際には、把持郚を把持したたた遊技盀を抌し蟌んだずしおも、把持郚を把持しおいる手ず支持枠の遊技盀収容郚ずが干枉するずいった䞍郜合を奜適に回避できる。これにより、䜜業時の持ち替えを回避し、䜜業効率の向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature D17, when removing the game board, it is possible to make it difficult to cause inconvenience that the support frame prevents access to the grip portion. Further, when the game board is mounted, even if the game board is pushed in while holding the grip part, it is preferable that the hand holding the grip part interferes with the game board housing part of the support frame. Can be avoided. As a result, it is possible to avoid changeover during work and contribute to improvement of work efficiency.

特城前蚘支持枠は、支持察象倖枠によっお開閉可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘遊技盀は、少なくずも前蚘支持枠が前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じられおいる状態にお、遊技機前方からの着脱が蚱容されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature D18. The support frame is supported by an object to be supported (outer frame 11) so as to be opened and closed,
The gaming board according to any one of D1 to D17, wherein the gaming board is allowed to be attached and detached from the front of the gaming machine at least in a state where the support frame is closed with respect to the support target. Game machines.

仮に遊技盀を支持枠の背面偎から着脱する構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀を着脱する前に支持枠を開攟する必芁が生じるず考えられる。この堎合、遊技盀を着脱する際に、支持枠が動き、同遊技盀の着脱䜜業が円滑に行えない可胜性がある。これは、特に遊技盀を装着する際に発生しやすい想定される。䞀方、このような䞍郜合を解消すべく、片方の手で支持枠を抑え぀぀、他方の手で遊技盀を装着しようずすれば、䜜業負担が増倧し埗る。この堎合、遊技盀のバランスをずろうずするず、どうしおも遊技盀の䞭倮郚分を把持する必芁が生じる。これに察応すべく、予め把持郚の䜍眮を片手䜜業に察応したものにしようずすれば、把持郚の配眮自由床を䜎䞋するこずずなる。   If a configuration in which the game board is detached from the back side of the support frame is employed, it is considered that the support frame needs to be opened before the game board is attached or detached. In this case, when the game board is attached or detached, the support frame may move, and the game board may not be attached / detached smoothly. This is assumed to occur particularly when the game board is mounted. On the other hand, in order to eliminate such inconvenience, it is possible to increase the work load if an attempt is made to mount the game board with the other hand while holding the support frame with one hand. In this case, if the game board is to be balanced, the center part of the game board must be gripped. In order to cope with this, if an attempt is made in advance to make the position of the gripping part corresponding to one-handed work, the degree of freedom of arrangement of the gripping part will be reduced.

この点、遊技盀を支持枠の前面偎から着脱する構成ずし、支持枠を支持察象に閉じた状態のたた同遊技盀の着脱䜜業を可胜ずすれば、䜜業者は䞡手で遊技盀を把持するこずが可胜ずなる。この堎合、片手で遊技盀を把持する堎合ず比范しお、同遊技盀のバランスをずるこずが容易ずなり、各把持郚の配眮に生じる制限を抑えるこずができる。故に、特城等に瀺したように遊技盀の䞭倮から倖れた䜍眮に把持郚を蚭定したずしおも、同遊技盀の着脱時の䜜業がやりにくくなるこずを回避でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In this regard, if the game board is configured to be attached / detached from the front side of the support frame and the game board can be attached / detached while the support frame is closed to the support target, the operator holds the game board with both hands. It becomes possible. In this case, it becomes easier to balance the game board as compared with the case where the game board is held with one hand, and the restriction on the arrangement of the holding parts can be suppressed. Therefore, even if the gripping part is set at a position deviated from the center of the game board as shown in the feature D2 or the like, it is possible to avoid the difficulty in performing work when the game board is attached / detached, and a practically preferable configuration is realized. it can.

特城矀
特城遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を着脱可胜に支持する支持枠内枠ず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の板面に察向する平板郚察向板郚ず、
前蚘平板郚に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を前蚘支持枠に固定する固定手段ロック装眮ず、
前蚘平板郚に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀に圢成された挿通郚貫通孔に挿通されるこずにより前蚘遊技盀の前蚘支持枠に察しおの取付䜍眮を芏定する突起䜍眮決め突起ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature E group>
Feature E1. A game board (game board 80) in which a game area (game area PE) is formed;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for detachably supporting the game board;
A flat plate portion (opposing plate portion 251) provided on the support frame and facing the plate surface of the game board;
A fixing means (lock device 400) provided on the flat plate portion and fixing the game board to the support frame;
Protrusions (positioning protrusions 259) for defining the mounting position of the game board with respect to the support frame by being inserted into an insertion part (through hole 91) provided in the flat plate part and formed in the game board. A gaming machine characterized by comprising:

特城によれば、遊技盀を支持枠に察しお着脱可胜な構成ずするこずにより、同遊技盀のメンテナンス䜜業の容易化等に貢献するこずができる。遊技盀を支持枠に取り付ける堎合には、遊技盀の挿通郚に支持枠の突起を挿通させるこずによりその䜍眮決めを行い、固定手段によっお遊技盀を支持枠に固定する。本特城においおは特に、遊技盀を固定する固定手段ず䜍眮決めを行う突起ずを同䞀の平板郚に配眮しおいる。これにより、固定手段ず突起ずの盞察䜍眮のずれを抑制し、䟋えば遊技盀を固定するこずで突起に負荷が加わるこずを抑制できる。このように、突起の保護を図るこずで、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   According to the feature E1, it is possible to contribute to facilitating maintenance work of the game board by making the game board detachable from the support frame. When the game board is attached to the support frame, positioning is performed by inserting the protrusion of the support frame through the insertion part of the game board, and the game board is fixed to the support frame by the fixing means. Particularly in this feature, the fixing means for fixing the game board and the protrusion for positioning are arranged on the same flat plate portion. Thereby, the shift | offset | difference of the relative position of a fixing means and protrusion is suppressed, and it can suppress that a load is added to protrusion by fixing a game board, for example. Thus, by protecting the projections, it is possible to contribute to improving the positional accuracy of the game board.

特城前蚘遊技領域は、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圢成されおおり、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘支持枠に察しお遊技機前方から着脱され、圓該遊技盀の背面が前蚘平板郚に察向した状態で固定されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E2. The game area is formed on the front surface of the game board,
The gaming machine according to E1, wherein the gaming board is attached to and detached from the front of the gaming machine with respect to the support frame, and is fixed with a back surface of the gaming board facing the flat plate portion.

特城においおは、遊技盀を支持枠に察しお遊技機前方から着脱する構成ずするこずにより、同遊技盀の着脱䜜業の容易化に貢献しおいる。しかしながら、遊技盀の前方からの着脱を可胜ずした堎合には、遊技盀を支持枠の埌方から着脱する構成ず比范しお、遊技盀詳しくはその前面の䜍眮粟床の確保が難しくなるず想定される。このような構成に、特城に瀺した構成を適甚すれば、同遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を高めるこずができ実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In the feature E2, the game board is configured to be attached to and detached from the front of the gaming machine with respect to the support frame, thereby contributing to the ease of attaching and detaching the game board. However, when it is possible to attach and detach the game board from the front, it is assumed that it is difficult to ensure the position accuracy of the game board (specifically, the front surface) compared to a configuration in which the game board is attached and detached from the rear of the support frame. Is done. If the configuration shown in the feature E1 is applied to such a configuration, the positional accuracy of the game board can be increased, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘支持枠には、前蚘平板郚ず、圓該平板郚から前蚘遊技盀偎に起立するずずもに同遊技盀を囲む囲み郚呚壁郚ず、によっお区画されおなる遊技盀収容郚遊技盀収容郚が圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature E3. The support frame has a game board housing portion (game board housing) defined by the flat plate portion and an enclosure portion (peripheral wall portion 261) that stands up from the flat plate portion to the game board side and surrounds the game board. A gaming machine according to E1 or E2, characterized in that part 75) is formed.

特城によれば、平板郚は囲み郚ずずもに遊技盀収容郚を圢成しおいる。この遊技盀収容郚に遊技盀を収容するこずにより、同遊技盀が突起の突出方向ず亀差する方向に抌されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくできる。たた、平板郚に同平板郚から起立する囲み郚が圢成されおいるこずにより、平板郚の剛性の確保に貢献できる。これにより、平板郚の倉圢等によっお固定手段ず突起ずの盞察䜍眮がばら぀くこずを抑制できる。   According to the feature E3, the flat plate portion forms a game board housing portion together with the surrounding portion. By housing the game board in the game board housing part, it is possible to prevent the disadvantage that the game board is pushed in a direction intersecting the protruding direction of the protrusion. Moreover, since the surrounding part which stands up from the flat plate part is formed in the flat plate part, it can contribute to ensuring the rigidity of the flat plate part. Thereby, it can suppress that the relative position of a fixing means and a processus | protrusion varies by deformation | transformation etc. of a flat plate part.

特城前蚘遊技盀は、略矩圢状をなし、
前蚘囲み郚は、前蚘遊技盀の四蟺に沿っお圢成された起立壁郚呚壁郚を構成しおいる壁郚〜がコヌナ郚を通じお連結されおなり、
前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、前蚘耇数の起立壁郚のうち぀䟋えば䞋偎壁郚に沿っお配眮されおいるずずもに、圓該起立壁郚からの距離が同等ずなるように構成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E4. The game board has a substantially rectangular shape,
The surrounding portion is formed by connecting upright wall portions (wall portions 262 to 265 constituting the peripheral wall portion 261) formed along the four sides of the game board through a corner portion,
The fixing means and the protrusion are arranged along one of the plurality of standing wall portions (for example, the lower wall portion 263), and are configured to have the same distance from the standing wall portion. The gaming machine according to E3, characterized in that:

特城に瀺すように、固定手段及び突起を起立壁郚に沿っお配眮するこずにより䞊蚘特城に瀺した剛性確保の恩恵を奜適に享受できる。たた、起立壁郚及び固定手段の距離ず同起立壁郚及び突起ずの距離を同等ずするこずにより、仮に平板郚が起立壁郚の根元郚分を基端ずしお撓んだ堎合であっおも、固定手段及び突起の盞察䜍眮のずれを抑制できる。これにより、突起に察しお負荷が加わりにくくし、遊技盀の䜍眮決め機胜の担保に貢献できる。   As shown in the feature E4, the advantage of securing the rigidity shown in the feature E3 can be suitably enjoyed by arranging the fixing means and the protrusion along the standing wall portion. Moreover, even if the flat plate portion is bent with the root portion of the standing wall portion as the base end by making the distance between the standing wall portion and the fixing means equal to the distance between the standing wall portion and the projection, A shift in the relative positions of the fixing means and the protrusion can be suppressed. Thereby, it is difficult to apply a load to the protrusion, and it is possible to contribute to ensuring the positioning function of the game board.

特城前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、それら䞡者が沿っお蚭けられた䞀の前蚘起立壁郚に連結されおいる他の起立壁郚に察しお、前蚘突起よりも前蚘固定手段の方が近くなるように配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature E5. The fixing means and the protrusion are arranged so that the fixing means is closer to the other standing wall portion connected to the one standing wall portion provided along both of them than the protrusion. The gaming machine according to E4, which is arranged.

固定手段及びその取付郚分には、固定操䜜等に䌎っお負荷が加わりやすいず想定される。固定手段ず突起ずは同䞀の平板郚に配されおいるため、固定手段の負荷が平板郚に䌝わるず、突起の䜍眮決め粟床も䜎䞋しおしたう。この点、本特城によれば、固定手段を、䞊蚘他の起立壁郚に察しお前蚘突起よりも近くなるように配眮するこずで、負荷を起立壁郚に分散させ、平板郚の倉圢等を抑制可胜ずしおいる。これにより、固定手段及び突起を同䞀の察象に蚭ける構成においおも、固定手段に発生する負荷に起因しお突起の䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋するこずを奜適に回避できる。   It is assumed that a load is likely to be applied to the fixing means and its mounting portion along with the fixing operation. Since the fixing means and the protrusion are arranged on the same flat plate portion, if the load of the fixing means is transmitted to the flat plate portion, the positioning accuracy of the protrusion also decreases. In this regard, according to this feature, the fixing means is disposed so as to be closer to the projection than the other standing wall portion, so that the load is distributed to the standing wall portion, and the deformation of the flat plate portion is performed. It can be suppressed. Thereby, even in the configuration in which the fixing unit and the protrusion are provided on the same target, it is possible to suitably avoid the decrease in the positioning accuracy of the protrusion due to the load generated on the fixing unit.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに蚘遊技盀よりも䞋偎に配眮されおおり、前蚘遊技領域に遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘遊技盀には、圓該遊技盀の前面から起立し、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に誘導する誘導レヌル誘導レヌルが蚭けられおおり、
前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚入口郚分は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配されおおり、
前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E6. A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) for launching a game ball to the game area is provided on the support frame and disposed below the game board.
The game board is provided with a guide rail (guide rail 100) that stands up from the front of the game board and guides the game ball launched from the game ball launcher to the game area,
The entrance portion (entrance portion 104) of the guide rail is arranged near the lower end of the game board,
The gaming machine according to any one of E1 to E5, wherein the fixing means and the protrusion are arranged near a lower end of the game board.

遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を誘導レヌルによっお遊技領域に導く構成においおは、遊技球が誘導レヌルに着地する䜍眮のばら぀きに起因しお、遊技球の円滑な誘導が劚げられるず懞念される。特に、着地䜍眮のばら぀きは同遊技球の着地時に誘導レヌルに生じる衝撃が倧きくなる芁因ずなり埗え、このような衝撃の増倧によっお、仮に誘導レヌル等に歪み等が生じた堎合には、䞊述した遊技球の円滑な移動が困難になるず懞念される。この点、本特城によれば、誘導レヌルの入口郚を遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮するずずもに、固定手段及び突起に぀いおも同様に遊技盀の䞋端よりに配眮するこずで、遊技盀の䞋端の䜍眮ばら぀き、すなわち誘導レヌルの入口郚の䜍眮ばら぀きを抑え、同入口郚の䜍眮粟床向䞊に貢献できる。このように、入口郚の䜍眮粟床を向䞊するこずで、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球の誘導レヌルでの着地䜍眮のばら぀きを䜎枛し、䞊述した䞍郜合を払拭するこずができる。   In the configuration in which the game ball launched from the game ball launching device is guided to the game area by the guide rail, there is a concern that smooth guidance of the game ball is hindered due to variations in the position of the game ball landing on the guide rail. The In particular, the variation in the landing position can be a factor that increases the impact generated on the guide rail when the game ball is landed. There is concern that smooth movement of game balls will be difficult. In this regard, according to this feature, the entrance portion of the guide rail is arranged near the lower end of the game board, and the fixing means and the protrusion are similarly arranged from the lower end of the game board so that the position of the lower end of the game board is obtained. The variation, that is, the position variation of the entrance portion of the guide rail can be suppressed, and the position accuracy of the entrance portion can be improved. As described above, by improving the position accuracy of the entrance portion, it is possible to reduce the variation in the landing position of the game ball launched from the game ball launching device on the guide rail, and to eliminate the above-described disadvantages.

特城前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、前蚘誘導レヌルにおける前蚘入口郚の近傍に蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature E7. The gaming machine according to E6, wherein the fixing means and the protrusion are provided in the vicinity of the entrance portion of the guide rail.

特城によれば、固定手段及び突起を誘導レヌルの入口郚近傍に配眮するこずにより、同入口郚での䜍眮粟床の曎なる向䞊に貢献できる。これにより、䞊述した着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制し、誘導レヌルの保護や遊技球の誘導の円滑化に貢献できる。   According to the feature E7, by disposing the fixing means and the protrusion in the vicinity of the entrance portion of the guide rail, it is possible to contribute to further improvement of the position accuracy at the entrance portion. Thereby, the dispersion | variation in the landing position mentioned above can be suppressed, and it can contribute to the smoothness of guidance rail protection and game ball guidance.

特城前蚘遊技盀は、略矩圢状をなし、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに、蚘遊技盀よりも䞋偎に配眮されおおり、前蚘遊技盀偎ぞ遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構を備え、
前蚘遊技盀には、圓該遊技盀の前面から起立し、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に誘導する誘導レヌル誘導レヌルが蚭けられおおり、
前蚘誘導レヌルの入口郚入口郚分は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配されおおり、
前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮されおおり、
前蚘支持枠には、前蚘遊技盀の四蟺に沿っお圢成された耇数の壁郚呚壁郚を構成しおいる壁郚〜がコヌナ郚を通じお連結されおなり、前蚘遊技盀を囲む呚壁呚壁郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘平板郚は、前蚘呚壁においお前蚘誘導レヌルの前蚘入口郚から最も近いコヌナ郚から連続しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E8. The game board has a substantially rectangular shape,
A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) that is provided on the support frame and disposed below the game board and launches a game ball to the game board side,
The game board is provided with a guide rail (guide rail 100) that stands up from the front of the game board and guides the game ball launched from the game ball launcher to the game area,
The entrance portion (entrance portion 104) of the guide rail is arranged near the lower end of the game board,
The fixing means and the protrusion are arranged near the lower end of the game board,
A plurality of wall portions (wall portions 262 to 265 constituting the peripheral wall portion 261) formed along the four sides of the game board are connected to the support frame through a corner portion, and surround the game board. A peripheral wall (peripheral wall portion 261) is formed,
The gaming machine according to any one of E1 to E5, wherein the flat plate portion is continuous from a corner portion closest to the entrance portion of the guide rail in the peripheral wall.

遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を誘導レヌルによっお遊技領域に導く構成においおは、遊技球が誘導レヌルに着地する䜍眮のばら぀きに起因しお、遊技球の円滑な誘導が劚げられるず懞念される。特に、着地䜍眮のばら぀きは同遊技球の着地時に誘導レヌルに生じる衝撃が倧きくなる芁因ずなり埗え、このような衝撃の増倧によっお、仮に誘導レヌル等に歪み等が生じた堎合には、䞊述した遊技球の円滑な移動が困難になるず懞念される。この点、本特城によれば、誘導レヌルの入口郚を遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮するずずもに、固定手段及び突起に぀いおも同様に遊技盀の䞋端よりに配眮するこずで、遊技盀の䞋端の䜍眮ばら぀き、すなわち誘導レヌルの入口郚の䜍眮ばら぀きを抑え、同入口郚の䜍眮粟床向䞊に貢献できる。このように、入口郚の䜍眮粟床を向䞊するこずで、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球の誘導レヌルでの着地䜍眮のばら぀きを䜎枛し、䞊述した䞍郜合を払拭するこずができる。   In the configuration in which the game ball launched from the game ball launching device is guided to the game area by the guide rail, there is a concern that smooth guidance of the game ball is hindered due to variations in the position of the game ball landing on the guide rail. The In particular, the variation in the landing position can be a factor that increases the impact generated on the guide rail when the game ball is landed. There is concern that smooth movement of game balls will be difficult. In this regard, according to this feature, the entrance portion of the guide rail is arranged near the lower end of the game board, and the fixing means and the protrusion are similarly arranged from the lower end of the game board so that the position of the lower end of the game board is obtained. The variation, that is, the position variation of the entrance portion of the guide rail can be suppressed, and the position accuracy of the entrance portion can be improved. As described above, by improving the position accuracy of the entrance portion, it is possible to reduce the variation in the landing position of the game ball launched from the game ball launching device on the guide rail, and to eliminate the above-described disadvantages.

たた、支持枠に圢成された呚壁によっお遊技盀が囲たれおおり、その呚壁郚においお誘導レヌルの入口郚から最も近いコヌナ郚から平板郚が連続しおいる。呚壁郚が遊技盀偎に向けお抌されるずうした堎合の遊技盀偎ぞの壁郚の倉圢量は、壁郚䞭倮ず比范しお壁郚同士の境界、すなわち䞊蚘コヌナ郚においお小さくなる。このように、倉䜍量の小さくなる郚䜍に察しお平板郚を連続させるこずで、平板郚の䜍眮粟床、すなわち突起及び固定手段の䜍眮粟床の向䞊に貢献できる。   Further, the game board is surrounded by a peripheral wall formed on the support frame, and a flat plate portion is continuous from the corner portion closest to the entrance portion of the guide rail in the peripheral wall portion. The amount of deformation of the wall part toward the game board when the peripheral wall part is pushed toward the game board side is smaller at the boundary between the wall parts, that is, at the corner part, compared to the center of the wall part. In this way, by making the flat plate portion continuous with respect to the portion where the amount of displacement becomes small, it is possible to contribute to the improvement of the positional accuracy of the flat plate portion, that is, the positional accuracy of the protrusion and the fixing means.

特城前蚘平板郚は、前蚘誘導レヌルの前蚘入口郚から最も近い前蚘コヌナ郚を介しお隣り合っおいる぀の壁郚に連続しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature E9. The gaming machine according to E8, wherein the flat plate portion is continuous with two adjacent wall portions through the corner portion closest to the entrance portion of the guide rail.

特城によれは、平板郚がコヌナ郚を介しお隣り合う぀の壁郚に連なっおいるこずで、呚壁の匷床向䞊ず、平板郚の匷床向䞊ずに貢献できる。これにより、曎なる遊技盀の䜍眮決め粟床向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature E9, since the flat plate portion is connected to two adjacent wall portions via the corner portion, it is possible to contribute to the improvement of the strength of the peripheral wall and the strength of the flat plate portion. Thereby, it can contribute to the positioning accuracy improvement of the further game board.

たた、䟋えば盞察向する぀の壁郚に跚るようにしお平板郚を圢成する堎合ず比范しお、平板郚の占有領域を小さくでき、䟋えば遊技盀の䞭倮偎ぞの匵り出しを奜適に抑えるこずができる。これにより、遊技盀に搭茉される各皮構成䟋えば制埡装眮や遊技球回収通路等ずの共存を容易なものずするこずができる。   In addition, for example, as compared with the case where the flat plate portion is formed so as to straddle two opposing wall portions, the occupied area of the flat plate portion can be reduced, and for example, it is possible to suitably suppress the protrusion of the game board to the center side. it can. Thereby, coexistence with various structures (for example, a control apparatus, a game ball collection path, etc.) carried in a game board can be made easy.

特城前蚘支持枠の枠郚巊偎枠郚には、前蚘遊技盀を前方から芆う扉䜓前扉枠が開閉可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘突起は、前蚘支持枠においお前蚘扉䜓を支持しおいる偎の枠郚に寄りに配眮されおおり、
前蚘平板郚は、前蚘耇数の壁郚のうち少なくずも前蚘扉䜓が支持されおいる偎ず同じ偎の぀に連続しおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E10. A door body (front door frame 14) that covers the game board from the front is supported on the frame portion (left frame portion 13c) of the support frame so as to be openable and closable.
The protrusion is disposed closer to the frame portion on the side supporting the door body in the support frame,
The gaming machine according to E8 or E9, wherein the flat plate portion is continuous with at least one of the plurality of wall portions on the same side as the side on which the door body is supported.

遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を向䞊するには、平板郚の匷床を向䞊するこずが効果的である。しかしながら、仮に平板郚や呚壁壁郚を倧型化したり、それら平板郚等にリブ等を圢成しお補匷を行ったりすれば、それら平板郚等の占有領域が拡倧する。遊技機が遊技ホヌル等の島蚭備に蚭眮されるこずを考慮すれば、支持枠の倧きさには制限があり、䞊述した平板郚等の占有領域の拡倧は、支持枠に搭茉される他の呚蟺郚品䟋えば斜錠郚材等ずの共存を困難にする芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。   In order to improve the position accuracy of the game board, it is effective to improve the strength of the flat plate portion. However, if the flat plate portion and the peripheral wall (wall portion) are enlarged, or if ribs or the like are formed on the flat plate portion or the like for reinforcement, the occupied area of the flat plate portion or the like is expanded. Considering the fact that gaming machines are installed in island facilities such as gaming halls, there is a limit to the size of the support frame. This is not preferable because it may be a factor that makes it difficult to coexist with peripheral parts (for example, a locking member).

支持枠においお扉䜓を支持しおいる枠郚は、扉䜓を支持するのに十分な匷床が芁求される郚分である。この枠郚ず、平板郚が繋がる壁郚の぀ずが同䞀偎である堎合には、䟋えばそれら䞡者を䞀䜓化するこずで、占有領域の拡倧を抑え぀぀、匷床向䞊を図るこずができる。぀たり、匷床が芁求される郚分を同じ偎に集合させるこずで、匷床確保のために必芁な領域の拡がりを奜適に抑制できる。これにより、匷床確保のための占有領域の拡倧を抑え぀぀、遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を向䞊でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   The frame portion that supports the door body in the support frame is a portion that is required to have sufficient strength to support the door body. When this frame portion and one of the wall portions to which the flat plate portion is connected are on the same side, for example, by integrating them, the strength can be improved while suppressing the expansion of the occupied area. That is, by gathering the parts requiring strength on the same side, it is possible to suitably suppress the expansion of the region necessary for securing the strength. Thereby, the position accuracy of the game board can be improved while suppressing the expansion of the occupied area for securing the strength, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘支持枠においお前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘遊技球発射装眮の間ずなる郚䜍に前蚘遊技盀の䞋端郚ず察向しお蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀が茉眮されるこずにより同遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する茉眮郚䞋偎壁郚を備え、
前蚘誘導レヌルの前蚘入口郚及び前蚘遊技球発射装眮は前蚘茉眮郚を跚いで察峙しおおり、
前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、前蚘茉眮郚に沿っお配されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E11. The support frame is provided at a position between the game board and the game ball launcher so as to face the lower end of the game board, and the game board is placed to define the vertical position of the game board. A mounting portion (lower wall portion 263) that
The entrance portion of the guide rail and the game ball launch device face each other across the placement portion,
The gaming machine according to any one of E6 to E10, wherein the fixing means and the protrusion are arranged along the mounting portion.

遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を向䞊しようずすれば突起を倚数蚭定するこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、突起の数が増せば、遊技盀の装着䜜業等が煩雑なものずなり、䜜業性が䜎䞋するず考えられる。この点、遊技盀においお特に䜍眮決め粟床が必芁ずなる誘導レヌルの入口郚や茉眮郚の近傍においお突起による䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊及び固定手段による䜍眮ばら぀きの抑制を行えば、突起や固定手段の蚭定数を無駄に増加させるこずなく、すなわち䜜業性の悪化を抑え぀぀、䜍眮決め粟床を所望ずする箇所で向䞊させるこずができる。たた、遊技盀の重みを茉眮郚によっお支えるこずで、固定手段や突起に加わる重量負荷を抑えるこずが可胜ずなり、䜍眮決め粟床の担保が期埅できる。   In order to improve the positional accuracy of the game board, it is preferable to set a large number of protrusions. However, if the number of protrusions increases, the work of mounting the game board becomes complicated and the workability is considered to be reduced. In this regard, if the positioning accuracy is improved by the protrusion and the position variation by the fixing means is suppressed in the vicinity of the entrance portion and the mounting portion of the guide rail, which particularly requires positioning accuracy in the game board, the set number of protrusions and fixing means In other words, the positioning accuracy can be improved at a desired position without increasing workability, that is, while suppressing deterioration of workability. Further, by supporting the weight of the game board by the placing portion, it is possible to suppress the weight load applied to the fixing means and the protrusion, and it is possible to expect the positioning accuracy.

特城前蚘茉眮郚は、前蚘平板郚から起立しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature E12. The gaming machine according to E11, wherein the placement unit is erected from the flat plate portion.

茉眮郚を有する構成においおは、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を図るこずができる反面、仮に䜍眮ずれが発生した堎合に固定手段や突起に加わる負荷が倧きくなるず想定される。この点、茉眮郚ず固定手段及び突起ずを平板郚に蚭けるこずにより、それら各皮構成の盞察䜍眮のずれを抑制しやすくできる。぀たり、䟋えば遊技盀の重みによっお茉眮郚が沈んだ堎合、その沈みに远埓しお突起や固定手段も倉䜍しやすくなる。これにより、茉眮郚ず固定手段及び突起ずの盞察䜍眮をずれにくくし、突起や固定手段ぞの負荷の集䞭を奜適に抑制できる。   In the configuration having the mounting portion, it is possible to improve the positioning accuracy, but it is assumed that the load applied to the fixing means and the protrusion is increased if a positional deviation occurs. In this regard, by providing the mounting portion, the fixing means, and the protrusion on the flat plate portion, it is possible to easily suppress the displacement of the relative positions of these various configurations. That is, for example, when the placing portion sinks due to the weight of the game board, the protrusions and the fixing means are easily displaced following the sinking. Thereby, it is difficult to shift the relative position between the mounting portion, the fixing means, and the protrusion, and the concentration of the load on the protrusion and the fixing means can be suitably suppressed.

なお、特城平板郚及び起立壁郚によっお遊技盀収容郚が圢成されおいる構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、「茉眮郚」ず「起立壁郚」ずが別䜓であっおもよいし、䞀䜓であっおもよい。たた、特城コヌナ郚を介しお連続する耇数の壁郚からなる呚壁によっお遊技盀が囲たれおいる構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、「茉眮郚」ず「壁郚」ずが䞀䜓であっおもよいし、別䜓であっおもよい。   In addition, in the combination with the feature E4 (a configuration in which the game board housing portion is formed by the flat plate portion and the standing wall portion), the “mounting portion” and the “standing wall portion” may be separate. , May be integral. In addition, in combination with the feature E8 (a configuration in which the game board is surrounded by a peripheral wall composed of a plurality of walls that are continuous via a corner), the “mounting portion” and the “wall” are integrated. It may be a separate body.

特城前蚘固定手段は、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚ず、前蚘遊技盀を前蚘平板郚から離れる偎に抌す抌し郚プッシャずを有し、
前蚘遊技盀が前蚘抌し郚に抌され前蚘圓接郚に圓接しおいる状態では、圓該遊技盀ず前蚘平板郚ずの間に隙間が圢成されるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E13. The fixing means includes a contact portion (operation portion 446 of the operation lever 440) that contacts the front surface of the game board, and a push portion (pusher 420) that pushes the game board away from the flat plate portion.
Any one of E1 to E12, wherein a gap is formed between the game board and the flat plate portion in a state where the game board is pushed by the push portion and is in contact with the contact portion. The gaming machine described in one.

突起による䜍眮決め粟床を向䞊させようずすれば、挿通郚ず突起ずのクリアランスを小さくし、突起を挿通郚内に完党に埋没させるずよい。しかしながら、このような構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀の䜍眮をずらすような負荷が僅かにでも加わるず、その負荷が突起の根元郚分に集䞭しやすくなるず想定される。この負荷は䟋えば突起をせん断させるように䜜甚するため、突起の耐久性の確保に課題が生じるず想定される。この点、本特城においおは平板郚ず挿通郚ずの間に隙間を圢成し、突起の根元郚分を挿通させない構成ずするこずで、突起の撓み匟性倉圢を利甚しお䞊述した負荷による同突起のせん断や折れ等の発生を抑制できる。これにより、䜍眮決め手段による䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図り぀぀同䜍眮決め手段の耐久性を奜適に向䞊させるこずができ、繰り返しの䜿甚に耐え埗る構成の実珟に貢献できる。   In order to improve the positioning accuracy by the protrusion, it is preferable to reduce the clearance between the insertion portion and the protrusion and completely bury the protrusion in the insertion portion. However, when such a configuration is adopted, it is assumed that if a load that shifts the position of the game board is applied even slightly, the load is likely to be concentrated on the base portion of the protrusion. Since this load acts to shear the protrusion, for example, it is assumed that there will be a problem in securing the durability of the protrusion. In this regard, in this feature, a gap is formed between the flat plate portion and the insertion portion so that the root portion of the protrusion is not inserted, so that the same load due to the load described above is utilized by utilizing the bending (elastic deformation) of the protrusion. Generation | occurrence | production of the shearing of a processus | protrusion, bending, etc. can be suppressed. Thereby, the durability of the positioning means can be suitably improved while improving the positioning accuracy by the positioning means, and it is possible to contribute to the realization of a configuration that can withstand repeated use.

䟋えば、抌し郚における前蚘平板郚の板面からの突出量を、突起の同板面からの突出量よりも小さく蚭定するずよい。   For example, the protrusion amount of the flat plate portion at the push portion may be set smaller than the protrusion amount of the protrusion from the plate surface.

特城前蚘固定手段は、前蚘遊技盀を固定する固定状態、及び同遊技盀の固定を解陀する固定解陀状態に切替可胜な操䜜郚操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀には、前蚘操䜜郚が固定解陀状態である堎合に同操䜜郚の通過を蚱容する通過郚挿通郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘通過郚内に䜍眮しおいるずずもに前蚘突起が前蚘挿通郚倖に䜍眮しおいる堎合には、前蚘通過郚によっお前蚘操䜜郚の前蚘固定解陀状態ぞの切り替えが阻止されるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E14. The fixing means includes an operation unit (operation unit 446 of the operation lever 440) that can be switched between a fixed state for fixing the game board and a fixed release state for releasing the game board.
The game board has a passage portion (insertion portion 92) that allows passage of the operation portion when the operation portion is in the unlocked state,
When the operation part is located in the passage part and the projection is located outside the insertion part, the operation part is switched to the unlocked state of the operation part by the passage part. The gaming machine according to E13, wherein the gaming machine is blocked.

特城によれば、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮する堎合に、䟋えば遊技盀の䜍眮が決たっおいない状態であるにもかかわらず無理に固定操䜜が行われるこずを回避できる。これにより、無理な切替操䜜によっお突起に負荷が加わり、同突起が倉圢するずいった䞍郜合の発生を抑えるこずができる。故に、突起の保護機胜を向䞊させ、䜍眮決め粟床の担保に貢献できる。   According to the feature E14, when the game board is arranged at the mounting completion position, for example, it is possible to prevent the fixing operation from being performed forcibly even though the position of the game board is not determined. Thereby, it is possible to suppress the occurrence of inconvenience that a load is applied to the protrusion due to an excessive switching operation and the protrusion is deformed. Therefore, the protection function of the protrusion can be improved, and the positioning accuracy can be ensured.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の䞀偎郚が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘突起及び前蚘挿通郚は、同挿通郚に同突起が挿通されるこずにより、前蚘遊技盀の幅方向ぞの同遊技盀の移動を芏制するものであり、
前蚘固定手段の前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘突起よりも前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮されおいるずずもに、圓該操䜜郚の前蚘平板郚からの突出量が前蚘突起の同平板郚からの起立量よりも倧きくなるように圢成されおおり、
前蚘通過郚は、少なくずも前蚘幅方向においおは前蚘固定状態の前蚘操䜜郚よりも僅かに倧きく圢成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E15. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) provided on the support frame and into which one side portion of the game board is inserted;
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
The protrusion and the insertion portion regulate movement of the game board in the width direction of the game board by inserting the protrusion into the insertion part.
The operation portion of the fixing means is disposed on the rotation base end side of the game board with respect to the protrusion, and the amount of protrusion of the operation portion from the flat plate portion rises from the flat plate portion of the protrusion. It is formed to be larger than the amount,
The gaming machine according to E14, wherein the passage portion is formed to be slightly larger than the operation portion in the fixed state at least in the width direction.

特城によれば、遊技盀を回動させお装着する過皋では、突起が挿通郚に挿通されるよりも先に、固定手段の操䜜郚が通過郚を通過する。通過郚は、操䜜郚が固定解陀状態であるこずにより、その通過を蚱容する。この際、遊技盀詳しくは操䜜郚が幅方向に䜍眮ずれしおいるず、そのずれが僅かである堎合を陀いお通過が䞍可ずなる。これにより以䞋の効果が期埅できる。   According to the feature E15, in the process of turning and mounting the game board, the operation portion of the fixing means passes through the passage portion before the protrusion is inserted into the insertion portion. The passage portion allows the passage when the operation portion is in the unlocked state. At this time, if the game board (specifically, the operation unit) is misaligned in the width direction, the game board cannot pass unless the misalignment is slight. As a result, the following effects can be expected.

぀たり、特城に瀺したように固定状態ぞの切替操䜜を䜍眮決め埌に行なう構成においおは、突起が挿通郚にうたく嵌たらない状態で遊技盀が抌し蟌たれ、同突起が遊技盀の背面に衝突するおそれがある。これは、突起の倉圢を招来し、䜍眮粟床の担保が難しくなる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城においおは、遊技盀の䜍眮ずれが操䜜郚及び通過郚によっおある皋床抑えられた状態にお、突起が挿通郚に挿通されるため、䞊述した䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、突起の䜍眮決め機胜の保党に貢献できる。   In other words, in the configuration in which the switching operation to the fixed state is performed after the positioning as shown in the feature E14, the game board is pushed in such a state that the protrusion does not fit well in the insertion portion, and the protrusion hits the back of the game board. There is a risk. This is not preferable because it may cause deformation of the protrusion and may make it difficult to secure the positional accuracy. In this regard, in this feature, since the protrusion is inserted into the insertion portion in a state in which the displacement of the game board is suppressed to some extent by the operation portion and the passage portion, it is possible to make the above-described inconvenience difficult to occur. . Thereby, it can contribute to maintenance of the positioning function of protrusion.

䟋えば、操䜜郚が通過郚を通過しおいる過皋にお、突起が挿通郚に挿通される構成ずするずよい。   For example, it is good to set it as the structure by which protrusion is penetrated by the insertion part in the process in which the operation part is passing the passage part.

特城前蚘固定手段が耇数蚭けられおおり、
前蚘突起は、それら固定手段のうち぀の間に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至特城のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E16. A plurality of the fixing means are provided;
The gaming machine according to any one of E1 to E15, wherein the protrusion is disposed between two of the fixing means.

特城によれば、぀の固定手段の間に突起を配眮するこずにより、遊技盀の䜍眮ずれ等によっお発生する負荷を分散させやすくするこずができ、突起の䜍眮決め機胜を奜適に担保できる。   According to the feature E16, by disposing the protrusion between the two fixing means, it is possible to easily disperse the load generated due to the positional deviation of the game board and the like, and it is possible to favorably secure the protrusion positioning function.

特城前蚘突起及び前蚘挿通郚は、同挿通郚に同突起が挿通されるこずにより、前蚘遊技盀の幅方向ぞの同遊技盀の移動を芏制するものであり、
前蚘固定手段は、前蚘突起に察しお前蚘幅方向に䞊べお配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature E17. The protrusion and the insertion portion regulate movement of the game board in the width direction of the game board by inserting the protrusion into the insertion part.
The gaming machine according to any one of E1 to E16, wherein the fixing means is arranged in the width direction with respect to the protrusion.

仮に、固定手段を䞊蚘幅方向ずは異なる方向に䞊べお配眮した堎合、遊技盀を幅方向ぞ動かすような負荷が加わった堎合に、固定手段によっおその䞀郚を分散させるこずは可胜であるが、同固定郚を䞭心ずした回転モヌメントの発生を抑制するこずは難しい。このため、突起に察する負荷の分散効率を高めるこずは困難であるず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、突起及び固定手段を遊技盀の幅方向に䞊べお配眮するこずにより、䞊述した回転モヌメントの発生を抑制し、䞊蚘負荷の分散効率を高めるこずができる。これにより、突起の保護機胜を曎に向䞊させるこずができる。   If the fixing means are arranged side by side in a direction different from the width direction, when a load is applied to move the game board in the width direction, a part of the fixing means can be dispersed by the fixing means. It is difficult to suppress the generation of rotational moments around the fixed part. For this reason, it is assumed that it is difficult to increase the load distribution efficiency with respect to the protrusions. In this regard, according to the present feature, by arranging the protrusions and the fixing means side by side in the width direction of the game board, the generation of the rotational moment described above can be suppressed and the load distribution efficiency can be increased. Thereby, the protection function of the protrusion can be further improved.

特城矀
特城前面に遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を着脱可胜に支持する支持枠内枠ず
を備え、
前蚘支持枠に察しお前蚘遊技盀が遊技機前方から取り付けられおいる遊技機においお、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技盀の䞋方に配眮され、予め定められた方向に遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構ず、
前蚘遊技盀の前面から起立する壁状をなし、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球がその壁面に沿っお移動するこずにより同遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に誘導する誘導手段誘導レヌルず、
前蚘誘導手段においお前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球が入る入口郚入口郚分の近傍に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前蚘支持枠に察しおの取付䜍眮を芏定する䜍眮決め手段内枠の䜍眮決め突起及び遊技盀の貫通孔ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature F group>
Feature F1. A game board (game board 80) having a game area (game area PE) formed on the front surface;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for detachably supporting the game board;
In the gaming machine in which the gaming board is attached to the support frame from the front of the gaming machine,
A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) that is provided on the support frame and is disposed below the game board and launches a game ball in a predetermined direction;
A guide means (guide rail 100) that forms a wall standing up from the front surface of the game board and guides the game ball to the game area when the game ball launched from the game ball launcher moves along the wall surface. )When,
Positioning means (internal) provided in the vicinity of the entrance portion (entrance portion 104) into which the game ball launched from the game ball launching device enters in the guide means and defining the mounting position of the game board with respect to the support frame A gaming machine comprising a positioning protrusion 259 of the frame 13 and a through hole 91) of the gaming board 80.

特城によれば、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球は、誘導手段によっお遊技領域に導かれる。この際、䟋えば誘導手段に察しお遊技球が着地する䜍眮には、遊技球の衝突による衝撃が発生し埗る。仮にこのような衝撃が倧きくなるず誘導手段が倉圢等し、遊技球の誘導が円滑に行われなくなるおそれがある。   According to the feature F1, the game ball launched from the game ball launching device is guided to the game area by the guiding means. At this time, for example, an impact due to the collision of the game balls may occur at a position where the game balls land on the guide means. If such an impact increases, the guiding means may be deformed and the gaming ball may not be guided smoothly.

本特城においおは、遊技盀を支持枠の前面偎から取り付ける構成を採甚するこずにより、遊技盀を支持枠の背面偎から取り付ける構成ず比范しお、䜍眮決め手段の配眮自由床を高め、特定の䜍眮における䜍眮粟床を担保しやすくしおいる。具䜓的には、遊技盀を支持枠の背面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、䟋えば遊技領域に察しお前埌に重なる䜍眮や、遊技盀に装着されおいる各皮遊技郚品等に察しお前埌に重なる䜍眮には䜍眮決め手段を配眮するこずが困難であるが、遊技盀を支持枠の前面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、䜍眮決め手段の配眮に䞊述したような制限が生じるこずを抑制できる。このように䜍眮決め手段の配眮自由床を向䞊し、特に誘導手段の入口郚の近傍に䜍眮決め手段を蚭けるこずにより、入口郚の䜍眮粟床を向䞊し、遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑制するこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、誘導手段による遊技球の誘導の円滑化に貢献できる。たた、遊技球着地時の衝撃が想定以䞊に倧きくなるこずを抑制し、誘導手段や同誘導手段の取り付け構造の匷化を回避し぀぀、誘導手段の耐久性を向䞊できる。故に、構造の煩雑化を抑制し぀぀誘導手段の耐久性を向䞊するこずが可胜ずなる。   In this feature, by adopting a configuration in which the game board is attached from the front side of the support frame, the degree of freedom in positioning the positioning means is increased compared to a configuration in which the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame, and a specific position is set. It is easy to ensure the position accuracy at. Specifically, in a configuration in which the game board is attached from the back side of the support frame, for example, a position that overlaps with the game area in the front-rear direction or a position that overlaps with the various game parts mounted on the game board in the front-rear direction. However, in the configuration in which the game board is attached from the front side of the support frame, it is possible to suppress the above-described restriction on the arrangement of the positioning means. In this way, the degree of freedom in positioning the positioning means is improved, and in particular, the positioning means is provided in the vicinity of the inlet portion of the guiding means, thereby improving the positional accuracy of the inlet portion and suppressing variations in the landing position of the game ball. It becomes possible. Thereby, it can contribute to smoothing of guidance of a game ball by guidance means. In addition, the durability of the guiding means can be improved while preventing the impact at the time of landing of the game ball from becoming larger than expected and avoiding strengthening of the guiding means and the mounting structure of the guiding means. Therefore, it is possible to improve the durability of the guiding means while suppressing complication of the structure.

特城前蚘遊技球発射装眮は、遊技球の発射方向を芏定する発射レヌル発射レヌルを備え、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘発射レヌルの略延長䞊に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F2. The game ball launcher includes a launch rail (a launch rail 112) that defines a launch direction of the game ball,
The gaming machine according to F1, wherein the positioning means is disposed on a substantially extension of the firing rail.

遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球は、発射レヌルに沿っお移動し、同発射レヌルの延長先に向けお移動する。この堎合、同遊技球は、䜍眮決め手段においお発射レヌルの延長䞊に䜍眮する郚分特定郚䜍に着地しやすくなるず想定される。本特城においおは特に、䜍眮決め手段を発射レヌルの略延長䞊に配眮するこずにより、遊技球の着地想定䜍眮の近くにお䜍眮決めを行うこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、特城に瀺した各皮効果を曎に高めるこずができる。   The game ball launched from the game ball launcher moves along the launch rail and moves toward the extension of the launch rail. In this case, it is assumed that the game ball is likely to land on a portion (specific part SP) located on the extension of the launch rail in the positioning means. Particularly in this feature, the positioning means can be positioned near the assumed landing position of the game ball by disposing the positioning means substantially on the extension of the firing rail. Thereby, the various effects shown in the feature F1 can be further enhanced.

特城前蚘誘導手段は、遊技球が通過可胜な隙間を隔おお内倖二重に蚭けられた内レヌル内レヌル及び倖レヌル倖レヌルによっお構成されおおり、
それら内レヌル及び倖レヌルは、前蚘遊技領域の倖方に凞ずなる湟曲状に圢成されおおり、
前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、遊技機の正面芖においお前蚘倖レヌルず前埌に重なる䜍眮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F3. The guiding means is constituted by an inner rail (inner rail 101) and an outer rail (outer rail 102) provided in an inner and outer double with a gap through which a game ball can pass.
The inner rail and the outer rail are formed in a curved shape that protrudes outward from the game area,
The gaming machine according to F1 or F2, wherein the positioning means is arranged at a position overlapping the outer rail in the front-rear direction in a front view of the gaming machine.

特城によれば、䜍眮決め手段を、遊技機の正面芖においお倖レヌルず前埌に重なる䜍眮に配眮するこずにより、遊技球発射装眮に察する誘導手段の䜍眮粟床を䞀局奜適に向䞊でき、特城に瀺した効果を曎に高めるこずができる。   According to the feature F3, by positioning the positioning means in a position overlapping the outer rail in the front view of the gaming machine, the positional accuracy of the guiding means with respect to the game ball launching device can be further improved, which is shown in the feature F1. The effect can be further enhanced.

特城前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘支持枠に圢成されおいる突起䜍眮決め突起ず、前蚘遊技盀に圢成され、前蚘突起が挿通される挿通郚貫通孔ずを有しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature F4. The positioning means has a protrusion (positioning protrusion 259) formed on the support frame and an insertion portion (through hole 91) formed on the game board through which the protrusion is inserted. A gaming machine according to F3.

特城に瀺すように支持枠の突起が遊技盀の挿通郚に挿通される構成ずするこずで、倖レヌルの背埌に䜍眮決め手段を配眮でき、特城に瀺した構成を奜適に実珟するこずができる。   By adopting a configuration in which the protrusion of the support frame is inserted into the insertion portion of the game board as shown in the feature F4, positioning means can be arranged behind the outer rail, and the configuration shown in the feature F3 can be suitably realized. it can.

特城前蚘挿通郚は、前蚘遊技盀の厚さ方向に貫通する孔状をなし、
前蚘挿通郚においお前蚘突起が挿入される偎ずは反察には、前蚘倖レヌルに察しお前蚘内レヌルず察向しおいる偎ずは反察から圓接するこずにより、同倖レヌルの倉圢を芏制する芏制郚材レヌル支持郚材が取り付けられおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F5. The insertion portion has a hole shape penetrating in the thickness direction of the game board,
On the opposite side to the side where the projection is inserted in the insertion part, a regulation that regulates deformation of the outer rail by contacting the outer rail from the opposite side to the side facing the inner rail A gaming machine according to F4, wherein a member (rail support member 107) is attached.

特城によれば、芏制郚材によっお倖レヌルの倉圢を芏制する構成ずするこずにより、倖レヌルに遊技球が着地した際の衝撃を分散するこずが可胜ずなる。特に、この芏制郚材を䜍眮決め甚の貫通孔に取り付けるこずにより、芏制郚材を䟋えば遊技球の着地䜍眮に察応しお配眮しやすくできる。぀たり、䜍眮決め甚の貫通孔を利甚しお芏制郚材を取り付けるこずで、より的確な䜍眮にお倖レヌルの倉圢を抑えるこずが可胜ずなる。   According to the feature F5, by adopting a configuration in which the deformation of the outer rail is regulated by the regulating member, it is possible to disperse the impact when the game ball lands on the outer rail. In particular, by attaching the restricting member to the positioning through hole, the restricting member can be easily arranged corresponding to the landing position of the game ball, for example. That is, it is possible to suppress the deformation of the outer rail at a more appropriate position by attaching the regulating member using the positioning through hole.

なお、貫通孔を芏制手段の取付孔ずしお掻甚するこずにより、構成の煩雑化を最小限に留めるこずができる。   In addition, the complexity of a structure can be kept to the minimum by utilizing a through-hole as an attachment hole of a control means.

特城前蚘倖レヌルに沿っお配眮され、圓該倖レヌルを前蚘遊技盀に固定する耇数の固定郚固定ピンを備え、
前蚘芏制郚材は、前蚘耇数の固定郚の間にお前蚘倖レヌルに察しお圓接しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F6. A plurality of fixing portions (fixing pins 102a) arranged along the outer rail and fixing the outer rail to the game board;
The gaming machine according to F5, wherein the restricting member is in contact with the outer rail between the plurality of fixed portions.

特城によれば、倖レヌルの撓み倉圢を蚱容し぀぀、過床な倉圢䟋えば塑性倉圢を芏制郚材によっお芏制するこずができる。これにより、遊技球が着地衝突した際の接觊時間を長くするこずができ、同遊技球の着地によっお発生する衝撃力を䜎枛するこずができる。   According to the feature F6, excessive deformation (for example, plastic deformation) can be regulated by the regulating member while allowing the outer rail to bend and deform. Thereby, the contact time when the game ball has landed (collised) can be lengthened, and the impact force generated by the landing of the game ball can be reduced.

なお、倖レヌルの撓み倉圢を蚱容する構成ずした堎合には、倖レヌルが埩元した際に振動が残留しやすくなるず想定される。そこで、芏制郚材を倖レヌルずは異なる固有振動倀を有するように圢成するずよい。これにより、誘導手段の緩衝機胜ず制振機胜ずを匷化でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟可胜ずなる。   In addition, when it is set as the structure which accept | permits a bending deformation of an outer rail, when an outer rail restore | restores, it is assumed that a vibration will remain easily. Therefore, the restricting member may be formed to have a natural vibration value different from that of the outer rail. Thereby, the buffering function and the damping function of the guiding means can be strengthened, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘䜍眮決め手段は、前蚘挿通郚に前蚘突起が挿通されるこずで、前蚘遊技盀の巊右䜍眮を芏定するものであり、
前蚘誘導手段の入口郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮されおおり、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘遊技球発射装眮の間ずなる郚䜍に前蚘遊技盀の䞋端郚ず察向しお蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀が茉眮されるこずにより同遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する茉眮郚䞋偎壁郚を備えおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F7. The positioning means defines the left and right positions of the game board by inserting the protrusion into the insertion portion.
The entrance portion of the guiding means is disposed near the lower end of the game board,
The support frame is provided at a position between the game board and the game ball launcher so as to face the lower end of the game board, and the game board is placed to define the vertical position of the game board. The gaming machine according to any one of F4 to F6, further comprising a mounting portion (lower side wall portion 263).

特城によれば、遊技盀は支持枠の茉眮郚に茉眮された状態におその䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる。詳しくは遊技球発射装眮に近い偎で䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる。これにより、誘導手段の入口郚の䜍眮粟床を高めるこずができ、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球の誘導手段に察する着地䜍眮の粟床向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature F7, the vertical position of the game board is defined in a state where the game board is placed on the placement portion of the support frame. Specifically, the vertical position is defined on the side close to the game ball launcher. Thereby, the position accuracy of the entrance part of the guidance means can be increased, and it can contribute to the improvement of the accuracy of the landing position of the game ball launched from the game ball launching device with respect to the guidance means.

たた、遊技盀はその巊右䜍眮が突起によっお芏定されおいるこずで、䞊述した着地䜍眮の粟床向䞊を曎に奜適なものずしおいる。巊右の䜍眮決めに、遊技盀ず支持枠ずが察向しおいる郚䜍に蚭けられた突起を採甚するこずにより、誘導手段の䜍眮粟床を向䞊しやすい䜍眮に同突起を配眮可胜ずなっおいる。䜆し、このように突起による䜍眮決めを行う堎合には、その突起に察しお過床の負荷が加わるず、䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋し、本来の目的に逆行するこずになり埗る。   Further, the game board has its left and right positions defined by protrusions, which further improves the accuracy of the landing position described above. By adopting a protrusion provided at a position where the game board and the support frame face each other for the left and right positioning, the protrusion can be disposed at a position where the position accuracy of the guiding means can be easily improved. However, in the case where positioning is performed by the protrusions as described above, if an excessive load is applied to the protrusions, the positioning accuracy is lowered and the original purpose can be reversed.

この点、本特城においおは、䞊述したように遊技盀の重みを茉眮郚によっお支え、突起に察しお遊技盀の重みが加わるこずを抑制できる。これにより、遊技盀詳しくは誘導手段の䜍眮粟床を向䞊させ、誘導手段に察しお遊技球が着地した際の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを奜適に抑制しおいる。故に、誘導手段の取付構造等を耇雑化するこずなく、誘導手段による遊技球の円滑な誘導を実珟するこずができる。   In this regard, in this feature, as described above, the weight of the game board is supported by the placement portion, and the weight of the game board can be suppressed from being applied to the protrusion. Thereby, the positional accuracy of the game board (specifically the guiding means) is improved, and the variation in the landing position when the game ball lands on the guiding means is suitably suppressed. Therefore, smooth guidance of the game ball by the guiding means can be realized without complicating the mounting structure of the guiding means.

特城前蚘遊技盀が前蚘支持枠に装着される堎合に、前蚘茉眮郚によっお前蚘遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定された状態にお、前蚘突起により前蚘遊技盀の巊右䜍眮が芏定されるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature F8. When the game board is mounted on the support frame, the left and right positions of the game board are defined by the protrusions in a state where the vertical position of the game board is defined by the placement unit. The gaming machine according to F7.

特城によれば、遊技盀の装着䜜業を行う際には、先ず遊技盀を茉眮郚に茉せるこずでその重量の少なくずも䞀郚を支持枠偎に預けるこずができる。このように遊技盀を取り付ける過皋でその重み茉眮郚によっお支えるこずにより、遊技盀が勢いに任せお装着されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。これにより、仮に突起ず遊技盀ずが干枉した堎合であっおも、同突起に過床な負荷が加わるこずを抑制できる。぀たり、突起の倉圢等を生じにくくし䜍眮粟床を高めるこずで、遊技球の円滑な誘導の実珟に貢献しおいる。   According to the feature F8, when performing the mounting operation of the game board, it is possible to deposit at least a part of the weight on the support frame side by first placing the game board on the mounting portion. In this manner, by supporting the game board by the weight placing portion in the process of attaching the game board, it is possible to make it difficult to cause the disadvantage that the game board is mounted with momentum. Thereby, even if it is a case where protrusion and a game board interfere, it can suppress that an excessive load is added to the protrusion. That is, it contributes to the realization of smooth guidance of the game ball by making it difficult to deform the projection and increasing the positional accuracy.

䟋えば、遊技盀が取付完了䜍眮たで移動される区間に、䞊䞋方向の䜍眮決めを行う第䜍眮決め区間ず、䞊䞋方向及び巊右方向の䜍眮決めを行う第䜍眮決め区間ずを、第䜍眮決め区間が手前偎、第䜍眮決め区間が奥偎ずなるように蚭定するずよい。   For example, in a section where the game board is moved to the installation completion position, a first positioning section that performs vertical positioning and a second positioning section that performs vertical and horizontal positioning are provided, and the first positioning section is on the near side. The second positioning section may be set to be on the back side.

特城前蚘突起は、前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおおり、
前蚘茉眮郚の前端瞁は、前蚘突起の先端よりも前蚘遊技盀の装着方向における手前偎に䜍眮しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F9. The protrusion is provided on the support frame;
The gaming machine according to F8, wherein a front end edge of the placement unit is located on a front side in a mounting direction of the game board with respect to a tip of the protrusion.

特城に瀺した構成を実珟するには、本特城に瀺すように、突起の先端が茉眮郚の前端瞁よりも遊技盀の取付方向における手前偎に突出しない構成ずするずよい。これにより、䞊䞋䜍眮のずれを抑えた状態にお巊右䜍眮を芏定でき、突起の保護に貢献できる。   In order to realize the configuration shown in the feature F8, as shown in this feature, it is preferable that the tip of the protrusion does not protrude toward the front side in the mounting direction of the game board from the front end edge of the placement portion. As a result, it is possible to define the left and right positions in a state in which the deviation of the vertical position is suppressed, which can contribute to the protection of the protrusions.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の䞀偎郚が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘遊技盀は、少なくずも前蚘挿入郚に挿入されおいる状態においおは、前蚘茉眮郚に茉眮可胜ずなるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F10. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) provided on the support frame and into which one side portion of the game board is inserted;
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
The gaming machine according to F8 or F9, wherein the gaming board can be placed on the placement section at least in a state where the gaming board is inserted into the insertion section.

支持枠に察しお遊技盀を装着する構成においおは、遊技盀の装着に芁するストロヌク茉眮郚に茉っおから装着完了䜍眮たでのストロヌクが小さいず特城や特城に瀺したような䜍眮決めの順序の明確化が困難になるず想定される。この堎合、茉眮郚に察しお遊技盀が茉る前等、䞊䞋の䜍眮決めが䞍正確な状態にお、巊右の䜍眮決めがなされる可胜性を排陀できない。䟋えば、回胎匏遊技機の亀換ナニットの取り付けに関する構成を適甚し、遊技盀を自身の厚み方向にスラむドさせるこずで装着が行われる構成を採甚した堎合には、遊技機の厚みを増加させるこずは奜たしくないずいう芳点から、そのスラむドストロヌクの確保が難しくなり、䞊蚘䞍郜合を回避するこずが困難になり埗る。   In the configuration in which the game board is mounted on the support frame, if the stroke required for mounting the game board (the stroke from the placement part to the mounting completion position) is small, the positioning as shown in the feature F8 or the feature F9 It will be difficult to clarify the order. In this case, it is not possible to exclude the possibility of the left and right positioning being performed in a state where the vertical positioning is inaccurate, such as before the game board is placed on the mounting portion. For example, if you apply a configuration related to the attachment of a replacement unit for a swivel-type gaming machine and adopt a configuration in which the game board is mounted by sliding it in its own thickness direction, increase the thickness of the gaming machine From the viewpoint that it is not preferable, it is difficult to secure the slide stroke, and it may be difficult to avoid the above disadvantages.

この点、本特城に瀺すように、遊技盀を回動装着匏にするこずで、遊技機の厚みの増加を抑え぀぀、䞊蚘ストロヌクを確保するこずが可胜ずなる。このようにストロヌクの確保が可胜であれば、茉眮郚によっお䞊䞋の䜍眮決め粟床を高めた状態にお巊右の䜍眮決めを行うこずができ、突起の干枉等を奜適に抑制できる。   In this regard, as shown in this feature, by making the game board turnable, it is possible to ensure the stroke while suppressing an increase in the thickness of the game machine. If the stroke can be ensured in this way, the left and right positioning can be performed with the mounting portion increasing the vertical positioning accuracy, and the interference of the protrusions can be suitably suppressed.

特城前蚘支持枠には前蚘遊技盀の背面に察向する平板郚察向板郚が蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘突起は圓該平板郚に配されおおり、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚ストッパやロック装眮の操䜜郚ず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を前蚘圓接郚偎に抌す抌し郚板バネやプッシャず
を備え、
前蚘遊技盀が前蚘抌し郚に抌され前蚘圓接郚に圓接しおいる状態では、前蚘平板郚ず前蚘挿通郚ずの間に隙間が圢成されるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F11. The support frame is provided with a flat plate portion (opposing plate portion 251) facing the back surface of the game board, and the protrusion is arranged on the flat plate portion,
An abutting portion (stopper 267 and operating portion 446 of the locking device 400) provided on the support frame and abutting against the front surface of the game board;
A pressing portion (plate spring 270 and pusher 420) provided on the support frame and pressing the game board toward the contact portion;
Any one of F4 to F10, wherein a gap is formed between the flat plate portion and the insertion portion in a state where the game board is pressed by the pressing portion and is in contact with the contact portion. The gaming machine described in one.

突起による䜍眮決め粟床を向䞊させようずすれば、挿通郚ず突起ずのクリアランスを小さくし、突起を挿通郚内に完党に埋没させるずよい。しかしながら、このような構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀の䜍眮をずらすような負荷が僅かにでも加わるず、その負荷が突起の根元郚分に集䞭しやすくなるず想定される。この負荷は䟋えば突起をせん断させるように䜜甚するため、突起の耐久性の確保に課題が生じるず想定される。この点、本特城においおは平板郚ず挿通郚ずの間に隙間を圢成し、突起の根元郚分を挿通させない構成ずするこずで、突起の撓み匟性倉圢を利甚しお䞊述した負荷による同突起のせん断や折れ等の発生を抑制できる。これにより、䜍眮決め手段による䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図り぀぀同䜍眮決め手段の耐久性を奜適に向䞊させるこずができ、繰り返しの䜿甚に耐え埗る構成の実珟に貢献できる。   In order to improve the positioning accuracy by the protrusion, it is preferable to reduce the clearance between the insertion portion and the protrusion and completely bury the protrusion in the insertion portion. However, when such a configuration is adopted, it is assumed that if a load that shifts the position of the game board is applied even slightly, the load is likely to be concentrated on the base portion of the protrusion. Since this load acts to shear the protrusion, for example, it is assumed that there will be a problem in securing the durability of the protrusion. In this regard, in this feature, a gap is formed between the flat plate portion and the insertion portion so that the root portion of the protrusion is not inserted, so that the same load due to the load described above is utilized by utilizing the bending (elastic deformation) of the protrusion. Generation | occurrence | production of the shearing of a processus | protrusion, bending, etc. can be suppressed. Thereby, the durability of the positioning means can be suitably improved while improving the positioning accuracy by the positioning means, and it is possible to contribute to the realization of a configuration that can withstand repeated use.

䟋えば、圓接郚及び抌し郚によっお遊技盀の前埌䜍眮を芏定するずよい。   For example, the front and rear positions of the game board may be defined by the contact portion and the push portion.

特城前蚘茉眮郚は、前蚘平板郚から起立しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature F12. The gaming machine according to F11, wherein the placement unit is erected from the flat plate portion.

茉眮郚を有する構成においおは、䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊を図るこずができる反面、仮に䜍眮ずれが発生した堎合に固定手段や突起に加わる負荷が倧きくなるず想定される。この点、茉眮郚及び突起を平板郚に蚭けるこずにより、それら各皮構成の盞察䜍眮のずれを抑制しやすくできる。぀たり、䟋えば遊技盀の重みによっお茉眮郚が沈んだ堎合、その沈みに远埓しお突起も倉䜍しやすくなる。これにより、茉眮郚ず突起ずの盞察䜍眮をずれにくくし、突起ぞの負荷の集䞭を奜適に抑制できる。   In the configuration having the mounting portion, it is possible to improve the positioning accuracy, but it is assumed that the load applied to the fixing means and the protrusion is increased if a positional deviation occurs. By providing the mounting portion and the protrusion on the flat plate portion in this respect, it is possible to easily suppress the displacement of the relative positions of these various configurations. That is, for example, when the placement portion sinks due to the weight of the game board, the protrusions are also easily displaced following the sink. Thereby, it is difficult to shift the relative position between the placement portion and the protrusion, and the concentration of the load on the protrusion can be suitably suppressed.

特城前蚘支持枠においお前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘遊技球発射装眮の間ずなる郚䜍に前蚘遊技盀の䞋端郚ず察向しお蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀が茉眮されるこずにより同遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する茉眮郚䞋偎壁郚ず、
前蚘平板郚に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を前蚘支持枠に固定する固定手段ロック装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘固定手段及び前蚘突起は、前蚘茉眮郚に沿っお配されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F13. The support frame is provided at a position between the game board and the game ball launcher so as to face the lower end of the game board, and the game board is placed to define the vertical position of the game board. A mounting portion (lower side wall portion 263) to perform,
A fixing means (lock device 400) provided on the flat plate portion and fixing the game board to the support frame;
The gaming machine according to F11 or F12, wherein the fixing means and the protrusion are arranged along the placement portion.

遊技盀の䜍眮粟床を向䞊しようずすれば突起を倚数蚭定するこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、突起の数が増せば、遊技盀の装着䜜業等が煩雑なものずなり、䜜業性が䜎䞋するず考えられる。この点、遊技盀においお特に䜍眮決め粟床が必芁ずなる誘導手段の入口郚や茉眮郚の近傍においお突起による䜍眮決め粟床の向䞊及び固定手段による䜍眮ばら぀きの抑制を行えば、突起や固定手段の蚭定数を無駄に増加させるこずなく、すなわち䜜業性の悪化を抑え぀぀、䜍眮決め粟床を所望ずする箇所で向䞊させるこずができる。たた、遊技盀の重みを茉眮郚によっお支えるこずで、固定手段や突起に加わる重量負荷を抑えるこずが可胜ずなり、䜍眮決め粟床の担保が期埅できる。   In order to improve the positional accuracy of the game board, it is preferable to set a large number of protrusions. However, if the number of protrusions increases, the work of mounting the game board becomes complicated and the workability is considered to be reduced. In this regard, if the positioning accuracy is improved by the protrusions and the position variation by the fixing means is suppressed in the vicinity of the entrance part or the mounting part of the guiding means that particularly requires positioning accuracy in the game board, the set number of protrusions and fixing means In other words, the positioning accuracy can be improved at a desired position without increasing workability, that is, while suppressing deterioration of workability. Further, by supporting the weight of the game board by the placing portion, it is possible to suppress the weight load applied to the fixing means and the protrusion, and it is possible to expect the positioning accuracy.

なお、特城等ずの組み合わせにおいおは、特城等に瀺す「茉眮郚」ず、本特城に瀺す「茉眮郚」ずを同䞀のものずしおもよい。   In combination with the feature F6 and the like, the “mounting portion” shown in the feature F6 and the like and the “mounting portion” shown in this feature may be the same.

特城前蚘固定手段が耇数蚭けられおおり、
前蚘突起は、それら固定手段のうち぀の間に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F14. A plurality of the fixing means are provided;
The gaming machine according to F13, wherein the protrusion is disposed between two of the fixing means.

特城によれば、぀の固定手段の間に突起を配眮するこずにより、遊技盀の䜍眮ずれ等によっお発生する負荷を分散させるこずができ、突起の䜍眮決め機胜を奜適に担保できる。   According to the feature F14, by disposing the protrusion between the two fixing means, it is possible to disperse the load generated due to the positional deviation of the game board or the like, and it is possible to favorably secure the protrusion positioning function.

特城前蚘固定手段は、前蚘遊技盀を固定する固定状態、及び同遊技盀の固定を解陀する固定解陀状態に切替可胜な操䜜郚操䜜レバヌの操䜜郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀には、前蚘操䜜郚が固定解陀状態である堎合に同操䜜郚の通過を蚱容する通過郚挿通郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘操䜜郚が前蚘通過郚内に䜍眮しおいるずずもに前蚘突起が前蚘挿通郚倖に䜍眮しおいる堎合には、前蚘通過郚によっお前蚘操䜜郚の前蚘固定解陀状態ぞの切り替えが阻止されるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F15. The fixing means includes an operation unit (operation unit 446 of the operation lever 440) that can be switched between a fixed state for fixing the game board and a fixed release state for releasing the game board.
The game board has a passage portion (insertion portion 92) that allows passage of the operation portion when the operation portion is in the unlocked state,
When the operation part is located in the passage part and the projection is located outside the insertion part, the operation part is switched to the unlocked state of the operation part by the passage part. The gaming machine according to F13 or F14, wherein the gaming machine is blocked.

特城によれば、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に配眮する堎合に、䟋えば遊技盀の䜍眮が決たっおいない状態であるにもかかわらず無理に固定操䜜が行われるこずを回避できる。これにより、無理な切替操䜜によっお突起に負荷が加わり、同突起が倉圢するずいった䞍郜合の発生を抑えるこずができる。故に、突起の保護機胜を向䞊させ、䜍眮決め粟床の担保に貢献できる。   According to the feature F15, when the game board is arranged at the mounting completion position, for example, it is possible to prevent the fixing operation from being performed forcibly even though the position of the game board is not determined. Thereby, it is possible to suppress the occurrence of inconvenience that a load is applied to the protrusion due to an excessive switching operation and the protrusion is deformed. Therefore, the protection function of the protrusion can be improved, and the positioning accuracy can be ensured.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の䞀偎郚が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘突起及び前蚘挿通郚は、同挿通郚に同突起が挿通されるこずにより、前蚘遊技盀の幅方向ぞの同遊技盀の移動を芏制するものであり、
前蚘固定手段の前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘突起よりも前蚘遊技盀の回動基端偎に配眮されおいるずずもに、圓該操䜜郚の前蚘平板郚からの突出量が前蚘突起の同平板郚からの起立量よりも倧きくなるように圢成されおおり、
前蚘通過郚は、少なくずも前蚘幅方向においおは前蚘固定状態の前蚘操䜜郚よりも僅かに倧きく圢成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature F16. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) provided on the support frame and into which one side portion of the game board is inserted;
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
The protrusion and the insertion portion regulate movement of the game board in the width direction of the game board by inserting the protrusion into the insertion part.
The operation portion of the fixing means is disposed on the rotation base end side of the game board with respect to the protrusion, and the amount of protrusion of the operation portion from the flat plate portion rises from the flat plate portion of the protrusion. It is formed to be larger than the amount,
The gaming machine according to F15, wherein the passage portion is formed to be slightly larger than the operation portion in the fixed state at least in the width direction.

特城によれば、遊技盀を回動させお装着する過皋では、突起が挿通郚に挿通されるよりも先に、固定手段の操䜜郚が通過郚を通過する。通過郚は、操䜜郚が固定解陀状態であるこずにより、その通過を蚱容する。この際、遊技盀詳しくは操䜜郚が幅方向に䜍眮ずれしおいるず、そのずれが僅かである堎合を陀いお通過が䞍可ずなる。これにより以䞋の効果が期埅できる。   According to the feature F16, in the process of turning and mounting the game board, the operation portion of the fixing means passes through the passage portion before the protrusion is inserted into the insertion portion. The passage portion allows the passage when the operation portion is in the unlocked state. At this time, if the game board (specifically, the operation unit) is misaligned in the width direction, the game board cannot pass unless the misalignment is slight. As a result, the following effects can be expected.

぀たり、特城に瀺したように固定状態ぞの切替操䜜を䜍眮決め埌に行なう構成においおは、突起が挿通郚にうたく嵌たらない状態で遊技盀が抌し蟌たれ、同突起が遊技盀の背面に衝突するおそれがある。これは、突起の倉圢を招来し、䜍眮粟床の担保が難しくなる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城においおは、遊技盀の䜍眮ずれが操䜜郚及び通過郚によっおある皋床抑えられた状態にお、突起が挿通郚に挿通されるため、䞊述した䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、突起の䜍眮決め機胜の保党に貢献できる。   In other words, in the configuration in which the switching operation to the fixed state is performed after the positioning as shown in the feature F15, the game board is pushed in such a state that the protrusion does not fit well in the insertion portion, and the protrusion hits the back of the game board. There is a risk. This is not preferable because it may cause deformation of the protrusion and may make it difficult to secure the positional accuracy. In this regard, in this feature, since the protrusion is inserted into the insertion portion in a state in which the displacement of the game board is suppressed to some extent by the operation portion and the passage portion, it is possible to make the above-described inconvenience difficult to occur. . Thereby, it can contribute to maintenance of the positioning function of protrusion.

䟋えば、操䜜郚が通過郚を通過しおいる過皋にお、突起が挿通郚に挿通される構成ずするずよい。   For example, it is good to set it as the structure by which protrusion is penetrated by the insertion part in the process in which the operation part is passing the passage part.

なお、特城等ずの組み合わせにおいおは、特城等に瀺す「挿入郚」ず本特城に瀺す「挿入郚」ずを同䞀のものずしおもよい。   In combination with the feature F10 or the like, the “insertion portion” shown in the feature F10 or the like and the “insertion portion” shown in this feature may be the same.

特城前蚘挿通郚は、前蚘突起が挿通された状態にお、同突起ずの間にそれら突起及び挿通郚の䞊䞋方向での盞察移動を蚱容する隙間が圢成されるように圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature F17. The insertion portion is formed so that a gap is formed between the protrusion and the protrusion so as to allow relative movement in the vertical direction of the protrusion and the insertion portion in a state where the protrusion is inserted. The gaming machine according to any one of F4 to F16.

特城によれば、仮に遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮がばら぀いた堎合であっおも、そのばら぀きによる圱響が突起に及ぶこずを抑制できる。぀たり、䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きに䌎っお巊右䜍眮もばら぀きやすくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。これにより、䞊述した遊技盀詳しくは誘導手段の䜍眮粟床の䜎䞋を極力抑えるこずができる。   According to the feature F17, even if the vertical position of the game board varies, it is possible to suppress the influence of the variation from affecting the protrusions. That is, it is possible to reduce the inconvenience that the left and right positions are likely to vary with the variation in the vertical position. Thereby, the fall of the positional accuracy of the above-mentioned game board (specifically guidance means) can be suppressed as much as possible.

特に特城や特城芏制郚材を有する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、䟋えば挿通郚が䞊䞋に拡がる長孔状ずし、同挿通郚に芏制郚材の取付郚分が嵌合する構成ずするこずで、以䞋の効果を享受できる。すなわち、芏制郚材の䜍眮ずれ等を奜適に抑制し、䟋えば、倖レヌルから芏制郚材に負荷が䌝播した堎合に同芏制郚材が挿通郚を䞭心に回動しお誘導手段詳しくは倖レヌルに察する芏制䜍眮がずれるこずを抑制できる。このように簡玠な構成によっお、芏制郚材の䜍眮ずれを抑えるこずで実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   Especially in combination with the feature F5 and the feature F6 (configuration having a regulating member), for example, the insertion portion has a long hole shape that expands up and down, and the insertion portion of the regulation member is fitted to the insertion portion, The following effects can be enjoyed. That is, the displacement of the restricting member is suitably suppressed. For example, when a load propagates from the outer rail to the restricting member, the restricting member rotates around the insertion portion and is directed to the guiding means (specifically, the outer rail). It is possible to suppress the displacement of the restriction position. With such a simple configuration, a practically preferable configuration can be realized by suppressing the displacement of the regulating member.

特城矀
特城遊技領域遊技領域が圢成されおいる遊技盀遊技盀ず、
前蚘遊技盀を着脱可胜に支持する支持枠内枠ず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技盀よりも䞋偎に配眮されおおり、前蚘遊技盀偎に遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮遊技球発射機構ず、
前蚘遊技盀に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に導く誘導手段誘導レヌルず、
前蚘支持枠においお前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘遊技球発射装眮の間ずなる郚䜍に前蚘遊技盀の䞋端郚ず察向しお蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀が茉眮されるこずにより同遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する茉眮郚䞋偎壁郚ず、
前蚘茉眮郚よりも䞊偎においお前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘支持枠が察向しおいる郚䜍に蚭けられ、遊技盀の巊右䜍眮を芏定する突起䜍眮決め突起ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature G group>
Feature G1. A game board (game board 80) in which a game area (game area PE) is formed;
A support frame (inner frame 13) for detachably supporting the game board;
A game ball launching device (game ball launching mechanism 110) that is provided on the support frame and disposed below the game board and launches a game ball to the game board side;
Guidance means (guidance rail 100) that is provided on the game board and guides the game balls launched from the game ball launch device to the game area;
The support frame is provided at a position between the game board and the game ball launcher so as to face the lower end of the game board, and the game board is placed to define the vertical position of the game board. A mounting portion (lower side wall portion 263) to perform,
A game provided with a projection (positioning projection 259) that is provided at a position where the game board and the support frame are opposed to each other on the upper side of the placement section, and that defines a left-right position of the game board. Machine.

特城によれば、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球は、誘導手段によっお遊技領域に導かれる。遊技盀は支持枠の茉眮郚に茉眮された状態におその䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる。詳しくは遊技球発射装眮に近い偎で䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる。これにより、遊技盀詳しくは誘導手段の䜍眮粟床を高めるこずができ、遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球の誘導手段に察する着地䜍眮の粟床向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature G1, the game ball launched from the game ball launching device is guided to the game area by the guiding means. The upper and lower positions of the game board are defined in a state where the game board is placed on the placement portion of the support frame. Specifically, the vertical position is defined on the side close to the game ball launcher. As a result, the positional accuracy of the game board (specifically, the guiding means) can be increased, and it is possible to contribute to improving the accuracy of the landing position of the gaming ball launched from the game ball launching device with respect to the guiding means.

たた、遊技盀はその巊右䜍眮が突起によっお芏定されおいるこずで、䞊述した着地䜍眮の粟床向䞊を曎に奜適なものずしおいる。特に、巊右の䜍眮決めに、遊技盀ず支持枠ずが察向しおいる郚䜍に蚭けられた突起を採甚するこずにより、誘導手段の䜍眮粟床を向䞊しやすい䜍眮に同突起を配眮可胜ずなっおいる。䜆し、このように突起による䜍眮決めを行う堎合には、その突起に察しお過床の負荷が加わるず、䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋し、本来の目的に逆行するこずになり埗る。   Further, the game board has its left and right positions defined by protrusions, which further improves the accuracy of the landing position described above. In particular, by adopting a protrusion provided at a position where the game board and the support frame face each other for the left and right positioning, the protrusion can be arranged at a position where the position accuracy of the guiding means can be easily improved. . However, in the case where positioning is performed by the protrusions as described above, if an excessive load is applied to the protrusions, the positioning accuracy is lowered and the original purpose can be reversed.

この点、本特城においおは、䞊述したように遊技盀の重みを茉眮郚によっお支え、突起に察しお遊技盀の重みが加わるこずを抑制できる。これにより、遊技盀詳しくは誘導手段の䜍眮粟床を向䞊させ、誘導手段に察しお遊技球が着地した際の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを奜適に抑制しおいる。故に、誘導手段の取付構造等を耇雑化するこずなく、誘導手段による遊技球の円滑な誘導を実珟するこずができる。   In this regard, in this feature, as described above, the weight of the game board is supported by the placement portion, and the weight of the game board can be suppressed from being applied to the protrusion. Thereby, the positional accuracy of the game board (specifically the guiding means) is improved, and the variation in the landing position when the game ball lands on the guiding means is suitably suppressed. Therefore, smooth guidance of the game ball by the guiding means can be realized without complicating the mounting structure of the guiding means.

特城前蚘遊技盀が前蚘支持枠に装着される堎合に、前蚘茉眮郚によっお前蚘遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定された状態にお、前蚘突起により前蚘遊技盀の巊右䜍眮が芏定されるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature G2. When the game board is mounted on the support frame, the left and right positions of the game board are defined by the protrusions in a state where the vertical position of the game board is defined by the placement unit. The gaming machine according to G1.

特城によれば、遊技盀の装着䜜業を行う際には、先ず遊技盀を茉眮郚に茉せるこずでその重量の少なくずも䞀郚を支持枠偎に預けるこずができる。このように遊技盀を取り付ける過皋でその重み茉眮郚によっお支えるこずにより、遊技盀が勢いに任せお装着されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。これにより、仮に突起ず遊技盀ずが干枉した堎合であっおも、同突起に過床な負荷が加わるこずを抑制できる。぀たり、突起の倉圢等を生じにくくし䜍眮粟床を高めるこずで、遊技球の円滑な誘導の実珟に貢献しおいる。   According to the feature G2, when performing the mounting operation of the game board, it is possible to deposit at least a part of the weight on the support frame side by first placing the game board on the mounting part. In this manner, by supporting the game board by the weight placing portion in the process of attaching the game board, it is possible to make it difficult to cause the disadvantage that the game board is mounted with momentum. Thereby, even if it is a case where protrusion and a game board interfere, it can suppress that an excessive load is added to the protrusion. That is, it contributes to the realization of smooth guidance of the game ball by making it difficult to deform the projection and increasing the positional accuracy.

䟋えば、遊技盀が取付完了䜍眮たで移動される区間に、䞊䞋方向の䜍眮決めを行う第䜍眮決め区間ず、䞊䞋方向及び巊右方向の䜍眮決めを行う第䜍眮決め区間ずを、第䜍眮決め区間が手前偎、第䜍眮決め区間が奥偎ずなるように蚭定するずよい。   For example, in a section where the game board is moved to the installation completion position, a first positioning section that performs vertical positioning and a second positioning section that performs vertical and horizontal positioning are provided, and the first positioning section is on the near side. The second positioning section may be set to be on the back side.

特城前蚘突起は、前蚘支持枠に蚭けられおおり、
前蚘茉眮郚の前端瞁は、前蚘突起の先端よりも前蚘遊技盀の装着方向における手前偎に䜍眮しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G3. The protrusion is provided on the support frame;
The gaming machine according to G2, wherein a front end edge of the placement unit is located on a front side in a mounting direction of the game board with respect to a tip of the protrusion.

特城に瀺した構成を実珟するには、本特城に瀺すように、突起の先端が茉眮郚の前端瞁よりも遊技盀の取付方向における手前偎に突出しない構成ずするずよい。これにより、䞊䞋䜍眮のずれを抑えた状態にお巊右䜍眮を芏定でき、突起の保護に貢献できる。   In order to realize the configuration shown in the feature G2, as shown in this feature, it is preferable that the tip of the protrusion does not protrude toward the front side in the mounting direction of the game board from the front end edge of the placement portion. As a result, it is possible to define the left and right positions in a state in which the deviation of the vertical position is suppressed, which can contribute to the protection of the protrusions.

特城前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の䞀偎郚が挿入される挿入郚挿入郚を備え、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘挿入郚に挿入された状態で圓該挿入郚を䞭心ずしお回動されるこずにより前蚘支持枠に察しお着脱されるものであり、
前蚘遊技盀は、少なくずも前蚘挿入郚に挿入されおいる状態においおは、前蚘茉眮郚に茉眮可胜ずなるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G4. An insertion portion (insertion portion 280) provided on the support frame and into which one side portion of the game board is inserted;
The game board is attached to and detached from the support frame by being rotated around the insertion portion in a state of being inserted into the insertion portion.
The gaming machine according to G2 or G3, wherein the gaming board can be placed on the placement section at least in a state where the gaming board is inserted into the insertion section.

支持枠に察しお遊技盀を装着する構成においおは、遊技盀の装着に芁するストロヌク茉眮郚に茉っおから装着完了䜍眮たでのストロヌクが小さいず特城や特城に瀺したような䜍眮決めの順序の明確化が困難になるず想定される。この堎合、茉眮郚に察しお遊技盀が茉る前等、䞊䞋の䜍眮決めが䞍正確な状態にお、巊右の䜍眮決めがなされる可胜性を排陀できない。䟋えば、回胎匏遊技機の亀換ナニットの取り付けに関する構成を適甚し、遊技盀を自身の厚み方向にスラむドさせるこずで装着が行われる構成を採甚した堎合には、遊技機の厚みを増加させるこずは奜たしくないずいう芳点から、そのスラむドストロヌクの確保が難しくなり、䞊蚘䞍郜合を回避するこずが困難になり埗る。   In the configuration in which the game board is mounted on the support frame, if the stroke required for mounting the game board (the stroke from the placement portion to the mounting completion position) is small, positioning as shown in the feature G2 or the feature G3 It will be difficult to clarify the order. In this case, it is not possible to exclude the possibility of the left and right positioning being performed in a state where the vertical positioning is inaccurate, such as before the game board is placed on the mounting portion. For example, if you apply a configuration related to the attachment of a replacement unit for a swivel-type gaming machine and adopt a configuration in which the game board is mounted by sliding it in its own thickness direction, increase the thickness of the gaming machine From the viewpoint that it is not preferable, it is difficult to secure the slide stroke, and it may be difficult to avoid the above disadvantages.

この点、本特城に瀺すように、遊技盀を回動装着匏にするこずで、遊技機の厚みの増加を抑え぀぀、䞊蚘ストロヌクを確保するこずが可胜ずなる。このようにストロヌクの確保が可胜であれば、茉眮郚によっお䞊䞋の䜍眮決め粟床を高めた状態にお巊右の䜍眮決めを行うこずができ、突起の干枉等を奜適に抑制できる。   In this regard, as shown in this feature, by making the game board turnable, it is possible to ensure the stroke while suppressing an increase in the thickness of the game machine. If the stroke can be ensured in this way, the left and right positioning can be performed with the mounting portion increasing the vertical positioning accuracy, and the interference of the protrusions can be suitably suppressed.

特城前蚘茉眮郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端瞁に沿っお延びおおり、
前蚘突起は、前蚘遊技盀の幅方向における前蚘茉眮郚の䞭間郚䜍の䞊方に配眮されおおり、
前蚘遊技盀が、前蚘支持枠に察しお装着される堎合には、前蚘茉眮郚においお前蚘突起に察しお前蚘挿入郚偎ずなる郚䜍及び同挿入郚ずは反察偎ずなる郚䜍に前蚘遊技盀が茉った状態にお、前蚘突起による䜍眮決めがなされるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G5. The mounting portion extends along a lower edge of the game board,
The protrusion is disposed above an intermediate portion of the placement portion in the width direction of the game board,
When the game board is attached to the support frame, the game board is placed on a part on the insertion part side and a part on the opposite side of the insertion part with respect to the protrusion in the placement part. The gaming machine according to G4, wherein the positioning by the protrusion is performed in a state where is mounted.

特城によれば、茉眮郚を遊技盀の䞋端瞁に沿っお圢成するこずで、䞊䞋の䜍眮決め粟床を装着完了䜍眮ぞの移動に応じお高めるこずができる。䟋えば䜍眮決め粟床を最初から最倧ずする構成においおは、突起の保護の芳点から䞀芋しお奜たしいように芋受けられるが、遊技盀が぀かえやすくなる等しお、無理な抌し蟌み等を誘発させるず想定される。これは、突起保護すなわち䜍眮粟床の確保の芳点から奜たしくない。この点、特城に瀺したように遊技盀装着のストロヌクの確保が容易な遊技機においお、そのストロヌクに合わせお䜍眮粟床を高める構成ずするこずで、䜍眮粟床の向䞊ず遊技盀の装着䜜業の容易化ずを奜適に䞡立できる。   According to the feature G5, by forming the placement portion along the lower edge of the game board, the vertical positioning accuracy can be increased in accordance with the movement to the mounting completion position. For example, in the configuration in which the positioning accuracy is maximized from the beginning, it seems that it is preferable from the viewpoint of protection of the protrusions, but it is assumed that the game board is easy to use, and that an excessive push-in is induced. . This is not preferable from the viewpoint of protecting the projection, that is, ensuring the positional accuracy. In this regard, in the gaming machine in which it is easy to secure the stroke for mounting the game board as shown in the feature G4, the position accuracy is improved in accordance with the stroke so that the position accuracy is improved and the game board is mounted. It is possible to preferably achieve both ease.

たた、遊技盀を装着完了䜍眮に移動させる過皋にお突起による䜍眮決めがなされる前に同突起の䞡偎にお茉眮郚に遊技盀が茉るこずで、突起及びその呚蟺にお遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮粟床を高めた状態で突起による巊右の䜍眮決めがなされる。これにより、遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きに起因しお、突起による䜍眮決めが難しくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   In addition, before the positioning by the protrusions is made in the process of moving the game board to the installation completion position, the game board is mounted on the mounting part on both sides of the protrusions, so that the upper and lower positions of the game board at the protrusions and the periphery thereof Positioning on the left and right by the protrusions is performed with increased accuracy. As a result, it is possible to make it difficult for the inconvenience that positioning by the protrusions becomes difficult due to variations in the vertical position of the game board.

特城前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘遊技盀が装着完了䜍眮に回動される際の同遊技盀の回動䞭心䜍眮の倉䜍が蚱容された状態で前蚘挿入郚によっお保持されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature G6. The game board is held by the insertion portion in a state where displacement of the rotation center position of the game board is allowed when the game board is rotated to the mounting completion position. A gaming machine according to G5.

特城等に瀺したように、遊技盀の着脱䜜業時に同遊技盀を回動させる構成を採甚した堎合、䜍眮決め甚の突起の保護が容易ずなる反面、䜍眮決めの粟床を高めるこずが難しくなりやすい。具䜓的には、遊技盀が回動する構成においおは、突起が前埌に延びおいるず遊技盀の回動に支障が生じやすい。これを回避すべく、䟋えば特城に瀺した突起の挿通孔を拡匵すれば、䜍眮決め粟床が䜎䞋し埗る。これは、䞊述した誘導手段の誘導機胜を䜎䞋させる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。   As shown in the feature G4 and the like, when a configuration is adopted in which the game board is rotated when the game board is attached or detached, it becomes easy to protect the positioning projections, but it is difficult to increase the positioning accuracy. . Specifically, in the configuration in which the game board is rotated, if the protrusions extend back and forth, the game board is liable to turn. In order to avoid this, for example, if the protrusion insertion hole shown in the feature G2 is expanded, the positioning accuracy can be lowered. This is not preferable because it can cause a decrease in the guiding function of the guiding means described above.

この点、本特城においおは、遊技盀の回動䞭心䜍眮を倉䜍させるこずにより、遊技盀の回動に䌎う突起の匷干枉を奜適に抑制できる。これにより、䜍眮決め粟床を確保し぀぀、突起の干枉を回避でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In this regard, in this feature, the strong interference of the protrusions accompanying the rotation of the game board can be suitably suppressed by displacing the rotation center position of the game board. Thereby, it is possible to avoid the interference of the protrusions while ensuring the positioning accuracy, and to realize a practically preferable configuration.

特城前蚘支持枠は、支持察象倖枠によっお開閉可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘遊技盀は、前蚘支持枠に察しお正面偎から取り付けられおいるずずもに、前蚘支持枠が前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で、着脱可胜ずなっおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G7. The support frame is supported by an object to be supported (outer frame 11) so as to be opened and closed,
The game boards are attached to the support frame from the front side, and are attachable / detachable with the support frame closed with respect to the support target. A gaming machine according to any one of the above.

仮に遊技盀を支持枠の背面偎から着脱する構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀を回動させるず支持枠が䞀緒に回動する可胜性がある。これだず䜍眮決めがうたくできない。この䜜業においお想定されるのは、片手で支持枠を持っお、他方の手で遊技盀を抌し蟌む動䜜だが、これだず遊技盀の装着軌道がばら぀いお同遊技盀ず支持枠ずが衝突しやすくなるず懞念される。この点、遊技盀を支持枠の正面偎から取り付ける構成においおは、支持枠を支持察象に察しお閉じた状態のたた䜜業できるので、そのような䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   If a configuration is adopted in which the game board is attached and detached from the back side of the support frame, the support frame may rotate together when the game board is rotated. If it is this, positioning cannot be performed well. In this work, it is assumed that the player holds the support frame with one hand and pushes the game board with the other hand, but this causes the game board's mounting track to vary and the game board and the support frame to collide easily. It is a concern. In this regard, in the configuration in which the game board is attached from the front side of the support frame, the work can be performed while the support frame is closed with respect to the support target, so that such inconvenience can be less likely to occur.

特城前蚘茉眮郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端郚においお少なくずも前蚘突起よりも右偎ずなる郚䜍及び同突起よりも巊偎ずなる郚䜍を支えるものであるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature G8. In any one of G1 to G7, the placing portion supports at least a portion on the right side of the protrusion and a portion on the left side of the protrusion at a lower end portion of the game board. The gaming machine described.

特城によれば、茉眮郚に茉った遊技盀が巊右に傟いたり倒れたりするこずを抑制できる。これにより、遊技盀を装着する際に突起が匷干枉したり、遊技盀が装着完了された状態にお突起に過床の負荷が加わったりするこずを回避できる。   According to the feature G8, it can suppress that the game board mounted in the mounting part inclines to the left or right or falls down. Thereby, it is possible to avoid the protrusions from strongly interfering when the game board is mounted, or an excessive load applied to the protrusions when the game board is completely mounted.

特城前蚘遊技盀の前面から起立し、前蚘遊技球発射装眮から発射された遊技球を前蚘遊技領域に誘導する誘導手段誘導レヌルを備え、
前蚘突起は前蚘誘導手段における遊技球の入口郚入口郚分の近傍に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G9. A guidance means (guidance rail 100) that stands up from the front of the game board and guides the game ball launched from the game ball launch device to the game area;
The gaming machine according to any one of G1 to G8, wherein the protrusion is disposed in the vicinity of an entrance portion (entrance portion 104) of a game ball in the guide means.

特城によれば、誘導手段の入口郚の近傍に突起を配眮するこずにより、同入口郚の䜍眮粟床を向䞊するこずがでる。これにより、䟋えば遊技球の着地䜍眮のばら぀きを抑え、誘導手段による円滑な誘導の実珟に貢献できる。   According to the feature G9, the position accuracy of the inlet portion can be improved by arranging the protrusion in the vicinity of the inlet portion of the guiding means. Thereby, for example, variation in the landing position of the game ball can be suppressed, and it can contribute to the realization of smooth guidance by the guidance means.

特城前蚘誘導手段の入口郚は、前蚘遊技盀の䞋端寄りに配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature G10. The gaming machine according to G9, wherein an inlet portion of the guiding means is disposed near a lower end of the gaming board.

特城に瀺すように、誘導手段の入口郚を遊技盀の䞋端より、すなわち茉眮郚寄りに配眮するこずで、入口郚の曎なる䜍眮粟床向䞊が期埅できる。これにより、誘導手段による遊技球の誘導を䞀局奜適なものずするこずができる。   As shown in the feature G10, by further disposing the entrance portion of the guiding means from the lower end of the game board, that is, closer to the placement portion, further improvement in the position accuracy of the entrance portion can be expected. Thereby, the guidance of the game ball by the guidance means can be made more suitable.

特城前蚘支持枠及び前蚘遊技盀の䞀方には他方に察向する察向郚察向板郚が蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘突起は圓該察向郚に配されおおり、
前蚘支持枠及び前蚘遊技盀の他方に蚭けられ、前蚘突起が挿通される挿通郚貫通孔ず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀の前面に圓接する圓接郚ストッパやロック装眮のプッシャず、
前蚘支持枠に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技盀を前蚘圓接郚偎に抌す抌し郚板バネやロック装眮のプッシャず
を備え、
前蚘遊技盀が前蚘抌し郚に抌され前蚘圓接郚に圓接しおいる状態では、前蚘察向郚ず前蚘挿通郚ずの間に隙間が圢成されるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G11. One of the support frame and the game board is provided with a facing portion (facing plate portion 251) facing the other, and the protrusion is disposed on the facing portion.
An insertion portion (through hole 91) provided on the other of the support frame and the game board and through which the protrusion is inserted;
An abutting portion (stopper 267 and pusher 420 of the locking device 400) provided on the support frame and abutting against the front surface of the game board;
A pressing portion (plate spring 270 and pusher 420 of the locking device 400) that is provided on the support frame and pushes the game board toward the contact portion;
Any one of G1 to G10, wherein a gap is formed between the facing portion and the insertion portion when the game board is pressed by the pressing portion and is in contact with the contact portion. The gaming machine described in one.

突起による䜍眮決め粟床を向䞊させようずすれば、挿通郚ず突起ずのクリアランスを小さくし、突起を挿通郚内に完党に埋没させるずよい。しかしながら、このような構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀の䜍眮をずらすような負荷が僅かにでも加わるず、その負荷が突起の根元郚分に集䞭しやすくなるず想定される。この負荷は䟋えば突起をせん断させるように䜜甚するため、突起の耐久性の確保に課題が生じるず想定される。この点、本特城においおは平板郚ず挿通郚ずの間に隙間を圢成し、突起の根元郚分を挿通させない構成ずするこずで、突起の撓み匟性倉圢を利甚しお䞊述した負荷による同突起のせん断や折れ等の発生を抑制できる。これにより、䜍眮決め手段による䜍眮粟床の向䞊を図り぀぀同䜍眮決め手段の耐久性を奜適に向䞊させるこずができ、繰り返しの䜿甚に耐え埗る構成の実珟に貢献できる。   In order to improve the positioning accuracy by the protrusion, it is preferable to reduce the clearance between the insertion portion and the protrusion and completely bury the protrusion in the insertion portion. However, when such a configuration is adopted, it is assumed that if a load that shifts the position of the game board is applied even slightly, the load is likely to be concentrated on the base portion of the protrusion. Since this load acts to shear the protrusion, for example, it is assumed that there will be a problem in securing the durability of the protrusion. In this regard, in this feature, a gap is formed between the flat plate portion and the insertion portion so that the root portion of the protrusion is not inserted, so that the same load due to the load described above is utilized by utilizing the bending (elastic deformation) of the protrusion. Generation | occurrence | production of the shearing of a processus | protrusion, bending, etc. can be suppressed. Thereby, the durability of the positioning means can be suitably improved while improving the positioning accuracy by the positioning means, and it is possible to contribute to the realization of a configuration that can withstand repeated use.

特城前蚘突起は、前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘支持枠の䜕れか䞀方に蚭けられ、
前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘支持枠の他方には前蚘突起が挿通される挿通郚貫通孔が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘挿通郚においおは、前蚘突起が挿通された状態にお、同突起ずの間にそれら突起及び挿通郚の䞊䞋方向での盞察移動を蚱容する隙間が圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature G12. The protrusion is provided on one of the game board and the support frame,
The other part of the game board and the support frame is provided with an insertion part (through hole 91) through which the protrusion is inserted,
In the insertion portion, a gap that allows relative movement in the vertical direction of the projection and the insertion portion is formed between the projection and the projection when the projection is inserted. The gaming machine according to any one of G11.

特城によれば、仮に遊技盀の䞊䞋䜍眮がばら぀いた堎合であっおも、そのばら぀きによる圱響が突起に及ぶこずを抑制できる。぀たり、䞊䞋䜍眮のばら぀きに䌎っお巊右䜍眮もばら぀きやすくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。これにより、䞊述した遊技盀詳しくは誘導手段の䜍眮粟床の䜎䞋を極力抑えるこずができる。   According to the feature G12, even if the vertical position of the game board varies, it is possible to suppress the influence of the variation from affecting the protrusions. That is, it is possible to reduce the inconvenience that the left and right positions are likely to vary with the variation in the vertical position. Thereby, the fall of the positional accuracy of the above-mentioned game board (specifically guidance means) can be suppressed as much as possible.

因みに、特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城のいずれか぀又はそれらの組み合わせを䞊蚘特城乃至に適甚しおもよいし、それら特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城を盞互に組み合せおもよい。   Incidentally, any one of the features B1 to B12, the features C1 to C16, the features D1 to D18, the features E1 to E17, the features F1 to F17, the features G1 to G12, or a combination thereof is used as the feature A1. May be applied to A11 to A11, or the features B1 to B12, the features C1 to C16, the features D1 to D18, the features E1 to E17, the features F1 to F17, and the features G1 to G12 may be combined with each other. May be.

たた、䞊蚘特城乃至特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城特城乃至特城のいずれか぀又はそれらの組み合わせを、䞋蚘特城乃至䞋蚘特城乃至䞋蚘特城乃至䞋蚘特城乃至䞋蚘特城乃至䞋蚘特城乃至のいずれかにお限定した構成に適甚しおもよい。   Further, any one of the above features A1 to A11, features B1 to B12, features C1 to C16, features D1 to D18, features E1 to E17, features F1 to F17, features G1 to G12, or these Is applied to a configuration limited to any one of the following features H1 to H14, the following features I1 to I11, the following features J1 to J7, the following features K1 to K12, the following features L1 to L11, and the following features M1 to M8. May be.

䞊蚘特城矀矀矀矀矀矀矀は以䞋の課題に察しお適甚するず効果的である。   The above-mentioned features A group, B group, C group, D group, E group, F group, and G group are effective when applied to the following problems.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技盀を枠䜓に搭茉しおなる遊技機本䜓を備えおいるものがある。遊技盀の前面にはレヌル郚材が蚭けられおおり、同遊技盀の前面のうちこのレヌル郚材によっお囲たれた領域が遊技領域ずなっおいる。遊技機本䜓の前面偎には圓該遊技機本䜓を芆う扉䜓が蚭けられおおり、同扉䜓においお遊技盀の前方ずなる䜍眮に配蚭された透明パネルを介しお遊技領域が芖認可胜ずなっおいる。遊技者により遊技球発射ハンドルが操䜜されるず遊技球発射装眮から遊技球が発射される。遊技球発射装眮は遊技球の発射方向を芏定する発射レヌルを有しおいる。この発射レヌルから発射された遊技球は、䞊蚘レヌル郚材に沿っお移動するこずにより遊技領域に導かれるこずずなる。   Some gaming machines such as pachinko machines are provided with a gaming machine body in which a gaming board is mounted on a frame. A rail member is provided on the front surface of the game board, and a region surrounded by the rail member on the front surface of the game board is a game area. A door body covering the gaming machine body is provided on the front side of the gaming machine body, and the gaming area can be visually recognized through a transparent panel disposed at a position in front of the gaming board in the door body. ing. When the game ball launch handle is operated by the player, the game ball is launched from the game ball launch device. The game ball launcher has a launch rail that defines the launch direction of the game ball. The game ball launched from the launch rail is guided to the game area by moving along the rail member.

䞀般的に、このような遊技機においおは遊技盀が枠䜓に察しお着脱可胜に取り付けられおおり、遊技盀の着脱を可胜ずするこずで遊技盀等のメンテナンス䜜業の容易化や機皮倉曎時における同遊技盀の入替䜜業の容易化が図られおいる。特に、近幎では遊技盀を枠䜓の前方から着脱可胜ずする遊技機が提案されおおり、䞊述した遊技盀着脱䜜業の曎なる容易化が図られおいる。   Generally, in such a gaming machine, the game board is detachably attached to the frame body, and by making the game board detachable, maintenance work of the game board etc. is facilitated or the model is changed. In this game, the game board can be easily replaced. In particular, in recent years, a gaming machine in which a game board can be attached / detached from the front of the frame body has been proposed, and the above-described game board attaching / detaching work is further facilitated.

しかしながら、遊技盀を枠䜓の前方から取り付けるタむプの遊技機においおは、遊技盀の取付容易性取付䜍眮粟床取付安定性等、未だ改善の䜙地がある。   However, in a type of gaming machine in which the game board is attached from the front side of the frame, there is still room for improvement, such as ease of attachment of the game board, attachment position accuracy, and attachment stability.

特城矀
特城遊技領域遊技領域が圢成された遊技盀遊技盀を有しおなる遊技機本䜓内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓を同遊技機本䜓の前面偎から芆うずずもに、圓該遊技機本䜓に察しお開閉可胜に取り付けられおいる扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘扉䜓を斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切替可胜に蚭けられた斜錠郚材䟋えば前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
倖郚操䜜手段䟋えばシリンダ錠及びそれに挿入しお操䜜されるキヌの操䜜に連動しお前蚘斜錠郚材を斜錠解陀状態に切り替える切替手段䟋えばカム郚材や連動杆ず
を有し、
少なくずも前蚘斜錠郚材及び前蚘切替手段は、前蚘扉䜓ず前蚘遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間内に収容されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature H group>
Feature H1. A gaming machine body (inner frame 13) having a gaming board (gaming board 80) in which a gaming area (game area PE) is formed;
A door body (front door frame 14) that covers the gaming machine body from the front side of the gaming machine body and is attached to the gaming machine body so as to be openable and closable;
A locking device (locking device 500) for locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body,
The locking device is
A locking member (for example, a front door rod member 550) provided so as to be switchable between a locked state for locking the door body and a unlocked state not locked;
Switching means (for example, cam member 530 or interlocking rod 540) for switching the locking member to the unlocked state in conjunction with the operation of external operation means (for example, cylinder lock 520 and key K inserted and operated) ,
At least the locking member and the switching means are accommodated in a space surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine main body.

特城によれば、斜錠装眮の斜錠郚材及び切替手段を扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間内に収容するこずにより、それら斜錠郚材や切替手段の露出を抑え同斜錠郚材等に察する䞍正なアクセスを困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、斜錠が䞍正に解陀され、遊技領域に察しお䞍正なアクセスがなされるこずを回避できる。䟋えば、斜錠装眮を遊技機本䜓の背面等に配眮する構成においおも、同斜錠装眮を芆うカバヌ等を蚭けるこずにより、類䌌の効果を奏するこずができる。しかしながら、このような察応を行った堎合には、カバヌが取り倖されるこずを回避するための工倫等が必芁ずなり埗る。この点、本特城に瀺した構成においおは、そのような構成の远加等を必ずしも必芁ずしない点で優れおいる。   According to the feature H1, the locking member and the switching means of the locking device are accommodated in the space surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine main body, thereby suppressing the exposure of the locking member and the switching means, and the fraud to the locking member etc. Access can be difficult. As a result, it is possible to avoid that the lock is illegally released and the game area is illegally accessed. For example, even in a configuration in which the locking device is disposed on the back surface of the gaming machine body, a similar effect can be achieved by providing a cover or the like that covers the locking device. However, when such a measure is taken, it may be necessary to devise measures for avoiding the cover being removed. In this regard, the configuration shown in this feature is excellent in that it does not necessarily require addition of such a configuration.

たた、斜錠装眮詳しくは斜錠郚材及び切替手段の配眮を倉えお防犯性を向䞊させるこずで、䟋えば斜錠装眮の数を増やしたり斜錠の手順を耇雑化したりする構成ず比范しお、ホヌル管理者等によっお正芏の手順で扉䜓が開攟される堎合の䜜業性の䜎䞋を抑制でき、メンテナンスの容易性の確保ず防犯性の向䞊ずを奜適に䞡立できる。   Also, by changing the arrangement of locking devices (specifically locking members and switching means) to improve crime prevention, for example, the number of locking devices can be increased or the locking procedure can be complicated compared to a configuration that controls the hall. It is possible to suppress a decrease in workability when the door is opened in a regular procedure by a person or the like, and it is possible to suitably achieve both the ease of maintenance and the improvement of crime prevention.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓には前蚘空間を開攟する開口郚䞭倮開口が圢成されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓には前蚘遊技盀が前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面偎からのみ着脱可胜に取り付けられおおり、
前蚘遊技盀が前蚘遊技機本䜓に取り付けられた状態にお、前蚘開口郚が同遊技盀により芆われおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H2. The gaming machine main body has an opening (a central opening 76) that opens the space,
The gaming board is detachably attached to the gaming machine body only from the front side of the gaming machine body,
The gaming machine according to H1, wherein the opening is covered with the gaming board in a state where the gaming board is attached to the gaming machine main body.

特城によれば、遊技機本䜓に蚭けられ、䞊述した空間圢成の䞀端を担っおいる遊技盀においおは、䞊蚘空間の倖郚、すなわち遊技機本䜓の背面偎からの取り倖しが䞍可ずなっおいるため、同空間を䞍正に露出させるずいった行為を抑制するこずができる。これにより、開口郚を通じた斜錠装眮ぞのアクセスを困難なものずし、防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature H2, the gaming board provided in the gaming machine main body and serving as one end of the space formation described above cannot be removed from the outside of the space, that is, from the back side of the gaming machine main body. , It is possible to suppress the act of exposing the space illegally. This makes it difficult to access the locking device through the opening, and can contribute to improved crime prevention.

たた、扉䜓を閉じるこずにより遊技盀の取り倖しを䞍可ずするこずができる。぀たり、扉䜓が遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠されおいる堎合には、遊技領域に察するアクセスが容易になるこずを抑制し、防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。これにより、䟋えば釘釘が倉圢され入賞口䞀般入賞口や䜜動口等ぞの入賞確率が倉曎されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   Further, the game board can be removed by closing the door. That is, when the door is locked in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body, it is possible to suppress easy access to the gaming area and contribute to improvement of crime prevention. Thereby, for example, it is possible to make it difficult to cause inconveniences such as the deformation of the nail (nail 87) and the change of the winning probability to the winning opening (the general winning opening 81 or the operation opening 83).

このように防犯性を向䞊した堎合であっおも、遊技領域ぞのアクセスや同遊技盀の着脱は、扉䜓を開攟するこずによっお蚱容されるため、メンテナンス時等の䜜業性が䜎䞋するこずを抑制できる。   Even when crime prevention is improved in this way, access to the game area and attachment / detachment of the game board are permitted by opening the door body, so that workability during maintenance and the like is reduced. Can be suppressed.

特城前蚘遊技盀の背面には、前蚘遊技領域に蚭けられた入球口䞀般入賞口や䜜動口等を通じお圓該遊技盀の背面偎に誘導された遊技球を回収する回収通路台座郚材の回収通路が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘回収通路は、前蚘開口郚を介しお前蚘遊技機本䜓の背面偎に露出されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H3. A collection passage (pedestal member) for collecting game balls guided to the back side of the game board through a game entrance (general winning entrance 81, operation port 83, etc.) provided in the game area on the back of the game board 141 recovery passageway)
The gaming machine according to H2, wherein the collection passage is exposed to the back side of the gaming machine main body through the opening.

特城によれば、開口郚を介しお遊技盀に搭茉されおいる構成等を遊技機本䜓の背面偎に露出させるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間䟋えば遊技領域に導かれた遊技球を入球口を通じお、同空間の倖郚、䟋えば遊技ホヌル等の島蚭備に返华する返华経路の確保が可胜ずなる。   According to the feature H3, it is possible to expose the configuration mounted on the game board through the opening to the back side of the gaming machine main body. As a result, the return path for returning the game ball guided to the space (for example, the game area) surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine body to the outside of the space, for example, an island facility such as a game hall through the entrance. Securement is possible.

しかしながらその反面、開口郚を蚭けるこずで同開口郚を介しお遊技領域ぞの䞍正なアクセスが行われやすくなったり、遊技盀の䞍正な取り倖しがなされやすくなったりするず想定される。この点、遊技盀によっお開口郚を芆うこずにより、䞍正具等の䟵入を抑制するこずができ、曎には開口郚を通じた遊技盀の取り倖しを䞍可ずするこずにより、同遊技盀の䞍正な入れ替えや䞍正な改造等を奜適に抑制できる。   However, on the other hand, it is assumed that providing an opening makes it easy for unauthorized access to the gaming area through the opening, and makes it easier to remove the gaming board. In this regard, covering the opening with the game board can suppress the intrusion of unauthorized tools and the like, and further prohibiting the removal of the game board through the opening makes it possible to illegally replace the game board. Unauthorized remodeling can be suitably suppressed.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓は、
前蚘遊技盀の背面に察向しおいるずずもに、前蚘開口郚が圢成された察向郚察向板郚ず、
前蚘察向郚から前蚘扉䜓偎に起立するずずもに、前蚘遊技盀の呚瞁に沿っお圢成された呚壁郚呚壁郚ず
を有し、
それら察向郚及び呚壁郚によっお、前蚘遊技盀を収容する遊技盀収容郚遊技盀収容郚が構成されおおり、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技盀収容郚倖に配されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H4. The gaming machine body is
An opposing portion (opposing plate portion 251) facing the back of the gaming board and having the opening formed therein;
A peripheral wall portion (peripheral wall portion 261) formed along the peripheral edge of the game board, while standing on the door body side from the facing portion;
A game board housing part (game board housing part 75) for housing the game board is constituted by the facing part and the peripheral wall part,
The gaming machine according to H2 or H3, wherein the locking device is arranged outside the game board housing portion.

特城によれば、仮に開口郚を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、察向郚や呚壁郚によっお同䞍正具の移動を制限し、斜錠装眮ぞの到達を困難なものずするこずができる。具䜓的には、遊技盀ず呚壁郚ずの隙間を通過する䞍正具を遊技領域及び斜錠装眮の䞡者から離れる偎、すなわち扉䜓偎に誘導するこずができる。これにより、曎なる防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature H4, even if a fraudulent tool is inserted through the opening, the movement of the fraudulent tool is restricted by the facing portion and the peripheral wall portion, and it is difficult to reach the locking device. it can. Specifically, the unauthorized tool passing through the gap between the game board and the peripheral wall portion can be guided to the side away from both the game area and the locking device, that is, the door body side. Thereby, it can contribute to the further improvement of crime prevention.

特城前蚘扉䜓及び前蚘遊技機本䜓の少なくずも䞀方には、同扉䜓ず同遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間においお前蚘遊技盀が配眮されおいる領域ず前蚘斜錠郚材及び前蚘切替手段が配眮されおいる領域ずを区画する区画手段ガラスホルダ及び右偎壁郚が蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature H5. At least one of the door body and the gaming machine main body is provided with an area in which the gaming board is disposed in a space surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine main body, the locking member, and the switching means. The gaming machine according to any one of H2 to H4, characterized in that partition means (a glass holder 27 and a right side wall portion 265) for partitioning the region is provided.

特城によれば、遊技盀が配眮されおいる領域ず斜錠装眮が配眮されおいる領域を区画するこずで、仮に開口郚遊技盀ず遊技機本䜓ずの隙間を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、同䞍正具が斜錠装眮に達するこずを抑制できる。   According to the feature H5, an illegal tool is temporarily inserted through an opening (gap between the game board and the gaming machine main body) by dividing the area where the game board is arranged and the area where the locking device is arranged. Even if it is a case, it can suppress that the unauthorized tool reaches a locking device.

特城前蚘遊技盀を前蚘遊技機本䜓に固定する固定手段ロック装眮を備え、
前蚘固定手段は、前蚘遊技盀を固定する固定䜍眮及び同遊技盀の固定を解陀する固定解陀䜍眮に切替可胜な操䜜郚操䜜レバヌを有し、
少なくずも前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘扉䜓ず前蚘遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間内に配されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H6. A fixing means (lock device 400) for fixing the gaming board to the gaming machine body;
The fixing means has an operation portion (operation lever 440) that can be switched between a fixing position for fixing the gaming board and a fixing releasing position for releasing the fixing of the gaming board,
The gaming machine according to any one of H2 to H5, wherein at least the operation unit is arranged in a space surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine main body.

特城によれば、固定手段の操䜜郚が扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずの間に䜍眮しおいるため、扉䜓が遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じられおいる状態では、同扉䜓を開攟するこずなく固定手段に察するアクセスするこずが困難になる。これにより、遊技盀の固定が䞍正に解陀され、斜錠装眮や遊技領域等ぞのアクセス経路が確保されやすくなるずいった䞍郜合を奜適に抑制できる。   According to the feature H6, since the operation part of the fixing means is located between the door body and the gaming machine main body, the door body is opened when the door body is closed with respect to the gaming machine main body. Without it, it becomes difficult to access the fixing means. As a result, it is possible to suitably suppress the inconvenience that the fixing of the game board is illegally released and the access path to the locking device, the game area, and the like is easily secured.

特城前蚘遊技盀及び前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面に沿っお䞊べお配眮されおおり、
前蚘遊技盀における前蚘斜錠装眮偎の端郚寄りに配され、前蚘遊技盀を前蚘遊技機本䜓に固定する固定手段ロック装眮を備え、
前蚘固定手段は、前蚘遊技盀を固定する固定䜍眮及び同遊技盀の固定を解陀する固定解陀䜍眮に切替可胜な操䜜郚操䜜レバヌを有し、
少なくずも前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘扉䜓ず前蚘遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間内に配されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H7. The gaming board and the locking device are arranged side by side along the front surface of the gaming machine body,
The game board includes a fixing means (lock device 400) arranged near the end of the locking device side of the game board and fixing the game board to the gaming machine body,
The fixing means has an operation portion (operation lever 440) that can be switched between a fixing position for fixing the gaming board and a fixing releasing position for releasing the fixing of the gaming board,
The gaming machine according to any one of H2 to H5, wherein at least the operation unit is arranged in a space surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine main body.

特城によれば、特城に瀺した効果に加え以䞋の効果を奏する。すなわち、遊技盀を遊技機本䜓の前面偎から取り付ける構成を採甚した堎合、遊技盀が仮に扉䜓偎に抌されるず遊技盀ず遊技機本䜓ずの隙間が拡匵されやすくなるず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、固定手段を遊技盀における斜錠装眮偎の端郚寄りに配眮するこずにより、䞊述したような䞍郜合を奜適に回避できる。぀たり、固定手段を斜錠装眮偎の端郚寄りに配眮するこずにより、同斜錠装眮に近い偎での遊技盀ず遊技機本䜓ずの隙間の拡がりを抑えるこずができる。これにより、䞊蚘隙間を通じお挿入された䞍正具により、斜錠装眮に察しお䞍正なアクセスがなされるこずを奜適に抑制できる。䟋えば、固定手段を遊技盀における斜錠装眮偎の端郚に沿っお耇数配眮するずよい。   According to the feature H7, in addition to the effect shown in the feature H6, the following effect is produced. That is, when the configuration in which the gaming board is attached from the front side of the gaming machine main body is assumed, the gap between the gaming board and the gaming machine main body is likely to be expanded if the gaming board is pushed to the door body side. In this respect, according to the present feature, the above-described inconvenience can be suitably avoided by disposing the fixing means closer to the end on the locking device side of the game board. That is, by disposing the fixing means closer to the end on the locking device side, it is possible to suppress the spread of the gap between the game board and the gaming machine main body on the side close to the locking device. Thereby, it can suppress suitably that an unauthorized access is made with respect to a locking device with the unauthorized tool inserted through the said clearance gap. For example, a plurality of fixing means may be arranged along the end of the game board on the locking device side.

特城前蚘遊技盀を前蚘遊技機本䜓に固定する固定手段ロック装眮を備え、
前蚘固定手段は、前蚘遊技盀を固定する固定䜍眮及び同遊技盀の固定を解陀する固定解陀䜍眮に切替可胜な操䜜郚操䜜レバヌを有し、
少なくずも前蚘操䜜郚は、前蚘扉䜓ず前蚘遊技機本䜓ずによっお囲たれた空間においお前蚘呚壁郚ず前蚘遊技盀ずの境界の延長䞊から離れた䜍眮に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H8. A fixing means (lock device 400) for fixing the gaming board to the gaming machine body;
The fixing means has an operation portion (operation lever 440) that can be switched between a fixing position for fixing the gaming board and a fixing releasing position for releasing the fixing of the gaming board,
At least the operation section is arranged at a position away from the extension of the boundary between the peripheral wall section and the game board in a space surrounded by the door body and the gaming machine main body. The gaming machine described.

特城によれば、特城に瀺した効果に加え以䞋の効果を奏する。仮に遊技盀及び遊技機本䜓の境界郚䜍を介しお䞍正具等が挿入された堎合であっおも、その挿入軌道䞊に固定手段が䜍眮しないため、同䞍正具による固定手段の切替操䜜を困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、遊技盀の固定が䞍正に解陀され、同遊技盀ず遊技機本䜓ずの隙間を拡げるこずで、同隙間を通じた斜錠装眮や遊技領域ぞの䞍正なアクセスが容易化されるこずを奜適に抑制できる。   According to the feature H8, in addition to the effect shown in the feature H6, the following effect is produced. Even if a fraudulent tool or the like is inserted through the boundary portion of the game board and the gaming machine main body, the fixing means is not positioned on the insertion track, so that it is difficult to switch the fixing means with the fraudulent tool. Can be. Thereby, the fixing of the game board is illegally released, and it is preferable that unauthorized access to the locking device and the game area through the gap is facilitated by widening the gap between the game board and the gaming machine main body. Can be suppressed.

特城前蚘扉䜓には、圓該扉䜓が前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態にお、前蚘操䜜郚の固定解陀䜍眮ぞの移動を阻止する阻止手段が蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature H9. H6 thru | or the said door body is provided with the prevention means which blocks | prevents the movement to the fixed release position of the said operation part in the state which the said door body closed with respect to the said game machine main body. The gaming machine according to any one of H8.

特城によれば、扉䜓が閉じおいる状態においおは、操䜜郚の切替を阻止するこずができる。これにより、䟋えば遊技盀の固定が䞍正に解陀されるずいった䞍郜合を奜適に回避でき、曎なる防犯性の向䞊を図るこずができる。たた、メンテナンス等で遊技盀を脱着した堎合の固定忘れ等を抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   According to the feature H9, switching of the operation unit can be prevented when the door is closed. Thereby, for example, the inconvenience of illegally releasing the game board can be preferably avoided, and the crime prevention can be further improved. In addition, it is possible to suppress forgetting to fix when the game board is attached or detached for maintenance or the like, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘斜錠郚材は、扉甚斜錠郚材であり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓は、支持枠倖枠によっお開閉可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面には、前蚘扉䜓ずは反察偎に凹み、前蚘斜錠装眮の少なくずも䞀郚が収容される斜錠装眮収容郚斜錠装眮収容郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚の底郚に圢成された貫通孔スリットによっお同遊技機本䜓の背面偎に露出し、前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切替可胜に蚭けられた本䜓甚斜錠郚材内枠甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘扉甚斜錠郚材前蚘切替手段及び前蚘本䜓甚斜錠郚材が取り付けられおいるベヌス郚材第基枠ず
を有し、
前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚においお前蚘扉䜓偎に開攟されおいる郚䜍が前蚘ベヌス郚材によっお芆われおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H10. The locking member is a door locking member,
The gaming machine body is supported by a support frame (outer frame 11) so as to be opened and closed.
On the front surface of the gaming machine main body, a locking device accommodating portion (locking device accommodating portion 77) that is recessed on the opposite side to the door body and that accommodates at least a part of the locking device is formed.
The locking device is
A locking state in which the gaming machine body is locked to the support frame and a locking release state in which the gaming machine body is not locked is exposed to the back side of the gaming machine body through a through hole (slit 303) formed in the bottom of the locking device housing portion. A main body locking member (inner frame collar member 620) provided to be switchable to
A base member (first base frame 510) to which the door locking member, the switching means, and the main body locking member are attached;
The gaming machine according to any one of H1 to H9, wherein a portion of the locking device housing portion that is open to the door body side is covered with the base member.

特城によれば、本䜓甚斜錠郚材の露出を抑えるこずができ、支持枠に察しお遊技機本䜓を閉じた状態での防犯性を向䞊できる。   According to the feature H10, exposure of the locking member for main body can be suppressed, and the crime prevention property in a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame can be improved.

たた、仮に貫通孔を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、斜錠装眮収容郚の開攟郚䜍がベヌス郚材によっお芆われおいるこずで、遊技領域等ぞのアクセスを困難なものずするこずができる。   Further, even if an unauthorized tool is inserted through the through hole, it may be difficult to access the game area or the like because the open portion of the locking device housing portion is covered with the base member. it can.

特城前蚘切替手段ず前蚘扉甚斜錠郚材の少なくずも䞀郚ずは、前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚ず前蚘ベヌス郚材ずによっお区画された空間に収容されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature H11. The gaming machine according to H10, wherein the switching means and at least a part of the door locking member are accommodated in a space defined by the locking device accommodating portion and the base member.

特城によれば、切替手段ず扉甚斜錠郚材の少なくずも䞀郚ずが遊技機本䜓ずベヌス郚材ずによっお区画された空間内に収容されおいる。このため、仮に遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずの境界郚䜍等から䞍正具等が挿入された堎合であっおも同䞍正具によっお扉甚斜錠郚材や切替手段にアクセスされるこずを抑制でき、曎なる防犯性の向䞊を期埅できる。   According to the feature H11, the switching means and at least a part of the door locking member are accommodated in a space defined by the gaming machine main body and the base member. For this reason, even if a fraudulent tool or the like is inserted from the boundary portion between the gaming machine main body and the door body, it is possible to suppress access to the door locking member or the switching means by the fraudulent tool. The improvement of crime prevention can be expected.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓は前蚘支持枠によっお回動可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘扉䜓は前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動基端偎にお同遊技機本䜓により回動可胜に支持されおおり、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に配されおおり、
前蚘ベヌス郚材は前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端郚に沿っお延びおおり、
前蚘扉甚斜錠郚材及び前蚘本䜓甚斜錠郚材は、前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向の䞀端寄りに配されおおり、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘貫通孔ず前蚘扉甚斜錠郚材ずの間に䜍眮するずずもに、前蚘貫通孔の少なくずも䞀郚を前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚の内偎から芆う壁面郚連動杆のフランゞを有しおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature H12. The gaming machine body is rotatably supported by the support frame,
The door body is rotatably supported by the gaming machine main body on the rotating base end side of the gaming machine main body,
The locking device is disposed on the rotating tip side of the gaming machine body,
The base member extends along the rotating tip of the gaming machine body,
The door locking member and the main body locking member are arranged near one end in the longitudinal direction of the base member,
The locking device is located between the through hole and the door locking member, and covers a wall surface portion (flange 545 of the interlocking rod 540) that covers at least a part of the through hole from the inside of the locking device housing portion. A gaming machine according to H11, characterized in that the gaming machine has.

特城に瀺したように、扉甚斜錠郚材を斜錠装眮収容郚に収容する構成においおは、貫通孔を通じお前扉斜錠装眮にアクセスされる可胜性が生じ埗る。特に、扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずの各斜錠郚材を回動先端偎、詳しくはベヌス郚材の長手方向の䞀端寄りに配眮した堎合、扉䜓及び遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制できる反面、䞊蚘貫通孔を通じおの扉甚斜錠郚材に察するアクセスが容易になり埗る。この点、本特城に瀺すように、貫通孔ず扉甚斜錠郚材ずの間に壁面郚を蚭け、同壁面郚によっお貫通孔の少なくずも䞀郚を芆うこずで、各斜錠郚材を近づけお配眮したずしおも貫通孔を通じお扉甚斜錠郚材に察する䞍正なアクセスがなされるこずを抑制できる。扉䜓や遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がりを抑え぀぀、それ起因しお防犯性が䜎䞋するこずを抑制できる。   As shown in the feature H11, in the configuration in which the door locking member is accommodated in the locking device accommodating portion, there is a possibility that the front door locking device may be accessed through the through hole. In particular, when the locking members of the door body and the gaming machine main body are arranged on the rotating front end side, specifically near one end in the longitudinal direction of the base member, the lifting of the door body and the gaming machine main body can be preferably suppressed, Access to the door locking member through the through hole can be facilitated. In this regard, as shown in this feature, a wall surface portion is provided between the through hole and the door locking member, and at least a part of the through hole is covered by the wall surface portion so that the locking members are arranged close to each other. It is also possible to prevent unauthorized access to the door locking member through the through hole. While suppressing the lifting of the door body and the gaming machine main body, it is possible to suppress the crime prevention performance from being lowered.

特城前蚘扉䜓が、前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じられおいる状態においおは、前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚からの前蚘ベヌス郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に圓該扉䜓が䜍眮しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature H13. In the state where the door body is closed with respect to the gaming machine main body, the door body is located on the removal track of the base member from the locking device housing portion. The gaming machine according to any one of H12.

特城によれば、扉䜓が閉じおいる状態にお斜錠装眮詳しくはベヌス郚材及びそれに取り付けられた斜錠郚材等の各皮構成が取り倖されるこずを抑制でき、特城等に瀺した防犯効果を奜適に享受できる。   According to the feature H13, it is possible to prevent the locking device (specifically, various configurations such as the base member and the locking member attached thereto) from being removed while the door is closed, and the crime prevention effect shown in the feature H10 and the like Can be enjoyed suitably.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面には、前蚘遊技盀を蚭眮する遊技盀蚭眮郚遊技盀収容郚ず、前蚘斜錠装眮を蚭眮する斜錠装眮蚭眮郚斜錠装眮収容郚ず、それら遊技盀蚭眮郚及び斜錠装眮蚭眮郚を仕切る仕切り郚右偎壁郚ずが圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature H14. On the front surface of the gaming machine main body, a game board installation part (game board housing part 75) for installing the game board, a locking device installation part (locking device housing part 77) for installing the locking device, and these game boards The gaming machine according to any one of H2 to H13, characterized in that a partitioning part (right side wall part 265) for partitioning the installation part and the locking device installation part is formed.

特城によれば、仮に遊技機本䜓及び扉䜓の境界郚䜍等から䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、遊技盀蚭眮郚及び斜錠装眮蚭眮郚間での䞍正具の移動を仕切り郚によっお劚げるこずができる。これにより、䞍正具が挿入される経路を遊技領域や斜錠装眮等の各皮䞍正察象ごずに分断させるこずが可胜ずなる。故に、どの経路でどの察象が狙われやすくなるかを絞り、想定される各䟵入経路に応じた䞍正察策の有効性を奜適に高めるこずができる。   According to the feature H14, even if an unauthorized tool is inserted from the boundary part of the gaming machine main body and the door body, the partitioning unit moves the unauthorized tool between the game board installation unit and the locking device installation unit. Can hinder. Thereby, it becomes possible to divide the path | route in which a fraudulent tool is inserted for every fraud object, such as a game area | region and a locking device. Therefore, it is possible to narrow down which route is likely to be targeted by which route, and to appropriately increase the effectiveness of fraud countermeasures according to each assumed intrusion route.

なお、特城等遊技盀収容郚を有する構成ずの組み合わせにおいおは、「遊技盀収容郚」ず「遊技盀蚭眮郚」ず眮き換えるこずも可胜である。たた、特城等斜錠装眮収容郚ずの組み合わせにおいおは、「斜錠装眮収容郚」を「斜錠装眮蚭眮郚」ず眮き換えるこずも可胜である。   In combination with the feature H4 or the like (configuration having a game board housing part), the “game board housing part” and the “game board installation part” can be replaced. In combination with the feature H10 or the like (locking device housing portion), the “locking device housing portion” can be replaced with the “locking device installation portion”.

特城矀
特城支持枠倖枠によっお回動可胜に支持される遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓をその前面偎から芆うずずもに、前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動基端偎にお同遊技機本䜓により回動可胜に支持されおいる扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠するずずもに、前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端郚に沿っお延びるベヌス郚材第基枠ず、
前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向の䞀端偎に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓の䞀方を閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切替可胜な状態で前蚘ベヌス郚材に取り付けられおいる第斜錠郚材前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘ベヌス郚材においお前蚘第斜錠郚材ず前蚘長手方向の同䞀偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに、同第斜錠郚材ずは前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向にずらしお配されおおり、前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓の他方を閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切替可胜な状態で前蚘ベヌス郚材に取り付けられおいる第斜錠郚材内枠甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘第斜錠郚材を繋ぐ付勢郚材コむルバネず
を有し、
前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘第斜錠郚材に圢成された前蚘付勢郚材の取付郚突起ず前蚘第斜錠郚材に圢成された前蚘付勢郚材の取付郚突起ずが同付勢手段により互いに逆向きずなるように付勢されるこずでそれぞれ斜錠状態に維持され、
前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚は、圓該第斜錠郚材においお前蚘第斜錠郚材ずは反察偎ずなる郚䜍に配されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature I group>
Feature I1. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) that is rotatably supported by a support frame (outer frame 11);
A door body (front door frame 14) that covers the gaming machine main body from the front side thereof and is rotatably supported by the gaming machine main body on the rotating base end side of the gaming machine main body;
Locking provided on the rotating front end side of the gaming machine main body, locking the gaming machine main body in a closed state with respect to the support frame, and locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body. A device (locking device 500),
The locking device is
A base member (first base frame 510) extending along the rotation tip of the gaming machine body;
Provided on one end side in the longitudinal direction of the base member and attached to the base member in a state where it can be switched between a locked state in which one of the gaming machine main body and the door body is closed and a unlocked state in which the lock is not locked. A first locking member (front door collar member 550);
The base member is provided on the same side in the longitudinal direction as the first locking member, and the first locking member is arranged to be shifted in the longitudinal direction of the base member. A second locking member (an inner frame collar member 620) attached to the base member in a state where it can be switched between a locked state in which the other side of the door is closed and a unlocked state in which the door is not locked;
A biasing member (coil spring 560) that connects the first locking member and the second locking member;
The first locking member and the second locking member include an attaching portion (protrusion 622) of the biasing member formed on the first locking member and an attaching portion of the biasing member formed on the second locking member. (Protrusion 554) is maintained in a locked state by being urged by the urging means so as to be opposite to each other,
The gaming machine according to claim 1, wherein the attachment portion of the first locking member is disposed on a portion of the first locking member that is opposite to the second locking member.

特城によれば、第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材をベヌス郚材の長手方向における䞀端偎にそれぞれ配眮するこずにより、その䞀端偎における支持枠からの遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がり及び遊技機本䜓からの扉䜓の浮き䞊がりを抑制するこずができる。䟋えば、これら各斜錠郚材をベヌス郚材の䞡端偎にそれぞれ配眮するこずで、防犯性の向䞊を図るこずができる。   According to the feature I1, by disposing the first locking member and the second locking member on one end side in the longitudinal direction of the base member, the gaming machine main body is lifted from the support frame on the one end side, and from the gaming machine main body. Lifting of the door body can be suppressed. For example, the security can be improved by disposing each of the locking members on both ends of the base member.

たた、第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を付勢郚材によっお繋ぐこずにより、個々の斜錠郚材に察応した個別の付勢郚材を蚭ける堎合ず比范しお、斜錠装眮の構成の簡略化を実珟しおいる。本特城においおは特に、第斜錠郚材の取付郚ず第斜錠郚材の取付郚ずが互いに逆向きずなるように付勢されるこずで、第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材がそれぞれ斜錠状態に維持される構成ずした。これにより、付勢郚材の共通化を図り぀぀、同付勢郚材の取り回しを簡玠化しおいる。しかしながら、このように付勢郚材を共通化した堎合には、各斜錠郚材を近づけお配眮するこずで、同付勢郚材の動䜜ストロヌクの確保が難しくなる。付勢郚材の動䜜ストロヌクの確保が難しくなるず、付勢郚材の配眮が困難になるだけでなく、各斜錠郚材の円滑な切替が困難になるず想定される。この点、本特城においおは、第斜錠郚材の取付郚を、圓該第斜錠郚材においお前蚘第斜錠郚材ずは反察偎ずなる郚䜍に蚭けるこずにより、䞡付勢郚材を近づけお配眮し぀぀、䞊蚘動䜜ストロヌクを奜適に確保するこずができる。故に、支持枠からの遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がりず遊技機本䜓からの扉䜓の浮き䞊がりずを抑制し぀぀、斜錠装眮の構成を簡略化するこずができる。   In addition, by connecting the first locking member and the second locking member by the biasing member, the configuration of the locking device is simplified as compared with the case where individual biasing members corresponding to the individual locking members are provided. ing. Particularly in this feature, the first locking member and the second locking member are respectively locked by being biased so that the mounting portion of the first locking member and the mounting portion of the second locking member are opposite to each other. It was set as the structure maintained by. This simplifies the handling of the urging member while sharing the urging member. However, when the urging member is shared as described above, it is difficult to secure the operation stroke of the urging member by arranging the locking members close to each other. If it becomes difficult to secure the operation stroke of the urging member, it is assumed that not only the arrangement of the urging member becomes difficult, but also it becomes difficult to smoothly switch the locking members. In this regard, in this feature, the first locking member mounting portion is provided on a portion of the first locking member that is opposite to the second locking member, so that the two biasing members are disposed close to each other. The operation stroke can be suitably secured. Therefore, the structure of the locking device can be simplified while suppressing the floating of the gaming machine main body from the support frame and the lifting of the door body from the gaming machine main body.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚ず前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚ずが互い近づく偎に付勢されるこずで斜錠状態に維持されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature I2. The first locking member and the second locking member are maintained in a locked state by urging the mounting portion of the first locking member and the mounting portion of the second locking member toward each other. The gaming machine according to I1, characterized in that:

特城よれば、各取付郚が互いに近づく偎に付勢されおいる。斜錠解陀状態に切り替える際には䞡取付郚の少なくずも䞀方が、付勢されおいる方向ずは反察偎、すなわち䞡取付郚の他方から離れる偎に移動する。蚀い換えれば、斜錠解陀される堎合には䞡斜錠郚材が遠ざかるものの、少なくずも斜錠状態においおは、それら䞡者を近づけおおくこずができる。これにより、䟋えば第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を第斜錠郚材の取付郚ず第斜錠郚材の取付郚ずを互い遠ざかる偎に付勢するこずで斜錠状態に維持しおいる堎合ず比范しお、䞡斜錠郚材の浮き䞊がり抑制機胜の差を小さくするこずができる。   According to the feature I2, the attachment portions are biased toward the sides approaching each other. When switching to the unlocked state, at least one of the attachment portions moves to the side opposite to the biased direction, that is, the side away from the other of the attachment portions. In other words, when locking is released, both locking members move away, but at least in the locked state, both of them can be kept close. Thus, for example, the first locking member and the second locking member are compared with the case where the first locking member and the second locking member are maintained in the locked state by urging the mounting portion of the first locking member and the mounting portion of the second locking member away from each other. And the difference of the floating suppression function of both locking members can be made small.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘第斜錠郚材よりも、前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向における前蚘䞀端寄りに配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature I3. The gaming machine according to I1 or I2, wherein the second locking member is disposed closer to the one end in the longitudinal direction of the base member than the first locking member.

特城によれば、第斜錠郚材を第斜錠郚材よりもベヌス郚材の䞀端寄りに配眮するこずで、特城等に瀺したように付勢郚材の動䜜ストロヌクを拡げ぀぀、それら䞡斜錠郚材をベヌス郚材の端郚に近づけお配眮するこずが容易ずなる。このように䞡斜錠郚材をベヌス郚材の端郚に近づけお配眮するこずで、扉䜓及び遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がりを䞀局奜適に抑制するこずができる。   According to the feature I3, by disposing the second locking member closer to one end of the base member than the first locking member, both the locking members are expanded while expanding the operation stroke of the urging member as shown in the feature I1 and the like. It becomes easy to arrange | position close to the edge part of a base member. Thus, by arranging both locking members close to the end of the base member, the lifting of the door body and the gaming machine main body can be more suitably suppressed.

特城前蚘ベヌス郚材は、
圓該ベヌス郚材の長手方向に延びる長板状をなし、その片偎の板面に前蚘第斜錠郚材が取り付けられおいる第ベヌス郚基枠固定郚ず、
前蚘第ベヌス郚においお前蚘第斜錠郚材が取り付けられおいる偎の板面から起立する板状の第ベヌス郚郚材取付郚ず
を有しおなり、
前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘第ベヌス郚においお前蚘第斜錠郚材偎を向いおいる板面に取り付けらおおり、
前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚は、前蚘第ベヌス郚ずは前蚘第ベヌス郚が起立しおいる偎ず同䞀偎に突出しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature I4. The base member is
A first base part (base frame fixing part 511) in which a long plate shape extending in the longitudinal direction of the base member is formed, and the first locking member is attached to a plate surface on one side thereof;
A plate-like second base portion (member attachment portion 515) that stands up from the plate surface on the side where the first locking member is attached in the first base portion;
The second locking member is attached to a plate surface facing the first locking member side in the second base portion,
In any one of I1 to I3, the mounting portion of the first locking member protrudes on the same side as the first base portion from which the second base portion stands. The gaming machine described.

特城等に瀺した構成においおは、仮に各斜錠郚材の動䜜時に同斜錠郚材ず付勢郚材ずが干枉するず䟋えば匕っ掛かるず斜錠状態ぞの切替が劚げられたり、付勢機胜が䜎䞋したりするず想定される。特城に瀺した構成を実珟するには、䟋えば同䞀平板䞊に第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を配眮するこずも可胜である。しかしながら、このような構成を採甚した堎合には、第斜錠郚材の取付郚が第斜錠郚材ずは反察偎に蚭けられおいるため、䞡斜錠郚材を繋ぐ付勢郚材が第斜錠郚材に近づきやすくなるず想定される。これは、䞊述した付勢郚材ず斜錠郚材ずの干枉を発生させる芁因ずなり埗る。   In the configuration shown in the feature I1 or the like, if the locking member and the biasing member interfere with each other during the operation of each locking member (for example, if it is caught), switching to the locked state is prevented, or the biasing function is reduced. It is assumed. In order to realize the configuration shown in the feature I1, for example, the first locking member and the second locking member can be arranged on the same flat plate. However, when such a configuration is adopted, the attaching portion of the first locking member is provided on the side opposite to the second locking member, so that the urging member that connects the two locking members becomes the first locking member. It is assumed that it will be easy to approach. This can be a factor causing the interference between the biasing member and the locking member.

この点、本特城によれば、第ベヌス郚に第斜錠郚材を取り付けるずずもに、第ベヌス郚に第斜錠郚材を取り付け、第斜錠郚材の取付郚を第ベヌス郚が起立しおいる偎ず同䞀偎に突出させるこずで、付勢郚材ず第斜錠郚材ずの間に隙間を蚭定するこずが可胜ずなる。故に、䞊述した干枉の発生を抑え、動䜜䞍良等の䞍郜合を奜適に回避するこずができる。   In this regard, according to this feature, the first locking member is attached to the first base portion, the second locking member is attached to the second base portion, and the second base portion stands upright on the attachment portion of the first locking member. By projecting to the same side as the existing side, a gap can be set between the biasing member and the first locking member. Therefore, the occurrence of the above-described interference can be suppressed, and inconveniences such as malfunction can be suitably avoided.

たた、各ベヌス郚に第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を分けお配するこずで、各斜錠郚材の動䜜領域を確保し぀぀、それら斜錠郚材を䞀局近づけるこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、扉䜓や遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がり抑制機胜を向䞊させるこずができる。   In addition, by arranging the first locking member and the second locking member separately on each base portion, it becomes possible to bring the locking members closer together while securing the operation area of each locking member. Thereby, the floating suppression function of a door body or a gaming machine main body can be improved.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚ず前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚ずが互い近づく偎に付勢されるこずで斜錠状態に維持されおおり、
前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚は、前蚘第斜錠郚材の前蚘取付郚よりも前蚘第ベヌス郚ず前蚘第ベヌス郚ずの境界寄りに配眮されおおり、
前蚘付勢郚材は、前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向に察しお亀差する方向に延びおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature I5. The first locking member and the second locking member are maintained in a locked state by urging the mounting portion of the first locking member and the mounting portion of the second locking member toward each other. And
The mounting portion of the second locking member is disposed closer to the boundary between the first base portion and the second base portion than the mounting portion of the first locking member;
The gaming machine according to I4, wherein the urging member extends in a direction intersecting with a longitudinal direction of the base member.

特城によれば、付勢郚材をベヌス郚材の長手方向に察しお傟けお蚭けるこずができ、付勢郚材の動䜜ストロヌクの拡匵に貢献できる。この堎合、仮に第斜錠郚材の取付郚が斜錠解陀時に第斜錠郚材偎に移動するず、第斜錠郚材ず付勢郚材ずが干枉しやすくなるず懞念される。この点、本特城に瀺すように、第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を、第斜錠郚材の取付郚ず第斜錠郚材の取付郚ずが互い近づく偎に付勢されるこずで斜錠状態に維持する構成ずすれば、第斜錠郚材を斜錠解陀状態に切り替える際に、同第斜錠郚材の取付郚は第斜錠郚材から遠ざかる偎に倉䜍するこずなる。これにより、第斜錠郚材の取付郚を䞡ベヌス郚の境界寄りに配眮したずしおも、付勢郚材ず第斜錠郚材ずの干枉を奜適に回避するこずができ、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   According to the feature I5, the urging member can be provided to be inclined with respect to the longitudinal direction of the base member, which can contribute to the expansion of the operation stroke of the urging member. In this case, if the attachment portion of the first locking member moves to the second locking member side when the locking is released, there is a concern that the first locking member and the biasing member are likely to interfere with each other. In this regard, as shown in this feature, the first locking member and the second locking member are locked by the biasing of the first locking member mounting portion and the second locking member mounting portion toward each other. When the first locking member is switched to the unlocked state, the attachment portion of the first locking member is displaced to the side away from the second locking member. Thereby, even if the attachment part of the 2nd locking member is arrange | positioned near the boundary of both base parts, interference with an urging | biasing member and a 1st locking member can be avoided suitably, and a practically preferable structure can be implement | achieved. .

特城前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技機本䜓に取り付けられおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature I6. The gaming machine according to any one of I1 to I5, wherein the locking device is attached to the gaming machine main body.

特城によれば、扉䜓のみを開攟させたり、遊技機本䜓のみを開攟させたりするこずが容易ずなり、メンテナンス等を行う際の䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。   According to the feature I6, it is easy to open only the door body or only the gaming machine main body, which can contribute to facilitating work when performing maintenance or the like.

たた、第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材のベヌス郚材における長手方向でのずれを枛らし、それら䞡斜錠郚材を奜適に近づけお配眮するこずが可胜ずなる。このように、䞡斜錠郚材を近づけお配眮可胜な構成に、䞊蚘特城等を適甚すれば、付勢郚材の動䜜ストロヌクを奜適に確保でき、付勢郚材の蚭眮領域確保のために䞡斜錠郚材を近づけるこずができなくなるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくできる。   Further, it is possible to reduce the displacement in the longitudinal direction of the base member of the first locking member and the second locking member, and to arrange these locking members close to each other suitably. In this way, if the above feature I1 or the like is applied to a configuration in which both locking members can be arranged close to each other, the operation stroke of the biasing member can be suitably secured, and both locking members are secured in order to secure the installation area of the biasing member. Can be less likely to cause inconvenience such as being unable to approach.

特城前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技機本䜓ず前蚘扉䜓ずによっお挟たれた領域に配されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面偎には、埌方に凹むずずもに前蚘扉䜓偎に開攟された斜錠装眮収容郚斜錠装眮収容郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘斜錠装眮が前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚内に収容された状態にお、前蚘第ベヌス郚及び前蚘第ベヌス郚のいずれか䞀方により、前蚘斜錠装眮収容郚の開攟郚分が塞がれおおり、
前蚘第ベヌス郚及び前蚘第ベヌス郚の他方は、前蚘遊技機本䜓の背面偎に向けお延びおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature I7. The locking device is arranged in a region sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body,
A locking device housing portion (locking device housing portion 77) that is recessed rearward and opened to the door body side is formed on the front side of the gaming machine body,
In a state where the locking device is housed in the locking device housing portion, an open portion of the locking device housing portion is blocked by either one of the first base portion or the second base portion,
The game machine according to I4 or I5, wherein the other of the first base part and the second base part extends toward a back side of the gaming machine main body.

特城によれば、斜錠装眮を遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずによっお挟たれた領域に配するこずで、同斜錠装眮に察する䞍正なアクセスを抑制するこずができる。   According to the feature I7, unauthorized access to the locking device can be suppressed by arranging the locking device in an area sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body.

たた、斜錠装眮を斜錠装眮収容郚に収容した状態にお、同斜錠装眮収容郚の開攟郚分が第ベヌス郚又は第ベヌス郚の䞀方によっお芆われるこずで、曎なる防犯性の向䞊が期埅できる。たた、第ベヌス郚及び第ベヌス郚の他方が遊技機本䜓の背面偎に延びおいる。このため、扉䜓に近い偎のベヌス郚に取り付けられた斜錠郚材により扉䜓を斜錠し、支持枠に近い偎のベヌス郚に取り付けられた斜錠郚材により遊技機本䜓を斜錠するこずで、斜錠郚材が過床に倧きくなるこずを抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In addition, in the state where the locking device is housed in the locking device housing portion, the open portion of the locking device housing portion is covered by one of the first base portion or the second base portion, so that further improvement in crime prevention is expected. it can. The other of the first base portion and the second base portion extends to the back side of the gaming machine main body. Therefore, the locking member is locked by the locking member attached to the base portion close to the door body, and the gaming machine main body is locked by the locking member attached to the base portion close to the support frame. Can be prevented from becoming excessively large, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘第斜錠郚材のうち、少なくずも䞀方は回動可胜に蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature I8. The gaming machine according to any one of I1 to I5, wherein at least one of the first locking member and the second locking member is rotatably provided.

の付勢郚材によっお第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を繋ぐ構成を採甚した堎合、付勢力の䜜甚する方向ず各斜錠郚材の動䜜方向ずが異なるず、各斜錠郚材が動䜜する際に回転モヌメントが発生しやすくなるず想定される。この回転モヌメントは、斜錠郚材の円滑な動䜜を劚げる芁因ずなり埗るため、できるだけ小さくするこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、䟋えば第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材をスラむド匏ずした堎合には、䞡斜錠郚材の動䜜軌道を揃える等する必芁が生じ、斜錠郚材のレむアりトに制玄が生じやすくなる。これは、䞡斜錠郚材をベヌス郚材の端郚に近づけお配眮するこずを困難にし、本来の目的たる浮き䞊がり抑制機胜の向䞊に反するこずずなるため奜たしくない。この点、本特城に瀺すように、䞡斜錠郚材の少なくずも䞀方を回動匏ずすれば、䞊蚘回転モヌメントによる圱響を抑えやすくでき、䞊述したレむアりト䞊の制玄を䜎枛できる。これにより、構成の簡略化ず浮き䞊がり抑制機胜の向䞊ずを奜適に䞡立できる。   When the configuration in which the first locking member and the second locking member are connected by one urging member is used, if the direction in which the urging force acts and the operation direction of each locking member are different, rotation occurs when each locking member operates. It is assumed that moments are likely to occur. Since this rotational moment can be a factor that hinders the smooth operation of the locking member, it is preferable to make it as small as possible. However, for example, when the first locking member and the second locking member are slidable, it is necessary to align the operation trajectories of both locking members, and the layout of the locking members is likely to be restricted. This is not preferable because it makes it difficult to dispose both locking members close to the end of the base member, which is contrary to the improvement of the originally intended lifting suppression function. In this regard, as shown in this feature, if at least one of the locking members is of a rotary type, the influence of the rotational moment can be easily suppressed, and the above-described layout restrictions can be reduced. As a result, both simplification of the configuration and improvement of the lifting suppression function can be suitably achieved.

特城支持枠倖枠によっお回動可胜に支持される遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓をその前面偎から芆うずずもに、前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動基端偎にお同遊技機本䜓により回動可胜に支持されおいる扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠するずずもに、前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠手段鉀受け郚材及び斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動䞭心軞線及び前蚘前扉枠の回動䞭心軞線は䞊䞋に延びおおり、
前蚘斜錠手段は、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓の䞀方に取り付けられ、その䞀方の回動先端郚に沿っお延びるベヌス郚材第基枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓の他方に固定されおいる第固定係止具䟋えば鉀受け郚材ず、
前蚘支持枠に固定された第固定係止具䟋えば鉀受け郚材ず、
前蚘第固定係止具及び前蚘第固定係止具の䞀方に察しお係止される第係止郚䟋えば鉀郚を有し、圓該第係止郚が係止される係止状態及び係止解陀状態に切替可胜な状態で前蚘ベヌス郚材に取り付けられおいる第可動係止具䟋えば内枠甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘第固定係止具及び前蚘第固定係止具の他方に察しお係止される第係止郚䟋えば鉀郚を有し、圓該第係止郚が係止される係止状態及び係止解陀状態に切替可胜な状態で前蚘ベヌス郚材に取り付けられおいるずずもに、前蚘第可動係止具ずは前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向にずらしお配眮されおいる第可動係止具䟋えば前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘第可動係止具及び前蚘第可動係止具を繋ぐ付勢郚材コむルバネず
を有し、
前蚘第可動係止具は、
前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向ずは異なる方向に延びる䞭心軞線を䞭心ずしお回動可胜に蚭けられおおり、その回動により前蚘係止状態ず前蚘係止解陀状態ずの切り替えがなされるずずもに、
同第可動係止具の回動䞭心軞線に察しお前蚘第係止郚ずは反察偎に圢成され前蚘付勢郚材が取り付けられおいる第取付郚突起を有し、
前蚘第可動係止具は、
前蚘ベヌス郚材に沿ったスラむド移動が可胜ずなるようにしお蚭けられおおり、そのスラむド移動により前蚘係止状態ず前蚘係止解陀状態ずの切り替えがなされるずずもに、
前蚘付勢郚材が取り付けられおいる第取付郚突起を有し、
前蚘第可動係止具及び前蚘第可動係止具は、前蚘第取付郚ず前蚘第取付郚ずが前蚘付勢手段によっお互いに逆向きずなるように付勢されるこずによりそれぞれ係止状態に維持され、
さらに、前蚘第可動係止具においおは、前蚘付勢郚材の付勢力により前蚘第取付郚が倉䜍するこずにより前蚘第係止郚が前蚘第固定係止具及び前蚘第固定係止具の䞀方に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かり、
前蚘第可動係止具においおは、前蚘付勢郚材の付勢力によっお前蚘第取付郚が倉䜍するこずにより前蚘第係止郚が前蚘第固定係止具及び前蚘第固定係止具の他方に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature I9. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) that is rotatably supported by a support frame (outer frame 11);
A door body (front door frame 14) that covers the gaming machine main body from the front side thereof and is rotatably supported by the gaming machine main body on the rotating base end side of the gaming machine main body;
Locking provided on the rotating front end side of the gaming machine main body, locking the gaming machine main body in a closed state with respect to the support frame, and locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body. Means (saddle receiving members 63, 350 and locking device 500),
The pivot center axis of the gaming machine body and the pivot center axis of the front door frame extend vertically.
The locking means is
A base member (first base frame 510) attached to one of the gaming machine main body and the door body and extending along one of the pivot tips;
A first fixed locking tool (for example, a hook receiving member 63) fixed to the other of the gaming machine main body and the door body;
A second fixing latch (for example, a hook receiving member 63) fixed to the support frame;
It has a 1st locking part (for example, collar part 625) locked with respect to one of the 1st fixed locking tool and the 2nd fixed locking tool, and the 1st locking part is locked. A first movable locking tool (e.g., inner frame collar member 620) attached to the base member in a switchable state between a locked state and a locked state;
It has the 2nd locking part (for example, collar part 555) locked with respect to the other of the 1st fixed locking tool and the 2nd fixed locking tool, and the 2nd locking part is locked. A second movable engagement member that is attached to the base member in a state that can be switched between an engagement state and an engagement release state, and that is shifted from the first movable engagement member in the longitudinal direction of the base member. A fastener (for example, a front door flange member 550);
An urging member (coil spring 560) connecting the first movable locking tool and the second movable locking tool;
The first movable locking tool is:
The base member is provided so as to be pivotable about a central axis extending in a direction different from the longitudinal direction of the base member, and switching between the locked state and the unlocked state is performed by the rotation,
A first attachment portion (projection 622) that is formed on the opposite side of the first engagement portion with respect to the rotation center axis of the first movable engagement tool and to which the urging member is attached;
The second movable locking tool is
The sliding movement along the base member is made possible, and switching between the locking state and the locking release state is made by the sliding movement,
A second attachment portion (projection 554) to which the biasing member is attached;
The first movable locking tool and the second movable locking tool are respectively engaged by urging the first mounting portion and the second mounting portion so that they are opposite to each other by the biasing means. Maintained in a stationary state,
Further, in the first movable locking tool, the first locking part is displaced by the biasing force of the biasing member, so that the first locking part becomes the first fixed locking tool and the second fixing latch. Hook from below on one of the stops,
In the second movable locking device, the second mounting portion is displaced by the urging force of the urging member, so that the second locking portion becomes the first fixed locking device and the second fixed locking device. A game machine that is caught from the lower side with respect to the other of the above.

特城によれば、斜錠手段を遊技機本䜓扉䜓の回動先端偎に配するこずで、遊技機本䜓や扉䜓の閉䜍眮からの浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制するこずができる。たた、遊技機本䜓及び扉䜓の回動䞭心軞を同䞀偎に配眮するこずで、それら遊技機本䜓及び扉䜓に察応した斜錠手段の各皮構成をたずめるこずができ、斜錠手段における構成の簡略化が図られおいる。   According to the feature I9, by disposing the locking means on the rotating front end side of the gaming machine main body (door body), the floating of the gaming machine main body and the door body from the closed position can be suitably suppressed. In addition, by arranging the rotation center axis of the gaming machine main body and the door body on the same side, various configurations of the locking means corresponding to the gaming machine main body and the door body can be put together, and the configuration in the locking means is simplified. Is planned.

遊技機本䜓や扉䜓を斜錠する堎合、各係止具をそれら遊技機本䜓や扉䜓の䞊䞋䞡端郚に配眮するこずが奜たしい。䞊端寄り及び䞋端寄りに係止具をそれぞれ配眮するこずで、䞊述した浮き䞊がりを䞀局奜適に抑制するこずができる。この堎合、各係止具の配眮が䌌通いやすくなるず想定される。そこで、本特城に瀺すように第可動係止具ず第可動係止具ずを付勢郚材によっお繋ぎ付勢郚材の共甚化を図るこずで、各可動係止具に察応する付勢郚材を個別に蚭ける堎合ず比范しお斜錠装眮の構成を簡玠化するこずができる。この堎合であっおも、各可動係止具をベヌス郚材の長手方向すなわち䞊䞋方向にずらしおおくこずで、各係止具の盞互干枉を回避し、可動係止具の動䜜スペヌスを奜適に確保するこずができる。   When locking the gaming machine main body and the door body, it is preferable to dispose each locking tool at the upper and lower ends of the gaming machine main body and the door body. By disposing the locking tools near the upper end and the lower end, respectively, the above-described lifting can be more suitably suppressed. In this case, it is assumed that the arrangement of the locking tools is likely to be similar. Therefore, as shown in this feature, the biasing member corresponding to each movable latching tool is formed by connecting the first movable latching tool and the second movable latching tool by the biasing member to share the biasing member. The structure of the locking device can be simplified as compared with the case where each is provided individually. Even in this case, by shifting each movable locking tool in the longitudinal direction of the base member (that is, the vertical direction), it is possible to avoid the mutual interference of the respective locking tools and to make the operation space of the movable locking tool suitable. Can be secured.

しかしながら、䞊䞋にずらしお配眮された各可動係止具を付勢郚材によっお繋ぐ堎合、固定係止具に察する可動係止具の係止態様によっおは、係止状態ぞの切り替えが円滑に行われなくなる可胜性が生じる。具䜓的に説明すれば、扉䜓や遊技機本䜓が回動可胜に支持されおいる構成においおは、それら扉䜓や遊技機本䜓が自重等によっお䞋方に傟きやすくなるず想定される。このような傟きに基づく䜍眮ずれの床合いは、回動先端偎にお倧きくなる。仮に、可動係止具が固定係止具に察しお䞊方から匕っ掛かる構成を採甚した堎合には、䞊蚘䜍眮ずれによっお可動係止具の䜍眮が䞋がるこずで扉䜓や遊技機本䜓を閉じる際に可動係止具ず固定係止具ずが匷干枉し埗る。これは、可動係止具に過床な負荷を生じさせ、同可動係止具の係止機胜を損なう芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。特に、䞊述の劂く各可動係止具を付勢郚材によっお繋いだ堎合、それら䞡係止具の付勢方向が逆向きになるため、䞀方の可動係止具においおは固定係止具に察しお䞊偎から匕っ掛かりやすくなるず懞念される。   However, when the movable locking devices arranged so as to be shifted up and down are connected by the biasing member, the switching to the locked state may not be smoothly performed depending on the locking mode of the movable locking device with respect to the fixed locking device. A possibility arises. If it demonstrates concretely, in the structure by which the door body and the game machine main body are supported so that rotation is possible, it will be assumed that those door bodies and the game machine main body tend to incline downward by their own weight. The degree of misalignment based on such inclination increases on the rotation tip side. If the movable latch is configured to be hooked from above with respect to the fixed latch, the movable latch can move when the door or game machine main body is closed by lowering the position of the movable latch due to the displacement. The locking tool and the fixed locking tool can interfere strongly. This is not preferable because it can cause an excessive load on the movable locking tool and impair the locking function of the movable locking tool. In particular, when the movable locking devices are connected by the urging member as described above, the urging directions of the both locking devices are opposite to each other. There is concern that it will be easily caught from above.

この点、本特城においおは、第可動係止具を回動匏、第可動係止具をスラむド匏ずするこずで、第可動係止具における第係止郚の付勢方向をそのたたに、第可動係止具の第係止郚の付勢方向を逆転させおいる。぀たり、第可動係止具においおは、付勢郚材が取り付けられおいる第取付郚を、回動䞭心軞線に察しお前蚘第係止郚ずは反察偎に配するこずで、第係止郚の付勢方向を逆転させおいる。そしお、各係止郚が各固定具に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かるこずで、䞊蚘䜍眮ばら぀きが生じた堎合であっおも、各可動係止具ず各固定係止具ずが匷干枉するこずを抑制でき、斜錠手段の保護に貢献するこずができる。   In this point, in this feature, the first movable locking tool is a pivoting type, and the second movable locking tool is a sliding type, so that the biasing direction of the second locking portion in the second movable locking tool can be changed. As it is, the biasing direction of the first locking portion of the first movable locking tool is reversed. That is, in the first movable locking tool, the first mounting portion to which the urging member is mounted is arranged on the opposite side to the first locking portion with respect to the rotation center axis, thereby The urging direction of the locking portion is reversed. And, even if the above-mentioned variation in position occurs because each locking part is hooked from the lower side with respect to each fixing tool, each movable locking tool and each fixed locking tool can strongly interfere with each other. It can suppress and can contribute to protection of a locking means.

特城支持枠倖枠によっお回動可胜に支持される遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓をその前面偎から芆うずずもに、前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動基端偎にお同遊技機本䜓により回動可胜に支持されおいる扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に蚭けられ、前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠するずずもに、前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠手段鉀受け郚材及び斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動䞭心軞線及び前蚘前扉枠の回動䞭心軞線は䞊䞋に延びおおり、
前蚘斜錠手段は、
前蚘遊技機本䜓に取り付けられ、同遊技機本䜓の回動先端郚に沿っお延びるベヌス郚材第基枠ず、
前蚘支持枠及び前蚘扉䜓の䞀方に固定された第固定係止具䟋えば鉀受け郚材ず、
前蚘第固定係止具に察しお係止される第係止郚䟋えば鉀郚を有し、圓該第係止郚が係止される係止状態及び係止解陀状態に切替可胜な状態で前蚘ベヌス郚材に取り付けられおいる第可動係止具䟋えば内枠甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘支持枠及び前蚘扉䜓の他方に固定された第固定係止具䟋えば鉀受け郚材ず、
前蚘第固定係止具に察しお係止される第係止郚䟋えば鉀郚を有し、圓該第係止郚が係止される係止状態及び係止解陀状態に切替可胜な状態で前蚘ベヌス郚材に取り付けられおいるずずもに、前蚘第可動係止具ずは前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向にずらしお配眮されおいる第可動係止具䟋えば前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘第可動係止具及び前蚘第可動係止具を繋ぐ付勢郚材コむルバネず
を有し、
前蚘第可動係止具は、
前蚘ベヌス郚材の長手方向ずは異なる方向に延びる䞭心軞線を䞭心ずしお回動可胜に蚭けられおおり、その回動により前蚘係止状態ず前蚘係止解陀状態ずの切り替えがなされるずずもに、
圓該第可動係止具の回動䞭心軞線に察しお前蚘第係止郚ずは反察偎に圢成され、前蚘付勢郚材が取り付けられおいる第取付郚突起を有し、
前蚘第可動係止具は、
前蚘ベヌス郚材に沿ったスラむド移動が可胜ずなるようにしお蚭けられおおり、そのスラむド移動により前蚘係止状態ず前蚘係止解陀状態ずの切り替えがなされるずずもに、
前蚘付勢郚材が取り付けられおいる第取付郚突起を有し、
前蚘第可動係止具及び前蚘第可動係止具は、前蚘第取付郚ず前蚘第取付郚ずが前蚘付勢手段によっお互いに逆向きずなるように付勢されるこずによりそれぞれ係止状態に維持され、
さらに、前蚘第可動係止具においおは、前蚘付勢郚材の付勢力により前蚘第取付郚が倉䜍するこずにより前蚘第係止郚が前蚘第固定係止具に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かり、
前蚘第可動係止具においおは、前蚘付勢郚材の付勢力によっお前蚘第取付郚が倉䜍するこずにより前蚘第係止郚が前蚘第固定係止具に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature I10. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) that is rotatably supported by a support frame (outer frame 11);
A door body (front door frame 14) that covers the gaming machine main body from the front side thereof and is rotatably supported by the gaming machine main body on the rotating base end side of the gaming machine main body;
Locking provided on the rotating front end side of the gaming machine main body, locking the gaming machine main body in a closed state with respect to the support frame, and locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body. Means (saddle receiving members 63, 350 and locking device 500),
The pivot center axis of the gaming machine body and the pivot center axis of the front door frame extend vertically.
The locking means is
A base member (first base frame 510) attached to the gaming machine main body and extending along a rotation tip of the gaming machine main body;
A first fixing latch (for example, a hook receiving member 350) fixed to one of the support frame and the door body;
It has a 1st locking part (for example, collar part 625) locked with respect to the 1st above-mentioned fixed locking tool, and changes to the locked state and the locked release state where the 1st locking part is locked A first movable locking member (for example, inner frame collar member 620) attached to the base member in a possible state;
A second fixed locking tool (for example, a hook receiving member 63) fixed to the other of the support frame and the door body;
It has a 2nd locking part (for example, collar part 555) locked with respect to the 2nd above-mentioned fixed locking tool, and changes to the locked state and the locked release state where the said 2nd locking part is locked A second movable locking member (for example, a front door rod member 550) that is attached to the base member in a possible state and is shifted from the first movable locking member in the longitudinal direction of the base member. )When,
An urging member (coil spring 560) connecting the first movable locking tool and the second movable locking tool;
The first movable locking tool is:
The base member is provided so as to be pivotable about a central axis extending in a direction different from the longitudinal direction of the base member, and switching between the locked state and the unlocked state is performed by the rotation,
A first mounting portion (projection 622) formed on the opposite side of the first locking portion with respect to the rotation center axis of the first movable locking tool, to which the biasing member is mounted;
The second movable locking tool is
The sliding movement along the base member is made possible, and switching between the locking state and the locking release state is made by the sliding movement,
A second attachment portion (projection 554) to which the biasing member is attached;
The first movable locking tool and the second movable locking tool are respectively engaged by urging the first mounting portion and the second mounting portion so that they are opposite to each other by the biasing means. Maintained in a stationary state,
Furthermore, in the first movable locking device, the first mounting portion is displaced from the lower side with respect to the first fixed locking device by the displacement of the first mounting portion by the biasing force of the biasing member. Caught
In the second movable locking tool, the second locking part is caught from the lower side with respect to the second fixed locking tool by the displacement of the second mounting part by the biasing force of the biasing member. A gaming machine characterized by

特城によれば、斜錠手段を遊技機本䜓の回動先端郚に取り付けるこずで、遊技機本䜓や扉䜓の閉䜍眮からの浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制するこずができる。   According to the feature I10, by attaching the locking means to the turning tip of the gaming machine main body, it is possible to suitably suppress the floating of the gaming machine main body and the door body from the closed position.

遊技機本䜓や扉䜓を斜錠する堎合、各係止具をそれら遊技機本䜓や扉䜓の䞊䞋䞡端寄りに配眮するこずが奜たしい。本特城によれば、ベヌス郚材及び可動係止具を扉䜓ず支持枠ずの䞭間に䜍眮する遊技機本䜓に配眮するこずで、それら各皮構成を扉䜓に配眮する堎合ず比范しお、第可動係止具及び第可動係止具を奜適に近づけるこずが可胜ずなる。぀たり、それら䞡可動係止具を共に䞊端寄り及び䞋端寄りに配眮するこずができ、䞊述した浮き䞊がりを䞀局奜適に抑制するこずができる。この堎合、各係止具の配眮が䌌通いやすくなるず想定される。そこで、本特城に瀺すように第可動係止具ず第可動係止具ずを付勢郚材によっお繋ぎ同付勢郚材の共甚化を図るこずで、各可動係止具に察応する付勢郚材を個別に蚭ける堎合ず比范しお斜錠装眮の構成を簡玠化するこずができる。この堎合であっおも、各可動係止具をベヌス郚材の長手方向すなわち䞊䞋方向にずらしおおくこずで、各係止具の盞互干枉を回避し、可動係止具の動䜜スペヌスを奜適に確保するこずができる。   When locking the gaming machine main body and the door body, it is preferable to dispose each locking tool near the upper and lower ends of the gaming machine main body and the door body. According to this feature, by disposing the base member and the movable locking device in the gaming machine main body located between the door body and the support frame, compared with the case where these various configurations are disposed in the door body, The first movable locking tool and the second movable locking tool can be suitably brought close to each other. That is, both these movable locking tools can be disposed near the upper end and the lower end, and the above-described lifting can be more suitably suppressed. In this case, it is assumed that the arrangement of the locking tools is likely to be similar. Therefore, as shown in this feature, the first movable locking tool and the second movable locking tool are connected by a biasing member so that the biasing member is shared, so that the biasing corresponding to each movable locking tool is achieved. The configuration of the locking device can be simplified as compared with the case where the members are provided individually. Even in this case, by shifting each movable locking tool in the longitudinal direction of the base member (that is, the vertical direction), it is possible to avoid the mutual interference of the respective locking tools and to make the operation space of the movable locking tool suitable. Can be secured.

しかしながら、䞊䞋にずらしお配眮された各可動係止具を付勢郚材によっお繋ぐ堎合、固定係止具に察する可動係止具の係止態様によっおは、係止状態ぞの切り替えが円滑に行われなくなる可胜性が生じる。具䜓的に説明すれば、扉䜓や遊技機本䜓が回動可胜に支持されおいる構成においおは、それら扉䜓や遊技機本䜓が自重等によっお䞋方に傟きやすくなるず想定される。このような傟きに基づく䜍眮ずれの床合いは、回動先端偎にお倧きくなる。仮に、可動係止具が固定係止具に察しお䞊方から匕っ掛かる構成を採甚した堎合には、䞊蚘䜍眮ずれによっお可動係止具の䜍眮が䞋がるこずで扉䜓や遊技機本䜓を閉じる際に可動係止具ず固定係止具ずが匷干枉し埗る。これは、可動係止具に過床な負荷を生じさせ、同可動係止具の係止機胜を損なう芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。特に、䞊述の劂く各可動係止具を付勢郚材によっお繋いだ堎合、それら䞡係止具の付勢方向が逆になるため、䞀方の可動係止具においおは固定係止具に察しお䞊偎から匕っ掛かりやすくなるず懞念される。   However, when the movable locking devices arranged so as to be shifted up and down are connected by the biasing member, the switching to the locked state may not be smoothly performed depending on the locking mode of the movable locking device with respect to the fixed locking device. A possibility arises. If it demonstrates concretely, in the structure by which the door body and the game machine main body are supported so that rotation is possible, it will be assumed that those door bodies and the game machine main body tend to incline downward by their own weight. The degree of misalignment based on such inclination increases on the rotation tip side. If the movable latch is configured to be hooked from above with respect to the fixed latch, the movable latch can move when the door or game machine main body is closed by lowering the position of the movable latch due to the displacement. The locking tool and the fixed locking tool can interfere strongly. This is not preferable because it can cause an excessive load on the movable locking tool and impair the locking function of the movable locking tool. In particular, when the movable locking devices are connected by the urging member as described above, the urging directions of the both locking devices are reversed, so that one of the movable locking devices is above the fixed locking device. There is concern that it will be caught easily.

この点、本特城においおは、第可動係止具を回動匏、第可動係止具をスラむド匏ずするこずで、第可動係止具における第係止郚の付勢方向をそのたたに、第可動係止具の第係止郚の付勢方向を逆転させおいる。぀たり、第可動係止具においおは、付勢郚材が取り付けられおいる第取付郚を、回動䞭心軞線に察しお前蚘第係止郚ずは反察偎に配するこずで、第係止郚の付勢方向を逆転させおいる。そしお、各係止郚が各固定具に察しお䞋偎から匕っ掛かるこずで、䞊蚘䜍眮ばら぀きが生じた堎合であっおも、各可動係止具ず各固定係止具ずが匷干枉するこずを抑制でき、斜錠手段の保護に貢献するこずができる。   In this point, in this feature, the first movable locking tool is a pivoting type, and the second movable locking tool is a sliding type, so that the biasing direction of the second locking portion in the second movable locking tool can be changed. As it is, the biasing direction of the first locking portion of the first movable locking tool is reversed. That is, in the first movable locking tool, the first mounting portion to which the urging member is mounted is arranged on the opposite side to the first locking portion with respect to the rotation center axis, thereby The urging direction of the locking portion is reversed. And, even if the above-mentioned variation in position occurs because each locking part is hooked from the lower side with respect to each fixing tool, each movable locking tool and each fixed locking tool can strongly interfere with each other. It can suppress and can contribute to protection of a locking means.

なお、特城及び特城に瀺した技術的特城を特城乃至特城のいずれか぀に適甚するこずも可胜である。   Note that the technical features shown in the feature I9 and the feature I10 can be applied to any one of the features I1 to I8.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓に蚭けられ、絵柄を可倉衚瀺する絵柄衚瀺装眮図柄衚瀺装眮ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓に蚭けられ、前蚘絵柄衚瀺装眮を制埡する制埡装眮衚瀺制埡装眮ず、
前蚘扉䜓に蚭けられ、遊技球を貯留する球受け皿䞊皿や䞋皿ず、
前蚘扉䜓に蚭けられ、光を発する発光手段ランプ郚〜ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature I11. A pattern display device (symbol display device 94) provided in the gaming machine main body and variably displaying a pattern;
A control device (display control device 825) which is provided in the gaming machine body and controls the picture display device;
A ball tray (upper plate 33 and lower plate 34) provided on the door body and storing game balls;
The gaming machine according to I9 or I10, wherein the gaming machine is provided with a light emitting means (lamp portions 23 to 25) that is provided on the door body and emits light.

特城に瀺すように、遊技機本䜓が絵柄衚瀺装眮や制埡装眮を有し、扉䜓が球受け皿や発光手段を有する構成においおは、それら遊技機本䜓や扉䜓の重量が比范的嵩みやすい。このような構成においおは、特城等に瀺した、遊技機本䜓や扉䜓の䜍眮ずれが倧きくなりやすいず考えられる。本特城に瀺す構成に察しお特城や特城を適甚するこずで、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   As shown in the feature I11, in a configuration in which the gaming machine main body has a picture display device and a control device, and the door body has a ball tray and light emitting means, the weight of the gaming machine main body and the door body is relatively easily increased. In such a configuration, it is considered that the misalignment of the gaming machine main body and the door shown in the feature I9 and the like is likely to increase. A practically preferable configuration can be realized by applying the feature I9 or the feature I10 to the configuration shown in this feature.

䞊蚘特城矀は以䞋の課題に察しお適甚するず効果的である。   The feature group I is effective when applied to the following problems.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技領域が圢成された遊技盀を搭茉しおなる遊技機本䜓を備えおいるものがある。遊技機本䜓は、遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に固定されおいる支持枠䟋えば倖枠に察しお開閉可胜に取り付けられおおり、メンテナンス等の際には同遊技機本䜓を開攟するこずにより、その背面偎ぞアクセスしやすくなっおいるものが䞀般的である。たた、遊技機本䜓には䞊蚘遊技領域等を前方から芆う扉䜓が取り付けられおおり、遊技領域の露出が回避されおいる。この扉䜓に぀いおも遊技機本䜓ず同様に開閉可胜にずなっおいるものが倚く、メンテナンス時等の遊技領域ぞのアクセスの容易化が図られおいる。   Some gaming machines such as pachinko machines are provided with a gaming machine main body on which a gaming board in which a gaming area is formed is mounted. The gaming machine main body is attached to a support frame (for example, an outer frame) fixed to the island facility of the gaming hall so that it can be opened and closed. Generally, it is easy to access the back side. In addition, a door body that covers the gaming area and the like from the front is attached to the gaming machine body, thereby avoiding exposure of the gaming area. Many of these door bodies can be opened and closed in the same manner as the gaming machine main body, and the access to the gaming area during maintenance or the like is facilitated.

このようにメンテナンス性の向䞊を図った遊技機においおは、遊技機本䜓の背面偎に配眮されおいる各皮制埡装眮や䞊蚘遊技領域に察しおの䞍正なアクセスが容易ずなるのは奜たしくない。そこで、䞀般的には、そのような䞍郜合を回避すべく遊技機本䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠するずずもに、扉䜓を遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮が蚭けられおいるこずが倚い。   In gaming machines with improved maintainability as described above, it is not preferable that unauthorized access to various control devices arranged on the back side of the gaming machine main body and the gaming area is facilitated. Therefore, in general, in order to avoid such inconvenience, the gaming machine main body is locked against opening with the support frame closed, and the door body cannot be opened with the gaming machine main body closed. In many cases, a locking device is provided for locking.

斜錠装眮は、遊技機本䜓及び支持枠に察応する第斜錠郚材ず、扉䜓及び遊技機本䜓に察応する第斜錠郚材ず、それら各斜錠郚材が斜錠䜍眮及び斜錠解陀䜍眮に各々移動可胜な状態で取り付けられおいるベヌス郚材ずを有しおいる。近幎ではベヌス郚材等の各斜錠郚材に関連する構成を共有化するこずにより、構成の簡略化やメンテナンスの容易化等が図られおいるものが提案されおいる。   The locking device includes a first locking member corresponding to the gaming machine body and the support frame, a second locking member corresponding to the door body and the gaming machine body, and each of the locking members is movable to a locking position and a locking release position. And a base member attached in a state. In recent years, it has been proposed that the configuration related to each locking member such as a base member is shared, thereby simplifying the configuration and facilitating maintenance.

䞊述した第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材は、扉䜓や遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に配眮するこずが奜たしく、特に各斜錠郚材を䞊端寄り、及び䞋端寄りにそれぞれ配するこずで、閉䜍眮からの浮き䞊がり等を奜適に抑制するこずが可胜ずなる。   The first locking member and the second locking member described above are preferably arranged on the rotating front end side of the door body or the gaming machine main body, and in particular, by disposing each locking member closer to the upper end and closer to the lower end, respectively. It is possible to suitably suppress lifting from the position.

しかしながら、浮き䞊がり抑制を念頭においた堎合には第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材の奜たしい配眮領域は䌌通いやくなり互いに配眮の制玄を受けやすくなり、狭い領域におそれら䞡斜錠郚材を共存させる必芁が生じるず想定される。䜆し、狭い領域で䞡者を共存させるこずは、䞡斜錠郚材に関連する郚品の配眮を難しくする芁因ずなり埗るだけでなく、䞊述した斜錠装眮の構成の簡略化を劚げる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。   However, when restraining the lifting, the preferred arrangement area of the first locking member and the second locking member becomes similar and easily subject to arrangement restrictions, and both of the locking members need to coexist in a narrow area. Is assumed to occur. However, the coexistence of both in a narrow region is not preferable because it can be a factor that makes it difficult to dispose parts related to both locking members, and can also prevent the simplification of the configuration of the locking device described above.

特城矀
特城支持察象倖枠によっお回動可胜に支持されおいる開閉䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配されおいるずずもに、その開閉䜓に察しお同開閉䜓の前面偎から取り付けられ、圓該開閉䜓を前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘開閉䜓に圢成された貫通孔スリットを通じお、遊技機埌方に突出し、同支持察象に蚭けられた鉀受け郚鉀受け郚材の鉀受け郚に匕っ掛かる匕っ掛かり䜍眮及び同鉀受け郚に匕っ掛からない匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮を含んだ範囲を移動可胜な鉀郚内枠甚鉀郚材の鉀郚が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘開閉䜓には、前蚘貫通孔よりも前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配され、前蚘鉀郚が前蚘匕っ掛かり䜍眮から前蚘匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮に移動する堎合に通過する領域に察しお前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎から重なる壁郚察向壁郚が蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature J group>
Feature J1. An opening / closing body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) that is rotatably supported by a support target (outer frame 11);
The opening / closing body is disposed on the rotating front end side, and is attached to the opening / closing body from the front side of the opening / closing body, and locks the opening / closing body in an unopenable state in a closed state with respect to the support target. A locking device (locking device 500),
The locking device protrudes rearward of the gaming machine through a through-hole (slit 303) formed in the opening / closing body, and is hooked on a hook receiving portion (the hook receiving portion 351 of the hook receiving member 350) provided on the support target. There is provided a hook part (the hook part 625 of the inner frame hook member 620) that can move within a range including the hook position and the hook release position that does not catch on the hook receiving part.
The opening / closing body is disposed closer to the rotation tip side of the opening / closing body than the through hole, and the opening / closing body has a region that passes when the collar moves from the hook position to the hook release position. A gaming machine, characterized in that a wall portion (opposing wall portion 305) that overlaps from the rotating tip side is provided.

特城によれば、斜錠装眮が開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配されおいるため、斜錠状態における開閉䜓の支持察象からの浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑えるこずができる。たた、開閉䜓には、鉀郚が匕っ掛かり䜍眮から匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮に移動する堎合に通過する領域以䞋䟿宜䞊通過領域ず称するに察しお同開閉䜓の回動先端偎から重なる壁郚が圢成されおいる。このため、仮に開閉䜓ず支持察象ずの隙間詳しくは回動先端偎の隙間からワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、その䞍正具による鉀郚ぞのアクセスを困難なものずし、同䞍正具によっお鉀郚が匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮に移動され、斜錠が䞍正に解陀されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。すなわち、防犯性の向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   According to the feature J1, since the locking device is arranged on the rotating distal end side of the opening / closing body, the lifting of the opening / closing body from the support target in the locked state can be suitably suppressed. Further, the opening / closing body is formed with a wall portion that overlaps from the rotation tip side of the opening / closing body with respect to an area (hereinafter referred to as a passing area for convenience) that passes when the collar portion moves from the hook position to the hook release position. ing. For this reason, even if an unauthorized tool such as a wire is inserted from the gap between the opening and closing body and the support target (specifically, the clearance on the rotating tip side), it is difficult to access the buttocks by the unauthorized tool. In this case, it is possible to reduce the inconvenience that the hook is caught and moved to the release position by the unauthorized tool and the lock is illegally released. That is, it can contribute to the improvement of crime prevention.

たた、斜錠装眮の配蚭察象ず同䞀の察象すなわち開閉䜓に壁郚を蚭けるこずで、仮に開閉䜓が閉䜍眮にお䜍眮ずれ等した堎合であっおも、壁郚ず鉀郚ずの䜍眮関係の倉化を奜適に抑制できる。぀たり、開閉䜓の支持察象に察する䜍眮ずれ等に起因した防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。䟋えば、䞍正行為者が開閉䜓を抌す等しお同開閉䜓の䜍眮を故意にずらし、そのずらした状態にお鉀郚ぞのアクセスを詊みた堎合であっおも、そのような予備的䜜業によっお鉀郚の移動が容易になるこずを抑制できる。   In addition, by providing a wall on the same object (that is, the opening / closing body) as the locking device, even if the opening / closing body is misaligned at the closed position, the wall and the collar Changes in the positional relationship can be suitably suppressed. That is, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention due to a positional deviation or the like of the opening / closing body with respect to the support target. For example, even if a fraudulent person intentionally shifts the position of the opening / closing body by pushing the opening / closing body and attempts to access the buttocks in the shifted state, It can suppress that the movement of a buttocks becomes easy.

特城前蚘鉀受け郚には、前蚘開閉䜓が前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じられおいる堎合に、前蚘壁郚の少なくずも先端郚䜍が挿入される挿入郚鉀受け郚の開口が圢成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature J2. The hook receiving portion is formed with an insertion portion (opening 353 of the hook receiving portion 351) into which at least a tip portion of the wall portion is inserted when the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the support target. A gaming machine according to J1, characterized in that:

特城によれば、壁郚の先端郚䜍が挿入郚に挿入されるこずにより、同壁郚を迂回しお鉀郚にアクセスするこずを䞀局困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、曎なる防犯性の向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature J2, by inserting the distal end portion of the wall portion into the insertion portion, it is possible to make it more difficult to bypass the wall portion and access the collar portion. Thereby, it can contribute to the further improvement of crime prevention.

特城前蚘鉀受け郚は前蚘鉀郚偎に開攟された略箱状をなし、
前蚘開閉䜓が前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じられおいる堎合には、少なくずも前蚘鉀郚における匕っ掛かり郚分の䞀郚及び前蚘壁郚の先端郚䜍が圓該鉀受け郚の開攟郚分を通じお前蚘鉀受け郚内に収容されるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature J3. The hook receiving portion has a substantially box shape opened to the hook side,
When the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the object to be supported, at least a part of the hook portion in the flange portion and the tip portion of the wall portion are accommodated in the flange receiving portion through the open portion of the flange receiving portion. A gaming machine according to J1, wherein

特城によれば、鉀受け郚が略箱状をなし、その内郚に少なくずも鉀郚の匕っ掛かり郚分の䞀郚及び壁郚の先端郚䜍が収容されるこずにより、鉀受け郚倖からの鉀郚ぞのアクセスを抑制できる。   According to the feature J3, the hook receiving portion has a substantially box shape, and at least a part of the hooked portion of the hook portion and the tip end portion of the wall portion are accommodated therein, so that the hook portion from the outside of the hook receiving portion is received. Access can be suppressed.

特に、壁郚の先端郚䜍が鉀受け郚内に収容されるこずで、同壁郚及び鉀受け郚の䞡者をかわしお鉀郚にアクセスするこずを困難なものずするこずができる。   In particular, since the tip portion of the wall portion is accommodated in the heel receiving portion, it is difficult to access both the wall portion and the heel receiving portion to access the heel portion.

特城前蚘壁郚ず前蚘鉀受け郚の開攟郚分ずの隙間においお前蚘鉀郚が前蚘匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮ぞ移動する堎合の移動方向先偎における隙間は、前蚘鉀郚ず前蚘鉀受け郚ずの掛かり代よりも小さく蚭定されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature J4. In the gap between the wall part and the open part of the hook receiving part, the gap on the moving direction front side when the hook part moves to the hook release position is more than the hooking allowance between the hook part and the hook receiving part. The gaming machine according to J3, wherein the gaming machine is set small.

特城によれば、開閉䜓が匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮偎に䜍眮ずれした堎合であっおも、壁郚ず鉀郚の䞊蚘通過領域ずの重なりを奜適に担保するこずができる。䟋えば開閉䜓を揺するこずにより同開閉䜓ず支持察象ずの䜍眮をずらしお壁郚の防犯機胜を䜎䞋させようずしおも、そのような予備的行為による防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。故に、同予備的䜜業によっお鉀郚に察する䞍正なアクセスが容易化されるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   According to the feature J4, even when the opening / closing body is caught and displaced toward the release position side, the overlap between the wall portion and the passage region of the collar portion can be suitably secured. For example, even if the position of the opening / closing body and the object to be supported are shifted by shaking the opening / closing body to reduce the crime prevention function of the wall portion, it is possible to suppress the reduction in crime prevention performance due to such a preliminary act. Therefore, it is possible to make it difficult to cause inconvenience that unauthorized access to the buttocks is facilitated by the preliminary work.

特城前蚘壁郚は、前蚘貫通孔の開口瞁に沿っお圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature J5. The game machine according to any one of J1 to J4, wherein the wall portion is formed along an opening edge of the through hole.

特城等に瀺したように開閉䜓の貫通孔を通じお鉀郚を露出させる構成ずすれば、斜錠装眮党䜓の露出郚分を枛瞮するこずができる。これにより、鉀郚を移動させる構成等が䞍正なアクセスの察象ずなるこずを抑制できる。しかしながら、鉀郚を移動可胜ずするには、貫通孔がその移動を蚱容する皋床の倧きさを有する必芁が生じ、貫通孔の小型化には限床がある。぀たり、貫通孔を通じた䞍正行為を抑制するには、貫通孔のサむズ倉曎だけで察応するのは困難であるず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、壁郚を貫通孔の開口瞁に沿っお圢成するこずにより、仮に開閉䜓ず支持察象ずの隙間を通じお䞍正具が挿入された堎合であっおも、同壁郚により同䞍正具の貫通孔内ぞの䟵入を劚げるこずができる。これにより、貫通孔を通じた䞍正行為を奜適に抑制できる。   If it is set as the structure which exposes a collar part through the through-hole of an opening-and-closing body as shown to the characteristic J1 grade | etc., The exposed part of the whole locking device can be reduced. Thereby, it can suppress that the structure etc. which move a buttocks become the object of unauthorized access. However, in order to make the collar portion movable, the through hole needs to have a size that allows the movement, and there is a limit to downsizing the through hole. In other words, it is assumed that it is difficult to cope with fraudulent acts through the through hole only by changing the size of the through hole. In this regard, according to the present feature, by forming the wall portion along the opening edge of the through hole, even if an unauthorized tool is inserted through the gap between the opening / closing body and the support target, Therefore, it is possible to prevent the unauthorized tool from entering the through hole. Thereby, the fraudulent act through a through-hole can be suppressed suitably.

特城前蚘開閉䜓の前面偎には、圓該開閉䜓を芆う扉䜓が蚭けられ、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘扉䜓ず前蚘開閉䜓ずによっお挟たれた領域に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする特城乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature J6. On the front side of the opening / closing body, a door body covering the opening / closing body is provided,
The gaming machine according to any one of features J1 to J7, wherein the locking device is disposed in a region sandwiched between the door body and the opening / closing body.

特城によれば、斜錠装眮を開閉䜓ず扉䜓ずによっお挟たれた領域に配眮するこずで、斜錠装眮の露出を抑え、同斜錠装眮に察する䞍正なアクセスを奜適に抑制できる。このように斜錠装眮の露出を抑えた構成に、特城等に瀺した構成を適甚するこずで、防犯性に優れた遊技機の実珟に貢献するこずができる。   According to the feature J6, by disposing the locking device in a region sandwiched between the opening / closing body and the door body, exposure of the locking device can be suppressed, and unauthorized access to the locking device can be preferably suppressed. In this way, by applying the configuration shown in the feature J1 or the like to the configuration in which the exposure of the locking device is suppressed, it is possible to contribute to the realization of a gaming machine excellent in crime prevention.

特城前蚘開閉䜓は、前蚘斜錠装眮を取り付ける取付郚ボスを有し、
前蚘取付郚及び前蚘壁郚は、前蚘開閉䜓に察しお䞀䜓成圢されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature J7. The opening / closing body has an attachment portion (boss 302) to which the locking device is attached,
The game machine according to any one of J1 to J6, wherein the attachment portion and the wall portion are integrally formed with the opening / closing body.

特城等に瀺したように、斜錠装眮ず壁郚ずを個別に蚭けた堎合、䞡者の補造ばら぀きや組付ばら぀き等の环積によっお、鉀郚ず壁郚ずの䜍眮関係がばら぀きやすくなるず想定される。このようなばら぀きは、壁郚による防犯機胜を䜎䞋させる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。この点、本特城に瀺すように、取付郚ず壁郚ずを開閉䜓に察しお䞀䜓成圢すれば、䞊蚘ばら぀きを抑え、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   As shown in the feature J1 etc., when the locking device and the wall portion are individually provided, it is assumed that the positional relationship between the collar portion and the wall portion is likely to vary due to the accumulation of manufacturing variation and assembly variation of both. The Such variation is not preferable because it can cause a reduction in the security function by the wall. In this respect, as shown in this feature, if the mounting portion and the wall portion are integrally formed with the opening / closing body, the above-described variation can be suppressed and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

たた、壁郚を開閉䜓に察しお䞀䜓成圢するこずで、同壁郚ず開閉䜓ずを別䜓で蚭ける堎合ず比范しお、曎なる防犯性の向䞊が期埅できる。぀たり、壁郚ず開閉䜓ずの隙間を通じお壁郚が迂回されるずいった䞍郜合を払拭し、壁郚の防犯機胜を奜適に発揮させるこずができる。   Further, by integrally forming the wall portion with respect to the opening / closing body, further improvement in crime prevention can be expected as compared with the case where the wall portion and the opening / closing body are provided separately. That is, the problem that the wall portion is bypassed through the gap between the wall portion and the opening / closing body can be eliminated, and the crime prevention function of the wall portion can be suitably exhibited.

䞊蚘特城矀は以䞋の課題に察しお適甚するず効果的である。   The above-mentioned feature group J is effective when applied to the following problems.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に固定されおいる支持察象䟋えば倖枠に察しお回動可胜に取り付けられた開閉䜓䟋えば遊技盀が搭茉されおなる遊技機本䜓を備えおいるものがある。メンテナンス等の際には開閉䜓を開攟するこずにより、同開閉䜓の背面偎等に蚭けられた各皮制埡装眮等ぞのアクセスが蚱容される構成ずなっおいるものが倚い。   Game machines such as pachinko machines have an opening / closing body (for example, a game board main body on which a game board is mounted) that is attached to a support target (for example, an outer frame) fixed to an island facility of the game hall. ). In many cases, the opening / closing body is opened during maintenance, thereby allowing access to various control devices and the like provided on the back side of the opening / closing body.

䞀般的にこのような開閉䜓を有する遊技機においおは、同開閉䜓を支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮を蚭けるこずにより、䞊蚘各皮制埡装眮等ぞの䞍正なアクセスが抑制されおいる。斜錠装眮は、支持察象に蚭けられた鉀受け郚に察しお匕っ掛かる䜍眮ず匕っ掛からない䜍眮ずに移動可胜な鉀郚を有し、それら鉀郚ず鉀受け郚ずが匕っ掛かるこずにより開閉䜓が斜錠された状態ずなるずずもに、所定のキヌ操䜜等によっお鉀郚ず鉀受け郚ずの匕っ掛かりが解陀されるこずで開閉䜓の開攟が蚱容されるように構成されおいる。   In general, in gaming machines having such an opening / closing body, unauthorized access to the various control devices described above is provided by providing a locking device that locks the opening / closing body in a state where it is closed with respect to a support target. Is suppressed. The locking device has a hook part that can be moved to a position where it can be hooked with respect to the hook receiving part provided on the support target and a position where it is not caught, and the opening and closing body is locked by the hook part and hook receiving part being hooked. In addition, the opening and closing body is allowed to be opened by releasing the hook between the hook part and the hook receiving part by a predetermined key operation or the like.

䞊述した斜錠装眮は開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配されるこずが倚く、そのように斜錠装眮の配眮を工倫するこずで、支持察象からの開閉䜓の浮き䞊がり等を奜適に抑制しおいる。しかしながら斜錠装眮を開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配する構成においおは、開閉䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制できる反面、以䞋の䞍郜合を生じやすくなるず想定される。すなわち、斜錠装眮が開閉䜓ず支持察象ずの隙間回動先端偎での隙間に近づけお配眮されるこずで、同隙間を通じた斜錠装眮ぞの䞍正アクセスが行われやすくなるず懞念される。より具䜓的には、䞊蚘隙間等から挿入したワむダ等の䞍正具を鉀郚に匕っ掛けお同鉀郚を移動させるこずにより開閉䜓の斜錠を解陀するずいった䞍正行為が行われやすくなるず懞念される。   In many cases, the locking device described above is arranged on the rotating distal end side of the opening / closing body, and by appropriately devising the arrangement of the locking device, lifting of the opening / closing body from the support target is suitably suppressed. However, in the configuration in which the locking device is arranged on the rotating distal end side of the opening / closing body, it is assumed that the floating of the opening / closing body can be preferably suppressed, but the following disadvantages are likely to occur. In other words, there is a concern that the locking device is arranged close to the gap between the opening / closing body and the support target (the gap at the rotation tip side), so that unauthorized access to the locking device through the gap is likely to be performed. More specifically, there is a concern that a fraudulent act such as unlocking the opening / closing body is likely to be performed by hooking a fraudulent tool such as a wire inserted from the gap or the like to the hook and moving the hook.

特城矀
特城支持枠倖枠に察しお開閉可胜に蚭けられおいる遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面偎に蚭けられ、圓該遊技機本䜓に察しお開閉される扉䜓遊技機䞻郚の前扉枠ず、
前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられおいるずずもに前蚘扉䜓の前方に露出し、遊技機倖郚から操䜜される操䜜郚シリンダ錠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられ、前蚘扉䜓を斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切り替え可胜に蚭けられた斜錠郚材前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられ、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜された堎合には圓該操䜜に基づいお動䜜するこずにより前蚘斜錠郚材を前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態に切り替えるずずもに、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜されおいない堎合には前蚘斜錠郚材の前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えを芏制する芏制郚材カム郚材ず
を有し、
前蚘遊技機本䜓には、遊技機偎方及び遊技機埌方に連続し、前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しを蚱容する開口開口郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、圓該支持枠が前蚘開口のうち少なくずも偎方ぞの開口郚䜍ず察向するずずもに、圓該開口郚䜍を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に䜍眮するこずで、前蚘開口を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature K group>
Feature K1. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) provided to be openable and closable with respect to the support frame (outer frame 11);
A door body (front door frame 14 of the main part 12 of the gaming machine) provided on the front side of the gaming machine body and opened and closed with respect to the gaming machine body;
A locking device (locking device 500) for locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body,
The locking device is
An operating portion (cylinder lock 520) that is provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, exposed to the front of the door body, and operated from outside the gaming machine;
Locking members (front door cage members 550, 580) provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body so as to be switchable between a locked state in which the door body is locked and a unlocked state in which the door body is not locked. When,
Provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, and when the operation unit is operated, the locking member is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state by operating based on the operation. And a restricting member (cam member 530) for restricting switching of the locking member from the locked state to the unlocked state when the operation unit is not operated,
The gaming machine main body is formed with an opening (opening 320) that is continuous to the side of the gaming machine and behind the gaming machine and that allows the restriction member to be removed.
In a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame faces at least a side opening portion of the opening and is positioned on the removal track of the regulating member through the opening portion. By doing so, it is difficult or impossible to remove the regulating member through the opening.

特城によれば、斜錠装眮の斜錠郚材や芏制郚材を遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずによっお挟たれた空間に配するこずにより、遊技機倖郚からの斜錠郚材等ぞのアクセスを抑制しおいる。぀たり、操䜜郚を操䜜するこずによる扉䜓の開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、斜錠郚材等の露出を抑えるこずにより、䞍正開攟䞍正解錠を行いにくくしおいる。   According to the feature K1, access to the locking member from the outside of the gaming machine is suppressed by arranging the locking member and the regulating member of the locking device in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body. That is, it is difficult to perform unauthorized opening (unauthorized unlocking) by suppressing exposure of the locking member and the like while allowing the door to be opened by operating the operation unit.

遊技機を搬送しおいる際、すなわち遊技ホヌルの島蚭備等に蚭眮する以前は、遊技機本䜓の開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが蚱容されおいる。この芏制郚材を取り倖すこずにより、斜錠郚材の切り替えが蚱容され、扉䜓を開攟するこずができる。このように、手間はかかるものの、操䜜郚を䜿甚するこずなく解錠操䜜を可胜ずするこずで、緊急時の扉䜓の開攟が可胜ずなっおいる。䞀方、遊技機本䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、支持枠が開口のうち少なくずも偎方ぞの開口郚䜍ず察向するずずもに、圓該開口郚䜍を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に䜍眮するこずで、開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなる。これにより、芏制郚材が取り倖されお斜錠郚材が斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられるこずを抑制できる。故に、搬送時等の扉䜓の緊急開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、遊技機本䜓を蚭眮した状態での扉䜓の䞍正開攟行為を困難なものずするこずができる。すなわち、利䟿性を向䞊し぀぀、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。   When the gaming machine is being transported, that is, before being installed in an island facility or the like of the gaming hall, removal of the regulating member through the opening of the gaming machine body is allowed. By removing this regulating member, switching of the locking member is permitted and the door can be opened. As described above, although it takes time, the door can be opened in an emergency by enabling the unlocking operation without using the operation unit. On the other hand, in a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame faces at least a side opening portion of the opening and is positioned on the removal track of the restriction member through the opening portion. Therefore, it is difficult or impossible to remove the regulating member through the opening. Thereby, it can suppress that a control member is removed and a locking member is switched to a lock release state. Therefore, it is possible to make the door body illegally open in a state where the main body of the gaming machine is installed while enabling the emergency opening of the door body during transportation. That is, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention while improving convenience.

特城支持枠倖枠に察しお開閉可胜に蚭けられおいる遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面偎に蚭けられ、圓該遊技機本䜓に察しお開閉される扉䜓遊技機䞻郚の前扉枠ず、
前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられおいるずずもに前蚘扉䜓の前方に露出し、遊技機倖郚から操䜜される操䜜郚シリンダ錠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられ、前蚘扉䜓を斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切り替え可胜に蚭けられた斜錠郚材前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられ、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜された堎合には圓該操䜜に基づいお動䜜するこずにより前蚘斜錠郚材を前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態に切り替えるずずもに、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜されおいない堎合には前蚘斜錠郚材の前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えを芏制する芏制郚材カム郚材ず
を有し、
前蚘遊技機本䜓には、圓該遊技機本䜓の偎方ぞの前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しを蚱容する開口開口郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、圓該支持枠が前蚘開口を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に䜍眮するこずで、前蚘開口を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature K2. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) provided to be openable and closable with respect to the support frame (outer frame 11);
A door body (front door frame 14 of the main part 12 of the gaming machine) provided on the front side of the gaming machine body and opened and closed with respect to the gaming machine body;
A locking device (locking device 500) for locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body,
The locking device is
An operating portion (cylinder lock 520) that is provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, exposed to the front of the door body, and operated from outside the gaming machine;
Locking members (front door cage members 550, 580) provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body so as to be switchable between a locked state in which the door body is locked and a unlocked state in which the door body is not locked. When,
Provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, and when the operation unit is operated, the locking member is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state by operating based on the operation. And a restricting member (cam member 530) for restricting switching of the locking member from the locked state to the unlocked state when the operation unit is not operated,
The gaming machine main body is formed with an opening (opening 320) that allows the regulation member to be removed to the side of the gaming machine main body.
In a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame is positioned on the removal track of the restriction member through the opening, so that it is difficult or impossible to remove the restriction member through the opening. A gaming machine characterized by

特城によれば、斜錠装眮の斜錠郚材や芏制郚材を遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずによっお挟たれた空間に配するこずにより、遊技機倖郚からの斜錠郚材等ぞのアクセスを抑制しおいる。぀たり、操䜜郚を操䜜するこずによる扉䜓の開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、斜錠郚材等の露出を抑えるこずにより、䞍正開攟䞍正解錠を行いにくくしおいる。   According to the feature K2, access to the locking member and the like from the outside of the gaming machine is suppressed by arranging the locking member and the regulating member of the locking device in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body. That is, it is difficult to perform unauthorized opening (unauthorized unlocking) by suppressing exposure of the locking member and the like while allowing the door to be opened by operating the operation unit.

遊技機を搬送しおいる際、すなわち遊技ホヌルの島蚭備等に蚭眮する以前は、遊技機本䜓の開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが蚱容されおいる。この芏制郚材を取り倖すこずにより、斜錠郚材の切り替えが蚱容され、扉䜓を開攟するこずができる。このように、手間はかかるものの、操䜜郚を䜿甚するこずなく解錠操䜜を可胜ずするこずで、緊急時の扉䜓の開攟が可胜ずなっおいる。䞀方、遊技機本䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に支持枠が䜍眮するこずで、同開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなる。これにより、芏制郚材が取り倖されお斜錠郚材が斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられるこずを抑制できる。故に、搬送時等の扉䜓の緊急開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、遊技機本䜓を蚭眮した状態での扉䜓の䞍正開攟行為を困難なものずするこずができる。すなわち、利䟿性を向䞊し぀぀、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。   When the gaming machine is being transported, that is, before being installed in an island facility or the like of the gaming hall, removal of the regulating member through the opening of the gaming machine body is allowed. By removing this regulating member, switching of the locking member is permitted and the door can be opened. As described above, although it takes time, the door can be opened in an emergency by enabling the unlocking operation without using the operation unit. On the other hand, in a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame is positioned on the removal track of the restriction member through the opening, which makes it difficult or impossible to remove the restriction member through the opening. Thereby, it can suppress that a control member is removed and a locking member is switched to a lock release state. Therefore, it is possible to make the door body illegally open in a state where the main body of the gaming machine is installed while enabling the emergency opening of the door body during transportation. That is, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention while improving convenience.

特城支持枠倖枠に察しお開閉可胜に蚭けられおいる遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面偎に蚭けられ、圓該遊技機本䜓に察しお開閉される扉䜓遊技機䞻郚の前扉枠ず、
前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられおいるずずもに前蚘扉䜓の前方に露出し、遊技機倖郚から操䜜される操䜜郚シリンダ錠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられ、前蚘扉䜓を斜錠する斜錠状態及び斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態に切り替え可胜に蚭けられた斜錠郚材前扉甚鉀郚材ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられ、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜された堎合には圓該操䜜に基づいお動䜜するこずにより前蚘斜錠郚材を前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態に切り替えるずずもに、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜されおいない堎合には前蚘斜錠郚材の前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えを芏制する芏制郚材カム郚材ず
を有し、
前蚘遊技機本䜓には、圓該遊技機本䜓の背面偎ぞの前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しを蚱容する開口開口郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、圓該支持枠が前蚘開口を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に䜍眮するこずで、前蚘開口を通じた前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature K3. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of the gaming machine main part 12) provided to be openable and closable with respect to the support frame (outer frame 11);
A door body (front door frame 14 of the main part 12 of the gaming machine) provided on the front side of the gaming machine body and opened and closed with respect to the gaming machine body;
A locking device (locking device 500) for locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body,
The locking device is
An operating portion (cylinder lock 520) that is provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, exposed to the front of the door body, and operated from outside the gaming machine;
Locking members (front door cage members 550, 580) provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body so as to be switchable between a locked state in which the door body is locked and a unlocked state in which the door body is not locked. When,
Provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, and when the operation unit is operated, the locking member is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state by operating based on the operation. And a restricting member (cam member 530) for restricting switching of the locking member from the locked state to the unlocked state when the operation unit is not operated,
In the gaming machine main body, an opening (opening 320) that allows removal of the regulating member to the back side of the gaming machine main body is formed.
In a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame is positioned on the removal track of the restriction member through the opening, so that it is difficult or impossible to remove the restriction member through the opening. A gaming machine characterized by

特城によれば、斜錠装眮の斜錠郚材や芏制郚材を遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずによっお挟たれた空間に配するこずにより、遊技機倖郚からの斜錠郚材等ぞのアクセスを抑制しおいる。぀たり、操䜜郚を操䜜するこずによる扉䜓の開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、斜錠郚材等の露出を抑えるこずにより、䞍正開攟䞍正解錠を行いにくくしおいる。   According to the feature K3, access to the locking member and the like from the outside of the gaming machine is suppressed by arranging the locking member and the regulating member of the locking device in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body. That is, it is difficult to perform unauthorized opening (unauthorized unlocking) by suppressing exposure of the locking member and the like while allowing the door to be opened by operating the operation unit.

遊技機を搬送しおいる際、すなわち遊技ホヌルの島蚭備等に蚭眮する以前は、遊技機本䜓の開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが蚱容されおいる。この芏制郚材を取り倖すこずにより、斜錠郚材の切り替えが蚱容され、扉䜓を開攟するこずができる。このように、手間はかかるものの、操䜜郚を䜿甚するこずなく解錠操䜜を可胜ずするこずで、緊急時の扉䜓の開攟が可胜ずなっおいる。䞀方、遊技機本䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖し軌道䞊に支持枠が䜍眮するこずで、同開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが困難又は䞍可ずなる。これにより、芏制郚材が取り倖されお斜錠郚材が斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられるこずを抑制できる。故に、搬送時等の扉䜓の緊急開攟を可胜ずし぀぀、遊技機本䜓を蚭眮した状態での扉䜓の䞍正開攟行為を困難なものずするこずができる。すなわち、利䟿性を向䞊し぀぀、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑えるこずができる。   When the gaming machine is being transported, that is, before being installed in an island facility or the like of the gaming hall, removal of the regulating member through the opening of the gaming machine body is allowed. By removing this regulating member, switching of the locking member is permitted and the door can be opened. As described above, although it takes time, the door can be opened in an emergency by enabling the unlocking operation without using the operation unit. On the other hand, in a state where the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame is positioned on the removal track of the restriction member through the opening, which makes it difficult or impossible to remove the restriction member through the opening. Thereby, it can suppress that a control member is removed and a locking member is switched to a lock release state. Therefore, it is possible to make the door body illegally open in a state where the main body of the gaming machine is installed while enabling the emergency opening of the door body during transportation. That is, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention while improving convenience.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、圓該支持枠が前蚘開口に察向しおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature K4. The gaming machine according to K2 or K3, wherein the support frame faces the opening when the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame.

開口䜿甚時の利䟿性向䞊を考慮するず、同開口はある皋床倧きく圢成するこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、単に開口を倧きくしただけでは、開口を通じお䞍正具が挿入されるずいった䞍郜合が生じやすくなる。この点、本特城によれば、遊技機本䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態にお開口ず支持枠ずを察向させるこずにより、開口ぞのアクセス経路を枛瞮するこずができる。これにより、芏制郚材や斜錠郚材等ぞの䞍正なアクセスを抑制するこずができ、防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑え぀぀、利䟿性の向䞊に貢献できる。   In consideration of improvement in convenience when using the opening, it is preferable that the opening is formed to be large to some extent. However, simply enlarging the opening tends to cause inconvenience that an unauthorized tool is inserted through the opening. In this regard, according to this feature, the access path to the opening can be reduced by making the opening and the supporting frame face each other with the gaming machine main body closed with respect to the supporting frame. Thereby, unauthorized access to the restricting member, the locking member, and the like can be suppressed, and it is possible to contribute to the improvement of convenience while suppressing the deterioration of the security function.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓は、前蚘支持枠により回動可胜に支持され、前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じおいる堎合には圓該遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎の䞀郚が同支持枠の内偎に嵌った状態で同支持枠を遊技機前方から芆っおおり、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に配されおおり、
前蚘遊技機本䜓においお前蚘支持枠内に嵌っおいる郚分には、前蚘遊技機本䜓における回動基端偎ずは反察偎を向いた第壁郚壁面郚、及び同第壁郚に連なるずずもに埌偎を向いた第壁郚壁面郚が圢成されおおり、
前蚘開口は、前蚘第壁郚及び前蚘第壁郚の䞡壁郚に跚るように圢成されおおり、
前蚘支持枠は、前蚘開口においお前蚘第壁郚に圢成されおいる郚䜍に察向する第察向郚壁面郚ず、前蚘開口においお前蚘第壁郚に圢成されおいる郚䜍に察向する第察向郚壁面郚ずを有しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature K5. The gaming machine main body is rotatably supported by the support frame, and when the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, a part of the rotation leading end side of the gaming machine main body is fitted inside the support frame. The support frame is covered from the front of the gaming machine in the state,
The locking device is disposed on the rotating tip side of the gaming machine body,
In the gaming machine main body, a portion fitted in the support frame includes a first wall portion (wall surface portions 311b and 312b) facing the side opposite to the rotation base end side in the gaming machine main body, and the first A second wall portion (wall surface portion 312a) that is continuous with the wall portion and faces the rear side is formed,
The opening is formed so as to straddle both wall portions of the first wall portion and the second wall portion,
The support frame includes a first facing portion (wall surface portion 385a, 386a) facing the portion formed in the first wall portion in the opening and a portion formed in the second wall portion in the opening. The gaming machine according to any one of K1 to K4, which has a second opposing portion (wall surface portions 385b, 386b) facing each other.

特城によれば、遊技機本䜓の回動先端偎に斜錠装眮を配するこずで、支持枠に察しお閉じた状態での遊技機本䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制できる。このように遊技機本䜓を回動可胜に蚭けた堎合、支持枠ず同支持枠に嵌たっおいる遊技機本䜓の䞀郚ずの間に動䜜隙を蚭けるこずが奜たしい。特に、回動先端偎では、回動基端偎ず比べお遊技機本䜓の䜍眮ばら぀き等が倧きくなりやすいため、䞊蚘動䜜隙はある皋床倧きく蚭定するずよい。たた、遊技機本䜓によっお遊技機前方から支持枠を芆う構成においおは、それら遊技機本䜓ず支持枠ずの前埌䜍眮のばら぀きが生じやすいず想定される。特城等に瀺したように、緊急時等における開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しを可胜ずした堎合、開口の倧きさをある皋床倧きくするこずで䜜業の容易化を図るこずができる。しかしながら、単に開口を倧きくしたのでは、䜜業の容易化に䌎っお防犯性が䜎䞋するず懞念される。䟋えば、遊技機本䜓をずらすこずにより同遊技機本䜓ず支持枠ずの隙間が拡匵された堎合、開口を通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しが容易になったり、同開口を通じお䞍正具等が挿入されやすくなったりするず想定される。特にの壁郚に開口を圢成した堎合を想定するず、開口ず支持枠ずが向き合っおいる方向に遊技機本䜓が抌される等しお、開口ず支持枠ずの隙間が拡がるず、開口における防犯機胜が䞀気に䜎䞋するず考えられる。   According to the feature K5, by disposing the locking device on the rotating front end side of the gaming machine body, it is possible to suitably suppress the lifting of the gaming machine body in the closed state with respect to the support frame. When the gaming machine main body is rotatably provided as described above, it is preferable to provide an operation gap between the support frame and a part of the gaming machine main body fitted in the support frame. In particular, since the variation in the position of the gaming machine main body is likely to be larger on the rotation distal end side than on the rotation proximal end side, the operation gap may be set to be somewhat large. Further, in the configuration in which the gaming machine main body covers the support frame from the front of the gaming machine, it is assumed that variations in the front and rear positions of the gaming machine main body and the support frame are likely to occur. As shown in the feature K1 and the like, when the restriction member can be removed through the opening in an emergency or the like, the work can be facilitated by increasing the size of the opening to some extent. However, there is a concern that simply increasing the size of the opening reduces the crime prevention property as the work becomes easier. For example, when the gap between the gaming machine main body and the support frame is expanded by shifting the gaming machine main body, it becomes easy to remove the regulating member through the opening, or unauthorized tools etc. can be easily inserted through the opening. It is assumed. In particular, assuming that an opening is formed in the wall portion of 1, if the gap between the opening and the support frame is widened by pressing the gaming machine body in a direction in which the opening and the support frame face each other, the crime prevention in the opening It is thought that the function will drop at a stretch.

この点、本特城においおは、開口を第壁郚及び第壁郚に跚るように圢成するこずで、䜍眮ばら぀きの圱響による防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑えやすくしおいる。具䜓的には、第壁郚における開口の䞀郚ず第察向郚ずの間隔が拡がっおも、第壁郚における開口の䞀郚ず第察向郚ずの間隔の拡がりを抑えるこずができる。たた、第壁郚における開口の䞀郚ず第察向郚ずの間隔が拡がっおも、第壁郚における開口の䞀郚ず第察向郚ずの間隔の拡がりを抑えるこずができる。これにより、遊技機本䜓の䜍眮ばら぀き等に起因しお、防犯機胜が䞀気に䜎䞋するこずを抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In this respect, in this feature, the opening is formed so as to straddle the first wall portion and the second wall portion, thereby making it easy to suppress the deterioration of the security function due to the influence of the position variation. Specifically, even if the interval between the part of the opening in the first wall part and the first opposing part is expanded, the increase in the distance between the part of the opening in the second wall part and the second opposing part can be suppressed. it can. Moreover, even if the space | interval of a part of opening in a 2nd wall part and a 2nd opposing part expands, the expansion of the space | interval of a part of opening in a 1st wall part and a 1st opposing part can be suppressed. As a result, it is possible to prevent the crime prevention function from being reduced at a stretch due to variations in the position of the gaming machine body, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘開口においお前蚘第壁郚に圢成されおいる郚䜍ず、前蚘第壁郚に圢成されおいる郚䜍ずは、それら䞡郚䜍を通じおの前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しを蚱容するずずもに、それら䞡郚䜍の䞀方を通じおの前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しが䞍可ずなるように圢成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature K6. In the opening, the part formed in the first wall part and the part formed in the second wall part allow removal of the regulating member through both parts, and one of these parts. The gaming machine according to K5, wherein the gaming machine is formed such that the regulating member cannot be removed through the machine.

特城によれば、開口においお第壁郚に圢成されおいる郚䜍以䞋䟿宜䞊、第開口郚䜍ず称する及び第壁郚に圢成されおいる郚䜍以䞋䟿宜䞊、第開口郚䜍ず称するは、それら䞡郚䜍の䞀方を通じおの前蚘芏制郚材の取り倖しが䞍可ずなるように圢成されおいる。第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずが察向しおいる方向ぞ遊技機本䜓が抌される等した堎合、第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずの隙間は拡がりやすくなるものの、第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずの隙間の拡がりを抑えるこずは可胜である。第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずの隙間が拡がったずしおも、第開口郚䜍のみを通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しは䞍可ずなっおいるこずで、防犯機胜を発揮するこずができる。たた、第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずが察向しおいる方向ぞ遊技機本䜓が抌される等した堎合、第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずの隙間は拡がりやすくなるものの、第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずの隙間の拡がりを抑えるこずは可胜である。第開口郚䜍ず第壁郚ずの隙間が拡がったずしおも、第開口郚䜍のみを通じた芏制郚材の取り倖しは䞍可ずなっおいるこずで、防犯機胜を発揮するこずができる。故に、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑え぀぀、開口を拡げるこずによる䜜業の容易化に貢献できる。   According to the feature K6, a portion formed in the first wall portion in the opening (hereinafter referred to as a first opening portion for convenience) and a portion formed in the second wall portion (hereinafter referred to as a second opening portion for convenience). ) Is formed such that it is impossible to remove the restricting member through one of the two parts. When the gaming machine main body is pushed in a direction in which the second opening portion and the second wall portion are opposed to each other, the gap between the second opening portion and the second wall portion is likely to widen, but the first opening portion and It is possible to suppress the spread of the gap with the first wall portion. Even if the gap between the second opening portion and the second wall portion widens, it is impossible to remove the regulating member only through the second opening portion, so that the crime prevention function can be exhibited. In addition, when the gaming machine main body is pushed in a direction in which the first opening portion and the first wall portion are opposed to each other, the gap between the first opening portion and the first wall portion is likely to widen, but the second opening It is possible to suppress the spread of the gap between the part and the second wall portion. Even if the gap between the first opening portion and the first wall portion widens, it is impossible to remove the restricting member only through the first opening portion, so that the crime prevention function can be exhibited. Therefore, it is possible to contribute to facilitating work by widening the opening while suppressing deterioration in crime prevention.

特城前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘操䜜郚が操䜜された堎合に前蚘芏制郚材に連動しお解錠偎ぞ移動し、前蚘斜錠郚材を前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態ぞ切り替える移動郚材連動杆が蚭けられおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature K7. The locking device has a moving member (interlocking rod 540) that moves to the unlocking side in conjunction with the regulating member when the operation unit is operated, and switches the locking member from the locked state to the unlocked state. The gaming machine according to any one of K1 to K6, characterized in that is provided.

特城等に瀺したように、斜錠装眮詳しくは芏制郚材ぞのアクセスを蚱容する開口が圢成されおいる堎合、圓該開口を介しお芏制郚材以倖の構成、䟋えば斜錠郚材にアクセスされるこずは奜たしくない。本特城においおは、移動郚材を介しお芏制郚材ず斜錠郚材ずを連動させるこずにより、開口から斜錠郚材を遠ざけお配眮するこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、同開口を通じおの斜錠郚材ぞのアクセスを困難なものずするこずができる。故に、利䟿性を向䞊し぀぀、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑制できる。   As shown in the feature K1 and the like, when an opening that allows access to the locking device (specifically, a regulating member) is formed, the configuration other than the regulating member, for example, the locking member is accessed through the opening. Is not preferred. In this feature, it is possible to dispose the locking member away from the opening by interlocking the regulating member and the locking member via the moving member. Thereby, the access to the locking member through the opening can be made difficult. Therefore, it is possible to suppress a decrease in crime prevention while improving convenience.

特城前蚘斜錠郚材は、前蚘遊技機本䜓の䞀偎郚に沿っお䞊蚭された第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材を有しおなり、
前蚘第斜錠郚材を斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する第付勢手段コむルバネず、
前蚘第斜錠郚材を斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する第付勢手段コむルバネず
を備え、
前蚘各斜錠郚材は、前蚘移動郚材が解錠偎ぞ移動しおいない堎合には前蚘各付勢手段の付勢力により、それぞれ独立しお前蚘斜錠状態に維持され、
前蚘開口は、前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘第斜錠郚材の䞀方寄りに配されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature K8. The locking member has a first locking member and a second locking member arranged in parallel along one side of the gaming machine main body,
First biasing means (coil spring 560) for biasing the first locking member toward the locking position;
Second urging means (coil spring 560) for urging the second locking member toward the locking position;
Each locking member is independently maintained in the locked state by the urging force of each urging means when the moving member has not moved to the unlocking side,
The game machine according to K7, wherein the opening is arranged closer to one of the first locking member and the second locking member.

特城によれば、各斜錠郚材を個別に斜錠状態に維持しおおくこずで、仮に開口を通じおそれら斜錠郚材にアクセスされた堎合であっおも、䞀床に䞡方の斜錠郚材を斜錠解陀状態に切り替えるこずが難しくなっおいる。これにより、防犯性の向䞊を図っおいる。特に、開口を第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材の䞀方寄りに配するこずで、少なくずも開口から遠い他方に察しおのアクセスを難しくするこずができる。これにより、扉䜓の䞍正開攟を奜適に抑制できる。   According to the feature K8, by maintaining each locking member individually in the locked state, even if the locking members are accessed through the opening, both the locking members are switched to the unlocked state at once. It has become difficult. Thereby, the improvement of crime prevention is aimed at. In particular, by arranging the opening closer to one of the first locking member and the second locking member, it is possible to make at least access to the other far from the opening difficult. Thereby, unauthorized opening of a door body can be controlled suitably.

なお、移動郚材を甚いた斜錠郚材の斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えは斜錠郚材の数に関わらず䞀遍に執り行うこずができる。぀たり、正芏の手順で芏制郚材を取り倖した埌は、移動郚材を移動させるこずにより、党おの斜錠郚材の切り替えが可胜ずなる。これにより、防犯性を向䞊し぀぀䜜業の煩雑化を抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   Note that the switching of the locking member using the moving member to the unlocked state can be performed uniformly regardless of the number of locking members. That is, after the restricting member is removed by a regular procedure, all the locking members can be switched by moving the moving member. Thereby, the complexity of work can be suppressed while improving crime prevention, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘斜錠郚材は、前蚘開閉䜓の䞀偎郚に沿っお耇数䞊蚭され、
前蚘各斜錠郚材を、斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する付勢手段コむルバネを備え、
前蚘各斜錠郚材は、前蚘移動郚材が解錠偎ぞ移動しおいない堎合には前蚘付勢手段の付勢力により、それぞれ独立しお斜錠状態で維持され、
前蚘開口は、前蚘斜錠郚材の䞊蚭方向においお、前蚘斜錠郚材矀の䞡端に配眮された぀よりも倖偎ずなる䜍眮に配されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature K9. A plurality of the locking members are juxtaposed along one side of the opening / closing body,
A biasing means (coil spring 560) for biasing each locking member toward the locking position;
Each of the locking members is independently maintained in a locked state by the urging force of the urging means when the moving member has not moved to the unlocking side,
The gaming machine according to K7, wherein the opening is arranged at a position outside the two arranged at both ends of the locking member group in the direction in which the locking members are arranged.

特城によれば、仮に開口を通じお䞀方の斜錠郚材にアクセスされた堎合であっおも、その斜錠郚材によっお他の斜錠郚材ぞのアクセスを劚げるこずができる。぀たり、開口に近い䞀の斜錠郚材を、他の斜錠郚材ぞのアクセス経路䞊の障害物ずしお利甚できる。たた、各々の斜錠郚材が独立しお切り替え可胜ずなっおいるため、扉䜓を開攟するには党おの斜錠郚材の切り替えを行う必芁が生じるが、䞊述の劂く、少なくずもの斜錠郚材に察するアクセスを困難なものずするこずで、扉䜓の䞍正開攟を奜適に抑制できる。   According to the feature K9, even if one locking member is accessed through the opening, the locking member can prevent access to the other locking member. That is, one locking member close to the opening can be used as an obstacle on the access path to another locking member. In addition, since each locking member can be switched independently, it is necessary to switch all the locking members in order to open the door body. However, as described above, access to at least one locking member is required. By making it difficult, unauthorized opening of the door body can be suitably suppressed.

なお、移動郚材を甚いた斜錠郚材の斜錠解陀状態ぞの切り替えは斜錠郚材の数に関わらず䞀遍に執り行うこずができる。぀たり、正芏の手順で芏制郚材を取り倖した埌は、移動郚材を移動させるこずにより、党おの斜錠郚材の切り替えが可胜ずなる。これにより、防犯性を向䞊し぀぀䜜業の煩雑化を抑制でき、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   Note that the switching of the locking member using the moving member to the unlocked state can be performed uniformly regardless of the number of locking members. That is, after the restricting member is removed by a regular procedure, all the locking members can be switched by moving the moving member. Thereby, the complexity of work can be suppressed while improving crime prevention, and a practically preferable configuration can be realized.

特城前蚘斜錠郚材は前蚘扉䜓を閉じた状態で斜錠する扉䜓甚斜錠郚材であり、
前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘遊技機本䜓及び前蚘扉䜓によっお挟たれた空間に蚭けられおいるずずもに、同遊技機本䜓に圢成された貫通孔スリットを介しお前蚘支持枠偎に露出しおおり、前蚘遊技機本䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する本䜓甚斜錠郚材内枠甚鉀郚材が耇数蚭けられおおり、
前蚘開口は、前蚘本䜓甚斜錠郚材の間に配眮されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature K10. The locking member is a door locking member that locks the door closed.
The locking device is provided in a space sandwiched between the gaming machine main body and the door body, and is exposed to the support frame side through a through hole (slit 303) formed in the gaming machine main body. A plurality of main body locking members (inner frame hook members 620) for locking the gaming machine main body closed with respect to the support frame;
The gaming machine according to any one of K1 to K9, wherein the opening is arranged between the locking members for the main body.

特城によれば、開口を本䜓甚斜錠郚材の間に配眮するこずにより、遊技機本䜓が支持枠に察しお閉じられおいる状態での、開口呚蟺における支持枠ず遊技機本䜓ずの境界の拡がりを抑制できる。これにより、開口を通じおの斜錠装眮に察する䞍正なアクセスを抑制し、防犯性の曎なる向䞊に貢献できる。   According to the feature K10, by arranging the opening between the locking members for the main body, the boundary between the support frame and the gaming machine main body around the opening when the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame. Expansion can be suppressed. Thereby, the unauthorized access to the locking device through the opening can be suppressed, and the crime prevention can be further improved.

特城前蚘本䜓甚斜錠郚材を、斜錠䜍眮に向けお付勢する本䜓甚付勢手段コむルバネを備え、
前蚘各本䜓甚斜錠郚材は、前蚘本䜓甚付勢手段の付勢力により、それぞれ独立しお斜錠状態に維持され、
前蚘本䜓甚斜錠郚材のうち少なくずも぀は、前蚘開口に察しお前蚘扉䜓甚斜錠郚材を挟んだ反察偎に配されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature K11. A main body biasing means (coil spring 560) for biasing the main body locking member toward the locking position;
Each main body locking member is independently maintained in a locked state by the biasing force of the main body biasing means,
The game machine according to K10, wherein at least one of the locking members for the main body is disposed on an opposite side of the opening with the locking member for the door body interposed therebetween.

特城に瀺したように本䜓甚斜錠郚材を有する構成においおは、同本䜓甚斜錠郚材が解錠されるこずにより開口が露になる。仮に本䜓甚斜錠郚材が䞍正に解錠されるず、芏制郚材の䞍正な取り倖しを回避するこずが困難ずなる。そしお、芏制郚材が取り倖されるこずで、扉䜓が䞍正に開攟され埗る。   In the configuration having the main body locking member as shown in the feature K10, the opening is exposed when the main body locking member is unlocked. If the locking member for main body is unlocked illegally, it is difficult to avoid unauthorized removal of the regulating member. And a door can be opened illegally by removing a control member.

この点、本特城においおは、本䜓甚斜錠郚材ず開口ずの間に扉䜓甚斜錠郚材を少なくずも぀配眮するこずで、同扉䜓甚斜錠郚材によっお開口を通じた同本䜓甚斜錠郚材ぞの䞍正なアクセスを抑制できる。各本䜓甚斜錠郚材は、互いに独立しお斜錠状態に維持されおいるため、少なくずも぀が斜錠状態で維持されおいるこずで、䞍正開攟を劚げるこずができる。そしお、本䜓甚斜錠郚材ず開口ずの間に配眮された扉䜓甚斜錠郚材によっお同本䜓甚鉀郚材ぞのアクセスを劚げるこずで、圓該本䜓甚鉀郚材の解錠を困難なものずするこずができる。故に、遊技機本䜓が䞍正開攟され、支持枠による防犯機胜が損なわれるずいった䞍郜合を生じにくくするこずができる。   In this respect, in this feature, by disposing at least one door locking member between the main body locking member and the opening, the door locking member can be used to improperly lock the main body through the opening. Access can be suppressed. Since each locking member for main bodies is maintained in the locked state independently of each other, unauthorized opening can be prevented by maintaining at least one in the locked state. And it may be difficult to unlock the main body heel member by preventing access to the main body heel member by the door body locking member disposed between the main body locking member and the opening. it can. Therefore, it is possible to prevent the inconvenience that the gaming machine main body is illegally opened and the security function by the support frame is impaired.

特城前蚘芏制郚材を前蚘遊技機本䜓に固定する固定具ネゞを備え、
前蚘遊技機本䜓が前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、前蚘支持枠が前蚘固定具の取り倖し軌道䞊に䜍眮しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature K12. A fixing tool (screw 531) for fixing the regulating member to the gaming machine body;
The gaming machine according to any one of K1 to K11, wherein when the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, the support frame is located on a removal track of the fixture. .

特城によれば、遊技機本䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態では、固定具の取り倖しが䞍可ずなる。これにより芏制郚材の取り倖しを䞍可ずする構成ず比范しお曎なる防犯性の向䞊が期埅できる。具䜓的には、芏制郚材を取り倖すのではなく、同芏制郚材を遊技機本䜓内でずらすずいった行為を困難なものずするこずができる。   According to the feature K12, when the gaming machine main body is closed with respect to the support frame, it is impossible to remove the fixture. As a result, further improvement in crime prevention can be expected as compared with a configuration that makes it impossible to remove the regulating member. Specifically, it is possible to make it difficult to displace the regulating member in the gaming machine main body instead of removing the regulating member.

䞊蚘特城矀は以䞋の課題に察しお適甚するず効果的である。   The feature K group is effective when applied to the following problems.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技盀が搭茉されおなる遊技機本䜓ず、遊技機本䜓を前面偎から芆う扉䜓ずを備えおいるものがある。扉䜓は遊技機本䜓によっお開閉可胜に支持されおおり、メンテナンス等の際には同扉䜓を開攟するこずにより、遊技盀に圢成された遊技領域等ぞのアクセスが蚱容される構成ずなっおいる。   Some gaming machines such as pachinko machines are provided with a gaming machine body on which a gaming board is mounted and a door body that covers the gaming machine body from the front side. The door body is supported by the gaming machine main body so that it can be opened and closed. During maintenance, etc., the door body is opened to allow access to a game area formed on the game board. Yes.

たた、このような遊技機は、扉䜓を遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮を備え、所定のキヌ操䜜等によっお斜錠が解陀され開閉䜓の開攟を蚱容するように構成されおいるのが䞀般的である。斜錠装眮は、遊技機前方にキヌの差し蟌み口が露出しおいるキヌシリンダ同キヌシリンダに差し蟌たれるキヌの回動操䜜に連動しお回動されるカム同カムの回動に連動しお移動する移動郚材等を備えおいる。カムは、䞊述したキヌ操䜜による動䜜が蚱容されおいるものの、キヌを甚いるこずなく同カムを盎接動かすこずが䞍可ずなるように圢成されおいるものが倚い。これにより防犯性の向䞊が図られおいる。   In addition, such a gaming machine includes a locking device that locks the door body in a state in which it cannot be opened with the door body closed with respect to the gaming machine main body, and is unlocked by a predetermined key operation or the like so that the opening / closing body can be opened. Generally, it is configured as follows. The locking device consists of a key cylinder with the key slot exposed in the front of the gaming machine, a cam that is rotated in conjunction with the rotation operation of the key that is inserted into the key cylinder, and the rotation of the cam. It includes a moving member that moves. Although the cam is permitted to operate by the key operation described above, the cam is often formed so that the cam cannot be directly moved without using a key. As a result, crime prevention is improved.

近幎では、斜錠装眮に察する䞍正なアクセス等を抑制すべく、同斜錠装眮を扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずの間に配眮し、䞊蚘カムや移動郚材等の露出を抑えたものがある。しかしながら、斜錠装眮を芆い隠し、同斜錠郚材に察する䞍正なアクセスを抑制する構成を採甚した堎合には確かに防犯性は向䞊するものの、それに起因しお緊急時等の扉䜓の開攟が䞍胜ずなり埗る。これは、正芏の目的で遊技機を取り扱う者補造業者やホヌル管理者等にずっおは䞍䟿ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。   In recent years, in order to suppress unauthorized access to the locking device, the locking device is disposed between the door body and the gaming machine main body to suppress the exposure of the cam and the moving member. However, when a configuration that covers and conceals the locking device and suppresses unauthorized access to the locking member is used, the crime prevention property is certainly improved, but it may be impossible to open the door body in an emergency. . This is not preferable because it can be inconvenient for those who handle gaming machines for legitimate purposes (manufacturers, hall managers, etc.).

特城矀
特城遊技機本䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓の䞀偎郚に蚭けられ、遊技に関しおの所定の操䜜が行われる遊技甚操䜜郚遊技球発射ハンドルず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓における前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚ずは反察偎の偎郚にお回動可胜に支持され、同遊技機本䜓においお前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚が蚭けられおいる領域以倖の領域を遊技機前方から芆うずずもに、前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚を前蚘遊技機本䜓に残留させたたた開閉可胜な扉䜓前扉枠ず、
前蚘扉䜓を前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚が蚭けられた前蚘遊技機本䜓の䞀偎郚に、圓該遊技甚操䜜郚ず共に䞊べお配眮されおいる第斜錠郚材前扉甚第鉀郚材ず、
前蚘遊技機本䜓における前蚘扉䜓を支持しおいる偎の偎郚及び前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚の間に配眮されおいる第斜錠郚材前扉甚第鉀郚材ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature L group>
Feature L1. A gaming machine main body (inner frame 13 of gaming machine main part 12);
A game operation unit (game ball launching handle 40) provided on one side of the gaming machine main body, for performing a predetermined operation relating to a game;
An area other than the area where the gaming operation section is provided in the gaming machine main body is supported by a side portion opposite to the gaming operation section from the front of the gaming machine. A door body (front door frame 14) that can be opened and closed with the gaming operation unit remaining in the gaming machine body,
A locking device (locking device 500) for locking the door body in a closed state with respect to the gaming machine main body,
The locking device is
A first locking member (first door member 550 for the front door) arranged side by side with the game operation unit on one side of the gaming machine body provided with the game operation unit;
A second locking member (front door second heel member 580) disposed between the side of the gaming machine main body that supports the door and the gaming operation unit; A gaming machine characterized by

特城によれば、遊技機本䜓に察しお遊技甚操䜜郚及び扉䜓を個別に蚭けおおり、扉䜓を開攟する際には遊技甚操䜜郚が遊技機本䜓に残留する構成ずなっおいる。このように遊技甚操䜜郚が残留する構成においおは、同遊技甚操䜜郚呚蟺での扉䜓の浮き䞊がりが発生しやすくなるず懞念される。䟋えば、扉䜓における遊技甚操䜜郚呚蟺を匕っ匵る等しお、遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずの隙間境界郚䜍が拡匵され、その隙間を介しおワむダ等の䞍正具が挿入されるこずで、遊技領域等ぞのアクセスが容易になるず懞念される。   According to the feature L1, the gaming operation unit and the door are individually provided for the gaming machine body, and the gaming operation unit remains in the gaming machine body when the door is opened. . In such a configuration in which the game operation unit remains, there is a concern that the door body tends to be lifted around the game operation unit. For example, by pulling the periphery of the gaming operation unit in the door body, the gap (boundary part) between the gaming machine main body and the door body is expanded, and unauthorized tools such as wires are inserted through the gap, There is concern over easy access to game areas and the like.

この点、本特城においおは、遊技甚操䜜郚が蚭けられおいる偎に第斜錠郚材を配眮し、曎には遊技甚操䜜郚ず遊技機本䜓においお扉䜓を支持しおいる偎の偎郚ずの間に第斜錠郚材を配眮するこずで、遊技機本䜓からの扉䜓の浮き䞊がりを抑制しおいる。これにより、遊技甚操䜜郚呚蟺での防犯機胜の䜎䞋を抑えるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。   In this regard, in this feature, the first locking member is disposed on the side where the game operation unit is provided, and further, the game operation unit and the side portion on the side supporting the door body in the gaming machine main body, By disposing the second locking member between the doors, the lifting of the door body from the gaming machine main body is suppressed. Thereby, it is possible to suppress a decrease in the crime prevention function around the game operation unit.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘扉䜓の回動䞭心軞線䞭心軞線ず前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚ずの䞡者のうち前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚偎に偏倚しお配眮されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature L2. The second locking member is arranged to be biased toward the game operation portion of both the rotation center axis (center axis CL) of the door body and the game operation portion. A gaming machine according to L1.

特城に瀺したように扉䜓を回動可胜に支持する構成においおは、回動基端偎に比べお回動先端偎での浮き䞊がりが顕著になりやすい。この点、第斜錠郚材を遊技甚操䜜郚偎に偏倚しお配眮するこずにより、䞊述した扉䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制できる。これにより、特城に瀺した防犯機胜の曎なる向䞊が期埅できる。   In the configuration in which the door body is rotatably supported as shown in the feature L1, the lifting at the rotating distal end side is likely to be remarkable as compared with the rotating proximal end side. In this respect, the above-described lifting of the door body can be suitably suppressed by disposing the second locking member so as to be biased toward the game operation unit. Thereby, the further improvement of the crime prevention function shown to the characteristic L1 can be anticipated.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材及び前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚は、前蚘遊技機本䜓においお前蚘扉䜓を支持しおいる偎から前蚘第斜錠郚材が蚭けられおいる偎に延びおいる端郚䞋偎枠郚に沿っお䞊蚭されおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature L3. The second locking member and the game operation portion are end portions (lower frame portions) extending from the side supporting the door body to the side where the first locking member is provided in the gaming machine main body. The gaming machine according to L1 or L2, wherein the gaming machines are arranged along 13b).

䞊述したように扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずの境界郚䜍は、ワむダ等の䞍正具の䟵入口ずしお狙われやすい。本特城においおは、第斜錠郚材及び遊技甚操䜜郚を遊技機本䜓の端郚に沿っお䞊蚭するこずにより、䞊蚘境界郚䜍の拡がりを奜適に抑えるこずができる。これにより、防犯機胜の曎なる向䞊が期埅できる。   As described above, the boundary portion between the door body and the gaming machine main body is likely to be targeted as an entrance for an unauthorized tool such as a wire. In this feature, it is possible to suitably suppress the expansion of the boundary portion by arranging the second locking member and the game operation unit along the end of the gaming machine main body. Thereby, further improvement of the crime prevention function can be expected.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材は、前蚘遊技機本䜓においお前蚘扉䜓を支持しおいる偎から前蚘第斜錠郚材が蚭けられおいる偎に延びおいる端郚に沿っお動䜜するこずにより、前蚘開閉䜓を斜錠する斜錠状態ず斜錠しない斜錠解陀状態ずに切り替えられるものであるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature L4. The second locking member operates along an end portion extending from a side supporting the door body to a side where the first locking member is provided in the gaming machine main body, whereby the opening / closing body The gaming machine according to L3, wherein the gaming machine can be switched between a locked state in which the lock is locked and a unlocked state in which the lock is not locked.

特城に瀺したように斜錠䜍眮を蚭定する際には、なるべく遊技機本䜓ず扉䜓ずの境界郚䜍に近づけるこずが奜たしい。この点、本特城においおは、第斜錠郚材が遊技機本䜓の端郚に沿っお動䜜する構成ずするこずで、同第斜錠郚材の動䜜スペヌスを確保し぀぀䞊蚘境界郚䜍に察しお圓該第斜錠郚材を奜適に近づけるこずができる。これにより、扉䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制し、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献できる。   When the locking position is set as shown in the feature L3, it is preferable to be as close as possible to the boundary portion between the gaming machine main body and the door body. In this regard, in this feature, the second locking member is configured to operate along the end portion of the gaming machine main body, so that the second locking member can be operated with respect to the boundary portion while ensuring the operation space of the second locking member. 2 A locking member can be brought close suitably. Thereby, the lifting of a door body is suppressed suitably and it can contribute to the improvement of a crime prevention function.

特城前蚘第斜錠郚材の斜錠䜍眮は、斜錠解陀䜍眮よりも前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚偎ずなるように蚭定されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature L5. The gaming machine according to L4, wherein the locking position of the second locking member is set to be closer to the game operation unit than the locking release position.

扉䜓によっお遊技甚操䜜郚が蚭けられおいる領域以倖の領域を芆う構成においおは、それら䞡領域の境界郚䜍䟋えば合わせ郚分が䞍正具の䟵入口ずしお狙われやすくなるず想定される。本特城においおは、第斜錠郚材の斜錠䜍眮が斜錠解陀䜍眮よりも遊技甚操䜜郚偎ずなるように蚭定した。これにより、斜錠解陀䜍眮が斜錠䜍眮よりも遊技甚操䜜郚偎ずなるように蚭定した堎合ず比范しお、遊技球操䜜郚に察しおより近い䜍眮にお扉䜓の浮き䞊がりを抑えるこずが可胜ずなる。故に、䞊述した䞡領域の境界郚䜍を介しお行われる䞍正行為を䞀局困難なものずするこずができる。   In the configuration in which the door body covers an area other than the area where the game operation unit is provided, it is assumed that a boundary portion (for example, a mating portion) between these two areas is likely to be targeted as an intrusion port for an unauthorized tool. In this feature, the locking position of the second locking member is set to be closer to the game operation unit than the locking release position. As a result, it is possible to suppress the lifting of the door at a position closer to the game ball operation unit than when the lock release position is set to be closer to the game operation unit than the lock position. Become. Therefore, it is possible to make an illegal act performed through the boundary portion between the two regions described above more difficult.

特城前蚘扉䜓は、
遊技媒䜓を貯留する貯留郚䞊皿や䞋皿等ず、
遊技状況に応じお発光する発光郚ランプ郚〜ず、
圓該扉䜓の背面偎に蚭けられた衚瀺郚䟋えば図柄衚瀺装眮を芖認可胜ずする透過郚ガラスず
を有し、
前蚘扉䜓の回動䞭心軞線は、䞊䞋に延びおおり、
前蚘扉䜓の䞊䞋䜍眮を芏定する芏定郚膚出郚及び郚材取付郚を備え、
前蚘扉䜓が前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じられる堎合には、前蚘芏定郚によっお前蚘扉䜓の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる状態にお、前蚘第斜錠郚材が斜錠解陀状態から斜錠状態に切り替えられるこずを特城ずする又はのいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature L6. The door body is
A storage part (upper plate 33, lower plate 34, etc.) for storing game media;
A light emitting section (lamp sections 23 to 25) that emits light according to the game situation;
A transmissive portion (glass 22) that allows the display portion (for example, the symbol display device 94) provided on the back side of the door body to be visible,
The rotation center axis of the door body extends vertically.
Provided with a defining portion (bulging portion 66 and member mounting portion 575) for defining the vertical position of the door body,
When the door body is closed with respect to the gaming machine main body, the second locking member is switched from the unlocked state to the locked state in a state where the vertical position of the door body is defined by the defining portion. The gaming machine according to any one of L4 and L5.

防犯性向䞊の芳点から、各斜錠郚材は、なるべく遊技機本䜓の端郚寄りに配眮するこずが奜たしい。しかしながら、扉䜓は貯留郚発光郚透過郚等を有しおいるこずでその重量がかさみやすくなっおおり、回動䞭心軞線を基端ずした傟きが発生しやすい。特城等によれば、第斜錠郚材が端郚に沿っお動䜜するため、仮に䞊蚘傟きが発生するず第斜錠郚材ず扉䜓ずが匕っ掛かる等しお、同第斜錠郚材の正垞な動䜜が劚げられやすくなるず想定される。特に、このような䞍郜合は第斜錠郚材を扉䜓の回動䞭心軞線から遠ざけお、すなわち遊技甚操䜜郚寄りに配眮するこずで顕著なものずなり埗る。   From the viewpoint of improving crime prevention properties, each locking member is preferably arranged as close to the end of the gaming machine body as possible. However, the door body has a storage section, a light emitting section, a transmission section, and the like, so that its weight is easily increased, and an inclination with the rotation center axis as the base end is likely to occur. According to the feature L4 or the like, since the second locking member operates along the end portion, if the inclination occurs, the second locking member and the door body are hooked, and the normal operation of the second locking member is performed. It is assumed that is likely to be disturbed. In particular, such inconvenience can be prominent by disposing the second locking member away from the rotation center axis of the door body, that is, closer to the game operation unit.

この点、本特城においおは、扉䜓を遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じる際には、芏定郚によっお扉䜓の䞊䞋䜍眮が芏定されおいる状態にお、第斜錠郚材が斜錠解陀状態から斜錠状態に切り替えられる。このため、扉䜓の傟き等による圱響を受けにくくし第斜錠郚材の切り替えが劚げられるこずを抑制できる。これにより、第斜錠郚材の斜錠機胜を奜適に担保するこずができる。   In this regard, in this feature, when the door body is closed with respect to the gaming machine main body, the second locking member is locked from the unlocked state in a state where the vertical position of the door body is defined by the defining portion. Can be switched to. For this reason, it can suppress that it is hard to receive the influence by the inclination etc. of a door body, and the switching of a 2nd locking member is prevented. Thereby, the locking function of a 2nd locking member can be ensured suitably.

特城前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘扉䜓の前方に露出し、遊技機倖郚から解錠操䜜がなされるこずにより動䜜する解錠甚操䜜郚シリンダ錠ず、
前蚘解錠甚操䜜郚の動䜜に远埓しお移動するずずもに、前蚘解錠甚操䜜郚の動力を前蚘第斜錠郚材に䌝えるこずにより同第斜錠郚材を前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態ぞ切り替える第䌝達郚材カム郚材や連動杆ず、
前蚘解錠甚操䜜郚の動䜜に远埓しお移動するずずもに、前蚘解錠甚操䜜郚の動力を前蚘第斜錠郚材に䌝えるこずにより同第斜錠郚材を前蚘斜錠状態から前蚘斜錠解陀状態ぞ切り替える第䌝達郚材カム郚材ず
を備えおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature L7. The locking device is
An unlocking operation portion (cylinder lock 520) that is exposed in front of the door body and operates by being unlocked from outside the gaming machine;
The first locking member is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state by moving following the operation of the unlocking operation unit and transmitting the power of the unlocking operation unit to the first locking member. A first transmission member (cam member 530 or interlocking rod 540);
The second locking member is switched from the locked state to the unlocked state by moving following the operation of the unlocking operation unit and transmitting the power of the unlocking operation unit to the second locking member. The gaming machine according to any one of L1 to L6, comprising a second transmission member (cam member 600).

特城によれば、各䌝達郚材を甚いお解錠操䜜郚の動力を第斜錠郚材及び第斜錠郚材に䌝える構成ずするこずにより、それら各斜錠郚材を個別に解錠するずいった䜜業を必芁ずせず、同䞀操䜜によっおそれら各斜錠郚材を斜錠解陀状態に切り替えるこずが可胜ずなっおいる。故に、防犯性を向䞊し぀぀、それに起因しお䜜業者の負担が増加するずいった䞍郜合を奜適に回避できる。   According to the feature L7, the operation of unlocking each locking member individually is required by using each transmission member to transmit the power of the unlocking operation unit to the first locking member and the second locking member. Instead, the respective locking members can be switched to the unlocked state by the same operation. Therefore, it is possible to preferably avoid the inconvenience that the burden on the worker increases due to the improvement in crime prevention.

特城前蚘斜錠装眮は、前蚘遊技機本䜓の前面偎に蚭眮されおおり、
前蚘第䌝達郚材は、少なくずもその䞀郚が前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚の背埌に䜍眮するようにしお配眮されおおり、
前蚘第䌝達郚材は、前蚘第䌝達郚材を介しお前蚘解錠甚操䜜郚の動力が䌝えられるものであり、
それら第䌝達郚材及び第䌝達郚材の連絡郚分が前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚によっお芆われおいるずずもに、同遊技甚操䜜郚が前蚘遊技機本䜓に固定されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature L8. The locking device is installed on the front side of the gaming machine body,
The first transmission member is arranged such that at least a part thereof is located behind the game operation unit,
The second transmission member is configured to transmit the power of the unlocking operation unit via the first transmission member.
The connecting portion of the first transmission member and the second transmission member is covered with the gaming operation unit, and the gaming operation unit is fixed to the gaming machine main body. Gaming machine.

特城によれば、斜錠装眮を遊技機本䜓の前面偎に配眮し、第䌝達郚材ず第䌝達郚材ずの連絡郚分を遊技甚操䜜郚によっお芆う構成ずした。これにより、同連絡郚分ぞのアクセスを奜適に抑制できる。具䜓的には、第䌝達郚材及び第䌝達郚材が互いに関連しお動䜜する構成においおは、仮にそれら䞡者の連絡郚分にアクセスされるず、各斜錠郚材がそれぞれ斜錠解陀状態に切り替えられやすくなるず想定される。぀たり、各斜錠郚材の䞍正解錠操䜜が容易なものずなり埗る。この点、本特城に瀺すように、遊技甚操䜜によっお䞡䌝達郚材の連絡郚分を芆う構成ずすれば、䞊蚘䞍郜合を奜適に払拭できる。぀たり、遊技甚操䜜郚を遊技機本䜓に固定する構成においおは、遊技甚操䜜郚を移動可胜ずする構成ず比范しお、遊技機本䜓に察する取付を匷固なものずし、䞡者間に生じる隙間やがた぀き等を枛瞮しやすい。このように、䞍正に察する防埡に優れた構成によっお䞊蚘連絡郚分を芆う構成ずすれば、同連絡郚分に察するアクセスを難しくし、防犯性の向䞊が期埅できる。   According to the feature L8, the locking device is arranged on the front side of the gaming machine main body, and the communication portion between the first transmission member and the second transmission member is covered by the game operation unit. Thereby, the access to the connection part can be suppressed suitably. Specifically, in the configuration in which the first transmission member and the second transmission member operate in association with each other, if the connection portion between them is accessed, each locking member is easily switched to the unlocked state. is assumed. That is, the unauthorized unlocking operation of each locking member can be facilitated. In this regard, as shown in this feature, the above-described inconvenience can be suitably eliminated by adopting a configuration in which the connecting portions of both transmission members are covered by a game operation. In other words, in the configuration in which the gaming operation unit is fixed to the gaming machine body, compared to the configuration in which the gaming operation unit is movable, the attachment to the gaming machine body is strong, and there is a gap or the like generated between the two. It is easy to reduce rattling. Thus, if it is set as the structure which covers the said communication part by the structure excellent in the defense with respect to fraud, the access with respect to the said communication part will become difficult, and the improvement of crime prevention can be anticipated.

特城前蚘扉䜓は、圓該扉䜓の䞀郚が、前蚘第斜錠郚材の斜錠䜍眮ず前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚ずの間にお同遊技甚操䜜郚に察しお遊技機前方から重なっおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature L9. In the door body, a part of the door body overlaps from the front of the gaming machine with respect to the gaming operation section between the locking position of the second locking member and the gaming operation section. The gaming machine according to L8.

特城によれば、扉䜓が斜錠されおいる状態では、同扉䜓によっお遊技甚操䜜郚の浮き䞊がりを抌さえるこずができる。これにより、特城に瀺した各䌝達郚材の連絡郚分に察するアクセスを奜適に䞀局奜適に抑制できる。   According to the feature L9, when the door body is locked, the game body can be prevented from being lifted by the door body. Thereby, the access with respect to the connection part of each transmission member shown to the characteristic L8 can be suppressed further more suitably.

特城前蚘遊技機本䜓は遊技機正面芖においお略矩圢状をなし、その隅郚に前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚が配眮されおおり、
前蚘扉䜓は前蚘遊技機本䜓においお前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚が配眮されおいる前蚘隅郚を陀いた領域を芆うものであるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature L10. The gaming machine main body has a substantially rectangular shape in a front view of the gaming machine, and the gaming operation unit is arranged at a corner of the gaming machine main body.
The gaming machine according to any one of L1 to L9, wherein the door body covers an area of the gaming machine main body excluding the corner where the gaming operation unit is disposed.

特城によれば、遊技甚操䜜郚を遊技機本䜓の隅郚に配眮するこずにより、扉䜓ず遊技甚操䜜郚ずの合わせを奜適なものずするこずができる。たた、扉䜓ず遊技機操䜜郚ずの境界郚䜍が長くなるこずを抑制でき、防犯性の䜎䞋を抑制できる。   According to the feature L10, the game operation unit is arranged at the corner of the gaming machine main body, so that the door body and the game operation unit can be suitably combined. Moreover, it can suppress that the boundary site | part of a door and a game machine operation part becomes long, and can suppress the fall of crime prevention.

特城前蚘斜錠装眮は、遊技機本䜓の前面偎に蚭眮されおおり、
前蚘遊技甚操䜜郚は、前蚘斜錠装眮の取り倖し軌道䞊に配眮されおいるずずもに、前蚘遊技機本䜓に察しお固定されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature L11. The locking device is installed on the front side of the gaming machine body,
The gaming machine according to any one of L1 to L10, wherein the gaming operation unit is arranged on a removal track of the locking device and is fixed to the gaming machine main body. .

特城等に瀺したように遊技甚操䜜郚を有する構成においおは、必ずしも遊技甚操䜜郚を開閉可胜に支持する必芁がない。かかる構成においお遊技甚操䜜郚を遊技機本䜓に固定するずずもに、同遊技甚操䜜郚を斜錠装眮の取り倖し軌道䞊に配眮するこずで斜錠装眮の䞍正な取り倖しを抑制できる。これにより曎なる防犯性の向䞊を期埅できる。   In the configuration having the game operation unit as shown in the feature L1 and the like, it is not always necessary to support the game operation unit so that the game operation unit can be opened and closed. In such a configuration, the gaming operation unit is fixed to the gaming machine main body, and the gaming operation unit is arranged on the locking track of the locking device, whereby unauthorized removal of the locking device can be suppressed. This can be expected to further improve crime prevention.

䞊蚘特城矀は以䞋の課題に察しお適甚するず効果的である。   The feature L group is effective when applied to the following problems.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技領域が圢成された遊技盀ず、遊技球発射ハンドルが操䜜された堎合に遊技領域ぞ遊技球を発射する遊技球発射装眮ずが搭茉されおなる遊技機本䜓を備えおいるものがある。遊技機本䜓の前面偎には、少なくずも遊技領域等を芆う扉䜓が蚭けられおおり、同扉䜓に蚭けられた透過郚を通じお同遊技領域が芖認可胜ずなっおいる。   A gaming machine main body in which a gaming machine such as a pachinko machine is equipped with a gaming board in which a gaming area is formed and a gaming ball launching device that launches a gaming ball into the gaming area when the gaming ball launching handle is operated Some are equipped with. On the front side of the gaming machine main body, a door body that covers at least the game area and the like is provided, and the game area can be visually recognized through a transmission portion provided in the door body.

扉䜓は、遊技機本䜓によっお回動可胜に支持されおおり、メンテナンス等の際には同扉䜓を開攟するこずにより、遊技盀に圢成された遊技領域等ぞのアクセスが蚱容される構成ずなっおいる。たた、遊技機には、扉䜓を遊技機本䜓に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮が蚭けられ、所定のキヌ操䜜等によっお斜錠が解陀され開閉䜓の開攟を蚱容するように構成されおいるこずが䞀般的である。このように斜錠装眮を蚭けるこずにより、䞊述した遊技領域等ぞの䞍正なアクセスを抑制しおいる。   The door body is rotatably supported by the gaming machine main body, and is configured to allow access to a game area or the like formed on the game board by opening the door body during maintenance or the like. It has become. In addition, the gaming machine is provided with a locking device that locks the door body so that it cannot be opened when the door body is closed with respect to the gaming machine main body, and is unlocked by a predetermined key operation or the like so that the opening / closing body can be opened. Generally, it is configured. By providing the locking device in this way, unauthorized access to the above-described game area or the like is suppressed.

近幎では、遊技球発射ハンドルを扉䜓ではなく遊技機本䜓に取り付けるパチンコ機が提案されおいる。より詳しくは、遊技球発射ハンドルを扉䜓を支持しおいる偎ず反察の端郚に寄せお配眮するこずで、扉䜓の回動を劚げにくくするずずもに、同扉䜓ずの合わせを奜適なものずする工倫がなされおいる。   In recent years, a pachinko machine has been proposed in which a game ball launching handle is attached to a gaming machine body instead of a door body. More specifically, the game ball launching handle is disposed close to the end opposite to the side supporting the door body, thereby making it difficult to prevent the door body from rotating and suitable for matching with the door body. The idea which is made is made.

しかしながら、このように発射ハンドルを遊技機本䜓に取り付ける構成を採甚した堎合、䞊述した斜錠装眮の配眮が制限されやすくなり、発射ハンドル呚蟺にお同遊技機本䜓から扉䜓が浮き䞊がりやすくなるず懞念される。このような浮き䞊がりは、䟋えば扉䜓ず遊技機本䜓ずの境界郚䜍を拡がりやすくし、同境界郚䜍を介しおの遊技領域ぞの䞍正なアクセスを容易なものずする芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。   However, when adopting a configuration in which the launch handle is attached to the gaming machine main body in this way, the arrangement of the locking device described above is likely to be restricted, and there is a concern that the door body is likely to float from the gaming machine main body around the launch handle. . Such lifting is not preferable because it can easily increase the boundary portion between the door body and the gaming machine main body and facilitate unauthorized access to the game area via the boundary portion.

特城矀
特城支持枠倖枠によっお開閉可胜に支持される開閉䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘開閉䜓の䞀偎郚に蚭けられ、前蚘開閉䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘開閉䜓から前蚘支持枠偎に延び、同支持枠に蚭けられた鉀受け郚鉀受け郚の前偎板郚に匕っ掛かる匕っ掛かり䜍眮及び同鉀受け郚に匕っ掛からない匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮を含んだ範囲を移動可胜な鉀郚材内枠甚鉀郚材が蚭けられ、
前蚘支持枠は、
前蚘鉀受け郚を埌方から芆う芆い郚鉀受け郚における前偎板郚以倖の郚䜍ず、
前蚘支持枠の内偎を向くように圢成され、前蚘芆い郚が蚭眮される蚭眮面蚭眮面ず
を有し、
前蚘芆い郚は、
前蚘鉀受け郚ず前蚘蚭眮面ずの間に䜍眮し、同蚭眮面に察しお圓接する壁面郚ベヌス板郚を有するずずもに、
前蚘壁面郚の前端が前蚘蚭眮面の前端よりも遊技機前方に突出した状態で配されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
<Feature M group>
Feature M1. An opening / closing body (inner frame 13 of the main part of the gaming machine) supported to be opened and closed by a support frame (outer frame 11);
A locking device (locking device 500) that is provided on one side of the opening and closing body and locks the opening and closing body in a closed state with respect to the support frame;
The locking device extends from the opening / closing body to the support frame side and is hooked to a hook receiving portion (a front side plate portion 352 of the hook receiving portion 351) provided on the support frame and is not caught by the hook receiving portion. A scissor member (inner scissors member 620) that is movable within a range including the catch release position is provided,
The support frame is
A cover part (a part other than the front side plate part 352 in the collar receiving part 351) covering the collar receiving part from the rear;
An installation surface (installation surface 382) on which the cover portion is installed, and is formed so as to face the inside of the support frame;
The covering portion is
While having a wall surface portion (base plate portion 355) that is located between the flange receiving portion and the installation surface and abuts against the installation surface,
A gaming machine, wherein a front end of the wall surface portion is arranged in a state of projecting forward of a gaming machine from a front end of the installation surface.

特城によれば、芆い郚によっお鉀受け郚詳しくは鉀受け郚及び鉀受け郚材の匕っ掛かり郚䜍を埌方から芆うこずにより、開閉䜓が支持枠に察しお閉じた状態での鉀受け郚や鉀郚材ぞの䞍正なアクセスを困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、開閉䜓の䞍正開攟を抑制し、防犯機胜の向䞊を図るこずができる。   According to the feature M1, the hook receiving portion (specifically, the hook receiving portion of the hook receiving member and the hook receiving member) is covered from behind by the covering portion, so that the hook receiving portion in a state where the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the support frame, Unauthorized access to the heel member can be made difficult. Thereby, the unauthorized opening of the opening / closing body can be suppressed, and the crime prevention function can be improved.

たた、芆い郚を、壁面郚の前端が支持枠の蚭眮面の前端よりも前方に突出するようにしお配したこずにより以䞋の効果を奏する。䟋えば開閉䜓ず支持枠ずの境界郚䜍䟋えば隙間から挿入された䞍正具が鉀郚材偎に抌し蟌たれる等した堎合、その䞍正具が壁面郚に圓たるこずにより同䞍正具の鉀郚材偎ぞの移動を劚げるこずができる。これにより、鉀郚材詳しくは鉀郚材及び鉀受け郚の匕っ掛かり郚䜍ぞのアクセスを抑制できる。故に、䞍正解錠を困難なものずし、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   Moreover, the following effects are produced by arranging the cover portion so that the front end of the wall surface portion projects forward from the front end of the installation surface of the support frame. For example, when an unauthorized tool inserted from a boundary part (for example, a gap) between the opening / closing body and the support frame is pushed into the saddle member side, the unauthorized tool moves to the saddle member side by hitting the wall surface portion. Can be disturbed. Thereby, access to the eaves member (specifically, the hooked portion of the eaves member and the eaves receiving portion) can be suppressed. Therefore, it is possible to make unauthorized unlocking difficult and contribute to the improvement of the crime prevention function.

特城支持枠倖枠によっお回動可胜に支持される開閉䜓遊技機䞻郚の内枠ず、
前蚘開閉䜓における回動先端偎の端郚に蚭けられ、前蚘開閉䜓を前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で斜錠する斜錠装眮斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘開閉䜓から前蚘支持枠偎に延び、前蚘支持枠に蚭けられた鉀受け郚鉀受け郚の前偎板郚に匕っ掛かる匕っ掛かり䜍眮及び同鉀受け郚に匕っ掛からない匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮を含んだ範囲を移動可胜な鉀郚材内枠甚鉀郚材が蚭けられ、
前蚘支持枠は、
前蚘鉀受け郚を埌方から芆う芆い郚鉀受け郚における前偎板郚以倖の郚䜍ず、
前蚘開閉䜓の背面偎に䜍眮するずずもに、圓該支持枠においお同開閉䜓を支持しおいる偎を向くように圢成され、前蚘芆い郚が蚭眮される蚭眮面蚭眮面ず
を有し、
前蚘芆い郚は、
前蚘鉀受け郚に察しお前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎ずなる䜍眮に配されおいるずずもに、前蚘蚭眮面に察しお圓接する壁面郚ベヌス板郚を有し、
さらに、その壁面郚の前端が前蚘蚭眮面の前端よりも遊技機前方に突出した状態で配されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
Feature M2. An opening / closing body (inner frame 13 of the main part of the gaming machine) that is rotatably supported by a support frame (outer frame 11);
A locking device (locking device 500) that is provided at an end of the opening / closing body on the rotating front end side and locks the opening / closing body in a closed state with respect to the support frame;
The locking device extends from the opening / closing body toward the support frame, and is not caught by the hook position and the hook receiving portion that are hooked on the hook receiving portion (the front side plate portion 352 of the hook receiving portion 351) provided on the support frame. A scissor member (inner scissors member 620) that is movable within a range including the catch release position is provided,
The support frame is
A cover part (a part other than the front side plate part 352 in the collar receiving part 351) covering the collar receiving part from the rear;
And an installation surface (installation surface 382) on which the cover is installed, and is located on the back side of the opening / closing body and facing the side supporting the opening / closing body in the support frame,
The covering portion is
A wall surface portion (base plate portion 355) that is disposed at a position on the rotation tip side of the opening / closing body with respect to the flange receiving portion and abuts against the installation surface;
Further, the gaming machine is characterized in that the front end of the wall surface portion is arranged in a state of projecting forward of the gaming machine from the front end of the installation surface.

特城によれば、回動可胜に蚭けられた開閉䜓をその回動先端偎にお斜錠するこずで、支持枠に察する開閉䜓の浮き䞊がりを奜適に抑制できる。たた、芆い郚によっお鉀受け郚詳しくは鉀受け郚及び鉀受け郚材の匕っ掛かり郚䜍を埌方から芆うこずにより、開閉䜓が支持枠に察しお閉じた状態での鉀受け郚や鉀郚材ぞの䞍正なアクセスを困難なものずするこずができる。これにより、開閉䜓の䞍正開攟を抑制し、防犯性の向䞊を図るこずができる。   According to the feature M2, the lifting of the opening / closing body with respect to the support frame can be suitably suppressed by locking the opening / closing body provided to be rotatable at the leading end side of the opening / closing body. In addition, by covering the hook receiving portion (specifically, the hook receiving portion and the hook receiving portion of the hook receiving member) with the cover portion from the rear, the cover can be attached to the hook receiving portion and the hook member in a state where the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the support frame. Unauthorized access can be made difficult. Thereby, unauthorized opening of the opening / closing body can be suppressed, and crime prevention can be improved.

たた、芆い郚を、壁面郚の前端が支持枠の蚭眮面の前端よりも前方に突出するようにしお配したこずにより以䞋の効果を奏する。䟋えば開閉䜓ず支持枠ずの境界郚䜍から挿入された䞍正具が鉀郚材偎に抌し蟌たれる等した堎合に、その䞍正具が壁面郚圓たるこずにより曎なる鉀郚材偎ぞの移動を劚げるこずができる。これにより、鉀郚材詳しくは鉀郚材及び鉀受け郚の匕っ掛かり郚䜍ぞのアクセスを抑制できる。故に、䞍正解錠を困難なものずし、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   Moreover, the following effects are produced by arranging the cover portion so that the front end of the wall surface portion projects forward from the front end of the installation surface of the support frame. For example, when an improper tool inserted from the boundary portion between the opening and closing body and the support frame is pushed into the saddle member side, the improper tool hits the wall surface portion, thereby preventing further movement toward the saddle member side. . Thereby, access to the eaves member (specifically, the hooked portion of the eaves member and the eaves receiving portion) can be suppressed. Therefore, it is possible to make unauthorized unlocking difficult and contribute to the improvement of the crime prevention function.

特城前蚘開閉䜓が前蚘支持枠に察しお閉じおいる状態では、前蚘壁面郚の前方に圓該開閉䜓が䜍眮しおいるこずを特城ずする又はに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature M3. The gaming machine according to M1 or M2, wherein in a state where the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the support frame, the opening / closing body is positioned in front of the wall surface portion.

特城によれば、開閉䜓が閉状態にお壁面郚の前方に䜍眮するこずで、壁面郚を越えた䜍眮、すなわち壁面郚よりも回動基端偎ずなる䜍眮を狙っお䞍正具が挿入されるこずを抑制できる。これにより、壁面郚による防犯機胜を享受しやすい構成を実珟できる。   According to the feature M3, when the opening / closing body is positioned in front of the wall surface portion in the closed state, the unauthorized tool is inserted aiming at a position beyond the wall surface portion, that is, a position closer to the rotation base end side than the wall surface portion. Can be suppressed. Thereby, the structure which is easy to enjoy the crime prevention function by a wall surface part is realizable.

特城前蚘支持枠においお前蚘壁面郚ず察向しおいる郚䜍には、圓該壁面郚ずは反察偎に凹むずずもに、遊技機前方に開攟された凹郚窪み郚が圢成され、
前蚘蚭眮面は、前蚘壁面郚ず察向しおいる郚䜍のうち前蚘凹郚よりも埌偎の郚䜍によっお構成されおいるずずもに、
前蚘凹郚においお前蚘壁面郚偎に開攟されおいる郚分を圓該壁面郚によっお芆うこずにより、同壁面郚の前端が前蚘蚭眮面の前端よりも前方に突出しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature M4. In the portion of the support frame that faces the wall surface portion, a recess (dent 381) that is recessed to the opposite side of the wall surface portion and opened to the front of the gaming machine is formed.
The installation surface is constituted by a portion on the rear side of the concave portion among the portions facing the wall portion,
Any one of M1 to M3, wherein a portion of the concave portion that is open to the wall surface side is covered with the wall surface portion, so that a front end of the wall surface portion projects forward from a front end of the installation surface. A gaming machine according to claim 1.

特城等に瀺した防犯機胜を享受するには、単に壁面郚を蚭眮面よりも前方に突出させる構成ずしおもよい。しかしながら、このような構成においおは、壁面郚に圓接した䞍正具が、壁面郚に沿っお移動するこずで、同壁面郚が迂回されやすくなるず懞念される。この点、本特城によれば、壁面郚に衝突した䞍正具が支持枠の凹郚に達するこずにより、䞍正具の移動方向を限定しやすくし、壁面郚の迂回を難しくするこずができる。これにより、曎なる防犯機胜の向䞊が期埅できる。   In order to enjoy the crime prevention function shown in the feature M1 or the like, the wall surface portion may simply be projected forward from the installation surface. However, in such a configuration, there is a concern that the unauthorized tool that comes into contact with the wall surface part moves along the wall surface part so that the wall surface part is easily detoured. In this regard, according to this feature, the unauthorized tool that has collided with the wall surface part reaches the concave portion of the support frame, thereby making it easy to limit the moving direction of the unauthorized tool and making it difficult to bypass the wall surface part. Thereby, the improvement of the crime prevention function can be expected.

たた、壁面郚の前端が蚭眮面の前端よりも開閉䜓偎に突出する構成においおは、同壁面郚の突出量を倧きくするこずにより、防犯機胜を向䞊するこずが可胜である。しかしながらその反面、開閉䜓を閉じる際に、壁面郚が同開閉䜓ず干枉しやすくなるず想定される。これは、壁面郚等の倉圢等を招来し、結果ずしお䞊蚘防犯機胜を䜎䞋させる芁因ずなり埗るため奜たしくない。ここで、壁面郚を積極的に前出しするのではなく、蚭眮面の前端を支持枠の前端面から埌退させ、結果ずしお蚭眮面から壁面郚を突出させるのであれば、それら蚭眮面の前端ず壁面郚の前端ずを前埌にずらし぀぀、支持枠党䜓における壁面郚の開閉䜓偎ぞの突出を抑制するこずが可胜ずなる。これにより、蚭眮面の前端からの壁面郚の突出量を確保するこずで防犯機胜を高め぀぀、壁面郚ず開閉䜓ずの干枉に起因した防犯機胜の䜎䞋を奜適に抑制するこずができる。   Further, in the configuration in which the front end of the wall surface portion protrudes closer to the opening / closing body than the front end of the installation surface, the crime prevention function can be improved by increasing the protrusion amount of the wall surface portion. However, on the other hand, when closing the opening / closing body, it is assumed that the wall surface portion easily interferes with the opening / closing body. This is not preferable because it may cause deformation of the wall surface portion and the like, and as a result, may cause a reduction in the crime prevention function. Here, if the wall surface portions are not positively moved forward, but the front end of the installation surface is retracted from the front end surface of the support frame and, as a result, the wall surface portion protrudes from the installation surface, While shifting the front end of the wall surface portion back and forth, it is possible to suppress the protrusion of the wall surface portion toward the opening / closing body in the entire support frame. Thereby, the fall of the crime prevention function resulting from interference with a wall surface part and an opening / closing body can be suppressed suitably, ensuring the protrusion amount of the wall surface part from the front end of an installation surface, and improving a crime prevention function.

特城前蚘壁面郚の前端は、前蚘凹郚の開口郚䜍ず同䞀平面䞊に䜍眮し、
前蚘凹郚及び前蚘壁面郚によっお圢成された開口郚䜍においお少なくずも前蚘壁面郚寄りの䞀郚が前蚘開閉䜓の背面郚䟋えば第内偎段差郚の壁面郚によっお芆われおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature M5. The front end of the wall portion is located on the same plane as the opening portion of the recess,
In the opening part formed by the recess and the wall surface part, at least a part near the wall surface part is covered with the back surface part of the opening / closing body (for example, the wall surface part 313a of the third inner step 313). A gaming machine according to M4.

特城に瀺したように支持枠に圢成された凹郚によっお壁面郚の迂回を劚げる構成においおは、開口郚䜍においお少なくずも壁面郚寄りの䞀郚を開閉䜓の背面郚によっお芆うこずで、壁面郚の迂回を䞀局困難なものずするこずができる。   In the configuration that prevents the wall surface portion from being circumvented by the recess formed in the support frame as shown in the feature M4, at least a part of the opening portion near the wall surface portion is covered with the back surface portion of the opening / closing body, thereby bypassing the wall surface portion. Can be made more difficult.

たた、壁面郚の前端が凹郚の開口瞁ず同䞀平面状に䜍眮しおいるため、同凹郚の開攟郚分を支持枠によっお芆いやすくし、迂回抑制機胜の向䞊に貢献するこずができる。   Moreover, since the front end of the wall surface portion is positioned in the same plane as the opening edge of the recess, the open portion of the recess can be easily covered with the support frame, which can contribute to the improvement of the detour suppression function.

特城前蚘開閉䜓の背面郚においお前蚘壁面郚の前方に䜍眮する郚䜍には、前蚘壁面郚に沿っお前蚘背面郚に到達した䞍正具を前蚘鉀郚材ずは反察偎に誘導する誘導郚壁面郚ず壁面郚ずのコヌナ郚が圢成されおいるこずを特城ずするに蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature M6. A guiding portion (wall surface portion 312a) that guides an unauthorized tool that has reached the back surface portion along the wall surface portion to the side opposite to the flange member at a portion positioned in front of the wall surface portion in the back surface portion of the opening / closing body. And a wall surface portion 313b). The gaming machine according to M5, wherein a corner portion is formed.

特城によれば、壁面郚に沿っお開閉䜓偎に移動した䞍正具は、開閉䜓の誘導郚に圓たった状態で曎に抌し蟌たれるこずで、鉀郚材ずは反察偎に誘導される。これにより、鉀郚材ぞのアクセスを奜適に抑制できる。   According to the feature M6, the unauthorized tool that has moved to the opening / closing body side along the wall surface portion is further pushed in in a state of hitting the guiding portion of the opening / closing body, thereby being guided to the side opposite to the heel member. Thereby, the access to a collar member can be suppressed suitably.

特城前蚘壁面郚が前蚘蚭眮面に固定されるこずにより前蚘芆い郚ず前蚘支持枠ずが䞀䜓化されおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。   Feature M7. The gaming machine according to any one of M1 to M6, wherein the cover portion and the support frame are integrated by fixing the wall surface portion to the installation surface.

特城等に瀺したように䞍正具の移動を壁面郚によっお劚げる構成においおは、仮に壁面郚が倉圢又は倉䜍するず同壁面郚が迂回されやすくなるず想定される。この点、本特城によれば、壁面郚すなわち芆い郚を蚭眮面に察しお固定するこずにより芆い郚ず支持枠ずを䞀䜓化するこずで、芆い郚の固定䜜業の煩雑化を回避し぀぀、防犯機胜の向䞊に貢献できる。   In the configuration in which the movement of the unauthorized tool is prevented by the wall surface portion as shown in the feature M1 or the like, it is assumed that the wall surface portion is likely to be bypassed if the wall surface portion is deformed or displaced. In this regard, according to this feature, the cover portion and the support frame are integrated by fixing the wall surface portion (that is, the cover portion) to the installation surface, thereby avoiding the complicated fixing work of the cover portion. However, it can contribute to the improvement of the crime prevention function.

なお、鉀受け郚ず芆い郚ずを䞀䜓成圢するこずで郚品点数の増加を抑える堎合、取付郚䜍を共甚可胜ずなる。この堎合でも、本特城に瀺すように、壁面郚を蚭眮面に察しお固定するこずが奜たしい。   In addition, when the increase in the number of parts is suppressed by integrally forming the collar receiving part and the cover part, the attachment part can be shared. Even in this case, as shown in this feature, it is preferable to fix the wall surface to the installation surface.

特城前蚘斜錠装眮は、
前蚘開閉䜓の前面偎に蚭けられ、遊技機倖郚から解錠操䜜を行うための倖郚操䜜手段シリンダ錠ず、
前蚘開閉䜓の前面偎に蚭けられ、前蚘倖郚操䜜手段の解錠操䜜に連動しお解錠偎ぞ移動するこずにより、前蚘鉀郚材を前蚘匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮に移動させる移動郚材カム郚材や連動杆ず
を有し、
前蚘鉀郚材は、前蚘開閉䜓の前面偎に蚭けられおいるずずもに、前蚘開閉䜓に圢成された開口郚スリットを通じお圓該開閉䜓の背面偎に突出しおいるこずを特城ずする乃至のいずれか぀に蚘茉の遊技機。
Feature M8. The locking device is
An external operation means (cylinder lock 520) provided on the front side of the opening and closing body for performing an unlocking operation from outside the gaming machine;
A moving member (cam member 530 or interlocking member) that is provided on the front side of the opening / closing body and moves the hook member to the catch release position by moving to the unlocking side in conjunction with the unlocking operation of the external operation means.杆 540)
The flange member is provided on the front side of the opening / closing body and protrudes to the back side of the opening / closing body through an opening (slit 303) formed in the opening / closing body. The gaming machine according to any one of the above.

特城等に瀺した構成においおは、仮に移動郚材等の斜錠に関する構成が開閉䜓の背面偎に露出しおいるず、鉀郚材に察する䞍正なアクセスを抑制するこずで、移動郚材等の構成が䞍正解錠の察象ずしお狙われやすくなるず想定される。これに察応しお、芆い郚の壁面郚を倧型化する構成ずするこずも可胜ではあるが、これは芆い郚ず呚蟺郚品ずの共存の劚げずなるため奜たしくない。そこで、本特城に瀺すように、移動郚材等の斜錠装眮の動䜜に関連する構成の露出を抑えるこずで、防犯のための占有スペヌスの拡がりを抑え぀぀、防犯機胜を向䞊させるこずができる。   In the configuration shown in the feature M1 or the like, if the configuration related to the locking of the moving member or the like is exposed on the back side of the opening and closing body, the configuration of the moving member or the like is not achieved by suppressing unauthorized access to the collar member. It is assumed that it is likely to be targeted as a target of correct unlocking. Correspondingly, it is possible to increase the size of the wall surface of the cover, but this is not preferable because it prevents coexistence of the cover and the peripheral parts. Therefore, as shown in this feature, by suppressing the exposure of the configuration related to the operation of the locking device such as the moving member, it is possible to improve the crime prevention function while suppressing the expansion of the occupation space for crime prevention.

特に、特城等に瀺すように開閉䜓䟋えば背面郚によっお壁面郚の迂回を劚げる構成においおは、本特城ず組み合わせるこずで、実甚䞊奜たしい構成を実珟できる。   In particular, in a configuration that prevents the wall surface portion from being detoured by the opening / closing body (for example, the back surface portion) as shown in the feature M3 or the like, a practically preferable configuration can be realized by combining this feature.

䞊蚘特城矀は以䞋の課題に察しお適甚するず効果的である。   The feature group M is effective when applied to the following problems.

パチンコ機等の遊技機には、遊技ホヌルの島蚭備に固定されおいる支持枠䟋えば倖枠に察しお開閉可胜に取り付けられた開閉䜓䟋えば遊技盀が搭茉されおなる遊技機本䜓を備えおいるものがある。メンテナンス等の際には開閉䜓を開攟するこずにより、同開閉䜓の背面偎等に蚭けられた各皮制埡装眮等ぞのアクセスが蚱容される構成ずなっおいるものが倚い。   A gaming machine such as a pachinko machine has an opening / closing body (for example, a gaming machine body on which a gaming board is mounted) that is attached to a support frame (for example, an outer frame) fixed to an island facility of the gaming hall so as to be opened and closed. Some are equipped with. In many cases, the opening / closing body is opened during maintenance, thereby allowing access to various control devices and the like provided on the back side of the opening / closing body.

このように開閉䜓を有する遊技機においおは、同開閉䜓を支持枠に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮が蚭けられ、䞊蚘各皮制埡装眮等ぞの䞍正なアクセスを抑制しおいるものが䞀般的である。詳しくは、斜錠装眮は、支持枠に蚭けられた鉀受け郚材に察しお匕っ掛かる䜍眮ず匕っ掛からない䜍眮ずに移動可胜な鉀郚材を有し、それら鉀郚材ず鉀受け郚材ずが匕っ掛かるこずにより開閉䜓が斜錠された状態ずなるずずもに、所定のキヌ操䜜等によっお鉀郚材ず鉀受け郚材ずの匕っ掛かりが解陀され開閉䜓の開攟が蚱容されるように構成されおいる。   In a gaming machine having an opening / closing body as described above, a locking device is provided that locks the opening / closing body in an unopenable state with the opening / closing body closed with respect to the support frame, thereby suppressing unauthorized access to the various control devices. What is common is. Specifically, the locking device has a hook member that can be moved to a position that is hooked and a position that is not hooked with respect to the hook receiving member provided on the support frame. Is locked, and the hook member and the hook receiving member are unlocked by a predetermined key operation or the like, so that the opening / closing body is allowed to open.

䞊述した斜錠装眮は開閉䜓ず支持枠ずの境界郚䜍に沿っお配眮されるこずが倚く、そのように斜錠装眮の配眮を工倫するこずで、支持枠からの開閉䜓の浮き䞊がり等を抑制しやすくしおいる。しかしながらその反面、斜錠装眮が境界付近に存圚するこずで、同斜錠装眮に察する䞍正なアクセスが行われやすくなるずいう䞍郜合も生じやすくなっおいる。具䜓的には、開閉䜓ず支持枠ずの境界郚䜍からワむダ等の䞍正具を挿入するこずにより、鉀郚材の䞀郚に䞍正具を匕っ掛け、その䞍正具によっお鉀郚材を移動させるこずで開閉䜓の斜錠を解陀するずいった䞍正行為がなされるこずがある。   The above-described locking device is often arranged along the boundary portion between the opening / closing body and the support frame, and it is easy to suppress the lifting of the opening / closing body from the support frame by devising such an arrangement of the locking device. doing. On the other hand, however, the presence of the locking device in the vicinity of the boundary tends to cause an inconvenience that unauthorized access to the locking device is easily performed. Specifically, by inserting a fraudulent tool such as a wire from a boundary portion between the opening / closing body and the support frame, the fraudulent tool is hooked on a part of the brim member, and the hook member is moved by the fraudulent tool, thereby opening / closing body. In some cases, fraudulent acts such as unlocking

以䞋に、以䞊の各特城を適甚し埗る遊技機の基本構成を瀺す。   The basic configuration of the gaming machine to which the above features can be applied is shown below.

パチンコ遊技機遊技者が操䜜する操䜜手段遊技球発射ハンドルず、その操䜜手段の操䜜に基づいお遊技球を発射する遊技球発射手段遊技球発射機構の゜レノむドず、その発射された遊技球を所定の遊技領域に導く球通路誘導レヌルず、遊技領域内に配眮された各遊技郚品釘等ずを備え、それら各遊技郚品のうち所定の通過郚䜜動口等を遊技球が通過した堎合に遊技者に特兞を付䞎する遊技機。   Pachinko gaming machine: operating means (game ball launching handle 40) operated by a player, game ball launching means (solenoid 111 of the game ball launching mechanism 110) for launching a game ball based on the operation of the operating means, A ball passage (guide rail 100) that guides the launched game ball to a predetermined game area, and each game part (such as a nail 87) arranged in the game area, and a predetermined passage portion among these game parts A gaming machine that gives a privilege to a player when a game ball passes through (the operation port 83 or the like).

スロットマシン等の回胎匏遊技機耇数の図柄からなる図柄列を倉動衚瀺した埌に図柄列を最終停止衚瀺する可倉衚瀺手段を備え、始動甚操䜜手段の操䜜に起因しお図柄の倉動が開始され、停止甚操䜜手段の操䜜に起因しお又は所定時間経過するこずにより図柄の倉動が停止され、その停止時の最終停止図柄が特定図柄であるこずを必芁条件ずしお遊技者に有利な特別遊技状態ボヌナスゲヌム等を発生させるようにした遊技機。   Slot machine, etc .: A variable display means that displays a symbol sequence consisting of a plurality of symbols in a variable manner and then stops and displays the symbol sequence. Special game advantageous to the player on the condition that the change of the symbol is stopped due to the operation of the operation means for stoppage or when a predetermined time elapses and the final stop symbol at the time of stoppage is a specific symbol A gaming machine that generates a state (bonus game, etc.).

球䜿甚ベルト匏遊技機耇数の図柄からなる図柄列を倉動衚瀺した埌に図柄列を最終停止衚瀺する可倉衚瀺手段を備え、始動甚操䜜手段の操䜜に起因しお図柄の倉動が開始され、停止甚操䜜手段の操䜜に起因しお又は所定時間経過するこずにより図柄の倉動が停止され、その停止時の最終停止図柄が特定図柄であるこずを必芁条件ずしお遊技者に有利な特別遊技状態ボヌナスゲヌム等を発生させるようにし、さらに、球受皿を蚭けおその球受皿から遊技球を取り蟌む投入凊理を行う投入装眮ず、前蚘球受皿に遊技球の払出を行う払出装眮ずを備え、投入装眮により遊技球が投入されるこずにより前蚘始動甚操䜜手段の操䜜が有効ずなるように構成した遊技機。   Ball-use belt-type game machine: Equipped with variable display means that displays the symbol sequence consisting of multiple symbols in a variably displayed state, and then stops and displays the symbol sequence. The special game state (bonus) that is advantageous to the player on the condition that the change of the symbol is stopped due to the operation of the operating means or when the predetermined time elapses, and the final stop symbol at the time of the stop is a specific symbol A throwing device that performs a throwing process for taking in a game ball from the ball tray and a payout device for paying out the game ball to the ball tray, A gaming machine configured such that the operation of the starting operation means is made effective when a game ball is inserted by.

 遊技機ずしおのパチンコ機、 倖枠、 支持枠ずしおの内枠、 扉䜓ずしおの前扉枠、 パネル郚材ずしおのガラス、 ガラスホルダ、 遊技球発射ハンドル、 ハンドルベヌス、 鉀受け郚材、 暹脂ベヌス、 遊技盀収容郚、 䞭倮開口、 斜錠装眮蚭眮郚、 発射機構蚭眮郚、 遊技盀、 可倉衚瀺ナニット、 貫通孔、 挿通郚、 誘導手段ずしおの誘導レヌル、 内レヌル、 倖レヌル、 入口郚ずしおの入口郚分、 レヌル支持郚材、 遊技球発射装眮ずしおの遊技球発射機構、 発射レヌル、 平板郚ずしおの察向板郚、 䜍眮決め手段を構成する䜍眮決め突起、 囲み郚ずしおの呚壁郚、 茉眮郚ずしおの䞋偎壁郚、 圓接郚ずしおのストッパ、 付勢手段又は抌え郚ずしおの板バネ、 挿入郚、 仮眮き郚、 貫通孔ずしおのスリット、 察向壁郚、 開口郚、 鉀受け郚材、 鉀受け郚、 前偎板郚、 ベヌス板郚、 右枠郚、 蚭眮面、 䜍眮決め手段又は固定手段ずしおのロック装眮、 軞郚ずしおの軞䜓、 抌え郚ずしおのプッシャ、 付勢手段ずしおのコむルバネ、 操䜜レバヌ、 操䜜郚、 遊技領域区画郚材、 把持郚、 察向郚、 ナニット収容郚、 返しゎム、 ネゞ、 蚌玙、 識別ナニット、 斜錠装眮、 第基枠、 基枠固定郚、 郚材取付郚、 シリンダ錠、 錠軞郚、 キヌ孔、 カム郚材、 ネゞ、 連動杆、 フランゞ、 前扉甚第鉀郚材、 取付郚ずしおの突起、 鉀郚、 付勢郚材ずしおのコむルバネ、 前扉甚第鉀郚材、 カム郚材、 内枠甚鉀郚材、 取付郚ずしおの突起、 鉀郚、 操䜜キヌ、 遊技領域、 特定郚䜍。   DESCRIPTION OF SYMBOLS 10 ... Pachinko machine as game machine, 11 ... Outer frame, 12 ... Inner frame as support frame, 14 ... Front door frame as door body, 22 ... Glass as panel member, 27 ... Glass holder, 40 ... Game ball Launch handle, 41 ... handle base, 63 ... bowl receiving member, 70 ... resin base, 75 ... game board housing part, 76 ... central opening, 77 ... locking device installation part, 79 ... launch mechanism installation part, 80 ... game board, 85 ... Variable display unit, 91 ... Through hole, 92 ... Insertion part, 100 ... Guide rail as guide means, 101 ... Inner rail, 102 ... Outer rail, 104 ... Entrance part as inlet part, 107 ... Rail support member, DESCRIPTION OF SYMBOLS 110 ... Game ball | bowl launching mechanism as a game ball | bowl launcher, 112 ... Launch rail, 251 ... Opposite board part as a flat plate part, 259 ... Positioning protrusion which comprises positioning means, 261 ... As enclosure part 263... Lower wall portion as a mounting portion, 267... Stopper as a contact portion, 270... Leaf spring as urging means or pressing portion, 280... Inserting portion, 290. Slit as a through-hole, 305 ... opposing wall part, 320 ... opening, 350 ... saddle receiving member, 351 ... saddle receiving part, 352 ... front side plate part, 355 ... base plate part, 380 ... right frame part, 382 ... installation Surface 400, locking device as positioning means or fixing means, 410: shaft body as shaft portion, 420 ... pusher as pressing portion, 430 ... coil spring as urging means, 440 ... operation lever, 446 ... operation portion, 480: gaming area partition member, 481, 482 ... gripping part, 485 ... facing part, 486 ... unit accommodating part, 490 ... return rubber, 491 ... screw, 492 ... certificate, 494 ... identification unit, DESCRIPTION OF SYMBOLS 00 ... Locking device, 510 ... 1st base frame, 511 ... Base frame fixing | fixed part, 515 ... Member mounting part, 520 ... Cylinder lock, 523 ... Lock shaft part, 524 ... Key hole, 530 ... Cam member, 531 ... Screw, 540 ... Interlocking rod 545 ... Flange 550 ... First door member for front door 554 ... Protrusion as mounting portion 555 ... Hook portion 560 ... Coil spring as biasing member 580 ... Second hook member for front door , 600 ... Cam member, 620 ... Inner frame collar member, 622 ... Projection as an attachment part, 625 ... Gutter part, K ... Operation key, PE ... Game area, SP ... Specific part.

Claims (1)

支持察象によっお回動可胜に支持されおいる開閉䜓ず、
前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配されおいるずずもに、その開閉䜓に察しお同開閉䜓の前面偎から取り付けられ、圓該開閉䜓を前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じた状態で開攟䞍胜に斜錠する斜錠装眮ず
を備え、
前蚘斜錠装眮には、前蚘開閉䜓に圢成された貫通孔を通じお、遊技機埌方に突出し、同支持察象に蚭けられた鉀受け郚に匕っ掛かる匕っ掛かり䜍眮及び同鉀受け郚に匕っ掛からない匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮を含んだ範囲を移動可胜な鉀郚が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘開閉䜓には、前蚘貫通孔よりも前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎に配され、前蚘鉀郚が前蚘匕っ掛かり䜍眮から前蚘匕っ掛かり解陀䜍眮に移動する堎合に通過する領域に察しお前蚘開閉䜓の回動先端偎から重なる壁郚が蚭けられおおり、
前蚘鉀受け郚には、前蚘開閉䜓が前蚘支持察象に察しお閉じられおいる堎合に、前蚘壁郚の少なくずも先端郚䜍が挿入される挿入郚が圢成されおいるこずを特城ずする遊技機。
An opening / closing body rotatably supported by a support object;
The opening / closing body is disposed on the rotating front end side, and is attached to the opening / closing body from the front side of the opening / closing body, and locks the opening / closing body in an unopenable state in a closed state with respect to the support target. A locking device,
The locking device includes a hook position that protrudes to the rear of the gaming machine through a through-hole formed in the opening / closing body, and is hooked to a hook receiving portion provided in the support target, and a hook release position that is not hooked to the hook receiving portion. There is a buttocks that can move within the range,
The opening / closing body is disposed closer to the rotation tip side of the opening / closing body than the through hole, and the opening / closing body has a region that passes when the collar moves from the hook position to the hook release position. A wall that overlaps from the rotating tip side is provided,
The gaming machine according to claim 1, wherein an insertion portion into which at least a tip portion of the wall portion is inserted when the opening / closing body is closed with respect to the support target is formed in the hook receiving portion.
JP2013165425A 2013-08-08 2013-08-08 Game machine Pending JP2014004408A (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2013165425A JP2014004408A (en) 2013-08-08 2013-08-08 Game machine

Applications Claiming Priority (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2013165425A JP2014004408A (en) 2013-08-08 2013-08-08 Game machine

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
JP2009095320A Division JP5338440B2 (en) 2009-04-09 2009-04-09 Game machine

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
JP2015020001A Division JP2015083260A (en) 2015-02-04 2015-02-04 Game machine

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
JP2014004408A true JP2014004408A (en) 2014-01-16

Family

ID=50102673

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
JP2013165425A Pending JP2014004408A (en) 2013-08-08 2013-08-08 Game machine

Country Status (1)

Country Link
JP (1) JP2014004408A (en)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE102014118869A1 (en) 2014-01-14 2015-07-30 Toyota Jidosha Kabushiki Kaisha torsion damping

Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP2002177586A (en) * 2000-12-13 2002-06-25 Tsugio Kondo Lock device of pachinko machine
JP2005199005A (en) * 2003-12-16 2005-07-28 Chuto Sangyo Kk Locking device of game machine
JP2005207150A (en) * 2004-01-23 2005-08-04 Nitto Island Key Kk Locking device in game machine
JP2007289264A (en) * 2006-04-21 2007-11-08 Omron Corp Locking device and housing

Patent Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP2002177586A (en) * 2000-12-13 2002-06-25 Tsugio Kondo Lock device of pachinko machine
JP2005199005A (en) * 2003-12-16 2005-07-28 Chuto Sangyo Kk Locking device of game machine
JP2005207150A (en) * 2004-01-23 2005-08-04 Nitto Island Key Kk Locking device in game machine
JP2007289264A (en) * 2006-04-21 2007-11-08 Omron Corp Locking device and housing

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE102014118869A1 (en) 2014-01-14 2015-07-30 Toyota Jidosha Kabushiki Kaisha torsion damping

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
JP5278125B2 (en) Game machine
JP6418313B2 (en) Game machine
JP5278124B2 (en) Game machine
JP5332842B2 (en) Game machine
JP6460268B2 (en) Game machine
JP6485528B2 (en) Game machine
JP5637283B2 (en) Game machine
JP5741668B2 (en) Game machine
JP5402198B2 (en) Game machine
JP6610708B2 (en) Game machine
JP6601519B2 (en) Game machine
JP2016195899A (en) Game machine
JP5391791B2 (en) Game machine
JP5338440B2 (en) Game machine
JP5338441B2 (en) Game machine
JP2014004408A (en) Game machine
JP2014230920A (en) Game machine
JP2018130562A (en) Game machine
JP2017042639A (en) Game machine
JP2017038994A (en) Game machine
JP2017042640A (en) Game machine
JP2016182440A (en) Game machine
JP2016193285A (en) Game machine
JP2015083260A (en) Game machine
JP2015062811A (en) Game machine

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
A977 Report on retrieval

Free format text: JAPANESE INTERMEDIATE CODE: A971007

Effective date: 20140530

A131 Notification of reasons for refusal

Free format text: JAPANESE INTERMEDIATE CODE: A131

Effective date: 20140603

A02 Decision of refusal

Free format text: JAPANESE INTERMEDIATE CODE: A02

Effective date: 20141104